Provisioning Transponder and Muxponder Cards

This chapter describes transponder (TXP), muxponder (MXP), GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, 10GE_XPE, ADM-10G, OTU2_XP, 100G-LC-C, 10x10G-LC, CFP-LC, 100G-CK-C, 100G-ME-C,100ME-CKC, 100GS-CK-LC, 400G-XP-LC, WSE, AR_MXP, AR_XP, and AR_XPE cards, as well as their associated plug-in modules (Small Form-factor Pluggables [SFP, SFP+, XFP, CXP, or CFP module]). For card safety and compliance information, see the Regulatory Compliance and Safety Information for Cisco NCS Platform document.


Note


The cards and procedures described in this chapter are supported on the Cisco NCS 2002 and Cisco NCS 2006 platforms, unless noted otherwise.



Note


Cisco NCS supports IBM's 5G DDR (Double Data Rate) InfiniBand interfaces.

5G DDR InfiniBand is referred to as IB_5G.

Card Overview

The card overview section lists the cards described in this chapter and provides compatibility information.

The purpose of a TXP, MXP, GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, 10GE_XPE, ADM-10G, OTU2_XP, AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card is to convert the “gray” optical client interface signals into trunk signals that operate in the “colored” dense wavelength division multiplexing (DWDM) wavelength range. Client-facing gray optical signals generally operate at shorter wavelengths, whereas DWDM colored optical signals are in the longer wavelength range (for example, 1490 nm = violet; 1510 nm = blue; 1530 nm = green; 1550 nm = yellow; 1570 nm = orange; 1590 nm = red; 1610 nm = brown). Some of the newer client-facing PPMs, however, operate in the colored region. Transponding or muxponding is the process of converting the signals between the client and trunk wavelengths.

An MXP generally handles several client signals. It aggregates, or multiplexes, lower rate client signals together and sends them out over a higher rate trunk port. Likewise, it demultiplexes optical signals coming in on a trunk and sends them out to individual client ports. A TXP converts a single client signal to a single trunk signal and converts a single incoming trunk signal to a single client signal. GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards can be provisioned as TXPs, as MXPs, or as Layer 2 switches.

All of the TXP and MXP cards perform optical to electrical to optical (OEO) conversion. As a result, they are not optically transparent cards. The reason for this is that the cards must operate on the signals passing through them, so it is necessary to do an OEO conversion.

On the other hand, the termination mode for all of the TXPs and MXPs, which is done at the electrical level, can be configured to be transparent. In this case, neither the Line nor the Section overhead is terminated. The cards can also be configured so that either Line or Section overhead can be terminated, or both can be terminated.


Note


The MXP_2.5G_10G card, by design, when configured in the transparent termination mode, actually does terminate some of the bytes. See "Termination Modes" section for details.


Card Compatibility

Table 1 Platform and Software Release Compatibility for Transponder and Muxponder Cards

Card Name

R10.0

R10.1

R10.3

R10.5

R10.5.2

R10.6.1

TXP_MR_10E_C

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

TXP_MR_10E_L

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

TXP_MR_10E

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006, NCS 2015

NCS 2002, NCS 2006, NCS 2015

TXP_MR_2.5G, TXPP_MR_2.5G

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

MXP_2.5G_10G

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

MXP_2.5G_10E_C

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

MXP_2.5G_10E_L

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

MXP_MR_2.5G, MXPP_MR_2.5G

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

MXP_MR_10DME_C

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

MXP_MR_10DME_L

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

GE_XP and 10GE_XP

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

GE_XPE and 10GE_XPE

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

ADM-10G

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

OTU2_XP

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006, NCS 2015

NCS 2002, NCS 2006, NCS 2015

TXP_MR_10EX_C, MXP_2.5G_10EX_C, MXP_MR_10DMEX_C

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

40E-TXP-C, 40ME-TXP-C, 40ME-MXP-C

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

40E-MXP-C

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006, NCS 2015

NCS 2002, NCS 2006, NCS 2015

40G-MXP-C

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

AR_XP

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006, NCS 2015

NCS 2002, NCS 2006, NCS 2015

AR_MXP, AR_XPE

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006, NCS 2015

NCS 2002, NCS 2006, NCS 2015

NCS 2002, NCS 2006, NCS 2015

100G-LC-C, 100G-ME-C, 10x10G-LC

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006, NCS 2015

NCS 2002, NCS 2006, NCS 2015

NCS 2002, NCS 2006, NCS 2015

CFP-LC

NCS 2006

NCS 2006

NCS 2006

NCS 2006

NCS 2006, NCS 2015

NCS 2006, NCS 2015

WSE

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006, NCS 2015

NCS 2002, NCS 2006, NCS 2015

NCS 2002, NCS 2006, NCS 2015

100G-CK-LC, 100ME-CK-LC

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

100GS-CK-LC

No

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006, NCS 2015

NCS 2002, NCS 2006, NCS 2015

NCS 2002, NCS 2006, NCS 2015

200G-CK-LC

No

No

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006, NCS 2015

NCS 2002, NCS 2006, NCS 2015

NCS 2002, NCS 2006, NCS 2015

MR-MXP

No

No

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006, NCS 2015

NCS 2002, NCS 2006, NCS 2015

NCS 2002, NCS 2006, NCS 2015

100ME-CKC

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006, NCS 2015

NCS 2002, NCS 2006, NCS 2015

NCS 2002, NCS 2006, NCS 2015

100G-CK-C

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006

NCS 2002, NCS 2006, NCS 2015

NCS 2002, NCS 2006, NCS 2015

NCS 2002, NCS 2006, NCS 2015

400G-XP-LC

No

No

No

No

No

NCS 2006, NCS 2015

Version Number Compatibility for Transponder and Muxponder Cards

Older versions of the TXP_MR_10E_C, TXP_MR_2.5G, TXPP_MR_2.5G, and MXP_2.5G_10E_C cards cannot be installed in the Cisco NCS 2002 and Cisco NCS 2006 shelves because of an incompatible backplane connector.

The following table describes the version numbers of the cards that are compatible with the Cisco NCS 2002 and Cisco NCS 2006 shelves. The version numbers can be viewed from the HW Rev field in the Inventory tab.

Table 2 Version Number Compatibility
Card Version Number
TXP_MR_2.5G Version 06 or later of the different unit part number
TXPP_MR_2.5G Version 06 or later of the different unit part number
MXP_2.5G_10E_C Version 04 or later of the 800-26774 part number
TXP_MR_10E_C Version 04 or later of the 800-26772 part number

Safety Labels

For information about safety labels, see the "Safety Labels" section.

Interface Classes

The input interface cards have been grouped in classes listed in the following table. The subsequent tables list the optical performance and output power of each interface class.

Table 3  Card Interfaces Assigned to Input Power Classes

Input Power Class

Card

A

10-Gbps multirate transponder cards (TXP_MR_10G, TXP_MR_10E, TXP_MR_10E_C, and TXP_MR_10E_L) with forward error correction (FEC) enabled, 10-Gbps muxponder cards (MXP_2.5G_10G, MXP_2.5G_10E, MXP_MR_10DME_C, MXP_MR_10DME_L, MXP_2.5G_10E_C, and MXP_2.5G_10E_L) with FEC enabled, 40-Gbps transponder cards (40E-TXP-C, and 40ME-TXP-C), and 40-Gbps muxponder cards (40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C)

B

10-Gbps multirate transponder card (TXP_MR_10G) without FEC and the 10-Gbps muxponder card (MXP_2.5G_10G, MXP_MR_10DME_C, MXP_MR_10DME_L), 40-Gbps transponder cards (40E-TXP-C, and 40ME-TXP-C), and 40-Gbps muxponder cards (40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C), and ADM-10G cards with FEC disabled

C

OC-192 LR ITU cards without FEC, 10-Gbps multirate transponder (TXP_MR_10E, TXP_MR_10E_C, and TXP_MR_10E_L) and muxponder (MXP_2.5G_10E, MXP_2.5G_10E_L, and MXP_MR_10DME_L) cards with FEC disabled

D

2.5-Gbps multirate transponder card (TXP_MR_2.5G), both protected and unprotected, with FEC enabled

E

OC-48 100-GHz dense wavelength division multiplexing (DWDM) muxponder card (MXP_MR_2.5G) and 2.5-Gbps multirate transponder card (TXP_MR_2.5G), protected or unprotected; FEC disabled; and retime, reshape, and regenerate (3R) mode enabled

F

2.5-Gbps multirate transponder card (TXP_MR_2.5G), protected or unprotected, in regenerate and reshape (2R) mode

G

OC-48 ELR 100 GHz card

H

2/4 port GbE transponder (GBIC WDM 100GHz)

I

10-Gbps multirate transponder cards (TXP_MR_10E, TXP_MR_10E_C, and TXP_MR_10E_L) and 10-Gbps muxponder cards (MXP_2.5G_10E, MXP_2.5G_10E_L, and MXP_MR_10DME_L) with enhanced FEC (E-FEC) enabled, 40-Gbps transponder cards (40E-TXP-C, and 40ME-TXP-C), and 40-Gbps muxponder cards (40G-MXP-C, 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C) with E-FEC enabled

K

OC-192/STM-64 LR ITU cards without FEC, 100GHz 10Gbps Ethernet Xponder (GE_XP, GE_XPE, 10GE_XP, 10GE_XPE), Sonet/SDH add/drop (ADM_10G), OTU2 Xponder (OTU2_XP), with FEC disabled

L

40Gbps Duobinary CRS-1 DWDM ITU-T line card

M

2.5 Gbps DWDM ITU-T SPF

N

10Gbps enhanced full tunable transponder (TXP_MR_10E_C) and muxponder (MXP_2.5G_10E_C, MXP_MR_10DME_C) with E-FEC enabled

O

10Gbps Ethernet Xponder (GE_XP, GE_XPE, 10GE_XP, 10GE_XPE), 10Gbps Sonet/SDH add/drop (ADM_10G), OTU2 Xponder (OTU2_XP), with FEC enabled

P

10Gbps Ethernet Xponder (GE_XP, GE_XPE, 10GE_XP, 10GE_XPE), 10Gbps Sonet/SDH add/drop (ADM_10G), OTU2 Xponder (OTU2_XP), with E-FEC enabled

T

40Gbps DPSK CRS-1 DWDM ITU-T line card

V

OC-192/STM-64 LR ITU cards without FEC, full tunable 10Gbps Ethernet Xponder (GE_XP, GE_XPE, 10GE_XP, 10GE_XPE), Sonet/SDH add/drop (ADM_10G), OTU2 Xponder (OTU2_XP), with FEC disabled, full tunable

W

10Gbps Ethernet Xponder (GE_XP, GE_XPE, 10GE_XP, 10GE_XPE), Sonet/SDH add/drop (ADM_10G), OTU2 Xponder (OTU2_XP), with FEC enabled, full tunable

X

10Gbps Ethernet Xponder (GE_XP, GE_XPE, 10GE_XP, 10GE_XPE), Sonet/SDH add/drop (ADM_10G), OTU2 Xponder (OTU2_XP), with E-FEC enabled, full tunable

Y

10Gbps enhanced full tunable transponder (TXP_MR_10EX_C) and muxponder (MXP_2.5G_10EX_C, MXP_MR_10DMEX_C), with FEC enabled and maximum likelihood sequence estimator (MLSE) correction

Z

10Gbps enhanced full tunable transponder (TXP_MR_10EX_C) and muxponder (MXP_2.5G_10EX_C, MXP_MR_10DMEX_C), with E-FEC enabled and MLSE correction

Table 4 40-Gbps Interface Optical Performance

Parameter

Class A

Class B

Class I

Type

Power Limited

OSNR Limited
(if appl.)

OSNR = optical signal-to-noise ratio

Power Limited

OSNR Limited
(if appl.)

Power Limited

OSNR Limited
(if appl.)

Maximum bit rate

40 Gbps

40 Gbps

40 Gbps

Regeneration

3R

3R

3R

FEC

Yes

No

Yes (E-FEC)

Threshold

Optimum

Average

Optimum

Maximum BER

BER = bit error rate

10–15

10–12

10–15

OSNR sensitivity

OSNR = optical signal-to-noise ratio

23 dB

9 dB

23 dB

19 dB

20 dB

8 dB

Power sensitivity

–24 dBm

–18 dBm

–21 dBm

–20 dBm

–26 dBm

–18 dBm

Power overload

–8 dBm

–8 dBm

–8 dBm

Transmitted Power Range—These values, decreased by patchcord and connector losses, are also the input power values for the OADM cards.

40-Gbps multirate transponder/40-Gbps FEC transponder (40E-TXP-C, and 40ME-TXP-C)

+2.5 to 3.5 dBm

+2.5 to 3.5 dBm

OC-192 LR ITU

Dispersion compensation tolerance

+/–800 ps/nm

+/–1,000 ps/nm

+/–800 ps/nm

Table 5 10-Gbps Interface Optical Performance (Class A, B, C, I, and K)

Parameter

Class A

Class B

Class C

Class I

Class K

Type

Power Limited

OSNR Limited

Power Limited

OSNR Limited

Power Limited

OSNR Limited

Power Limited

OSNR Limited

Power Limited

OSNR Limited

Maximum bit rate

10 Gbps

10 Gbps

10 Gbps

10 Gbps

10 Gbps

Regeneration

3R

3R

3R

3R

3R

FEC

Yes

No

No

Yes (E-FEC)

No

Threshold

Optimum

Average

Average

Optimum

Average

Maximum BER

10–15

10–12

10–12

10–15

10–12

OSNR sensitivity

23 dB

8.5 dB

23 dB

19 dB

19 dB

19 dB

20 dB

6 dB

23 dB

This value is for Xen Pak XFP used with Catalyst card.

16 dB3

23 dB

This value is for XFP used with Catalyst, Xponder, and ADM-10G cards.

17 dB4

23 dB

This value is for X2 XFP used with Catalyst card.

17 dB5

Power sensitivity

–24 dBm

–18 dBm

–21 dBm

–20 dBm

–22 dBm

–22 dBm

–26 dBm

–18 dBm

–24 dBm3

–17 dBm3

–23 dBm4

–18 dBm4

–23 dBm5

–17 dBm5

Power overload

–8 dBm

–8 dBm

–9 dBm

–8 dBm

–7 dBm

Transmitted Power Range—These values, decreased by patchcord and connector losses, are also the input power values for the optical add drop multiplexer (OADM) cards.

10-Gbps multirate transponder /10-Gbps FEC transponder

+2.5 to 3.5 dBm (for TXP_MR_10G)

+3.0 to 6.0 dBm (for TXP_MR_10E)

+2.5 to 3.5 dBm

+3.0 to 6.0 dBm

+3.0 to 6.0 dBm

OC-192 LR ITU

+3.0 to 6.0 dBm

–1.0 to +3.0 dBm

10-Gbps Ethernet Xponder, Sonet/SDH Add/Drop, OTU2 Xponder

–1.0 to +3.0 dBm

Dispersion compensation tolerance

+/–800 ps/nm

+/–1,000 ps/nm

+/–1,000 ps/nm

+/–800 ps/nm

–400 to +800 ps/nm

Table 6 10-Gbps Interface Optical Performance (Class N, O, P, and V)

Parameter

Class N

Class O

Class P

Class V

Type

Power Limited

OSNR Limited

Power Limited

OSNR Limited

Power Limited

OSNR Limited

Power Limited

OSNR Limited

Maximum bit rate

10 Gbps

10 Gbps

10 Gbps

10 Gbps

Regeneration

3R

3R

3R

3R

FEC

Yes (E-FEC)

Yes

Yes (E-FEC)

No

Threshold

Optimum

Optimum

Optimum

Average

Maximum BER

10–15

10–15

10–15

10–12

OSNR sensitivity

19 dB

5 dB

11 dB

11 dB

23 dB

8 dB

23 dB

16 dB

Power sensitivity

–27 dBm

–20 dBm

–18 dBm

–18 dBm

–27 dBm

–18 dBm

–24 dBm

–18 dBm

Power overload

–8 dBm

–7 dBm

–7 dBm

–7 dBm

Transmitted Power Range—These values, decreased by patchcord and connector losses, are also the input power values for the optical add drop multiplexer (OADM) cards.

10-Gbps multirate transponder/10-Gbps FEC transponder

+3.0 to 6.0 dBm

OC-192 LR ITU

0 to +3.0 dBm

10-Gbps Ethernet Xponder, Sonet/SDH Add/Drop, OTU2 Xponder

–1.0 to +3.0 dBm

–1.0 to +3.0 dBm

0 to +3.0 dBm

Dispersion compensation tolerance

+/–800 ps/nm

–500 to +1100 ps/nm

–500 to +1100 ps/nm

–500 to +1600 ps/nm

Table 7 10-Gbps Interface Optical Performance (Class W, X, Y, and Z)

Parameter

Class W

Class X

Class Y

Class Z

Type

Power Limited

OSNR Limited

Power Limited

OSNR Limited

Power Limited

OSNR Limited

Power Limited

OSNR Limited

Maximum bit rate

10 Gbps

10 Gbps

10 Gbps

10 Gbps

Regeneration

3R

3R

3R

3R

FEC

Yes

Yes (E-FEC)

Yes

Yes (E-FEC)

Threshold

Optimum

Optimum

Optimum

Optimum

Maximum BER

10–15

10–15

10–15

10–15

OSNR sensitivity

8.5 dB

8.5 dB

19 dB

5 dB

23 dB

8 dB

19 dB

5.5 dB

Power sensitivity

–18 dBm

–18 dBm

–27 dBm

–20 dBm

–24 dBm

–20 dBm

–27 dBm

–20 dBm

Power overload

–7 dBm

–7 dBm

–8 dBm

–8 dBm

Transmitted Power Range—These values, decreased by patchcord and connector losses, are also the input power values for the optical add drop multiplexer (OADM) cards.

10-Gbps multirate transponder/10-Gbps FEC transponder

+3.0 to 6.0 dBm

+3.0 to 6.0 dBm

OC-192 LR ITU

10-Gbps Ethernet Xponder, Sonet/SDH Add/Drop, OTU2 Xponder

0 to +3.0 dBm

0 to +3.0 dBm

Dispersion compensation tolerance

–500 to +1100 ps/nm

–500 to +1300 ps/nm

–800 to +1600 ps/nm

–2200 to +3700 ps/nm

Table 8 2.5-Gbps Interface Optical Performance (Class D, E, and F)

Parameter

Class D

Class E

Class F

Type

Power Limited

OSNR Limited

Power Limited

OSNR Limited

Power Limited

OSNR Limited

Maximum bit rate

2.5 Gbps

2.5 Gbps

2.5 Gbps

Regeneration

3R

3R

2R

FEC

Yes

No

No

Threshold

Average

Average

Average

Maximum BER

10–15

10–12

10–12

OSNR sensitivity

14 dB

5 dB

14 dB

10 dB

15 dB

15 dB

Power sensitivity

–31 dBm

–25 dBm

–30 dBm

–23 dBm

–24 dBm

–24 dBm

Power overload

–9 dBm

–9 dBm

–9 dBm

Transmitted Power Range—These values, decreased by patchcord and connector losses, are also the input power values for the optical add drop multiplexer (OADM) cards.

TXP_MR_2.5G and TXPP_MR_2.5G

–1.0 to 1.0 dBm

–1.0 to 1.0 dBm

–1.0 to 1.0 dBm

MXP_MR_2.5G and MXPP_MR_2.5G

+2.0 to +4.0 dBm

OC-48 ELR 100 GHz

2/4 port GbE Transponder (GBIC WDM 100GHz)

2.5 Gbps DWDM ITU-T SPF

Dispersion compensation tolerance

–1200 to +5400 ps/nm

–1200 to +5400 ps/nm

–1200 to +3300 ps/nm

Table 9 2.5-Gbps Interface Optical Performance (Class G, H, and M)

Parameter

Class G

Class H

Class M

Type

Power Limited

OSNR Limited

Power Limited

OSNR Limited

Power Limited

OSNR Limited

Maximum bit rate

2.5 Gbps

1.25 Gbps

2.5 Gbps

Regeneration

3R

3R

3R

FEC

No

No

No

Threshold

Average

Average

Average

Maximum BER

10–12

10–12

10–12

OSNR sensitivity

14 dB

11 dB

13 dB

8 dB

14 dB

9 dB

Power sensitivity

–27 dBm

–23 dBm

–28 dBm

–18 dBm

–28 dBm

–22 dBm

Power overload

–9 dBm

–7 dBm

–9 dBm

Transmitted Power Range—These values, decreased by patchcord and connector losses, are also the input power values for the optical add drop multiplexer (OADM) cards.

   

TXP_MR_2.5G

TXPP_MR_2.5G

MXP_MR_2.5G

–2.0 to 0 dBm

MXPP_MR_2.5G

OC-48 ELR 100 GHz

2/4 port GbE Transponder (GBIC WDM 100GHz)

–1200 to +3300 ps/nm

0 to +3 dBm

2.5 Gbps DWDM ITU-T SPF

 

0 to +4 dBm

Dispersion compensation tolerance

 

–1000 to +3600 ps/nm

–800 to +2400 ps/nm

TXP_MR_10E Card

The card is fully backward compatible with the TXP_MR_10G card. It processes one 10-Gbps signal (client side) into one 10-Gbps, 100-GHz DWDM signal (trunk side) that is tunable over four wavelength channels (spaced at 100 GHz on the ITU grid) in the C band and tunable over eight wavelength channels (spaced at 50 GHz on the ITU grid) in the L band. There are eight versions of the C-band card, with each version covering four wavelengths, for a total coverage of 32 wavelengths. There are five versions of the L-band card, with each version covering eight wavelengths, for a total coverage of 40 wavelengths.

You can install TXP_MR_10E cards in , Slot 2 in Cisco NCS 2002 chassis, Slots 2 to 6 in Cisco NCS 2006, Slots 2 to 17 in Cisco NCS 2015 chassis and provision the cards in a linear configuration, BLSR/MS-SPRing, path protection/SNCP, or a regenerator. The card can be used in the middle of BLSR/MS-SPRing or 1+1 spans when the card is configured for transparent termination mode.

The TXP_MR_10E card features a 1550-nm tunable laser (C band) or a 1580-nm tunable laser (L band) for the trunk port and ONS-XC-10G-S1 1310-nm or ONS-XC-10G-L2 1550-nm laser XFP module for the client port that can be ordered separately.


Note


When the ONS-XC-10G-L2 XFP is installed, the TXP_MR_10E card must be installed in Slots 6, 7, 12 or 13).


On its faceplate, the TXP_MR_10E card contains two transmit and receive connector pairs, one for the trunk port and one for the client port. Each connector pair is labeled.

Key Features

The key features of the TXP_MR_10E card are:

  • A tri-rate client interface (available through the ONS-XC-10G-S1 XFP, ordered separately)

    • OC-192 (SR1)

    • 10GE (10GBASE-LR)

    • 10G-FC (1200-SM-LL-L)

  • OC-192 to ITU-T G.709 OTU2 provisionable synchronous and asynchronous mapping

  • The MTU setting is used to display the OverSizePkts counters on the receiving trunk and client port interfaces. Traffic of frame sizes up to 65535 bytes pass without any packet drops, from the client port to the trunk port and vice versa irrespective of the MTU setting.

TXP_MR_10E Functions

The following functions of the TXP_MR_10E card are explained in "Card Features" chapter:
  •  Client Interface

  •  DWDM Trunk Interface

  • FEC

  • Client-to-Trunk Mapping

For more information about the TXP_MR_10E card, see http:/​/​www.cisco.com/​en/​US/​prod/​collateral/​optical/​ps5724/​ps2006/​ps5320/​product_​data_​sheet0900aecd803fc3e8_​ps13234_​Products_​Data_​Sheet.html.

Related Procedures for TXP_MR_10E Card

The following is the list of procedures and tasks related to the configuration of the TXP_MR_10E card:

TXP_MR_10E_C and TXP_MR_10E_L Cards

The TXP_MR_10E_C and TXP_MR_10E_L cards are fully backward compatible with the TXP_MR_10G and TXP_MR_10E cards. They processes one 10-Gbps signal (client side) into one 10-Gbps, 100-GHz DWDM signal (trunk side). The TXP_MR_10E_C is tunable over the entire set of C-band wavelength channels (82 channels spaced at 50 GHz on the ITU grid). The TXP_MR_10E_L is tunable over the entire set of L-band wavelength channels (80 channels spaced at 50 GHz on the ITU grid) and is particularly well suited for use in networks that employ DS fiber or SMF-28 single-mode fiber.

The advantage of these cards over previous versions (TXP_MR_10G and TXP_MR_10E) is that there is only one version of each card (one C-band version and one L-band version) instead of several versions needed to cover each band.

You can install TXP_MR_10E_C and TXP_MR_10E_L cards in , Slot 2 in Cisco NCS 2002 chassis, Slots 2 to 6 in Cisco NCS 2006 and provision the cards in a linear configuration, BLSR/MS-SPRing, path protection/SNCP, or a regenerator. The cards can be used in the middle of BLSR/MS-SPRing or 1+1 spans when the cards are configured for transparent termination mode.

The TXP_MR_10E_C and TXP_MR_10E_L cards feature a universal transponder 2 (UT2) 1550-nm tunable laser (C band) or a UT2 1580-nm tunable laser (L band) for the trunk port and a separately orderable ONS-XC-10G-S1 1310-nm or ONS-XC-10G-L2 1550-nm laser XFP module for the client port.

On its faceplate, the TXP_MR_10E_C and TXP_MR_10E_L cards contain two transmit and receive connector pairs, one for the trunk port and one for the client port. Each connector pair is labeled.

Key Features

The key features of the TXP_MR_10E_C and TXP_MR_10E_L cards are:

  • A tri-rate client interface (available through the ONS-XC-10G-S1 XFP, ordered separately):

    • OC-192 (SR1)

    • 10GE (10GBASE-LR)

    • 10G-FC (1200-SM-LL-L)

  • A UT2 module tunable through the entire C band (TXP_MR_10E_C card) or L band (TXP_MR_10E_L card). The channels are spaced at 50 GHz on the ITU grid.

  • OC-192 to ITU-T G.709 OTU2 provisionable synchronous and asynchronous mapping.

  • The MTU setting is used to display the OverSizePkts counters on the receiving trunk and client port interfaces. Traffic of frame sizes up to 65535 bytes pass without any packet drops, from the client port to the trunk port and vice versa irrespective of the MTU setting.

Faceplates and Block Diagram

Figure 1. TXP_MR_10E_C and TXP_MR_10E_L Faceplates and Block Diagram



For information about safety labels for the cards, see the "Class 1M Laser Product Cards" section.


Caution


You must use a 15-dB fiber attenuator (10 to 20 dB) when working with the TXP_MR_10E_C or TXP_MR_10E_L card in a loopback on the trunk port. Do not use direct fiber loopbacks with the cards. Using direct fiber loopbacks causes irreparable damage to the cards.


TXP_MR_10E_C and TXP_MR_10E_L Functions

The following functions of the TXP_MR_10E_C and TXP_MR_10E_L cards are explained in "Card Features" chapter:
  • Automatic Laser Shutdown

  • Card level indicators

  • Port level indicators

  • Client Interface

  • DWDM Trunk Interface

  • FEC

  •  Client-to-Trunk Mapping

Related Procedures for TXP_MR_10E_C and TXP_MR_10E_L Cards

The following is the list of procedures and tasks related to the configuration for both TXP_MR_10E_C and TXP_MR_10E_L:

TXP_MR_2.5G and TXPP_MR_2.5G Cards

The TXP_MR_2.5G card processes one 8-Mbps to 2.488-Gbps signal (client side) into one 8-Mbps to 2.5-Gbps, 100-GHz DWDM signal (trunk side). It provides one long-reach STM-16/OC-48 port per card, compliant with ITU-T G.707, ITU-T G.709, ITU-T G.957, and Telcordia GR-253-CORE.

The TXPP_MR_2.5G card processes one 8-Mbps to 2.488-Gbps signal (client side) into two 8-Mbps to 2.5-Gbps, 100-GHz DWDM signals (trunk side). It provides two long-reach STM-16/OC-48 ports per card, compliant with ITU-T G.707, ITU-T G.957, and Telcordia GR-253-CORE.

The TXP_MR_2.5G and TXPP_MR_2.5G cards are tunable over four wavelengths in the 1550-nm, ITU 100-GHz range. They are available in eight versions, each of which covers four wavelengths, for a total coverage of 32 different wavelengths in the 1550-nm range.


Note


ITU-T G.709 specifies a form of FEC that uses a “wrapper” approach. The digital wrapper lets you transparently take in a signal on the client side, wrap a frame around it, and restore it to its original form. FEC enables longer fiber links because errors caused by the optical signal degrading with distance are corrected.


The trunk/line port operates at up to 2.488 Gbps (or up to 2.66 Gbps with ITU-T G.709 Digital Wrapper/FEC) over unamplified distances up to 360 km (223.7 miles) with different types of fiber such as C-SMF or higher if dispersion compensation is used.


Caution


Because the transponder has no capability to look into the payload and detect circuits, a TXP_MR_2.5G or TXPP_MR_2.5G card does not display circuits under card view.


The TXP_MR_2.5G and TXPP_MR_2.5G cards support 2R (retime, regenerate) and 3R (retime, reshape, and regenerate) modes of operation where the client signal is mapped into a ITU-T G.709 frame. The mapping function is simply done by placing a digital wrapper around the client signal. Only OC-48/STM-16 client signals are fully ITU-T G.709 compliant, and the output bit rate depends on the input client signal. The following table shows the possible combinations of client interfaces, input bit rates, 2R and 3R modes, and ITU-T G.709 monitoring.

Table 10 2R and 3R Mode and ITU-T G.709 Compliance by Client Interface

Client Interface

Input Bit Rate

3R vs. 2R

ITU-T G.709

OC-48/STM-16

2.488 Gbps

3R

On or Off

DV-6000

2.38 Gbps

2R

2 Gigabit Fibre Channel (2G-FC)/fiber connectivity (FICON)

2.125 Gbps

3R

No monitoring

On or Off

High-Definition Television (HDTV)

1.48 Gbps

2R

Gigabit Ethernet (GE)

1.25 Gbps

3R

On or Off

1 Gigabit Fibre Channel (1G-FC)/FICON

1.06 Gbps

3R

On or Off

OC-12/STM-4

622 Mbps

3R

On or Off

OC-3/STM-1

155 Mbps

3R

On or Off

Enterprise System Connection (ESCON)

200 Mbps

2R

SDI/D1/DVB-ASI video

270 Mbps

2R

ISC-1 Compat

1.06 Gbps

2R

Off

ISC-3

1.06 or 2.125 Gbps

2R

ETR_CLO

16 Mbps

2R


Note


ITU-T G.709 and FEC support is disabled for all the 2R payload types in the TXP_MR_2.5G and TXPP_MR_2.5G cards.


The output bit rate is calculated for the trunk bit rate by using the 255/238 ratio as specified in ITU-T G.709 for OTU1. The following table lists the calculated trunk bit rates for the client interfaces with ITU-T G.709 enabled.

Table 11 Trunk Bit Rates With ITU-T G.709 Enabled

Client Interface

ITU-T G.709 Disabled

ITU-T G.709 Enabled

OC-48/STM-16

2.488 Gbps

2.66 Gbps

2G-FC

2.125 Gbps

2.27 Gbps

GE

1.25 Gbps

1.34 Gbps

1G-FC

1.06 Gbps

1.14 Gbps

OC-12/STM-3

622 Mbps

666.43 Mbps

OC-3/STM-1

155 Mbps

166.07 Mbps

For 2R operation mode, the TXP_MR_2.5G and TXPP_MR_2.5G cards have the ability to pass data through transparently from client side interfaces to a trunk side interface, which resides on an ITU grid. The data might vary at any bit rate from 200-Mbps up to 2.38-Gbps, including ESCON, DVB-ASI, ISC-1, and video signals. In this pass-through mode, no performance monitoring (PM) or digital wrapping of the incoming signal is provided, except for the usual PM outputs from the SFPs. Similarly, this card has the ability to pass data through transparently from the trunk side interfaces to the client side interfaces with bit rates varying from 200-Mbps up to 2.38-Gbps. Again, no PM or digital wrapping of received signals is available in this pass-through mode.

For 3R operation mode, the TXP_MR_2.5G and TXPP_MR_2.5G cards apply a digital wrapper to the incoming client interface signals (OC-N/STM-N, 1G-FC, 2G-FC, GE). PM is available on all of these signals except for 2G-FC, and varies depending upon the type of signal. For client inputs other than OC-48/STM-16, a digital wrapper might be applied but the resulting signal is not ITU-T G.709 compliant. The card applies a digital wrapper that is scaled to the frequency of the input signal.

The TXP_MR_2.5G and TXPP_MR_2.5G cards have the ability to take digitally wrapped signals in from the trunk interface, remove the digital wrapper, and send the unwrapped data through to the client interface. PM of the ITU-T G.709 OH and SONET/SDH OH is implemented.

You can install TXP_MR_2.5G and TXPP_MR_2.5G cards in , Slot 2 in Cisco NCS 2002 chassis, Slots 2 to 6 in Cisco NCS 2006. You can provision this card in a linear configuration. TXP_MR_10G and TXPP_MR_2.5G cards cannot be provisioned as a BLSR/MS-SPRing, a path protection/SNCP, or a regenerator. They can be used in the middle of BLSR/MS-SPRing or 1+1 spans only when the card is configured for transparent termination mode.

The TXP_MR_2.5G card features a 1550-nm laser for the trunk/line port and a 1310-nm laser for the client port. It contains two transmit and receive connector pairs (labeled) on the card faceplate. The card uses dual LC connectors for optical cable termination.

The TXPP_MR_2.5G card features a 1550-nm laser for the trunk/line port and a 1310-nm or 850-nm laser (depending on the SFP) for the client port and contains three transmit and receive connector pairs (labeled) on the card faceplate. The card uses dual LC connectors for optical cable termination.

Related Procedures for TXP_MR_2.5G and TXPP_MR_2.5G Cards

The following is the list of procedures and tasks related to the configuration for both TXP_MR_2.5G and TXPP_MR_2.5G:

40E-TXP-C and 40ME-TXP-C Cards

The 40E-TXP-C and 40ME-TXP-C cards process a single 40-Gbps signal (client side) into a single 40-Gbps, 50-GHz DWDM signal (trunk side). It provides one 40-Gbps port per card that can be provisioned for an OC-768/STM-256 very short reach (1550-nm) signal compliant with ITU-T G.707, ITU-T G.691, and Telcordia GR-253-CORE, 40G Ethernet LAN signal compliant with IEEE 802.3ba, or OTU3 signal compliant with ITU-T G.709.

You can install and provision the 40E-TXP-C and 40ME-TXP-C cards in a linear configuration in:

  • Slot 2 in Cisco NCS 2002 chassis

  • Slots 2 to 6 in Cisco NCS 2006 chassis

When a protection switch occurs on the 40E-TXP-C, and 40ME-TXP-C cards, the recovery from PSM protection switch takes about 3 to 4 minutes.

For more information about the 40E-TXP-C and 40ME-TXP-C cards, see http:/​/​www.cisco.com/​en/​US/​prod/​collateral/​optical/​ps5724/​ps2006/​data_​sheet_​c78-643796.html.

Related Procedures for 40E-TXP-C and 40ME-TXP-C Cards

The following is the list of procedures and tasks related to the configuration of 40E-TXP-C and 40ME-TXP-C:

MXP_2.5G_10G Card

The MXP_2.5G_10G card multiplexes/demultiplexes four 2.5-Gbps signals (client side) into one 10-Gbps, 100-GHz DWDM signal (trunk side). It provides one extended long-range STM-64/OC-192 port per card on the trunk side (compliant with ITU-T G.707, ITU-T G.709, ITU-T G.957, and Telcordia GR-253-CORE) and four intermediate- or short-range OC-48/STM-16 ports per card on the client side. The port operates at 9.95328 Gbps over unamplified distances up to 80 km (50 miles) with different types of fiber such as C-SMF or dispersion compensated fiber limited by loss and/or dispersion.

Client ports on the MXP_2.5G_10G card are also interoperable with SONET OC-1 (STS-1) fiber optic signals defined in Telcordia GR-253-CORE. An OC-1 signal is the equivalent of one DS-3 channel transmitted across optical fiber. OC-1 is primarily used for trunk interfaces to phone switches in the United States. There is no SDH equivalent for SONET OC-1.

The MXP_2.5G_10G card is tunable over two neighboring wavelengths in the 1550-nm, ITU 100-GHz range. It is available in 16 different versions, each of which covers two wavelengths, for a total coverage of 32 different wavelengths in the 1550-nm range.


Note


ITU-T G.709 specifies a form of FEC that uses a “wrapper” approach. The digital wrapper lets you transparently take in a signal on the client side, wrap a frame around it and restore it to its original form. FEC enables longer fiber links because errors caused by the optical signal degrading with distance are corrected.


The port can also operate at 10.70923 Gbps in ITU-T G.709 Digital Wrapper/FEC mode.


Caution


Because the transponder has no capability to look into the payload and detect circuits, an MXP_2.5G_10G card does not display circuits under card view.



Caution


You must use a 20-dB fiber attenuator (15 to 25 dB) when working with the MXP_2.5G_10G card in a loopback on the trunk port. Do not use direct fiber loopbacks with the MXP_2.5G_10G card. Using direct fiber loopbacks causes irreparable damage to the MXP_2.5G_10G card.


You can install MXP_2.5G_10G cards in , Slot 2 in Cisco NCS 2002 chassis, Slots 2 to 6 in Cisco NCS 2006.


Caution


Do not install an MXP_2.5G_10G card in Slot 3 if you have installed a DS3/EC1-48 card in Slots 1or 2. Likewise, do not install an MXP_2.5G_10G card in Slot 17 if you have installed a DS3/EC1-48 card in Slots 15 or 16. If you do, the cards will interact and cause DS-3 bit errors.


You can provision this card in a linear configuration. MXP_2.5G_10G cards cannot be provisioned as a BLSR/MS-SPRing, a path protection/SNCP, or a regenerator. They can be used in the middle of BLSR/MS-SPRing or 1+1 spans only when the card is configured for transparent termination mode.

The MXP_2.5G_10G port features a 1550-nm laser on the trunk port and four 1310-nm lasers on the client ports and contains five transmit and receive connector pairs (labeled) on the card faceplate. The card uses a dual LC connector on the trunk side and SFP connectors on the client side for optical cable termination.


Note


When you create a 4xOC-48 OCHCC circuit, you need to select the G.709 and Synchronous options. A 4xOC-48 OCHCC circuit is supported by G.709 and synchronous mode. This is necessary to provision a 4xOC-48 OCHCC circuit.


For more information about the MXP_2.5G_10G card, see http:/​/​www.cisco.com/​en/​US/​prod/​collateral/​optical/​ps5724/​ps2006/​ps5320/​product_​data_​sheet0900aecd80121bee_​ps13234_​Products_​Data_​Sheet.html.

Related Procedures for MXP_2.5G_10G Card

The following is the list of procedures and tasks related to the configuration of MXP_2.5G_10G:

MXP_2.5G_10E Card

The faceplate designation of the card is “4x2.5G 10E MXP.” The MXP_2.5G_10E card is a DWDM muxponder that supports full transparent termination the client side. The card multiplexes four 2.5 Gbps client signals (4 x OC48/STM-16 SFP) into a single 10-Gbps DWDM optical signal on the trunk side. The MXP_2.5G_10E provides wavelength transmission service for the four incoming 2.5 Gbps client interfaces. The MXP_2.5G_10E muxponder passes all SONET/SDH overhead bytes transparently.

The MXP_2.5G_10E card is not compatible with the MXP_2.5G_10G card, which does not support full transparent termination. You can install MXP_2.5G_10E cards in , Slot 2 in Cisco NCS 2002 chassis, Slots 2 to 6 in Cisco NCS 2006. You can provision this card in a linear configuration, as a BLSR/MS-SPRing, a path protection/SNCP, or a regenerator. The card can be used in the middle of BLSR/MS-SPRing or 1+1 spans when the card is configured for transparent termination mode.

The MXP_2.5G_10E features a 1550-nm laser on the trunk port and four 1310-nm lasers on the client ports and contains five transmit and receive connector pairs (labeled) on the card faceplate. The card uses a dual LC connector on the trunk side and uses SFP modules on the client side for optical cable termination. The SFP pluggable modules are short reach (SR) or intermediate reach (IR) and support an LC fiber connector.


Note


When you create a 4xOC-48 OCHCC circuit, you need to select the G.709 and Synchronous options. A 4xOC-48 OCHCC circuit is supported by G.709 and synchronous mode. This is necessary to provision a 4xOC-48 OCHCC circuit.


Key Features

The MXP_2.5G_10E card has the following high level features:

  • Four 2.5 Gbps client interfaces (OC-48/STM-16) and one 10 Gbps trunk. The four OC-48 signals are mapped into a ITU-T G.709 OTU2 signal using standard ITU-T G.709 multiplexing.

  • Onboard E-FEC processor: The processor supports both standard Reed-Solomon (RS, specified in ITU-T G.709) and E-FEC, which allows an improved gain on trunk interfaces with a resultant extension of the transmission range on these interfaces. The E-FEC functionality increases the correction capability of the transponder to improve performance, allowing operation at a lower OSNR compared to the standard RS (237,255) correction algorithm. A new block code (BCH) algorithm implemented in E-FEC allows recovery of an input BER up to 1E-3.

  • Pluggable client interface optic modules: The MXP_2.5G_10E card has modular interfaces. Two types of optics modules can be plugged into the card. These include an OC-48/STM 16 SR-1 interface with a 7-km (4.3-mile) nominal range (for short range and intra-office applications) and an IR-1 interface with a range up to 40 km (24.9 miles). SR-1 is defined in Telcordia GR-253-CORE and in I-16 (ITU-T G.957). IR-1 is defined in Telcordia GR-253-CORE and in S-16-1 (ITU-T G.957).

  • High level provisioning support: The MXP_2.5G_10E card is initially provisioned using CiscoTransport Planner software. Subsequently, the card can be monitored and provisioned using CTC software.

  • Link monitoring and management: The MXP_2.5G_10E card uses standard OC-48 OH (overhead) bytes to monitor and manage incoming interfaces. The card passes the incoming SDH/SONET data stream and its overhead bytes transparently.

  • Control of layered SONET/SDH transport overhead: The card is provisionable to terminate regenerator section overhead. This is used to eliminate forwarding of unneeded layer overhead. It can help reduce the number of alarms and help isolate faults in the network.

  • Automatic timing source synchronization: The MXP_2.5G_10E normally synchronizes from the control card. If for some reason, such as maintenance or upgrade activity, the control card is not available, the MXP_2.5G_10E automatically synchronizes to one of the input client interface clocks.

  • Configurable squelching policy: The card can be configured to squelch the client interface output if there is LOS at the DWDM receiver or if there is a remote fault. In the event of a remote fault, the card manages multiplex section alarm indication signal (MS-AIS) insertion.

MXP_2.5G_10E Functions

The following functions of the MXP_2.5G_10E card are explained in "Card Features" chapter:
  • Client Interface

  • DWDM Interface

  •  Multiplexing Function

  • Timing Synchronization

  • FEC

  • SONET/SDH Overhead Byte Processing

  • Card-Level Indicators

  •  Client Interface Monitoring

  • Jitter

  • Lamp Test

  • Onboard Traffic Generation

Wavelength Identification

The card uses trunk lasers that are wave-locked, which allows the trunk transmitter to operate on the ITU grid effectively. The laser is tunable over eight wavelengths at 50-GHz spacing or four at 100-GHz spacing.

Table 12 MXP_2.5G_10E Trunk Wavelengths

Band

Wavelength (nm)

Band

Wavelength (nm)

30.3

1530.33

46.1

1546.12

30.3

1531.12

46.1

1546.92

30.3

1531.90

46.1

1547.72

30.3

1532.68

46.1

1548.51

34.2

1534.25

50.1

1550.12

34.2

1535.04

50.1

1550.92

34.2

1535.82

50.1

1551.72

34.2

1536.61

50.1

1552.52

38.1

1538.19

54.1

1554.13

38.1

1538.98

54.1

1554.94

38.1

1539.77

54.1

1555.75

38.1

1540.56

54.1

1556.55

42.1

1542.14

58.1

1558.17

42.1

1542.94

58.1

1558.98

42.1

1543.73

58.1

1559.79

42.1

1544.53

58.1

1560.61

For more information about the MXP_2.5G_10E card, see http:/​/​www.cisco.com/​en/​US/​prod/​collateral/​optical/​ps5724/​ps2006/​ps5320/​product_​data_​sheet0900aecd801018ac.html.

Related Procedures for MXP_2.5G_10E Card

The following is the list of procedures and tasks related to the configuration of MXP_2.5G_10E Card:

MXP_2.5G_10E_C and MXP_2.5G_10E_L Cards

The MXP_2.5G_10E_C and MXP_2.5G_10E_L cards are DWDM muxponders that support transparent termination mode on the client side. The faceplate designation of the cards is “4x2.5G 10E MXP C” for the MXP_2.5G_10E_C card and “4x2.5G 10E MXP L” for the MXP_2.5G_10E_L card. The cards multiplex four 2.5-Gbps client signals (4 x OC48/STM-16 SFP) into a single 10-Gbps DWDM optical signal on the trunk side. The MXP_2.5G_10E_C and MXP_2.5G_10E_L cards provide wavelength transmission service for the four incoming 2.5 Gbps client interfaces. The MXP_2.5G_10E_C and MXP_2.5G_10E_L muxponders pass all SONET/SDH overhead bytes transparently.

The digital wrapper function (ITU-T G.709 compliant) formats the DWDM wavelength so that it can be used to set up GCCs for data communications, enable FEC, or facilitate PM.

The MXP_2.5G_10E_C and MXP_2.5G_10E_L cards work with OTN devices defined in ITU-T G.709. The cards support ODU1 to OTU2 multiplexing, an industry standard method for asynchronously mapping a SONET/SDH payload into a digitally wrapped envelope. See the "Multiplexing Function" section.

The MXP_2.5G_10E_C and MXP_2.5G_10E_L cards are not compatible with the MXP_2.5G_10G card, which does not support transparent termination mode.

You can install MXP_2.5G_10E_C and MXP_2.5G_10E_L cards in , Slot 2 in Cisco NCS 2002 chassis, Slots 2 to 6 in Cisco NCS 2006. You can provision a card in a linear configuration, as a BLSR/MS-SPRing, a path protection/SNCP, or a regenerator. The cards can be used in the middle of BLSR/MS-SPRing or 1+1 spans when the cards are configured for transparent termination mode.

The MXP_2.5G_10E_C card features a tunable 1550-nm C-band laser on the trunk port. The laser is tunable across 82 wavelengths on the ITU grid with 50-GHz spacing between wavelengths. The MXP_2.5G_10E_L features a tunable 1580-nm L-band laser on the trunk port. The laser is tunable across 80 wavelengths on the ITU grid, also with 50-GHz spacing. Each card features four 1310-nm lasers on the client ports and contains five transmit and receive connector pairs (labeled) on the card faceplate. The cards uses dual LC connectors on the trunk side and use SFP modules on the client side for optical cable termination. The SFP pluggable modules are SR or IR and support an LC fiber connector.


Note


When you create a 4xOC-48 OCHCC circuit, you need to select the G.709 and Synchronous options. A 4xOC-48 OCHCC circuit is supported by G.709 and synchronous mode. This is necessary to provision a 4xOC-48 OCHCC circuit.


Key Features

The MXP_2.5G_10E_C and MXP_2.5G_10E_L cards have the following high level features:

  • Four 2.5 Gbps client interfaces (OC-48/STM-16) and one 10 Gbps trunk. The four OC-48 signals are mapped into a ITU-T G.709 OTU2 signal using standard ITU-T G.709 multiplexing.

  • Onboard E-FEC processor: The processor supports both standard RS (specified in ITU-T G.709) and E-FEC, which allows an improved gain on trunk interfaces with a resultant extension of the transmission range on these interfaces. The E-FEC functionality increases the correction capability of the transponder to improve performance, allowing operation at a lower OSNR compared to the standard RS (237,255) correction algorithm. A new BCH algorithm implemented in E-FEC allows recovery of an input BER up to 1E-3.

  • Pluggable client interface optic modules: The MXP_2.5G_10E_C and MXP_2.5G_10E_L cards have modular interfaces. Two types of optics modules can be plugged into the card. These include an OC-48/STM 16 SR-1 interface with a 7-km (4.3-mile) nominal range (for short range and intra-office applications) and an IR-1 interface with a range up to 40 km (24.9 miles). SR-1 is defined in Telcordia GR-253-CORE and in I-16 (ITU-T G.957). IR-1 is defined in Telcordia GR-253-CORE and in S-16-1 (ITU-T G.957).

  • High level provisioning support: The cards are initially provisioned using Cisco TransportPlanner software. Subsequently, the card can be monitored and provisioned using CTC software.

  • Link monitoring and management: The cards use standard OC-48 OH (overhead) bytes to monitor and manage incoming interfaces. The cards pass the incoming SDH/SONET data stream and its overhead bytes transparently.

  • Control of layered SONET/SDH transport overhead: The cards are provisionable to terminate regenerator section overhead. This is used to eliminate forwarding of unneeded layer overhead. It can help reduce the number of alarms and help isolate faults in the network.

  • Automatic timing source synchronization: The MXP_2.5G_10E_C and MXP_2.5G_10E_L cards normally synchronize from the control card. If for some reason, such as maintenance or upgrade activity, the control card is not available, the cards automatically synchronize to one of the input client interface clocks.

  • Configurable squelching policy: The cards can be configured to squelch the client interface output if there is LOS at the DWDM receiver or if there is a remote fault. In the event of a remote fault, the card manages MS-AIS insertion.

  • The cards are tunable across the full C band (MXP_2.5G_10E_C) or full L band (MXP_2.5G_10E_L), thus eliminating the need to use different versions of each card to provide tunability across specific wavelengths in a band.

    Faceplates and Block Diagram

    Figure 2. MXP_2.5G_10E _C and MXP_2.5G_10E_L Faceplates and Block Diagram



For information about safety labels for the cards, see the "Class 1 Laser Product Cards" section.

MXP_2.5G_10E_C and MXP_2.5G_10E_L Functions

The following functions of the MXP_2.5G_10E_C and MXP_2.5G_10E_L cards are explained in the"Card Features" chapter:
  • Client Interface

  •  DWDM Interface

  • Multiplexing Function

  • Timing Synchronization

  • FEC

  • SONET/SDH Overhead Byte Processing

  • Client Interface Monitoring

  •  Automatic Laser Shutdown

  • Jitter

  • Lamp Test

  • Onboard Traffic Generation

  • Card level indicators

  • Port level indicators

Wavelength Identification

The card uses trunk lasers that are wavelocked, which allows the trunk transmitter to operate on the ITU grid effectively. Both the MXP_2.5G_10E_C and MXP_2.5G_10E_L cards implement the UT2 module. The MXP_2.5G_10E_C card uses a C-band version of the UT2 and the MXP_2.5G_10E_L card uses an L-band version. For MXP_2.5G_10E_C card, the laser is tunable over 82 wavelengths in the C band at 50-GHz spacing on the ITU grid.

Table 13 MXP_2.5G_10E_C Trunk Wavelengths

Channel Number

Frequency (THz)

Wavelength (nm)

Channel Number

Frequency (THz)

Wavelength (nm)

1

196.00

1529.55

42

193.95

1545.72

2

195.95

1529.94

43

193.90

1546.119

3

195.90

1530.334

44

193.85

1546.518

4

195.85

1530.725

45

193.80

1546.917

5

195.80

1531.116

46

193.75

1547.316

6

195.75

1531.507

47

193.70

1547.715

7

195.70

1531.898

48

193.65

1548.115

8

195.65

1532.290

49

193.60

1548.515

9

195.60

1532.681

50

193.55

1548.915

10

195.55

1533.073

51

193.50

1549.32

11

195.50

1533.47

52

193.45

1549.71

12

195.45

1533.86

53

193.40

1550.116

13

195.40

1534.250

54

193.35

1550.517

14

195.35

1534.643

55

193.30

1550.918

15

195.30

1535.036

56

193.25

1551.319

16

195.25

1535.429

57

193.20

1551.721

17

195.20

1535.822

58

193.15

1552.122

18

195.15

1536.216

59

193.10

1552.524

19

195.10

1536.609

60

193.05

1552.926

20

195.05

1537.003

61

193.00

1553.33

21

195.00

1537.40

62

192.95

1553.73

22

194.95

1537.79

63

192.90

1554.134

23

194.90

1538.186

64

192.85

1554.537

24

194.85

1538.581

65

192.80

1554.940

25

194.80

1538.976

66

192.75

1555.343

26

194.75

1539.371

67

192.70

1555.747

27

194.70

1539.766

68

192.65

1556.151

28

194.65

1540.162

69

192.60

1556.555

29

194.60

1540.557

70

192.55

1556.959

30

194.55

1540.953

71

192.50

1557.36

31

194.50

1541.35

72

192.45

1557.77

32

194.45

1541.75

73

192.40

1558.173

33

194.40

1542.142

74

192.35

1558.578

34

194.35

1542.539

75

192.30

1558.983

35

194.30

1542.936

76

192.25

1559.389

36

194.25

1543.333

77

192.20

1559.794

37

194.20

1543.730

78

192.15

1560.200

38

194.15

1544.128

79

192.10

1560.606

39

194.10

1544.526

80

192.05

1561.013

40

194.05

1544.924

81

192.00

1561.42

41

194.00

1545.32

82

191.95

1561.83

For MXP_2.5G_10E_L card, the laser is fully tunable over 80 wavelengths in the L band at 50-GHz spacing on the ITU grid.

Table 14 MXP_2.5G_10E_L Trunk Wavelengths

Channel Number

Frequency (THz)

Wavelength (nm)

Channel Number

Frequency (THz)

Wavelength (nm)

1

190.85

1570.83

41

188.85

1587.46

2

190.8

1571.24

42

188.8

1587.88

3

190.75

1571.65

43

188.75

1588.30

4

190.7

1572.06

44

188.7

1588.73

5

190.65

1572.48

45

188.65

1589.15

6

190.6

1572.89

46

188.6

1589.57

7

190.55

1573.30

47

188.55

1589.99

8

190.5

1573.71

48

188.5

1590.41

9

190.45

1574.13

49

188.45

1590.83

10

190.4

1574.54

50

188.4

1591.26

11

190.35

1574.95

51

188.35

1591.68

12

190.3

1575.37

52

188.3

1592.10

13

190.25

1575.78

53

188.25

1592.52

14

190.2

1576.20

54

188.2

1592.95

15

190.15

1576.61

55

188.15

1593.37

16

190.1

1577.03

56

188.1

1593.79

17

190.05

1577.44

57

188.05

1594.22

18

190

1577.86

58

188

1594.64

19

189.95

1578.27

59

187.95

1595.06

20

189.9

1578.69

60

187.9

1595.49

21

189.85

1579.10

61

187.85

1595.91

22

189.8

1579.52

62

187.8

1596.34

23

189.75

1579.93

63

187.75

1596.76

24

189.7

1580.35

64

187.7

1597.19

25

189.65

1580.77

65

187.65

1597.62

26

189.6

1581.18

66

187.6

1598.04

27

189.55

1581.60

67

187.55

1598.47

28

189.5

1582.02

68

187.5

1598.89

29

189.45

1582.44

69

187.45

1599.32

30

189.4

1582.85

70

187.4

1599.75

31

189.35

1583.27

71

187.35

1600.17

32

189.3

1583.69

72

187.3

1600.60

33

189.25

1584.11

73

187.25

1601.03

34

189.2

1584.53

74

187.2

1601.46

35

189.15

1584.95

75

187.15

1601.88

36

189.1

1585.36

76

187.1

1602.31

37

189.05

1585.78

77

187.05

1602.74

38

189

1586.20

78

187

1603.17

39

188.95

1586.62

79

186.95

1603.60

40

188.9

1587.04

80

186.9

1604.03

Related Procedures for MXP_2.5G_10E_C and MXP_2.5G_10E_L Cards

The following is the list of procedures and tasks related to the configuration of MXP_2.5G_10E_C and MXP_2.5G_10E_L cards:

MXP_MR_2.5G and MXPP_MR_2.5G Cards

The MXP_MR_2.5G card aggregates a mix and match of client Storage Area Network (SAN) service client inputs (GE, FICON, Fibre Channel, and ESCON) into one 2.5 Gbps STM-16/OC-48 DWDM signal on the trunk side. It provides one long-reach STM-16/OC-48 port per card and is compliant with Telcordia GR-253-CORE.


Note


In Software Release 7.0 and later, two additional operating modes have been made available to the user: pure ESCON (all 8 ports running ESCON), and mixed mode (Port 1 running FC/GE/FICON, and Ports 5 through 8 running ESCON). When the card is part of a system running Software Release 6.0 or below, only one operating mode, (FC/GE) is available for use.


The 2.5-Gbps Multirate Muxponder–Protected–100 GHz–Tunable 15xx.xx-15yy.yy (MXPP_MR_2.5G) card aggregates various client SAN service client inputs (GE, FICON, Fibre Channel, and ESCON) into one 2.5 Gbps STM-16/OC-48 DWDM signal on the trunk side. It provides two long-reach STM-16/OC-48 ports per card and is compliant with ITU-T G.957 and Telcordia GR-253-CORE.

Because the cards are tunable to one of four adjacent grid channels on a 100-GHz spacing, each card is available in eight versions, with 15xx.xx representing the first wavelength and 15yy.yy representing the last wavelength of the four available on the card. In total, 32 DWDM wavelengths are covered in accordance with the ITU-T 100-GHz grid standard, G.692, and Telcordia GR-2918-CORE, Issue 2.

Table 15 Card Versions

Card Version

Frequency Channels at 100 GHz (0.8 nm) Spacing

1530.33–1532.68

1530.33 nm

1531.12 nm

1531.90 nm

1532.68 nm

1534.25–1536.61

1534.25 nm

1535.04 nm

1535.82 nm

1536.61 nm

1538.19–1540.56

1538.19 nm

1538.98 nm

1539.77 nm

1540.56 nm

1542.14–1544.53

1542.14 nm

1542.94 nm

1543.73 nm

1544.53 nm

1546.12–1548.51

1546.12 nm

1546.92 nm

1547.72 nm

1548.51 nm

1550.12–1552.52

1550.12 nm

1550.92 nm

1551.72 nm

1552.52 nm

1554.13–1556.55

1554.13 nm

1554.94 nm

1555.75 nm

1556.55 nm

1558.17–1560.61

1558.17 nm

1558.98 nm

1559.79 nm

1560.61 nm

The muxponders are intended to be used in applications with long DWDM metro or regional unregenerated spans. Long transmission distances are achieved through the use of flat gain optical amplifiers.

The client interface supports the following payload types:

  • 2G FC

  • 1G FC

  • 2G FICON

  • 1G FICON

  • GE

  • ESCON


    Note


    Because the client payload cannot oversubscribe the trunk, a mix of client signals can be accepted, up to a maximum limit of 2.5 Gbps.


The current version of the ITU-T Transparent Generic Framing Procedure (GFP-T) G.7041 supports transparent mapping of 8B/10B block-coded protocols, including Gigabit Ethernet, Fibre Channel, and FICON.

In addition to the GFP mapping, 1-Gbps traffic on Port 1 or 2 of the high-speed serializer/deserializer (SERDES) is mapped to an STS-24c channel. If two 1-Gbps client signals are present at Port 1 and Port 2 of the SERDES, the Port 1 signal is mapped into the first STS-24c channel and the Port 2 signal into the second STS-24c channel. The two channels are then mapped into an OC-48 trunk channel.

Table 16 MXP_MR_2.5G and MXPP_MR_2.5G Client Interface Data Rates and Encapsulation

Client Interface

Input Data Rate

ITU-T GFP-T G.7041 Encapsulation

2G FC

2.125 Gbps

Yes

1G FC

1.06 Gbps

Yes

2G FICON

2.125 Gbps

Yes

1G FICON

1.06 Gbps

Yes

GE

1.25 Gbps

Yes

ESCON

0.2 Gbps

Yes

Table 17 Client Data Rates and Ports

Mode

Port(s)

Aggregate Data Rate

2G FC

1

2.125 Gbps

1G FC

1, 2

2.125 Gbps

2G FICON

1

2.125 Gbps

1G FICON

1, 2

2.125 Gbps

GE

1, 2

2.5 Gbps

1G FC
ESCON
(mixed mode)

1
5, 6, 7, 8

1.06 Gbps
0.8 Gbps

1.86 Gbps total

1G FICON
ESCON
(mixed mode)

1
5, 6, 7, 8

1.06 Gbps
0.8 Gbps

1.86 Gbps total

GE
ESCON
(mixed mode)

1
5, 6, 7, 8

1.25 Gbps
0.8 Gbps

Total 2.05 Gbps

ESCON

1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8

1.6 Gbps

Faceplates and Block Diagram

Figure 3. MXP_MR_2.5G and MXPP_MR_2.5G Faceplates



For information about safety labels for the cards, see the "Class 1M Laser Product Cards" section.

The card has eight SFP client interfaces. Ports 1 and 2 can be used for GE, FC, FICON, or ESCON. Ports 3 through 8 are used for ESCON client interfaces. There are two SERDES blocks dedicated to the high-speed interfaces (GE, FC, FICON, and ESCON) and two SERDES blocks for the ESCON interfaces. A FPGA is provided to support different configurations for different modes of operation. This FPGA has a Universal Test and Operations Physical Interface for ATM (UTOPIA) interface. A transceiver add/drop multiplexer (TADM) chip supports framing. Finally, the output signal is serialized and connected to the trunk front end with a direct modulation laser. The trunk receive signal is converted into an electrical signal with an avalanche photodiode (APD), is deserialized, and is then sent to the TADM framer and FPGA.

The MXPP_MR_2.5G is the same, except a 50/50 splitter divides the power at the trunk interface. In the receive direction, there are two APDs, two SERDES blocks, and two TADM framers. This is necessary to monitor both the working and protect paths. A switch selects one of the two paths to connect to the client interface.

Figure 4. MXP_MR_2.5G and MXPP_MR_2.5G Block Diagram




Caution


You must use a 20-dB fiber attenuator (15 to 25 dB) when working with the MXP_MR_2.5G and MXPP_MR_2.5G cards in a loopback configuration on the trunk port. Do not use direct fiber loopbacks with the MXP_MR_2.5G and MXPP_MR_2.5G cards. Using direct fiber loopbacks causes irreparable damage to the MXP_MR_2.5G and MXPP_MR_2.5G cards.


MXP_MR_2.5G and MXPP_MR_2.5G Functions

The following functions of the MXP_MR_2.5G and MXPP_MR_2.5G cards are explained in the "Card Features" chapter:
  • Performance Monitoring

  • Distance Extension

  • Slot Compatibility

  • Interoperability with Cisco MDS Switches

  • Client and Trunk Ports

  • Automatic Laser Shutdown

  • Card level indicators

  • Port level indicator

Related Procedures for MXP_MR_2.5G and MXPP_MR_2.5G Cards

The following is the list of procedures and tasks related to the configuration of MXP_MR_2.5G and MXPP_MR_2.5G cards:

MXP_MR_10DME_C and MXP_MR_10DME_L Cards

The MXP_MR_10DME_C and MXP_MR_10DME_L cards aggregate a mix of client SAN service client inputs (GE, FICON, and Fibre Channel) into one 10.0 Gbps STM-64/OC-192 DWDM signal on the trunk side. It provides one long-reach STM-64/OC-192 port per card and is compliant with Telcordia GR-253-CORE and ITU-T G.957.

The cards support aggregation of the following signal types:

  • 1-Gigabit Fibre Channel

  • 2-Gigabit Fibre Channel

  • 4-Gigabit Fibre Channel

  • 1-Gigabit Ethernet

  • 1-Gigabit ISC-Compatible (ISC-1)

  • 2-Gigabit ISC-Peer (ISC-3)


    Note


    On the card faceplates, the MXP_MR_10DME_C and MXP_MR_10DME_L cards are displayed as 10DME_C and 10DME_L, respectively.



    Caution


    The card can be damaged by dropping it. Handle it safely.



    Note


    Because the client payload cannot oversubscribe the trunk, a mix of client signals can be accepted, up to a maximum limit of 10 Gbps.



    Note


    The MXP_MR_10DME_C and MXP_MR_10DME_L cards are not compatible with the MXP_2.5G_10G card, which does not support transparent termination mode.


The MXP_MR_10DME_C card features a tunable 1550-nm C-band laser on the trunk port. The laser is tunable across 82 wavelengths on the ITU grid with 50-GHz spacing between wavelengths. The MXP_MR_10DME_L features a tunable 1580-nm L-band laser on the trunk port. The laser is tunable across 80 wavelengths on the ITU grid, also with 50-GHz spacing. Each card features four 1310-nm lasers on the client ports and contains five transmit and receive connector pairs (labeled) on the card faceplate. The cards uses dual LC connectors on the trunk side and use SFP modules on the client side for optical cable termination. The SFP pluggable modules are SR or IR and support an LC fiber connector.

The current version of the GFP-T G.7041 supports transparent mapping of 8B/10B block-coded protocols, including Gigabit Ethernet, Fibre Channel, ISC, and FICON.

In addition to the GFP mapping, 1-Gbps traffic on Port 1 or 2 of the high-speed SERDES is mapped to an STS-24c channel. If two 1-Gbps client signals are present at Port 1 and Port 2 of the high-speed SERDES, the Port 1 signal is mapped into the first STS-24c channel and the Port 2 signal into the second STS-24c channel. The two channels are then mapped into an OC-48 trunk channel.

Table 18 MXP_MR_10DME_C and MXP_MR_10DME_L Client Interface Data Rates and Encapsulation

Client Interface

Input Data Rate

GFP-T G.7041 Encapsulation

2G FC

2.125 Gbps

Yes

1G FC

1.06 Gbps

Yes

2G FICON/2G ISC-Compatible (ISC-1)/ 2G ISC-Peer (ISC-3)

2.125 Gbps

Yes

1G FICON/1G ISC-Compatible (ISC-1)/ 1G ISC-Peer (ISC-3)

1.06 Gbps

Yes

Gigabit Ethernet

1.25 Gbps

Yes

There are two FPGAs on each MXP_MR_10DME_C and MXP_MR_10DME_L, and a group of four ports is mapped to each FPGA. Group 1 consists of Ports 1 through 4, and Group 2 consists of Ports 5 through 8. The following table shows some of the mix and match possibilities on the various client data rates for Ports 1 through 4, and Ports 5 through 8. An X indicates that the data rate is supported in that port.

Table 19 Supported Client Data Rates for Ports 1 through 4 and Ports 5 through 8

Port (Group 1)

Port (Group 2)

Gigabit Ethernet

1G FC

2G FC

4G FC

1

5

X

X

X

X

2

6

X

X

3

7

X

X

X

4

8

X

X

GFP-T PM is available through RMON and trunk PM is managed according to Telcordia GR-253-CORE and ITU G.783/826. Client PM is achieved through RMON for FC and GE.

A buffer-to-buffer credit management scheme provides FC flow control. With this feature enabled, a port indicates the number of frames that can be sent to it (its buffer credit), before the sender is required to stop transmitting and wait for the receipt of a “ready” indication The MXP_MR_10DME_C and MXP_MR_10DME_L cards support FC credit-based flow control with a buffer-to-buffer credit extension of up to 1600 km (994.1 miles) for 1G FC, up to 800 km (497.1 miles) for 2G FC, or up to 400 km (248.5 miles) for 4G FC. The feature can be enabled or disabled.

The MXP_MR_10DME_C and MXP_MR_10DME_L cards feature a 1550-nm laser for the trunk/line port and a 1310-nm or 850-nm laser (depending on the SFP) for the client ports. The cards contains eight 12.5 degree downward tilt SFP modules for the client interfaces. For optical termination, each SFP uses two LC connectors, which are labeled TX and RX on the faceplate. The trunk port is a dual-LC connector with a 45 degree downward angle.

The throughput of the MXP_MR_10DME_C and MXP_MR_10DME_L cards is affected by the following parameters:

  • Distance extension—If distance extension is enabled on the card, it provides more throughput but more latency. If distance extension is disabled on the card, the buffer to buffer credits on the storage switch affects the throughput; higher the buffer to buffer credits higher is the throughput.


    Note


    For each link to operate at the maximum throughput, it requires a minimum number of buffer credits to be available on the devices which the link connects to. The number of buffer credits required is a function of the distance between the storage switch extension ports and the link bandwidth, that is, 1G, 2G, or 4G. These buffer credits are provided by either the storage switch (if distance extension is disabled) or by both the storage switch and the card (if distance extension is enabled).


  • Forward Error Correction (FEC)—If Enhanced FEC (E-FEC) is enabled on the trunk port of the card, the throughout is significantly reduced in comparison to standard FEC being set on the trunk port.


    Note


    If distance extension is enabled on the card, the FEC status does not usually affect the throughput of the card.


  • Payload size—The throughput of the card decreases with decrease in payload size.

The resultant throughput of the card is usually the combined effect of the above parameters.

Key Features

The MXP_MR_10DME_C and MXP_MR_10DME_L cards have the following high-level features:

  • Onboard E-FEC processor: The processor supports both standard RS (specified in ITU-T G.709) and E-FEC, which allows an improved gain on trunk interfaces with a resultant extension of the transmission range on these interfaces. The E-FEC functionality increases the correction capability of the transponder to improve performance, allowing operation at a lower OSNR compared to the standard RS (237,255) correction algorithm. A new BCH algorithm implemented in E-FEC allows recovery of an input BER up to 1E-3.

  • Pluggable client interface optic modules: The MXP_MR_10DME_C and MXP_MR_10DME_L cards have modular interfaces. Two types of optics modules can be plugged into the card. These include an OC-48/STM 16 SR-1 interface with a 7-km (4.3-mile) nominal range (for short range and intra-office applications) and an IR-1 interface with a range up to 40 km (24.9 miles). SR-1 is defined in Telcordia GR-253-CORE and in I-16 (ITU-T G.957). IR-1 is defined in Telcordia GR-253-CORE and in S-16-1 (ITU-T G.957).

  • Y-cable protection: Supports Y-cable protection between the same card type only, on ports with the same port number and signal rate. See the "Y-Cable Protection Availability on TXP, MXP, and Xponder Cards” section for more detailed information.

  • High level provisioning support: The cards are initially provisioned using Cisco TransportPlanner software. Subsequently, the card can be monitored and provisioned using CTC software.

  • ALS: A safety mechanism used in the event of a fiber cut. For details regarding ALS provisioning for the MXP_MR_10DME_C and MXP_MR_10DME_L cards, see the “NTP-G162 Change the ALS Maintenance Settings” section.

  • Link monitoring and management: The cards use standard OC-48 OH bytes to monitor and manage incoming interfaces. The cards pass the incoming SDH/SONET data stream and its OH bytes transparently.

  • Control of layered SONET/SDH transport overhead: The cards are provisionable to terminate regenerator section overhead. This is used to eliminate forwarding of unneeded layer overhead. It can help reduce the number of alarms and help isolate faults in the network.

  • Automatic timing source synchronization: The MXP_MR_10DME_C and MXP_MR_10DME_L cards normally synchronize from the control card. If for some reason, such as maintenance or upgrade activity, the control card is not available, the cards automatically synchronize to one of the input client interface clocks.


    Note


    MXP_MR_10DME_C and MXP_MR_10DME_L cards cannot be used for line timing.


  • Configurable squelching policy: The cards can be configured to squelch the client interface output if there is LOS at the DWDM receiver or if there is a remote fault. In the event of a remote fault, the card manages MS-AIS insertion.

  • The cards are tunable across the full C band (MXP_MR_10DME_C) or full L band (MXP_MR_10DME_L), thus eliminating the need to use different versions of each card to provide tunability across specific wavelengths in a band.

  • You can provision a string (port name) for each fiber channel/FICON interface on the MXP_MR_10DME_C and MXP_MR_10DME_L cards, which allows the MDS Fabric Manager to create a link association between that SAN port and a SAN port on a Cisco MDS 9000 switch.

  • From Software Release 9.0, the fast switch feature of MXP_MR_10DME_C and MXP_MR_10DME_L cards along with the buffer-to-buffer credit recovery feature of MDS switches, prevents reinitialization of ISL links during Y-cable switchovers.

MXP_MR_10DME_C and MXP_MR_10DME_L Functions

The following functions of the MXP_MR_10DME_C and MXP_MR_10DME_L cards are explained in the "Card Features" chapter:

  • Card level indicators

  • Port level indicators

Wavelength Identification

The card uses trunk lasers that are wavelocked, which allows the trunk transmitter to operate on the ITU grid effectively. Both the MXP_MR_10DME_C and MXP_MR_10DME_L cards implement the UT2 module. The MXP_MR_10DME_C card uses a C-band version of the UT2 and the MXP_MR_10DME_L card uses an L-band version.

The MXP_MR_10DME_C card is tunable over 82 wavelengths in the C band at 50-GHz spacing on the ITU grid.

Table 20 MXP_MR_10DME_C Trunk Wavelengths

Channel Number

Frequency (THz)

Wavelength (nm)

Channel Number

Frequency (THz)

Wavelength (nm)

1

196.00

1529.55

42

193.95

1545.72

2

195.95

1529.94

43

193.90

1546.119

3

195.90

1530.334

44

193.85

1546.518

4

195.85

1530.725

45

193.80

1546.917

5

195.80

1531.116

46

193.75

1547.316

6

195.75

1531.507

47

193.70

1547.715

7

195.70

1531.898

48

193.65

1548.115

8

195.65

1532.290

49

193.60

1548.515

9

195.60

1532.681

50

193.55

1548.915

10

195.55

1533.073

51

193.50

1549.32

11

195.50

1533.47

52

193.45

1549.71

12

195.45

1533.86

53

193.40

1550.116

13

195.40

1534.250

54

193.35

1550.517

14

195.35

1534.643

55

193.30

1550.918

15

195.30

1535.036

56

193.25

1551.319

16

195.25

1535.429

57

193.20

1551.721

17

195.20

1535.822

58

193.15

1552.122

18

195.15

1536.216

59

193.10

1552.524

19

195.10

1536.609

60

193.05

1552.926

20

195.05

1537.003

61

193.00

1553.33

21

195.00

1537.40

62

192.95

1553.73

22

194.95

1537.79

63

192.90

1554.134

23

194.90

1538.186

64

192.85

1554.537

24

194.85

1538.581

65

192.80

1554.940

25

194.80

1538.976

66

192.75

1555.343

26

194.75

1539.371

67

192.70

1555.747

27

194.70

1539.766

68

192.65

1556.151

28

194.65

1540.162

69

192.60

1556.555

29

194.60

1540.557

70

192.55

1556.959

30

194.55

1540.953

71

192.50

1557.36

31

194.50

1541.35

72

192.45

1557.77

32

194.45

1541.75

73

192.40

1558.173

33

194.40

1542.142

74

192.35

1558.578

34

194.35

1542.539

75

192.30

1558.983

35

194.30

1542.936

76

192.25

1559.389

36

194.25

1543.333

77

192.20

1559.794

37

194.20

1543.730

78

192.15

1560.200

38

194.15

1544.128

79

192.10

1560.606

39

194.10

1544.526

80

192.05

1561.013

40

194.05

1544.924

81

192.00

1561.42

41

194.00

1545.32

82

191.95

1561.83

The MXP_MR_10DME_L card is fully tunable over 80 wavelengths in the L band at 50-GHz spacing on the ITU grid.

Table 21 MXP_MR_10DME_L Trunk Wavelengths

Channel Number

Frequency (THz)

Wavelength (nm)

Channel Number

Frequency (THz)

Wavelength (nm)

1

190.85

1570.83

41

188.85

1587.46

2

190.8

1571.24

42

188.8

1587.88

3

190.75

1571.65

43

188.75

1588.30

4

190.7

1572.06

44

188.7

1588.73

5

190.65

1572.48

45

188.65

1589.15

6

190.6

1572.89

46

188.6

1589.57

7

190.55

1573.30

47

188.55

1589.99

8

190.5

1573.71

48

188.5

1590.41

9

190.45

1574.13

49

188.45

1590.83

10

190.4

1574.54

50

188.4

1591.26

11

190.35

1574.95

51

188.35

1591.68

12

190.3

1575.37

52

188.3

1592.10

13

190.25

1575.78

53

188.25

1592.52

14

190.2

1576.20

54

188.2

1592.95

15

190.15

1576.61

55

188.15

1593.37

16

190.1

1577.03

56

188.1

1593.79

17

190.05

1577.44

57

188.05

1594.22

18

190

1577.86

58

188

1594.64

19

189.95

1578.27

59

187.95

1595.06

20

189.9

1578.69

60

187.9

1595.49

21

189.85

1579.10

61

187.85

1595.91

22

189.8

1579.52

62

187.8

1596.34

23

189.75

1579.93

63

187.75

1596.76

24

189.7

1580.35

64

187.7

1597.19

25

189.65

1580.77

65

187.65

1597.62

26

189.6

1581.18

66

187.6

1598.04

27

189.55

1581.60

67

187.55

1598.47

28

189.5

1582.02

68

187.5

1598.89

29

189.45

1582.44

69

187.45

1599.32

30

189.4

1582.85

70

187.4

1599.75

31

189.35

1583.27

71

187.35

1600.17

32

189.3

1583.69

72

187.3

1600.60

33

189.25

1584.11

73

187.25

1601.03

34

189.2

1584.53

74

187.2

1601.46

35

189.15

1584.95

75

187.15

1601.88

36

189.1

1585.36

76

187.1

1602.31

37

189.05

1585.78

77

187.05

1602.74

38

189

1586.20

78

187

1603.17

39

188.95

1586.62

79

186.95

1603.60

40

188.9

1587.04

80

186.9

1604.03

For more information about the MXP_MR_10DME_C and MXP_MR_10DME_L cards, see http:/​/​www.cisco.com/​en/​US/​prod/​collateral/​optical/​ps5724/​ps2006/​ps5320/​product_​data_​sheet0900aecd803fc51a.html.

Related Procedures for MXP_MR_10DME_C and MXP_MR_10DME_L Cards

The following is the list of procedures and tasks related to the configuration of MXP_MR_10DME_C and MXP_MR_10DME_L cards:

40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C Cards

The 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C cards aggregate a variety of client service inputs (Gigabit Ethernet, Fibre Channel, OTU2, OTU2e, and OC-192) into a single 40-Gbps OTU3/OTU3e signal on the trunk side.


Note


In CTC, the 40E-MXP-C and 40ME-MXP-C card is displayed with the same card name, 40E-MXP-C.


The 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C cards support aggregation of the following signals:

  • With overclock enabled on the trunk port:

    • OC-192/STM-64 (only on 40E-MXP-C and 40ME-MXP-C cards)

    • 10 Gigabit Fibre Channel

    • OTU2e

    • 10 Gigabit Ethernet LAN-Phy (CBR mapping) (only on 40E-MXP-C and 40ME-MXP-C cards)

  • With overclock disabled on the trunk port:

    • 8 Gigabit Fibre Channel

    • 10 GigabitEthernet LAN-Phy (GFP framing)

    • 10 GigabitEthernet LAN-Phy (WIS framing)

    • OC-192/STM-64

    • OTU2


      Caution


      Handle the card with care. Dropping or misuse of the card could result in permanent damage.


You can install and provision the 40G-MXP-C, cards in a linear configuration in:

  • Slot 2 in Cisco NCS 2002 chassis

  • Slots 2 to 17 in Cisco NCS 2015 chassis (for 40E-MXP-C card)

The client ports of the 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C cards interoperates with all the existing TXP/MXP (OTU2 trunk) cards.

The auto negotiation is not supported on the 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C cards in 8G FC client mode. Hence, during interoperation, the auto negotiation of the 8G-FC client port of the other device connected to 8G-FC client port on 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, or 40ME-MXP-C card must be set to Fixed/Disabled.

The client port of 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C cards do not interoperate with OTU2_XP card when the signal rate is OTU1e (11.049 Gbps) and the “No Fixed Stuff” option is enabled on the trunk port of OTU2_XP card.

For OTU2 and OTU2e client protocols, Enhanced FEC (EFEC) is not supported on Port 1 of the 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C cards.

Table 22 Client Interface Data Rates for 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C and 40ME-MXP-C Cards

40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C and 40ME-MXP-C Client Port

FEC Configuration Supported on OTU2/OTU2e Client Protocol

Port 1

Only Standard FEC

Port 2

Standard and Enhanced FEC

Port 3

Standard and Enhanced FEC

Port 4

Standard and Enhanced FEC

When setting up the card for the first time, or when the card comes up after clearing the LOS-P condition due to fiber cut, the trunk port of the 40G-MXP-C card takes about 6 minutes to lock a signal. The trunk port of the 40G-MXP-C card raises an OTUK-LOF alarm when the card is comes up. The alarm clears when the trunk port locks the signal.

When a protection switch occurs on the 40E-MXP-C and 40ME-MXP-C cards, the recovery from PSM protection switch takes about 3 to 4 minutes.

Key Features

The 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C cards provides the following key features:

  • The 40G-MXP-C card uses the RZ-DQPSK 40G modulation format.

  • The 40E-MXP-C and 40ME-MXP-C cards uses the CP-DQPSK modulation format.

  • Onboard E-FEC processor—The E-FEC functionality improves the correction capability of the transponder to improve performance, allowing operation at a lower OSNR compared to the standard RS (239,255) correction algorithm. A new BCH algorithm implemented (according to G.975.1 I.7) in E-FEC allows recovery of an input BER up to 1E-3. The 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C cards support both the standard RS (specified in ITU-T G.709) and E-FEC standard, which allows an improved gain on trunk interfaces with a resultant extension of the transmission range on these interfaces.

  • Y-cable protection—Supports Y-cable protection only between the same card type on ports with the same port number and signal rate. For more information on Y-cable protection, see the "Y-Cable Protection Availability on TXP, MXP, and Xponder Cards" section.


    Note


    Y-cable cannot be created on a 10 GE port when WIS framing is enabled on the 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C cards.


  • Unidirectional regeneration—The 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C cards supports unidirectional regeneration configuration. Each 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C card in the configuration regenerates the signal received from another 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C card in one direction.


    Note


    When you configure the 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C cards in the Unidirectional Regen mode, ensure that the payload is not configured on the pluggable port modules of the 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C card.


    Figure 5. 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C Cards in Unidirectional Regeneration Configuration



  • High level provisioning support—The cards are initially provisioned using Cisco Transport Planner software. Subsequently, the card can be monitored and provisioned using CTC software.

  • Automatic Laser Shutdown (ALS)—A safety mechanism, Automatic Laser Shutdown (ALS), is used in the event of a fiber cut. The Auto Restart ALS option is supported only for OC-192/STM-64 and OTU2 payloads. The Manual Restart ALS option is supported for all payloads. For more information on provisioning ALS for the 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C cards, see the “NTP-G162 Change the ALS Maintenance Settings” section.

  • Control of layered SONET/SDH transport overhead—The cards are provisionable to terminate regenerator section overhead. This is used to eliminate forwarding of unneeded layer overhead. It can help reduce the number of alarms and help isolate faults in the network.

  • Automatic timing source synchronization—The 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C cards synchronize to the card cards. Because of a maintenance or upgrade activity, if the control cards are not available, the cards automatically synchronize to one of the input client interface clocks.

  • Squelching policy—The cards are set to squelch the client interface output if there is LOS at the DWDM receiver, or if there is a remote fault. In the event of a remote fault, the card manages MS-AIS insertion.

  • The 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C cards are tunable across the full C-band wavelength.

Wavelength Identification

The 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C cards use trunk lasers that are wavelocked, which allows the trunk transmitter to operate on the ITU grid effectively. These cards implement the UT2 module; they use a C-band version of the UT2. The laser is tunable over 82 wavelengths in the C-band at 50-GHz spacing on the ITU grid.

Table 23 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C Trunk Wavelengths

Channel Number

Frequency (THz)

Wavelength (nm)

Channel Number

Frequency (THz)

Wavelength (nm)

1

196.00

1529.55

42

193.95

1545.72

2

195.95

1529.94

43

193.90

1546.119

3

195.90

1530.334

44

193.85

1546.518

4

195.85

1530.725

45

193.80

1546.917

5

195.80

1531.116

46

193.75

1547.316

6

195.75

1531.507

47

193.70

1547.715

7

195.70

1531.898

48

193.65

1548.115

8

195.65

1532.290

49

193.60

1548.515

9

195.60

1532.681

50

193.55

1548.915

10

195.55

1533.073

51

193.50

1549.32

11

195.50

1533.47

52

193.45

1549.71

12

195.45

1533.86

53

193.40

1550.116

13

195.40

1534.250

54

193.35

1550.517

14

195.35

1534.643

55

193.30

1550.918

15

195.30

1535.036

56

193.25

1551.319

16

195.25

1535.429

57

193.20

1551.721

17

195.20

1535.822

58

193.15

1552.122

18

195.15

1536.216

59

193.10

1552.524

19

195.10

1536.609

60

193.05

1552.926

20

195.05

1537.003

61

193.00

1553.33

21

195.00

1537.40

62

192.95

1553.73

22

194.95

1537.79

63

192.90

1554.134

23

194.90

1538.186

64

192.85

1554.537

24

194.85

1538.581

65

192.80

1554.940

25

194.80

1538.976

66

192.75

1555.343

26

194.75

1539.371

67

192.70

1555.747

27

194.70

1539.766

68

192.65

1556.151

28

194.65

1540.162

69

192.60

1556.555

29

194.60

1540.557

70

192.55

1556.959

30

194.55

1540.953

71

192.50

1557.36

31

194.50

1541.35

72

192.45

1557.77

32

194.45

1541.75

73

192.40

1558.173

33

194.40

1542.142

74

192.35

1558.578

34

194.35

1542.539

75

192.30

1558.983

35

194.30

1542.936

76

192.25

1559.389

36

194.25

1543.333

77

192.20

1559.794

37

194.20

1543.730

78

192.15

1560.200

38

194.15

1544.128

79

192.10

1560.606

39

194.10

1544.526

80

192.05

1561.013

40

194.05

1544.924

81

192.00

1561.42

41

194.00

1545.32

82

191.95

1561.83

For more information on 40G-MXP-C card, see http:/​/​www.cisco.com/​en/​US/​prod/​collateral/​optical/​ps5724/​ps2006/​datasheet_​c78-598898.html.

For more information on 40E-MXP-C and 40ME-MXP-C cards, see http:/​/​www.cisco.com/​en/​US/​prod/​collateral/​optical/​ps5724/​ps2006/​data_​sheet_​c78-606950.html.

Related Procedures for 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C Cards

The following is the list of procedures and tasks related to the configuration of 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C cards:

GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE Cards


Note


GE_XPE card is the enhanced version of the GE_XP card and 10GE_XPE card is the enhanced version of the 10GE_XP card.


The cards aggregate Ethernet packets received on the client ports for transport on C-band trunk ports that operate on a 100-GHz grid. The trunk ports operate with ITU-T G.709 framing and either FEC or E-FEC. The GE_XP and 10GE_XP cards are designed for bulk point-to-point transport over 10GE LAN PHY wavelengths for Video-on-Demand (VOD), or broadcast video across protected 10GE LAN PHY wavelengths. The GE_XPE and 10GE_XPE cards are designed for bulk GE_XPE or 10GE_XPE point-to-point, point-to-multipoint, multipoint-to-multipoint transport over 10GE LAN PHY wavelengths for Video-on-Demand (VOD), or broadcast video across protected 10GE LAN PHY wavelengths.

You can install and provision the GE_XP, and GE_XPE cards in a linear configuration in:

  • Slot 2 in Cisco NCS 2002 chassis

  • Slots 2 to 6 in Cisco NCS 2006 chassis

The RAD pluggables (ONS-SC-E3-T3-PW= and ONS-SC-E1-T1-PW=) do not support:

  • No loopbacks (Terminal or Facility)

  • RAI (Remote Alarm Indication) alarm

  • AIS and LOS alarm


    Caution



GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards can be provisioned to perform different Gigabit Ethernet transport roles. All the cards can work as Layer 2 switches. However, the 10GE_XP and 10GE_XPE cards can also perform as a 10 Gigabit Ethernet transponders (10GE TXP mode), and the GE_XP and GE_XPE can perform as a 10 Gigabit Ethernet or 20 Gigabit Ethernet muxponders (10GE MXP or 20GE MXP mode).


Note


Changing the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card mode requires the ports to be in a OOS-DSBL (ANSI) or Locked, disabled (ETSI) service state. In addition, no circuits can be provisioned on the cards when the mode is being changed.


Table 24 GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPECard Modes

Card Mode

Cards

Description

Layer 2 Ethernet switch

GE_XP

10GE_XP

GE_XPE

10GE_XPE

Provides capability to switch between any two ports irrespective of client or trunk port. Supported Ethernet protocols and services include 1+1 protection, QoS (Quality of Service), CoS (Class of Service), QinQ, MAC learning, MAC address retrieval, service provider VLANs (SVLANs), IGMP snooping and Multicast VLAN Registration (MVR), link integrity, and other Ethernet switch services.

10GE TXP

10GE_XP

10GE_XPE

Provides a point-to-point application in which each 10 Gigabit Ethernet client port is mapped to a 10 Gigabit Ethernet trunk port.

10GE MXP

20GE MXP

GE_XP

GE_XPE

Provides the ability to multiplex the twenty Gigabit Ethernet client ports on the card to one or both of its 10 Gigabit Ethernet trunk ports. The card can be provisioned as a single MXP with twenty Gigabit Ethernet client ports mapped to one trunk port (Port 21) or as two MXPs with ten Gigabit Ethernet client ports mapped to a trunk port (Ports 1 to 10 mapped to Port 21, and Ports 11-20 mapped to Port 22).

Key Features

The GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards have the following high-level features:

  • Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) that allows you to bundle several physical ports together to form a single logical channel.

  • Ethernet Connectivity Fault Management (CFM) protocol that facilitates proactive connectivity monitoring, fault verification, and fault isolation.

  • Ethernet Operations, Administration, and Maintenance (OAM) protocol that facilitates link monitoring, remote failure indication, and remote loopback.

  • Resilient Ethernet Protocol (REP) that controls network loops, handles link failures, and improves convergence time.

  • Configurable service VLANs (SVLANs) and customer VLANs (CVLANs).

  • Ingress rate limiting that can be applied on both SVLANs and CVLANs. You can create SVLAN and CVLAN profiles and can associate a SVLAN profile to both UNI and NNI ports; however, you can associate a CVLAN profile only to UNI ports.

  • CVLAN rate limiting that is supported for QinQ service in selective add mode.

  • Differentiated Services Code Point (DSCP) to class of service (CoS) mapping that you can configure for each port. You can configure the CoS of the outer VLAN based on the incoming DSCP bits. This feature is supported only on GE_XPE and 10GE_XPE cards.

  • Ports, in Layer 2 switch mode, can be provisioned as network-to-network interfaces (NNIs) or user-network interfaces (UNIs) to facilitate service provider to customer traffic management.

  • Broadcast drop-and-continue capability for VOD and broadcast video applications.

  • Gigabit Ethernet MXP, TXP, and Layer 2 switch capability.

  • For more information on FELC, see the"Far-End Laser Control" section.

  • Layer 2 switch mode that provides VLAN translation, QinQ, ingress CoS, egress QoS, Fast Ethernet protection switching, and other Layer 2 Ethernet services.

  • Interoperable with TXP_MR_10E and TXP_MR_10E_C cards. Also interoperable with Cisco Catalyst 6500 and Cisco 7600 series Gigabit Ethernet, 10 GE interfaces and CRS-1 10GE interfaces.

  • The GE_XP and GE_XPE cards have twenty Gigabit Ethernet client ports and two 10 Gigabit Ethernet trunk ports. The 10GE_XP and 10GE_XPE cards have two 10 Gigabit Ethernet client ports and two 10 Gigabit Ethernet trunk ports. The client Gigabit Ethernet signals are mapped into an ITU-T G.709 OTU2 signal using standard ITU-T G.709 multiplexing when configured in one of the MXP modes (10GE MXP or 20GE MXP).

  • ITU-T G.709 framing with standard Reed-Soloman (RS) (255,237) FEC. Performance monitoring and ITU-T G.709 Optical Data Unit (ODU) synchronous and asynchronous mapping. E-FEC with ITU-T G.709 ODU and 2.7 Gbps with greater than 8 dB coding gain.

  • IEEE 802.3 frame format that is supported for 10 Gigabit Ethernet interfaces. The minimum frame size is 64 bytes. The maximum frame size is user-provisionable.

  • MAC learning capability in Layer 2 switch mode.

  • MAC address retrieval in cards provisioned in the L2-over-DWDM mode.

  • When a port is in UNI mode, tagging can be configured as transparent or selective. In transparent mode, only SVLANs in the VLAN database of the node can be configured. In selective mode, a CVLAN- to-SVLAN relationship can be defined.

  • Layer 2 VLAN port mapping that allows the cards to be configured as multiple Gigabit Ethernet TXPs and MXPs.

  • Y-cable protection is configurable in TXP and MXP modes.

  • Two protection schemes are available in Layer 2 mode. They are:

    • 1+1 protection—Protection scheme to address card, port, or shelf failures for client ports.

    • Fast Automatic Protection—Protection scheme to address card, port, or shelf failures for trunk ports.

  • End-to-end Ethernet link integrity.

  • Pluggable client interface optic modules (SFPs and XFPs)—Client ports support tri-rate SX, LX, and ZX SFPs, and 10-Gbps SR1 XFPs.

  • Pluggable trunk interface optic modules; trunk ports support the DWDM XFP.

  • Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) snooping that restricts the flooding of multicast traffic by forwarding multicast traffic to those interfaces where a multicast device is present.

  • Multicast VLAN Registration (MVR) for applications using wide-scale deployment of multicast traffic across an Ethernet ring-based service provider network.

  • Ingress CoS that assigns a CoS value to the port from 0 (highest) to 7 (lowest) and accepts CoS of incoming frames.

  • Egress QoS that defines the QoS capabilities for the egress port.

  • MAC address learning that facilitates switch processing.

  • Storm Control that limits the number of packets passing through a port. You can define the maximum number of packets allowed per second for the following types of traffic: Broadcast, Multicast, and Unicast. The threshold for each type of traffic is independent and the maximum number of packets allowed per second for each type of traffic is 16777215.

Protocol Compatibility list

Table 25 Protocol Compatibility List for GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE Cards
Protocol L1 1+1 FAPS IGMP REP LACP CFM EFM

L1

 

No

Yes

Yes

No

No

Yes

No

1+1

No

 

Yes

Yes

No

No

Yes

No

FAPS

Yes

Yes

 

Yes

No

No

Yes

No

IGMP

Yes

Yes

Yes

 

Yes

No

Yes

No

REP

No

No

No

Yes

 

No

Yes

No

LACP

No

No

No

No

No

 

No

No

CFM

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

Yes

No

 

No

EFM

No

No

No

No

No

No

No

 

The 10GE_XP and 10GE_XPE card trunk ports are displayed as follows:

  • Trunk 1 and Trunk 2 on the faceplate

  • 3-1 and 4-1 on CTC

  • 3 (Trunk) and 4 (Trunk) on the Optics Thresholds table

Client Interface

The client interface is implemented with separately orderable SFP or XFP modules. The client interfaces support the following tri-rate SFPs and XFPs using dual LC connectors and multimode fiber:

  • SFP - GE/1G-FC/2G-FC - 850 nm - MM - LC (PID ONS-SE-G2F-SX)

  • SFP - GE/1G-FC/2G-FC 1300 nm - SM - LC (PID ONS-SE-G2F-LX)

  • SFP - GE/1G-FC/2G-FC 1300 nm - SM - LC (PID ONS-SE-G2F-ZX)

  • SFP - 10/100/1000Base-T - Copper (PID ONS-SE-ZE-EL) Intra office up to 100;
Cable: RJ45 STP CAT5, CAT5E, and CAT6

  • SFP - 1000Base BX D/Gigabit Ethernet 1550 nm - SM - LC (PID ONS-SE-GE-BXD)

  • SFP - 1000Base BX U/Gigabit Ethernet 1550 nm - SM - LC (PID ONS-SE-GE-BXU)

  • SFP - Fast Ethernet 1310 nm - SM - LC (PID ONS-SI-100-LX10)

  • SFP - Fast Ethernet 1310 nm - MM - LC (PID ONS-SI-100-FX)

  • SFP - Fast Ethernet over DS1/E1 - SM - LC (PID ONS-SC-EOP1)

  • SFP - Fast Ethernet over DS3/E3 - SM - LC (PID ONS-SC-EOP3)

  • SFP - E1/DS1 over Fast Ethernet - SM - LC (PID ONS-SC-E1-T1-PW)

  • SFP - E3/DS3 PDH over Fast Ethernet - SM - LC (PID ONS-SC-E3-T3-PW)

    Figure 6. Recommended Topology for Using ONS-SC-E1-T1-PW and ONS -SC-E3-T3-PW SFPs



The client interfaces support the following dual-rate XFP using dual LC connectors and single-mode fiber:

  • XFP - OC-192/STM-64/10GE/10-FC/OTU2 - 1310 SR - SM LC (PID: ONS-XC-10G-S1)

  • XFP - 10GE - 1550 nm - SM - LC (PID ONS-XC-10G-L2)

  • XFP - 10GE - 1550 nm - SM - LC (PID ONS-XC-10G-C)


    Note


    If ONS-XC-10G-C XFP is used on GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards on client port 1, the maximum temperature at which the system qualifies is +45 degree Celsius.


The client interfaces support the following multimode XFP using dual LC connectors and multi-mode fiber:

  • XFP - OC-192/10GFC/10GE - 850 nm MM LC (PID ONS-XC-10G-SR-MM)

DWDM Trunk Interface

The GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards have two 10 Gigabit Ethernet trunk ports operating at 10 Gigabit Ethernet (10.3125 Gbps) or 10 Gigabit Ethernet into OTU2 (nonstandard 11.0957 Gbps). The ports are compliant with ITU-T G.707, ITU-T G.709, and Telcordia GR-253-CORE standards. The ports are capable of carrying C-band and L-band wavelengths through insertion of DWDM XFPs. Forty channels are available in the 1550-nm C band 100-GHz ITU grid, and forty channels are available in the L band.

Configuration Management

The GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards support the following configuration management parameters:

  • Port name—User-assigned text string.

  • Admin State/Service State—Administrative and service states to manage and view port status.

  • MTU—Provisionable maximum transfer unit (MTU) to set the maximum number of bytes per frames accepted on the port.

  • Mode—Provisional port mode, either Autonegotiation or the port speed.

  • Flow Control—Flow control according to IEEE 802.1x pause frame specification can be enabled or disabled for TX and RX ports.

  • Bandwidth—Provisionable maximum bandwidth allowed for the port.

  • Ingress CoS—Assigns a CoS value to the port from 0 (highest) to 7 (lowest) and accepts CoS of incoming frames.

  • Egress QoS—Defines the QoS capabilities at the egress port.

  • NIM—Defines the port network interface management type based on Metro Ethernet Forum specifications. Ports can be defined as UNI or NNI.

  • MAC Learning—MAC address learning to facilitate switch processing.

  • VLAN tagging provided according to the IEEE 802.1Q standard.


    Note


    When the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards are provisioned in a MXP or TXP mode, only the following parameters are available: Port Name, State, MTU, Mode, Flow control, and Bandwidth.


Security

GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE card ports can be provisioned to block traffic from a user-defined set of MAC addresses. The remaining traffic is normally switched. You can manually specify the set of blocked MAC addresses for each port. Each port of the card can receive traffic from a limited predefined set of MAC addresses. The remaining traffic will be dropped. This capability is a subset of the Cisco IOS “Port Security” feature.

Card Protection

The following card protection schemes are available for the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards.
  • Y-Cable Protection

  • 1+1 Protection

  • Layer 2 Over DWDM Protection

Related Procedures for Card Protection

The following are the related procedures for creating card protection on GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards:

IGMP Snooping

As networks increase in size, multicast routing becomes critically important as a means to determine which segments require multicast traffic and which do not. IP multicasting allows IP traffic to be propagated from one source to a number of destinations, or from many sources to many destinations. Rather than sending one packet to each destination, one packet is sent to the multicast group identified by a single IP destination group address. GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards can learn up to a maximum of 1024 multicast groups. This includes groups on all the VLANs.

Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) snooping restricts the flooding of multicast traffic by forwarding multicast traffic to those interfaces where a multicast device is present.

When the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card receives an IGMP leave group message from a host, it removes the host port from the multicast forwarding table after generating group specific queries to ensure that no other hosts interested in traffic for the particular group are present on that port. Even in the absence of any “leave” message, the cards have a timeout mechanism to update the group table with the latest information. After a card relays IGMP queries from the multicast router, it deletes entries periodically if it does not receive any IGMP membership reports from the multicast clients.

In a multicast router, general queries are sent on a VLAN when Protocol Independent Multicast (PIM) is enabled on the VLAN. The GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card forwards queries to all ports belonging to the VLAN. All hosts interested in this multicast traffic send Join requests and are added to the forwarding table entry. The Join requests are forwarded only to router ports. By default, these router ports are learned dynamically. However, they can also be statically configured at the port level in which case the static configuration overrides dynamic learning.

For information about interaction of IGMP with other protocols, see the “Protocol Compatibility list” section on page 11-50.

IGMP Snooping Guidelines and Restrictions

The following guidelines and restrictions apply to IGMP snooping on GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards:

  • IGMP snooping V2 is supported as specified in RFC 4541.

  • IGMP snooping V3 is not supported and the packets are flooded in the SVLAN.

  • Layer 2 multicast groups learned through IGMP snooping are dynamic.

  • GE_XP and 10GE_XP cards support IGMP snooping on 128 stacked VLANs and GE_XPE and 10GE_XPE cards support up to 256 stacked VLANs that are enabled.

  • IGMP snooping can be configured per SVLAN or CVLAN. By default, IGMP snooping is disabled on all SVLANs and CVLANs.

  • IGMP snooping on CVLAN is enabled only when:

    • MVR is enabled.

    • UNI ports are in selective add and selective translate modes. For each UNI port, a CVLAN must be specified for which IGMP snooping is to be enabled.

  • IGMP snooping can be enabled only on one CVLAN per port. If you enable IGMP snooping on CVLAN, you cannot enable IGMP snooping on the associated SVLAN and vice versa. The number of VLANs that can be enabled for IGMP snooping cannot exceed 128.

  • When IGMP snooping is enabled on double-tagged packets, CVLAN has to be the same on all ports attached to the same SVLAN.

  • When IGMP snooping is working with the Fast Automatic Protection Switch (FAPS) in a ring-based setup, it is advisable to configure all NNI ports as static router ports. This minimizes the multicast traffic hit when a FAPS switchover occurs.

The following conditions are raised from IGMP snooping at the card:

  • MCAST-MAC-TABLE-FULL—This condition is raised when the multicast table is full and a new join request is received. This table is cleared when at least one entry gets cleared from the multicast table after the alarm is raised.

  • MCAST-MAC-ALIASING—This condition is raised when there are multiple L3 addresses that map to the same L2 address in a VLAN. This is a transient condition.

For more information on severity level of these conditions and procedure to clear these alarms, refer to the Cisco NCS 2000 Series Troubleshooting Guide.

Fast-Leave Processing


Note


Fast-Leave processing is also known as Immediate-Leave.


IGMP snooping Fast-Leave processing allows the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE to remove an interface that sends a leave message from the forwarding table without first sending group specific queries to the interface. When you enable IGMP Fast-Leave processing, the card immediately removes a port from the IP multicast group when it detects an IGMP, version 2 (IGMPv2) leave message on that port.

Static Router Port Configuration

Multicast-capable ports are added to the forwarding table for every IP multicast entry. The card learns of such ports through the PIM method.

Report Suppression

Report suppression is used to avoid a storm of responses to an IGMP query. When this feature is enabled, a single IGMP report is sent to each multicast group in response to a single query. Whenever an IGMP snooping report is received, report suppression happens if the report suppression timer is running. The Report suppression timer is started when the first report is received for a general query. Then this time is set to the response time specified in general query.

IGMP Statistics and Counters

An entry in a counter contains multicasting statistical information for the IGMP snooping capable GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card. It provides statistical information about IGMP messages that have been transmitted and received. IGMP statistics and counters can be viewed via CTC from the Performance > Ether Ports > Statistics tab.

This information can be stored in the following counters:

  • cisTxGeneralQueries—Number of general queries transmitted through an interface.

  • cisTxGroupSpecificQueries—Total group specific queries transmitted through an interface.

  • cisTxReports—Total membership reports transmitted through an interface.

  • cisTxLeaves—Total Leave messages transmitted through an interface.

  • cisRxGeneralQueries—Total general queries received at an interface.

  • cisRxGroupSpecificQueries—Total Group Specific Queries received at an interface.

  • cisRxReports—Total Membership Reports received at an interface.

  • cisRxLeaves—Total Leave messages received at an interface.

  • cisRxValidPackets—Total valid IGMP packets received at an interface.

  • cisRxInvalidPackets—Total number of packets that are not valid IGMP messages received at an interface.

Related Procedure for Enabling IGMP Snooping

To enable IGMP snooping on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards, see the NTP-G204 Enabling IGMP Snooping on a Card.

Multicast VLAN Registration

Multicast VLAN Registration (MVR) is designed for applications using wide-scale deployment of multicast traffic across an Ethernet-ring-based service provider network (for example, the broadcast of multiple television channels over a service-provider network). MVR allows a subscriber on a port to subscribe and unsubscribe to a multicast stream on the network-wide multicast VLAN. It allows the single multicast VLAN to be shared in the network while subscribers remain in separate VLANs. MVR provides the ability to continuously send multicast streams in the multicast VLAN, but to isolate the streams from the subscriber VLANs for bandwidth and security reasons.

MVR assumes that subscriber ports subscribe and unsubscribe (“Join” and “Leave”) these multicast streams by sending out IGMP Join and Leave messages. These messages can originate from an IGMP version-2-compatible host with an Ethernet connection. MVR operates on the underlying mechanism of IGMP snooping. MVR works only when IGMP snooping is enabled.

The card identifies the MVR IP multicast streams and their associated MAC addresses in the card forwarding table, intercepts the IGMP messages, and modifies the forwarding table to include or remove the subscriber as a receiver of the multicast stream, even though the receivers is in a different VLAN than the source. This forwarding behavior selectively allows traffic to cross between different VLANs.


Note


When MVR is configured, the port facing the router must be configured as NNI in order to allow the router to generate or send multicast stream to the host with the SVLAN. If router port is configured as UNI, the MVR will not work properly.


Related Procedure for Enabling MVR

To enable MVR on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards, see the NTP-G206 Enabling MVR on a Card.

MAC Address Learning

The GE_XPE and 10 GE_XPE cards support 32K MAC addresses. MAC address learning can be enabled or disabled per SVLAN on GE_XPE and 10 GE_XPE cards. The cards learn the MAC address of packets they receive on each port and add the MAC address and its associated port number to the MAC address learning table. As stations are added or removed from the network, the GE_XPE and 10 GE_XPE cards update the MAC address learning table, adding new dynamic addresses and aging out those that are currently not in use.

MAC address learning can be enabled or disabled per SVLAN. When the configuration is changed from enable to disable, all the related MAC addresses are cleared. The following conditions apply:

  • If MAC address learning is enabled on per port basis, the MAC address learning is not enabled on all VLANs, but only on VLANs that have MAC address learning enabled.

  • If per port MAC address learning is disabled then the MAC address learning is disabled on all VLANs, even if it is enabled on some of the VLAN supported by the port.

  • If the per port MAC address learning is configured on GE-XP and 10 GE-XP cards, before upgrading to GE-XPE or 10 GE-XPE cards, enable MAC address learning per SVLAN. Failing to do so disables MAC address learning.

Related Procedure for MAC Address Learning

To enable MAC address learning on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards, see the DLP-G221 Enabling MAC Address Learning on SVLANs.

MAC Address Retrieval

MAC addresses learned can be retrieved or cleared on GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards provisioned in L2-over-DWDM mode. The MAC addresses can be retrieved using the CTC or TL1 interface.

GE_XPE and 10GE_XPE cards support 32K MAC addresses and GE_XP and 10GE_XP cards support 16K MAC addresses. To avoid delay in processing requests, the learned MAC addresses are retrieved using an SVLAN range. The valid SVLAN range is from 1 to 4093.

The MAC addresses of the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards can also be retrieved. The card MAC addresses are static and are used for troubleshooting activities. One MAC address is assigned to each client, trunk, and CPU ports of the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card. These internal MAC addresses can be used to determine if the packets received on the far-end node are generated by GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards.

For MAC address retrieval, the following conditions apply:

  • The cards must be provisioned in L2-over-DWDM mode.

  • MAC address learning must be enabled per SVLAN on GE_XPE or 10 GE_XPE cards.

  • MAC address learning must be enabled per port on GE_XP or 10 GE_XP cards.

Related Procedure for MAC Address Retrieving

To retrieve and clear MAC addresses on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards, see the NTP-G237 Retrieving and Clearing MAC Addresses on SVLANs.

Link Integrity

The GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE card support end-to-end Ethernet link integrity. This capability is integral to providing an Ethernet private line service and correct operation of Layer 2 and Layer 3 protocols on the attached Ethernet devices.

The link integrity feature propagates a trunk fault on all the affected SVLAN circuits in order to squelch the far end client interface. Ethernet-Advanced IP Services (E-AIS) packets are generated on a per-port/SVLAN basis. An E-AIS format is compliant with ITU Y.1731.


Note


E-AIS packets are marked with a CoS value of 7 (also called .1p bits). Ensure that the network is not overloaded and there is sufficient bandwidth for this queue in order to avoid packet drops.


When link integrity is enabled on a per-port SVLAN basis, E-AIS packets are generated when the following alarms are raised;

  • LOS-P

  • OTUKLOF/LOM

  • SIGLOSS

  • SYNCHLOSS

  • OOS

  • PPM not present

When link integrity is enabled, GE_XP and 10 GE_XP card supports up to128 SVLANs and GE_XPE, 10 GE_XPE can support up to 256 SVLANs.

Related Procedure for Enabling Link Integrity

To enable link integrity on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards, see the NTP-G205 Enabling Link Integrity on a Card.

Ingress CoS

Ingress CoS functionality enables differentiated services across the GE_XPE and 10GE_XPE cards. A wide range of networking requirements can be provisioned by specifying the class of service applicable to each transmitted traffic.

When a CVLAN is configured as ingress CoS, the per-port settings are not considered. A maximum of 128 CVLAN and CoS relationships can be configured.

Related Procedure for Enabling Ingress CoS

To enable Ingress CoS on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards, see the:

CVLAN Rate Limiting

CVLAN rate limiting is supported on GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards. CVLAN rate limiting is supported for QinQ service in selective add mode. The following limitations and restrictions apply to CVLAN rate limiting:

  • CVLAN rate limiting is not supported for the following service types:

    • Selective translate mode

    • Transparent mode

    • Selective double add mode

    • Selective translate add mode

    • Untagged packets

    • CVLAN range

    • Services associated with the channel group

  • CVLAN rate limiting and SVLAN rate limiting cannot be applied to the same service instance.

  • Pseudo-IOS command line interface (PCLI) is not supported for CVLAN rate limiting.

  • A VLAN profile with Link Integrity option enabled cannot be used to perform CVLAN rate limiting.

  • On GE_XP and 10 GE_XP cards, CVLAN rate limiting can be applied to up to 128 services. However, the number of provisionable CVLAN rate limiting service instances is equal to 192 minus the number of SVLAN rate limiting service instances present on the card (subject to a minimum of 64 CVLAN rate limiting service instances).

  • On GE_XPE and 10 GE_XPE cards, CVLAN rate limiting can be applied to up to 256 services. However, the number of provisionable CVLAN rate limiting service instances is equal to 384 minus the number of SVLAN rate limiting service instances present on the card (subject to a minimum of 128 CVLAN rate limiting service instances).

Related Procedure for Provisioning CVLAN Rate

To provision CVLAN rate on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards, see the DLP-G289 Provisioning CVLAN Rate Limiting on a Card.

DSCP to CoS Mapping

DSCP to CoS mapping can be configured for each port. You can configure the CoS of the outer VLAN based on the incoming DSCP bits. This feature is supported only on GE_XPE and 10GE_XPE cards. PCLI is not supported for DSCP to CoS mapping.

DSCP to CoS mapping is supported for the following service types:

  • Selective add mode

  • Selective translate mode

  • Transparent mode

  • Selective double add mode

  • Selective translate add mode

  • Untagged packets

  • CVLAN range

  • Services associated with the channel group

Related Procedure for Provisioning CoS Based on DSCP

To provision CoS based on DSCP on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards, see the DLP-G384 Provisioning the QinQ Settings.

Link Aggregation Control Protocol

Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) is part of the IEEE802.3ad standard that allows you to bundle several physical ports together to form a single logical channel. LACP allows a network device such as a switch to negotiate an automatic bundling of links by sending LACP packets to the peer device.

LACP allows you to form a single Layer 2 link automatically from two or more Ethernet links. This protocol ensures that both ends of the Ethernet link are functional and agree to be members of the aggregation group before the link is added to the group. LACP must be enabled at both ends of the link to be operational.

For more information on LACP, refer to the IEEE802.3ad standard. For information about interaction of LACP with other protocols, see the “Protocol Compatibility list” section on page 11-50.

Advantages of LACP

LACP provides the following advantages:

  • High-speed network that transfers more data than any single port or device.

  • High reliability and redundancy. If a port fails, traffic continues on the remaining ports.

  • Hashing algorithm that allows to apply load balancing policies on the bundled ports.

Functions of LACP

LACP performs the following functions in the system:

  • Maintains configuration information to control aggregation.

  • Exchanges configuration information with other peer devices.

  • Attaches or detaches ports from the link aggregation group based on the exchanged configuration information.

  • Enables data flow when both sides of the aggregation group are synchronized.

Modes of LACP

LACP can be configured in the following modes:

  • On — Default. In this mode, the ports do not exchange LACP packets with the partner ports.

  • Active — In this mode, the ports send LACP packets at regular intervals to the partner ports.

  • Passive — In this mode, the ports do not send LACP packets until the partner sends LACP packets. After receiving the LACP packets from the partner ports, the ports send LACP packets.

Parameters of LACP

LACP uses the following parameters to control aggregation:

  • System Identifier—A unique identification assigned to each system. It is the concatenation of the system priority and a globally administered individual MAC address.

  • Port Identification—A unique identifier for each physical port in the system. It is the concatenation of the port priority and the port number.

  • Port Capability Identification—An integer, called a key, that identifies the capability of one port to aggregate with another port. There are two types of keys:

    • Administrative key—The network administrator configures this key.

    • Operational key—The LACP assigns this key to a port, based on its aggregation capability.

  • Aggregation Identifier—A unique integer that is assigned to each aggregator and is used for identification within the system.

Unicast Hashing Schemes

LACP supports the following unicast hashing schemes:

  • Ucast SA VLAN Incoming Port

  • Ucast DA VLAN Incoming Port

  • Ucast SA DA VLAN Incoming port

  • Ucast Src IP TCP UDP

  • Ucast Dst IP TCP UDP

  • Ucast Src Dst IP TCP UDP


    Note


    Unicast hashing schemes apply to unicast traffic streams only when the destination MAC address is already learned by the card. Hence, MAC learning must be enabled to support load balancing as per the configured hashing scheme. If the destination MAC address is not learned, the hashing scheme is Ucast Src Dst IP TCP UDP.


LACP Limitations and Restrictions

The LACP on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards has the following limitations and restrictions:

  • Hot standby link state is not supported on the channel group.

  • Marker protocol generator is not supported.

  • ALS cannot be configured on the channel group.

  • Loopback configuration cannot be applied on the channel group.

Related Procedure for LACP

To provision Channel Group using LACP, see the NTP-G281 Managing the GE_​XP, 10GE_​XP, GE_​XPE, and 10GE_​XPE Card Channel Group Settings.

Ethernet Connectivity Fault Management

Ethernet Connectivity Fault Management (CFM) is part of the IEEE 802.1ag standard. The Ethernet CFM is an end-to-end per service instance that supports the Ethernet layer Operations, Administration, and Management (OAM) protocol. It includes proactive connectivity monitoring, link trace on a per service basis, fault verification, and fault isolation for large Ethernet metropolitan-area networks (MANs) and WANs.

CFM is disabled on the card by default. CFM is enabled on all the ports by default.

For more information on CFM, refer to the IEEE 802.1ag standard. For information about interaction of CFM with other protocols, see the “Protocol Compatibility list” section on page 11-50. The following sections contain conceptual information about Ethernet CFM.

Maintenance Domain

A maintenance domain is an administrative domain that manages and administers a network. You can assign a unique maintenance level (from 0 to 7) to define the hierarchical relationship between domains. The larger the domain, the higher the maintenance level for that domain. For example, a service provider domain would be larger than an operator domain and might have a maintenance level of 6, while the operator domain maintenance level would be 3 or 4.

Maintenance domains cannot intersect or overlap because that would require more than one entity to manage it, which is not allowed. Domains can touch or nest if the outer domain has a higher maintenance level than the nested domain. Maintenance levels of nesting domains must be communicated among the administrating organizations. For example, one approach would be to have the service provider assign maintenance levels to operators.

The CFM protocol supports up to eight maintenance domains on GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards.

Maintenance Association

A maintenance association identifies a service within the maintenance domain. You can have any number of maintenance associations within each maintenance domain. The CFM protocol supports up to 1500 maintenance associations on GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards.


Note


Each maintenance association is mapped to a maintenance domain. This mapping is done to configure a Maintenance End Point (MEP). The CFM protocol supports up to 1000 mappings on GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards.


Maintenance End Points

Maintenance End Points (MEPs) reside at the edge of the maintenance domain and are active elements of the Ethernet CFM. MEPs transmit Continuity Check messages at periodic intervals and receive similar messages from other MEPs within a domain. MEPs also transmit Loopback and Traceroute messages at the request of the administrator. MEPs confine CFM messages within the boundary of a maintenance domain through the maintenance level. There are two types of MEPs:

  • Up (Inwards, towards the bridge)

  • Down (Outwards, towards the wire).

You can create up to 255 MEPs and MIPs together on GE_XP and 10GE_XP cards. You can create up to 500 MEPs and MIPs together on GE_XPE and 10GE_XPE cards.

The MEP continuity check database (CCDB) stores information that is received from other MEPs in the maintenance domain. The card can store up to 4000 MEP CCDB entries.

Maintenance Intermediate Points

Maintenance Intermediate Points (MIPs) are internal to the maintenance domain and are passive elements of the Ethernet CFM. They store information received from MEPs and respond to Linktrace and Loopback CFM messages. MIPs forward CFM frames received from MEPs and other MIPs, drop all CFM frames at a lower level, and forward all CFM frames at a higher level.

You can create up to 255 MEPs and MIPs together on GE_XP and 10GE_XP cards. You can create up to 500 MEPs and MIPs together on GE_XPE and 10GE_XPE cards.

The MIP CCDB maintains the information received for all MEPs in the maintenance domain. The card can store up to 4000 MIP CCDB entries.

CFM Messages

The Ethernet CFM on GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards supports the following messages:

  • Continuity Check—These messages are exchanged periodically among MEPs. They allow MEPs to discover other MEPs within a domain and allow MIPs to discover MEPs. These messages are confined to a domain.

  • Loopback—These messages are unicast messages that a MEP transmits, at the request of an administrator, to verify connectivity to a specific maintenance point. A reply to a loopback message indicates whether a destination is reachable.

  • Traceroute—These messages are multicast messages that a MEP transmits, at the request of an administrator, to track the path to a destination MEP.

CFM Limitations and Restrictions

The CFM on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards has the following limitations and restrictions:

  • CFM is not supported on channel groups.

  • CFM is not enabled on protected ports running REP, FAPS, and 1+1.

  • Y.1731 enhancements including AIS, LCK, and performance monitoring messages along with CFM are not supported.

  • IEEE CFM MIB is not supported.

  • L1 and CFM are mutually exclusive on a SVLAN because LI and CFM use the same MAC address.

  • MAC security and CFM are mutually exclusive on the card due to hardware resource constraints.

Related Procedure for Ethernet CFM

For information about the supported Ethernet CFM features on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards, see the NTP-G283 Managing the Card CFM Settings.

Ethernet OAM

The Ethernet OAM protocol is part of the IEEE 802.3ah standard and is used for installing, monitoring, and troubleshooting Ethernet MANs and Ethernet WANs. This protocol relies on an optional sublayer in the data link layer of the OSI model. The Ethernet OAM protocol was developed for Ethernet in the First Mile (EFM) applications. The terms Ethernet OAM and EFM are interchangeably used and both mean the same.

Normal link operation does not require Ethernet OAM. You can implement Ethernet OAM on any full-duplex point-to-point or emulated point-to-point Ethernet link for a network or part of a network (specified interfaces). OAM frames, called OAM Protocol Data Units (OAM PDUs), use the slow protocol destination MAC address 0180.c200.0002. OAM PDUs are intercepted by the MAC sublayer and cannot propagate beyond a single hop within an Ethernet network.

Ethernet OAM is disabled on all interfaces by default. When Ethernet OAM is enabled on an interface, link monitoring is automatically turned on.

For more information on Ethernet OAM protocol, refer to IEEE 802.3ah standard. For information about interaction of Ethernet OAM with other protocols, see the “Protocol Compatibility list” section on page 11-50.

Components of the Ethernet OAM

Ethernet OAM consists of two major components, the OAM Client and the OAM Sublayer.

OAM Client

The OAM client establishes and manages the Ethernet OAM on a link. The OAM client also enables and configures the OAM sublayer. During the OAM discovery phase, the OAM client monitors the OAM PDUs received from the remote peer and enables OAM functionality. After the discovery phase, the OAM client manages the rules of response to OAM PDUs and the OAM remote loopback mode.

OAM Sublayer

The OAM sublayer presents two standard IEEE 802.3 MAC service interfaces:

  • One interface facing toward the superior sub-layers, which include the MAC client (or link aggregation).

  • Other interface facing toward the subordinate MAC control sublayer.

The OAM sublayer provides a dedicated interface for passing OAM control information and OAM PDUs to and from the client.

Benefits of the Ethernet OAM

Ethernet OAM provides the following benefits:

  • Competitive advantage for service providers

  • Standardized mechanism to monitor the health of a link and perform diagnostics

Features of the Ethernet OAM

The Ethernet OAM protocol has the following OAM features:

  • Discovery—Identifies devices in the network and their OAM capabilities. The Discovery feature uses periodic OAM PDUs to advertise the OAM mode, configuration, and capabilities. An optional phase allows the local station to accept or reject the configuration of the peer OAM entity.

  • Link Monitoring—Detects and indicates link faults under a variety of conditions. It uses the event notification OAM PDU to notify the remote OAM device when it detects problems on the link.

  • Remote Failure Indication—Allows an OAM entity to convey the failure conditions to its peer through specific flags in the OAM PDU.

  • Remote Loopback—Ensures link quality with a remote peer during installation or troubleshooting.

Ethernet OAM Limitations and Restrictions

The Ethernet OAM on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards has the following limitations and restrictions:

  • CFM, REP, link integrity, LACP, FAPS, IGMP on SVLAN and L2 1+1 protection are not supported with EFM.

  • IEEE EFM MIB is not supported.

  • EFM cannot be enabled or disabled at the card level.

  • Unidirectional functionality is not supported.

  • Errored Symbol Period, Rx CRC errors, Tx CRC errors are not supported.

  • OAM PDUs are limited to 1 frame per second.

  • Dying Gasp and critical events are not supported.


    Note


    Dying Gasp RFI is not generated on GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards. However, if the peer device sends a dying gasp RFI, the card detects it and raises an alarm.


Related Procedure for Ethernet OAM

For information about the supported Ethernet OAM features on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards, see the NTP-G285 Managing the Card EFM Settings.

Resilient Ethernet Protocol

The Resilient Ethernet Protocol (REP) is a protocol used to control network loops, handle link failures, and improve convergence time.

REP performs the following tasks:

  • Controls a group of ports connected in a segment.

  • Ensures that the segment does not create any bridging loops.

  • Responds to link failures within the segment.

  • Supports VLAN load balancing.

For information about interaction of REP with other protocols, see the “Protocol Compatibility list” section on page 11-50.

REP Segments

A REP segment is a chain of ports connected to each other and configured with a segment ID. Each segment consists of regular segment ports and two edge ports. A GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card can have up to 2 ports that belong to the same segment, and each segment port can have only one external neighbor port.

A segment protects only against a single link failure. Any more failures within the segment result in loss of connectivity.

Characteristics of REP Segments

REP segments have the following characteristics:

  • If all the ports in the segment are operational, one port blocks traffic for each VLAN. If VLAN load balancing is configured, two ports in the segment control the blocked state of VLANs.

  • If any port in the segment is not operational, all the other operational ports forward traffic on all VLANs to ensure connectivity.

  • In case of a link failure, the alternate ports are immediately unblocked. When the failed link comes up, a logically blocked port per VLAN is selected with minimal disruption to the network.

REP Port States

Ports in REP segments take one of three roles or states: Failed, Open, or Alternate.

  • A port configured as a regular segment port starts as a failed port.

  • When the neighbor adjacencies are determined, the port transitions to the alternate port state, blocking all the VLANs on the interface. Blocked port negotiations occur and when the segment settles, one blocked port remains in the alternate role and all the other ports become open ports.

  • When a failure occurs in a link, all the ports move to the failed state. When the alternate port receives the failure notification, it changes to the open state, forwarding all VLANs.

Link Adjacency

Each segment port creates an adjacency with its immediate neighbor. Link failures are detected and acted upon locally. If a port detects a problem with its neighbor, the port declares itself non-operational and REP converges to a new topology.

REP Link Status Layer (LSL) detects its neighbor port and establishes connectivity within the segment. All VLANs are blocked on an interface until the neighbor port is identified. After the neighbor port is identified, REP determines the neighbor port that must be the alternate port and the ports that must forward traffic.

Each port in a segment has a unique port ID. When a segment port starts, the LSL layer sends packets that include the segment ID and the port ID.

A segment port does not become operational if the following conditions are satisfied:

  • No neighbor port has the same segment ID or more than one neighbor port has the same segment ID.

  • The neighbor port does not acknowledge the local port as a peer.

Fast Reconvergence

REP runs on a physical link and not on per VLAN. Only one hello message is required for all VLANs that reduces the load on the protocol.

REP Hardware Flood Layer (HFL) is a transmission mechanism that floods packets in hardware on an admin VLAN. HFL avoids the delay that is caused by relaying messages in software. HFL is used for fast reconvergence in the order of 50 to 200 milliseconds.

VLAN Load Balancing

You must configure two edge ports in the segment for VLAN load balancing. One edge port in the REP segment acts as the primary edge port; the other edge port as the secondary edge port. The primary edge port always participates in VLAN load balancing in the segment. VLAN load balancing is achieved by blocking certain VLANs at a configured alternate port and all the other VLANs at the primary edge port.

REP Configuration Sequence

You must perform the following tasks in sequence to configure REP:

  • Configure the REP administrative VLAN or use the default VLAN 1. The range of REP admin VLAN is 1 to 4093. VLAN 4094 is not allowed.

  • Add ports to the segment in interface configuration mode.

  • Enable REP on ports and assign a segment ID to it. REP is disabled on all ports by default. The range of segment ID is 1 to 1024.

  • Configure two edge ports in the segment; one port as the primary edge port and the other as the secondary edge port.

  • If you configure two ports in a segment as the primary edge port, for example, ports on different switches, REP selects one of the ports to serve as the primary edge port based on port priority. The Primary option is enabled only on edge ports.

  • Configure the primary edge port to send segment topology change notifications (STCNs) and VLAN load balancing to another port or to other segments. STCNs and VLAN load balancing configurations are enabled only for edge ports.


    Note


    A port can belong to only one segment. Only two ports can belong to the same segment. Both the ports must be either regular ports or edge ports. However, if the No-neighbor port is configured, one port can be an edge port and another port can be a regular port.


REP Supported Interfaces

REP supports the following interfaces:

  • REP is supported on client (UNI) and trunk (NNI) ports.

  • Enabling REP on client ports allows protection at the access or aggregation layer when the cards are connected to the L2 network.

  • Enabling REP on trunk ports allows protection at the edge layer when the cards are connected in a ring.

REP Limitations and Restrictions

The REP on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards has the following limitations and restrictions:

  • Fast re-convergence and VLAN load balancing are not supported on UNI ports in transparent mode.

  • Native VLAN is not supported.

  • CFM, EFM, link integrity, LACP, FAPS, and L2 1+1 protection are not supported on ports that are configured as part of REP segment and vice versa.

  • When a node installed with GE_XP, GE_XPE, 10GE_XP, or 10GE_XPE cards configured with REP or LACP is upgraded, traffic loss may occur. This traffic loss is due to reconvergence when the cards soft reset during the upgrade process.

  • NNI ports cannot be configured as the primary edge port or blocking port at the access or aggregation layer.

  • Only three REP segments can be configured on GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards.

  • Consider the following configuration:

    More than one REP closed segment is configured on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards and the same HFL admin VLAN is enabled on the switches.

    If two different segments are configured on more than one common switch, the following consequences happen.

    • Layer 1 loop

    • Flooding of HFL packets across segments if one REP segment fails

    • Segment goes down due to LSL time out even if the segment does not have faults

      Hence, it is recommended not to configure two different segments on more than one common switch.

  • Consider the following configuration:

    • VLAN Load Balancing is configured on GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards by specifying the VLB preempt delay.

    • Primary and secondary edge ports are configured on the same switch.

    • HFL or LSL is activated.

      This configuration leads to high convergence time during manual premption, VLB activation, and deactivation (400 to 700 milliseconds).

Related Procedure for Managing the REP Settings

To manage the REP settings on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards, see the NTP-G287 Managing the Card REP Settings.

For more information about the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards, see:

Related Procedures for GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE Cards

The following is the list of procedures and tasks related to the configuration of the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards:

ADM-10G Card

The ADM-10G card operates on Cisco NCS 2002 and Cisco NCS 2006 networks to carry optical signals and Gigabit Ethernet signals over DWDM wavelengths for transport. The card aggregates lower bit-rate client SONET or SDH signals (OC-3/STM-1, OC-12/STM-4, OC-48/STM-16, or Gigabit Ethernet) onto a C-band tunable DWDM trunk operating at a higher OC-192/STM-64 rate. In a DWDM network, the ADM-10G card transports traffic over DWDM by mapping Gigabit Ethernet and SONET or SDH circuits onto the same wavelength with multiple protection options.

You can install and provision the ADM-10G card in a linear configuration in:

  • Slot 2 in Cisco NCS 2002

  • Slots 2 to 6 in Cisco NCS 2006

The card is compliant with ITU-T G.825 and ITU-T G.783 for SDH signals. It supports concatenated and non-concatenated AU-4 mapped STM-1, STM-4, and STM-16 signals as specified in ITU-T G.707. The card also complies with Section 5.6 of Telcordia GR-253-CORE and supports synchronous transport signal (STS) mapped OC-3, OC-12, and OC-48 signals as specified in the standard.

The client SFP and trunk XFP are compliant with interface requirements in Telcordia GR-253-CORE, ITU-T G.957 and/or ITU-T G.959.1, and IEEE 802.3.

Key Features

The ADM-10G card has the following high-level features:

  • Operates with the control card.

  • Interoperable with TXP_MR_10E, TXP_MR_10E_C, TXP_MR_10EX_C, and OTU2_XP cards.

  • Has built-in OC-192/STM-64 add/drop multiplexing function including client, trunk, and STS cross-connect.

  • Supports both single-card and double-card (ADM-10G peer group) configuration.

  • Supports path protection/SNCP on client and trunk ports for both single-card and double-card configuration. The card does not support path protection/SNCP between a client port and a trunk port. Path protection/SNCP is supported only between two client ports or two trunk ports.

  • Supports 1+1 protection on client ports for double-card configuration only.

  • Supports SONET, SDH, and Gigabit Ethernet protocols on client SFPs.

  • Supports XFP DWDM trunk interface single wavelengths.

  • Returns zero bit errors when a control card switches from active to standby or when manual or forced protection switches occur.

  • Has 16 SFP-based client interfaces (gray, colored, coarse wavelength division multiplexing (CWDM), and DWDM optics available).

  • Supports STM1, STM4, STM16, and Gigabit Ethernet client signals (8 Gigabit Ethernet maximum).

  • Has one XFP-based trunk interface supporting E-FEC/FEC and ITU-T G.709 for double-card configuration.

  • Has two XFP-based trunk interface supporting E-FEC/FEC and ITU-T G.709 for single-card configuration.

  • Has two SR XFP interlink interfaces supporting redundancy connection with protection board and pass-through traffic for double-card configuration.

  • Supports frame-mapped generic framing procedure (GFP-F) and LEX mapping for Ethernet over SONET or SDH.

  • Can be installed or pulled from operation, in any slot, without impacting other service cards in the shelf.

  • Supports client to client hairpinning, that is, creation of circuits between two client ports for both single-card and double-card configuration. See the “Circuit Provisioning” section on page 11-76 for more detailed information.

ADM-10G POS Encapsulation, Framing, and CRC

The ADM-10G card supports Cisco EoS LEX (LEX) and generic framing procedure framing (GFP-F) encapsulation on 8 POS ports corresponding to 8 GigE ports (Port 1 to Port 8) in both single-card and double-card (ADM-10G peer group) configuration.

You can provision framing on the ADM-10G card as either the default GFP-F or LEX framing. With GFP-F framing, you can configure a 32-bit cyclic redundancy check (CRC) or none (no CRC) (the default). LEX framing supports 16-bit or 32-bit CRC configuration. The framing type cannot be changed when there is a circuit on the port.

On the CTC, navigate to card view and click the Provisioning > Line> Ethernet Tab. Parameters such as, admin state, service state, framing type, CRC, MTU and soak time for a port can be configured.

It is possible to create an end-to-end circuit between equipment supporting different kinds of encapsulation (for example, LEX on one side and GFP-F on other side). But, under such circumstances, traffic does not pass through, and an alarm is raised if there is a mismatch.

POS Overview

Ethernet data packets need to be framed and encapsulated into a SONET/SDH frame for transport across the SONET/SDH network. This framing and encapsulation process is known as packet over SONET/SDH (POS).

The Ethernet frame comes into the ADM-10G card on a standard Gigabit Ethernet port and is processed through the card’s framing mechanism and encapsulated into a POS frame. When the POS frame exits, the ADM-10G card is in a POS circuit, and this circuit is treated as any other SONET circuit (STS) or SDH circuit (VC) in the node. It is cross-connected and rides the SONET/SDH signal out the port of an optical card and across the SONET/SDH network.

The destination of the POS circuit is a card or a device that supports the POS interface. Data packets in the destination card frames are removed and processed into ethernet frames. The Ethernet frames are then sent to a standard Ethernet port of the card and transmitted onto an Ethernet network.

POS Framing Modes

A POS framing mode is the type of framing mechanism employed by the ADM-10G card to frame and encapsulate data packets into a POS signal. These data packets were originally encapsulated in Ethernet frames that entered the standard Gigabit Ethernet interface of the ADM-10G card.

GFP-F Framing

The GFP-F framing represent standard mapped Ethernet over GFP-F according to ITU-T G.7041. GFP-F defines a standard-based mapping of different types of services onto SONET/SDH. GFP-F maps one variable length data packet onto one GFP packet. GFP-F comprises of common functions and payload specific functions. Common functions are those shared by all payloads. Payload-specific functions are different depending on the payload type. GFP-F is detailed in the ITU recommendation G.7041.

LEX Framing

LEX encapsulation is a HDLC frame based Cisco Proprietary protocol, where the field is set to values specified in Internet Engineering Task Force (IETF) RFC 1841. HDLC is one of the most popular Layer 2 protocols. The HDLC frame uses the zero insertion/deletion process (commonly known as bit stuffing) to ensure that the bit pattern of the delimiter flag does not occur in the fields between flags. The HDLC frame is synchronous and therefore relies on the physical layer to provide a method of clocking and synchronizing the transmission and reception of frames. The HDLC framing mechanism is detailed in the IETF’s RFC 1662, “PPP in HDLC-like Framing.”

Faceplate and Block Diagram

Figure 7. ADM-10G Card Faceplate and Block Diagram





Port Configuration Rules

Figure 8. ADM-10G Card Port Capacities

Port 17 acts as trunk2 or ILK1 interface based on single-card or double-card configuration.

Client Interfaces

The ADM-10G card uses LC optical port connectors supports up to 16 SFPs that can be utilized for OC-N/STM-N traffic. Eight of the SFPs can be used for Gigabit Ethernet. The interfaces can support any mix of OC-3/STM-1, OC-12/STM-4, OC-48/STM-16, or Gigabit Ethernet of any reach, such as SX, LX, ZX, SR, IR, or LR. The interfaces support a capacity of:

  • 4 x OC-48/STM-16

  • 16 x OC-12/STM-4

  • 16 x OC-3/STM-1

  • 8 x GE

The supported client SFPs and XFPs are:

  • Gray SFPs

    • 1000Base-SX SFP 850 nm (ONS-SE-G2F-SX=)

    • 1000Base-LX SFP 1310 nm (ONS-SE-G2F-LX=)

    • OC48/STM16 IR1, OC12/STM4 SR1, OC3/STM1 SR1, GE-LX multirate SFP 1310 nm (ONS-SE-Z1=)

    • OC3/STM1 IR1, OC12/STM4 IR1 multirate SFP 1310 nm (ONS-SI-622-I1=)

    • OC48/STM16 SR1 SFP 1310 nm (ONS-SI-2G-S1=)

    • OC48/STM16 IR1 SFP 1310 nm (ONS-SI-2G-I1=)

    • OC48/STM16, 1550 LR2, SM LC (ONS-SE-2G-L2=)

  • Colored DWDM SFPs

    • 1000Base-ZX SFP 1550 nm (ONS-SI-GE-ZX=)

    • OC3/STM1 LR2 SFP 1550 nm (ONS-SI-155-L2=)

    • OC48/STM16 LR2 SFP 1550 nm (ONS-SI-2G-L2=)

    • OC48/STM16 SFP (ONS-SC-2G-xx.x)


      Note


      xx.x = 28.7 to 60.6. ONS-SC-2G-28.7, ONS-SC-2G-33.4, ONS-SC-2G-41.3, ONS-SC-2G-49.3, and ONS-SC-2G-57.3 are supported from Release 8.5 and later.


  • CWDM SFPs

    • OC48/STM16/GE CWDM SFP (ONS-SC-Z3-xxxx)

  • XFPs

    • OC-192/STM-64/10GE XFP 1550 nm (ONS-XC-10G-I2)

Interlink Interfaces

Two 2R interlink interfaces, called ILK1 (Port 17) and ILK2 (Port 18), are provided for creation of ADM-10G peer groups in double-card configurations. In a single-card configuration, Port 17 (OC-192/STM-64) and Port 18 (OC-192/STM-64 or OTU2 payload) must be configured as trunk interfaces. In a double-card configuration (ADM-10G peer group), Ports 17 and 18 must be configured as ILK1 and ILK2 interfaces, respectively. Physically cabling these ports between two ADM-10G cards, located on the same shelf, allows you to configure them as an ADM-10G peer group.The ILK ports carry 10 Gb of traffic each.

The interlink interfaces support STM64 SR1 (ONS-XC-10G-S1=) XFP and 10GE BASE SR (ONS-XC-10G-SR-MM=) XFPs.

DWDM Trunk Interface

The ADM-10G card supports OC-192/STM-64 signal transport and ITU-T G.709 digital wrapping according to the ITU-T G.709 standard.The ADM-10G card supports three trunk XFPs:

  • Two DWDM trunks, and one trunk interface in a single-card configuration.

  • One DWDM trunk XFP in a double-card configuration.

The supported DWDM trunk XFPs are:

  • 10G DWDM (ONS-XC-10G-xx.x=) (colored XFP)

  • STM64 SR1 (ONS-XC-10G-S1=) (gray XFP)

Configuration Management

When using OC-48/STM-16 traffic, some contiguous port configurations are unavailable due to hardware limitations. This limitation does not impact the Gigabit Ethernet payload.


Note


The ADM-10G card cannot be used in the same shelf with SONET or SDH cross-connect cards.


Table 26 OC-48/STM-16 Configuration Limitations

OC-48/STM-16 Port Number

Ports Restricted from Optical Traffic

OC-48/STM-16 on Port 13

No OC-N/STM-N on Port 1 through Port 3

OC-48/STM-16 on Port 14

No OC-N/STM-N on Port 4 through Port 6

OC-48/STM-16 on Port 15

No OC-N/STM-N on Port 7 through Port 9

OC-48/STM-16 on Port 16

No OC-N/STM-N on Port 10 through Port 12


Note


The total traffic rate for each trunk cannot exceed OC-192/STM-64 on each ADM-10G card, or for each ADM-10G peer group.



Note


Gigabit Ethernet is supported on Ports 1 through 8. Ports 9 through Port 12 support only OC-3/STM-1 or OC-12/STM-4.


Additionally, the following guidelines apply to the ADM-10G card:

  • Trunk Port 17 supports OC-192/STM-64.

  • Trunk Ports 18 and 19 support OC-192/STM-64 and OTU2.

  • The interlink port supports OC-192/STM-64.

  • Up to six ADM-10G cards can be installed in one shelf.

  • Up to 24 ADM-10G cards can be installed per network element (NE) regardless of whether the card is installed in one shelf or in multiple shelves.

  • A lamp test function can be activated from CTC to ensure that all LEDs are functional.

  • The card can operate as a working protected or working non-protected card.

  • In a redundant configuration, an active card hardware or software failure triggers a switch to the standby card. This switch is detected within 10 ms and is completed within 50 ms.

  • ADM-10G cards support jumbo frames with MTU sizes of 64 to 9,216 bytes; the maximum is 9,216.

  • After receiving a link or path failure, the ADM-10G card can shut down only the downstream Gigabit Ethernet port.


    Note


    In ADM-10G cards, the Gigabit Ethernet port does not support flow control.


Security

The ADM-10G card that an SFP or XFP is plugged into implements the Cisco Standard Security Code Check Algorithm that keys on the vendor ID and serial number.

If a pluggable port module (PPM) is plugged into a port on the card but fails the security code check because it is not a Cisco PPM, a minor NON-CISCO-PPM alarm is raised.

If a PPM with an unqualified product ID is plugged into a port on this card—that is, the PPM passes the security code as a Cisco PPM but it has not been qualified for use on the ADM-10G card— a minor UNQUAL-PPM alarm is raised.

Protection

The ADM-10G card supports 1+1 and SONET path protection and SDH SNCP protection architectures in compliance with Telcordia GR-253-CORE, Telcordia GR-1400-CORE, and ITU-T G.841 specifications.

Circuit Protection Schemes

The ADM-10G card supports path protection/SNCP circuits at the STS/VC4 (high order) level and can be configured to switch based on signal degrade calculations. The card supports path protection/SNCP on client and trunk ports for both single-card and double-card configuration.


Note


The ADM-10G card supports path protection/SNCP between client ports and trunk port 17. The card does not support path protection/SNCP between client ports and trunk ports 18 or 19. The card does not support path protection/SNCP between port 17 and trunk ports 18 and 19.


The card allows open-ended path protection/SNCP configurations incorporating other vendor equipment. In an open-ended path protection/SNCP, you can specify one source point and two possible endpoints (or two possible source points and one endpoint) and the legs can include other vendor equipment. The source and endpoints are part of the network discovered by CTC.

Port Protection Schemes

The ADM-10G card supports unidirectional and bidirectional 1+1 APS protection schemes on client ports for double-card configuration (ADM-10G peer group) only. 1+1 APS protection scheme is not supported in single-card configuration. For 1+1 optical client port protection, you can configure the system to use any pair of like facility interfaces that are on different cards of the ADM-10G peer group.

Circuit Provisioning

The ADM-10G card supports STS circuit provisioning both in single-card and double-card (ADM-10G peer group) configuration. The card allows you to create STS circuits between:

  • Client and trunk ports

  • Two trunk ports

  • Two client ports (client-to-client hairpinning)


    Note


    Circuits between two trunk ports are called pass-through circuits.


For an ADM-10G card in single-card configuration, if you are creating STS circuits between two client ports, the following limitation must be considered:

  • Gigabit Ethernet to Gigabit Ethernet connections are not supported.

For an ADM-10G card that is part of an ADM-10G peer group, if you are creating STS circuits between two client ports or between client and trunk ports, the following limitations must be considered:

  • Gigabit Ethernet to Gigabit Ethernet connections are not supported.

  • Optical channel (OC) to OC, OC to Gigabit Ethernet, and Gigabit Ethernet to OC connections between two peer group cards are supported. Peer group connections use interlink port bandwidth, hence, depending on the availability/fragmentation of the interlink port bandwidth, it may not be possible to create an STS circuit from the Gigabit Ethernet/OC client port to the peer card trunk port. This is because, contiguous STSs (that is, STS-3c, STS-12c, STS-24c, and so on) must be available on the interlink port for circuit creation.


    Note


    There are no limitations to create an STS circuit between two trunk ports.


The two ADM-10G cards used in a paired mode use interlink ports ILK1 (Port 17) and ILK2 (Port 18). A CCAT or VCAT circuit created between the peer ADM-10G cards uses the ILK1 port if the source or destination is Port 19. The circuits created with a single ADM-10G card uses the ILK2 port.

If the circuit is of type STS-nc (where n is an integer and can take values 3,6,9,12,18,24,36,48,96) and uses the ILK2 port, then the starting timeslot needs to use specific timeslots for traffic to flow. The timeslots can be 12m+1 for STS-12c circuits and 48m+1 (where m is an integer and can take values 0,1,2,3...) for STS-48c circuits. The timeslots can be 3m+1 for the other STS-nc circuits.

The following example illustrates how to use the correct timeslot for an ILK2 port:

If there is no circuit on the ILK2 port and a STS-3c circuit is created, the circuit uses timeslots 1 to 3. An STS-12c circuit must be created on the ILK2 port later. The STS-12c circuit must have used timeslots 4 to 15. However, the STS-12c circuit uses timeslots starting from 12m+1 (1, 13, 25, and so on) as defined in the above rule. Therefore, before creating the STS-12c circuit, dummy circuits must be created in CTC that consumes STS-9 bandwidth.

ADM-10G CCAT and VCAT Characteristics

The ADM-10G card supports high-order (HO) contiguous concatenation (CCAT) and HO virtual concatenation (VCAT) circuits on 8 GigE ports (Port 1 to Port 8) in both single-card and double-card (ADM-10G peer group) configuration.

To enable end-to-end connectivity in a VCAT circuit that traverses through a third-party network, you can use Open-Ended VCAT circuit creation.

The ADM-10G card supports flexible non-LCAS VCAT groups (VCGs). With flexible VCGs, the ADM-10G can perform the following operations:

  • Add or remove members from groups

  • Put members into or out of service, which also adds/removes them from the group

  • Add or remove cross-connect circuits from VCGs

Any operation on the VCG member is service effecting (for instance, adding or removing members from the VCG). Adding or removing cross-connect circuits is not service-affecting, if the associated members are not in the group

The ADM-10G card allows independent routing and protection preferences for each member of a VCAT circuit. You can also control the amount of VCAT circuit capacity that is fully protected, unprotected, or uses Protection Channel Access (PCA) (when PCA is available). Alarms are supported on a per-member as well as per virtual concatenation group (VCG) basis.

The ADM-10G card supports both automatic and manual routing for VCAT circuit, that is, all members are manually or automatically routed. Bidirectional VCAT circuits are symmetric, which means that the same number of members travel in each direction. With automatic routing, you can specify the constraints for individual members; with manual routing, you can select different spans for different members. Two types of automatic and manual routing are available for VCAT members: common fiber routing and split routing.

The ADM-10G card supports VCAT common fiber routing and VCAT split fiber (diverse) routing. With VCAT split fiber routing, each member can be routed independently through the SONET or SDH or DWDM network instead of having to follow the same path as required by CCAT and VCAT common fiber routing. This allows a more efficient use of network bandwidth, but the different path lengths and different delays encountered may cause slightly different arrival times for the individual members of the VCG. The VCAT differential delay is this relative arrival time measurement between members of a VCG. The maximum tolerable VCAT split fiber routing differential delay for the ADM-10G card is approximately 55 milliseconds. A loss of alignment alarm is generated if the maximum differential delay supported is exceeded.

The differential delay compensation function is automatically enabled when you choose split fiber routing during the CTC circuit configuration process. CCAT and VCAT common fiber routing do not enable or need differential delay support.


Caution


Protection switches with switching time of less than 60 milliseconds are not guaranteed with the differential delay compensation function enabled. The compensation time is added to the switching time.



Note


For TL1, EXPBUFFERS parameter must be set to ON in the ENT-VCG command to enable support for split fiber routing.


Available Circuit Sizes

Table 27 Supported SONET Circuit Sizes of ADM-10G card

CCAT

VCAT High Order

STS-1

STS-1-1nV (n= 1 to 21)

STS-3c

STS-3c-mv (m= 1 to 7)

STS-6c

 

STS-9c

 

STS-12c

 

STS-24c

 
Table 28 Supported SDH Circuit Sizes of ADM-10G card

CCAT

VCAT High Order

VC-4

VC-4-mv (m= 1 to 7)

VC-4-2c

 

VC-4-3c

 

VC-4-4c

 

VC-4-8c

 

Note


In ADM-10G cards, the Gigabit Ethernet port does not support flow control. When less than seven VC-4s are configured for the port, with the client traffic expected to be below the line rate, a burst in traffic beyond the supposed bandwidth leads to packet loss. It is, therefore, recommended to use an external flow control mechanism with less than seven VC-4s configured. Connecting a GE-XP or GE-XPE card between the client traffic and the ADM-10G Gigabit Ethernet interface enables such flow control.


Related Procedure for VCAT Circuit

The following is the list of procedures related to creating VCAT circuits:

Intermediate Path Performance Monitoring

Intermediate path performance monitoring (IPPM) allows a node to monitor the constituent channel of an incoming transmission signal. You can enable IPPM for STS/VC-4s payload on OCn and Trunk ports of ADM-10G card. The IPPM is complaint with GR253/G.826.

Software Release 9.2 and higher enables the ADM-10G card to monitor the near-end and far-end PM data on individual STS/VC-4 payloads by enabling IPPM. After provisioning IPPM on the card, service providers can monitor large amounts of STS/VC-4 traffic through intermediate nodes, thus making troubleshooting and maintenance activities more efficient. IPPM occurs only on STS/VC-4 paths that have IPPM enabled, and TCAs are raised only for PM parameters on the selected IPPM paths.

For a CCAT circuit, you can enable IPPM only on the first STS/VC-4 of the concatenation group. For a VCAT circuit, you can enable IPPM independently on each member STS/VC-4 of the concatenation group.

Related Procedure for IPPM

To enable IPPM on the ADM-10G card, see:

Pointer Justification Count Performance Monitoring

Pointers are used to compensate for frequency and phase variations. Pointer justification counts indicate timing errors on SONET networks. When a network is out of synchronization, jitter and wander occur on the transported signal. Excessive wander can cause terminating equipment to slip.

Slips cause different effects in service. Voice service has intermittent audible clicks. Compressed voice technology has short transmission errors or dropped calls. Fax machines lose scanned lines or experience dropped calls. Digital video transmission has distorted pictures or frozen frames. Encryption service loses the encryption key, causing data to be transmitted again.

Pointers provide a way to align the phase variations in STS and VC4 payloads. The STS payload pointer is located in the H1 and H2 bytes of the line overhead. Clocking differences are measured by the offset in bytes from the pointer to the first byte of the STS synchronous payload envelope (SPE) called the J1 byte. Clocking differences that exceed the normal range of 0 to 782 can cause data loss.

There are positive (PPJC) and negative (NPJC) pointer justification count parameters. PPJC is a count of path-detected (PPJC-PDET-P) or path-generated (PPJC-PGEN-P) positive pointer justifications. NPJC is a count of path-detected (NPJC-PDET-P) or path-generated (NPJC-PGEN-P) negative pointer justifications depending on the specific PM name. PJCDIFF is the absolute value of the difference between the total number of detected pointer justification counts and the total number of generated pointer justification counts. PJCS-PDET-P is a count of the one-second intervals containing one or more PPJC-PDET or NPJC-PDET. PJCS-PGEN-P is a count of the one-second intervals containing one or more PPJC-PGEN or NPJC-PGEN.

A consistent pointer justification count indicates clock synchronization problems between nodes. A difference between the counts means that the node transmitting the original pointer justification has timing variations with the node detecting and transmitting this count. Positive pointer adjustments occur when the frame rate of the SPE is too slow in relation to the rate of the STS-1.

You must enable PPJC and NPJC performance monitoring parameters for ADM-10Gcard. In CTC, the count fields for PPJC and NPJC PMs appear white and blank unless they are enabled on the card view Provisioning tab.

Performance Monitoring Parameter Definitions

This section describes the STS and VC-4 path performance monitoring parameters that ADM-10G card support.

Table 29 STS Near-end Path Performance Monitoring Parameters

Parameter

Definition

CV-P

Near-End STS Path Coding Violations (CV-P) is a count of BIP errors detected at the STS path layer (that is, using the B3 byte). Up to eight BIP errors can be detected per frame; each error increments the current CV-P second register.

ES-P

Near-End STS Path Errored Seconds (ES-P) is a count of the seconds when at least one STS path BIP error was detected. An AIS Path (AIS-P) defect (or a lower-layer, traffic-related, near-end defect) or a Loss of Pointer Path (LOP-P) defect can also cause an ES-P.

SES-P

Near-End STS Path Severely Errored Seconds (SES-P) is a count of the seconds when K (2400) or more STS path BIP errors were detected. An AIS-P defect (or a lower-layer, traffic-related, near-end defect) or an LOP-P defect can also cause an SES-P.

UAS-P

Near-End STS Path Unavailable Seconds (UAS-P) is a count of the seconds when the STS path was unavailable. An STS path becomes unavailable when ten consecutive seconds occur that qualify as SES-Ps, and continues to be unavailable until ten consecutive seconds occur that do not qualify as SES-Ps.

FC-P

Near-End STS Path Failure Counts (FC-P) is a count of the number of near-end STS path failure events. A failure event begins when an AIS-P failure, an LOP-P failure, a UNEQ-P failure, or a Section Trace Identifier Mismatch Path (TIM-P) failure is declared. A failure event also begins if the STS PTE that is monitoring the path supports Three-Bit (Enhanced) Remote Failure Indication Path Connectivity (ERFI-P-CONN) for that path. The failure event ends when these failures are cleared.

PPJC-PDET-P

Positive Pointer Justification Count, STS Path Detected (PPJC-PDET-P) is a count of the positive pointer justifications detected on a particular path in an incoming SONET signal.

PPJC-PGEN-P

Positive Pointer Justification Count, STS Path Generated (PPJC-PGEN-P) is a count of the positive pointer justifications generated for a particular path to reconcile the frequency of the SPE with the local clock.

NPJC-PDET-P

Negative Pointer Justification Count, STS Path Detected (NPJC-PDET-P) is a count of the negative pointer justifications detected on a particular path in an incoming SONET signal.

NPJC-PGEN-P

Negative Pointer Justification Count, STS Path Generated (NPJC-PGEN-P) is a count of the negative pointer justifications generated for a particular path to reconcile the frequency of the SPE with the local clock.

PJCDIFF-P

Pointer Justification Count Difference, STS Path (PJCDIFF-P) is the absolute value of the difference between the total number of detected pointer justification counts and the total number of generated pointer justification counts. That is, PJCDiff-P is equal to (PPJC-PGEN-P - NPJC-PGEN-P) - (PPJC-PDET-P - NPJC-PDET-P).

PJCS-PDET-P

Pointer Justification Count Seconds, STS Path Detect (NPJCS-PDET-P) is a count of the one-second intervals containing one or more PPJC-PDET or NPJC-PDET.

PJCS-PGEN-P

Pointer Justification Count Seconds, STS Path Generate (PJCS-PGEN-P) is a count of the one-second intervals containing one or more PPJC-PGEN or NPJC-PGEN.

Table 30 VC-4 Near-end Path Performance Monitoring Parameters

Parameter

Definition

HP-EB

High-Order Path Errored Block (HP-EB) indicates that one or more bits are in error within a block.

HP-BBE

High-Order Path Background Block Error (HP-BBE) is an errored block not occurring as part of an SES.

HP-ES

High-Order Path Errored Second (HP-ES) is a one-second period with one or more errored blocks or at least one defect.

HP-SES

High-Order Path Severely Errored Seconds (HP-SES) is a one-second period containing 30 percent or more errored blocks or at least one defect. SES is a subset of ES.

HP-UAS

High-Order Path Unavailable Seconds (HP-UAS) is a count of the seconds when the VC path was unavailable. A high-order path becomes unavailable when ten consecutive seconds occur that qualify as HP-SESs, and it continues to be unavailable until ten consecutive seconds occur that do not qualify as HP-SESs.

HP-BBER

High-Order Path Background Block Error Ratio (HP-BBER) is the ratio of BBE to total blocks in available time during a fixed measurement interval. The count of total blocks excludes all blocks during SESs.

HP-ESR

High-Order Path Errored Second Ratio (HP-ESR) is the ratio of errored seconds to total seconds in available time during a fixed measurement interval.

HP-SESR

High-Order Path Severely Errored Second Ratio (HP-SESR) is the ratio of SES to total seconds in available time during a fixed measurement interval.

HP-PPJC-PDET

High-Order, Positive Pointer Justification Count, Path Detected (HP-PPJC-Pdet) is a count of the positive pointer justifications detected on a particular path on an incoming SDH signal.

HP-NPJC-PDET

High-Order, Negative Pointer Justification Count, Path Detected (HP-NPJC-Pdet) is a count of the negative pointer justifications detected on a particular path on an incoming SDH signal.

HP-PPJC-PGEN

High-Order, Positive Pointer Justification Count, Path Generated (HP-PPJC-Pgen) is a count of the positive pointer justifications generated for a particular path.

HP-NPJC-PGEN

High-Order, Negative Pointer Justification Count, Path Generated (HP-NPJC-Pgen) is a count of the negative pointer justifications generated for a particular path.

HP-PJCDIFF

High-Order Path Pointer Justification Count Difference (HP-PJCDiff) is the absolute value of the difference between the total number of detected pointer justification counts and the total number of generated pointer justification counts. That is, HP-PJCDiff is equal to (HP-PPJC-PGen - HP-NPJC-PGen) - (HP-PPJC-PDet - HP-NPJC-PDet).

HP-PJCS-PDET

High-Order Path Pointer Justification Count Seconds (HP-PJCS-PDet) is a count of the one-second intervals containing one or more HP-PPJC-PDet or HP-NPJC-PDet.

HP-PJCS-PGEN

High-Order Path Pointer Justification Count Seconds (HP-PJCS-PGen) is a count of the one-second intervals containing one or more HP-PPJC-PGen or HP-NPJC-PGen.

ADM-10G Functions

The following functions of the ADM-10G card are explained in the "Card Features" chapter:

  •  Automatic Laser Shutdown

  • Card level indicators

  • Port level indicators

Related Procedures for ADM-10G Card

The following is the list of procedures and tasks related to the configuration of the ADM-10G card:

DLP-G775 Displaying the Bandwidth Usage of the STS Timeslots

Purpose

This task displays the bandwidth usage of the STS timeslots on the interlink interfaces, ILK1 (Port 17) and ILK2 (Port 18), in ADM-10G double-card configuration.

Tools/Equipment

None

Prerequisite Procedures

Required/As Needed

As needed

Onsite/Remote

Onsite or remote

Security Level

Provisioning or higher

Procedure
    Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the ADM-10G card where you want to display the bandwidth usage of the STS timeslots on the interlink interfaces.
    Step 2   Click the Maintenance > ILK Utilization tabs.
    Step 3   In the Interlink Ports drop-down list, choose the interlink port for which you want to display the bandwidth usage and click Refresh.

    The bandwidth usage of STS 1 to 192 timeslots are displayed in the Free/Occupied column. The bandwidth usage values are updated only after clicking the Refresh button.

    Step 4   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

    OTU2_XP Card

    The OTU2_XP card is a single-slot card with four ports with XFP-based multirate (OC-192/STM-64, 10GE, 10G FC, IB_5G) Xponder. The OTU2_XP card supports multiple configurations.

    Table 31 OTU2_XP Card Configurations and Ports

    Configuration

    Port 1

    Port 2

    Port 3

    Port 4

    2 x 10G transponder

    Client port 1

    Client port 2

    Trunk port 1

    Trunk port 2

    2 x 10G standard regenerator (with enhanced FEC (E-FEC) only on one port)

    Trunk port 1

    Trunk port 2

    Trunk port 1

    Trunk port 2

    10 GE LAN Phy to WAN Phy

    Client port

    Client port in transponder or trunk port in regenerator configuration

    Trunk port

    Trunk port in transponder or regenerator configuration

    1 x 10G E-FEC regenerator 
(with E-FEC on two ports)

    Not used

    Not used

    Trunk port

    Trunk port

    1 x 10G splitter protected transponder

    Client port

    Not used

    Trunk port (working)

    Trunk port (protect)

    All the four ports are ITU-T G.709 compliant and support 40 channels (wavelengths) at 100-GHz channel spacing in the C-band (that is, the 1530.33 nm to 1561.42 nm wavelength range).

    The OTU2_XP card can be installed in , Slot 2 in Cisco NCS 2002, Slots 2 to 6 in Cisco NCS 2006, Slots 2 to 17 in Cisco NCS 2015 chassis. The OTU2_XP card supports SONET SR1, IR2, and LR2 XFPs, 10GE BASE SR, SW, LR, LW, ER, EW, and ZR XFPs, and 10G FC MX-SN-I and SM-LL-L XFPs.

    Key Features

    The OTU2_XP card has the following high-level features:

    • 10G transponder, regenerator, and splitter protection capability.

    • Interoperable with TXP_MR_10E and TXP_MR_10E_C cards.

    • Four port, multirate (OC-192/STM-64, 10G Ethernet WAN Phy, 10G Ethernet LAN Phy, 10G Fibre Channel, IB_5G) client interface. The client signals are mapped into an ITU-T G.709 OTU2 signal using standard ITU-T G.709 multiplexing.

    • ITU-T G.709 framing with standard Reed-Soloman (RS) (255,237) FEC. Performance monitoring and ITU-T G.709 Optical Data Unit (ODU) synchronous mapping. Enhanced FEC (E-FEC) with ITU-T G.709 ODU with greater than 8 dB coding gain.

    • The trunk rate remains the same irrespective of the FEC configuration. The error coding performance can be provisioned as follows:

      • FEC—Standard ITU-T G.709.

      • E-FEC—Standard ITU-T G.975.1 (subclause I.7)

    • IEEE 802.3 frame format supported for 10 Gigabit Ethernet interfaces. The minimum frame size is 64 bytes. The maximum frame size is user-provisionable.

    • Supports fixed/no fixed stuff mapping (insertion of stuffing bytes) for 10G Ethernet LAN Phy signals (only in transponder configuration).

    • Supports 10G Ethernet LAN Phy to 10G Ethernet WAN Phy conversion on Ports 1 (client port) and 3 (trunk port).

    • Supports 10G Ethernet LAN Phy to WAN Phy conversion using CTC and TL1. When enabled on the OTU2_XP card, the first Channel (Ports 1 and 3) supports LAN to WAN conversion. The second channel carries normal 10GE, 10G FC, and OC192/STM64 traffic.

    • The LAN Phy to WAN Phy conversion functions in accordance to WAN Interface Sublayer (WIS) mechanism as defined by IEEE802.3ae (IEEE Std 802.3ae-2002, Amendment to CSMA/CD).

    • Default configuration is transponder, with trunk ports configured as ITU-T G.709 standard FEC.

    • In transponder or regenerator configuration, if one of the ports is configured the corresponding port is automatically created.

    • In regenerator configuration, only Ports 3 and 4 can be configured as E-FEC. Ports 1 and 2 can be configured only with standard FEC.

    • When port pair 1-3 or 2-4 is configured as regenerator (that is, card mode is standard regenerator), the default configuration on Ports 3 and 4 is automatically set to standard FEC.

    • When Ports 3 and 4 are configured as regenerator (that is, card mode is E-FEC regenerator), the default configuration on both these ports is automatically set to E-FEC.

    • In a splitter-protected transponder configuration, the trunk ports (Port 3 and Port 4) are configured as ITU-T G.709 standard FEC or E-FEC. OCHCC circuits with different trunk wavelengths can be configured for the working and protect paths. The process of setting the trunk wavelengths is similar to the “DLP-G367 Change the 2.5G Multirate Transponder Trunk Wavelength Settings” task on page 11-175. OCHCC circuits having different trunk wavelengths on the working and protect paths can be upgraded to GMPLS circuits.

    • Supports protection through Y-cable protection scheme.


      Note


      When enabled, the 10G Ethernet LAN Phy to WAN Phy conversion feature does not support Y-cable protection on the LAN to WAN interface (ports 1 and 3).


    • Client ports support SONET SR1, IR2, and LR2 XFPs, 10GE BASE SR, SW, LR, LW, ER, EW, and ZR XFPs, and 10G FC MX-SN-I and SM-LL-L XFPs.

    • Following are the OTU2 link rates that are supported on the OTU2_XP trunk port:

      • Standard G.709 (10.70923 Gbps) when the client is provisioned as “SONET” (including 10G Ethernet WAN PHY) (9.95328 Gbps).

      • G.709 overclocked to transport 10GE as defined by ITU-T G. Sup43 Clause 7.2 (11.0491 Gbps) when the client is provisioned as “10G Ethernet LAN Phy” (10.3125 Gbps) with “No Fixed Stuff” enabled.

      • G.709 overclocked to transport 10GE as defined by ITU-T G. Sup43 Clause 7.1 (11.0957 Gbps) when the client is provisioned as “10G Ethernet LAN Phy” (10.3125 Gbps) with “No Fixed Stuff” disabled.

      • G.709 proprietary overclocking mode to transport 10G FC (11.3168 Gbps) when the client is provisioned as “10G Fiber Channel” (10.518 Gbps).

      • Proprietary rate at the trunk when the client is provisioned as IB_5G.

    • The MTU setting is used to display the ifInerrors and OverSizePkts counters on the receiving trunk and client port interfaces. Traffic of frame sizes up to 65535 bytes pass without any packet drops, from the client port to the trunk port and vice versa irrespective of the MTU setting.

    • The OTU2_XP card configured in the Transponder or Mixed mode does not support egress Ethernet variables such as ifOutOctets, ifOutDiscards, ifOutMulticastPkts, and ifOutBroadcastPkts.

    OTU2_XP Card Interface

    The OTU2_XP card is a multi-functional card that operates in different configurations, such as transponder, standard regenerator, E-FEC regenerator, and 10G Ethernet LAN Phy to WAN Phy conversion mode. The OTU2_XP card acts as a protected transponder, when the 10G Ethernet LAN Phy to WAN Phy is in splitter protected transponder configuration mode.

    Depending on the configuration of the OTU2_XP card, the ports act as client or trunk ports (see "OTU2_​XP Card Configurations and Ports" table). The following section describes the client and trunk rates supported on the OTU2_XP card for different card configurations:

    Client Interface

    In transponder and 10G Ethernet LAN Phy to WAN Phy card configurations, Ports 1 and 2 act as client ports and in splitter protected transponder configuration, Port 1 acts as a client port. For these card configurations, the client rates supported are:

    • OC-192/STM-64

    • 10G Ethernet WAN Phy

    • 10G Ethernet LAN Phy

    • 10G Fibre Channel

    • IB_5G

    Trunk Interface

    In transponder, 10G Ethernet LAN Phy to WAN Phy, and splitter protected transponder card configurations, Ports 3 and 4 act as trunk ports. For these card configurations, the trunk rates supported are:

    • OC-192/STM-64

    • 10G Ethernet WAN Phy

    • 10G Ethernet LAN Phy

    • 10G Fibre Channel

    • OTU2 with ITU-T G.709 for OC-192 client interface

    • OTU2e with ITU-T G.709 for 10G Ethernet LAN Phy client interface

    • Proprietary rate at the trunk when the client is provisioned as IB_5G

    In standard regenerator card configuration, all four ports act as trunk ports and in E-FEC regenerator configuration, Ports 3 and 4 act as the trunk ports. For these card configurations, the trunk rate supported is OTU2 G.709


    Note


    The above mentioned OTU2 signal must be an OC-192/STM-64, 10G Ethernet WAN Phy, 10G Ethernet LAN Phy, or 10G Fibre Channel signal packaged into an OTU2 G.709 frame. Additionally, the standard regenerator and E-FEC regenerator configuration supports an OTU2 signal that is OTU2 has been generated by multiplexing four ODU1 signals.


    Configuration Management

    The OTU2_XP card supports the following configuration management parameters:

    • Card Configuration—Provisionable card configuration: Transponder, Standard Regen, Enhanced FEC, or Mixed, or 10G Ethernet LAN Phy to WAN Phy.

    • Port Mode—Provisionable port mode when the card configuration is set as Mixed. The port mode can be chosen as either Transponder or Standard Regen for each port pair (1-3 and 2-4). For card configurations other than Mixed, CTC automatically sets the port mode depending on the selected card configuration. For 10G Ethernet LAN Phy to WAN Phy mode, CTC automatically selects the port pair (1-3) as 10G Ethernet LAN Phy to WAN Phy. Port pair (2-4) in 10G Ethernet LAN Phy to WAN Phy mode is selected as Transponder or Standard Regen.

    • Termination Mode—Provisionable termination mode when the card configuration is set as either Transponder or Mixed. The termination mode can be chosen as Transparent, Section, or Line. For Standard Regen and Enhanced FEC card configurations, CTC automatically sets the termination mode as Transparent. For 10G Ethernet LAN Phy to WAN Phy mode, CTC automatically selects the Termination Mode of port pair (1-3) as Line. You cannot provision the Termination Mode parameter.

    • Fault Signalling—Provisionable Fault Signaling mode configuration when the card configuration is set as either Transponder, Mixed, or Standard Regen. The Fault Signaling mode configuration can be chosen as AIS/Send Local Fault or Squelch/Laser-Off. For Enhanced FEC card configuration, CTC automatically sets the AIS/Send Local Fault or Squelch/Laser-Off mode configuration as AIS/Send Local Fault. For 10G Ethernet LAN Phy to WAN Phy mode, the CTC automatically selects the AIS/Send Local Fault or Squelch/Laser-Off of port pair (1-3) as Squelch/Laser-Off. You cannot provision the AIS/Send Local Fault or Squelch/Laser-Off parameter.


      Note


      When Fault Signaling is enabled in Standard Regen configuration with port pairs (1-3) and (2-4), Squelch/Laser-Off is supported on ports 1 and 2 and AIS/Send Local Fault on ports 3 and 4.



      Note


      When you choose the 10G Ethernet LAN Phy to WAN Phy conversion, the Termination mode is automatically set to LINE. The AIS/Squelch is set to Squelch/Laser-Off and ODU Transparency is set to Cisco Extended Use for Ports 1 and 3.


    • Regen Line Name—User-assigned text string for regeneration line name.

    • ODU Transparency—Provisionable ODU overhead byte configuration, either Transparent Standard Use or Cisco Extended Use. See the “ODU Transparency” section on page 11-89 for more detailed information. For 10G Ethernet LAN Phy to WAN Phy mode, CTC automatically selects the ODU Transparency as Cisco Extended Use. You cannot provision the ODU Transparency parameter.

    • Port name—User-assigned text string.

    • Admin State/Service State—Administrative and service states to manage and view port status.

    • ALS Mode—Provisionable ALS function.

    • Reach—Provisionable optical reach distance of the port.

    • Wavelength—Provisionable wavelength of the port.

    • AINS Soak—Provisionable automatic in-service soak period.

    OTU2_XP Card Configuration Rules

    The following rules apply to OTU2_XP card configurations:

    • When you preprovision the card, port pairs 1-3 and 2-4 come up in the default Transponder configuration.

    • The port pairs 1-3 and 2-4 can be configured in different modes only when the card configuration is Mixed. If the card configuration is Mixed, you must choose different modes on port pairs 1-3 and 2-4 (that is, one port pair in Transponder mode and the other port pair in Standard Regen mode).

    • If the card is in Transponder configuration, you can change the configuration to Standard Regen or Enhanced FEC.

    • If the card is in Standard Regen configuration and you have configured only one port pair, then configuring payload rates for the other port pair automatically changes the card configuration to Mixed, with the new port pair in Transponder mode.

    • If the card is in Standard Regen configuration, you cannot directly change the configuration to Enhanced FEC. You have to change to Transponder configuration and then configure the card as Enhanced FEC.

    • If the card is in Enhanced FEC configuration, Ports 1 and 2 are disabled. Hence, you cannot directly change the configuration to Standard Regen or Mixed. You must remove the Enhanced FEC group by moving the card to Transponder configuration, provision PPM on Ports 1 and 2, and then change the card configuration to Standard Regen or Mixed.

    • If the card is in Standard Regen or Enhanced FEC configuration, you cannot change the payload rate of the port pairs. You have to change the configuration to Transponder, change the payload rate, and then move the card configuration back to Standard Regen or Enhanced FEC.

    • If any of the affected ports are in IS (ANSI) or Unlocked-enabled (ETSI) state, you cannot change the card configuration.

    • If IB_5G payload has to be provisioned, the NE Default should match the values. For more information on editing the NE Default values, see the "NTP-G135 Edit Network Element Defaults” task.

    Table 32 OTU2_XP Card Configuration for IB_5G Payload Provisioning

    Parameter

    NE Default Name

    Value

    FEC

    OTU2-XP.otn.otnLines.FEC

    Standard

    ITU-T G.709 OTN

    OTU2-XP.otn.otnLines.G709OTN

    Enable

    Termination Mode

    OTU2-XP.config.port.TerminationMode

    Transparent

    ODU Transparency

    OTU2-XP.config.port.OduTransparency

    Cisco Extended Use

    AIS/Squelch

    OTU2-XP.config.port.AisSquelchMode

    Squelch

    • If the card is changed to 10G Ethernet LAN Phy to WAN Phy, the first PPM port is deleted and replaced by a 10G Ethernet port; the third PPM port is deleted and automatically replaced with OC192/STM64 (SONET/SDH) port. The third PPM port is automatically deleted and the third PPM port is replaced with OC192/STM64 (SONET/SDH).

    Table 33 Card Configuration Transition Summary

    Card Configuration

    Transition To

    Transponder

    Standard Regen

    Enhanced FEC

    Mixed

    10G Ethernet LAN Phy to WAN Phy

    Transponder

    Yes

    Yes

    Yes

    Yes

    Standard Regen

    Yes

    No

    Yes

    Yes

    Enhanced FEC

    Yes

    No

    No

    No

    Mixed

    Yes

    Yes

    No

    Yes

    10G Ethernet LAN Phy to WAN Phy

    Yes

    Yes

    No

    The 10G Ethernet LAN Phy to WAN Phy to Mixed is supported if the Port pair 1-3 is chosen as Transponder.

    The 10G Ethernet LAN Phy to WAN Phy to Mixed is not supported if the Port pair 1-3 is chosen as Standard Regen.

    Security

    The OTU2_XP card, when an XFP is plugged into it, implements the Cisco Standard Security Code Check Algorithm that keys on vendor ID and serial number.

    If a PPM is plugged into a port on the card but fails the security code check because it is not a Cisco PPM, a NON-CISCO-PPM Not Reported (NR) condition occurs.

    If a PPM with a non-qualified product ID is plugged into a port on this card, that is, the PPM passes the security code as a Cisco PPM but it has not been qualified for use on the OTU2_XP card, a UNQUAL-PPM NR condition occurs.

    ODU Transparency

    A key feature of the OTU2_XP card is the ability to configure the ODU overhead bytes (EXP bytes and RES bytes 1 and 2) using the ODU Transparency parameter. The two options available for this parameter are:

    • Transparent Standard Use—ODU overhead bytes are transparently passed through the card. This option allows the OTU2_XP card to act transparently between two trunk ports (when the card is configured in Standard Regen or Enhanced FEC).

    • Cisco Extended Use—ODU overhead bytes are terminated and regenerated on both ports of the regenerator group.

    The ODU Transparency parameter is configurable only for Standard Regen and Enhanced FEC card configuration. For Transponder card configuration, this parameter defaults to Cisco Extended Use and cannot be changed.


    Note


    The Forward Error Correction (FEC) Mismatch (FEC-MISM) alarm will not be raised on OTU2_XP card when you choose Transparent Standard Use.


    For more information about the OTU2_XPcard, see http:/​/​www.cisco.com/​en/​US/​prod/​collateral/​optical/​ps5724/​ps2006/​data_​sheet_​c78-500937.html

    Related Procedures for OTU2_XP Card

    The following is the list of procedures and tasks related to the configuration of the OTU2_XP card:

    TXP_MR_10EX_C Card

    The TXP_MR_10EX_C card is a multirate transponder card. The card is fully backward compatible with TXP_MR_10E_C cards (only when the error decorrelator is disabled in the CTC on the TXP_MR_10EX_C card). It processes one 10-Gbps signal (client side) into one 10-Gbps, 100-GHz DWDM signal (trunk side). The TXP_MR_10EX_C card is tunable over the 82 channels of C-band (82 channels spaced at 50 GHz on the ITU grid).

    You can install TXP_MR_10EX_C card in , Slot 2 in Cisco NCS 2002 chassis, Slots 2 to 6 in Cisco NCS 2006. The card can be provisioned in linear, BLSR/MS-SPRing, path protection/SNCP configurations or as a regenerator. The card can be used in the middle of BLSR/MS-SPRing or 1+1 spans when the card is configured for transparent termination mode. The TXP_MR_10EX_C card features an MLSE-based Universal Transponder 1550-nm tunable laser and a separately orderable ONS-XC-10G-S1 1310-nm or ONS-XC-10G-L2 1550-nm laser XFP module for the client port.


    Note


    The PRE FEC BER performance of the TXP_MR_10EX_C card may be significantly low when compared to the TXP_MR_10E card. However, this does not affect the Post FEC BER performance, but could possibly affect any specific monitoring application that relies on the PRE FEC BER value (for example, protection switching). In this case, the replacement of TXP_MR_10E card with the TXP_MR_10EX_C may not work properly.


    Key Features

    The key features of the TXP_MR_10EX_C card are:

    • A multi-rate client interface (available through the ONS-XC-10G-S1 XFP, ordered separately):

      • OC-192 (SR1)

      • 10GE (10GBASE-LR)

      • 10G-FC (1200-SM-LL-L)

      • (ONS-XC-10G-S1 version 3 only) IB_5G

    • An MLSE-based UT module tunable through 82 channels of C-band. The channels are spaced at 50 GHz on the ITU grid.

    • OC-192 to ITU-T G.709 OTU2 provisionable synchronous and asynchronous mapping.

    • Proprietary rate at the trunk when the client is provisioned as IB_5G.

    • The MTU setting is used to display the OverSizePkts counters on the receiving trunk and client port interfaces. Traffic of frame sizes up to 65535 bytes pass without any packet drops, from the client port to the trunk port and vice versa irrespective of the MTU setting.

    For information about safety labels for the card, see the "Class 1M Laser Product Cards" section.


    Caution


    You must use a 15-dB fiber attenuator (10 to 20 dB) when working with the TXP_MR_10EX_C card in a loopback on the trunk port. Do not use direct fiber loopbacks with this card, because they can cause irreparable damage to the card.


    For more information about the TXP_MR_10EX_C card, see http:/​/​www.cisco.com/​en/​US/​prod/​collateral/​optical/​ps5724/​ps2006/​data_​sheet_​c78-580763.html

    Related Procedures for TXP_MR_10EX_C Card

    The following is the list of procedures and tasks related to the configuration of the TXP_MR_10EX_C card:

    MXP_2.5G_10EX_C card

    The MXP_2.5G_10EX_C card is a DWDM muxponder supports transparent termination mode on the client side. The faceplate designation of the card is “4x2.5G 10EX MXP.” The card multiplexes four 2.5-Gbps client signals (4xOC48/STM-16 SFP) into a single 10-Gbps DWDM optical signal on the trunk side. The card provides wavelength transmission service for the four incoming 2.5-Gbps client interfaces. The MXP_2.5G_10EX_C muxponder passes all SONET/SDH overhead bytes transparently.

    The digital wrapper function (ITU-T G.709 compliant) formats the DWDM wavelength so that it can be used to set up GCCs for data communications, enable FEC, or facilitate PM.

    The MXP_2.5G_10EX_C card works with OTN devices defined in ITU-T G.709. The card supports ODU1 to OTU2 multiplexing, an industry standard method for asynchronously mapping a SONET/SDH payload into a digitally wrapped envelope. See the    "Multiplexing Function” section.

    The MXP_2.5G_10EX_C card is not compatible with the MXP_2.5G_10G card, which does not support transparent termination mode.

    You can install the MXP_2.5G_10EX_C card in , Slot 2 in Cisco NCS 2002 chassis, Slots 2 to 6 in Cisco NCS 2006. You can provision a card in a linear configuration, a BLSR/MS-SPRing, a path protection/SNCP, or a regenerator. The card can be used in the middle of BLSR/MS-SPRing or 1+1 spans when the card is configured for transparent termination mode.

    The MXP_2.5G_10EX_C card features a tunable 1550-nm C-band laser on the trunk port. The laser is tunable across 82 wavelengths on the ITU grid with 50-GHz spacing between wavelengths. The card features four 1310-nm lasers on the client ports and contains five transmit and receive connector pairs (labeled) on the card faceplate. The card uses dual LC connectors on the trunk side and SFP modules on the client side for optical cable termination. The SFP pluggable modules are SR or IR and support an LC fiber connector.


    Note


    When you create a 4xOC-48 OCHCC circuit, you need to select the G.709 and Synchronous options. A 4xOC-48 OCHCC circuit is supported by G.709 and synchronous mode, which are necessary to provision the 4xOC-48 OCHCC circuit.


    Key Features

    The MXP_2.5G_10EX_C card has the following high-level features:

    • Four 2.5-Gbps client interfaces (OC-48/STM-16) and one 10-Gbps trunk. The four OC-48 signals are mapped into an ITU-T G.709 OTU2 signal using standard ITU-T G.709 multiplexing.

    • Onboard E-FEC processor: The processor supports both standard RS (specified in ITU-T G.709) and E-FEC, which allows an improved gain on trunk interfaces with a resultant extension of the transmission range on these interfaces. The E-FEC functionality increases the correction capability of the transponder to improve performance, allowing operation at a lower OSNR compared to the standard RS (237,255) correction algorithm.

    • Pluggable client-interface optic modules: The MXP_2.5G_10EX_C card has modular interfaces. Two types of optic modules can be plugged into the card. These modules include an OC-48/STM-16 SR-1 interface with a 7-km (4.3-mile) nominal range (for short range and intra-office applications) and an IR-1 interface with a range of up to 40 km (24.9 miles). SR-1 is defined in Telcordia GR-253-CORE and in I-16 (ITU-T G.957). IR-1 is defined in Telcordia GR-253-CORE and in S-16-1 (ITU-T G.957).

    • High-level provisioning support: The card is initially provisioned using Cisco TransportPlanner software. Subsequently, the card can be monitored and provisioned using CTC software.

    • Link monitoring and management: The card uses standard OC-48 OH (overhead) bytes to monitor and manage incoming interfaces. The card passes the incoming SDH/SONET data stream and its overhead bytes transparently.

    • Control of layered SONET/SDH transport overhead: The card is provisionable to terminate regenerator section overhead, which eliminates forwarding of unneeded layer overhead. It can help reduce the number of alarms and help isolate faults in the network.

    • Automatic timing source synchronization: The MXP_2.5G_10EX_C card normally synchronizes from the control card. If for some reason, such as maintenance or upgrade activity, the control card is not available, the card automatically synchronize to one of the input client-interface clocks.

    • Configurable squelching policy: The card can be configured to squelch the client interface output if LOS occurs at the DWDM receiver or if a remote fault occurs. In the event of a remote fault, the card manages MS-AIS insertion.

    • The card is tunable across the full C-band, thus eliminating the need to use different versions of each card to provide tunability across specific wavelengths in a band.

    Faceplate and Block Diagram

    Figure 9. MXP_2.5G_10EX_C Faceplate and Block Diagram



    For information about safety labels for the card, see the "Class 1 Laser Product Cards" section.

    MXP_2.5G_10EX_C Functions

    The following functions of the MXP_2.5G_10EX_C card are explained in the "Card Features" chapter:
    •  Client Interface

    • DWDM Interface

    • FEC

    • Multiplexing Function

    • Timing Synchronization

    • SONET/SDH Overhead Byte Processing

    • Client Interface Monitoring

    • Automatic Laser Shutdown

    • Jitter

    • Lamp Test

    • Onboard Traffic Generation

    • Card level indicators

    • Port level indicators

    Wavelength Identification

    The card uses trunk lasers that are wavelocked, which allows the trunk transmitter to operate on the ITU grid effectively. The MXP_2.5G_10EX_C card implements the MLSE-based UT module. The MXP_2.5G_10EX_C card uses a C-band version of the UT2.

    The MXP_2.5G_10EX_C card is tunable over 82 wavelengths in the C-band at 50-GHz spacing on the ITU grid.

    Table 34 MXP_2.5G_10EX_C Trunk Wavelengths

    Channel Number

    Frequency (THz)

    Wavelength (nm)

    Channel Number

    Frequency (THz)

    Wavelength (nm)

    1

    196.00

    1529.55

    42

    193.95

    1545.72

    2

    195.95

    1529.94

    43

    193.90

    1546.119

    3

    195.90

    1530.334

    44

    193.85

    1546.518

    4

    195.85

    1530.725

    45

    193.80

    1546.917

    5

    195.80

    1531.116

    46

    193.75

    1547.316

    6

    195.75

    1531.507

    47

    193.70

    1547.715

    7

    195.70

    1531.898

    48

    193.65

    1548.115

    8

    195.65

    1532.290

    49

    193.60

    1548.515

    9

    195.60

    1532.681

    50

    193.55

    1548.915

    10

    195.55

    1533.073

    51

    193.50

    1549.32

    11

    195.50

    1533.47

    52

    193.45

    1549.71

    12

    195.45

    1533.86

    53

    193.40

    1550.116

    13

    195.40

    1534.250

    54

    193.35

    1550.517

    14

    195.35

    1534.643

    55

    193.30

    1550.918

    15

    195.30

    1535.036

    56

    193.25

    1551.319

    16

    195.25

    1535.429

    57

    193.20

    1551.721

    17

    195.20

    1535.822

    58

    193.15

    1552.122

    18

    195.15

    1536.216

    59

    193.10

    1552.524

    19

    195.10

    1536.609

    60

    193.05

    1552.926

    20

    195.05

    1537.003

    61

    193.00

    1553.33

    21

    195.00

    1537.40

    62

    192.95

    1553.73

    22

    194.95

    1537.79

    63

    192.90

    1554.134

    23

    194.90

    1538.186

    64

    192.85

    1554.537

    24

    194.85

    1538.581

    65

    192.80

    1554.940

    25

    194.80

    1538.976

    66

    192.75

    1555.343

    26

    194.75

    1539.371

    67

    192.70

    1555.747

    27

    194.70

    1539.766

    68

    192.65

    1556.151

    28

    194.65

    1540.162

    69

    192.60

    1556.555

    29

    194.60

    1540.557

    70

    192.55

    1556.959

    30

    194.55

    1540.953

    71

    192.50

    1557.36

    31

    194.50

    1541.35

    72

    192.45

    1557.77

    32

    194.45

    1541.75

    73

    192.40

    1558.173

    33

    194.40

    1542.142

    74

    192.35

    1558.578

    34

    194.35

    1542.539

    75

    192.30

    1558.983

    35

    194.30

    1542.936

    76

    192.25

    1559.389

    36

    194.25

    1543.333

    77

    192.20

    1559.794

    37

    194.20

    1543.730

    78

    192.15

    1560.200

    38

    194.15

    1544.128

    79

    192.10

    1560.606

    39

    194.10

    1544.526

    80

    192.05

    1561.013

    40

    194.05

    1544.924

    81

    192.00

    1561.42

    41

    194.00

    1545.32

    82

    191.95

    1561.83

    Related Procedures for MXP_2.5G_10EX_C Card

    The following is the list of procedures and tasks related to the configuration of the MXP_2.5G_10EX_C card:

    MXP_MR_10DMEX_C Card

    The MXP_MR_10DMEX_C card aggregates a mix of client SAN service-client inputs (GE, FICON, and Fibre Channel) into one 10-Gbps STM-64/OC-192 DWDM signal on the trunk side. It provides one long-reach STM-64/OC-192 port per card and is compliant with Telcordia GR-253-CORE and ITU-T G.957.

    The card supports aggregation of the following signal types:

    • 1-Gigabit Fibre Channel

    • 2-Gigabit Fibre Channel

    • 4-Gigabit Fibre Channel

    • 1-Gigabit Ethernet

    • 1-Gigabit ISC-Compatible (ISC-1)

    • 2-Gigabit ISC-Peer (ISC-3)


      Caution


      The card can be damaged by dropping it. Handle it carefully.


    The MXP_MR_10DMEX_C muxponder passes all SONET/SDH overhead bytes transparently.

    The digital wrapper function (ITU-T G.709 compliant) formats the DWDM wavelength so that it can be used to set up GCCs for data communications, enable FEC, or facilitate PM. The MXP_MR_10DMEX_C card works with the OTN devices defined in ITU-T G.709. The card supports ODU1 to OTU2 multiplexing, an industry standard method for asynchronously mapping a SONET/SDH payload into a digitally wrapped envelope. See the    "Multiplexing Function” section.


    Note


    You cannot disable ITU-T G.709 on the trunk side. If ITU-T G.709 is enabled, then FEC cannot be disabled.



    Note


    Because the client payload cannot oversubscribe the trunk, a mix of client signals can be accepted, up to a maximum limit of 10 Gbps.


    You can install the MXP_MR_10DMEX_C card in , Slot 2 in Cisco NCS 2002 chassis, Slots 2 to 6 in Cisco NCS 2006.


    Note


    The MXP_MR_10DMEX_C card is not compatible with the MXP_2.5G_10G card, which does not support transparent termination mode.


    The MXP_MR_10DMEX_C card features a tunable 1550-nm C-band laser on the trunk port. The laser is tunable across 82 wavelengths on the ITU grid with 50-GHz spacing between wavelengths. Each card features four 1310-nm lasers on the client ports and contains five transmit and receive connector pairs (labeled) on the card faceplate. The card uses dual LC connectors on the trunk side and SFP modules on the client side for optical cable termination. The SFP pluggable modules are SR or IR and support an LC fiber connector.

    The current version of the GFP-T G.7041 supports transparent mapping of 8B/10B block-coded protocols, including Gigabit Ethernet, Fibre Channel, ISC, and FICON.

    In addition to the GFP mapping, 1-Gbps traffic on Port 1 or 2 of the high-speed SERDES is mapped to an STS-24c channel. If two 1-Gbps client signals are present at Port 1 and Port 2 of the high-speed SERDES, the Port 1 signal is mapped into the first STS-24c channel and the Port 2 signal into the second STS-24c channel. The two channels are then mapped into an OC-48 trunk channel.

    Table 35 MXP_MR_10DMEX_C Client Interface Data Rates and Encapsulation

    Client Interface

    Input Data Rate

    GFP-T G.7041 Encapsulation

    2G FC

    2.125 Gbps

    Yes

    1G FC

    1.06 Gbps

    Yes

    2G FICON/2G ISC-Compatible (ISC-1)/ 2G ISC-Peer (ISC-3)

    2.125 Gbps

    Yes

    1G FICON/1G ISC-Compatible (ISC-1)/ 1G ISC-Peer (ISC-3)

    1.06 Gbps

    Yes

    Gigabit Ethernet

    1.25 Gbps

    Yes

    The MXP_MR_10DMEX_C card includes two FPGAs, and a group of four ports is mapped to each FPGA. Group 1 consists of Ports 1 through 4, and Group 2 consists of Ports 5 through 8. The following table shows some of the mix and match possibilities on the various client data rates for Ports 1 through 4, and Ports 5 through 8. An X indicates that the data rate is supported in that port.

    Table 36 Supported Client Data Rates for Ports 1 through 4 and Ports 5 through 8

    Port (Group 1)

    Port (Group 2)

    Gigabit Ethernet

    1G FC

    2G FC

    4G FC

    1

    5

    X

    X

    X

    X

    2

    6

    X

    X

    3

    7

    X

    X

    X

    4

    8

    X

    X

    GFP-T PM is available through RMON and trunk PM is managed according to Telcordia GR-253-CORE and ITU G.783/826. Client PM is achieved through RMON for FC and GE.

    A buffer-to-buffer credit management scheme provides FC flow control. With this feature enabled, a port indicates the number of frames that can be sent to it (its buffer credit), before the sender is required to stop transmitting and wait for the receipt of a “ready” indication. The MXP_MR_10DMEX_C card supports FC credit-based flow control with a buffer-to-buffer credit extension of up to 1600 km (994.1 miles) for 1G FC, up to 800 km (497.1 miles) for 2G FC, or up to 400 km (248.5 miles) for 4G FC. The feature can be enabled or disabled.

    The MXP_MR_10DMEX_C card features a 1550-nm laser for the trunk/line port and a 1310-nm or 850-nm laser (depending on the SFP) for the client ports. The card contains eight 12.5-degree downward-tilt SFP modules for the client interfaces. For optical termination, each SFP uses two LC connectors, which are labeled TX and RX on the faceplate. The trunk port is a dual-LC connector with a 45-degree downward angle.

    Key Features

    The MXP_MR_10DMEX_C card has the following high-level features:

    • Onboard E-FEC processor: The processor supports both standard RS (specified in ITU-T G.709) and E-FEC, which allows an improved gain on trunk interfaces with a resultant extension of the transmission range on these interfaces. The E-FEC functionality increases the correction capability of the transponder to improve performance, allowing operation at a lower OSNR compared to the standard RS (237,255) correction algorithm.

    • Pluggable client-interface optic modules: The MXP_MR_10DMEX_C card has modular interfaces. Two types of optics modules can be plugged into the card. These modules include an OC-48/STM-16 SR-1 interface with a 7-km (4.3-mile) nominal range (for short range and intra-office applications) and an IR-1 interface with a range of up to 40 km (24.9 miles). SR-1 is defined in Telcordia GR-253-CORE and in I-16 (ITU-T G.957). IR-1 is defined in Telcordia GR-253-CORE and in S-16-1 (ITU-T G.957).

    • Y-cable protection: The card supports Y-cable protection between the same card type only, on ports with the same port number and signal rate. See the "Y-Cable Protection Availability on TXP, MXP, and Xponder Cards" section for more detailed information.

    • High-level provisioning support: The card is initially provisioned using Cisco TransportPlanner software. Subsequently, the card can be monitored and provisioned using CTC software.

    • ALS: This safety mechanism is used in the event of a fiber cut. For details regarding ALS provisioning for the MXP_MR_10DMEX_C card, see the “NTP-G162 Change the ALS Maintenance Settings” section.

    • Link monitoring and management: The card uses standard OC-48 OH (overhead) bytes to monitor and manage incoming interfaces. The card passes the incoming SDH/SONET data stream and its OH (overhead) bytes transparently.

    • Control of layered SONET/SDH transport overhead: The card is provisionable to terminate regenerator section overhead, which eliminates forwarding of unneeded layer overhead. It can help reduce the number of alarms and help isolate faults in the network.

    • Automatic timing source synchronization: The MXP_MR_10DMEX_C card normally synchronizes from the control card. If for some reason, such as maintenance or upgrade activity, the control card is not available, the card automatically synchronizes to one of the input client-interface clocks.


      Note


      MXP_MR_10DMEX_C card cannot be used for line timing.


    • Configurable squelching policy: The card can be configured to squelch the client-interface output if LOS occurs at the DWDM receiver or if a remote fault occurs. In the event of a remote fault, the card manages MS-AIS insertion.

    • The card is tunable across the full C-band, thus eliminating the need to use different versions of each card to provide tunability across specific wavelengths in a band.

    • You can provision a string (port name) for each fiber channel/FICON interface on the MXP_MR_10DMEX_C card, which allows the MDS Fabric Manager to create a link association between that SAN port and a SAN port on a Cisco MDS 9000 switch.

    Faceplate and Block Diagram

    Figure 10. MXP_MR_10DMEX_C Faceplate and Block Diagram



    For information about safety labels for the card, see the "Class 1M Laser Product Cards" section.


    Caution


    You must use a 20-dB fiber attenuator (15 to 25 dB) when working with the card in a loopback on the trunk port. Do not use direct fiber loopbacks with the card, because they can cause irreparable damage to the MXP_MR_10DMEX_C card.


    MXP_MR_10DMEX_C Functions

    The following functions of the MXP_MR_10DMEX_C card are explained in the "Card Features" chapter:

    • Card level indicators

    • Port level indicators

    Wavelength Identification

    The card uses trunk lasers that are wavelocked, which allows the trunk transmitter to operate on the ITU grid effectively. The MXP_MR_10DMEX_C card uses a C-band version of the MLSE-based UT module.

    The MXP_MR_10DMEX_C card is tunable over 82 wavelengths in the C-band at 50-GHz spacing on the ITU grid.

    Table 37 MXP_MR_10DMEX_C Trunk Wavelengths

    Channel Number

    Frequency (THz)

    Wavelength (nm)

    Channel Number

    Frequency (THz)

    Wavelength (nm)

    1

    196.00

    1529.55

    42

    193.95

    1545.72

    2

    195.95

    1529.94

    43

    193.90

    1546.119

    3

    195.90

    1530.334

    44

    193.85

    1546.518

    4

    195.85

    1530.725

    45

    193.80

    1546.917

    5

    195.80

    1531.116

    46

    193.75

    1547.316

    6

    195.75

    1531.507

    47

    193.70

    1547.715

    7

    195.70

    1531.898

    48

    193.65

    1548.115

    8

    195.65

    1532.290

    49

    193.60

    1548.515

    9

    195.60

    1532.681

    50

    193.55

    1548.915

    10

    195.55

    1533.073

    51

    193.50

    1549.32

    11

    195.50

    1533.47

    52

    193.45

    1549.71

    12

    195.45

    1533.86

    53

    193.40

    1550.116

    13

    195.40

    1534.250

    54

    193.35

    1550.517

    14

    195.35

    1534.643

    55

    193.30

    1550.918

    15

    195.30

    1535.036

    56

    193.25

    1551.319

    16

    195.25

    1535.429

    57

    193.20

    1551.721

    17

    195.20

    1535.822

    58

    193.15

    1552.122

    18

    195.15

    1536.216

    59

    193.10

    1552.524

    19

    195.10

    1536.609

    60

    193.05

    1552.926

    20

    195.05

    1537.003

    61

    193.00

    1553.33

    21

    195.00

    1537.40

    62

    192.95

    1553.73

    22

    194.95

    1537.79

    63

    192.90

    1554.134

    23

    194.90

    1538.186

    64

    192.85

    1554.537

    24

    194.85

    1538.581

    65

    192.80

    1554.940

    25

    194.80

    1538.976

    66

    192.75

    1555.343

    26

    194.75

    1539.371

    67

    192.70

    1555.747

    27

    194.70

    1539.766

    68

    192.65

    1556.151

    28

    194.65

    1540.162

    69

    192.60

    1556.555

    29

    194.60

    1540.557

    70

    192.55

    1556.959

    30

    194.55

    1540.953

    71

    192.50

    1557.36

    31

    194.50

    1541.35

    72

    192.45

    1557.77

    32

    194.45

    1541.75

    73

    192.40

    1558.173

    33

    194.40

    1542.142

    74

    192.35

    1558.578

    34

    194.35

    1542.539

    75

    192.30

    1558.983

    35

    194.30

    1542.936

    76

    192.25

    1559.389

    36

    194.25

    1543.333

    77

    192.20

    1559.794

    37

    194.20

    1543.730

    78

    192.15

    1560.200

    38

    194.15

    1544.128

    79

    192.10

    1560.606

    39

    194.10

    1544.526

    80

    192.05

    1561.013

    40

    194.05

    1544.924

    81

    192.00

    1561.42

    41

    194.00

    1545.32

    82

    191.95

    1561.83

    Related Procedures for MXP_MR_10DMEX_C Card

    The following is the list of procedures and tasks related to the configuration of the MXP_MR_10DMEX_C card:

    AR_MXP, AR_XP, and AR_XPE Cards

    The AR_MXP (Any-Rate Muxponder), AR_XP (Any-Rate Xponder), and AR_XPE (Any-Rate Enhanced Xponder) cards are supported on Cisco NCS 2000 Series platform. The AR_MXP card supports a trunk bandwidth of up to 10 Gbps. The AR_XP and AR_XPE cards support a trunk bandwidth of up to 20 Gbps. The AR_MXP, AR_XP, and AR_XPE cards aggregate a mix of client SAN services (FC or FICON 1G/2G/4G/8G, ESCON and ISC3-STP 1G/2G), Ethernet (FE, GE, 10GE LAN), OCn (OC3/STM-1, OC12/STM-4, and OC48/STM-16), OTU (OTU1, OTU2e/1e), and Video (SD-SDI, HD-SDI, and 3G-SDI) into one 10 Gbps signal on the trunk side.

    Table 38 AR_MXP, AR_XP, and AR_XPE Client Interface Data Rates and Encapsulation

    Client Interface

    Input Data Rate

    GFP Encapsulation

    OC3/ STM1

    155.52 Mbps

    OC12/STM4

    622.08 Mbps

    OC48/STM16

    2.488 Gbps

    FE

    100 Mbps

    GFP-F

    GE

    1.125 Gbps

    GFP-F
GFP-T (as per G.709 mentioned in 17.7.1.1 1000BASE-X transcoding) for AR_XPE card

    10GE LAN

    10.31 Gbps

    1GFC

    1.06 Gbps

    GFP-T

    2GFC

    2.125 Gbps

    GFP-T

    4GFC

    4.25 Gbps

    GFP-T

    8GFC

    8.5 Gbps

    GFP-T for AR_MXP and AR_XP cards
GMP for AR_XPE card

    OTU1

    2.66 Gbps

    OTU2

    10.7 Gbps

    ESCON

    200 Mbps

    GFP-T

    1G ISC3-STP

    1.06 Gbps

    GFP-T

    2G ISC3-STP

    2.125 Gbps

    GFP-T

    HD-SDI

    1.485 Gbps

    GFP-F

    SD-SDI

    270 Mbps

    GFP-F

    3G-SDI

    2.970 Gbps

    GFP-F

    Key Features

    The AR_MXP, AR_XP, and AR_XPE cards support the following key features:

    • Multiple Operating Modes—The AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card can be configured into multiple operating modes. The cards are equipped with pluggables for client and trunk options, and offer a large variety of configurations. For more information about multiple operating modes, see 11.0.3  Multiple Operating Modes, page 11-105.

    • Operating Mode to Client Payload Mapping—Each operating mode supports a specific set of client payloads.

    Table 39 AR_MXP, AR_XP, and AR_XPE Card Supported Client-Payload Mapping—SONET/SDH, Ethernet, OTU1, and FC

    Card Mode

    Rate

    SONET/SDH

    Ethernet

    OTU

    FC

    OC3/STM1

    OC12/STM4

    OC48/STM16

    FE

    GE

    10 GE

    OTU1

    OTU2e

    FICON1G/FC1G

    FICON2G/FC2G

    FICON4G/FC4G

    FICON8G/FC8G

    ESCON

    TXP_MR

    LOW

    Yes

    Yes

    Yes

    Yes

    Yes

    N/A

    No

    No

    Yes

    Yes

    Yes

    No

    Yes

    HIGH

    No

    No

    No

    No

    No

    Yes

    No

    Yes

    No

    No

    No

    Yes

    No

    TXPP_MR

    LOW

    Yes

    Yes

    Yes

    Yes

    Yes

    N/A

    No

    No

    Yes

    Yes

    Yes

    No

    Yes

    HIGH

    N/A

    N/A

    N/A

    N/A

    N/A

    N/A

    N/A

    N/A

    N/A

    N/A

    N/A

    N/A

    N/A

    MXP_DME

    HIGH

    No

    No

    No

    No

    Yes

    N/A

    No

    No

    Yes

    Yes

    Yes

    No

    No

    MXPP_DME

    HIGH

    No

    No

    No

    No

    Yes

    N/A

    No

    No

    Yes

    Yes

    Yes

    No

    No

    MXP_MR

    LOW

    Yes

    Yes

    No

    Yes

    Yes

    N/A

    No

    No

    Yes

    No

    No

    No

    Yes

    HIGH

    Yes

    Yes

    Yes

    Yes

    Yes

    N/A

    Yes

    No

    Yes

    Yes

    Yes

    No

    Yes

    MXPP_MR

    LOW

    Yes

    Yes

    No

    Yes

    Yes

    N/A

    No

    No

    Yes

    No

    No

    No

    Yes

    HIGH

    Yes

    Yes

    Yes

    Yes

    Yes

    N/A

    Yes

    No

    Yes

    Yes

    Yes

    No

    Yes

    MXP-4x2.5-10G

    HIGH

    No

    No

    Yes

    No

    No

    N/A

    Yes

    No

    No

    No

    No

    No

    No

    MXPP-4x2.5-10G

    HIGH

    No

    No

    Yes

    No

    No

    N/A

    Yes

    No

    No

    No

    No

    No

    No

    MXP-VD-10G

    HIGH

    No

    No

    No

    No

    No

    N/A

    No

    No

    No

    No

    No

    No

    No

    RGN

    HIGH

    No

    No

    No

    No

    No

    N/A

    No

    Yes

    No

    No

    No

    No

    No

    LOW

    No

    No

    No

    No

    No

    N/A

    Yes

    No

    No

    No

    No

    No

    No

    Table 40 AR_MXP, AR_XP, and AR_XPE Card Supported Client-Payload Mapping—ISC and Video
       

    ISC

    Video

    Card Mode

    Rate

    ISC-1

    ISC3_STP_1G

    ISC3_STP_2G

    SD-SDI

    HD-SDI

    3G-SDI

    TXP_MR

    LOW

    No

    Yes

    Yes

    No

    No

    No

    HIGH

    No

    No

    No

    No

    No

    No

    TXPP_MR

    LOW

    No

    No

    N/A

    No

    No

    No

    HIGH

    N/A

    N/A

    N/A

    N/A

    N/A

    N/A

    MXP_DME

    HIGH

    No

    No

    No

    No

    No

    No

    MXPP_DME

    HIGH

    No

    No

    No

    No

    No

    No

    MXP_MR

    LOW

    No

    No

    No

    No

    No

    No

    HIGH

    No

    No

    No

    Yes

    Yes

    No

    MXPP_MR

    LOW

    No

    No

    No

    No

    No

    No

    HIGH

    No

    No

    No

    Yes

    Yes

    No

    MXP-4x2.5-10G

    HIGH

    No

    No

    No

    No

    No

    No

    MXPP-4x2.5-10G

    HIGH

    No

    No

    No

    No

    No

    No

    MXP-VD-10G

    HIGH

    No

    No

    No

    No

    No

    Yes

    RGN

    HIGH

    No

    No

    No

    No

    No

    No

    LOW

    No

    No

    No

    No

    No

    No

    • Auto Sensing—The AR_MXP, AR_XP, and AR_XPE cards support auto sensing of client payloads. The line card analyzes the received client signal and configures the payload on the client port automatically without user intervention.

      Auto sensing feature is supported on the Gigabit Ethernet, OC-3/STM-1, OC-12/STM-4, and OC-48/STM-16 payloads. Following operating card modes support the autosensing feature:

      • TXP (low rate)

      • TXPP (low rate)

      • MXP_MR (low and high Rate)

      • MXPP_MR (low and high rate)

        CTC supports the configuration of all the provisioning parameters supported by the autosensed payload. However, creation and deletion of the

        circuits are the only configurations supported on the “AUTO” payload.

    • Video Multiplexing—The AR_XP and AR_XPE cards support the capability to multiplex SD-SDI, HD-SDI, and 3G-SDI signals over the OTU2 trunk interface allowing to maximize the wavelength bandwidth, maintain full transparency for uncompressed signals, and reduce latency. The video multiplexing of 3G-SDI signal is not supported on the AR_MXP card.

    • Regenerator Mode—This mode regenerates the OTU2e or OTU1 signals with ODU transparent or CISCO Extended Use options. For OTU2e, FEC can be Disabled, Standard G.975, EFEC I.4 or EFEC I.7, and for OTU1, FEC can be Standard G.975 or Disabled.

    • High Speed GCCs—The AR_MXP, AR_XP, and AR_XPE cards support the provisioning of GCC channel on OTN (OTU1/OTU2) enabled client and trunk ports. A maximum of ten GCC channels on Cisco NCS 2002 or Cisco NCS 2006 shelf can be created. The high speed GCC enables you to create the GCC when both the NE and FE line cards are in Cisco NCS 2002 or Cisco NCS 2006 shelf.

    • Y-cable protection—Y-cable protection between the same card type is supported only on ports with the same port number and signal rate. Switching time is high between two AR_XPE cards when auto negotiation is enabled. Hence, if Y-cable protection is configured on AR_XPE cards, auto-negotiation must be disabled on the client ports so that the switching time is less than 50 ms. For more detailed information, see "Y-Cable Protection Availability on TXP, MXP, and Xponder Cards" section.

    • Splitter protection—For splitter protection, OCHCC circuits with different trunk wavelengths for the working and protect paths can be configured. The process of setting the trunk wavelengths is similar to the “DLP-G367 Change the 2.5G Multirate Transponder Trunk Wavelength Settings” task on page 11-175. OCHCC circuits having different trunk wavelengths on the working and protect paths can be upgraded to GMPLS circuits.

    • SyncE Support—Customers using a packet network find it difficult to provide timing to multiple remote network elements (NEs) through an external time division multiplexed (TDM) circuit. The SyncE feature helps to overcome this problem by providing effective timing to the remote NEs through a packet network. SyncE leverages the physical layer of the Ethernet to transmit frequency to the remote sites. SyncE's functionality and accuracy resemble the SONET/SDH network because of its physical layer characteristic. 
The SyncE feature provides the required synchronization at the physical level. Operation messages maintain SyncE links and ensure that a node always derives timing from the most reliable source. SyncE uses the Ethernet Synchronization Message Channel (ESMC) to enable traceability of the best clock source to correctly define the timing source and prevent a timing loop. SyncE is not supported on the AR_XPE card.

    • Licensing—The AR_MXP and AR_XP cards offer you an unprecedented flexibility. The cards support a wide range of different applications and configurations. To help you take advantage of such flexibility to lower capital expenditures (CapEx) on your network, Cisco provides a licensing model for AR_MXP and AR_XP cards. Licensing is not supported on the AR_XPE card. For more information on licensing, see the Cisco NCS 2000 Series Licensing Configuration Guide.

    The AR_MXP, AR_XP, and AR_XPE cards can be installed in any service slots in the chassis. The AR_MXP, AR_XP, and AR_XPE cards do not interoperate with all the existing TXP or MXP cards. The AR_MXP card allows you to configure only one high rate XFP port. This can be a muxponder mode where N [N= 1 to 8] client ports goes out via 1 trunk XFP port or in a transponder mode where client and trunk are XFP ports. There is no limitation in the AR_XP and AR_XPE cards, where you can use both high rate trunk ports simultaneously.

    The AR_XPE card does not interoperate with AR_MXP and AR_XP cards.

    The GE client interfaces on the AR-XPE card interoperate with NCS 4000 platform, when ODU2 is multiplexed on a 100G trunk interface, with both 100GS-CK-LC and 200G-CK-LC cards, in MXP-10X10G operating mode. The GE client mapping on AR-XPE cards must be performed directly on ODU0, and then on ODU2 not passing through the ODU1 container.

    Multiple Operating Modes

    A single AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card can be configured into multiple operating modes. Criteria for selecting a particular operational mode are defined by the network level design. CTP helps you to choose the appropriate operational mode. Each operating mode is divided into two categories based on the trunk rate:

    • Low rate (trunk rate < 5G)

    • High rate (trunk rate > 5G)

    The AR_XP or AR_XPE card allows you to configure two high rate operational modes, where as you can configure only one high rate operational mode on the AR_MXP card.

    When you configure the AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card in to multiple operational modes, make sure that the following tasks are completed:

    • In order to make the ports operational and to correctly report alarms, OCHCC circuit must be created for the following operating modes::

      • Low-rate MXP_MR

      • High-rate MXP_MR

      • Low-rate MXPP_MR

      • High-rate MXPP_MR

    • Same operational mode is configured at both ends and ensure the port numbers are same on both ends.

    • The OCHCC circuit should be created between the same client port numbers at the near and far end.

    • Ensure ODU1 and timeslots are matching at both ends.

    • For AR_XPE card that is configured with 1GE or 1GFC payload, ensure that ODU0 and ODU1 are matching at both ends.

    • For auto sensing payloads created on auto ports, you should check the Auto Sensing checkbox in the provisioning pane.

    • GMPLS circuits can be created on AR_MXP, AR_XP, and AR_XPE cards.

    • PPMs must be provisioned on all ports before configuring the operational mode.

    • The following conditions determine the maximum bandwidth at the client side when a 4GFC payload is configured in the TXP_MR or TXPP_MR mode:

      • The maximum client bandwidth should not exceed 28G when TXP_MR or TXPP_MR operating mode is configured on the AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card and other operating modes, like low-rate or high-rate TXP_MR,TXPP_MR, MXP_DME, MXPP_DME, MXP_MR, MXPP_MR, MXP-4X2.5G-10G, MXPP-4X2.5G-10G, and MXP-VDC-10G, are configured on the same card.

      • The maximum client bandwidth should not exceed 20G when a TXP_MR or TXPP_MR operating mode is configured on the AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card and if more than two or more combinations of Low-rate or high-rate TXP_MR,TXPP_MR, MXP_DME, MXPP_DME, MXP_MR, MXPP_MR, MXP-4X2.5G-10G, MXPP-4X2.5G-10G, and MXP-VDC-10G, operating modes are configured on the same card.

      • The utilized client bandwidth is 8G when the TXP_MR operating mode is configured with a 4GFC as payload.

      • The utilized client bandwidth is 12G when the TXPP_MR operating mode is configured with a 4GFC as payload.

      • There is no restriction on the bandwidth if only TXP_MR or TXPP_MR operating mode with 4GFC payload is configured on the card. For example, four instances of TXP_MR mode with 4GFC payload on one AR_MPX, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card.

      • The low-rate or high-rate RGN operating mode does not add to the client side bandwidth. For example, four instances of TXP_MR mode with 4GFC and one instance of high-rate RGN mode on same card.

        For all the other payloads and operating modes, the client bandwidth utilized is the client payload data rate.

    • If you revert to a release earlier than Release 9.80, ensure that you delete the following card modes:

      • Low-rate TXPP_MR if the client payload is 4GFC.

      • High-rate TXP_MR if the client payload is 10 GE.

    The AR_MXP, AR_XP, and AR_XPE cards support the following operating modes:

    TXP_MR (Unprotected Transponder)

    The AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card can be configured as a low-rate or a high-rate TXP_MR card mode.


    Note


    OTN cannot be enabled for 4GFC trunk ports.


    • Low Rate—A maximum of four TXP_MR configurations can be provisioned on a single AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card. The AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card can be configured as a low-rate TXP_MR card by adhering to the following provisioning rules:
      1. Two SFP ports must be grouped. The allowed port pairs are 1-2, 3-4, 5-6, 7-8, 1-5, 2-6, 3-7, and/or 4-8.

      2. Ports 2, 4, 5, 6, 7, or 8 can be configured as trunk ports.

      3. Ports 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 or 7 can be configured as client ports.


      Note


      The trunk port is not created when the low-rate TXP_MR card operating mode is configured. It is created after the client payload is created.


      Figure 11. Low-Rate TXP_MR Card Operating Mode Configuration

    • High Rate—Only one TXP_MR configuration can be provisioned on a single AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card. The AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card can be configured as a high-rate TXP_MR card by adhering to the following provisioning rules:

      1. XFP ports 9 and 10 must be grouped.

      2. Port 10 must be configured as a trunk port.

      3. Port 9 must be configured as a client port.

      Figure 12. High-Rate TXP_MR Card Operating Mode Configuration

    TXPP_MR (Protected Transponder)

    The AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card can be configured as a low-rate TXPP_MR card mode. A maximum of two TXPP_MR configurations can be provisioned on a single AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card. The AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card can be configured as a low-rate TXPP_MR card by adhering to the following provisioning rules:

    1. Three SFP ports must be grouped. The allowed port pairs are 1-5-6 or 2-7-8, or both.

    2. Ports 5 and 6, and 7 and 8 must be configured as trunk ports, where 6 and 8 are the protect trunk ports for 5 and 6 respectively.

    3. Ports 1 and 2 must be configured as client ports.

    Splitter protection is automatically created between ports 5-6 and 7-8.

    Figure 13. Low-Rate TXPP_MR Card Operating Mode Configuration

    MXP_DME (Unprotected Data Muxponder)

    The AR_XP or AR_XPE card can be configured as a high-rate 4:1 or 8:1 MXP_DME card mode. The AR_MXP card can be configured as a high rate 8:1 MXP_DME card mode.

    • 4:1 MXP_DME mode—A maximum of two MXP_DME configurations can be provisioned on a single AR_XP or AR_XPE card. The AR_XP or AR_XPE card can be configured as a high-rate 4:1 MXP_DME card by adhering to the following provisioning rules:

      1. Four SFP ports and one XFP port must be grouped. The allowed port pairs are 1-2-3-4-9 or 5-6-7-8-10, or both.

      2. Port 9 or 10 must be configured as a trunk port.

      3. Ports 1, 2, 3, and 4, or 5, 6, 7, and 8 must be configured as client ports.

    • 8:1 MXP_DME mode—Only one MXP_DME configuration can be provisioned on a single AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card. The AR_MXP, AR_XP, AR_XPE card can be configured as a high-rate 8:1 MXP_DME card by adhering to the following provisioning rules:

      1. Eight SFP ports and one XFP port must be grouped. The allowed port pairs are 1-2-3-4-5-6-7-8-9.

      2. Port 9 must be configured as a trunk port.

      3. Ports 1 to 8 must be configured as client ports.

      Figure 14. High-Rate MXP_DME Card Operating Mode Configuration

    MXPP_DME (Protected Data Muxponder)

    The AR_XP or AR_XPE card can be configured as a high-rate 4:2 or 8:2 MXPP_DME card mode.

    • 4:2 MXP_DME mode—Only one MXPP_DME configuration can be provisioned on a single AR_XP or AR_XPE card. The AR_XP or AR_XPE card can be configured as a high-rate 4:2 MXPP_DME card by adhering to the following provisioning rules:

      1. Four SFP ports and two XFP ports must be grouped. The allowed port pairs are 1-2-3-4-9-10 or 5-6-7-8-9-10.

      2. Ports 9 and 10 must be configured as trunk ports.

      3. Ports 1, 2, 3, and 4, or 5, 6, 7, and 8 must be configured as client ports.

    Splitter protection is automatically created between ports 9 and 10. Port 10 will be the protected trunk port for port 9.

    • 8:2 MXPP_DME mode—Only one MXPP_DME configuration can be provisioned on a single AR_XP or AR_XPE card. The AR_XP or AR_XPE card can be configured as a high-rate 8:2 MXPP_DME card by adhering to the following provisioning rules:

      1. Eight SFP ports and two XFP ports must be grouped. The allowed port pairs are 1-2-3-4-5-6-7-8-9-10.

      2. Ports 9 and 10 must be configured as trunk ports.

      3. Ports 1 to 8 must be configured as client ports.

    Splitter protection is automatically created between ports 9 and 10. Port 10 will be the protected trunk port for port 9.

    Figure 15. High-Rate MXPP_DME Card Operating Mode Configuration

    MXP_MR (Unprotected Multirate Muxponder)

    The AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card can be configured as a low-rate or a high-rate MXP_MR card mode.

    • Low Rate—A maximum of two MXP_MR configurations can be provisioned depending on the availability of client ports. The AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card can be configured as a low-rate MXP_MR card by adhering to the following provisioning rules:

      1. N:1 muxponder must be created, where N varies from client ports 2 to 7.

      2. Only ports 5, 6, 7, or 8 can be configured as trunk ports.

      3. Ports 1 to 8 can be configured as client ports, if they are not configured as trunk ports.

    Any client port can be added or deleted, if the trunk bandwidth supports the new payload without impacting the traffic on the existing services. Minimum of two client ports should be part of the operational mode group.

    On the AR_XPE card, 1GE or 1G FC payload cannot be configured with other payloads. When a 1GE or 1GFC payload is configured on a port of MXP_MR (low rate) mode, then only 1GE or 1GFC payload can be configured on the other ports.

    Figure 16. Low-Rate MXP_MR Card Operating Mode Configuration

    • High Rate—A maximum of two MXP_MR configurations can be provisioned on a AR_XP or AR_XPE card and only one such configuration can be provisioned on an AR_MXP card. The AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card can be configured as a high-rate MXP_MR card by adhering to the following provisioning rules:

      1. N:1 muxponder must be created, where N varies from client ports 2 to 8.

      2. Only ports 9 and 10 can be configured as trunk ports.

      3. Ports 1 to 8 can be configured as client ports.

    Any client payload can be added or deleted, if the trunk bandwidth supports the new payload without impacting the traffic on the existing services.

    On the AR_XPE card, when you create a OCHCC circuit using 1GE or 1GFC payload, only ODU0 mapping is supported and timeslot mapping is not supported. When a OCHCC circuit is created on a particular ODU1 timeslot with payloads using timeslot mapping, OCHCC circuits cannot be created on payloads using ODU0 mapping, but can be created on the other ODU1 timeslot. In MXP_MR (high-rate) mode, while creating a OCHCC circuits on the GE or 1GFC client payload, you can select the ODU1 and ODU0 timeslots instead of ODU1 and timeslot selection.

    Figure 17. High-Rate MXP_MR Card Operating Mode Configuration

    MXPP_MR (Protected Multirate Muxponder)

    The AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card can be configured as a low-rate or a high-rate MXPP_MR card mode.

    • Low Rate—A maximum of two MXPP_MR configurations can be provisioned depending on the availability of client ports. Any client payload can be added or deleted, if the trunk bandwidth supports the new payload without impacting the traffic on the existing services.

    The AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card can be configured as a low-rate MXPP_MR card by adhering to the following provisioning rules:

    1. N:2 muxponder must be created, where N varies from client ports 2 to 6.

    2. Only ports 5 and 6 or 7 and 8, or both can be configured as trunk port.

    3. Ports 1 to 8 can be configured as client ports, if ports are not configured as a trunk ports and are not part of another muxponder.

    Splitter protection is automatically created between ports 5 and 6 or 7 and 8.

    On the AR_XPE card, 1GE or 1G FC payload cannot be configured with other payloads. When a 1GE or 1GFC payload is configured on a port of MXPP_MR (low rate) mode, then only 1GE or 1GFC payload can be configured on the other ports.

    Figure 18. Low-Rate MXPP_MR Card Operating Mode Configuration

    • High Rate—A maximum of one MXPP_MR configuration can be provisioned on a AR_XP or AR_XPE card. Any client payload can be added or deleted, if the trunk bandwidth supports the new payload without impacting the traffic on the existing services.

    The AR_XP or AR_XPE card can be configured as a high-rate MXPP_MR card by adhering to the following provisioning rules:

    1. N:2 muxponder must be created, where N varies from client ports 2 to 8.

    2. Only ports 9 and 10 can be configured as trunk ports.

    3. Ports 1 to 8 can be configured as client ports.

    Splitter protection is automatically created between ports 9 and 10. Port 10 will be the protected trunk port for port 9.

    On the AR_XPE card, when you create a OCHCC circuit using 1GE or 1GFC payload, only ODU0 mapping is supported and timeslot mapping is not supported. When a OCHCC circuit is created on a particular ODU1 timeslot with payloads using timeslot mapping, OCHCC circuits cannot be created on payloads using ODU0 mapping, but can be created on the other ODU1 timeslot.

    Figure 19. High-Rate MXPP_MR Card Operating Mode Configuration

    MXP-4x2.5-10G (OC48/OTU1 Unprotected Muxponder)

    The AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card can be configured as a high-rate MXP-4x2.5-10G card mode. Only one MXP-4x2.5-10G configuration can be provisioned on an AR_MXP card and a maximum of two on a AR_XP or AR_XPE card.

    The AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card can be provisioned as MXP-4x2.5-10G card by adhering to the following provisioning rules:

    1. The allowed port pairs are 1-2-3-4-9 or 5-6-7-8-10, or both.

    2. Ports 9 and 10 can be configured as trunk ports.

    3. Ports 1-2-3-4 or 5-6-7-8 can be configured as client ports.

    Figure 20. High-Rate MXP-4x2.5-10G Card Operating Mode Configuration

    MXPP-4x2.5-10G (OC48/OTU1 Protected Muxponder)

    The AR_XP or AR_XPE card can be configured as a high-rate MXPP-4x2.5-10G card mode. Only one MXPP-4x2.5-10G configuration can be provisioned on a AR_XP or AR_XPE card.

    The AR_XP or AR_XPE card can be configured as MXPP-4x2.5-10G card by adhering to the following provisioning rules:

    1. Four SFP ports and two XFP ports must be configured. The allowed port pair is 1-2-3-4-9-10 or 5-6-7-8-9-10, or both.

    2. Only ports 9 and 10 can be configured as trunk ports.

    3. Ports 1-2-3-4 or 5-6-7-8 can be configured as client ports.

    Splitter protection is automatically created between ports 9 and 10. Port 10 will be the protected trunk port for port 9.

    Figure 21. High-Rate MXPP-4x2.5-10G Card Operating Mode Configuration

    MXP_MR_S (Unprotected Multirate Muxponder-Static) and MXPP_MR_S (Protected Multirate Muxponder-Static)

    The MXP_MR_S and MXPP_MR_S operating modes are similar to the existing MXP_MR and MXPP_MR operating modes except for static timeslot and ODU allocation. A specific set of client payloads or a mix of client playloads can be used only if the trunk bandwidth and timeslot are available as per the static allocation mapping.

    For example, the MXP_MR_S and MXPP_MR_S modes can be used to provision a dual 4xOC-48 or a mix of 2-OC-48 + 2-GE or 1-OC-48 + 6-GE into one OTU2 muxponder.

    This works similar to traditional transponders/muxponders where operators can choose to use OCH-CC or just provision OCH-Trail/OCH-NC for creating the circuits.

    RGN (OTU1/OTU2 Regenerator)

    The AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card can be configured as a low-rate or high-rate RGN card mode.

    • Low Rate—A maximum of four RGN configurations can be provisioned on a single AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card. The AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card can be configured as a low-rate RGN card by adhering to the following provisioning rules:

      The allowed port pairs are 1-2, 3-4, 5-6, 7-8 or 1-5, 2-6, 3-7, 4-8.

      Figure 22. Low-Rate RGN Card Operating Mode Configuration

    • High Rate—Only one RGN configuration can be provisioned on a AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card. The AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card can be configured as a high rate RGN card by adhering to the following provisioning rules:

      The allowed port pairs are 9-10.

      Figure 23. High-Rate RGN Card Operating Mode Configuration

    The 10 GE over OTU2e/OTU1e signal with disabled FEC, standard FEC, I.4 or I.7 EFEC mode can be regenerated. The ODU transparency can either be Transparent Standard Use or Cisco Extended Use.


    Note


    Payload PMs are not supported in this operating mode.


    MXP-VD-10G (Video Muxponder)

    The AR_XP or AR_XPE card can be configured as a high-rate MXP-VD-10G card mode. A maximum of two MXP-VD-10G configurations can be provisioned on a AR_XP or AR_XPE card.

    The AR_XP or AR_XPE card can be configured as MXP-VD-10G card by adhering to the following provisioning rules:

    1. The allowed port pairs are 1-2-3-9 or 5-6-7-10.

    2. Only ports 9 and 10 can be configured as trunk ports.

    3. Ports 1-2-3 and 5-6-7 can be configured as client ports.

    Figure 24. High-Rate MXP-VD-10G Card Operating Mode Configuration

    Scenarios of Different Operational mode Configurations on a AR_XP, or AR_XPE Card

    The following section provides a few sample scenarios of different operational modes that can be configured on an AR_XP or AR_XPE card:

    Scenario 1

    In this example, the following three operational modes are configured on the AR_XP or AR_XPE card:

    • Low-rate TXP_MR (Cl=1;Tr=5)

    • Low-rate MXP_MR (Cl=3,4;Tr=7)

    • High-rate 3:1 MXP_MR (Cl=2,6,8;Tr=9)

      Figure 25. Scenario 1

    Scenario 2

    In this example, the following four operational modes are configured on the AR_XP or AR_XPE card:

    • Low-rate TXP_MR (Cl=1;Tr=2)

    • 8G FC TXP (Cl=9;Tr=10)

    • Low-rate MR_MXP (Cl=4;TR=7,8)

    • Low-rate MR_MXP (Cl=3,6;TR=5)

      Figure 26. Scenario 2

    Scenario 3

    In this example, the following two operational modes are configured on the AR_XP card:

    • High-rate MXP-4x2.5-10G (Cl=1,2,3,4;Tr=9)

    • High-rate 4:1 MXP_DME (Cl=5,6,7,8;Tr=10)

      Figure 27. Scenario 3

    Scenario 4

    In this example, the following three operational modes are configured on the AR_XP or AR_XPE card:

    • Low-rate MXP_MR (Cl=1,2,3;Tr=5)

    • Low-rate MXP_MR (Cl=4,6,8; Tr=7)

    • RGN(Cl=9;Tr=10)

      Figure 28. Scenario 4

    Scenario 5

    In this example, the following two operational modes are configured on the AR_XP or AR_XPE card:

    • Low-rate MXPP_MR (Cl=1,3,4;Tr=5,6)

    • High-rate MXPP_MR (Cl=2,7,8;Tr=9,10)

      Figure 29. Scenario 5

    AR_MXP, AR_XP, and AR_XPE Functions and Features

    The AR_MXP, AR_XP, and AR_XPE cards have the following functions and features are explained in the "Card Features" chapter:
    • Client Interface

    • DWDM Interfac

    • DWDM Trunk Interface

    • Enhanced FEC (E-FEC) Feature

    • Timing Synchronization

    • Y-Cable Protection

    • Jitter Consideration

    For more information about the AR_MXP and AR_XPE cards, see http:/​/​www.cisco.com/​en/​US/​prod/​collateral/​optical/​ps5724/​ps2006/​data_​sheet_​c78-682432.html

    For more information about the AR_XPE card, see http:/​/​www.cisco.com/​en/​US/​prod/​collateral/​optical/​ps5724/​ps2006/​datasheet_​c78-726878.html

    Related Procedures for AR_MXP, AR_XP, and AR_XPE Cards

    The following is the list of procedures and tasks related to the configuration of the AR_MXP, AR_XP, and AR_XPE cards:

    100G-LC-C, 100G-ME-C, 100G-CK-C, 100ME-CKC, and 200G-CK-LC Cards

    The 100G-LC-C, 100G-ME-C, 100G-CK-C, and 100ME-CKC cards are tunable DWDM trunk cards, which simplifies the integration and transport of 100 Gigabit Ethernet interfaces and services into enterprises or service provider optical networks. The 100GS-CK-LC and 200G-CK-LC cards simplify the integration and transport of 100 and 200 Gigabit Ethernet interfaces and services into enterprises or service provider optical networks. These cards are supported on Cisco NCS 2000 Series platforms.

    The cards interoperate with 10x10G-LC and CFP-LC cards through a chassis backplane.


    Note


    The 100GS-CK-LC and 200G-CK-LC cards do not operate with the CFP-LC card.


    The cards provide the following benefits:

    • Provides 100 Gbps wavelengths transport over fully uncompensated networks, with more than 2,500 km of unregenerated optical links.

    • Enables 100-Gbps transport over very high Polarization Mode Dispersion (PMD).

    • Improves overall system density of up to 100 Gbps per slot, which is five times greater than what can be achieved with 40 Gbps units.

    Up to six cards can be installed per Cisco NCS 2006 shelf, supporting up to 42 100-Gbps interfaces per 42-rack units (RU) bay frame. It is possible to place up to two 100G TXPs, one 100 G Regen, or one 100 G MXP in an Cisco NCS 2006 shelf.


    Note


    The fan-tray assembly NCS2006-FTA= (for the NCS 2006 chassis), NCS2002-FTA= (for the NCS 2002 chassis) must be installed in the shelf where the cards are installed. When an ONS-SC+-10G-C pluggable is used along with the 10x10G-LC card, the maximum operating temperature of the shelf must not exceed 50 degrees Celsius.


    100G-LC-C, 100G-CK-C, 100ME-CKC, and 100G-ME-C Cards

    The 100G-CK-C card works similar to the 100G-LC-C card. The 100G-CK-C card has the new CPAK client interface replacing the CXP client interface of the 100G-LC-C card. The CPAK client interface enables different payload combinations such that this card can be used instead of the 100G-LC-C and CFP-LC cards.

    The 100G-ME-C and 100ME-CKC cards are metro edge versions of 100G-LC-C and 100G-CK-C respectively. The metro edge cards have chromatic dispersion of +/-5000 ps/nm and does not support 20% FEC.

    The 100G-CK-C and 100ME-CKC cards support the CPAK-100G-SR10 pluggable with 100GE/OTU4 and 40GE payloads. Both the cards support the CPAK-100G-LR4 pluggable with 100GE/OTU4 payloads.

    The 100G-LC-C and 100G-ME-C cards support these client signal types:

    • 100GE/OTU4

    • OTU4 from BP OTL4.10 (interconnect with CFP client)

    • 100GE from BP CAUI (interconnect with CFP client)

    • 3 x OTU3e(255/227) from BP OTL3.4 (interconnect with 10 x10G client)

    • 2 x OTU3 from BP OTL3.4 (interconnect with CFP client)

    • 2 x 40 GE from BP XLAUI (interconnect with CFP client)

    In addition to the above, the 100G-CK-C and 100ME-CKC cards support these client signal types:

    • 100GE/OTU4 for the CPAK-100G-SR10/CPAK-100G-LR4 client interface

    • 40GE for the CPAK-100G-SR10 client interface

    • The 100G-LC-C card and 100G-CK-C cards provide a 100 G DWDM trunk interface that supports up to 70000 ps/nm of CD robustness.

    • The 100G-LC-C card and 100G-CK-C cards enables configuration of the CD dispersion tolerance to 50000 ps/nm and 30000 ps/nm to reduce power consumption.

    100GS-CK-LC and 200G-CK-LC Cards

    The and 200G-CK-LC cards are tunable DWDM trunk cards, which simplify the integration and transport of 100 and 200 Gigabit Ethernet interfaces and services into enterprises or service provider optical networks. The 200G-CK-LC card is an enhancement of the 100GS-CK-LC card.

    The 100GS-CK-LC and 200G-CK-LC cards provide the following benefits:

    • Allow choosing 16 QAM and QPSK as the modulation formats at the line side.

    • Provide Standard G-FEC (Reed-Solomon), Soft Decision FEC (SD-FEC) encoding with 20% overhead, and Hard Decision FEC (HD-FEC) encoding with 7% overhead.

    • Provide Nyquist filtering for best performance and optimal band usage.

    • Support gridless tunability.

    • Allow client access either through the local 100G CPAK interface or through backplane lines.

    • In MXP-10X10G operating mode, allow 10GE and OC-192 clients (multiplexed on 100G trunk) to interoperate with NCS 4000 platform. The NCS 2000 line cards must fill the PT and MSI bytes to interoperate with the supported NCS 4000 10G client. The interoperability applies for Hard Decision FEC (HD-FEC) encoding with 7% overhead and GFEC trunk modes.

    The 200G-CK-LC card also supports feature-based licensing. The 200G-CK-LIC is the licensed card version of the 200G-CK-LC card. The licensed card version has only some basic functionality enabled while other features can be enabled separately with specific licenses.

    Key Features

    The card key features are listed in the “Key Features of 100G-LC-C, 10x10G-LC, and CFP-LC Cards” section on page 11-129.

    The cards are single-slot cards and can be installed in Slot 2 to Slot 7 in the Slot 2 to Slot 7 in the Cisco NCS 2006 chassis and Slot 2 and Slot 3 in the Cisco NCS 2002 chassis. The 100G-LC-C and 100G-ME-C cards have one DWDM port and one CXP port. The 100G-CK-C and 100ME-CK-C cards have one DWDM port and one CPAK port.

    Operating Modes for 100G-LC-C, 100G-ME-C, 100G-CK-C, 200G-CK-LC, and 100ME-CKC Cards

    100G Operating Modes

    Each operating mode can be configured using the specific set of cards and client payloads. Key Features of 100G-LC-C, 100G-ME-C, 100G-CK-C, 100ME-CKC, 10x10G-LC, 200G-CK-LC, CFP-LC, and MR-MXP Cards describes how each mode can be configured, the supported payloads, and the valid port pair for a specific operating mode.

    The 100G-LC-C, 100G-ME-C, 100G-CK-C, 100GS-CK-LC, 100ME-CKC, and 200G-CK-LC cards support the following 100G operating modes. The operating mode configuration for the 100G operating modes is performed on the client card.

    • TXP-100G (Standalone 100GE Transponder)

    • RGN-100G (100G Regenerator)

    TXP-100G (Standalone 100GE Transponder)

    The cards can be configured as a standalone 100 Gigabit Ethernet transponder. The 100 Gigabit Ethernet traffic is supported on the CXP/CPAK and coherent optical trunk. The 100 Gigabit Ethernet or OTU4 payload traffic is routed from the CXP/CPAK to the optical trunk, passing through the T100 framer and vice versa. The supported client signals in this mode are 100 Gigabit Ethernet LAN-PHY or OTU4 data rates.

    RGN-100G (100G Regenerator)

    The cards can be configured as a regenerator. Two cards can be connected to work in a back-to-back mode connecting through the chassis backplane in the same shelf. The allowed port pairs are 2-3, 4-5, or 6-7.

    The client signals supported are 100 Gigabit Ethernet or OTU4. Regeneration is performed leveraging on the OTU4 backplane interconnection. OTU4 overhead is terminated, allowing ODU4 to transparently pass through. GCC0 is terminated, while GCC1 and GCC2 are allowed to pass through.

    The CXP client is not required because communication between the two cards acting as a regeneration group is supported through the chassis backplane.

    MXP-2x40G

    The 100G-CK-C and 100ME-CKC cards support the MXP-2x40G operating mode. The 100G-CK-C and 100ME-CKC cards can be configured as a 2-port 40 GE muxponder. Two 40 GE flows through the CPAK client interface and are multiplexed in the 100G trunk interface. The traffic on the second client interface can be configured only after the traffic is provisioned on the first client interface. This operating mode is not supported on the 100GS-CK-LC card.

    If ONS 15454 with the MXP-2x40G operating mode is connected to a NCS 6000 router, ensure that both the 40G ports are connected to the same group of six ports on the NCS 6000 router. The 40G ports 1 and 2 need to connect to 1-6, 7-12, 13-18 ports on the NCS 6000 router.

    200G Operating Modes

    The 100GS-CK-LC and 200G-CK-LC cards also support the 200G operating modes. The operating mode configuration for these modes is performed on the trunk card.

    • MXP_200G

    • MXP_10x10G_100G

    • MXP_CK_100G

    MXP_200G

    Three cards, trunk card, peer card, and skip card are required to configure this operating mode. The skip card is adjacent to the peer card.

    The trunk card is 100GS-CK-LC or 200G-CK-LC card; the peer card and skip cards are MR-MXP. The first 10x10G is taken from the two SFP and two QFSP+ ports of the peer MR-MXP card and the second 10x10G is taken from the two SFP and two QFSP+ ports of the skip MR-MXP card.

    200G-CK-LC card supports another configuration in the MXP_200G operating mode. In this configuration, 2x40GE clients on QSFP+ ports and 2x10GE clients on SFP+ ports of both the peer MR-MXP and skip MR-MXP cards are multiplexed into 200G traffic on the trunk 200G-CK-LC card.

    The operating mode can be provisioned on the following slots:

    • NCS 2006: 100GS-CK-LC or 200G-CK-LC card in slots 2 or 7, peer and skip MR-MXP cards in adjacent slots 3, 4 or 5, 6

    • NCS 2015: 100GS-CK-LC or 200G-CK-LC card in slots 2, 7, 8, 13, or 14, peer and skip MR-MXP cards in adjacent slots.

    MXP_10x10G_100G

    Three cards, trunk card, peer card, and skip card are required to configure this operating mode.

    The trunk card is 100GS-CK-LC or 200G-CK-LC card; the peer card is 10x10G-LC and the skip card is MR-MXP . The first 10x10G is taken from the ten SFP ports of the peer 10x10G-LC card and the second 10x10G is taken from the two SFP and two QFSP+ ports of the skip MR-MXP card.

    The operating mode can be provisioned on the following slots:

    • NCS 2006: 100GS-CK-LC or 200G-CK-LC card in slots 2 or 7, peer and skip MR-MXP cards in adjacent slots 3, 4 or 5, 6

    • NCS 2015: 100GS-CK-LC or 200G-CK-LC card in slots 2, 7, 8, 13, or 14, peer and skip MR-MXP cards in adjacent slots.

    MXP_CK_100G

    Two cards, trunk and peer cards are required to configure this operating mode. The trunk card is 100GS-CK-LC or 200G-CK-LC; the peer card is MR-MXP . The first 100G is taken from the CPAK client port of the trunk 100GS-CK-LC or 200G-CK-LC card and the second 100G is taken from the CPAK client port of the MR-MXP card.

    200G-CK-LC card supports another configuration in the MXP_CK_100G operating mode. In this configuration, 10x10GE clients on QSFP+ or SFP+ ports of the peer MR-MXP card and 100GE client on the CPAK port of the 200G-CK-LC card are multiplexed into a 200G configuration on the trunk 200G-CK-LC card.

    The operating mode can be provisioned on the following slots:

    • NCS 2006: 100GS-CK-LC or 200G-CK-LC card and the peer MR-MXP card need to be in adjacent slots 2-3, 4-5, 6-7

    • NCS 2015: 100GS-CK-LC or 200G-CK-LC card and the peer MR-MXP card need to be in adjacent slots 2-3, 4-5, 6-7, 8-9, 10-11, 12-13, 14-15

    References

    For more information about the cards, see:

    10x10G-LC Card

    The 10x10G-LC card is a DWDM client card, which simplifies the integration and transport of 10 Gigabit Ethernet interfaces and services into enterprises or service provider optical networks. The 10x10G-LC card is supported on Cisco NCS 2000 Series platforms.

    The 10x10G-LC card is a single-slot card and can be installed in any service slots of the chassis. The 10x10G-LC card consists of a 10-port SFP+ based (gray, colored, coarse wavelength division multiplexing ([CWDM], and DWDM optics available) and one 100 G CXP-based port.

    The 10x10G-LC card interoperates with 100G-LC -C cards through a chassis backplane.

    The 10x10G-LC card supports the following signal types:

    • OC-192/STM-64 (9.95328 Gbps)

    • 10 Gigabit Ethernet LAN PHY (10.3125 Gbps)

    • 10 G FC (10.518 Gbps)

    • 8 G FC

    • OTU-2

    • G.709 overclocked to transport 10 Gigabit Ethernet as defined by ITU-T G. Sup43 Clause 7.1 (11.0957 Gbps)

    • IB_5G (supported only in TXP-10G operating mode)

    The key features of 10x10G-LC card are listed in Key Features of 100G-LC-C, 10x10G-LC, and CFP-LC Cards, page 11-129.

    Operating Modes for 10x10G-LC Card

    The 10x10G-LC card supports the following operating modes:

    • MXP-10x10G (10x10G Muxponder)

    • RGN-­10G (5x10G Regenerator)/TXP-­10G (5x10G Transponder)

    • Low Latency

    • Fanout-10X10G

    • TXPP-10G

    Each operating mode can be configured using the specific set of cards and client payloads. Key Features of 100G-LC-C, 100G-ME-C, 100G-CK-C, 100ME-CKC, 10x10G-LC, 200G-CK-LC, CFP-LC, and MR-MXP Cards describes how each mode can be configured, the supported payloads, and the valid port pair for a specific operating mode.

    MXP-10x10G (10x10G Muxponder)

    The 10x10G-LC card can be configured as a 10x10G muxponder. It can be connected with a 100G-LC-C, 100G-ME-C, 100G-CK-C, or 100ME-CKC card to support 10-port 10 G muxponder capabilities. The 100G-LC-C, 100G-ME-C, 100G-CK-C, , 200G-CK-LC, or 100ME-CKC card can be connected through the chassis backplane (no client CXP/CPAK required) with the 10x10G-LC card to provide OTN multiplexing of the 10 G data streams into a single 100 G DWDM OTU4 wavelength. The allowed port pairs are 2-3, 4-5, or 6-7.

    The 10x10G muxponder mode supports client signals that are a mix and combination of any 10 Gigabit Ethernet LAN-PHY, OC-192, STM-64, 10 G FC/FICON, 8 G FC/FICON, or OTU2 data rates.

    RGN-10G (5x10G Regenerator)/TXP-10G (5x10G Transponder)

    The 10x10G-LC card works as a standalone supporting the multitransponder functionality. The 10 Gbps SFP+ ports should be paired to provide the 10 G transponder functionality for each of the couple of ports. By using the grey optics SFP+ to provide the client equipment connectivity and DWDM SFP+ on the WDM side, up to five 10 G transponders are supported by a single 10x10G-LC card. Up to 6 10x10G-LC cards are supported on the Cisco NCS 2006 chassis allowing for 30 10 Gbps transponders in a single shelf.

    All the ports can be equipped with or without the G.709 Digital Wrapper function providing wide flexibility in terms of the supported services.

    As the client and trunk ports are completely independent, it is also possible to equip both the SFP+ of the same pair of ports with the DWDM SFP+ thereby allowing them to function as a WDM regenerator. The CXP pluggable is unused in this configuration.

    Each of the SFP+ ports can be provisioned as a client or trunk. When one port is selected as a trunk, the other port of the pair is automatically selected as the client port. The allowed port pairs are 1-2, 3-4, 5-6, 7-8, or 9-10.

    For RGN-10G mode, both the ports are trunk ports.

    It is not a constraint to provision 5 couple of TXP-10G mode or 5 couple of RGN-10G mode. A mix of TXP-10G and RGN-10G modes can be configured. For example, couple 1-2 and 5-6 can be configured as a TXP-10G mode and the remaining as the RGN-10G mode.

    Table 41 Supported Payload Mapping Between Two SFP+ Ports

    SFP+ Payload (Peer-1)

    SFP+ Payload (Peer -2)

    10GE-LAN (CBR Mapped)

    OTU2e or 10GE-LAN (CBR Mapped)

    OTU2

    OC192 or OTU2

    Low Latency

    The 10x10G-LC card can be configured in the low latency mode. This configuration minimizes the time spent by the signal to cross the card during the regeneration process. Adjacent SFP ports must be selected while provisioning this mode although each SFP port functions as a unidirectional regenerator. Both ports are trunk ports. The allowed ports are 1-2, 3-4, 5-6, 7-8, or 9-10. A mix of TXP-10G, RGN-10G, and low latency modes can be configured.

    The low latency mode supports 10GE and 10G FC data rates. The same payload must be provisioned on both the SFP ports involved in this operating mode. GCC cannot be provisioned on the ports used in the low latency mode. The low latency mode does not support terminal and facility loopback.

    Fanout-10X10G

    The 10x10G-LC card can be configured in the fanout-10x10G mode. The fanout configuration configures the CXP side as the client and SFP side as the trunk. This configuration functions as ten independent transponders. The CXP lanes are managed independently and the payload for each CXP-lane-SPF+ pair is independent from the other pairs.

    The fanout configuration provides the following mapping for the port pairs:

    • CXP lane 2-SFP1

    • CXP lane 3-SFP2

    • CXP lane 4-SFP3

    • CXP lane 5-SFP4

    • CXP lane 6-SFP5

    • CXP lane 7-SFP6

    • CXP lane 8-SFP7

    • CXP lane 9-SFP8

    • CXP lane 10-SFP9

    • CXP lane 11-SFP10


      Note


      CXP lane 1 and CXP lane 12 are not supported in this configuration.


    The fanout configuration supports the following payload types and mapping modes:

    • 10GE (CXP line), transparent (no mapping), 10GE (SFP)

    • 10GE (CXP line), GFP mapping, OTU2 (SFP)

    • 10GE (CXP line), CBR mapping, OTU2e (SFP)

    TXPP-10G

    Splitter protection can be implemented on the 10x10G-LC card in the TXPP-10G mode. The 10x10G-LC card supports up to two splitter protection groups with one client and two trunk ports. The client and trunk ports on the two groups are:

    • Port 3 (client), port 4, and port 6 (trunks) on the first protection group

    • Port 7 (client), port 8, and port 10 (trunks) on the second protection group

    Port 1 and port 2 are available for unprotected transponders and can be configured in the standard TXP-10G mode, with the first port selected as the trunk and the other port selected as the client. Two ports, port 5 and port 9 are left unused. A Y-Cable protection group cannot be defined on the same 10x10G-LC card when it is provisioned in the TXPP-10G mode. The splitter protection is supported only for 10GE traffic, with trunk ports set to disabled FEC, standard FEC, or enhanced FEC (E-FEC) mode.

    The following figure shows the 10x10G-LC card configured for splitter protection.

    Figure 30. Splitter Protection on the 10x10G-LC card


    Note


    If the card is configured only once in the TXPP-10G mode, with port 3 or port 7 as the client port, the rest of the ports are available for configuration in the standard TXP-10G mode (except port 5 and port 9, which are left unused). The TXPP-10G mode configuration is successful only when three licenses for the three ports (one client and two trunk ports) involved in splitter protection are available for the card. No new licensing is required for the splitter protection operating mode.


    For more information about the 10x10G-LC card, see http:/​/​www.cisco.com/​en/​US/​prod/​collateral/​optical/​ps5724/​ps2006/​data_​sheet_​c78-713296.html.

    CFP-LC Card

    The CFP-LC card is a client card, which simplifies the integration and transport of 40 GE and 100 GE interfaces and services into enterprises or service provider optical networks. The CFP-LC card is supported on the Cisco NCS 2006 and NCS 2015 platform. The CFP-LC card provides 100 Gbps services to support 100 G DWDM wavelengths generated by the 100G-LC-C card. The traffic coming from CFP interfaces is switched to the trunk port through a cross-switch.

    The CFP-LC card supports the following signal types:

    • 100 Gigabit Ethernet

    • 40 Gigabit Ethernet

    • OTU-3

    • OTU-4

    Client ports can be equipped with a large variety of CFP pluggables.

    Key Features

    The key features of CFP-LC card are listed in Key Features of 100G-LC-C, 10x10G-LC, and CFP-LC Cards, page 11-129.

    The CFP-LC card is a double-slot card and can be installed in Slot 3 or Slot 5 in the Cisco NCS 2006 chassis, and the 100G-LC-C peers cards must be placed in the adjacent slots (2 and 5 or 4 and 7). If the card is plugged in one of the unsupported slots or in a Cisco NCS 2002 chassis, the system raises an EQPT::MEA (Mismatch of Equipment Alarm) notification. Up to two CFP-LC cards can be installed per Cisco NCS 2006 shelf assembly, supporting up to 28x 40-Gbps or 14x 100 Gbps interfaces per 42-rack units (RU) bay frame.

    The CFP-LC card is equipped with two 100 G CFP pluggable modules and a cross-bar embedded switch module. The CFP-LC card provides two backplane interfaces (working both at 100 Gb or 40 Gb) that are suitable for the cross-switch application on the incoming CFP signals. The CFP-LC card can be configured to send all the client CFP services towards the backplane to be connected with up to two 100G-LC-C cards placed in the two adjacent slots (upper and lower) of the Cisco NCS 2006 chassis in order to provide two 100 G transponders configurations.

    Operating Modes for CFP-LC Card

    The CFP-LC card supports the following operating modes:

    • 2x40G Muxponder

    • CFP-TXP (100G Transponder)

    Each operating mode can be configured using the specific set of cards and client payloads. Key Features of 100G-LC-C, 100G-ME-C, 100G-CK-C, 100ME-CKC, 10x10G-LC, 200G-CK-LC, CFP-LC, and MR-MXP Cards describes how each mode can be configured, the supported payloads, and the valid port pair for a specific operating mode.

    2x40G Muxponder

    The CFP-LC card can be configured as a 2-port 40 G muxponder. It can be connected with the 100G-LC-C, 100G-ME-C, 100G-CK-C, or 100ME-CKC card to support 2-port 40 G muxponder capabilities. The 100G-LC-C, 100G-ME-C, 100G-CK-C, 100ME-CKC card can be connected through the Cisco NCS 2006backplane (no client CXP/CPAK required) with the CFP-LC card to provide OTN multiplexing of the 40 G data streams into a single 100 G WDM OTU4 wavelength. The 2x40G muxponder mode supports client signals that are a mix and combination of any 40 Gigabit Ethernet LAN-PHY or OTU3 data rates.

    CFP-TXP (100G Transponder)

    The CFP-LC card can be configured as a 100G transponder. It can be connected with the 100G-LC-C, 100G-ME-C, 100G-CK-C, or 100ME-CKC card to support the client interface for the 100-Gbps transponder capabilities. The 100G CXP pluggable available on the 100G-LC or 100G-ME-C card supports only 100GE-BASE-SR10 client interface, while the 100GE-BASE-LR4 is supported using a CFP form factor only. The 100G CPAK pluggable available on the 100G-CK-C or 100ME-CKC card supports the CPAK-100G-SR10 and CPAK-100G-LR4 client interfaces.

    The CFP-LC card can be connected through the Cisco NCS 2006backplane with up to two 100G-LC cards placed in the upper or in the lower slot of the same shelf to provide the equivalent functionalities of two 100 G LR4 transponders, leveraging on CFP pluggables as client interface.

    For more information about the CFP-LC card, see http:/​/​www.cisco.com/​en/​US/​prod/​collateral/​optical/​ps5724/​ps2006/​data_​sheet_​c78-713295.html

    MR-MXP Card

    The MR-MXP card is a mixed rate 10G and 40G client muxponder that is supported on Cisco NCS 2000 Series platforms. The card is equipped with one CPAK port, two SFP ports, and two QSFP+ ports. The card can interoperate with 100GS-CK-LC, 200G-CK-LC, and 10x10G-LC cards through a chassis backplane.


    Note


    The FPGA and firmware upgrade (via CTC) for MR-MXP cards should be done one by one. Wait till the card completely comes up, to active or standby (based on configuration) before upgrading the next card in the chassis. If this is not followed, the load on the TNC card increases causing longer booting time for the line cards in the chassis and in a few cases, the line cards might not boot up.


    When the node is upgraded to R10.5.2.4 or R10.6.x from a previous release, traffic loss on the MR-MXP card might occur for few seconds. When the node is reverted from R10.6.x to R10.5.x, cold reboot is required.

    The TRAF-AFFECT-RESET-REQUIRED (Traffic Affecting Reset Required) alarm is raised on the MR-MXP card in CTC after the node is upgraded to R10.5.2.4 or R10.6. Hence, it is recommended to reboot the card.

    1. In the Card view, go to Provisioning > Card.

    2. Click FPGA/FIRMWARE Upgrade/Traffic Affecting Reset to reboot the card.

    Encryption as an Appliance

    The MR-MXP-K9 and MR-MXP-K9= PIDs of MR-MXP card are referred as Encryption as an appliance PIDs. The card authentication and payload encryption are enabled by default and cannot be disabled for these PIDs.

    The MR-MXP-K9 and MR-MXP-K9= PIDs of MR-MXP card do not interoperate with other PIDs of the MR-MXP card. In MXP_200G operating mode, the two MR-MXP cards must have the same PIDs.

    Key Features

    The card key features are listed in the “Key Features of 100G-LC-C, 10x10G-LC, and CFP-LC Cards” section on page 11-129.

    The MR-MXP card provides the following features:
    • Termination point for a 100G client payload on the CPAK port. The aggregated payloads are forwarded to a 200G companion trunk card.

    • Provides encryption capability on the virtual port or OTU4 backplane port. This card provides confidentiality of the data, which is sent over a fiber optic communication channel, using Next Generation Cryptography. The encryption works only after provisioning the high speed or low speed encryption license. To provision encryption on the MR-MXP card, see NTP-G340 Provisioning Encryption on the WSE and MR-MXP Cards.

    • Supports feature-based licensing. The base functionality is enabled in the licensed card version. Additional features such as encryption are provided through specific feature licenses. The MR-MXP-LIC is the licensed card version of the MR-MXP card. For more information on licensing, see the Cisco NCS 2000 Series Licensing Configuration Guide.

    Operating Modes for MR-MXP Card

    The MR-MXP card supports the following 200G operating modes:

    • MXP_200G

    • MXP_10x10G_100G

    • MXP_CK_100G

    Each operating mode can be configured using the specific set of cards and client payloads. The operating mode is configured on the companion trunk card (100GS-CK-LC or 200G-CK-LC). For more information about these operating modes, see Operating Modes for 100G-LC-C, 100G-ME-C, 100G-CK-C, 200G-CK-LC, and 100ME-CKC Cards.

    The sub OpMode in MR-MXP cards determines the operating mode on the card client ports. For example, the QSFP+ port can be provisioned either as a 40GE port or can be divided into four 10G ports. This provisioning is controlled by the sub OpMode. The sub OpMode is created by default when the operating mode is configured on the card. The MR-MXP card supports only one sub OpMode for each of the 200G operating modes as follows :

    • OPM_10x10G—This is the default sub OpMode for the MXP_200G and MXP_10x10G_100G operating modes. In this sub OpMode, the SFP and QSFP+ ports are divided in such a way that 10 10GE payloads can be provisioned. When a PPM is provisioned on a QSFP+ port, four internal ports are created. A 10 GE payload can be provisioned on each of these ports. The OPM-10x10G operating mode is provisioned with MR-MXP card on the client side and the adjacent MR-MXP card on the trunk side. The operating mode can be provisioned only from the client side but can be deleted from both client and trunk sides. The aggregate signal from client is sent to trunk through the backplane.

    • OPM_100G—This is the default sub OpMode for the MXP_CK_100G operating mode where the CPAK port can be provisioned with a 100GE payload. The 100GE payload can be divided into either four or 10 sub-lanes. The OPM-100G operating mode is provisioned with MR-MXP card on the client side and the adjacent MR-MXP card on the trunk side. The operating mode can be provisioned only from the client side but can be deleted from both client and trunk sides. The aggregate signal from client is sent to trunk through the backplane.

    The MR-MXP card supports the following 100G operating modes:

    • MXP-100G

    • TXP-100G

    • 100G_B2B


    Note


    All the 100G and 200G operating modes support the encryption feature except MXP_CK_100G.


    MXP-100G

    MXP-100G operating mode is provisioned with MR-MXP card on the client side and the adjacent 200G-CK-LC card or 100GS-CK-LC card on the trunk side. The operating mode can be provisioned only from the client side but can be deleted from both client and trunk sides. This mode supports 10GE as the payload. This mode uses the SFP+ and QSFP+ ports on MR-MXP client card and the DWDM port on the 200G-CK-LC card or 100GS-CK-LC card. The aggregate signal from client is sent to trunk through the backplane.

    The operating mode can be provisioned on the following slots:

    • NCS 2002: Slots 2 and 3

    • NCS 2006: Slots 2 and 3, 4 and 5, 6 and 7

    • NCS 2015: Slots 2 and 3, 4 and 5, 6 and 7, 8 and 9, 10 and 11, 12 and 13, 14 and 15

    TXP-100G

    TXP-100G operating mode is provisioned with MR-MXP card on the client side and the adjacent 200G-CK-LC card or 100GS-CK-LC card on the trunk side. The operating mode can be provisioned only from the client side but can be deleted from both client and trunk sides. This mode supports 100GE as the payload. This mode uses the CPAK port on MR-MXP client card and the DWDM port on the 200G-CK-LC card or 100GS-CK-LC card. The aggregate signal from client is sent to trunk through the backplane.

    The operating mode can be provisioned on the following slots:

    • NCS 2002: Slots 2 and 3

    • NCS 2006: Slots 2 and 3, 4 and 5, 6 and 7

    • NCS 2015: Slots 2 and 3, 4 and 5, 6 and 7, 8 and 9, 10 and 11, 12 and 13, 14 and 15

    100G_B2B

    The 100G_B2B operating mode can be provisioned with MR-MXP card on the client side and the adjacent MR-MXP card card on the trunk side. The operating mode performs encryption of an 100GE client signal taken from the CPAK interface or 10x10GE client signal taken from the two QSFP and SFP interfaces of the client MR-MXP card and maps it to an OTU4 signal with encryption. The OTU4 signal is passed to the trunk MR-MXP card in the peer slot through the back plane. The trunk MR-MXP card converts the OTU4 signal to grey wavelength with either an SR-10 or an LR-4 through the CPAK interface of the trunk card. The 100GE client payload can be divided into either four or 10 sub-lanes.

    The CPAK port or two QSFP and 2 SFP+ ports can be selected on the client card during the provisioning. The operating mode can be provisioned from any MR-MXP card in the peer slot pair. When the operating mode is created, the card that the user selects to create operating mode acts as the client card and the peer card for that card acts as the trunk card. When payloads are created on both the client and trunk cards, CTC provides the option to select the number of lanes as required for LR4/SR10 based payload.

    The operating mode can be provisioned on the following slots:

    • NCS 2002: Slots 2 and 3

    • NCS 2006: Slots 2 and 3, 4 and 5, 6 and 7

    • NCS 2015: Slots 2 and 3, 4 and 5, 6 and 7, 8 and 9, 10 and 11, 12 and 13, 14 and 15

    Key Features of 100G-LC-C, 100G-ME-C, 100G-CK-C, 100ME-CKC, 10x10G-LC, 200G-CK-LC, CFP-LC, and MR-MXP Cards

    The 100G-LC-C, 100G-ME-C, 100G-CK-C, 100ME-CKC, 10x10G-LC, 200G-CK-LC, CFP-LC, and MR-MXP cards support the following key features:

    • Operating Modes—The cards can be configured into multiple operating modes. The cards can be equipped with pluggables for client and trunk options, and offer a large variety of configurations. When you configure the card into multiple operational modes, make sure that the following tasks are completed:

      • The card must be preprovisioned and the modes must be configured. None of the modes are provisioned on the card by default. All operating modes are created on the card level. These are card-specific provisioning, which decides the behavior of a particular card.

      • Depending on the card mode selected, the supported payload for that particular card mode must be provisioned on the PPMs.

      • The payloads can be provisioned after configuring the operational mode on the card.

    Each operating mode can be configured using the specific set of cards and client payloads.

    Table 42 Operating Modes and Supported Payloads for 100G-LC-C, 100G-ME-C, 100G-CK-C, 200G-CK-LC, 100ME-CKC, 10x10G-LC, CFP-LC, and MR-MXP Cards

    Card (provisioning executed on this card)

    Operational Mode

    Peer Card (connected through backplane)

    Supported Client Payloads

    100G-LC-C, 100G-ME-C, 100G-CK-C, 100ME-CKC

    TXP-100G (Standalone 100G Transponder)

    100GE, OTU4

    RGN-100G (100G Regenerator)

    100G-LC-C, 100G-ME-C, 100G-CK-C, 100ME-CKC

    
Regeneration of any 100 G configuration

    MXP-2x40G (for 100G-CK-C, 100ME-CKC)

    40GE, OTU3

    100GS-CK-LC and 200G-CK-LC

    TXP-100G (Standalone 100G Transponder)

    100GE and OTU4

    OTU4 is supported only for the 200G-CK-LC card.

    RGN-100G (100G Regenerator)

    100GS-CK-LC or 200G-CK-LC

    —
Regeneration of any 100 G configuration

    MXP_200G

    MR-MXP

    Skip card is MR-MXP

    MXP_10x10G_100G

    10x10G-LC

    Skip card is MR-MXP

    10GE, 100GE

    MXP_CK_100G

    MR-MXP

    10GE, 100GE

    10x10G-LC

    MXP-10x10G (10x10G Muxponder)

    100G-LC-C, 100G-ME-C, 100G-CK-C, 100ME-CKC, , 100GS-CK-LC 200G-CK-LC

    OC192/STM-64, 10GE-LAN Phy, 10GE-WAN Phy (using OC192), OTU2, OTU2e, 8G FC, 10G FC, FICON

    Only OC192/STM64 and 10GE are supported when the 10x10G-LC card is connected with the 100GS-CK-LC card.

    Only OC192/STM64, 10GE, and OTU2 are supported when the 10x10G-LC card is connected with the 200G-CK-LC card.

    RGN-10G (5x10G Regenerator)

    10GE-LAN Phy, OTU2

    TXP-10G (5x10G Transponder)

    10GE-LAN Phy, OTU2e, OTU2, OC192/STM-64, 8G FC, 10G FC, IB_5G

    Low Latency

    10GE, 10G FC

    Fanout-10X10G

    10GE

    TXPP-10G

    10GE, OTU2e

    CFP-LC

    2x40G Muxponder

    100G-LC-C or 100G-CK-C card

    OTU3/40GE-LAN Phy

    CFP-TXP (100G Transponder)—One port

    CFP-TXP (100G Transponder)—Two ports

    100G-LC-C or 100G-CK-C card

    OTU4, 100GE

    Two 100G-LC-C or 100G-CK-C cards

    OTU4, 100GE

    MR-MXP

    MXP-100G

    200G-CK-LC card or 100GS-CK-LC card

    10GE

    TXP-100G

    200G-CK-LC card or 100GS-CK-LC card

    100GE

    100G-B2B

    MR-MXP

    100GE, 10x10GE

    For operating modes of the respective cards, see the “Operating Modes for 100G-LC-C Card” section on page 11-124, “Operating Modes for 10x10G-LC Card” section on page 11-125, “Operating Modes for CFP-LC Card” section on page 11-128, and Operating Modes for MR-MXP Card.

    • Protocol Transparency—The 100G-LC-C, 100G-ME-C, 100G-CK-C, 100ME-CKC, 100GS-CK-LC, and 200G-CK-LC cards deliver any 100 Gbps services for cost-effective, point-to-point networking. The 10x10G-LC card delivers any 10 Gbps services for cost-effective, point-to-point networking. In case of 100 G muxponder clients that are mapped into OTU4 DWDM wavelength.

    Table 43 Transponder Client Configurations and Mapping for 100G-LC-C and 100G-CK-C Cards

    Client

     

    Trunk

    Format

    Rate (Gbps)

    Mapping

    Format

    Rate with 7% GFEC, 20% GFEC, or EFEC OH (Gbps)

    100GE LAN-PHY

    101.125

    Bit transparent through standard G.709v3 mapping

    OTU4         111.809    

    OTU4

    111.809

    Transparent G.709 standard

    Table 44 Transponder Client Configurations and Mapping for 10x10G-LC Card

    Client

    Mapping

    Format

    Rate (Gbps)

    10GE LAN-PHY (MXP-10x10G mode)

    10.3125

    CBR-BMP clause 17.2.4 (ex G sup43 7.1) + GMP ODU2e to OPU3e4

    10GE LAN-PHY (MXP-10x10G mode)

    10.3125

    GFP-F clause 17.4.1 (ex G sup43 7.3) + GMP ODU2 to OPU3e4

    10GE LAN-PHY (TXP-10G mode)

    10.3125

    CBR-BMP clause 17.2.4 (ex G sup43 7.1)

    10GE LAN-PHY (TXP-10G mode)

    10.3125

    GFP-F clause 17.4.1 (ex G sup43 7.3)

    OC-192/STM-64

    9.953

    CBR-BMP clause 17.2.2 (Sync) + GMP ODU2 to OPU3e4

    10G FC

    10.518

    513b Transc + AMP GFP-F clause 17.8.2 + GMP ODU2e to OPU3e4

    8G FC

    8.500

    CBR-BMP clause 17.9 (OduFlex) + GMP ODU2 to OPU3e4 (8 timeslot mapping)

    8G FC

    8.500

    GMP ODU2 to OPU3e4

    OTU2

    10.709

    ODU transparent + GMP ODU2 to OPU3e4

    OTU2e

    11.095

    ODU transparent + GMP ODU2e to OPU3e4

    IB-5G

    5.0000

    GMP ODU2e to OPU3e4

    Table 45 Client Configurations and Mapping for CFP-LC Card

    Client

     

    Trunk

    Format

    Rate (Gbps)

    Mapping

    Format

    Rate with 7% GFEC or EFEC OH (Gbps)

    100GE LAN-PHY

    101.125

    Bit transparent through standard G.709v3 mapping

    
OTU4         111.809

    OTU4

    111.809

    Transparent G.709 standard

    40GE LAN-PHY

    41.250

    1024b/1027b transc + OPU4 GMP G709 Appendix VIII

    OTU3

    43.018

    Transparent G.709 standard

    • Flow-Through Timing—The cards allow the timing to flow through from client to line optical interface. The received timing from client interface is used to time the line transmitter interface. This flow-through timing allows multiple cards to be placed in the same shelf but be fully independently timed, independent of the NE timing.

    • Far-End Laser Control (FELC)—FELC is supported on the cards. For more information on FELC, see "Far-End Laser Control" section.

    • Performance Monitoring—The 100-Gbps DWDM trunk provides support for both transparent and non-transparent signal transport performance monitoring. The Digital Wrapper channel is monitored according to G.709 (OTN) and G.8021 standards. Performance Monitoring of optical parameters on the client and DWDM line interface include Loss Of Signal (LOS), Laser Bias Current, Transmit Optical Power, and Receive Optical Power. Calculation and accumulation of the performance monitoring data are supported in 15-minute and 24-hour intervals as per G.7710. Physical system parameter measured at the wavelength level like Mean PMD, accumulated Chromatic Dispersion, or Received OSNR are also included in the set of performance monitoring parameters. These can greatly simplify troubleshooting operations and enhance the set of data which can be collected directly from the equipment.
The performance monitoring for the CFP-LC card takes into account that the two CFP-LC cards are an host board supporting CFP client equipment, while the digital monitoring if the incoming client is implemented on the 100G cards. There is a virtual port connection that displays the Digital Wrapper monitoring according to G.709 (OTN) as well as the RMON for Ethernet signals, while the optical performance monitoring is directly available on the two CFP-LC cards. Calculation and accumulation of the performance monitoring data are supported in 15-minute and 24-hour intervals as per G.7710.

    • Loopback—The terminal, facility, or backplane loopback can be provisioned on all the ports of the 100G-LC-C, 100G-CK-C, 100G-ME-C, 100ME-CKC, 10x10G-LC, 100GS-CK-LC, and 200G-CK-LC cards configured in any operating mode except for the low latency mode. The backplane facility loopback cannot be configured on the 10x10G -LC card configured in the MXP-10x10G mode. The loopback can be provisioned only when the port is in OOS-MT state. A new port cannot be provisioned when the backplane loopback is configured on the 10x10G-LC card. For the CFP-LC card configured in the CFP-TXP or CFP-MXP mode, the facility or terminal loopback can be configured on the backplane of the peer 100G-LC-C, 100G-CK-C, 100G-ME-C, 100ME-CKC, 100GS-CK-LC, and 200G-CK-LC cards. Terminal and facility loopback can be provisioned on MR-MXP cards configured in any operating mode.

      In Release 10.0.2, the facility loopback and drop feature can be provisioned on the client, trunk, and backplane interfaces of the 100G-LC-C, 10x10G-LC, CFP-LC, and 100G-CK-C cards as follows:
      • Trunk facility loopback (drop) and client facility loopback (drop) is supported on:
        • 100G-LC-C cards configured in the TXP mode (with CXP client pluggable) for OTU4 and 100GE client payloads.

        • 100G-CK-LC configured in the TXP mode (with CPAK client pluggable) for OTU4 and 100GE client payloads.

        When facility loopback (drop) is provisioned on the trunk interface, the trunk RX signal is sent back to the trunk TX port and an ODUk-AIS (for OTU4 payloads) or an LF (for 100GE payloads) signal is fowarded to the client port in the downstream direction for any of the squelch settings. When facility loopback (drop) is provisioned on the client interface, the client RX signal is sent back to the client TX port and an ODUk-AIS signal is forwarded to the trunk port in the downstream direction for any of the squelch settings.
      • Backplane facility loopback (drop) is supported on:
        • 100G-LC-C and CFP-LC configured in the TXP mode (with CFP client pluggable) for OTU4 and 100GE client payloads.

        • 100G-CK-C and CFP-LC configured in the TXP mode (with CFP client pluggable) for OTU4 and 100GE client payloads.

        When facility loopback (drop) is provisioned on the backplane interface, the client RX signal is sent back to the client TX port and an ODUk-AIS signal is forwarded to the trunk port in the downstream direction for any of the squelch settings.
    • Fault propagation on 10GE, 40GE, and 100GE clients— In R 10.3, a new squelch option named LF is supported for GigE payloads. A local fault (LF) indication is fowarded to the client port in the downstream direction when a failure on the trunk port occurs. The LF option is supported for :
      • 10GE payloads on 10x10G-LC cards configured in the:
        • RGN-10G or TXP-10G mode

        • MXP-10x10G mode (paired with 100G-LC-C, 100G-CK-C, or 100GS-CK-LC card)

        • MXP-10x10G-100G mode ( paired with a 100GS-CK-LC or 200G-CK-LC card)

      • 100GE payloads on:
        • 100G-LC-C, 100G-CK-LC, 100GS-CK-LC, or 200G-CK-LC cards configured in the TXP-100G mode

        • CFP-LC cards configured in the CFP-TXP mode (paired with 100G-LC-C or 100G-CK-C card)

      • 40GE payloads on:
        • CFP-LC card configured in the 2x40G Muxponder mode (paired with a 100G-LC-C or 100G-CK-C card)

        • 100G-CK-C card configured in the MXP-2x40G mode

    • Trail Trace Identifier—In R 10.3, the Trail Trace Identifier (TTI) in the path monitoring overhead is supported in OTU, and ODU OTN frames. It is possible to to individually manage the Source Access Point Identifer (SAPI), Destination Access Point Identifer (DAPI), and User Operator Data fields on VTXP. This feature is also supported on these cards.

      • 10x10G-LC— OTU4 and ODU4 payloads

      • CFP-LC— OTU4, ODU4, OTU3, and ODU3 payloads

      • 100G-LC-C, 100G-CK-LC, 100GS-CK-LC, 200G-CK-LC— OTU4 and ODU4 payloads

      The Trail Trace Identifier Mismatch (TTIM) alarm is raised after comparing only the SAPI bytes.

      TTI monitoring is not supported between two nodes (node 1, node 2) in the following conditions:
      • Node 1 and node 2 are installed with a release earlier to R10.3. Node 2 is upgraded to R 10.3. New TTI strings provisioned at either node1 or node 2 raises the TTIM alarm.

      • Node 1 is installed with the R 10.3 software. Node 2 is installed with a release earlier to R10.3. New TTI strings provisioned at either node1 or node 2 raises the TTIM alarm.

      • Node 1 is installed with R 10.3 software and TTI settings are configured. Node 2 is installed with the R10.3 software but the database is loaded from a release earlier to R10.3.

    • Generalized Multiprotocol Label Switching — The Generalized Multiprotocol Label Switching (GMPLS) circuit can be created on the 100G-LC-C, 100G-CK-C, 10 x10G-LC, 100GS-CK-LC, and 200G-CK-LC cards. However, this circuit cannot be created when the card is in 100G regenerator mode. When the card is configured in MXP-10 x10G card mode, only GMPLS Optical Channel Network Connections (OCHNCs) can be created.

    • Automatic Laser Shutdown (ALS) can be configured on all the ports. ALS is supported only on the ports that are configured with OC192/STM64, OTU2, and OTU4 payloads.

    • GCC channels—can be provisioned on the OTU2 client and trunk ports of the 10 x10G-LC card, OTU3 port (virtual port on the peer 100G-LC-C or 100G-CK-C card) of the CFP-LC card, and the OTU4 client and trunk ports of the 100G-LC-C or 100G-CK-C card.

    • 50 ms switching with PSM—A protection switch time of less than 50 ms can be achieved with two CFP-LC cards on their 100GE client ports using a PSM card that is configured in the standalone mode. The client ports of the CFP-LC cards are connected to the working and protect ports of the PSM card. An OCHCC circuit must be created between the two client ports. PSM is also supported on 100GS-CK-LC or 200G-CK-LC cards on their trunk ports where the protection switch time of 50 ms is achieved in the TXP-100G configuration with 20%SD FEC.

    • The optical TX power can be set to a value from -10.0 to +0.25 dBm on the trunk port of the 100G-LC-C or 100G-CK-C card, -10.0 to -0.5 dBm for 100GS-CK-LC card; to enable it to interoperate with ASR 9000 series routers and Cisco CRS-3 routers. The TX shutdown feature allows you to turn off the TX power on the 100G-LC-C or 100G-CK-C cards when the trunk port in out of service or in maintenance. The 100G-LC-C and 100G-CK-C cards have the ability to receive optical signals even when the TX power is turned off.

    • Pseudo Random Binary Sequence (PRBS)—For 100G-CK-C and 100G-LC-C cards, the trunk ports can generate PRBS_31 pattern and detect PRBS_11, PRBS_23, and PRBS_31 patterns. Only PRBS_31 is supported on the 100GS-CK-LC card. The detection is always on and does not need to be enabled. The generation can be enabled that prompts the card to fulfill the OPU with PRBS_31 pattern.

    • Licensing—The 100G-LC-C card adds the capability to cost-effectively transport the 10G service offering as a Pay-As-You-Grow licensing model for the 10 x 10G muxponder. A licensed card works in conjunction with a licensed 10 x10G line card. The two cards that can only work in this configuration and in combination of the other licensed pair card offers a price-sensitive solution with the ability to equip one 10G service.

      The 200G-CK-LC card also supports licensing. The 200G-CK-LIC is the licensed card version of the 200G-CK-LC card. The licensed card version has only some basic functionality enabled while other features can be enabled separately with specific licenses. For more information on licensing, see the Cisco NCS 2000 Series Licensing Configuration Guide.


      Note


      Licensing is not supported on the CFP-LC, 100G-CK-C and 100GS-CK-LC cards.


    Functions and Features

    The cards have the following functions and features, explained in the Card Features chapter:
    • Enhanced FEC (E-FEC) Feature

    • Timing Synchronization

    • Jitter Considerations

    • Card level indicators

    • Port level indicators

    Related Procedures for 100G-LC-C, 100G-ME-C, 100G-CK-C, 100ME-CKC, 10x10G-LC, CFP-LC, 100GS-CK-LC, 200G-CK-LC, and MR-MXP Cards

    DLP-L71 Provisioning the Frequency on the 100GS-CK-LC, 200G-CK-LC, and 400G-XP-LC Cards

    Purpose

    This task provisions the frequency on the 100GS-CK-LC, 200G-CK-LC, and 400G-XP-LC cards with 0.1 GHz granularity. This feature is available only in NCS flex package.

    Tools/Equipment

    None

    Prerequisite Procedures

    DLP-G46 Log into CTC

    Required/As Needed

    As needed

    Onsite/Remote

    Onsite or remote

    Security Level

    Provisioning or higher

    Procedure
      Step 1   In node view or shelf view, double-click the 100GS-CK-LC, 200G-CK-LC, or 400G-XP-LC card where you want to provision the frequency on the trunk port.
      Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line > Flex tabs.
      Step 3   Check the Gridless check box to enable gridless tunability on the trunk port of the card.

      When the Gridless check box is checked, the user cannot create internal patchcords, provisionable patchcords, and circuits on the cards. The wavelength cannot be changed and the wavelength is reset to first tunable wavelength.

      Step 4   Enter the Frequency on the trunk port of the card with 0.1 GHz granularity in the Frequency field.
      Step 5   Click Apply.
      Step 6   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

      400G-XP-LC Card

      The 400G-XP-LC card is a tunable DWDM trunk card that simplifies the integration and transport of 10 Gigabit and 100 Gigabit Ethernet interfaces and services into enterprises and service provider optical networks. The card is a double- slot unit that provides 400 Gbps of client and 400 Gbps of trunk capacity. The card supports six QSFP+ based client ports that can be equipped with 4x 10 Gbps optics and four QSFP28 or QSFP+ based client ports that can be equipped with 100 Gbps QSFP28 and 4x 10 Gbps QSFP+ optics. The card is capable of aggregating client traffic to either of the two 200 Gbps coherent CFP2 trunk ports.

      The 400G-XP-LC card supports the following client signals:
      • 10 GE

      • 100 GE

      The 400G-XP-LC card is supported only on Cisco NCS 2006 and Cisco NCS 2015 platforms.

      Three 400G-XP-LC cards can be installed in the Cisco NCS 2006 chassis that is powered by NCS2006-DC, NCS2006-DC40, or NCS2006-AC (180V AC to 264V AC). Seven 400G-XP-LC cards can be installed in the Cisco NCS 2015 chassis that is powered by DC 2 + 2, DC 3 + 1, or AC 2 + 2 PSU.

      For information on safety labels for the cards see the "Class 1M Laser Product Cards" section. For more information about the 400G-XP-LC card, see http:/​/​www.cisco.com/​c/​en/​us/​products/​collateral/​optical-networking/​network-convergence-system-2000-series/​datasheet-c78-736916.html.

      Key Features

      The 400G-XP-LC card supports the following key features:
      • Operating Modes—The card can be configured in the MXP operating mode. The cards can be equipped with pluggables for client and trunk ports, and offer a large variety of configurations. When you configure the card, make sure that the following tasks are completed:
        • The trunk port PPMs must be preprovisioned before configuring the card operating mode.

        • The client payloads can be provisioned after configuring the operational mode on the card.

        The table below details the configurations supported on the 400G-XP-LC card for the MXP card mode.
        Table 46 Configuration Options for the 400G-XP-LC Card

        Configuration

        Options

        Card configuration

        MXP

        Trunk configuration ( per trunk)

        None

        M_100G

        M_200G

        Slice configuration

        None

        OPM_100G

        OPM_10x10G

        For more information about the trunk and slice configuration, see Slice Definition and Line Card Configuration for 400G-XP-LC Card.
      • Each trunk port functions as a muxponder instance has the following features:
        • The trunk port supports Analog Coherent Optical (ACO) CFP2 coherent pluggable.


          Note


          Before removing the CFP2 pluggable from any of two trunk ports, ensure that the relevant trunk port is set to the OOS (Out-of-service) state. Wait until the trunk port LED turns off. Wait for a further 120 seconds before extracting the CFP2 pluggable.


        • Configurable trunk capacity:
          • 100 Gbps coherent DWDM transmission with quadrature phase shift keying (QPSK )modulation.

          • 200 Gbps coherent DWDM transmission with 16-state quadrature amplitude modulation (16-QAM) modulation.

        • Configurable trunk FEC: SD-FEC with 15% or 25% overhead.

        • Configurable differential/non-differential line encoding.

        • Nyquist shaping if channels at trunk TX.

        • Flex spectrum tunability over the full extended C-Band.

        • 100 Gbps through 100 Gbps QSFP28 client ports.

        • 10 Gbps through 4x 10 Gbps QSFP+ client ports.

      • The supported CD ranges are detailed in the table below:
        Table 47 CD Range for 400G-XP-LC Card

        200G 16-QAM

        100G QPSK

        Low

        High

        Low

        High

        Default Working CD Range

        -10000

        50000

        -20000

        90000

        Default CD Thresholds

        -9000

        45000

        -18000

        72000

        Allowed CD Range ( Working and Thresholds)

        -60000

        60000

        -280000

        280000

      • Loopback—The following loopback types are supported:
        • Client ports - Terminal (Inward), Facility (Line)

        • Trunk ports - Terminal (Inward)

        • Iports - Facility (Line), Terminal loopback (Drop)

          Note


          Before you provision loopback on the iports, place the relevant trunk ports in the OOS-MT state. This causes the iports to move to the OOS-MT state.


      • Automatic Laser Shutdown (ALS) can be configured on all the ports.

      • 100GE ethernet client ports can be provisioned with or without IEEE 802.3 bj FEC. The options are Auto, Force-Fec-On, Force-Fec-Off.

      • Trail Trace Identifier (TTI)—TTI in the section monitoring overhead is supported . Source AccessPoint Identifer (SAPI), Destination Access Point Identifer (DAPI), and User Operator Data fields will be supported in a future release.

      • Trunk Port Interworking—The two CFP2 trunk ports can interoperate with each other when the source and destination 400G-XP-LC cards have the same trunk mode and slice mode configuration. For more information, see Trunk Port Interworking in 400G-XP-LC Cards.

      Slice Definition and Line Card Configuration for 400G-XP-LC Card

      The image below displays the client and trunk ports of the 400G-XP-LC card.

      Figure 31. 400G-XP-LC Card



      The client to trunk port mapping is fixed in the 400G-XP-LC card as detailed in the table below.
      Table 48 Trunk -Client Port Mapping on the 400G-XP-LC Card

      Trunk

      Client Port

      Pluggable Type

      Trunk 1 (CFP2-11)- Slice 1 and Slice 2

      Ports 1, 2, 3

      QSFP+

      Ports 7, 8

      QSFP+ or QSFP28 1

      Trunk 2 (CFP2-12) - Slice 3 and Slice 4

      Ports 4, 5, 6

      QSFP+

      Ports 9, 10

      QSFP+ or QSFP28

      1 QSFP+ and QSFP28 share the same form factor.

      The trunk ports can be configured with either 100G or 200G rate. The client ports are grouped into four slices. The slice mode defines the aggregation capacity and can be configured independently.

      The configuration of each of the two trunk ports is independent and is done using either one of the two trunk operating modes.

      Trunk Operating Modes (trunk capacity)
      • M-100G: 100G QPSK . One slice is enabled on the trunk. Slice 2 is enabled for Trunk 1 and Slice 4 is enabled on Trunk 2.

      • M-200G: 200G 16 QAM. Two slices are enabled on the trunk.

      Slice Mode:
      • OPM-100G: Enables 100G client on the QSFP 28 port.

      • OPM-10x10G: Enables 10G client over a set of QSFP+ ports.

      Traffic from the client ports are aggregated on the 100G or 200G trunk at the intermediate ports. There are four intermediate ports (iports) , two per trunk. The iports are automatically configured when the slices are configured.

      The relation between the two trunk ports ( Ports 11 and 12) , client ports (Ports 1 through 10) and the four slices are represented in the tables below.
      Table 49 Trunk, Slice, and Port Configuration for Trunk 1 of the 400G-XP-LC Card

      Trunk 1

      Client Ports

      Trunk Mode

      Slice Operation Mode

      1

      2 2

      3

      7

      8

      Slice 1

      Slice 2

      Port Lanes

      M-200G

      OPM-100G

      OPM-100G

      -

      -

      -

      4x 3

      4x

      OPM-100G

      OPM-10x10G

      -

      3,4

      1 to 4

      4x

      1 to 4

      OPM-10x10G

      OPM-100G

      1 to 4

      1, 2

      -

      1 to 4

      4x

      OPM-10x10G

      OPM-10x10G

      1 to 4

      1 to 4

      1 to 4

      1 to 4

      1 to 4

      M-100G

      NA

      OPM-100G

      -

      -

      4x

      OPM-10x10G

      3,4

      1 to 4

      1 to 4

      2 Port 2 is shared between Slice 1 and Slice 2
      3 4x refers to all four lanes of the QSFP28 pluggable
      Table 50 Trunk, Slice, and Port Configuration for Trunk 2 of the 400G-XP-LC Card

      Trunk 2

      Client Ports

      Trunk Mode

      Slice Operation Mode

      4

      5

      4

      6

      9

      10

      Slice 3

      Slice 4

      Port Lanes

      M-200G

      OPM-100G

      OPM-100G

      -

      -

      -

      4x

      4x

      OPM-100G

      OPM-10x10G

      -

      3,4

      1 to 4

      4x

      1 to 4

      OPM-10x10G

      OPM-100G

      1 to 4

      1, 2

      -

      1 to 4

      4x

      OPM-10x10G

      OPM-10x10G

      1 to 4

      1 to 4

      1 to 4

      1 to 4

      1 to 4

      M-100G

      NA

      OPM-100G

      -

      -

      -

      -

      1 to 4

      OPM-10x10G

      3,4

      1 to 4

      1 to 4

      4 Port 5 is shared between Slice 3 and Slice 4

      Trunk Port Interworking in 400G-XP-LC Cards

      To provide greater flexibility on the network design and deployment, the two CFP2 trunk ports of the 400G-XP-LC card can interoperate with each other when the same trunk operating mode and slice configurations exist on both source and destination cards.

      OCHCC circuits can be created between compatible client ports as detailed in the tables below.
      Table 51 Compatible Client Ports for M-100G Trunk Port Configuration

      Trunk 1 - CFP2 Port 11

      Source/Destination Client Ports

      Source/Destination Client Ports

      Trunk 2 - CFP2 Port 12

      Slice configuration 1

      Slice 2: OPM_100G

      8

      10

      Slice 4: OPM_100G

      Slice configuration 1

      Slice configuration 2

      Slice 2: OPM_10x10G

      2-3

      5-3

      Slice 4: OPM_10x10G

      Slice configuration 2

      2-4

      5-4

      3-1

      6-1

      3-2

      6-2

      3-3

      6-3

      3-4

      6-4

      8-1

      10-1

      8-2

      10-2

      8-3

      10-3

      8-4

      10-4

      Table 52 Compatible Client Ports for M-200G Trunk Port Configuration

      Trunk 1 - CFP2 Port 11

      Source/Destination Client Ports

      Source/Destination Client Ports

      Trunk 2 - CFP2 Port 12

      Slice configuration 1

      Slice1: OPM_100G

      7

      9

      Slice 3: OPM_100G

      Slice configuration 1

      Slice 2: OPM_100G

      8

      10

      Slice 4: OPM_100G

      Slice 1: OPM_100G

      7

      9

      Slice 3: OPM_100G

      Slice configuration 2

      Slice 2: OPM_10x10G

      2-3

      5-3

      Slice 4: OPM_10x10G

      Slice configuration 2

      2-4

      5-4

      3-1

      6-1

      3-2

      6-2

      3-3

      6-3

      3-4

      6-4

      8-1

      10-1

      8-2

      10-2

      8-3

      10-3

      8-4

      10-4

      Slice configuration 3

      Slice 1: OPM_10x10G

      1-1

      4-1

      Slice 3: OPM_10x10G

      Slice configuration 3

      1-2

      4-2

      1-3

      4-3

      1-4

      4-4

      2-1

      5-1

      2-2

      5-2

      7-1

      9-1

      7-2

      9-2

      7-3

      9-3

      7-4

      9-4

      Slice 2: OPM_100G

      8

      10

      Slice 4: OPM_100G

      Slice configuration 4

      Slice 1: OPM_10x10G

      1-1

      4-1

      Slice 3: OPM_10x10G

      Slice configuration 4

      1-2

      4-2

      1-3

      4-3

      1-4

      4-4

      2-1

      5-1

      2-2

      5-2

      7-1

      9-1

      7-2

      9-2

      7-3

      9-3

      7-4

      9-4

      Slice 2: OPM_10x10G

      2-3

      5-3

      Slice 4: OPM_10x10G

      2-4

      5-4

      3-1

      6-1

      3-2

      6-2

      3-3

      6-3

      3-4

      6-4

      8-1

      10-1

      8-2

      10-2

      8-3

      10-3

      8-4

      10-4

      Related Procedures for 400G-XP-LC Cards

      WSE Card

      The Wire Speed Encryption (WSE) card is an optical line card that provides encryption capability, at the OTN layer, to the Cisco NCS 2000 Series and platforms. This card provides confidentiality of the data, which is sent over a fiber optic communication channel, using Next Generation Cryptography. In addition to providing encryption, this card also provides integrated transponder functionality.

      The WSE card supports these client signals:
      • 10GE LAN PHY mapped to OTU2e

      • OTU2

      • OTU2e

      • OTU1e

      • OC-192/STM-64

      • 10GE WAN

      • 10GE LAN mapped to OTU2

      • 8G FC/10G FC

      The WSE card does not support auto negotiation for SAN protocols (10GFC/8GFC). The WSE card supports only speed lock for SAN protocols.

      The WSE card is tunable on 96 wavelength channels, spaced at 50-GHz over the entire C-band. The digital wrapper function (ITU-T G.709 compliant) formats the DWDM wavelength so that it can be used to set up GCCs for data communications, enable FEC, or facilitate PM. The WSE card works with the OTN devices defined in ITU-T G.709. The OTN client can be FEC, standard G.975 FEC, or disabled FEC.

      For information on safety labels for the cards, see the "Class 1M Laser Product Cards" section.


      Caution


      A 15 to 20 dB fiber attenuator must be used when working with the cards in a loopback on the trunk port. Do not use direct fiber loopbacks with the cards. Using direct fiber loopbacks causes irreparable damage to the DWDM/CWDM XFP/SFPs plugged in WSE card.


      The WSE card is a single-slot card and can be installed in any service slots in the chassis. The card has 10 SFP+ ports. The trunk and client ports are fixed. The trunk ports are 2, 4, 6, 8, and 10; the client ports are 1, 3, 5, 7, and 9. The trunk SFP+ can be grey or DWDM. The trunks include FEC and EFEC for longer reach. Depending on the traffic pattern, the WSE card provides per port flexibility.

      Up to six WSE cards can be installed per Cisco NCS 2002 shelf assembly, supporting up to 30 encrypted streams in a 2-rack unit (RU) bay frame. Up to two WSE cards can be installed per Cisco NCS 2006 shelf assembly, supporting up to 10 encrypted streams in a 6-rack unit (RU) bay frame. It is possible to aggregate the wavelength required with 40G and 100G cards in the same chassis.

      Key Features

      The WSE card supports these key features:

      • Operating Modes—The WSE card can be configured into multiple operating modes. The card can be equipped with pluggables for client and trunk options, and offers a large variety of configurations. For more information about multiple operating modes, see Multiple Operating Modes, page 11-137.

      • Security Features

        • Secure Boot—This feature does a boot verification in hardware. It ensures that only authentic Cisco software boots up on the Cisco platform, and provides tamper and cloning resistance.

        • Digital Image Signing—After the secure boot, the Digital Image Signing ensures that the software that runs on Cisco devices is authentic. This maintains the integrity of the image that is loaded on the WSE card.

        • Key Exchange—Key exchange between authenticated peer cards happens over the GCC2 channel that is secured using Transport Layer Security (TLS). The Elliptic Curve Diffie Hellman Ephemeral (ECDHE) algorithm is used for key exchange.

        • Confidentiality of Data—The WSE card protects against ciphertext manipulation and cut-and-paste attempts. AES algorithm in XTS mode of operation.

        • Role Based Access Control—Access control is enforced to ensure that there is complete separation in managing the transport (provisioning) and the security functionalities. As a result, depending on the role assigned to a user, only certain operations can be performed by that user.

      • Card Authentication—The Secure Unique Device Identification (SUDI) certificate that is formatted as an X.509 certificate and conforms to the IEEE 802.1 AR standard. It is signed using Cisco's Root Certificate Authority. This certificate carries a unique identifier used to authenticate the peer card as being a WSE card before the data is exchanged. Information cannot be exchanged with a card that is not authenticated.

      • High Speed GCCs—The WSE card supports the provisioning of GCC channel on OTN (OTU2/OTU2e) enabled client and trunk ports. A maximum of ten GCC0 channels, on Cisco NCS 2002 or Cisco NCS 2006 shelf, can be created and a maximum of five for GCC2 Cisco NCS 2002 or Cisco NCS 2006 shelf can be created.

      • OCH-trail Protection—Provides protection for the DWDM signals through external optical switch units (Protection Switch Module [PSM]).

      • Licensing—A licensed version of the card provides a cost-effective solution for customers who do not need to encrypt data on all five streams from day one itself. The licensed WSE card provides single stream encryption as a base functionality. When an additional encrypted stream is required, you need to purchase a software ugrade license. Licensing is required for only security features. A WSE card without a license acts as for transponder. For more information on licensing, see the Cisco NCS 2000 Series Licensing Configuration Guide.

      For information on safety labels for the cards, see the "Class 1M Laser Product Cards" section.

      WSE Workflow Diagram

      The following figure shows the workflow diagram of the WSE card. The diagram provides information on the tasks required to configure the WSE card.

      Multiple Operating Modes

      A single WSE card can be configured into multiple operating modes. The criteria for selecting a particular operating mode are defined by the network level design. CTP helps you to choose the appropriate operating mode. When you configure the WSE card into multiple operating modes, make sure that these tasks are completed:

      • The PPMs must be configured on the card, and then the operating modes. None of the modes are provisioned on the card by default. All operating modes are created on a per port basis. This is card-specific provisioning, which decides the behavior of a particular card.

      • Depending on the card mode selected, the supported payload for that particular card mode must be provisioned on the PPMs.

      The WSE card supports these operating modes:

      • TXP-10G

      • RGN-10G

      A mix of TXP-10G and RGN-10G modes can be configured on the WSE card.

      TXP-10G

      A maximum of five TXP-10G configurations can be provisioned on a single WSE card. When the card is configured in this mode, these features are supported:

      • Enable or disable card authentication

      • Enable or disable payload encryption

      OTN cannot be disabled on the trunk port.

      Table 53 Supported Payload Mapping in TXP-10G Mode

      Client Payload

      Trunk Mapping

      10GE LAN PHY-CBR

      OTU2e

      OTU2

      OTU2

      OTU2e

      OTU2e

      RGN-10G

      In the RGN-10G mode, the card behaves as a standard regenerator with DWDM SFP+ on both the client and trunk ports. The card supports OTU2e regeneration on all client and trunk pairs. When the WSE card is configured in this mode, card authentication and payload encryption features are not supported.

      The OTN cannot be disabled when the card is configured in RGN-10G mode.

      Card Authentication

      The WSE cards provide TLS 1.2 based card-to-card authentication per port. An authentication failure on one trunk port does not affect the traffic on any other trunk port. The card authentication must be enabled to configure encryption on the card.

      Cisco Signed certificates are installed on the WSE card by default. These certificates are exchanged between the cards during card authentication.

      All ports are re-authenticated upon a soft-reset of the card.

      In case of TLS or SSL authentication failure, the KEY_EX_FAIL alarm is raised on the particular trunk port.

      Key Management

      A single key, called a master key, is exchanged for each TLS session. It is exchanged using an asymmetric key algorithm (Elliptic Curve Diffie Hellman). The master key is used to derive a set of symmetric keys for payload encryption.

      The user can change the master key at anytime from CTC, which initiates another DH exchange between the sender and the receiver. The user can also specify the time when the master key is periodically reset.

      The keys used for encryption of data are never stored in plaintext on the card. All keys are deleted when the card reboots or is removed from the chassis. The key changes do not affect the traffic.

      Important Notes on KEY-EX-FAIL Alarm

      • After an upgrade of a software version, KEY-EX-FAIL alarm may be raised due to soft reset of the card. However, the traffic is not impacted, and the alarm will be cleared in the next exchange interval of the master key

      • When the MANRESET alarm (Manual System Reset alarm) is cleared on a client WSE card, the KEY-EX-FAIL alarm might be raised due to soft reset of the card. The alarm is raised when the server exits the existing connection and establishes a new connection during this period. However, the traffic is not impacted.

      Payload Encryption

      The payload on each port can be encrypted independent of the other streams. NIST approved Advanced Encryption Standard (AES) AES-256, a symmetric key cryptographic algorithm in XTS mode of operation, is used to encrypt the OTN payload. The payload encryption needs to be enabled at both source and destination trunk ports; otheriwse, it is traffic affecting.

      AES Secure Packet

      The concept of a packet does not exist within OTN; however, packet-based traffic is necessary for encryption using XTS-AES algorithm. A single OTN frame cannot be tagged with the necessary Encapsulating Security Payload (ESP) header, which carry the information necessary for encryption and decryption of payloads. The ESP header and trailer require a total of 32 bytes within the OTN overhead.

      The AES secure packet for each port can be made up of four or eight OTN frames. In CTC, the user can choose from these two options for transporting the ESP header and trailer:

      • Four OTN frame based AES secure packet—The four OTN frame-based AES secure packet transports four ESP header and four ESP trailer bytes within each OTN frame. In the four OTN frame-based AES secure packet, eight overhead bytes are utilized in each OTN frame in order to transport all 32 bytes of ESP header and trailer within a single AES secure packet. Each location is four bytes wide, therefore two locations from each OTN frame are utilized, one for the ESP header and one for the ESP trailer.

      • Eight OTN frame based AES secure packet— The eight OTN frame-based AES secure packet transports two ESP header and two ESP trailer bytes within each OTN frame. In the eight OTN frame-based AES secure packet, four overhead bytes are utilized in each OTN frame in order to transport all 32 bytes of ESP header and trailer within a single AES secure packet. Each location is four bytes wide; therefore, only one location from each OTN is utilized. Within the selected location, two bytes are used for the ESP header, and two bytes for the ESP trailer.

      Pseudo Random Binary Sequence (PRBS) testing is used to ensure that the selected overhead bytes can be used to transport the ESP header and trailer safely. Both the transmitting node and receiving node must be aware that PRBS testing is taking place. Each node must also know which bytes are to be tested.

      Scenarios that Affect Traffic

      Scenario 1: Traffic in a Stacked Topology

      Consider an example where the WSE cards are connected in a stacked topology:

      Client:WSE1:Trunk===Trunk:WSE2:Client===Client:WSE3:Trunk===Trunk:WSE4:Client

      where WSE:Trunk represents OTU2e payload and WSE:Client represents 10GE signal.

      In this scenario, card-to-card authentication and payload encryption are enabled on all the trunk ports, and loopback is not configured.

      In this stacked topology, the WSE2 and WSE3 client will report a synchronization loss since the keys are different, and an ODUk-AIS is raised on the trunk ports. The key is not exchanged between WSE1 and WSE2 cards, and WSE 3 and WSE4 cards. This creates a deadlock and the traffic does not recover.

      Scenario 2: Traffic in a Far-end and Near-end Client Loopback

      Consider an example where loopback is configured on the WSE cards:

      TS(10GE): near-end WSE1(client):(trunk)=== far-end WSE2(trunk):(client loopback)

      where the trunk represents OTU2e payload and client represents 10GE signal.

      In WSE card, do not enable encryption with far-end or near-end client loopback as this results in synchronization loss at the client, and an ODUk-AIS is raised on the trunk port. The key is exchanged only after the ODUk-AIS on the trunk is cleared. This forms a deadlock and the traffic does not recover.

      Scenario 3: Traffic After Enabling PRBS Ingress and Egress

      In a scenario when WSE cards are connected in a point-to-point setup:

      10GE(client)===OTU2e(trunk)----OTU2e(trunk)===10GE(client-loopback)

      When PRBS Ingress and Egress are enabled at both ends of the setup, the traffic will go down.

      The traffic may be down on enabling PRBS, but the traffic comes up after disabling PRBS.

      Functions and Features

      The cards have the following functions and features, explained in the "Card Features" chapter:
      • Enhanced FEC (E-FEC) Feature

      • Timing Synchronization

      • Card level indicators

      • Port level indicators

      Scenarios that Affect Traffic

      Scenario 1: Traffic in a Stacked Topology

      Consider an example where the WSE cards are connected in a stacked topology:

      Client:WSE1:Trunk===Trunk:WSE2:Client===Client:WSE3:Trunk===Trunk:WSE4:Client

      where WSE:Trunk represents OTU2e payload and WSE:Client represents 10GE signal.

      In this scenario, card-to-card authentication and payload encryption are enabled on all the trunk ports, and loopback is not configured. In this stacked topology, the WSE2 and WSE3 client will report a synchronization loss since the keys are different, and an ODUk-AIS is raised on the trunk ports. The key is not exchanged between WSE1 and WSE2 cards, and WSE 3 and WSE4 cards. This creates a deadlock and the traffic does not recover.

      Scenario 2: Traffic in a Far-end and Near-end Client Loopback

      Consider an example where loopback is configured on the WSE cards:

      TS(10GE): near-end WSE1(client):(trunk)=== far-end WSE2(trunk):(client loopback)

      where the trunk represents OTU2e payload and client represents 10GE signal.

      In WSE card, do not enable encryption with far-end or near-end client loopback as this results in synchronization loss at the client, and an ODUk-AIS is raised on the trunk port. The key is exchanged only after the ODUk-AIS on the trunk is cleared. This forms a deadlock and the traffic does not recover.

      Scenario 3: Traffic After Enabling PRBS Ingress and Egress

      In a scenario when WSE cards are connected in a point-to-point setup:

      10GE(client)===OTU2e(trunk)----OTU2e(trunk)===10GE(client-loopback)

      When PRBS Ingress and Egress are enabled at both ends of the setup, the traffic will go down. When PRBS Ingress and Egress are enabled at both ends of the setup, the traffic will go down.


      Note


      When software version is downgraded to a previous version, the traffic may be affected with frame loss and BIP errors.

      Related Procedures for WSE Card

      MLSE UT

      The maximum likelihood sequence estimation (MLSE) based universal transponder (UT) modules are added to the TXP_MR_10EX_C, MXP_2.5G_10EX_C, and MXP_MR_10DMEX_C cards to support the error decorrelator functionality to enhance system performance.

      Error Decorrelator

      The MLSE feature uses the error decorrelator functionality to reduce the chromatic dispersion (CD) and polarization mode dispersion (PMD), thereby extending the transmission range on the trunk interface. You can enable or disable the error decorrelator functionality using CTC or TL1. The dispersion compensation unit (DCU) is also used to reduce CD and PMD. The MLSE-based UT module helps to reduce CD and PMD without the use of a DCU.

      SFP, SFP+, QSFP+, XFP, CXP, CFP, and CPAK Modules

      Small Form-factor Pluggable (SFP), Enhanced Small-Form-factor Pluggable (SFP+), Quad Small-Form-factor Pluggable Plus (QSFP+), 10-Gbps SFP (XFP), CXP, and C Form-factor pluggable (CFP and CPAK) modules are integrated fiber optic transceivers that provide high-speed serial links from a port or slot to the network. For more information on SFP, SFP+, QSFP+, XFP, CXP, CFP, and CPAK modules and for a list of SFP, SFP+, XFP, CXP, CFP, and CPAK modules supported by the transponder and muxponder cards, see the Installing the GBIC, SFP, SFP+, XFP, CXP, and CFP Optical Modules in Cisco NCS Platforms.

      In CTC, SFP, SFP+, QSFP+, XFP, CXP, CFP, and CPAK modules are called pluggable port modules (PPMs). To provision SFP, SFP+, QSFP+, XFP, CXP, CFP, or CPAK module and change the line rate for multirate PPMs, see the DLP-G725 Preprovisioning PPM Slot task.

      NTP-G128 Managing Pluggable Port Modules

      Purpose

      Complete this procedure to provision a multirate PPM, provision the optical line rate of a multirate PPM, or delete a single-rate or multirate PPM.

      Tools/Equipment

      None

      Prerequisite Procedures

      Required/As Needed

      As needed

      Onsite/Remote

      Onsite or remote

      Security Level

      Provisioning or higher


      Note


      If a single-rate PPM is installed, the PPM screen will autoprovision and no further steps are necessary.



      Note


      When you autoprovision a PPM, initial alarm and TCA defaults are supplied by Cisco Transport Controller (CTC) depending on your port and rate selections and the type of PPM. These default values can be changed after you install the PPM.



      Note


      The hardware device that plugs into a TXP, MXP, AR_MXP, AR_XP, AR_XPE, 100G-LC-C, 10x10G-LC, CFP-LC, 100G-CK-C, 100G-ME-C, , 200G-CK-LC, 400G-XP-LC, 100ME-CKC, WSE, GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, 10GE_XPE, ADM-10G, or OTU2_XP card faceplate to provide a fiber interface to the card is called a Small Form-factor Pluggable (SFP, SFP+, XFP, or CXP) or C Form-factor pluggable (CFP, CFP2). In CTC, SFPs, XFPs, CXPs, and CFPs are called pluggable port modules (PPMs). SFPs/XFPs/CXPs/CFPs/CFP2s are hot-swappable I/O devices that plug into a port to link the port with the fiber-optic network. Multirate PPMs have provisionable port rates and payloads. For more information about SFP, SFP+, QSFP+, XFP, CXP, CFP, and CPAK Modules.


      Procedure
        Step 1   Click the Alarms tab:
        1. Verify that the alarm filter is not turned on. See the "DLP-G128 Disable Alarm Filtering" as necessary.
        2. Verify that no unexplained conditions appear. If unexplained conditions appear, resolve them before continuing. Refer to the Cisco NCS 2000 Series Troubleshooting Guide.
        Step 2   If you are provisioning a MXP_MR_2.5G or MXPP_MR_2.5G card, complete the “DLP-G235 Change the 2.5G Data Muxponder Card Mode” task on page 11-145. If not, continue with Step 3
        Step 3   If you are provisioning a MXP_MR_10DME_C, MXP_MR_10DME_L, or MXP_MR_10DMEX_C card, complete the “DLP-G332 Change the 10G Data Muxponder Port Mode” task on page 11-146. If not, continue with Step 4.
        Step 4   If you are provisioning a GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE card, complete the “DLP-G379 Change the GE_​XP, 10GE_​XP, GE_​XPE, and 10GE_​XPE Card Mode” task on page 11-148. If not, continue with Step 5.
        Step 5   If you are provisioning a OTU2_XP card, complete the “DLP-G452 Change the OTU2_​XP Card Mode” task on page 11-150. If not, continue with Step 6.
        Step 6   If you are provisioning a PPM on an ADM-10G card, complete the “DLP-G411 Provision an ADM-10G PPM and Port” task on page 11-149. If not, continue with Step 10.
        Step 7   If you are provisioning a PPM on an AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card, complete the NTP-G321 Provisioning Multiple Operating Modes. If not, continue with Step 10.
        Step 8   If you are provisioning a PPM on an 100G-LC-C, 10x10G-LC, CFP-LC, 100G-CK-C, 100G-ME-C, or 100ME-CKC card, complete the NTP-G235 Provisioning an Operating Mode. If not, continue with Step 10.
        Step 9   If you are provisioning a PPM on an 400G-XP-LC card, complete the NTP-G361 Provisioning an Operating Mode on the 400G-XP-LC Card. If not, continued with Step 10.
        Step 10   If you are provisioning a PPM on a WSE card, complete the NTP-G338 Provisioning an Operating Mode on the WSE Card. If not, continue with Step 10.
        Step 11   Complete the DLP-G725 Preprovisioning PPM Slot task for TXP, MXP, AR_MXP, AR_XP, AR_XPE, 100G-LC-C, 10x10G-LC, CFP-LC, 100G-CK-C, 100G-ME-C,, 200G-CK-LC, 100ME-CKC, 400G-XP-LC, WSE, GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, 10GE_XPE, or OTU2_XP ports with multirate PPMs. If you already preprovisioned the multirate PPM, skip this step and continue with Step 11.
        Step 12   If you are provisioning an IBM ETR_CLO (External Time Reference – Control Link Oscillator) or InterSystem Coupling Link (ISC) service on the PPM, complete “DLP-G274 Verify Topologies for ETR_​CLO and ISC Services” task on page 11-151. Otherwise, continue with Step 12.
        Step 13   Complete the “DLP-G278 Provision the Optical Line Rate” task on page 11-153 to assign a line rate to a TXP, MXP, AR_MXP, AR_XP, AR_XPE, WSE, 100G-LC-C, 10x10G-LC, CFP-LC, 100G-CK-C, 100G-ME-C, , 200G-CK-LC, 100ME-CKC, 400G-XP-LC, or OTU2_XP port after the PPM is provisioned. (This task is not performed for GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE _XPE cards.)
        Step 14   If you need to delete a PPM at any point in this procedure, complete the DLP-G727 Delete PPM Provisioning task. Stop. You have completed this procedure.

        DLP-G235 Changing the 2.5G Data Muxponder Card Mode

        Purpose

        This task changes the card mode for MXP_MR_2.5G and MXPP_MR_2.5G muxponder cards. The card mode determines which PPMs can be provisioned for the card.

        Tools/Equipment

        None

        Prerequisite Procedures

        DLP-G46 Log into CTC

        Required/As Needed

        As needed

        Onsite/Remote

        Onsite or remote

        Security Level

        Provisioning or higher

        Procedure
          Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the MXP_MR_2.5G or MXPP_MR_2.5G card where you want to change the card settings.
          Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line > SONET (ANSI) or SDH (ETSI) tabs.
          Step 3   Locate the Trunk port table row and verify that the Service State column value is OOS-MA,DSBLD (ANSI) or Locked-enabled,disabled (ETSI). If the service state is correct, continue with Step 6. If not, complete the following steps:
          1. Click the Admin State table cell and choose OOS,DSBLD (ANSI) or Locked,Maintenance (ETSI).
          2. Click Apply, then Yes.
          Step 4   Click the Provisioning > Line > Client tabs.
          Step 5   Locate the Trunk port table row and verify that the Service State column value is OOS-MA,DSBLD (ANSI) or Locked-enabled,disabled (ETSI). If the service state is correct, continue with Step 6. If not, complete the following steps:
          1. Click the Admin State table cell and choose OOS,DSBLD (ANSI) or Locked,Maintenance (ETSI).
          2. Click Apply, then Yes.
          Step 6   Click the Provisioning > Card tabs.
          Step 7   Change the Card Mode as needed:
          • FC-GE—Choose this option if you will provision any of the following PPM port rates: FC1G (Ports 1-1 and 2-1 only), FC2G (Port 1-1 only), FICON1G (Ports 1-1 and 2-1 only), FICON2G (Port 1-1 only), and ONE_GE (Ports 1-1 through 8-1).

          • Mixed—Choose this option if you will provision any of the following PPM port rates: FC1G and ONE_GE (Port 1–1 only), ESCON (Ports 5–1 through 8-1 only)

          • ESCON—Choose this option if you will provision the ESCON PPM on Ports 1-1 through 8-1.

            Note   

            The Provisioning > Card tab also has the display-only Tunable Wavelengths field. This field shows the supported wavelengths of the trunk port after the card is installed in the format: 
first wavelength-last wavelength-frequency spacing-number of supported wavelengths. 
For example, 1529.55nm-1561.83nm-50gHz-82.

          Step 8   Click Apply.
          Step 9   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

          DLP-G332 Changing the 10G Data Muxponder Port Mode

          Purpose

          This task changes the port mode for the MXP_MR_10DME_C, MXP_MR_10DME_L, and MXP_MR_10DMEX_C muxponder cards. The port mode determines which PPMs can be provisioned on the ports.

          Tools/Equipment

          None

          Prerequisite Procedures

          DLP-G46 Log into CTC

          Required/As Needed

          As needed

          Onsite/Remote

          Onsite or remote

          Security Level

          Provisioning or higher


          Note


          The MXP_MR_10DME_C, MXP_MR_10DME_L, and MXP_MR_10DMEX_C cards have two port mode groups, one for Ports 1 through 4, and the second for Ports 5 through 8. To change the port mode, all ports within the selected port group must be in OOS (out-of-service) service state. Ports in the second port group do not need to be in OOS service state if you are not changing the port mode for the second port group. Before you change the port mode, you must also ensure that any PPM port rate provisioned for the selected port group is deleted (see the DLP-G727 Delete PPM Provisioning).


          Procedure
            Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the MXP_MR_10DME_C, MXP_MR_10DME_L, or MXP_MR_10DMEX_C card where you want to change the port mode.
            Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Card tabs.
            Step 3   Change the port mode as described in Table 11-47.
            Note   

            The PPM port rates are provisioned in the DLP-G725 Preprovisioning PPM Slot task.

            Table 54 10G Data Muxponder Card Port Modes

            Parameter

            Description

            Options

            Port 1-4 Mode

            Sets the mode of operation for Ports 1-1 through 4-1.

            Chose one of the following:

            • FC-GE_ISC—Choose this option if you will provision any of the following PPM port rates: FC1G (Ports 1-1 through 4-1), FC2G (Ports 1-1 and 3-1 only), FICON1G (Ports 1-1 through 4-1), FICON2G (Ports 1-1 and 3-1 only), ONE_GE (Ports 1-1 through 4-1), ISC3 COMPAT (Ports 1-1 through 4-1), ISC3 PEER 1G (Ports 1-1 through 4-1), and ISC3 PEER 2G (Ports 1-1 and 3-1 only).

            • FC4G—Choose this option if you will provision an FC4G or FICON4G PPM (Port 1-1 only).

            Port 5-8 Mode

            Sets the mode of operation for Ports 5-1 through 8-1.

            Chose one of the following:

            • FC-GE_ISC—choose this option if you will provision any of the following PPM port rates: FC1G (Ports 5-1 through 8-1), FC2G (Ports 5-1 and 7-1 only), FICON1G (Ports 5-1 through 8-1), FICON2G (Ports 5-1 and 7-1 only), ONE_GE (Ports 5-1 through 8-1), ISC3 COMPAT (Ports 5-1 through 8-1), ISC3 PEER 1G (Ports 5-1 through 8-1), and ISC3 PEER 2G (Ports 5-1 and 7-1 only).

            • FC4G—choose this option if you will provision an FC4G or FICON4G PPM port rate (Port 5-1 only).

            Note   

            The Provisioning > Cards tab also has a display-only Tunable Wavelengths field which shows the wavelengths supported by the card. If a MXP_MR_10DME_C card is installed, the 32 C-band wavelengths appear. If the MXP_MR_10DME_L card is installed, the 32 L-band wavelengths appear. If the MXP_MR_10DMEX_C card is installed, the 82 C-band wavelengths appear.

            Step 4   Click Apply.
            Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).
            Note   

            Loopbacks on MXP-MR-10DME are not applicable when Fiber Channel switches are present.

            Note   

            If the Fiber Channel switch version is not present then the Distance Extension settings are not supported.


            DLP-G379 Changing the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE Card Mode

            Purpose

            This task changes the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE card mode. 10GE_XP and 10GE_XPE cards can be provisioned as a Layer 2 Ethernet switch or a 10G Ethernet TXP. GE_XP and GE_XPE cards can be provisioned as a Layer 2 Ethernet switch, 10G Ethernet MXP, or 20G Ethernet MXP.

            Tools/Equipment

            None

            Prerequisite Procedures

            DLP-G46 Log into CTC

            Required/As Needed

            As needed

            Onsite/Remote

            Onsite or remote

            Security Level

            Provisioning or higher

            Procedure
              Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card where you want to change the card mode.
              Step 2   In card view, click Provisioning > Ether Ports > Ports.
              Step 3   Verify that any provisioned client or trunk ports have an OOS-MA,DSBLD (ANSI) or Locked-enabled,disabled(ETSI) service state in the Service State column. If so, continue with Step 4. If not, complete the following substeps.
              1. For the first port that is not out of service, in the Admin State column, choose OOS-MA,DSBLD (ANSI) or Locked-enabled,disabled (ETSI).
              2. Repeat Step a for each port that is not out of service.
              3. Click Apply.
              Step 4   Click the Provisioning > Card tabs.
              Step 5   Choose one of the following card modes:
              Table 55 GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE Card Modes

              Mode

              Cards

              Description

              L2 over DWDM

              GE_XP

              10GE_XP

              GE_XPE

              10GE_XPE

              Provisions the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE as a Layer 2 switch.

              10GE TXP

              10GE_XP

              10GE_XPE

              Provisions the 10GE_XP or 10GE_XPE as a 10 Gigabit Ethernet transponder. Traffic received on the 10GE client Port 1-1 is sent to 10 Gigabit Ethernet trunk Port 3-1, and traffic received on 10 Gigabit Ethernet client Port 2-1 is sent to 10 Gigabit Ethernet trunk Port 4-1.

              10GE MXP

              GE_XP

              GE_XPE

              Provisions the GE_XP or GE_XPE as a 10 Gigabit Ethernet muxponder. Traffic received on Gigabit Ethernet client Ports 1-1 through 10-1 is multiplexed and sent to 10 Gigabit Ethernet trunk Port 21-1, and traffic received on Gigabit Ethernet client Ports 11-1 through 20-1 is multiplexed and sent to 10 Gigabit Ethernet trunk Port 22-1.

              20GE MXP

              GE_XP

              GE_XPE

              Provisions the GE_XP or GE_XPE as a 20 Gigabit Ethernet muxponder. Traffic received on Gigabit Ethernet client Ports 1-1 through 20-1 is multiplexed and sent to 10 Gigabit Ethernet trunk Port 21-1. Trunk port 22-1 is not used.

              The GE-XP and GE-XPE cards operating in 10GE MXP mode and configured for 100% traffic flow, do not drop frames when up to nine ports are in use. However, when all the ten ports are in use, some frames are dropped. When the tenth port is to be used, configure the Committed Info Rate (CIR) at 55% on any one of the ports. For more information about configuring the CIR, see DLP-G380 Provisioning Ethernet Settings.

              Step 6   Click Apply, then click Yes in the confirmation dialog box.
              Step 7   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

              DLP-G411 Provisioning an ADM-10G PPM and Port

              Purpose

              This task provisions a fixed-rate PPM and port on an ADM-10G PPM card.

              Tools/Equipment

              None

              Prerequisite Procedures

              DLP-G46 Log into CTC

              Required/As Needed

              As needed

              Onsite/Remote

              Onsite or remote

              Security Level

              Provisioning or higher

              Procedure
                Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the ADM-10G card where you want to provision PPM settings.
                Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Pluggable Port Modules tabs.
                Step 3   In the Pluggable Port Modules area, click Create. The Create PPM dialog box appears.
                Step 4   In the Create PPM dialog box, complete the following:
                • PPM—Choose the SFP you want to install from the drop-down list.

                • PPM Type—Choose the number of ports supported by your SFP from the drop-down list. If only one port is supported,PPM (1 port) is the only option.

                Step 5   Click OK. The newly created PPM appears in the Pluggable Port Modules area. The row in the Pluggable Port Modules area turns white and the Actual Equipment Type column lists the equipment name.
                Step 6   In the Pluggable Ports area, click Create. The Create Ports dialog box appears.
                Step 7   In the Create Ports dialog box, complete the following:
                • Port—Choose the port you want to configure from the drop-down list.

                • Port Type—Choose the port type, such as OC-3, OC-12, OC-48, or ONE-GE from the drop-down list.

                  • Ports 1 - 8 can only be OC-3, OC-12, or ONE_GE

                  • Ports 9 - 12 can on be OC-3 or OC-12

                  • Ports 13 - 16 can only be OC-3, OC-12, or OC-48

                Step 8   Click OK. The newly created port appears in the Pluggable Ports area. The port type you provisioned is listed in the Rate column.
                Step 9   If you want to provision a PPM or another port, repeat Steps 4 through 8.
                Step 10   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                DLP-G452 Changing the OTU2_XP Card Mode

                Purpose

                This task changes the OTU2_XP card mode. The card mode determines which PPMs can be provisioned for the card.

                Tools/Equipment

                None

                Prerequisite Procedures

                DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                Required/As Needed

                As needed

                Onsite/Remote

                Onsite or remote

                Security Level

                Provisioning or higher


                Caution


                Changing the card configuration to 10G Ethernet LAN Phy to WAN Phy automatically replaces the current port configurations (Ports 1 and 3) to 10G Ethernet and OC192. This resets and reboots the OTU2_XP card.


                Procedure
                  Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the OTU2_XP card where you want to change the card mode.
                  Step 2   In card view, click the Provisioning > Line > Ports tabs.
                  Step 3   Verify that all provisioned client or trunk ports have an OOS-MA, DSBLD (ANSI) or Locked-enabled, disabled (ETSI) service state in the Service State column. If so, continue with Step 4. If not, complete the following substeps.
                  1. For the first port that is not out of service, in the Admin State column, choose OOS, DSBLD > Locked, disabled (ANSI) or (ETSI).
                  2. Repeat Step a for each port that is not out of service.
                  3. Click Apply.
                  Step 4   Click the Provisioning > Card tabs.
                  Step 5   Change the Card Configuration as needed:
                  • Transponder—Choose this option to provision the OTU2_XP card as a transponder. Port pairs 1-3 and 2-4 are both configured as transponders. This is the default card configuration.

                  • Standard Regen—Choose this option to provision the OTU2_XP card as a standard regenerator (with E-FEC only on one port). Port pairs 1-3 and 2-4 are both configured as regenerators.

                  • Enhanced FEC—Choose this option to provision the OTU2_XP card as an E-FEC regenerator (with E-FEC on two ports). Port pair 3-4 is configured as enhanced regenerator. Ports 1 and 2 are not used.

                  • Mixed—Choose this option to provision the OTU2_XP card as a transponder and a standard regenerator (mixed configuration). One of the port pair (1-3 or 2-4) is configured as a transponder and the other port pair as a standard regenerator.

                  • 10G Ethernet LAN Phy to WAN Phy—Choose this option to provision the OTU2_XP card to enable the 10G Ethernet LAN Phy to WAN Phy conversion. Port pair 1-3 supports LAN Phy to WAN Phy conversion. Port pair 2-4 can be configured either as a transponder or a standard regenerator.

                    Note   

                    If you revert to the previous release (release earlier than 9.10), be sure to disable the 10G Ethernet LAN Phy to WAN Phy conversion feature. If you do not disable the 10G Ethernet LAN Phy to WAN Phy feature, an error message stating that the user needs to disable 10G Ethernet LAN Phy to WAN Phy feature before reverting to the previous release is displayed.

                    Note   

                    Table 11-188 on page 11-439 lists the Ethernet variables supported on Ports 1 and 3 of the OTU2_XP card that has the 10G Ethernet LAN Phy to WAN Phy enabled. When the card is in the 10G Ethernet LAN Phy to WAN Phy mode, no 10G FC RMONS are supported on Ports 2 and 4.

                    For more information on OTU2_XP card configuration rules, see the “OTU2_​XP Card Configuration Rules” section.

                  Step 6   Click Apply. Then click Yes in the confirmation dialog box.
                  Step 7   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                  DLP-G274 Verifying Topologies for ETR_CLO and ISC Services

                  Purpose

                  This task verifies that the DWDM network topology can support the IBM ETR_CLO and ISC services.

                  Tools/Equipment

                  Cisco TransportPlanner site plan

                  Prerequisite Procedures

                  DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                  Required/As Needed

                  As needed

                  Onsite/Remote

                  Onsite or remote

                  Security Level

                  Provisioning or higher

                  Procedure
                    Step 1   Display your site plan in Cisco TransportPlanner.
                    Step 2   Verify that the topology where you plan to run the ETR_CLO or ISC service can support the service. The following topologies support ETR_CLO or ISC:
                    • Single span—Two terminal sites with no intermediate sites in between and one of the following sets of cards installed:

                      • 32WSS and 32DMX cards

                      • 32WSS and 32-DMX-O cards

                      • 40-MUX-C and 40-DMX-C/40-DMX-CE cards

                      • 40-WSS-C/40-WSS-CE and 40-DMX-C/40-DMX-CE cards

                        Figure 32. Single-Span Topology

                    • Point-to-Point—Two terminal sites with one of the following sets of cards installed:

                      • 32WSS and 32DMX cards

                      • 32WSS and 32-DMX-O cards

                      • 40-MUX-C and 40-DMX-C/40-DMX-CE cards

                      • 40-WSS-C/40-WSS-CE and 40-DMX-C/40-DMX-CE cards

                        Line amplifiers can be installed between the terminal sites, but intermediate (traffic terminating) sites cannot be installed.

                        Figure 33. Point-to-Point Topology

                    • Two hubs—Two hub nodes in a ring with one of the following sets of cards installed:

                      • 32MUX-O and 32DMX-O cards

                      • 32WSS and 32DMX cards

                      • 32WSS and 32-DMX-O cards

                      • 40-MUX-C and 40-DMX-C/40-DMX-CE cards

                      • 40-WSS-C/40-WSS-CE and 40-DMX-C/40-DMX-CE cards

                        Line amplifiers can be installed between the hubs.

                        Figure 34. Hubs with No Line Amplifiers



                        Figure 35. Hubs with Line Amplifiers

                    Step 3   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                    DLP-G278 Provisioning the Optical Line Rate

                    Purpose

                    This task provisions the line rate for TXP, MXP, AR_MXP, AR_XP, AR_XPE, 100G-LC-C, 10x10G-LC, CFP-LC, 100G-CK-C, 100G-ME-C, 100ME-CKC, 100GS-CK-LC, 200G-CK-LC, WSE, 400G-XP-LC, GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, 10GE_XPE, ADM-10G, and OTU2_XP cards.

                    Tools/Equipment

                    None

                    Prerequisite Procedures

                    Required/As Needed

                    As needed

                    Onsite/Remote

                    Onsite or remote

                    Security Level

                    Provisioning or higher


                    Note


                    The optical line rate for cards with single-rate PPMs is provisioned automatically when you complete the "DLP-G726 Preprovisioning a Multirate PPM" task if the trunk port is out of service. If the optical line rate was provisioned automatically, you do not need to complete this task for the MXP_2.5G_10G, MXP_2.5G_10E, MXP_2.5G_10E_C, MXP_2.5G_10E_L, MXP_2.5G_10EX_C, GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, 10GE_XPE, or OTU2_XP card. If the trunk port was in-service when you provisioned the PPM, complete this task to provision the optical line rate manually for those cards.


                    Procedure
                      Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the card where you want to provision PPM ports. If the data rate that you are provisioning is DV-6000, HDTV, ESCON, SDI/D1 Video, ISC1, ISC3 (for TXP_MR_2.5G and TXPP_MR_2.5G cards), or ETR_CLO, complete the following steps. Otherwise, continue with Step 4.
                      1. Click the Provisioning > OTN > OTN Lines tabs.
                      2. In the ITU-T G.709 OTN field for the respective PPM, choose Disable.
                      3. In the FEC field for the respective PPM, choose Disable.
                      4. Click Apply.
                      Step 2   For the TXP_MR-10G card, click the Provisioning > Data Rate Selection tabs. For all other cards, go to Step 4.
                      Step 3   In the Data Rate Selection area, click Create and choose the type of port from the drop-down list. The supported port types are SONET (including 10G Ethernet WAN Phy) and 10G Ethernet LAN Phy.
                      Step 4   Click the Provisioning > Pluggable Port Modules tabs.
                      Step 5   In the Pluggable Ports area, click Create. The Create Port dialog box appears.
                      Step 6   In the Create Port dialog box, complete the following:
                      • Port—Choose the port and port number from the drop-down list. The first number indicates the PPM in the Pluggable Port Modules area, and the second number indicates the port number on the PPM. For example, the first PPM with one port appears as 1-1 and the second PPM with one port appears as 2-1. The PPM number can be 1 to 4, but the port number is always 1.

                      • Port Type—Choose the type of port from the drop-down list. The port type list displays the supported port rates on your PPM. See table "PPM Port Types" for definitions of the supported rates.

                      Step 7   Click OK. The row in the Pluggable Ports area turns white if the physical SFP is installed and light blue if the SFP is not installed. 
If the optical parameter values differ from the NE Default settings, change the port state to In-Service (for ANSI) or Unlocked (for ETSI) to synchronize the values with the NE Default settings.
                      Step 8   Repeat Step 5 through Step 7 to configure the rest of the port rates as needed.
                      Table 56 PPM Port Types

                      Card

                      Port Type

                      TXP_MR_2.5G

                      TXPP_MR_2.5G

                      • OC-3/STM1—155 Mbps

                      • OC-12/STM4—622 Mbps

                      • OC-48/STM16—2.48 Gbps

                      • ONE_GE—One Gigabit Ethernet 1.125 Gbps

                      • ESCON—Enterprise System Connection 200 Mbps (IBM signal)

                      • DV6000—Proprietary signal from video vendor

                      • SDI_D1_VIDEO—Serial Digital Interface and Digital Video signal type 1

                      • HDTV—High Definition Television

                      • PASS-THRU—Not specified

                      • FC1G—Fibre Channel 1.06 Gbps

                      • FC2G—Fibre Channel 2.125 Gbps

                      • FICON1G—Fiber connectivity1.06 Gbps (IBM signal)

                      • FICON2G—Fiber connectivity 2.125 Gbps (IBM signal)

                      • ETR_CLO—External Time Reference–Control Link Oscillator

                      • ISC compat—InterSystem Coupling Link 1 (ISC1)

                      • ISC peer—InterSystem Coupling Link 3 (ISC3)

                      • DVB-ASI — Proprietary signal from video vendor. Digital Video Broadcast - Asynchronous Serial Interface

                      • ISC1— InterSystem Channel 1 Gbps (IBM signal)

                      MXP_2.5G_10G

                      MXP_2.5G_10E

                      MXP_2.5G_10E_C

                      MXP_2.5G_10E_L

                      MXP_2.5G_10EX_C

                      • OC-48/STM16—2.48 Gbps

                        Automatically provisioned when the PPM is created if the trunk port is out of service.

                      TXP_MR_10G

                      Provisioned on the Data Rate Selection tab.

                      • SONET (OC-192)/SDH (STM-64) including 10G Ethernet WAN Phy

                      • 10G Ethernet LAN Phy

                      TXP_MR_10E

                      TXP_MR_10E_C

                      TXP_MR_10E_L

                      TXP_MR_10EX_C

                      • SONET (OC-192)/SDH (STM-64) including 10G Ethernet WAN Phy—10 Gbps

                      • 10G Ethernet LAN Phy—10 Gbps Ethernet

                      • 10G Fibre Channel—10 Gbps Fibre Channel

                      • (TXP_MR_10EX_C only) IB_5G

                      40E-TXP-C 40ME-TXP-C

                      • SONET (OC-768)/SDH (STM-256)

                      • 40G Ethernet LAN Phy

                      • OTU3

                      MXP_MR_2.5G

                      MXPP_MR_2.5G

                      If the card mode is FC_GE:

                      • FC1G ISL—Fibre Channel 1.06 Gbps (Ports 1-1 and 2-1)

                      • FC2G ISL—Fibre Channel 2.125 Gbps (Port 1-1 only)

                      • FICON1G ISL—Fiber connectivity 1.06 Gbps (IBM signal) (Ports 1-1 and 2-1)

                      • FICON2G ISL—Fiber connectivity 2.125 Gbps (IBM signal) (Port 1-1 only)

                      • ONE_GE—One Gigabit Ethernet 1.125 Gbps (Ports 1-1 and 2-1 only)

                      If the card mode is Mixed:

                      • FC1G ISL—Fibre Channel 1.06 Gbps (Port 1-1 only)

                      • FICON1G ISL—Fiber connectivity 1.06 Gbps (IBM signal) (Port1-1 only)

                      • ONE_GE—One Gigabit Ethernet 1.125 Gbps (Port 1-1 only)

                      • ESCON—Enterprise System Connection 200 Mbps (IBM signal) (Ports 5-1 through 8-1)

                      If the card mode is ESCON:

                      • ESCON—Enterprise System Connection 200 Mbps (IBM signal) (Ports 1-1 through 8-1)

                      MXP_MR_10DME_C

                      MXP_MR_10DME_L

                      MXP_MR_10DMEX_C

                      If the port mode is FC_GE_ISC:

                      • FC1G—Fibre Channel 1.06 Gbps (Ports 1-1 through 8-1)

                      • FC2G—Fibre Channel 2.125 Gbps (Ports 1-1, 3-1, 5-1, and 7-1 only; ports are not available if the port that follows—2-1, 4-1, 6-1, or 8-1—has a PPM provisioned.)

                      • FICON1G—Fiber connectivity 1.06 Gbps (IBM signal) FICON2G—Fiber connectivity 2.125 Gbps (IBM signal) (Ports 1-1, 3-1, 5-1, and 7-1 only; ports are not available if the port that follows—2-1, 4-1, 6-1, or 8-1—has a PPM provisioned.)

                      • ONE_GE—One Gigabit Ethernet 1.125 Gbps (Ports 1-1 through 8-1)

                      • ISC COMPAT (Ports 1-1 through 8-1)

                      • ISC3 PEER 1G (Ports 1-1 through 8-1)

                      • ISC3 PEER 2G (Ports 1-1, 3-1, 5-1, and 7-1 only; ports are not available if the port that follows—2-1, 4-1, 6-1, or 8-1—has a PPM provisioned.)

                      If the port mode is FC4G:

                      • FC4G—Fibre Channel 4.25 Gbps (Ports 1-1 or 5-1 only; ports are not available if any of the three ports that follow has a PPM provisioned.)

                      • FICON4G—Fiber connectivity 4.25 Gbps (IBM signal) (Ports 1-1 or 5-1 only; ports are not available if any of the three ports that follow has a PPM provisioned.)

                      40G-MXP-C
40E-MXP-C
40ME-MXP-C

                      • SONET (OC-192)/SDH (STM-64)

                      • FC8G

                      • FC10G

                      • TEN_GE

                      • OTU2

                      GE_XP

                      10GE_XP

                      GE_XPE

                      10GE_XPE

                      • GE_XP and GE_XPE client ports1

                      • 10GE_XP and 10GE_XPE client and trunk ports; GE_XP and GE_XPE trunk ports1

                      OTU2_XP

                      • SONET (including 10G Ethernet WAN Phy)—10 Gbps

                      • 10G Ethernet LAN Phy—10 Gbps Ethernet

                      • 10G Fiber Channel—10 Gbps Fibre Channel

                      • IB_5G—InfiniBand 5 Gbps

                        Note   

                        If you have an OTU2 signal in which the OPU2 has been generated by multiplexing four ODU1 signals, choose SONET as the port rate. This allows the OTU2 signal to be transported transparently in standard or E-FEC regenerator configuration.

                      AR_MXP

                      AR_XP

                      AR_XPE

                      • OC-3/STM1—155 Mbps

                      • OC-12/STM4—622 Mbps

                      • OC-48/STM16—2.48 Gbps

                      • Gigabit Ethernet—1.125 Gbps

                      • Fast Ethernet—100 Mbps

                      • ESCON-Enterprise System Connection 200 Mbps (IBM signal)

                      • FC1G—Fibre Channel 1.06 Gbps

                      • FC2G—Fibre Channel 2.125 Gbps

                      • FC4G—Fibre Channel 4.25 Gbps

                      • FC8G—Fibre Channel 8.5 Gbps

                      • FICON1G—Fiber connectivity1.06 Gbps (IBM signal)

                      • FICON2G—Fiber connectivity 2.125 Gbps (IBM signal)

                      • FICON4G—Fiber connectivity 4.25 (IBM signal)

                      • FICON8G—Fiber connectivity 8.5 Gbps (IBM signal)

                      • SD-SDI—270 Mbps

                      • HD-SDI—1.485 Gbps

                      • Third-generation SDI (3G-SDI)—2.970 Gbps

                      • OTU2E —11.09 Gbps

                      • OTU1—2.66 Gbps

                      100G-LC-C

                      10x10G-LC

                      CFP-LC

                      100G-CK-C

                      100G-ME-C

                      100ME-CKC

                      400G-XP-LC

                      • SONET (OC-192)/SDH (STM-64)

                      • 10G Ethernet LAN Phy

                      • 40G Ethernet LAN Phy

                      • 100 GE

                      • FC 8G

                      • FC 10G

                      • OTU2

                      • OTU3

                      • OTU4

                      • IB_5G

                      WSE

                      • 10GE LAN PHY

                      • 8G FC

                      • 10G FC

                      • SONET (OC-192)/SDH (STM-64)

                      • OTU2

                      • OTU2e

                      Step 9   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                      NTP-G33 Creating a Y-Cable Protection Group

                      Purpose

                      This procedure creates a Y-cable protection group between the client ports of two TXP, MXP, AR_XP, AR_MXP, AR_XPE, 10x10G-LC, CFP-LC, 100G-CK-C, 100GS-CK-LC, 200G-CK-LC, GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, 10GE_XPE, or OTU2_XP cards when the cards are provisioned in the TXP or MXP mode.

                      Tools/Equipment

                      • Installed TXP, MXP, AR_MXP, AR_XP, AR_XPE, 10x10G-LC, CFP-LC, 100G-CK-C, 100GS-CK-LC, 200G-CK-LC, GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, 10GE_XPE, or OTU2_XP card.

                      • Cisco TransportPlanner Traffic Matrix

                      Prerequisite Procedures

                      Required/As Needed

                      As needed

                      Onsite/Remote

                      Onsite or remote

                      Security Level

                      Provisioning or higher


                      Note


                      Y-cable protection is available for the 100GS-CK-LC and 200G-CK-LC cards only in the MXP-10x10G operating modes



                      Note


                      Y-cable protection is available for the 10x10G-LC card when it is provisioned in one of the following modes:

                      • TXP-10G mode—The client ports are provisioned with 10G Ethernet LAN Phy, 8G FC, 10G FC, OTU2, and OC192/STM-64 payloads.

                      • MXP-10G mode—The client ports are provisioned with 10GE, 8G FC, 10G FC, OTU2, and OC192/STM-64 payloads.



                      Note


                      Y-cable protection is available for the 100G-CK-C card for the CPAK-100G-LR4 pluggable with 100GE/OTU4 payloads.



                      Note


                      Y-cable protection is available for the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards when they are provisioned in the 10GE MXP, 20GE MXP, or 10GE TXP mode. If you are provisioning Y-cable protection for GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards, the Ethernet mode must be set to 1000 and 10000 Mbps respectively. To provision the Ethernet mode, see the DLP-G380 Provisioning Ethernet Settings. Y-cable protection cannot be provisioned for the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards when they are provisioned in L2-over-DWDM mode.



                      Note


                      Y-cable protection is available for the OTU2_XP card when it is provisioned in the TXP card mode. The OTU2-XP and 40E-MXP-C card cannot implement Y-cable protection for the client ports in 10 GE LAN PHY mode. Hence, a pair of OTU2_XP cards is used at each end in pass-through mode (Transponder mode with G.709 disabled) to implement Y-cable protection. The 40E-MXP-CE card can implement Y-cable protection without the OTU2-XP card for the client ports in LAN PHY GFP mode. However, the 40E-MXP-CE card cannot implement Y-cable protection without the OTU2-XP card for the client ports in LAN PHY WIS mode.



                      Note


                      For SONET or SDH payloads, Loss of Pointer Path (LOP-P) alarms can occur on a split signal if the ports are not in a Y-cable protection group.


                      Procedure
                        Step 1   View the Cisco Transport Planner Traffic Matrix (see the Cisco Transport Planner Node Setup Information and Files table) for your site. Verify the cards that need Y-cable protection groups. (Cards requiring Y-cable protection are indicated with “Y-Cable” in the Traffic Matrix table Protection Type column.)
                        Step 2   Verify that the cards are installed according to the requirements specified in Cable Connections for Y-Cable Protection of One Client Signal. Protection Types lists the protection types available for DWDM client cards.
                        Step 3   Verify that pluggable ports are provisioned for the same payload and payload rate on the cards where you want to create the Y-cable protection group:
                        1. Display the card in card view.
                        2. Click the Provisioning > Pluggable Port Module tab.
                        3. Verify that a pluggable port is provisioned in the Pluggable Port Module area, and the payload type and rate is provisioned for it in the Pluggable Ports area. If they are not the same, for example, if the pluggable port and rate are not the same, you must either delete the provisioned rate and create a new rate to match using the DLP-G725 Preprovisioning PPM Slot task or replace the pluggable port (SFP or XFP) using the DLP-G728 Remove PPM from the Line Card task.
                        Step 4   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf mode), click the Provisioning > Protection tabs.
                        Step 5   In the Protection Groups area, click Create.
                        Step 6   In the Create Protection Group dialog box, enter the following:
                        • Name—Type a name for the protection group. The name can have up to 32 alphanumeric (a-z, A-Z, 0-9) characters. Special characters are permitted. For TL1 compatibility, do not use question mark (?), backslash (\), or double quote (“) characters.

                        • Type—Choose Y Cable from the drop-down list.

                        • Protect Port—From the drop-down list, choose the port that will be the standby or protection port to the active port. The list displays the available transponder or muxponder ports. If transponder or muxponder cards are not installed, no ports appear in the drop-down list.

                        After you choose the protect port, a list of available working ports appear in the Available Ports list. If no cards are available, no ports appear. If this occurs, you can not complete this task until you install the physical cards or preprovision the slots.

                        Step 7   From the Available Ports list, select the port that will be protected by the port you selected in Protect Ports. Click the top arrow button to move the port to the Working Ports list.
                        Step 8   Complete the remaining fields:
                        • Revertive—Check this check box if you want traffic to revert to the working port after failure conditions remain corrected for the amount of time entered in the Reversion Time field.

                        • Reversion time—If Revertive is checked, select a reversion time from the drop-down list. The range is 0.5 to 12.0 minutes. The default is 5.0 minutes. Reversion time is the amount of time that will elapse before the traffic reverts to the working card. The reversion timer starts after conditions causing the switch are cleared.

                        Note   

                        The bidirectional switching option is available for Y-cable protection groups only in the following cases:

                        • On the MXP_MR_10DME card when ISC3_PEER_1G/ISC3_PEER_2G is the client payload.

                        • On the MXP_MR_10DME and MXP_MR_2.5G cards when Fibre Channel is the client payload. In this case bidirectional switching is:

                          • Automatically enabled when Distance Extension is enabled.

                          • Automatically disabled when Distance Extension is disabled.

                        The bidirectional switching option is available for all SONET and SDH 1+1 protection groups.

                        Step 9   Click OK.
                        Step 10   Repeat this procedure for every Y-cable protection group indicated in the Cisco TransportPlanner Traffic Matrix.

                        Stop. You have completed this procedure.


                        Protection Types

                        Table 57 Protection Types

                        Protection Type

                        Cards

                        Description and Installation Requirements

                        Y-cable

                        MXP_2.5_10G

                        MXP_2.5_10E

                        MXP_2.5_10E_C

                        MXP_2.5_10E_L

                        TXP_MR_10EX_C

                        TXP_MR_10G

                        TXP_MR_10E

                        TXP_MR_10E_C

                        TXP_MR_10E_L

                        TXP_MR_2.5G

                        40E-TXP-C

                        40ME-TXP-C

                        MXP_MR_2.5G

                        MXP_MR_10DME_C

                        MXP_MR_10DME_L

                        MXP_MR_10DMEX_C

                        40G-MXP-C

                        40E-MXP-C

                        40ME-MXP-C

                        GE_XP (when provisioned in 10GE MXP or 20GE MXP card mode)

                        10GE_XP (when provisioned in 10GE TXP card mode)

                        GE_XPE

                        10GE_XPE

                        OTU2_XP

                        AR_MXP

                        AR_XP

                        AR_XPE

                        10x10G-LC

                        CFP-LC

                        100G-CK-C

                        Pairs a working transponder or muxponder card or port with a protect transponder or muxponder card or port. The protect port must be on a different card than the working port and it must be the same card type as the working port. The working and protect port numbers must be the same, that is, Port 1 can only protect Port 1, Port 2 can only protect Port 2, and so on.

                        Note   

                        The working and protect card must be in the same shelf for a multishelf node.

                        Splitter

                        TXPP_MR_2.5G

                        MXPP_MR_2.5G

                        AR_MXP

                        AR_XP

                        AR_XPE

                        A splitter protection group is automatically created when a TXPP_MR_2.5G, MXPP_MR_2.5G, AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card is installed. You can edit the splitter protection group name.

                        OTU2_XP

                        A splitter protection group is configurable for the OTU2_XP card. You can create a splitter protection group on ports 3 and 4 of the OTU2_XP card using the NTP-G199 Creating a Splitter Protection Group.

                        1+1

                        GE_XP

                        10GE_XP

                        GE_XPE

                        10GE_XPE

                        In the Layer 2 (L2) card mode 1+1 protection is provided to protect the card against client port and card failure.

                        NTP-G199 Creating a Splitter Protection Group

                        Purpose

                        This procedure creates a splitter protection group between the trunk ports of an OTU2_XP card. For additional information about splitter protection, see the "Splitter Protection" section.

                        Tools/Equipment

                        Installed OTU2_XP card

                        Cisco TransportPlanner Traffic Matrix

                        Prerequisite Procedures

                        In the Cisco NCS 2000 Series Hardware Installation Guide:

                        • NTP-G15 Install the Common Control Cards
                        • NTP-G14 Install DWDM Equipment

                        Required/As Needed

                        As needed

                        Onsite/Remote

                        Onsite or remote

                        Security Level

                        Provisioning or higher


                        Note


                        A splitter protection group is automatically created when a TXPP_MR_2.5G, MXPP_MR_2.5G, or PSM card is installed. You can edit the splitter protection group name for these cards. The splitter protection group is deleted when you delete the TXPP_MR_2.5G, MXPP_MR_2.5G, or PSM card.



                        Note


                        Splitter protection is available for the OTU2_XP card when it is provisioned in Transponder configuration only. In a splitter-protected Transponder configuration, Port 1 is the client port, Port 3 is the working trunk port, and Port 4 is the standby trunk port.



                        Note


                        For SONET or SDH payloads, Loss of Pointer Path (LOP-P) alarms can occur on a split signal if the ports are not in a splitter protection group.


                        Procedure
                          Step 1   View the Cisco TransportPlanner Traffic Matrix (see the Cisco Transport Planner Node Setup Information and Files table) for your site. Verify which OTU2_XP card needs a splitter protection group. (Cards requiring splitter protection are indicated with “Splitter” in the Traffic Matrix table Protection Type column. Refer to the Cisco Transport Planner DWDM Operations Guide for more information.)
                          Step 2   Verify that the OTU2_XP card is installed according to the requirements specified in Cable Connections for Y-Cable Protection of One Client Signal
                          Step 3   Verify that the pluggable port (SFP or XFP) slot is provisioned for the same payload rate as the pluggable port on the OTU2_XP card where you will create the splitter protection group:
                          1. Display the OTU2_XP card in card view.
                          2. Click the Provisioning > Pluggable Port Module tabs.
                          3. Verify that a pluggable port (SFP or XFP) slot is provisioned in the Pluggable Port Module area, and that the payload rate of the pluggable port (SFP or XFP) slot is same as the payload rate of the pluggable port on the OTU2_XP card provisioned in the Pluggable Ports area. If they are not the same, you must either delete the provisioned rate and create a new rate to match using the DLP-G725 Preprovisioning PPM Slot task or replace the pluggable port (SFP or XFP) using the DLP-G728 Remove PPM from the Line Card task.
                          Step 4   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), click the Provisioning > Protection tabs.
                          Step 5   In the Protection Groups area, click Create.
                          Step 6   In the Create Protection Group dialog box, enter the following:
                          • Name—Type a name for the protection group. The name can have up to 32 alphanumeric (a-z, A-Z, 0-9) characters. Special characters are permitted. For TL1 compatibility, do not use question mark (?), backslash (\), or double quote (“) characters.

                          • Type—Choose Splitter from the drop-down list.

                          • Protect Card—From the drop-down list, choose the port that will be the standby or protection port to the active port. The list displays the available OTU2_XP ports. If transponder or muxponder cards are not installed or if the trunk ports of the card are part of a regenerator group, no ports appear in the drop-down list.

                            After you choose the protect port, a list of available working ports appear in the Available Cards list. If no cards are available, no ports appear. If this occurs, you cannot complete this task until you install the physical cards or preprovision the slots using the DLP-G353 Preprovisioning a Slot.

                          Step 7   From the Available Cards list, select the port that will be protected by the port you selected in Protect Cards. Click the top arrow button to move the port to the Working Cards list.
                          Step 8   Complete the remaining fields:
                          • Revertive—Check this check box if you want traffic to revert to the working port after failure conditions remain corrected for the amount of time entered in the Reversion Time field.

                          • Reversion time—If Revertive is checked, select a reversion time from the drop-down list. The range is 0.5 to 12.0 minutes. The default is 5.0 minutes. Reversion time is the amount of time that will elapse before the traffic reverts to the working card. The reversion timer starts after conditions causing the switch are cleared.

                            Note   

                            The Bidirectional Switching option is not applicable for splitter protection groups.

                          Step 9   Click OK.
                          Step 10   Repeat this procedure for every splitter protection group indicated in the Cisco TransportPlanner Traffic Matrix.

                          Stop. You have completed this procedure.


                          NTP-G198 Creating 1+1 Protection for Cards

                          Purpose

                          This procedure creates a 1+1 protection group to protect against client port and card failure of GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, 10GE_XPE cards.

                          Tools/Equipment

                          None

                          Prerequisite Procedures

                          In the Cisco NCS 2000 Series Hardware Installation Guide:

                          Required/As Needed

                          As needed

                          Onsite/Remote

                          Onsite or remote

                          Security Level

                          Provisioning or higher

                          Procedure
                            Step 1   Verify that the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card is installed according to the requirements specified in Cable Connections for Y-Cable Protection of One Client Signal
                            Step 2   Complete the NTP-G242 Creating an Internal Patchcord Manually by selecting the Trunk to Trunk (L2) option, at the trunk port where you want to create 1+1 protection.
                            Step 3   Complete the DLP-G461 Creating a 1+1 Protection Group for Cards to create a protection group.
                            Step 4   Configure the standby port behavior, by setting the Protection Action to None or Squelch. For detailed information on how to configure the standby port behavior, see the DLP-G380 Provisioning Ethernet Settings task.
                            Note   

                            Do not enable squelch in a 1 + 1 protection group, if the 100FX, 100LX SFP, and ONS-SE-ZE-EL SFP is used in the protection group and is connected to the peer via the parallel cable (not Y-cable)

                            Note   

                            When you configure L2 1 + 1 protection on 10GE_XP and 10GE_XPE cards, set the Protection Action to None on the client ports. Setting the Protection Action as Squelch results in unexpected switching behavior.

                            Step 5   Configure the standby and active port speed, by setting the mode parameter to Auto or 1000 or any other values. For detailed information on how to configure the standby port behavior, see the DLP-G380 Provisioning Ethernet Settings task.

                            Stop. You have completed this procedure.


                            DLP-G461 Creating a 1+1 Protection Group for Cards

                            Purpose

                            This procedure creates a 1+1 protection group for GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE slots where internal patchcords were created.

                            Tools/Equipment

                            None

                            Prerequisite Procedures

                            DLP-G344 Verifying Provisionable and Internal Patchcords

                            Required/As Needed

                            As needed

                            Onsite/Remote

                            Onsite or remote

                            Security Level

                            Provisioning or higher

                            Procedure
                              Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or multishelf view (multishelf mode), click the Provisioning > Protection tabs.
                              Step 2   In the Protection Groups area, click Create.
                              Step 3   In the Create Protection Group dialog box, enter the following:
                              • Name—Type a name for the protection group. The name can have up to 32 alphanumeric (a-z, A-Z, 0-9) characters. Special characters are permitted. For TL1 compatibility, do not use question mark (?), backslash (\), or double quote (“) characters.

                              • Type—Choose L2 1+1 (port) from the drop-down list.

                              • Protect Port—From the drop-down list, choose the port that will be the standby or protection port for the active port. The list displays the available transponder or muxponder ports. If transponder or muxponder cards are not installed, no ports appear in the drop-down list.

                              After you choose the protect port, a list of available working ports appear in the Available Ports list. If no cards are available, no ports appear. If this occurs, you cannot complete this task until you install the physical cards or preprovision the slots using the DLP-G353 Preprovisioning a Slot task.

                              Step 4   From the Available Ports list, select the port that will be protected by the port you selected in the Protected Port drop-down list. Click the top arrow button to move the port to the Working Ports list.
                              Step 5   Complete the remaining fields:
                              • Revertive—Check this check box if you want traffic to revert to the working port after failure conditions remain corrected for the amount of time entered in the Reversion Time field.

                              • Reversion time—If Revertive is checked, select a reversion time from the drop-down list. The range is 0.5 to 12.0 minutes. The default is 5.0 minutes. Reversion time is the amount of time that will elapse before the traffic reverts to the working card. The reversion timer starts after conditions causing the switch are cleared.

                              The bidirectional switching option is available for SONET and SDH 1+1 protection groups.
                              Step 6   Click OK.
                              Step 7   Repeat this procedure for every 1+1 protection group indicated in the Cisco TransportPlanner Traffic Matrix.
                              Step 8   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                              NTP-G98 Provisioning the 2.5G Multirate Transponder Card Line Settings and PM Parameter Thresholds

                              Purpose

                              This procedure changes the line and threshold settings for TXP_MR_2.5G and TXPP_MR_2.5G transponder cards.

                              Tools/Equipment

                              None

                              Prerequisite Procedures

                              DLP-G723 Install PPM on a Line Card

                              DLP-G726 Preprovisioning a Multirate PPM (if necessary)

                              DLP-G278 Provisioning the Optical Line Rate

                              Required/As Needed

                              As needed

                              Onsite/Remote

                              Onsite or remote

                              Security Level

                              Provisioning or higher

                              Procedure
                                Step 1   As needed, complete the NTP-G103 Backing Up the Database task to preserve the existing transmission settings.
                                Step 2   Perform any of the following tasks as needed: Stop. You have completed this procedure.

                                DLP-G229 Changing the 2.5G or 10G Transponder Card Settings

                                Purpose

                                This task changes the card settings for TXP_MR_2.5G and TXPP_MR_2.5G, TXP_MR_10G, TXP_MR_10E, TXP_MR_10E_C, TXP_MR_10E_L, and TXP_MR_10EX_C transponder cards.

                                Tools/Equipment

                                None

                                Prerequisite Procedures

                                DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                Required/As Needed

                                As needed

                                Onsite/Remote

                                Onsite or remote

                                Security Level

                                Provisioning or higher

                                Procedure
                                  Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the card where you want to change the card settings.
                                  Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Card tabs.
                                  Step 3   Modify any of the settings described in the following table.
                                  Note   

                                  The Card subtab Framing Type and Tunable Wavelengths fields are display-only. Framing Type shows the card framing type, either SONET or SDH, depending on whether the card is installed in an ANSI or ETSI chassis. The Tunable Wavelengths field shows the tunable wavelengths for the physical TXP_MR_2.5G or TXPP_MR_2.5G that is installed.

                                  Table 58 2.5G or 10G Transponder Card Settings

                                  Parameter

                                  Description

                                  Options

                                  Termination Mode

                                  Sets the mode of operation (option only supported for SONET/SDH payloads).

                                  • Transparent

                                  • Section (ANSI) or Regeneration Section (ETSI) - Only for TXP_MR_2.5G, TXPP_MR_2.5G, and TXP_MR_10E.

                                  • Line (ANSI) or Multiplex Section (ETSI)

                                  AIS/Squelch Configuration

                                  (TXP_MR_10E, TXP_MR_10E_C, TXP_MR_10E_L, or TXP_MR_10EX_C only) Sets the transparent termination mode configuration.

                                  • Squelch

                                  • AIS

                                  Regeneration Peer Slot

                                  Sets the slot containing another multirate card to create a regeneration peer group. A regeneration peer group facilitates the management of two multirate cards that are needed to perform a complete signal regeneration.

                                  The regeneration peer group synchronizes provisioning of the two cards. Payload type and ITU-T G.709 optical transport network (OTN) changes made on one multirate card are reflected on the peer multirate card.

                                  Note   

                                  Y-cable protection groups cannot be created on TXP cards that are in a regeneration peer group.

                                  • None

                                  • 1

                                  • 2

                                  • 3

                                  • 4

                                  • 5

                                  • 6

                                  • 12

                                  • 13

                                  • 14

                                  • 15

                                  • 16

                                  • 17

                                  Regeneration Group Name

                                  Sets the regeneration peer group name.

                                  User defined

                                  Tunable Wavelengths

                                  (Only for 10G multirate transponder cards) Shows the supported wavelengths of the trunk port after the card is installed. For the TXP_MR_10E_C, or TXP_MR_10E_L cards, the first and last supported wavelength, frequency spacing, and number of supported wavelengths are shown in the format: first wavelength-last wavelength-frequency spacing-number of supported wavelengths. For example, the TXP_MR_10E_C card would show: 1529.55nm-1561.83nm-50gHz-82. The TXP_MR_10E show the four wavelengths supported by the card that is installed. The TXP_MR_10G show the two wavelengths supported by the card that is installed.

                                  Step 4   Click Apply.
                                  Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                  DLP-G230 Changing the 2.5G Multirate Transponder Line Settings

                                  Purpose

                                  This task changes the line settings for the client port of the TXP_MR_2.5G and TXPP_MR_2.5G transponder cards.

                                  Tools/Equipment

                                  None

                                  Prerequisite Procedures

                                  DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                  Required/As Needed

                                  As needed

                                  Onsite/Remote

                                  Onsite or remote

                                  Security Level

                                  Provisioning or higher

                                  Procedure
                                    Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the TXP_MR_2.5G or TXPP_MR_2.5G card where you want to change the line settings.
                                    Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line > SONET tabs.
                                    Step 3   Modify any of the settings described in the following table.
                                    Note   

                                    The 2.5G multirate transponder trunk settings are provisioned in the DLP-G305 Provisioning the 2.5G Multirate Transponder Trunk Port Alarm and TCA Thresholds.

                                    Table 59 TXP_MR_2.5G and TXPP_MR_2.5G Transponder Card Line Settings

                                    Parameter

                                    Description

                                    Options

                                    Port

                                    (Display only) Displays the port number.

                                    • 1

                                    • 2 (Trunk)

                                    • 3 (Trunk) (TXPP_MR_2.5G card only)

                                    Port Name

                                    The user can assign a logical name for each of the ports shown by filling in this field.

                                    User-defined. Name can be up to 80 alphanumeric/ special characters. Blank by default.

                                    Admin State

                                    Sets the port service state unless network conditions prevent the change. For more information about administrative states, see the Administrative and Service States document.

                                    • IS (ANSI) or Unlocked (ETSI)

                                    • IS,AINS (ANSI) or Unlocked,automaticInService (ETSI)

                                    • OOS,DSBLD (ANSI) or Locked,disabled (ETSI)

                                    • OOS,MT (ANSI) or Locked,maintenance (ETSI)

                                    Service State

                                    (Display only) Identifies the autonomously generated state that gives the overall condition of the port. Service states appear in the format: Primary State-Primary State Qualifier, Secondary State. For more information about service states, see the Administrative and Service States document.

                                    • IS-NR (ANSI) or Unlocked-enabled (ETSI)

                                    • OOS-AU,AINS (ANSI) or Unlocked-disabled,
automaticInService (ETSI)

                                    • OOS-MA,DSBLD (ANSI) or Locked-enabled,disabled (ETSI)

                                    • OOS-MA,MT (ANSI) or Locked-enabled,maintenance (ETSI)

                                    SF BER

                                    (OC-N and STM-N payloads only) Sets the signal fail bit error rate.

                                    • 1E-3

                                    • 1E-4

                                    • 1E-5

                                    SD BER

                                    (OC-N and STM-N payloads only) Sets the signal degrade bit error rate.

                                    • 1E-5

                                    • 1E-6

                                    • 1E-7

                                    • 1E-8

                                    • 1E-9

                                    ALS Mode

                                    Sets the automatic laser shutdown (ALS) function.

                                    • Disabled (default)

                                    • Auto Restart

                                    • Manual Restart

                                    • Manual Restart for Test

                                    Reach

                                    Displays the optical reach distance of the client port.

                                    Options: ANSI/ETSI

                                    • Autoprovision/Autoprovision (default)

                                    • SR

                                    • SR 1/I-1—Short reach up to 2-km distance

                                    • IR 1/S1—Intermediate reach, up to 15-km distance

                                    • IR 2/S2—Intermediate reach up to 40-km distance

                                    • LR 1/L1—long reach, up to 40-km distance

                                    • LR 2/L2—long reach, up to 80-km distance

                                    • LR 3/L3—long reach, up to 80-km distance

                                    Wavelength

                                    Displays the wavelength of the client port.

                                    • First Tunable Wavelength

                                    • Further wavelengths: 1310 nm through 1560.61 nm, 100-GHz ITU spacing; coarse wavelength division multiplexing (CWDM) spacing

                                    Note: supported wavelengths are marked by asterisks (**)

                                    AINS Soak

                                    (OC-N and STM-N payloads only) Sets the automatic in-service soak period.

                                    • Duration of valid input signal, in hh.mm format, after which the card becomes in service (IS) automatically

                                    • 0 to 48 hours, 15-minute increments

                                    Type

                                    (OC-N and STM-N payloads only) The optical transport type.

                                    • SONET

                                    • SDH

                                    Step 4   Click Apply.
                                    Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                    DLP-G231 Changing the 2.5G Multirate Transponder Line Section Trace Settings

                                    Purpose

                                    This task changes the section trace settings for TXP_MR_2.5G and TXPP_MR_2.5G transponder cards.

                                    Tools/Equipment

                                    None

                                    Prerequisite Procedures

                                    DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                    Required/As Needed

                                    As needed

                                    Onsite/Remote

                                    Onsite or remote

                                    Security Level

                                    Provisioning or higher


                                    Note


                                    This task only applies to SONET services.


                                    Procedure
                                      Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the TXP_MR_2.5G or TXPP_MR_2.5G card where you want to change the section trace settings.
                                      Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line > Section Trace tabs.
                                      Step 3   Modify any of the settings described in the following table.
                                      Table 60 TXP_MR_2.5G and TXPP_MR_2.5G Transponder Card Section Trace Settings

                                      Parameter

                                      Description

                                      Options

                                      Port

                                      (Display only) Port number.

                                      • 1

                                      • 2 (Trunk)

                                      • 3 (Trunk) (TXPP_MR_2.5G only)

                                      Received Trace Mode

                                      Sets the trace mode.

                                      • Off/None

                                      • Manual

                                      Disable AIS/RDI on TIM-S

                                      If an TIM on Section overhead alarm arises because of a J0 overhead string mismatch, no alarm indication signal is sent to downstream nodes if this box is checked.

                                      • Checked (AIS/RDI on TIM-S is disabled)

                                      • Unchecked (AIS/RDI on TIM-S is not disabled)

                                      Transmit Section Trace String Size

                                      Sets the trace string size.

                                      • 1 byte

                                      • 16 byte

                                      Transmit

                                      Displays the current transmit string; sets a new transmit string. You can click the button on the right to change the display. Its title changes, based on the current display mode. Click Hex to change the display to hexadecimal (button changes to ASCII); click ASCII to change the display to ASCII (button changes to Hex).

                                      String of trace string size

                                      Expected

                                      Displays the current expected string; sets a new expected string. You can click the button on the right to change the display. Its title changes, based on the current display mode. Click Hex to change the display to hexadecimal (button changes to ASCII); click ASCII to change the display to ASCII (button changes to Hex).

                                      String of trace string size

                                      Received

                                      (Display only) Displays the current received string. You can click Refresh to manually refresh this display, or check the Auto-refresh every 5 sec check box to keep this display updated automatically.

                                      String of trace string size

                                      Auto-refresh

                                      If checked, automatically refreshes the display every 5 seconds.

                                      Checked/unchecked (default)

                                      Step 4   Click Apply.
                                      Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                      DLP-G367 Changing the Multirate Transponder Trunk Wavelength Settings

                                      Purpose

                                      This task changes the trunk wavelength settings for the TXP_MR_2.5G and TXPP_MR_2.5G, TXP_MR_10G, TXP_MR_10E, TXP_MR_10E_C, TXP_MR_10E_L, and TXP_MR_10EX_C cards.

                                      Tools/Equipment

                                      None

                                      Prerequisite Procedures

                                      DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                      Required/As Needed

                                      As needed

                                      Onsite/Remote

                                      Onsite or remote

                                      Security Level

                                      Provisioning or higher


                                      Note


                                      Before modifying the wavelength settings, change the port state to OOS,DSBLD (for ANSI) or Locked,disabled (for ETSI) and delete the circuit and patchcord provisioning present on the port. Payload or communication channel provisioning can be retained.


                                      Procedure
                                        Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the multirate card where you want to change the trunk wavelength settings.
                                        Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line > Wavelength Trunk Settings tabs.
                                        Step 3   Modify any of the settings as described in the following table.
                                        Table 61 Multirate Transponder Card Wavelength Trunk Settings

                                        Parameter

                                        Description

                                        Options

                                        Port

                                        (Display only) Displays the port number.

                                        • 2 (Trunk)

                                        • 3 (Trunk) (TXPP_MR_2.5G only)

                                        Band

                                        Indicates the wavelength band that can be provisioned. If the physical TXP_MR_10G, TXP_MR_10E, TXP_MR_10E_C, TXP_MR_10E_L, and TXP_MR_10EX_C is installed, this field is display-only.

                                        • C—The C-band wavelengths are available in the Wavelength field.

                                        • L—The L-band wavelengths are available in the Wavelength field.

                                        Even/Odd

                                        Sets the wavelengths available for provisioning for TXP_MR_10E_C, and TXP_MR_10E_L cards.

                                        • Even—Displays even C-band or L-band wavelengths in the Wavelength field.

                                        • Odd—Displays odd C-band or L-band wavelengths in the Wavelength field.

                                        Wavelength

                                        The wavelength provisioned for the trunk.

                                        • First Tunable Wavelength

                                        • Further wavelengths in 100-GHz ITU-T C-band or L-band spacing, depending on the card that is installed. For TXP_MR_10G and TXP_MR_10E cards, the wavelengths carried by the card are identified with two asterisks. The wavelengths supported by the SFPs/XFPs plugged to the card are identified with two asterisks. Other wavelengths have a dark grey background. If the card is not installed, all wavelengths appear with a dark grey background.

                                        Step 4   Click Apply.
                                        Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                        DLP-G232 Changing the Multirate Transponder SONET or SDH Line Threshold Settings

                                        Purpose

                                        This task changes the line threshold settings for TXP_MR_2.5G and TXPP_MR_2.5G transponder cards carrying OC-3/STM-1, OC-12/STM-4, and OC-48/STM-16 payloads. You can also use this task to change the line threshold settings for TXP_MR_10G, TXP_MR_10E, TXP_MR_10E_C, TXP_MR_10E_L, and TXP_MR_10EX_C transponder cards carrying SONET or SDH payloads, including the physical 10G Ethernet WAN Phy payload.

                                        Tools/Equipment

                                        None

                                        Prerequisite Procedures

                                        DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                        Required/As Needed

                                        As needed

                                        Onsite/Remote

                                        Onsite or remote

                                        Security Level

                                        Provisioning or higher

                                        Procedure
                                          Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the multirate transponder card where you want to change the line threshold settings.
                                          Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line Thresholds tabs.
                                          Note   

                                          You must modify Near End and Far End independently; 15 Min and 1 Day independently; and Line and Section independently. To do so, choose the appropriate radio button and click Refresh.

                                          Step 3   Modify any of the settings in the following table.
                                          Note   

                                          Some parameters and options in the following table do not apply to all the multirate cards. If a parameter or option does not apply, that parameter or option does not appear in CTC.

                                          Table 62 Multirate Transponder Card Line Thresholds Settings

                                          Parameter

                                          Description

                                          Options - ANSI

                                          Options - ETSI

                                          Port

                                          (Display only) Port number

                                          • 1

                                          • 2 (Trunk)

                                          • 3 (Trunk) (TXPP_MR_2.5G only)

                                          • 1

                                          • 2 (Trunk)

                                          • 3 (Trunk) (TXPP_MR_2.5G only)

                                          EB

                                          Path Errored Block indicates that one or more bits are in error within a block

                                          Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                          • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                          • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                          • Types—Line or Section (near end only)

                                          Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                          Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                          • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                          • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                          • Types—Multiplex Section or Regeneration Section (near end only)

                                          Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                          CV

                                          Coding violations

                                          Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                          • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                          • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                          • Types—Line or Section (near end only)

                                          Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                          ES

                                          Errored seconds

                                          Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                          • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                          • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                          • Types—Line or Section (near end only)

                                          Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                          Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                          • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                          • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                          • Types—Multiplex Section or Regeneration Section (near end only)

                                          Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                          SES

                                          Severely errored seconds

                                          Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                          • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                          • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                          • Types—Line or Section (near end only)

                                          Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                          Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                          • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                          • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                          • Types—Multiplex Section or Regeneration Section (near end only)

                                          Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                          FC

                                          (Line or Multiplex Section only) Failure count

                                          Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                          • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                          • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                          • Types—Line or Section (near end only)

                                          Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                          SEFS

                                          (Near End Section or Regeneration Section only) Severely errored framing seconds

                                          Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                          • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                          • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                          • Types—Line or Section (near end only)

                                          Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                          UAS

                                          Unavailable seconds

                                          Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                          • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                          • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                          • Types—SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk) for 2.5G cards and Line or Section (near end only) for 10G cards.

                                          Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                          Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                          • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                          • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                          • Types—SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk) for 2.5G cards and Multiplex Section or Regeneration Section (near end only) for 10G cards.

                                          Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                          BBE

                                          Background block errors

                                          Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                          • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                          • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                          • Types—SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk) for 2.5G cards and Multiplex Section or Regeneration Section (near end only) for 10G cards

                                          Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                          OFS

                                          (Near End Section or Regeneration Section only) Out of frame seconds

                                          Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                          • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                          • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                          • Types—Line or Section (near end only)

                                          Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                          Step 4   Click Apply.
                                          Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                          DLP-G320 Changing the 2.5G Multirate Transponder Line RMON Thresholds

                                          Purpose

                                          This task changes the line remote monitoring (RMON) threshold settings for TXP_MR_2.5G and TXPP_MR_2.5G transponder cards carrying the 1G Ethernet or 1G FC/FICON payloads.

                                          Tools/Equipment

                                          None

                                          Prerequisite Procedures

                                          DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                          Required/As Needed

                                          As needed

                                          Onsite/Remote

                                          Onsite or remote

                                          Security Level

                                          Provisioning or higher

                                          Procedure
                                            Step 1   In card view, display the TXP_MR_2.5G or TXPP_MR_2.5G card where you want to change the line threshold settings.
                                            Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line Thresholds > RMON Thresholds tabs.
                                            Step 3   Click Create. The Create Threshold dialog box appears.
                                            Step 4   From the Port drop-down list, choose the applicable port.
                                            Step 5   From the Variable drop-down list, choose an Ethernet variable. See the following table for a list of available Ethernet variables.
                                            Table 63 TXP_MR_2.5G and TXPP_MR_2.5G Card 1G Ethernet and 1G FC/FICONThresholds

                                            Variable

                                            Description

                                            ifInErrors

                                            Number of inbound packets that contained errors preventing them from being delivered to a higher-layer protocol.

                                            rxTotalPkts

                                            Total number of received packets.

                                            8b10bStatsEncodingDispErrors

                                            Number of IETF 8b10b disparity violations on the Fibre Channel line side.

                                            8b10bIdleOrderedSets

                                            Number of received packets containing idle ordered sets.

                                            8b10bNonIdleOrderedSets

                                            Number of received packets containing non-idle ordered sets.

                                            8b10bDataOrderedSets

                                            Number of received packets containing data ordered sets.

                                            Step 6   From the Alarm Type drop-down list, indicate whether the event will be triggered by the rising threshold, the falling threshold, or both the rising and falling thresholds.
                                            Step 7   From the Sample Type drop-down list, choose either Relative or Absolute. Relative restricts the threshold to use the number of occurrences in the user-set sample period. Absolute sets the threshold to use the total number of occurrences, regardless of time period.
                                            Step 8   Enter the appropriate number of seconds for the Sample Period.
                                            Step 9   Enter the appropriate number of occurrences for the Rising Threshold.

                                            For a rising type of alarm, the measured value must move from below the falling threshold to above the rising threshold. For example, if a network is running below a rising threshold of 1000 collisions every 15 seconds and a problem causes 1001 collisions in 15 seconds, the excess occurrences trigger an alarm.

                                            Step 10   Enter the appropriate number of occurrences in the Falling Threshold field. In most cases a falling threshold is set lower than the rising threshold. A falling threshold is the counterpart to a rising threshold. When the number of occurrences is above the rising threshold and then drops below a falling threshold, it resets the rising threshold. For example, when the network problem that caused 1001 collisions in 15 seconds subsides and creates only 799 collisions in 15 seconds, occurrences fall below a falling threshold of 800 collisions. This resets the rising threshold so that if network collisions again spike over a 1000 per 15-second period, an event again triggers when the rising threshold is crossed. An event is triggered only the first time a rising threshold is exceeded (otherwise, a single network problem might cause a rising threshold to be exceeded multiple times and cause a flood of events).
                                            Step 11   Click OK.
                                            Step 12   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                            DLP-G305 Provisioning the 2.5G Multirate Transponder Trunk Port Alarm and TCA Thresholds

                                            Purpose

                                            This task changes the TXP_MR_2.5G and TXPP_MR_2.5G trunk port alarm and threshold crossing alert (TCA) thresholds.

                                            Tools/Equipment

                                            None

                                            Prerequisite Procedures

                                            DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                            Required/As Needed

                                            As needed

                                            Onsite/Remote

                                            Onsite or remote

                                            Security Level

                                            Provisioning or higher


                                            Note


                                            In this task, trunk port refers to Port 2 for TXP_MR_2.5G cards, and to Ports 2 and 3 for TXPP_MR_2.5G cards.


                                            Procedure
                                              Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the TXP_MR_2.5G or TXPP_MR_2.5G card where you want to change the trunk port alarm and TCA settings.
                                              Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Pluggable Port Modules tab. Under Pluggable Ports, record the Rate that is provisioned.
                                              Step 3   Look up the rate in the following table and note whether it is 2R or 3R.
                                              Table 64 2R and 3R Mode and ITU-T G.709 Compliance by Client Interface

                                              Client Interface

                                              Input Bit Rate

                                              3R vs. 2R

                                              ITU-T G.709

                                              OC-48/STM-16

                                              2.488 Gbps

                                              3R

                                              On or Off

                                              DV-6000

                                              2.38 Gbps

                                              2R

                                              2 Gigabit Fibre Channel (2G-FC)/fiber connectivity (FICON)

                                              2.125 Gbps

                                              3R (no monitoring)

                                              On or Off

                                              High-Definition Television (HDTV)

                                              1.48 Gbps

                                              2R

                                              Gigabit Ethernet (GE)

                                              1.25 Gbps

                                              3R

                                              On or Off

                                              1 Gigabit Fibre Channel (1G-FC)/FICON

                                              1.06 Gbps

                                              3R

                                              On or Off

                                              OC-12/STM-4

                                              622 Mbps

                                              3R

                                              On or Off

                                              OC-3/STM-1

                                              155 Mbps

                                              3R

                                              On or Off

                                              Enterprise System Connection (ESCON)

                                              200 Mbps

                                              2R

                                              SDI/D1 video

                                              270 Mbps

                                              2R

                                              ISC-1 Compact

                                              1.06 Gbps

                                              3R

                                              Off

                                              ISC-3

                                              1.06 or 2.125 Gbps

                                              2R

                                              ETR_CLO

                                              16 Mbps

                                              2R

                                              Step 4   Click the Provisioning > Optics Thresholds tabs.
                                              Step 5   Under Types, verify that the TCA radio button is checked. If not, check it and click Refresh.
                                              Step 6   Referring to the following table, verify the trunk port TCA thresholds for RX Power High and RX Power Low depending on whether the rate is 2R or 3R. Provision new thresholds as needed by double-clicking the threshold value you want to change, deleting it, entering a new value, and hitting Enter.
                                              Note   

                                              Do not modify the Laser Bias parameters.

                                              Note   

                                              You must modify 15 Min and 1 Day independently. To do so, choose the appropriate radio button and click Refresh.

                                              Table 65 TXP_MR_2.5G and TXPP_MR_2.5G Trunk Port TCA Thresholds

                                              Signal

                                              TCA RX Power Low

                                              TCA RX Power High

                                              3R

                                              –23 dBm

                                              –9 dBm

                                              2R

                                              –24 dBm

                                              –9 dBm

                                              Step 7   Click Apply.
                                              Step 8   Under Types, click the Alarm radio button and click Refresh.
                                              Step 9   Verify the trunk port Alarm thresholds for RX Power High is –7 dBm, and for RX Power Low is –26 dBm. Provision new thresholds as needed by double-clicking the threshold value you want to change, deleting it, entering a new value, and hitting Enter.
                                              Step 10   Click Apply.
                                              Step 11   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                              DLP-G306 Provisioning the 2.5G Multirate Transponder Client Port Alarm and TCA Thresholds

                                              Purpose

                                              This task provisions the client port alarm and TCA thresholds for the TXP_MR_2.5G and TXPP_MR_2.5G cards.

                                              Tools/Equipment

                                              None

                                              Prerequisite Procedures

                                              DLP-G278 Provisioning the Optical Line Rate

                                              DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                              Required/As Needed

                                              As needed

                                              Onsite/Remote

                                              Onsite or remote

                                              Security Level

                                              Provisioning or higher

                                              Procedure
                                                Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the TXP_MR_2.5G or TXPP_MR_2.5G card where you want to change the client port alarm and TCA settings.
                                                Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Optics Thresholds tabs. The TCA thresholds are shown by default.
                                                Step 3   Referring to the following table, verify the Port 1 (client) TCA thresholds for RX Power High, RX Power Low, TX Power High, and TX Power Low based on the client interface at the other end. Provision new thresholds as needed by double-clicking the threshold value you want to change, deleting it, entering a new value, and hitting Enter.
                                                Note   

                                                Do not modify the Laser Bias parameters.

                                                Note   

                                                You must modify 15 Min and 1 Day independently. To do so, choose the appropriate radio button and click Refresh.

                                                Note   

                                                The hardware device that plugs into a TXP, MXP, GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, 10GE_XPE, or ADM-10G card faceplate to provide a fiber interface to the card is called a Small Form-factor Pluggable (SFP or XFP). In CTC, SFPs and XFPs are called pluggable port modules (PPMs). SFPs/XFPs are hot-swappable input/output devices that plug into a port to link the port with the fiber-optic network. Multirate PPMs have provisionable port rates and payloads. For more information about SFPs and XFPs, see the SFP, SFP+, QSFP+, XFP, CXP, CFP, and CPAK Modules.

                                                Table 66 TXP_MR_2.5G and TXPP_MR_2.5G Card Client Interface TCA Thresholds

                                                Port Type
(by CTC)

                                                Pluggable Port Module 
(SFP)

                                                TCA RX
Power Low

                                                TCA RX
Power High

                                                TCA TX
Power Low

                                                TCA TX
Power High

                                                OC-3

                                                15454-SFP3-1-IR

                                                –23

                                                –8

                                                –21

                                                –2

                                                STM-1

                                                15454E-SFP-L.1.1

                                                –24

                                                –10

                                                –21

                                                –2

                                                OC-12

                                                15454-SFP12-4-IR

                                                –28

                                                –7

                                                –21

                                                –2

                                                STM-4

                                                15454E-SFP-L.4.1

                                                –28

                                                –8

                                                –21

                                                –2

                                                OC-48

                                                ONS-SE-2G-S1

                                                –18

                                                –3

                                                –16

                                                3

                                                15454-SFP-OC48-IR

                                                –18

                                                0

                                                –11

                                                6

                                                STM-16

                                                ONS-SE-2G-S1

                                                15454E-SFP-L.16.1

                                                –18

                                                –3

                                                –16

                                                3

                                                ONE_GE

                                                15454-SFP-GEFC-SX
15454E-SFP-GEFC-S
ONS-SE-G2F-SX

                                                –17

                                                0

                                                –16

                                                3

                                                15454-SFP-GE+-LX
15454E-SFP-GE+-LX
ONS-SE-G2F-LX

                                                –20

                                                –3

                                                –16

                                                3

                                                ESCON

                                                15454-SFP-200
15454E-SFP-200
ONS-SE-200-MM

                                                –21

                                                –14

                                                –35

                                                –8

                                                DV6000

                                                15454-SFP-OC48-IR

                                                –18

                                                0

                                                –11

                                                6

                                                15454E-SFP-L.16.1

                                                –18

                                                –3

                                                –16

                                                3

                                                SDI_D1_ VIDEO

                                                15454-SFP12-4-IR

                                                –28

                                                –7

                                                –21

                                                –2

                                                15454E-SFP-L.4.1

                                                –28

                                                –8

                                                –21

                                                –2

                                                HDTV

                                                15454-SFP-GE+-LX
15454E-SFP-GE+-LX
ONS-SE-G2F-LX

                                                –20

                                                –3

                                                –16

                                                3

                                                PASS-THRU

                                                2R MODE 
(not specified)

                                                FC1G

                                                15454-SFP-GEFC-SX
15454E-SFP-GEFC-S
ONS-SE-G2F-SX

                                                –17

                                                0

                                                –16

                                                3

                                                15454-SFP-GE+-LX
15454E-SFP-GE+-LX
ONS-SE-G2F-LX

                                                –20

                                                –3

                                                –16

                                                3

                                                FC2G

                                                15454-SFP-GEFC-SX
15454E-SFP-GEFC-S
ONS-SE-G2F-SX

                                                –15

                                                0

                                                –16

                                                3

                                                15454-SFP-GE+-LX
15454E-SFP-GE+-LX
ONS-SE-G2F-LX

                                                –20

                                                –3

                                                –16

                                                3

                                                FICON1G

                                                15454-SFP-GEFC-SX
15454E-SFP-GEFC-S
ONS-SE-G2F-SX

                                                –17

                                                0

                                                –16

                                                3

                                                15454-SFP-GE+-LX
15454E-SFP-GE+-LX
ONS-SE-G2F-LX

                                                –20

                                                –3

                                                –16

                                                3

                                                FICON2G

                                                15454-SFP-GEFC-SX
15454E-SFP-GEFC-S
ONS-SE-G2F-SX

                                                –15

                                                0

                                                –16

                                                3

                                                15454-SFP-GE+-LX
15454E-SFP-GE+-LX
ONS-SE-G2F-LX

                                                –20

                                                –3

                                                –16

                                                3

                                                ETR_CLO

                                                15454-SFP-200
15454E-SFP-200
ONS-SE-200-MM

                                                –17

                                                0

                                                –16

                                                3

                                                ISC compat

                                                15454-SFP-GE+-LX
15454E-SFP-GE+-LX
ONS-SE-G2F-LX

                                                –20

                                                –3

                                                –16

                                                3

                                                ISC peer

                                                15454-SFP-GE+-LX
15454E-SFP-GE+-LX
ONS-SE-G2F-LX

                                                –20

                                                –3

                                                –16

                                                3

                                                Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                Step 5   Under Types, click the Alarm radio button and click Refresh.
                                                Step 6   Referring to the following table, verify the Alarm thresholds for RX Power High, RX Power Low, TX Power High, and TX Power Low based on the client interface that is provisioned. Provision new thresholds as needed by double-clicking the threshold value you want to change, deleting it, entering a new value, and hitting Enter.
                                                Table 67 TXP_MR_2.5G and TXPP_MR_2.5G Card Client Interface Alarm Thresholds

                                                Port Type
(by CTC)

                                                Pluggable Port Module 
(SFP)

                                                Alarm RX
Power Low

                                                Alarm RX
Power High

                                                Alarm TX
Power Low

                                                Alarm TX
Power High

                                                OC-3

                                                15454-SFP3-1-IR

                                                –26

                                                –5

                                                –17

                                                –6

                                                STM-1

                                                15454E-SFP-L.1.1

                                                –27

                                                –7

                                                –17

                                                –6

                                                OC-12

                                                15454-SFP12-4-IR

                                                –31

                                                –4

                                                –17

                                                –6

                                                STM-4

                                                15454E-SFP-L.4.1

                                                –31

                                                –5

                                                –17

                                                –6

                                                OC-48

                                                ONS-SE-2G-S1

                                                –21

                                                0

                                                –12

                                                –1

                                                15454-SFP-OC48-IR

                                                –21

                                                3

                                                –7

                                                2

                                                STM-16

                                                ONS-SE-2G-S1

                                                15454E-SFP-L.16.1

                                                –21

                                                0

                                                –12

                                                –1

                                                ONE_GE

                                                15454-SFP-GEFC-SX
15454E-SFP-GEFC-S
ONS-SE-G2F-SX

                                                –20

                                                3

                                                –12

                                                –2

                                                15454-SFP-GE+-LX
15454E-SFP-GE+-LX
ONS-SE-G2F-LX

                                                –23

                                                0

                                                –12

                                                –1

                                                ESCON

                                                15454-SFP-200
15454E-SFP-200
ONS-SE-200-MM

                                                –24

                                                –11

                                                –31

                                                –12

                                                DV6000

                                                15454-SFP-OC48-IR

                                                –21

                                                3

                                                –7

                                                2

                                                15454E-SFP-L.16.1

                                                –21

                                                0

                                                –12

                                                –5

                                                SDI_D1_ VIDEO

                                                15454-SFP12-4-IR

                                                –31

                                                –4

                                                –17

                                                –6

                                                15454E-SFP-L.4.1

                                                –31

                                                –5

                                                –17

                                                –6

                                                HDTV

                                                15454-SFP-GE+-LX
15454E-SFP-GE+-LX
ONS-SE-G2F-LX

                                                –23

                                                0

                                                –12

                                                –1

                                                PASS-THRU

                                                2R MODE 
(not specified)

                                                FC1G

                                                15454-SFP-GEFC-SX
15454E-SFP-GEFC-S
ONS-SE-G2F-SX

                                                –20

                                                3

                                                –12

                                                –2

                                                15454-SFP-GE+-LX
15454E-SFP-GE+-LX
ONS-SE-G2F-LX

                                                –23

                                                0

                                                –12

                                                –1

                                                FC2G

                                                15454-SFP-GEFC-SX
15454E-SFP-GEFC-S
ONS-SE-G2F-SX

                                                –18

                                                3

                                                –12

                                                –2

                                                15454-SFP-GE+-LX
15454E-SFP-GE+-LX
ONS-SE-G2F-LX

                                                –23

                                                0

                                                –12

                                                –1

                                                FICON1G

                                                15454-SFP-GEFC-SX
15454E-SFP-GEFC-S
ONS-SE-G2F-SX

                                                –20

                                                3

                                                –12

                                                –2

                                                15454-SFP-GE+-LX
15454E-SFP-GE+-LX
ONS-SE-G2F-LX

                                                –23

                                                0

                                                –12

                                                –1

                                                FICON2G

                                                15454-SFP-GEFC-SX
15454E-SFP-GEFC-S
ONS-SE-G2F-SX

                                                –18

                                                3

                                                –12

                                                –2

                                                15454-SFP-GE+-LX
15454E-SFP-GE+-LX
ONS-SE-G2F-LX

                                                –23

                                                0

                                                –12

                                                –1

                                                ETR_CLO

                                                15454-SFP-200
15454E-SFP-200
ONS-SE-200-MM

                                                –20

                                                3

                                                –12

                                                –2

                                                ISC compat

                                                15454-SFP-GE+-LX
15454E-SFP-GE+-LX
ONS-SE-G2F-LX

                                                –23

                                                0

                                                –12

                                                –1

                                                ISC peer

                                                15454-SFP-GE+-LX
15454E-SFP-GE+-LX
ONS-SE-G2F-LX

                                                –23

                                                0

                                                –12

                                                –1

                                                Step 7   Click Apply.
                                                Step 8   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                DLP-G234 Changing the Multirate Transponder OTN Settings

                                                Purpose

                                                This task changes the OTN settings for the TXP_MR_2.5G, TXPP_MR_2.5G, TXP_MR_10G, TXP_MR_10E, TXP_MR_10E_C, TXP_MR_10E_L, TXP_MR_10EX_C, 40E-TXP-C, and 40ME-TXP-C transponder cards.

                                                Tools/Equipment

                                                None

                                                Prerequisite Procedures

                                                DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                Required/As Needed

                                                As needed

                                                Onsite/Remote

                                                Onsite or remote

                                                Security Level

                                                Provisioning or higher

                                                Procedure
                                                  Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the card where you want to change the OTN settings.
                                                  Step 2   Click the Provisioning > OTN tabs, then choose one of the following subtabs: OTN Lines, G.709 Thresholds, FEC Thresholds, or Trail Trace Identifier.
                                                  Step 3   Modify any of the settings described in the following tables.
                                                  Note   

                                                  You must modify Near End and Far End; 15 Min and 1 Day; and SM and PM settings independently. To do so, choose the appropriate radio button and click Refresh.

                                                  Table 68 Multirate Transponder Card OTN Line Settings

                                                  Parameter

                                                  Description

                                                  Options

                                                  Port

                                                  (Display only) Displays the port number.

                                                  • 1 (only when data rate is set to OTU3)

                                                  • 2 (Trunk)

                                                  • 3 (Trunk) (TXPP_MR_2.5G)

                                                  G.709 OTN

                                                  Sets the OTN lines according to ITU-T G.709. For TXP-MR-10EX_C cards, the G.709 OTN should be enabled.

                                                  • Enable

                                                  • Disable

                                                  FEC

                                                  Sets the OTN lines to forward error correction (FEC). FEC mode can be Disabled, Enabled, or, Enhanced FEC mode can be enabled to provide greater range and lower bit error rate. For TXP_MR_10E, 40E-TXP-C, and 40ME-TXP-C cards, Standard is the same as enabling FEC. For TXP-MR-10EX_C cards, the FEC should be enabled.

                                                  • Enable—FEC is on.

                                                  • Disable—FEC is off.

                                                  • Standard—(TXP_MR_10E, 40E-TXP-C, and 40ME-TXP-C only) Standard FEC is on.

                                                  • Enhanced—(TXP_MR_10E, 40E-TXP-C, and 40ME-TXP-C only) Enhanced FEC is on.

                                                  SF BER

                                                  (Display only) The signal fail bit error rate.

                                                  • 1E-5

                                                  SD BER

                                                  Sets the signal degrade bit error rate.

                                                  • 1E-5

                                                  • 1E-6

                                                  • 1E-7

                                                  • 1E-8

                                                  • 1E-9

                                                  Asynch/Synch Mapping

                                                  (TXP_MR_10E only) Sets how the ODUk (client payload) is mapped to the optical channel (OTUk).

                                                  • Asynch mapping

                                                  • Synch mapping

                                                  Table 69 Multirate Transponder Card ITU-T G.709 Threshold Settings

                                                  Parameter

                                                  Description

                                                  Options

                                                  Port

                                                  (Display only) Port number.

                                                  • 2 (Trunk)

                                                  • 3 (Trunk) (TXPP_MR_2.5G)

                                                  ES

                                                  Errored seconds

                                                  Numeric. Can be set for Near End or Far End, for 15-minute or one-day intervals, or for SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk). Select a bullet and click Refresh.

                                                  Note   

                                                  SM (OTUk) is the ITU-T G.709 optical channel transport unit order of k overhead frame used for management and performance monitoring. PM (ODUk) is the ITU-T G.709 optical channel data unit order of k overhead frame unit used for path performance monitoring.

                                                  SES

                                                  Severely errored seconds

                                                  Numeric. Can be set for Near End or Far End, for 15-minute or one-day intervals, or for SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk). Select a bullet and click Refresh.

                                                  UAS

                                                  Unavailable seconds

                                                  Numeric. Can be set for Near End or Far End, for 15-minute or one-day intervals, or for SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk). Select a bullet and click Refresh.

                                                  BBE

                                                  Background block errors

                                                  Numeric. Can be set for Near End or Far End, for 15-minute or one-day intervals, or for SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk). Select a bullet and click Refresh.

                                                  FC

                                                  Failure counter

                                                  Numeric. Can be set for Near End or Far End, for 15-minute or one-day intervals, or for SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk). Select a bullet and click Refresh.

                                                  Note   

                                                  Latency for a 1G-FC payload without ITU-T G.709 is 4 microseconds, and with ITU-T G.709 is 40 microseconds. Latency for a 2G-FC payload without ITU-T G.709 is 2 microseconds, and with ITU-T G.709 is 20 microseconds. Consider these values when planning a FC network that is sensitive to latency.

                                                  Table 70 Multirate Transponder Card FEC Threshold Settings

                                                  Parameter

                                                  Description

                                                  Options

                                                  Port

                                                  (Display only) Port number.

                                                  • 2 (Trunk)

                                                  • 3 (Trunk) (TXPP_MR_2.5G)

                                                  Bit Errors Corrected

                                                  Sets the value for bit errors corrected during the selected time period.

                                                  Numeric. Can be set for 15-minute or one-day intervals.

                                                  Uncorrectable Words

                                                  Sets the value for uncorrectable words during the selected time period.

                                                  Numeric. Can be set for 15-minute or one-day intervals.

                                                  Table 71 MultirateTransponder Card Trail Trace Identifier Settings

                                                  Parameter

                                                  Description

                                                  Options

                                                  Port

                                                  (Display only) Port number.

                                                  • 1 (OTU3) for 40E-TXP-C and 40ME-TXP-C cards

                                                  • 2 (Trunk)

                                                  • 3 (Trunk) (TXPP_MR_2.5G)

                                                  Level

                                                  Sets the level.

                                                  • Section

                                                  • Path

                                                  Received Trace Mode

                                                  Sets the trace mode.

                                                  • Off/None

                                                  • Manual

                                                  Disable AIS/RDI on TIM-S

                                                  If a TIM on Section overhead alarm is raised because of a J0 overhead string mismatch, no alarm indication signal is sent to downstream nodes if this box is checked.

                                                  • Checked (AIS/RDI on TIM-S is disabled)

                                                  • Unchecked (AIS/RDI on TIM-S is enabled)

                                                  Transmit

                                                  Displays the current transmit string; sets a new transmit string. You can click the button on the right to change the display. Its title changes, based on the current display mode. Click Hex to change the display to hexadecimal (button changes to ASCII); click ASCII to change the display to ASCII (button changes to Hex Mode).

                                                  String of trace string size; trail trace identifier is 64 bytes in length.

                                                  Expected

                                                  Displays the current expected string; sets a new expected string. You can click the button on the right to change the display. Its title changes, based on the current display mode. Click Hex to change the display to hexadecimal (button changes to ASCII); click ASCII to change the display to ASCII (button changes to Hex Mode).

                                                  String of trace string size

                                                  Received

                                                  (Display only) Displays the current received string. You can click Refresh to manually refresh this display, or check the Auto-refresh every 5 sec check box to keep this panel updated.

                                                  String of trace string size

                                                  Auto-refresh

                                                  If checked, automatically refreshes the display every 5 minutes.

                                                  Checked/unchecked (default)

                                                  Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                  Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                  NTP-G96 Provisioning the 10G Multirate Transponder Card Line Settings, PM Parameters, and Thresholds

                                                  Purpose

                                                  This procedure changes the line and threshold settings for 10G multirate transponder cards including the TXP_MR_10G, TXP_MR_10E, TXP_MR_10E_C, TXP_MR_10E_L, and TXP_MR_10EX_C cards.

                                                  Tools/Equipment

                                                  None

                                                  Prerequisite Procedures

                                                  Required/As Needed

                                                  As needed

                                                  Onsite/Remote

                                                  Onsite or remote

                                                  Security Level

                                                  Provisioning or higher


                                                  Note


                                                  The TXP_MR_10G card does not support PPMs.


                                                  Procedure
                                                    Step 1   As needed, complete the NTP-G103 Backing Up the Database to preserve the existing transmission settings.
                                                    Step 2   If you are provisioning a TXP_MR_10G card, complete the DLP-G365 Provisioning the TXP_​MR_​10G Data Rate, and if you are provisioning a TXP_MR_10E or TXP_MR_10EX_C card, complete the DLP-G712 Provisioning the TXP_​MR_​10E or TXP_​MR_​10EX_​C Data Rate. If not, continue with the next step.
                                                    Step 3   Perform any of the following tasks as needed: Stop. You have completed this procedure.

                                                    DLP-G365 Provisioning the TXP_MR_10G Data Rate

                                                    Purpose

                                                    This task changes the TXP_MR_10G card data rate.

                                                    Tools/Equipment

                                                    None

                                                    Prerequisite Procedures

                                                    DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                    Required/As Needed

                                                    As needed

                                                    Onsite/Remote

                                                    Onsite or remote

                                                    Security Level

                                                    Provisioning or higher

                                                    Procedure
                                                      Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the TXP_MR_10G card where you want to change the card data rate settings.
                                                      Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Data Rate Selection tabs.
                                                      Step 3   Click Create.
                                                      Step 4   In the Create Port dialog box, choose one of the following data rates:
                                                      • SONET (ANSI) or SDH (ETSI) (including 10G Ethernet WAN Phy)

                                                      • 10G Ethernet LAN Phy

                                                      Step 5   Click Ok.
                                                      Step 6   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                      DLP-G712 Provisioning the TXP_MR_10E or TXP_MR_10EX_C Data Rate

                                                      Purpose

                                                      This task changes the TXP_MR_10E or TXP_MR_10EX_C card data rate.

                                                      Tools/Equipment

                                                      None

                                                      Prerequisite Procedures

                                                      DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                      Required/As Needed

                                                      As needed

                                                      Onsite/Remote

                                                      Onsite or remote

                                                      Security Level

                                                      Provisioning or higher

                                                      Procedure
                                                        Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the TXP_MR_10E or TXP_MR_10EX_C card where you want to change the card data rate settings.
                                                        Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Pluggable Port Modules tabs.
                                                        Step 3   In the Pluggable Port Modules area, click Create. The Create PPM dialog box appears.
                                                        Step 4   In the Create PPM dialog box, complete the following:
                                                        • PPM—Choose the SFP you want to install from the drop-down list.

                                                        • PPM Type—Choose the number of ports supported by your SFP from the drop-down list. If only one port is supported, PPM (1 port) is the only option.

                                                        Step 5   Click OK. The newly created PPM appears in the Pluggable Port Modules area. The row in the Pluggable Port Modules area turns white and the Actual Equipment Type column lists the equipment name.
                                                        Step 6   In the Pluggable Ports area, click Create. The Create Ports dialog box appears.
                                                        Step 7   In the Create Port dialog box, choose one of the following data rates:
                                                        • SONET (ANSI) or SDH (ETSI) (including 10G Ethernet WAN Phy)

                                                        • 10G Ethernet LAN Phy

                                                        • 10G FIBER Channel

                                                        • (TXP-MR-10EX_C card only) IB_5G

                                                        Step 8   Click OK.
                                                        Step 9   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                        DLP-G217 Changing the 10G Multirate Transponder Line Settings

                                                        Purpose

                                                        This task changes the line settings for TXP_MR_10G, TXP_MR_10E, TXP_MR_10E_C, TXP_MR_10E_L, and TXP_MR_10EX_C cards.

                                                        Tools/Equipment

                                                        None

                                                        Prerequisite Procedures

                                                        DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                        Required/As Needed

                                                        As needed

                                                        Onsite/Remote

                                                        Onsite or remote

                                                        Security Level

                                                        Provisioning or higher

                                                        Procedure
                                                          Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the TXP_MR_10G, TXP_MR_10E, TXP_MR_10E_C, TXP_MR_10E_L, or TXP_MR_10EX_C card where you want to change the line settings.
                                                          Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line > SONET/SDH/Ethernet tabs. SONET is the option for ANSI shelves when 10G Ethernet WAN phy is the Pluggable Port Rate, SDH is the option for ETSI shelves when 10G Ethernet WAN phy is the Pluggable Port Rate, and Ethernet is the option for ANSI or ETSI shelves when 10GE LAN Phy is the Pluggable Port Rate.
                                                          Step 3   Modify any of the settings described in the following table.
                                                          Note   

                                                          In the following table, some parameter tabs do not always apply to all 10G multirate transponder cards. If a tab does not apply, it will not appear in CTC.

                                                          Table 72 TXP_MR_10G, TXP_MR_10E, TXP_MR_10E_C, TXP_MR_10E_L, or TXP_MR_10EX_C Line Settings

                                                          Parameter

                                                          Description

                                                          ONS 15454 (ANSI) Options

                                                          ONS 15454 SDH (ETSI) Options

                                                          Port

                                                          (Display only) Displays the port number.

                                                          • 1 (OC192) (10G Ethernet WAN Phy) (if TXP_MR_10G)

                                                          • 1 (TEN_GE) (if Ethernet LAN is provisioned on the TXP_MR_10G card)

                                                          • 1-1 (OC192) (10G Ethernet WAN Phy on the TXP_MR_10E card)

                                                          • 1-1 (TEN_GE) (if Ethernet LAN is provisioned on the TXP_MR_10E card)

                                                          • 1-1 (FC10G) (if 10G fiber channel is provisioned on the TXP_MR_10E card)

                                                          • 2 (Trunk)

                                                          • (TXP_MR_10EX_C only) IB_5G

                                                          • 1 (STM-64) (10G Ethernet WAN Phy) (if TXP_MR_10G)

                                                          • 1 (TEN_GE) (if Ethernet LAN is provisioned on the TXP_MR_10G card)

                                                          • 1-1 (STM-64) (10G Ethernet WAN Phy on the TXP_MR_10E card)

                                                          • 1-1 (TEN_GE) (if Ethernet LAN is provisioned on the TXP_MR_10E card)

                                                          • 1-1 (FC10G) (if 10G fiber channel is provisioned on the TXP_MR_10E card)

                                                          • 2 (Trunk)

                                                          • (TXP_MR_10EX_C only) IB_5G

                                                          Port Name

                                                          Provides the ability to assign the specified port a name.

                                                          User-defined. Name can be up to 80 alphanumeric/special characters. Blank by default.

                                                          User-defined. Name can be up to 80 alphanumeric/special characters. Blank by default.

                                                          Admin State

                                                          Sets the port service state. For more information about administrative states, see the Administrative and Service States document.

                                                          • IS

                                                          • IS,AINS

                                                          • OOS,DSBLD

                                                          • OOS,MT

                                                          • Unlocked

                                                          • Unlocked,automaticInService

                                                          • Locked,disabled

                                                          • Locked,maintenance

                                                          Service State

                                                          (Display only) Identifies the autonomously generated state that gives the overall condition of the port. Service states appear in the format: Primary State-Primary State Qualifier, Secondary State. For more information about service states, see the Administrative and Service States document.

                                                          • IS-NR

                                                          • OOS-AU,AINS

                                                          • OOS-MA,DSBLD

                                                          • OOS-MA,MT

                                                          • Unlocked-enabled

                                                          • Unlocked-disabled,
automaticInService

                                                          • Locked-enabled,disabled

                                                          • Locked-enabled,maintenance

                                                          SF BER

                                                          (SONET [ANSI] or SDH [ETSI] including 10G Ethernet WAN Phy only) Sets the signal fail bit error rate.

                                                          • 1E-3

                                                          • 1E-4

                                                          • 1E-5

                                                          • 1E-3

                                                          • 1E-4

                                                          • 1E-5

                                                          SD BER

                                                          (SONET [ANSI] or SDH [ETSI] including 10G Ethernet WAN Phy only) Sets the signal degrade bit error rate.

                                                          • 1E-5

                                                          • 1E-6

                                                          • 1E-7

                                                          • 1E-8

                                                          • 1E-9

                                                          • 1E-5

                                                          • 1E-6

                                                          • 1E-7

                                                          • 1E-8

                                                          • 1E-9

                                                          Type

                                                          (SONET [ANSI] or SDH [ETSI] including 10G Ethernet WAN Phy only) The optical transport type.

                                                          • SONET

                                                          • SDH

                                                          • SONET

                                                          • SDH

                                                          ALS Mode

                                                          Sets the ALS function mode. The DWDM transmitter supports ALS according to ITU-T G.644 (06/99). ALS can be disabled, or it can be set for one of three mode options.

                                                          • Disabled (default): ALS is off; the laser is not automatically shut down when traffic outages (LOS) occur.

                                                          • Auto Restart: ALS is on; the laser automatically shuts down when traffic outages (LOS) occur. It automatically restarts when the conditions that caused the outage are resolved.

                                                          • Manual Restart: ALS is on; the laser automatically shuts down when traffic outages (LOS) occur. However, the laser must be manually restarted when conditions that caused the outage are resolved.

                                                          • Manual Restart for Test: Manually restarts the laser for testing.

                                                          • Disabled (default): ALS is off; the laser is not automatically shut down when traffic outages (LOS) occur.

                                                          • Auto Restart: ALS is on; the laser automatically shuts down when traffic outages (LOS) occur. It automatically restarts when the conditions that caused the outage are resolved.

                                                          • Manual Restart: ALS is on; the laser automatically shuts down when traffic outages (LOS) occur. However, the laser must be manually restarted when conditions that caused the outage are resolved.

                                                          • Manual Restart for Test: Manually restarts the laser for testing.

                                                          AINS Soak

                                                          (SONET [ANSI] or SDH [ETSI] including 10G Ethernet WAN Phy only) Sets the automatic in-service soak period. Double-click the time and use the up and down arrows to change settings.

                                                          • Duration of valid input signal, in hh.mm format, after which the card becomes in service (IS) automatically

                                                          • 0 to 48 hours, 15-minute increments

                                                          • Duration of valid input signal, in hh.mm format, after which the card becomes in service (IS) automatically

                                                          • 0 to 48 hours, 15-minute increments

                                                          ProvidesSync

                                                          (TXP_MR_10E, OC192 only) Sets the ProvidesSync card parameter. If checked, the card is provisioned as a network element (NE) timing reference.

                                                          Checked or unchecked

                                                          Checked or unchecked

                                                          SyncMsgIn

                                                          (TXP_MR_10E, OC192 only) Sets the EnableSync card parameter. Enables synchronization status messages (S1 byte), which allow the node to choose the best timing source.

                                                          Checked or unchecked

                                                          Checked or unchecked

                                                          Max Size

                                                          (TXP_MR_10E, TXP_MR_10G LAN Phy only) Sets the maximum Ethernet packet size.

                                                          • 1548 bytes

                                                          • Jumbo (1518 to 9216 bytes)

                                                          • 1548 bytes

                                                          • Jumbo (1518 to 9216 bytes)

                                                          Incoming MAC Address

                                                          (TXP_MR_10E, TXP_MR_10G LAN Phy only) Sets the incoming MAC address.

                                                          Value of MAC address. Six bytes in hexadecimal format.

                                                          Value of MAC address. Six bytes in hexadecimal format.

                                                          Wavelength

                                                          Displays the wavelength of the client port.

                                                          • First Tunable Wavelength

                                                          • Further wavelengths: 1310 nm through 1560.61 nm, 100-GHz ITU spacing; coarse wavelength division multiplexing (CWDM) spacing

                                                          Note: supported wavelengths are marked by asterisks (**)

                                                          • First Tunable Wavelength

                                                          • Further wavelengths: 1310 nm through 1560.61 nm, 100-GHz ITU spacing; coarse wavelength division multiplexing (CWDM) spacing

                                                          Note: supported wavelengths are marked by asterisks (**)

                                                          Reach

                                                          Displays the optical reach distance of the client port.

                                                          The Reach options depend on the traffic type that has been selected.

                                                          The Reach options depend on the traffic type that has been selected.

                                                          Squelch Hold Off Timer

                                                          (Only for TXP_MR_10E card) Sets the period in milliseconds that the client interface waits for resolution of issues on the trunk side. The client squelching starts after this period.

                                                          The user can configure the squelch hold off timer in CTC only under the following conditions:

                                                          • The card must be configured in TXP or MXP operating modes.

                                                          • The client payload must be 10GE or 100GE.

                                                          • The Squelch drop-down in CTC must be set to Squelch.

                                                          • Disable (0 ms) - Default value

                                                          • 50 ms

                                                          • 100 ms

                                                          • 250 ms

                                                          • 500 ms

                                                          • Disable (0 ms) - Default value

                                                          • 50 ms

                                                          • 100 ms

                                                          • 250 ms

                                                          • 500 ms

                                                          Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                          Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                          DLP-G218 Changing the 10G or 40G Multirate Transponder Line Section Trace Settings

                                                          Purpose

                                                          This task changes the line section trace settings for the TXP_MR_10G, TXP_MR_10E, TXP_MR_10E_C, TXP_MR_10E_L, TXP_MR_10EX_C, 40E-TXP-C, and 40ME-TXP-C transponder cards.

                                                          Tools/Equipment

                                                          None

                                                          Prerequisite Procedures

                                                          DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                          Required/As Needed

                                                          As needed

                                                          Onsite/Remote

                                                          Onsite or remote

                                                          Security Level

                                                          Provisioning or higher

                                                          Procedure
                                                            Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the card where you want to change the section trace settings.
                                                            Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line > Section Trace tabs.
                                                            Note   

                                                            The Section Trace tab is available for the 10G Multirate Transponder cards only if no PPMs are provisioned, or the OC192 PPM is provisioned. The tab is not available if a 10G Ethernet LAN Phy or 10G Fibre Channel PPM is provisioned.

                                                            Step 3   Modify any of the settings described in the following table.
                                                            Table 73 10G or 40G Card Section Trace Settings

                                                            Parameter

                                                            Description

                                                            SONET Options

                                                            SDH Options

                                                            Port

                                                            Sets the port number.

                                                            • 1-1 (OC192) and 2—Trunk for 10G cards

                                                            • 1 (OC-768) and 2 (OC-768) for 40G cards

                                                            • 1-1 (STM64) and 2—Trunk for 10G cards

                                                            • 1 (STM-256) and 2 (STM-256) for 40G cards

                                                            Received Trace Mode

                                                            Sets the trace mode.

                                                            • Off/None

                                                            • Manual

                                                            • Off/None

                                                            • Manual

                                                            Transmit Section Trace String Size

                                                            Sets the trace string size.

                                                            • 1 byte

                                                            • 16 byte

                                                            • 1 byte

                                                            • 16 byte

                                                            Transmit

                                                            Displays the current transmit string; sets a new transmit string. You can click the button on the right to change the display. Its title changes, based on the current display mode. In Transmit String Type, click Hex Mode to change the display to hexadecimal (button changes to ASCII); click ASCII to change the display to ASCII (button changes to Hex Mode).The supported range for 1 bit Hex TX trace is 20 to 7E. If TX trace is provisioned outside this range, client transmits 00.

                                                            String of trace string size

                                                            String of trace string size

                                                            Disable AIS/RDI on TIM-S

                                                            If an TIM on Section overhead alarm arises because of a J0 overhead string mismatch, no alarm indication signal is sent to downstream nodes if this box is checked.

                                                            • Checked (AIS/RDI on TIM-S is disabled)

                                                            • Unchecked (AIS/RDI on TIM-S is not disabled)

                                                            • Checked (AIS/RDI on TIM-S is disabled)

                                                            • Unchecked (AIS/RDI on TIM-S is not disabled)

                                                            Expected

                                                            Displays the current expected string; sets a new expected string. You can click thebutton on the right to change the display. Its title changes, based on the current display mode. In Expected String Type, click Hex Mode to change the display to hexadecimal (button changes to ASCII); click ASCII to change the display to ASCII (button changes to Hex Mode).

                                                            String of trace string size

                                                            String of trace string size

                                                            Received

                                                            (Display only) Displays the current received string. You can click Refresh to manually refresh this display, or check the Auto-refresh every 5 sec check box to keep this panel updated.

                                                            String of trace string size

                                                            String of trace string size

                                                            Auto-refresh

                                                            If checked, automatically refreshes the display every 5 seconds.

                                                            Checked/unchecked (default)

                                                            Checked/unchecked (default)

                                                            Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                            Step 5   Click Default to restore default values.
                                                            Step 6   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                            DLP-G319 Changing the 10G Multirate Transponder Line RMON Thresholds for 10G Ethernet LAN Phy Payloads

                                                            Purpose

                                                            This task changes the line threshold settings for TXP_MR_10G, TXP_MR_10E, TXP_MR_10E_C, TXP_MR_10E_L, and TXP_MR_10EX_C transponder cards carrying the physical 10G Ethernet LAN payload.

                                                            Tools/Equipment

                                                            None

                                                            Prerequisite Procedures

                                                            DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                            Required/As Needed

                                                            As needed

                                                            Onsite/Remote

                                                            Onsite or remote

                                                            Security Level

                                                            Provisioning or higher

                                                            Procedure
                                                              Step 1   Display the TXP_MR_10G, TXP_MR_10E, TXP_MR_10E_C, TXP_MR_10E_L, or TXP_MR_10EX_C card where you want to change the line threshold settings in card view.
                                                              Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line Thresholds > RMON Thresholds tabs.
                                                              Step 3   Click Create. The Create Threshold dialog box appears.
                                                              Step 4   From the Port drop-down list, choose the applicable port.
                                                              Step 5   From the Variable drop-down list, choose an Ethernet variable. See the following table for a list of available Ethernet variables.
                                                              Table 74 TXP_MR_10G, TXP_MR_10E, TXP_MR_10E_C, TXP_MR_10E_L, or TXP_MR_10EX_C Card GE LAN Phy Variables

                                                              Variable

                                                              Description

                                                              ifInOctets

                                                              Total number of octets received on the interface, including framing characters.

                                                              rxTotalPkts

                                                              Total number of received packets.

                                                              ifInMulticastPkts

                                                              Number of multicast frames received error free.

                                                              ifInBroadcastPkts

                                                              Number of packets, delivered by a sublayer to an higher sublayer, that were addressed to a broadcast address at this sublayer.

                                                              ifInErrors

                                                              Number of inbound packets that contained errors preventing them from being delivered to a higher-layer protocol.

                                                              ifInErrorBytePkts (TXP_MR_10G only)

                                                              Number of receive error bytes.

                                                              ifInFramingErrorPkts (TXP_MR_10G only)

                                                              Number of receive framing error counters.

                                                              ifInJunkInterPkts (TXP_MR_10G only)

                                                              Number of receive interpacket junk counters.

                                                              ifOutOctets 
(TXP_MR_10G only)

                                                              Total number of octets transmitted out of the interface, including framing characters.

                                                              txTotalPkts 
(TXP_MR_10G only)

                                                              Total number of transmit packets.

                                                              ifOutMulticastPkts (TXP_MR_10G only)

                                                              Number of multicast frames transmitted error free.

                                                              ifOutBroadcastPkts (TXP_MR_10G only)

                                                              Total number of packets that higher-level protocols requested be transmitted, and that were addressed to a broadcast address at this sublayer, including those that were discarded or not sent.

                                                              dot3StatsFCSErrors

                                                              Number of frames with frame check errors, that is, there is an integral number of octets, but an incorrect Frame Check Sequence (FCS).

                                                              dot3StatsFrameTooLong (TXP_MR_10G only)

                                                              Number of received frames that were larger than the maximum size permitted.

                                                              etherStatsUndersizePkts

                                                              Total number of packets received that were less than 64 octets long (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets) and were otherwise well formed.

                                                              etherStatsFragments

                                                              Total number of packets received that were less than 64 octets in length (excluding framing bits but including FCS octets) and had either a bad FCS with an integral number of octets (FCS Error) or a bad FCS with a non-integral number of octets (Alignment Error). Note that it is entirely normal for etherStatsFragments to increment. This is because it counts both runts (which are normal occurrences due to collisions) and noise hits.

                                                              etherStatsPkts64Octets

                                                              Total number of packets (including bad packets) received that were 64 octets in length (excluding framing bits but including FCS octets).

                                                              etherStatsPkts65to127Octets

                                                              Total number of packets (including bad packets) received that were between 65 and 127 octets in length inclusive (excluding framing bits but including FCS octets).

                                                              etherStatsPkts128to255Octets

                                                              The total number of packets (including bad packets) received that were between 128 and 255 octets in length inclusive (excluding framing bits but including FCS octets).

                                                              etherStatsPkts256to511Octets

                                                              Total number of packets (including bad packets) received that were between 256 and 511 octets in length inclusive (excluding framing bits but including FCS octets).

                                                              etherStatsPkts512to1023Octets

                                                              Total number of packets (including bad packets) received that were between 512 and 1023 octets in length inclusive (excluding framing bits but including FCS octets).

                                                              etherStatsPkts1024to1518Octets

                                                              Total number of packets (including bad packets) received that were between 1024 and 1518 octets in length inclusive (excluding framing bits but including FCS octets).

                                                              etherStatsBroadcastPkts

                                                              Total number of good packets received that were directed to the broadcast address. Note that this does not include multicast packets.

                                                              etherStatsMulticastPkts

                                                              Total number of good packets received that were directed to a multicast address. Note that this number does not include packets directed to the broadcast address.

                                                              etherStatsOversizePkts

                                                              The total number of packets received that were longer than 1518 octets (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets) and were otherwise well formed.

                                                              etherStatsJabbers

                                                              Total number of packets received that were longer than 1518 octets (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets), and had either a bad FCS with an integral number of octets (FCS Error) or a bad FCS with a nonintegral number of octets (Alignment Error).

                                                              etherStatsOctets

                                                              Total number of octets of data (including those in bad packets) received on the network (excluding framing bits but including FCS octets).

                                                              etherStatsCRCAlignErrors (TXP_MR_10G only)

                                                              Total number of packets received that had a length (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets) of between 64 and 1518 octets, inclusive, but had either a bad FCS with an integral number of octets (FCS Error) or a bad FCS with a non-integral number of octets (Alignment Error).

                                                              rxPauseFrames 
(TXP_MR_10G only)

                                                              Number of received IETF 802.x pause frames.

                                                              rxControlFrames

                                                              Number of MAC control frames passed by the MAC sublayer to the MAC control sublayer.

                                                              rxUnknownOpcodeFrames (TXP_MR_10G only)

                                                              Number of MAC control frames received that contain an opcode that is not supported by the device.

                                                              Step 6   From the Alarm Type drop-down list, indicate whether the event will be triggered by the rising threshold, the falling threshold, or both the rising and falling thresholds.
                                                              Step 7   From the Sample Type drop-down list, choose either Relative or Absolute. Relative restricts the threshold to use the number of occurrences in the user-set sample period. Absolute sets the threshold to use the total number of occurrences, regardless of time period.
                                                              Step 8   Type in an appropriate number of seconds for the Sample Period.
                                                              Step 9   Type in the appropriate number of occurrences for the Rising Threshold.

                                                              For a rising type of alarm, the measured value must move from below the falling threshold to above the rising threshold. For example, if a network is running below a rising threshold of 1000 collisions every 15 seconds and a problem causes 1001 collisions in 15 seconds, the excess occurrences trigger an alarm.

                                                              Step 10   Enter the appropriate number of occurrences in the Falling Threshold field. In most cases a falling threshold is set lower than the rising threshold.

                                                              A falling threshold is the counterpart to a rising threshold. When the number of occurrences is above the rising threshold and then drops below a falling threshold, it resets the rising threshold. For example, when the network problem that caused 1001 collisions in 15 seconds subsides and creates only 799 collisions in 15 seconds, occurrences fall below a falling threshold of 800 collisions. This resets the rising threshold so that if network collisions again spike over a 1000 per 15-second period, an event again triggers when the rising threshold is crossed. An event is triggered only the first time a rising threshold is exceeded (otherwise, a single network problem might cause a rising threshold to be exceeded multiple times and cause a flood of events).

                                                              Step 11   Click OK.
                                                              Note   

                                                              To view all RMON thresholds, click Show All RMON thresholds.

                                                              Step 12   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                              DLP-G301 Provisioning the 10G Multirate Transponder Trunk Port Alarm and TCA Thresholds

                                                              Purpose

                                                              This task provisions the TXP_MR_10G, TXP_MR_10E, TXP_MR_10E_C, TXP_MR_10E_L, or TXP_MR_10EX_C trunk port alarm and threshold cross alert (TCA) thresholds.

                                                              Tools/Equipment

                                                              None

                                                              Prerequisite Procedures

                                                              DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                              Required/As Needed

                                                              As needed

                                                              Onsite/Remote

                                                              Onsite or remote

                                                              Security Level

                                                              Provisioning or higher

                                                              Procedure
                                                                Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the TXP_MR_10G, TXP_MR_10E, TXP_MR_10E_C, TXP_MR_10E_L, or TXP_MR_10EX_C card where you want to change the trunk port alarm and TCA settings.
                                                                Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Optics Thresholds tabs.
                                                                Step 3   Under Types, verify that the TCA radio button is checked. If not, check it, then click Refresh.
                                                                Step 4   Referring to the following table, verify the trunk port (Port 2) TCA thresholds for RX Power High, RX Power Low, TX Power High, and TX Power Low. Provision new thresholds as needed by double-clicking the threshold value you want to change, deleting the existing value, and entering the new value. Hit Enter, then click Apply.
                                                                Note   

                                                                You must modify 15 Min and 1 Day independently. To do so, choose the appropriate radio button and click Refresh.

                                                                Note   

                                                                Do not modify the Laser Bias parameters.

                                                                Table 75 10G Multirate Transponder Trunk Port TCA Thresholds

                                                                Card

                                                                TCA RX

                                                                Power High

                                                                TCA RX

                                                                Power Low

                                                                TCA TX

                                                                Power High

                                                                TCA TX

                                                                Power Low

                                                                TXP_MR_10G

                                                                –8 dBm

                                                                –18 dBm

                                                                7 dBm

                                                                –1 dBm

                                                                TXP_MR_10E

                                                                TXP_MR_10E_C

                                                                TXP_MR_10E_L

                                                                TXP_MR_10EX_C

                                                                –9 dBm

                                                                –18 dBm

                                                                9 dBm

                                                                0 dBm

                                                                Step 5   Click Apply.
                                                                Step 6   Under Types, click the Alarm radio button and click Refresh.
                                                                Step 7   Referring to the following table, verify the trunk port (Port 2) Alarm thresholds for RX Power High, RX Power Low, TX Power High, and TX Power Low. Provision new thresholds as needed by double-clicking the threshold value you want to change, deleting the existing value, and entering the new value. Hit Enter, then click Apply.
                                                                Note   

                                                                You must modify 15 Min and 1 Day independently. To do so, choose the appropriate radio button and click Refresh.

                                                                Table 76 10G Multirate Transponder Trunk Port Alarm Thresholds

                                                                Card

                                                                Alarm RX

                                                                Power High

                                                                Alarm RX

                                                                Power Low

                                                                Alarm TX

                                                                Power High

                                                                Alarm TX

                                                                Power Low

                                                                TXP_MR_10G

                                                                –8 dBm

                                                                –20 dBm

                                                                4 dBm

                                                                2 dBm

                                                                TXP_MR_10E

                                                                TXP_MR_10E_C

                                                                TXP_MR_10E_L

                                                                TXP_MR_10EX_C

                                                                –8 dBm

                                                                –20 dBm

                                                                7 dBm

                                                                3 dBm

                                                                Step 8   Click Apply.
                                                                Step 9   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                DLP-G302 Provisioning the 10G Multirate Transponder Client Port Alarm and TCA Thresholds

                                                                Purpose

                                                                This task provisions the client port alarm and TCA thresholds for the TXP_MR_10G, TXP_MR_10E, TXP_MR_10E_C, TXP_MR_10E_L, and TXP_MR_10EX_C cards.

                                                                Tools/Equipment

                                                                None

                                                                Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                DLP-G278 Provisioning the Optical Line Rate

                                                                DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                Required/As Needed

                                                                Required

                                                                Onsite/Remote

                                                                Onsite or remote

                                                                Security Level

                                                                Provisioning or higher

                                                                Procedure
                                                                  Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the TXP_MR_10G, TXP_MR_10E, TXP_MR_10E_C, TXP_MR_10E_L, or TXP_MR_10EX_C card where you want to change the client port alarm and TCA settings.
                                                                  Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Optics Thresholds tabs. The TCA thresholds are shown by default.
                                                                  Step 3   Under Types, verify that the TCA radio button is checked. If not, check it, then click Refresh.
                                                                  Step 4   Referring to the following table, verify the Port 1 (Client) TCA thresholds for RX Power High, RX Power Low, TX Power High, and TX Power Low based on the client interface at the other end. Provision new thresholds as needed by double-clicking the threshold value you want to change, deleting the existing value, and entering the new value. Hit Enter, then click Apply.
                                                                  Note   

                                                                  You must modify 15 Min and 1 Day independently. To do so, choose the appropriate radio button and click Refresh.

                                                                  Note   

                                                                  Do not modify the Laser Bias parameters.

                                                                  Note   

                                                                  The hardware device that plugs into a TXP, MXP, GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, 10GE_XPE, or ADM-10G card faceplate to provide a fiber interface to the card is called a Small Form-factor Pluggable (SFP or XFP). In CTC, SFPs and XFPs are called pluggable port modules (PPMs). SFPs/XFPs are hot-swappable input/output devices that plug into a port to link the port with the fiber-optic network. Multirate PPMs have provisionable port rates and payloads. For more information about SFPs and XFPs, see the SFP, SFP+, QSFP+, XFP, CXP, CFP, and CPAK Modules.

                                                                  Table 77 TXP_MR_10G, TXP_MR_10E, TXP_MR_10E_C, TXP_MR_10E_L, or TXP_MR_10EX_C Card Client Interface TCA Thresholds

                                                                  Pluggable Port Rate

                                                                  Pluggable Port Module (XFP)

                                                                  TCA RX
Power High

                                                                  TCA RX
Power Low

                                                                  TCA TX
Power High

                                                                  TCA TX
Power Low

                                                                  SONET (or SDH)

                                                                  TXP_MR_10E uses
ONS-XC-10G-S1

                                                                  TXP_MR_10G
(XFP not present)

                                                                  –1

                                                                  –11

                                                                  –1

                                                                  –6

                                                                  10G Ethernet LAN Phy

                                                                  TXP_MR_10E uses
ONS-XC-10G-S1

                                                                  TXP_MR_10G
(XFP not present)

                                                                  0.5

                                                                  –14.4

                                                                  –1

                                                                  –6

                                                                  10G Fibre Channel

                                                                  TXP_MR_10E uses
ONS-XC-10G-S1

                                                                  0.5

                                                                  –14.4

                                                                  –1

                                                                  –6

                                                                  IB_5G (Only the TXP_MR_10EX_C card supports IB_5G)

                                                                  TXP_MR_10EX_C uses ONS-XC-10G-S1 Version 3

                                                                  1.0

                                                                  –14.0

                                                                  5.0

                                                                  12.0

                                                                  Step 5   Click Apply.
                                                                  Step 6   Under Types, click the Alarm radio button and click Refresh.
                                                                  Step 7   Referring to the following table, provision the Port 1 (Client) Alarm thresholds for RX Power High, RX Power Low, TX Power High, and TX Power Low based on the client interface that is provisioned.
                                                                  Note   

                                                                  You must modify 15 Min and 1 Day independently. To do so, choose the appropriate radio button and click Refresh.

                                                                  Table 78 TXP_MR_10G, TXP_MR_10E, TXP_MR_10E_C, TXP_MR_10E_L, or TXP_MR_10EX_C Card Client Interface Alarm Thresholds

                                                                  Pluggable Port Rate

                                                                  Pluggable Port Module (XFP)

                                                                  Alarm RX
Power High

                                                                  Alarm RX
Power Low

                                                                  Alarm TX
Power High

                                                                  Alarm TX
Power Low

                                                                  SONET (or SDH)

                                                                  TXP_MR_10E uses
ONS-XC-10G-S1

                                                                  TXP_MR_10G
(XFP not present)

                                                                  3

                                                                  –16

                                                                  1

                                                                  –8

                                                                  10G Ethernet LAN Phy

                                                                  TXP_MR_10E uses
ONS-XC-10G-S1

                                                                  TXP_MR_10G
(XFP not present)

                                                                  3

                                                                  –16

                                                                  1

                                                                  –8

                                                                  10G Fibre Channel

                                                                  TXP_MR_10E uses
ONS-XC-10G-S1

                                                                  3

                                                                  –16

                                                                  1

                                                                  –8

                                                                  IB_5G (Only the TXP_MR_10EX_C card supports IB_5G)

                                                                  TXP_MR_10EX_C uses ONS-XC-10G-S1 Version 3

                                                                  3.0

                                                                  –16

                                                                  1.0

                                                                  –8

                                                                  Step 8   Click Apply.
                                                                  Step 9   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                  NTP-G292 Provisioning the 40G Multirate Transponder Card Line Settings, PM Parameters, and Thresholds

                                                                  Purpose

                                                                  This procedure changes the line settings, PM parameters, and threshold settings for 40G multirate transponder cards (40E-TXP-C, 40ME-TXP-C).

                                                                  Tools/Equipment

                                                                  None

                                                                  Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                  Required/As Needed

                                                                  As needed

                                                                  Onsite/Remote

                                                                  Onsite or remote

                                                                  Security Level

                                                                  Provisioning or higher


                                                                  Note


                                                                  The 40E-TXP-C and 40ME-TXP-C cards do not support PPMs.


                                                                  Procedure
                                                                    Step 1   As needed, complete the NTP-G103 Backing Up the Database task to preserve the existing transmission settings.
                                                                    Step 2   If you are provisioning a 40E-TXP-C or 40ME-TXP-C card, complete the DLP-G656 Provisioning the 40E-TXP-C and 40ME-TXP-C Data Rate task. If not, continue with the next step.
                                                                    Step 3   Perform any of the following tasks as needed: Stop. You have completed this procedure.

                                                                    DLP-G656 Provisioning the 40E-TXP-C and 40ME-TXP-C Data Rate

                                                                    Purpose

                                                                    This task changes the 40E-TXP-C and 40ME-TXP-C card data rate.

                                                                    Tools/Equipment

                                                                    None

                                                                    Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                    DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                    Required/As Needed

                                                                    As needed

                                                                    Onsite/Remote

                                                                    Onsite or remote

                                                                    Security Level

                                                                    Provisioning or higher

                                                                    Procedure
                                                                      Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the 40E-TXP-C card where you want to change the card data rate settings.
                                                                      Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Data Rate Selection tabs.
                                                                      Step 3   Click Create.
                                                                      Step 4   In the Create Port dialog box, choose one of the following data rates:
                                                                      • SONET (ANSI) OC-768 or SDH (ETSI) STM-256

                                                                      • 40G Ethernet LAN Phy (only when overclock mode is ON)

                                                                      • OTU3

                                                                      Step 5   Click OK.
                                                                      Step 6   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                      DLP-G657 Changing the 40G Multirate Transponder Card Settings

                                                                      Purpose

                                                                      This task changes the card settings of the 40E-TXP-C and 40ME-TXP-C cards.

                                                                      Tools/Equipment

                                                                      None

                                                                      Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                      DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                      Required/As Needed

                                                                      As needed

                                                                      Onsite/Remote

                                                                      Onsite or remote

                                                                      Security Level

                                                                      Provisioning or higher

                                                                      Procedure
                                                                        Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the 40E-TXP-C card where you want to change the card settings.
                                                                        Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Card tabs.
                                                                        Step 3   Modify any of the settings described in the following table.
                                                                        Table 79 40E-TXP-C and 40ME-TXP-C Card Settings

                                                                        Parameter

                                                                        Description

                                                                        ANSI Options

                                                                        ETSI Options

                                                                        Regeneration Peer Slot

                                                                        Sets the slot containing another 40E-TXP-C or 40ME-TXP-C card to create a regeneration peer group. A regeneration peer group facilitates the management of two 40E-TXP-C or 40ME-TXP-C cards that are needed to perform a complete signal regeneration.

                                                                        The regeneration peer group synchronizes provisioning of the two cards. Payload type and ITU-T G.709 optical transport network (OTN) changes made on one 40E-TXP-C or 40ME-TXP-C card is reflected on the peer 40E-TXP-C or 40ME-TXP-C card.

                                                                        Note   

                                                                        Y-cable protection groups cannot be created on TXP cards that are in a regeneration peer group.

                                                                        • None

                                                                        • 1

                                                                        • 2

                                                                        • 3

                                                                        • 4

                                                                        • 5

                                                                        • 12

                                                                        • 13

                                                                        • 14

                                                                        • 15

                                                                        • 16

                                                                        • None

                                                                        • 1

                                                                        • 2

                                                                        • 3

                                                                        • 4

                                                                        • 5

                                                                        • 12

                                                                        • 13

                                                                        • 14

                                                                        • 15

                                                                        • 16

                                                                        Regeneration Group Name

                                                                        (Display only) The regeneration peer group name.

                                                                        Trunk Wavelengths

                                                                        (Display only) Shows the supported wavelengths of the trunk port after the card is installed. The 40E-TXP-C, or 40ME-TXP-C that is installed shows the C-band wavelengths that it supports.

                                                                        Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                        Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                        DLP-G658 Changing the 40G Multirate Transponder Line Settings

                                                                        Purpose

                                                                        This task changes the line settings of the 40E-TXP-C and 40ME-TXP-C cards.

                                                                        Tools/Equipment

                                                                        None

                                                                        Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                        DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                        Required/As Needed

                                                                        As needed

                                                                        Onsite/Remote

                                                                        Onsite or remote

                                                                        Security Level

                                                                        Provisioning or higher

                                                                        Procedure
                                                                          Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the 40E-TXP-C card where you want to change the line settings.
                                                                          Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line > Ports tabs.
                                                                          Step 3   Modify any of the settings for the Client tab as described in the following table.
                                                                          Table 80 Line Settings of the 40E-TXP-C, and 40ME-TXP-C Cards

                                                                          Parameter

                                                                          Description

                                                                          Options

                                                                          Port

                                                                          (Display only) Displays the port number.

                                                                          1 and 2

                                                                          Port Name

                                                                          Assigns a logical name for each of the ports shown by filling in this field.

                                                                          User-defined. The port name can be up to 80 alphanumeric or special characters, or both. The port name is blank by default.

                                                                          Admin State

                                                                          Sets the port service state unless network conditions prevent the change. For more information about service states, see the Administrative and Service States document.

                                                                          • IS (ANSI) or Unlocked (ETSI)

                                                                          • OOS,DSBLD (ANSI) or Locked,disabled (ETSI)

                                                                          • OOS,MT (ANSI) or Locked,maintenance (ETSI)

                                                                          • IS,AINS (ANSI) or Unlocked,automaticInService (ETSI)

                                                                          Service State

                                                                          (Display only) Identifies the autonomously generated state that gives the overall condition of the port. Service states appear in the format: Primary State-Primary State Qualifier, Secondary State. For more information about service states, see the Administrative and Service States document.

                                                                          • IS-NR (ANSI) or Unlocked-enabled (ETSI)

                                                                          • OOS-AU,AINS (ANSI) or Unlocked-disabled,
automaticInService (ETSI)

                                                                          • OOS-MA,DSBLD (ANSI) or Locked-enabled,disabled (ETSI)

                                                                          • OOS-MA,MT (ANSI) or Locked-enabled,maintenance (ETSI)

                                                                          ALS Mode

                                                                          (Client port only) Sets the ALS function mode.

                                                                          • Disabled (default)—ALS is off; the laser is not automatically shut down when traffic outage or loss of signal (LOS) occurs.

                                                                          • Auto Restart: (OC-768/STM-256/OTU-3 only) ALS is on; the laser automatically shuts down when traffic outages (LOS) occur. It automatically restarts when the conditions that caused the outage are resolved.

                                                                          • Manual Restart—ALS is on; the laser automatically shuts down when traffic outage or LOS occurs. However, the laser must be manually restarted when conditions that caused the outage are resolved.

                                                                          • Manual Restart for Test—Manually restarts the laser for testing.

                                                                          Reach

                                                                          (Display only) Displays the optical reach distance of the port.

                                                                          • Autoprovision—(trunk port only) The system automatically provisions the reach.

                                                                          • VSR—(client port only) The system provisions very short reach (VSR) for the port.

                                                                          Wavelength

                                                                          Provisions the wavelength for the port.

                                                                          • First Tunable Wavelength

                                                                          • Further wavelengths:
Further wavelengths in 100-GHz ITU-T C-band spacing. The wavelengths carried by the card are identified with two asterisks. If the card is not installed, all wavelengths appear with a dark grey background.

                                                                          Fault Signalling

                                                                          (Display only) Applicable only to client port 1. When the termination mode is set to transparent, Squelch/Laser-Off is enabled. For section/line termination mode, AIS/Send Local Fault is enabled.
For trunk port, Squelch/Laser-Off is disabled.

                                                                          • Squelch/Laser-Off

                                                                          • AIS/Send Local Fault

                                                                          • Disable/Transparent

                                                                            Note   

                                                                            Both Squelch/Laser-Off and AIS/Send Local Fault options are supported when the selected Termination Mode is Transparent. If the Termination Mode selected is Section or Line, then only AIS/Send Local Fault is supported. This is applicable for OC-192/STM-64 and OC-768/STM-256.
For OTN payloads, both Squelch/Laser-Off and AIS/Send Local Fault options are supported.

                                                                          Overclock

                                                                          Enables or disables overclock mode on trunk port.

                                                                          • OFF (default)

                                                                          • ON

                                                                          Rx Wavelength

                                                                          Provisions the wavelength of the trunk port.

                                                                          • First Tunable Wavelength

                                                                          • Further wavelengths:
Further wavelengths in 100-GHz ITU-T C-band spacing. The wavelengths carried by the card are identified with two asterisks. If the card is not installed, all wavelengths appear with a dark grey background.

                                                                          Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                          Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                          DLP-G659 Changing the 40G Multirate Transponder SONET, SDH, or Ethernet Line Settings

                                                                          Purpose

                                                                          This task changes the SONET, SDH, or Ethernet line settings for 40E-TXP-C and 40ME-TXP-C cards.

                                                                          Tools/Equipment

                                                                          None

                                                                          Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                          DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                          Required/As Needed

                                                                          As needed

                                                                          Onsite/Remote

                                                                          Onsite or remote

                                                                          Security Level

                                                                          Provisioning or higher

                                                                          Procedure
                                                                            Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the 40E-TXP-C card where you want to change the SONET, SDH, or Ethernet line settings.
                                                                            Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line > SONET/SDH/Ethernet tabs.
                                                                            Step 3   Modify any of the settings described in the following table.
                                                                            Note   

                                                                            In the following table, some parameter tabs do not always apply to all 40G multirate transponder cards. If a tab does not apply, it will not appear in CTC.

                                                                            Table 81 SONET, SDH Line Settings of the 40E-TXP-C and 40ME-TXP-C Cards

                                                                            Parameter

                                                                            Description

                                                                            ANSI Options

                                                                            ETSI Options

                                                                            Port

                                                                            (Display only) Displays the port number.

                                                                            • 1 (OC-768)

                                                                            • 1 (40G Ethernet LAN Phy)

                                                                            • 1 (OTU3)

                                                                            • 1 (STM-256)

                                                                            • 1 (40G Ethernet LAN Phy)

                                                                            • 1 (OTU3)

                                                                            SF BER

                                                                            (SONET [ANSI] or SDH [ETSI] only) Sets the signal fail bit error rate.

                                                                            • 1E-3

                                                                            • 1E-4

                                                                            • 1E-5

                                                                            • 1E-3

                                                                            • 1E-4

                                                                            • 1E-5

                                                                            SD BER

                                                                            (SONET [ANSI] or SDH [ETSI] only) Sets the signal degrade bit error rate.

                                                                            • 1E-5

                                                                            • 1E-6

                                                                            • 1E-7

                                                                            • 1E-8

                                                                            • 1E-9

                                                                            • 1E-5

                                                                            • 1E-6

                                                                            • 1E-7

                                                                            • 1E-8

                                                                            • 1E-9

                                                                            ProvidesSync

                                                                            (OC-768/STM-256 only) Sets the ProvidesSync card parameter. If checked, the card is provisioned as a network element (NE) timing reference.

                                                                            Checked or unchecked

                                                                            Checked or unchecked

                                                                            SyncMsgIn

                                                                            (OC-768/STM-256 only) Sets the EnableSync card parameter. Enables synchronization status messages (S1 byte), which allow the node to choose the best timing source.

                                                                            Checked or unchecked

                                                                            Checked or unchecked

                                                                            Admin SSM In

                                                                            Overrides the synchronization status message (SSM) and the synchronization traceability unknown (STU) value. If the node does not receive an SSM signal, it defaults to STU.

                                                                            • PRS—Primary Reference Source (Stratum 1)

                                                                            • STU—Sync traceability unknown

                                                                            • ST2—Stratum 2

                                                                            • ST3—Stratum 3

                                                                            • SMC—SONET minimum clock

                                                                            • ST4—Stratum 4

                                                                            • DUS—Do not use for timing synchronization

                                                                            • RES—Reserved; quality level set by user

                                                                            • G811—Primary reference clock

                                                                            • STU—Sync traceability unknown

                                                                            • G812T—Transit node clock traceable

                                                                            • G812L—Local node clock traceable

                                                                            • SETS—Synchronous equipment

                                                                            • DUS—Do not use for timing synchronization

                                                                            Send DoNotUse

                                                                            (OC-768/STM-256 only) Sets the Send DoNotUse card state. When checked, sends a do not use (DUS) message on the S1 byte.

                                                                            Checked or unchecked

                                                                            Checked or unchecked

                                                                            Type

                                                                            (SONET [ANSI] or SDH [ETSI] only) Indicates the optical transport type.

                                                                            • SONET

                                                                            • SDH

                                                                            • SONET

                                                                            • SDH

                                                                            Termination Mode

                                                                            (OC-768/STM-256 only) Sets the mode of operation.

                                                                            Note   

                                                                            This option is only available for SONET/SDH payloads.

                                                                            • Transparent

                                                                            • Section

                                                                            • Line

                                                                            • Transparent

                                                                            • Regeneration Section (RS)

                                                                            • Multiplex Section (MS)

                                                                            Table 82 Ethernet Line Settings of the 40E-TXP-C and 40ME-TXP-C Cards

                                                                            Parameter

                                                                            Description

                                                                            ANSI Options

                                                                            ETSI Options

                                                                            Port

                                                                            (Display only) Displays the port number.

                                                                            • 1-1 to 1-16 (OC3/OC12/OC48/GE)

                                                                            • 17-1 (Trunk/Interlink)

                                                                            • 18-1 (Trunk/Interlink)

                                                                            • 19-1 (Trunk)

                                                                              Note   

                                                                              Port 17 and Port 18 are trunk ports that support OC192 payload in a single-card configuration. These ports are interlink ports in a double-card configuration (ADM-10G peer group).

                                                                            • 1-1 to 1-16 (STM1/STM4/STM16/GE)

                                                                            • 17-1 (Trunk/Interlink)

                                                                            • 18-1 (Trunk/Interlink)

                                                                            • 19-1 (Trunk)

                                                                              Note   

                                                                              Port 17 and Port 18 are trunk ports that support STM64 payload in a single-card configuration. These ports are interlink ports in a double-card configuration (ADM-10G peer group).

                                                                            Port Name

                                                                            Provides the ability to assign the specified port a name.

                                                                            User-defined. Name can be up to 80 alphanumeric/special characters. Blank by default.

                                                                            User-defined. Name can be up to 80 alphanumeric/special characters. Blank by default.

                                                                            Admin State

                                                                            Sets the port service state. For more information about administrative states, see the Administrative and Service States document.

                                                                            • IS

                                                                            • IS,AINS

                                                                            • OOS,DSBLD

                                                                            • OOS,MT

                                                                            • Unlocked

                                                                            • Unlocked,automaticInService

                                                                            • Locked,disabled

                                                                            • Locked,maintenance

                                                                            Service State

                                                                            (Display only) Identifies the autonomously generated state that gives the overall condition of the port. Service states appear in the format: Primary State-Primary State Qualifier, Secondary State. For more information about service states, see the Administrative and Service States document.

                                                                            • IS-NR

                                                                            • OOS-AU,AINS

                                                                            • OOS-MA,DSBLD

                                                                            • OOS-MA,MT

                                                                            • Unlocked-enabled

                                                                            • Unlocked-disabled,
automaticInService

                                                                            • Locked-enabled,disabled

                                                                            • Locked-enabled,maintenance

                                                                            ALS Mode

                                                                            Sets the ALS function mode. The DWDM transmitter supports ALS according to ITU-T G.644 (06/99). ALS can be disabled, or it can be set for one of three mode options.

                                                                            • Disabled (default): ALS is off; the laser is not automatically shut down when traffic outages (LOS) occur.

                                                                            • Manual Restart: ALS is on; the laser automatically shuts down when traffic outages (LOS) occur. However, the laser must be manually restarted when conditions that caused the outage are resolved.

                                                                            • Manual Restart for Test: Manually restarts the laser for testing.

                                                                            • Disabled (default): ALS is off; the laser is not automatically shut down when traffic outages (LOS) occur.

                                                                            • Manual Restart: ALS is on; the laser automatically shuts down when traffic outages (LOS) occur. However, the laser must be manually restarted when conditions that caused the outage are resolved.

                                                                            • Manual Restart for Test: Manually restarts the laser for testing.

                                                                            AINS Soak

                                                                            Sets the automatic in-service soak period. Double-click the time and use the up and down arrows to change settings.

                                                                            • Duration of valid input signal, in hh.mm format, after which the card becomes in service (IS) automatically

                                                                            • 0 to 48 hours, 15-minute increments

                                                                              Note   

                                                                              The AINS service state is not supported on interlink ports.

                                                                            • Duration of valid input signal, in hh.mm format, after which the card becomes in service (IS) automatically

                                                                            • 0 to 48 hours, 15-minute increments

                                                                              Note   

                                                                              The AINS service state is not supported on interlink ports.

                                                                            Reach

                                                                            Displays the optical reach distance of the client port.

                                                                            The Reach options depend on the traffic type that has been selected.

                                                                            The Reach options depend on the traffic type that has been selected.

                                                                            Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                            Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                            DLP-G692 Changing the 40G Multirate Transponder OTU Settings

                                                                            Purpose

                                                                            This task changes the OTU settings of the 40E-TXP-C, and 40ME-TXP-C transponder cards.

                                                                            Tools/Equipment

                                                                            None

                                                                            Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                            DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                            Required/As Needed

                                                                            As needed

                                                                            Onsite/Remote

                                                                            Onsite or remote

                                                                            Security Level

                                                                            Provisioning or higher

                                                                            Procedure
                                                                              Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the 40E-TXP-C or 40ME-TXP-C card where you want to change the OTU settings.
                                                                              Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line > OTU tabs.
                                                                              Step 3   Modify any of the settings described in the following table.
                                                                              Table 83 OTU Settings of the 40E-TXP-C, and 40ME-TXP-C Cards

                                                                              Parameter

                                                                              Description

                                                                              ANSI Options

                                                                              ETSI Options

                                                                              Port

                                                                              (Display only) Displays the port number that is applicable only for OC-192/STM-64 payloads.

                                                                              • 1-1

                                                                              • 2-1

                                                                              • 3-1

                                                                              • 4-1

                                                                              • 1-1

                                                                              • 2-1

                                                                              • 3-1

                                                                              • 4-1

                                                                              SyncMsgIn

                                                                              (Display only) (OC-768/STM-256 only) Sets the EnableSync card parameter. Enables synchronization status messages (S1 byte), which allow the node to choose the best timing source.

                                                                              Checked or unchecked

                                                                              Checked or unchecked

                                                                              Admin SSM

                                                                              Overrides the synchronization status message (SSM) and the synchronization traceability unknown (STU) value. If the node does not receive an SSM signal, it defaults to STU.

                                                                              • PRS—Primary Reference Source (Stratum 1)

                                                                              • STU—Sync traceability unknown

                                                                              • ST2—Stratum 2

                                                                              • ST3—Stratum 3

                                                                              • SMC—SONET minimum clock

                                                                              • ST4—Stratum 4

                                                                              • DUS—Do not use for timing synchronization

                                                                              • RES—Reserved; quality level set by user

                                                                              • G811—Primary reference clock

                                                                              • STU—Sync traceability unknown

                                                                              • G812T—Transit node clock traceable

                                                                              • G812L—Local node clock traceable

                                                                              • SETS—Synchronous equipment

                                                                              • DUS—Do not use for timing synchronization

                                                                              ProvidesSync

                                                                              (Display only) (OC-768/STM-256 only) Sets the ProvidesSync card parameter. If checked, the card is provisioned as a network element (NE) timing reference.

                                                                              Checked or unchecked

                                                                              Checked or unchecked

                                                                              Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                              Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                              DLP-G661 Changing the 40G Multirate Transponder Line Thresholds for SONET or SDH Payloads

                                                                              Purpose

                                                                              This task changes the line threshold settings of 40E-TXP-C and 40ME-TXP-C transponder cards carrying SONET or SDH payloads, including the physical 40G Ethernet WAN Phy payload.

                                                                              Tools/Equipment

                                                                              None

                                                                              Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                              DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                              Required/As Needed

                                                                              As needed

                                                                              Onsite/Remote

                                                                              Onsite or remote

                                                                              Security Level

                                                                              Provisioning or higher

                                                                              Procedure
                                                                                Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the 40E-TXP-C card where you want to change the line threshold settings.
                                                                                Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line Thresholds > SONET Thresholds (ANSI) or SDH Thresholds (ETSI) tabs.
                                                                                Step 3   Modify any of the settings described in the following table.
                                                                                Table 84 Line Threshold Settings for the 40E-TXP-C, and 40ME-TXP-C Cards

                                                                                Parameter

                                                                                Description

                                                                                ANSI Options

                                                                                ETSI Options

                                                                                Port

                                                                                (Display only) Port number

                                                                                • 1 (OC-768)

                                                                                • 2 (OC-768)

                                                                                • 1 (STM-256)

                                                                                • 2 (STM-256)

                                                                                CV

                                                                                Coding violations

                                                                                Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                • Types—Line or Section (near end only)

                                                                                Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                ES

                                                                                Errored seconds

                                                                                Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                • Types—Line or Section (near end only)

                                                                                Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                • Types—Multiplex Section or Regeneration Section (near end only)

                                                                                Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                SES

                                                                                Severely errored seconds

                                                                                Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                • Types—Line or Section (near end only)

                                                                                Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                Click Reset to Default to restore default values.

                                                                                Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                • Types—Multiplex Section or Regeneration Section (near end only)

                                                                                Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                Click Reset to Default to restore default values.

                                                                                FC

                                                                                (Line or Multiplex Section only) Failure count

                                                                                Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                • Types—Line or Section (near end only)

                                                                                Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                Click Reset to Default to restore default values.

                                                                                UAS

                                                                                (Line or Multiplex Section only) Unavailable seconds

                                                                                Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                • Types—Line or Section (near end only)

                                                                                Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                Click Reset to Default to restore default values.

                                                                                Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                • Types—Multiplex Section or Regeneration Section (near end only)

                                                                                Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                Click Reset to Default to restore default values.

                                                                                Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                DLP-G663 Provisioning the 40G Multirate Transponder Trunk Port Alarm and TCA Thresholds

                                                                                Purpose

                                                                                This task provisions the 40E-TXP-C, and 40ME-TXP-C trunk port alarm and threshold cross alert (TCA) thresholds.

                                                                                Tools/Equipment

                                                                                None

                                                                                Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                Required/As Needed

                                                                                As needed

                                                                                Onsite/Remote

                                                                                Onsite or remote

                                                                                Security Level

                                                                                Provisioning or higher

                                                                                Procedure
                                                                                  Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the 40E-TXP-C card where you want to change the trunk port alarm and TCA settings.
                                                                                  Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Optics Thresholds tabs.
                                                                                  Step 3   Under Types area, verify that the TCA radio button is selected. If not, click it, then click Refresh.
                                                                                  Step 4   Referring to the following table, verify the trunk port (Port 2) TCA thresholds for RX Power High, RX Power Low, TX Power High, and TX Power Low. Provision new thresholds as needed by double-clicking the threshold value you want to change, deleting the existing value, and entering the new value. Press Enter, then click Apply.
                                                                                  Step 5   Under Intervals area, select 15 Min or 1 Day, then click Refresh.
                                                                                  Note   

                                                                                  Do not modify the Laser Bias parameters.

                                                                                  Table 85 Trunk Port TCA Thresholds of the 40E-TXP-C, and 40ME-TXP-C Cards

                                                                                  Card

                                                                                  TCA RX Power High (dbm)

                                                                                  TCA RX Power Low (dbm)

                                                                                  TCA TX Power High (dbm)

                                                                                  TCA TX Power Low (dbm)

                                                                                  40E-TXP-C
40ME-TXP-C

                                                                                  –9.0

                                                                                  –22.0

                                                                                  9.0

                                                                                  0.0

                                                                                  Step 6   Click Apply.
                                                                                  Step 7   Under Types area, click the Alarm radio button and click Refresh.
                                                                                  Step 8   Referring to the following table, verify the trunk port (Port 2) alarm thresholds for RX Power High, RX Power Low, TX Power High, and TX Power Low. Provision new thresholds as needed by double-clicking the threshold value you want to change, deleting the existing value, and entering the new value. Press Enter, then click Apply.
                                                                                  Step 9   Under Intervals area, select 15 Min or 1 Day, then click Refresh.
                                                                                  Table 86 Trunk Port Alarm Thresholds of the 40E-TXP-C, and 40ME-TXP-C Cards

                                                                                  Card

                                                                                  Alarm RX

                                                                                  Power High

                                                                                  Alarm RX

                                                                                  Power Low

                                                                                  Alarm TX

                                                                                  Power High

                                                                                  Alarm TX

                                                                                  Power Low

                                                                                  40E-TXP-C
40ME-TXP-C

                                                                                  –9.0

                                                                                  –22.0

                                                                                  9.0

                                                                                  0.0

                                                                                  Step 10   Click Apply.
                                                                                  Step 11   Click Default to restore default values.
                                                                                  Step 12   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                  DLP-G664 Provisioning the 40G Multirate Transponder Client Port Alarm and TCA Thresholds

                                                                                  Purpose

                                                                                  This task provisions the client port alarm and TCA thresholds for the 40E-TXP-C, and 40ME-TXP-C cards.

                                                                                  Tools/Equipment

                                                                                  None

                                                                                  Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                  DLP-G278 Provisioning the Optical Line Rate

                                                                                  DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                  Required/As Needed

                                                                                  Required

                                                                                  Onsite/Remote

                                                                                  Onsite or remote

                                                                                  Security Level

                                                                                  Provisioning or higher

                                                                                  Procedure
                                                                                    Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the 40E-TXP-C card where you want to change the client port alarm and TCA settings.
                                                                                    Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Optics Thresholds tabs. The TCA thresholds are shown by default.
                                                                                    Step 3   Under Types area, verify that the TCA radio button is selected. If not, click it, then click Refresh.
                                                                                    Step 4   Referring to the following table, verify the client port (Port 1) TCA thresholds for RX Power High, RX Power Low, TX Power High, and TX Power Low based on the client interface at the other end. Provision new thresholds as needed by double-clicking the threshold value you want to change, deleting the existing value, and entering the new value. Press Enter, then click Apply.
                                                                                    Step 5   Under Intervals area, select 15 Min or 1 Day, then click Refresh.
                                                                                    Note   

                                                                                    Do not modify the Laser Bias parameters.

                                                                                    Table 87 Client Interface TCA Thresholds of the 40E-TXP-C, and 40ME-TXP-C Cards

                                                                                    Pluggable Port Rate

                                                                                    TCA RX
Power High

                                                                                    TCA RX
Power Low

                                                                                    TCA TX
Power High

                                                                                    TCA TX
Power Low

                                                                                    40G Ethernet LAN Phy

                                                                                    3.0

                                                                                    –6.0

                                                                                    6.0

                                                                                    –3.0

                                                                                    OC-768/STM-256

                                                                                    3.0

                                                                                    –6.0

                                                                                    6.0

                                                                                    –3.0

                                                                                    OTU3

                                                                                    3.0

                                                                                    –6.0

                                                                                    6.0

                                                                                    –3.0

                                                                                    Step 6   Click Apply.
                                                                                    Step 7   Under Types area, click the Alarm radio button and click Refresh.
                                                                                    Step 8   Referring to the following table, provision the client port (Port 1) alarm thresholds for RX Power High, RX Power Low, TX Power High, and TX Power Low based on the client interface that is provisioned.
                                                                                    Step 9   Under Intervals area, select 15 Min or 1 Day, then click Refresh.
                                                                                    Table 88 Card Client Interface Alarm Thresholds of the 40E-TXP-C, and 40ME-TXP-C Cards

                                                                                    Pluggable Port Rate

                                                                                    Alarm RX
Power High

                                                                                    Alarm RX
Power Low

                                                                                    Alarm TX
Power High

                                                                                    Alarm TX
Power Low

                                                                                    40G Ethernet LAN Phy

                                                                                    5.0

                                                                                    –8.0

                                                                                    4.0

                                                                                    –1.0

                                                                                    OC-768/STM-256

                                                                                    5.0

                                                                                    –8.0

                                                                                    4.0

                                                                                    –1.0

                                                                                    OTU3

                                                                                    5.0

                                                                                    –8.0

                                                                                    4.0

                                                                                    –1.0

                                                                                    Step 10   Click Apply.
                                                                                    Step 11   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                    NTP-G170 Provisioning the ADM-10G Card Peer Group, Ethernet Settings, Line Settings, PM Parameters, and Thresholds

                                                                                    Purpose

                                                                                    This procedure creates an ADM-10G peer group and changes line settings, PM parameters, and threshold settings for ADM-10G cards.

                                                                                    Tools/Equipment

                                                                                    None

                                                                                    Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                    DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                    DLP-G723 Install PPM on a Line Card

                                                                                    DLP-G411 Provisioning an ADM-10G PPM and Port

                                                                                    DLP-G278 Provisioning the Optical Line Rate

                                                                                    Required/As Needed

                                                                                    As needed

                                                                                    Onsite/Remote

                                                                                    Onsite or remote

                                                                                    Security Level

                                                                                    Provisioning or higher

                                                                                    Procedure
                                                                                      Step 1   As needed, complete the NTP-G103 Backing Up the Database task to preserve the existing transmission settings.
                                                                                      Step 2   To provision a peer group, complete the DLP-G403 Creating the ADM-10G Peer Group.
                                                                                      Step 3   To provision Ethernet settings, complete the DLP-G469 Provisioning the ADM-10G Card Ethernet Settings.
                                                                                      Step 4   To change line settings, complete the following tasks as needed:
                                                                                      Step 5   To change thresholds, complete the following tasks as needed: Stop. You have completed this procedure.

                                                                                      DLP-G403 Creating the ADM-10G Peer Group

                                                                                      Purpose

                                                                                      This task creates peer group protection for two ADM-10G cards within the same node, located on the same shelf. Perform this task on only one of the two peer cards.

                                                                                      Tools/Equipment

                                                                                      None

                                                                                      Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                      Required/As Needed

                                                                                      As needed

                                                                                      Onsite/Remote

                                                                                      Onsite or remote

                                                                                      Security Level

                                                                                      Provisioning or higher

                                                                                      Procedure
                                                                                        Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the ADM-10G card where you want to change the card settings.
                                                                                        Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Card tabs.
                                                                                        Step 3   In the ADM Group Peer drop-down list, choose the slot number where the companion ADM-10G card is located.
                                                                                        Step 4   In the ADM Peer Group field, enter a group name.
                                                                                        Step 5   Click Apply.
                                                                                        Note   

                                                                                        The Card Parameters Tunable Wavelengths area is read-only and does not contain any wavelengths until circuits are separately provisioned for the card.

                                                                                        Step 6   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                        DLP-G469 Provisioning the ADM-10G Card Ethernet Settings

                                                                                        Purpose

                                                                                        This task changes the Ethernet settings for the ADM-10G card.

                                                                                        Tools/Equipment

                                                                                        None

                                                                                        Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                        DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                        Required/As Needed

                                                                                        As needed

                                                                                        Onsite/Remote

                                                                                        Onsite or remote

                                                                                        Security Level

                                                                                        Provisioning or higher

                                                                                        Procedure
                                                                                          Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the ADM-10G card where you want to change the Ethernet settings. The card view appears.
                                                                                          Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line > Ethernet tabs.
                                                                                          Step 3   Modify any of the settings for the Ethernet tab as described in the following table. The parameters that appear depend on the card mode.
                                                                                          Table 89 ADM-10G Card Ethernet Settings

                                                                                          Parameter

                                                                                          Description

                                                                                          Options

                                                                                          Port

                                                                                          (Display only) The Port number (n-n) and rate.

                                                                                          MTU

                                                                                          The maximum size of the Ethernet frames accepted by the port.

                                                                                          Jumbo. Default: 64 to 9216

                                                                                          Numeric: 1548

                                                                                          Mode

                                                                                          Sets the Ethernet mode.

                                                                                          • 1000 Mbps

                                                                                          Framing

                                                                                          Sets the framing type.

                                                                                          • GFP-F

                                                                                          • HDLC

                                                                                          CRC Encap

                                                                                          Sets the CRC encap values for the framing type.

                                                                                          CRC encap value for GFP-F:

                                                                                          • None (default)

                                                                                          • 32-Bit

                                                                                          CRC encap value for HDLC:

                                                                                          • 16-Bit

                                                                                          • 32-Bit (default)

                                                                                          AINS Soak

                                                                                          Automatic in-service soak time. The duration of time that must pass with an uninterrupted signal before the traffic/termination transitions to the IS-NR (ANSI) or unlocked-enabled (ETSI) service state.

                                                                                          • Duration of valid input signal, in hh.mm format, after which the card becomes in service (IS) automatically

                                                                                          • 0 to 48 hours, 15-minute increments

                                                                                          Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                          Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                          DLP-G397 Changing the ADM-10G Line Settings

                                                                                          Purpose

                                                                                          This task changes the line settings for the ADM-10G card.

                                                                                          Tools/Equipment

                                                                                          None

                                                                                          Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                          DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                          Required/As Needed

                                                                                          As needed

                                                                                          Onsite/Remote

                                                                                          Onsite or remote

                                                                                          Security Level

                                                                                          Provisioning or higher

                                                                                          Procedure
                                                                                            Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the ADM-10G card where you want to change the line settings.
                                                                                            Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line > Ports tabs.
                                                                                            Step 3   Modify any of the settings described in the following table as needed.
                                                                                            Note   

                                                                                            In the following table, some parameter tabs do not always apply to all ADM-10G cards. If a tab does not apply, it will not appear in CTC.

                                                                                            Table 90 ADM-10G Line Port Tab Settings

                                                                                            Parameter

                                                                                            Description

                                                                                            ANSI Options

                                                                                            ETSI Options

                                                                                            Port

                                                                                            (Display only) Displays the port number.

                                                                                            • 1-1 to 1-16 (OC3/OC12/OC48/GE)

                                                                                            • 17-1 (Trunk/Interlink)

                                                                                            • 18-1 (Trunk/Interlink)

                                                                                            • 19-1 (Trunk)

                                                                                              Note   

                                                                                              Port 17 and Port 18 are trunk ports that support OC192 payload in a single-card configuration. These ports are interlink ports in a double-card configuration (ADM-10G peer group).

                                                                                            • 1-1 to 1-16 (STM1/STM4/STM16/GE)

                                                                                            • 17-1 (Trunk/Interlink)

                                                                                            • 18-1 (Trunk/Interlink)

                                                                                            • 19-1 (Trunk)

                                                                                              Note   

                                                                                              Port 17 and Port 18 are trunk ports that support STM64 payload in a single-card configuration. These ports are interlink ports in a double-card configuration (ADM-10G peer group).

                                                                                            Port Name

                                                                                            Provides the ability to assign the specified port a name.

                                                                                            User-defined. Name can be up to 80 alphanumeric/special characters. Blank by default.

                                                                                            User-defined. Name can be up to 80 alphanumeric/special characters. Blank by default.

                                                                                            Admin State

                                                                                            Sets the port service state. For more information about administrative states, see the Administrative and Service States document.

                                                                                            • IS

                                                                                            • IS,AINS

                                                                                            • OOS,DSBLD

                                                                                            • OOS,MT

                                                                                            • Unlocked

                                                                                            • Unlocked,automaticInService

                                                                                            • Locked,disabled

                                                                                            • Locked,maintenance

                                                                                            Service State

                                                                                            (Display only) Identifies the autonomously generated state that gives the overall condition of the port. Service states appear in the format: Primary State-Primary State Qualifier, Secondary State. For more information about service states, see the Administrative and Service States document.

                                                                                            • IS-NR

                                                                                            • OOS-AU,AINS

                                                                                            • OOS-MA,DSBLD

                                                                                            • OOS-MA,MT

                                                                                            • Unlocked-enabled

                                                                                            • Unlocked-disabled,
automaticInService

                                                                                            • Locked-enabled,disabled

                                                                                            • Locked-enabled,maintenance

                                                                                            ALS Mode

                                                                                            Sets the ALS function mode. The DWDM transmitter supports ALS according to ITU-T G.644 (06/99). ALS can be disabled, or it can be set for one of three mode options.

                                                                                            • Disabled (default): ALS is off; the laser is not automatically shut down when traffic outages (LOS) occur.

                                                                                            • Auto Restart: (Not applicable for Gigabit Ethernet client interfaces) ALS is on; the laser automatically shuts down when traffic outages (LOS) occur. It automatically restarts when the conditions that caused the outage are resolved.

                                                                                            • Manual Restart: ALS is on; the laser automatically shuts down when traffic outages (LOS) occur. However, the laser must be manually restarted when conditions that caused the outage are resolved.

                                                                                            • Manual Restart for Test: Manually restarts the laser for testing.

                                                                                            • Disabled (default): ALS is off; the laser is not automatically shut down when traffic outages (LOS) occur.

                                                                                            • Auto Restart: (Not applicable for Gigabit Ethernet client interfaces) ALS is on; the laser automatically shuts down when traffic outages (LOS) occur. It automatically restarts when the conditions that caused the outage are resolved.

                                                                                            • Manual Restart: ALS is on; the laser automatically shuts down when traffic outages (LOS) occur. However, the laser must be manually restarted when conditions that caused the outage are resolved.

                                                                                            • Manual Restart for Test: Manually restarts the laser for testing.

                                                                                            AINS Soak

                                                                                            Sets the automatic in-service soak period. Double-click the time and use the up and down arrows to change settings.

                                                                                            • Duration of valid input signal, in hh.mm format, after which the card becomes in service (IS) automatically

                                                                                            • 0 to 48 hours, 15-minute increments

                                                                                              Note   

                                                                                              The AINS service state is not supported on interlink ports.

                                                                                            • Duration of valid input signal, in hh.mm format, after which the card becomes in service (IS) automatically

                                                                                            • 0 to 48 hours, 15-minute increments

                                                                                              Note   

                                                                                              The AINS service state is not supported on interlink ports.

                                                                                            Reach

                                                                                            Displays the optical reach distance of the client port.

                                                                                            The Reach options depend on the traffic type that has been selected.

                                                                                            The Reach options depend on the traffic type that has been selected.

                                                                                            Wavelength

                                                                                            Tunable wavelength.

                                                                                            Shows the supported wavelengths of the trunk port after the card is installed in the format: first wavelength-last wavelength-frequency spacing-number of supported wavelengths. For example, 1529.55nm-1561.83nm-50gHz-8 are supported wavelengths.

                                                                                            Shows the supported wavelengths of the trunk port after the card is installed in the format: first wavelength-last wavelength-frequency spacing-number of supported wavelengths. For example, 1529.55nm-1561.83nm-50gHz-8 are supported wavelengths.

                                                                                            Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                            Step 5   Click the Provisioning > Line >SONET or SDH tabs.
                                                                                            Step 6   Modify any of the settings described in the following table as needed.
                                                                                            Table 91 ADM-10G Line SONET or SDH Tab Settings

                                                                                            Parameter

                                                                                            Description

                                                                                            ANSI Options

                                                                                            ETSI Options

                                                                                            Port

                                                                                            (Display only) Displays the client and trunk port number.

                                                                                            • 1-1 to 1-16 (OC3/OC12/OC48/GE)

                                                                                            • 17-1 (OC192)

                                                                                            • 18-1 (OC192/Interlink)

                                                                                            • 19-1 (OC192)

                                                                                              Note   

                                                                                              Port 17 and Port 18 are trunk ports that support OC192 payload in a single-card configuration. These ports are interlink ports in a double-card configuration (ADM-10G peer group).

                                                                                            • 1-1 to 1-16 (STM1/STM4/STM16/GE)

                                                                                            • 17-1(STM64)

                                                                                            • 18-1 (STM64/Interlink)

                                                                                            • 19-1 (STM64)

                                                                                              Note   

                                                                                              Port 17 and Port 18 are trunk ports that support STM64 payload in a single-card configuration. These ports are interlink ports in a double-card configuration (ADM-10G peer group).

                                                                                            ProvidesSync

                                                                                            When checked, the card is provisioned as an NE timing reference.

                                                                                            Checked or unchecked

                                                                                            Checked or unchecked

                                                                                            SyncMsgIn

                                                                                            Enables synchronization status messages (S1 byte), which allow the node to choose the best timing source.

                                                                                            Checked or unchecked

                                                                                            Checked or unchecked

                                                                                            SF BER

                                                                                            Sets the signal fail bit error rate.

                                                                                            • 1E-3

                                                                                            • 1E-4

                                                                                            • 1E-5

                                                                                            • 1E-3

                                                                                            • 1E-4

                                                                                            • 1E-5

                                                                                            Send DoNotUse

                                                                                            When checked, sends a DUS message on the S1 byte.

                                                                                            Checked or unchecked

                                                                                            Checked or unchecked

                                                                                            SD BER

                                                                                            Sets the signal degrade bit error rate.

                                                                                            • 1E-5

                                                                                            • 1E-6

                                                                                            • 1E-7

                                                                                            • 1E-8

                                                                                            • 1E-9

                                                                                            • 1E-5

                                                                                            • 1E-6

                                                                                            • 1E-7

                                                                                            • 1E-8

                                                                                            • 1E-9

                                                                                            Type

                                                                                            (Display only) Type of node.

                                                                                            • SONET

                                                                                            • SDH

                                                                                            • SDH

                                                                                            Admin SSM In

                                                                                            Overrides the synchronization status message (SSM) synchronization traceability unknown (STU) value. If the node does not receive an SSM signal, it defaults to STU.

                                                                                            • PRS—Primary Reference Source (Stratum 1)

                                                                                            • ST2—Stratum 2

                                                                                            • TNC—Transit node clock

                                                                                            • ST3E—Stratum 3E

                                                                                            • ST3—Stratum 3

                                                                                            • SMC—SONET minimum clock

                                                                                            • ST4—Stratum 4

                                                                                            • DUS—Do not use for timing synchronization

                                                                                            • RES—Reserved; quality level set by user

                                                                                            • G811—Primary reference clock

                                                                                            • STU—Sync traceability unknown

                                                                                            • G812T—Transit node clock traceable

                                                                                            • G812L—Local node clock traceable

                                                                                            • SETS—Synchronous equipment

                                                                                            • DUS—Do not use for timing synchronization

                                                                                            Step 7   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                            DLP-G398 Changing the ADM-10G Line Section Trace Settings

                                                                                            Purpose

                                                                                            This task changes the line section trace settings for the ADM-10G cards.

                                                                                            Tools/Equipment

                                                                                            None

                                                                                            Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                            DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                            Required/As Needed

                                                                                            As needed

                                                                                            Onsite/Remote

                                                                                            Onsite or remote

                                                                                            Security Level

                                                                                            Provisioning or higher


                                                                                            Note


                                                                                            The Section Trace tab is available for ports configured as OC-N (Ports 1 through 16, Ports 17 and 18 [only in a single-card configuration] and Port 19). Section trace is not available on interlink ports.


                                                                                            Procedure
                                                                                              Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the ADM-10G card where you want to change the section trace settings. The card view appears.
                                                                                              Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line > Section Trace tabs.
                                                                                              Step 3   Modify any of the settings described in the following table.
                                                                                              Table 92 ADM-10G Section Trace Settings

                                                                                              Parameter

                                                                                              Description

                                                                                              ANSI Options

                                                                                              ETSI Options

                                                                                              Port

                                                                                              Sets the port number.

                                                                                              • 1-1 to 1-16 (OC3/OC12/OC48/GE)

                                                                                              • 17-1 (OC 192)

                                                                                              • 18-1 (OC192)

                                                                                              • 19-1 (OC192)

                                                                                                Note   

                                                                                                Port 17 and Port 18 are trunk ports that support OC192 payload in a single-card configuration. These ports are interlink ports in a double-card configuration (ADM-10G peer group).

                                                                                              • 1-1 to 1-16 (STM1/STM4/STM16/GE)

                                                                                              • 17-1 (STM64)

                                                                                              • 18-1 (STM64)

                                                                                              • 19-1 (STM64)

                                                                                                Note   

                                                                                                Port 17 and Port 18 are trunk ports that support STM64 payload in a single-card configuration. These ports are interlink ports in a double-card configuration (ADM-10G peer group).

                                                                                              Received Trace Mode

                                                                                              Sets the trace mode.

                                                                                              • Off/None

                                                                                              • Manual

                                                                                              • Off/None

                                                                                              • Manual

                                                                                              Transmit Section Trace String Size

                                                                                              Sets the trace string size.

                                                                                              • 1 byte

                                                                                              • 16 byte

                                                                                              • 64 byte

                                                                                              • 1 byte

                                                                                              • 16 byte

                                                                                              • 64 byte

                                                                                              Current

                                                                                              Current Transmit String displays the current transmit string; New Transmit String sets a new transmit string. Current String Type allows you to choose between ASCII or Hexadecimal format. Click Hex to change the display to hexadecimal (button changes to ASCII); click ASCII to change the display to ASCII (button changes to Hex).

                                                                                              String of trace string size

                                                                                              String of trace string size

                                                                                              Received

                                                                                              (Display only) Current Received String displays the current received string. You can click Refresh to manually refresh this display, or check the Auto-refresh every 5 sec check box to keep this panel updated.

                                                                                              String of trace string size

                                                                                              String of trace string size

                                                                                              Auto-refresh

                                                                                              If checked, automatically refreshes the display every 5 seconds.

                                                                                              Checked/unchecked (default)

                                                                                              Checked/unchecked (default)

                                                                                              Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                              Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                              DLP-G399 Changing the ADM-10G Line Thresholds for SONET and SDH Payloads

                                                                                              Purpose

                                                                                              This task changes the line threshold settings for ADM-10G cards carrying SONET payloads.

                                                                                              Tools/Equipment

                                                                                              None

                                                                                              Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                              DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                              Required/As Needed

                                                                                              As needed

                                                                                              Onsite/Remote

                                                                                              Onsite or remote

                                                                                              Security Level

                                                                                              Provisioning or higher

                                                                                              Procedure
                                                                                                Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the ADM-10G card where you want to change the line threshold settings. The card view appears.
                                                                                                Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line Thresholds > SONET Thresholds or SDH Thresholds tabs.
                                                                                                Step 3   Modify any of the settings described in the following table.
                                                                                                Table 93 ADM-10G Card Line Threshold Settings

                                                                                                Parameter

                                                                                                Description

                                                                                                ANSI Options

                                                                                                ETSI Options

                                                                                                Port

                                                                                                (Display only) Port number

                                                                                                • 1-1 to 1-16 (OC3/OC12/OC48/GE)

                                                                                                • 17-1 (OC 192)

                                                                                                • 18-1 (OC192)

                                                                                                • 19-1 (OC192)

                                                                                                  Note   

                                                                                                  Port 17 and Port 18 are trunk ports that support OC192 payload in a single-card configuration. These ports are interlink ports in a double-card configuration (ADM-10G peer group).

                                                                                                • 1-1 to 1-16 (STM1/STM4/STM16/GE)

                                                                                                • 17-1 (STM 64)

                                                                                                • 18-1 (STM64)

                                                                                                • 19-1 (STM64)

                                                                                                  Note   

                                                                                                  Port 17 and Port 18 are trunk ports that support STM64 payload in a single-card configuration. These ports are interlink ports in a double-card configuration (ADM-10G peer group).

                                                                                                EB

                                                                                                Path Errored Block indicates that one or more bits are in error within a block

                                                                                                Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                • Types—Multiplex Section or Regeneration Section (near end only)

                                                                                                Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                CV

                                                                                                Coding violations

                                                                                                Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                • Types—Line or Section (near end only)

                                                                                                Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                ES

                                                                                                Errored seconds

                                                                                                Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                • Types—Line or Section (near end only)

                                                                                                Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                • Types—Line or Section (near end only)

                                                                                                Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                SES

                                                                                                Severely errored seconds

                                                                                                Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                • Types—Line or Section (near end only)

                                                                                                Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                • Types—Line or Section (near end only)

                                                                                                Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                BBE

                                                                                                Background block errors

                                                                                                Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                • Types—Multiplex Section or Regeneration Section (near end only)

                                                                                                Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                FC

                                                                                                (Line Section only) Failure count

                                                                                                Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                • Types—Line or Section (near end only)

                                                                                                Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                PSC

                                                                                                Protection Switching Count

                                                                                                Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                PSD

                                                                                                Protection Switching Duration

                                                                                                Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                UAS

                                                                                                (Line Section only) Unavailable seconds

                                                                                                Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                • Types—Line or Section (near end only)

                                                                                                Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                • Types—Line or Section (near end only)

                                                                                                Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                DLP-G412 Changing the ADM-10G Line RMON Thresholds for the 1G Ethernet Payload

                                                                                                Purpose

                                                                                                This task changes the line RMON threshold settings for an ADM-10G card carrying the 1G Ethernet payload.

                                                                                                Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                None

                                                                                                Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                DLP-G411 Provisioning an ADM-10G PPM and Port

                                                                                                Required/As Needed

                                                                                                As needed

                                                                                                Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                Onsite or remote

                                                                                                Security Level

                                                                                                Provisioning or higher


                                                                                                Note


                                                                                                This task can only be performed if the ADM-10G card has at least one PPM port provisioned for Gigabit Ethernet.


                                                                                                Procedure
                                                                                                  Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the ADM-10G card where you want to change the line RMON thresholds. The card view appears.
                                                                                                  Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line Thresholds > RMON Thresholds tabs.
                                                                                                  Step 3   Click Create. The Create Threshold dialog box appears.
                                                                                                  Step 4   From the Port drop-down list, choose the applicable port.
                                                                                                  Step 5   From the Variable drop-down list, choose the applicable Ethernet variable. See the following table for a list of available Ethernet variables.
                                                                                                  Table 94 ADM-10G Gigabit Ethernet Thresholds

                                                                                                  Variable

                                                                                                  Description

                                                                                                  ifInOctets

                                                                                                  Total number of octets received on the interface, including framing characters.

                                                                                                  ifInErrors

                                                                                                  Number of inbound packets that contained errors preventing them from being deliverable to a higher-layer protocol.

                                                                                                  ifOutOctets

                                                                                                  Total number of octets transmitted out of the interface, including framing characters.

                                                                                                  ifInMulticastPkts

                                                                                                  Number of multicast frames received error-free.

                                                                                                  ifInBroadcastPkts

                                                                                                  Number of packets, delivered by a sublayer to a higher layer or sublayer, that were addressed to a broadcast address at this sublayer.

                                                                                                  ifInErrorBytePkts

                                                                                                  Number of receive error bytes.

                                                                                                  dot3StatsFCSErrors

                                                                                                  Number of frames with frame check errors; that is, there is an integral number of octets, but there is also an incorrect frame check sequence (FCS).

                                                                                                  dot3StatsFrameTooLong

                                                                                                  Number of received frames that were larger than the permitted maximum size.

                                                                                                  dot3ControlInUnknownOpcodes

                                                                                                  A count of MAC control frames received on this interface that contain an opcode not supported by this device.

                                                                                                  dot3InPauseFrames

                                                                                                  A count of MAC control frames received on this interface with an opcode indicating the PAUSE operation.

                                                                                                  dot3OutPauseFrames

                                                                                                  A count of MAC control frames transmitted on this interface with an opcode indicating the PAUSE operation.

                                                                                                  etherStatsUndersizePkts

                                                                                                  Total number of packets received that were well-formed and less than 64 octets long (excluding framing bits and including FCS octets).

                                                                                                  etherStatsFragments

                                                                                                  Total number of packets received that were less than 64 octets in length (excluding framing bits but including FCS octets) and had either a bad FCS with an integral number of octets (FCS error) or a bad FCS with a non-integral number of octets (alignment error).

                                                                                                  Note   

                                                                                                  It is normal for etherStatsFragments to increment. This is because it counts both runts (which are normal occurrences due to collisions) and noise hits.

                                                                                                  etherStatsPkts64Octets

                                                                                                  Total number of packets (including bad packets) transmitted and received by the interface that were 64 octets in length (excluding framing bits and including FCS octets).

                                                                                                  etherStatsPkts65to127Octets

                                                                                                  Total number of packets (including bad packets) transmitted and received by the interface that were between 65 and 127 octets in length, inclusive.

                                                                                                  etherStatsPkts128to255Octets

                                                                                                  The total number of packets (including bad packets) transmitted and received by the interface that were between 128 and 255 octets in length, inclusive, excluding framing bits and including FCS octets.

                                                                                                  etherStatsPkts256to511Octets

                                                                                                  Total number of packets (including bad packets) transmitted and received by the interface that were between 256 and 511 octets in length, inclusive.

                                                                                                  etherStatsPkts512to1023Octets

                                                                                                  Total number of packets (including bad packets) transmitted and received by the interface that were between 512 and 1023 octets in length, inclusive, excluding framing bits and including FCS octets.

                                                                                                  etherStatsPkts1024to1518Octets

                                                                                                  Total number of packets (including bad packets) transmitted and received by the interface that were between 1024 and 1518 octets in length, inclusive, excluding framing bits and including FCS octets.

                                                                                                  etherStatsBroadcastPkts

                                                                                                  Total number of good packets transmitted and received by the interface that were directed to the broadcast address.

                                                                                                  Note   

                                                                                                  Multicast packets are not included.

                                                                                                  etherStatsMulticastPkts

                                                                                                  Total number of good packets transmitted and received by the interface that were directed to a multicast address.

                                                                                                  Note   

                                                                                                  This number does not include packets directed to the broadcast address.

                                                                                                  etherStatsOversizePkts

                                                                                                  Total number of packets transmitted and received by the interface that were well-formed and longer than 1518 octets, excluding framing bits and including FCS octets.

                                                                                                  etherStatsJabbers

                                                                                                  Total number of packets received that were longer than 1518 octets (excluding framing bits and including FCS octets), and had a bad FCS with an integral number of octets (FCS error) or a bad FCS with a non-integral number of octets (alignment error).

                                                                                                  rxTotalPkts

                                                                                                  Total number of received packets.

                                                                                                  txTotalPkts

                                                                                                  Total number of transmit packets.

                                                                                                  Step 6   From the Alarm Type drop-down list, indicate whether the event will be triggered by the rising threshold, the falling threshold, or both the rising and falling thresholds.
                                                                                                  Step 7   From the Sample Type drop-down list, choose either Relative or Absolute.

                                                                                                  Relative restricts the threshold to use the number of occurrences in the user-set sample period. Absolute sets the threshold to use the total number of occurrences, regardless of time period.

                                                                                                  Step 8   Type an appropriate number of seconds for the Sample Period.
                                                                                                  Step 9   Type the appropriate number of occurrences for the Rising Threshold.

                                                                                                  For a rising type of alarm, the measured value must move from below the falling threshold to above the rising threshold. For example, if a network is running below a rising threshold of 1000 collisions every 15 seconds and a problem causes 1001 collisions in 15 seconds, the excess occurrences trigger an alarm.

                                                                                                  Step 10   Enter the appropriate number of occurrences in the Falling Threshold field. In most cases a falling threshold is set lower than the rising threshold.

                                                                                                  A falling threshold is the counterpart to a rising threshold. When the number of occurrences is above the rising threshold and then drops below a falling threshold, it resets the rising threshold. For example, when the network problem that caused 1001 collisions in 15 seconds subsides and creates only 799 collisions in 15 seconds, occurrences fall below a falling threshold of 800 collisions. This resets the rising threshold so that if network collisions again spike over a 1000 per 15-second period, an event again triggers when the rising threshold is crossed. An event is triggered only the first time a rising threshold is exceeded (otherwise, a single network problem might cause a rising threshold to be exceeded multiple times and cause a flood of events).

                                                                                                  Step 11   Click OK.
                                                                                                  Step 12   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                  DLP-G400 Provisioning the ADM-10G Interlink or Trunk Port Alarm and TCA Thresholds

                                                                                                  Purpose

                                                                                                  This task provisions the ADM-10G interlink or trunk port alarm and threshold crossing alert (TCA) thresholds.

                                                                                                  Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                  None

                                                                                                  Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                  DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                  Required/As Needed

                                                                                                  As needed

                                                                                                  Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                  Onsite or remote

                                                                                                  Security Level

                                                                                                  Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                  Procedure
                                                                                                    Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the ADM-10G card where you want to change the interlink or trunk port alarm and TCA settings.
                                                                                                    Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Optics Thresholds tabs.
                                                                                                    Step 3   Under Types, verify that the TCA radio button is checked. If not, check it, then click Refresh.
                                                                                                    Step 4   Referring to the following table, verify the interlink or trunk port TCA thresholds for RX Power High, RX Power Low, TX Power High, and TX Power Low. Provision new thresholds as needed by double-clicking the threshold value you want to change, deleting it, entering a new value, and pressing Enter.
                                                                                                    Note   

                                                                                                    You must modify 15 Min and 1 Day independently. To do so, choose the appropriate radio button and click Refresh.

                                                                                                    Note   

                                                                                                    Do not modify the Laser Bias parameters.

                                                                                                    Table 95 ADM-10G Interlink and Trunk Port TCA Thresholds

                                                                                                    Port

                                                                                                    TCA RX

                                                                                                    Power High

                                                                                                    TCA RX

                                                                                                    Power Low

                                                                                                    TCA TX

                                                                                                    Power High

                                                                                                    TCA TX

                                                                                                    Power Low

                                                                                                    17-1 and 18-1 (Trunk/Interlink)

                                                                                                    Note   

                                                                                                    Port 17 and Port 18 are trunk ports in single-card configuration and an interlink port in double-card configuration (ADM-10G peer group).

                                                                                                    –7.0 dBm

                                                                                                    –27.0 dBm

                                                                                                    6.0 dBm

                                                                                                    –4.0 dBm

                                                                                                    19-1 (Trunk)

                                                                                                    –7.0 dBm

                                                                                                    –27.0 dBm

                                                                                                    6.0 dBm

                                                                                                    –4.0 dBm

                                                                                                    Step 5   Click Apply.
                                                                                                    Step 6   Under Types, click the Alarm radio button and click Refresh.
                                                                                                    Step 7   Referring to the following table, verify the interlink or trunk port alarm thresholds for RX Power High, RX Power Low, TX Power High, and TX Power Low.
                                                                                                    Step 8   Provision new thresholds as needed by double-clicking the threshold value you want to change, deleting it, entering a new value, and pressing Enter.
                                                                                                    Note   

                                                                                                    You must modify 15 Min and 1 Day independently. To do so, choose the appropriate radio button and click Refresh.

                                                                                                    Table 96 ADM-10G Interlink and Trunk Port Alarm Thresholds

                                                                                                    Port

                                                                                                    Alarm RX

                                                                                                    Power High

                                                                                                    Alarm RX

                                                                                                    Power Low

                                                                                                    Alarm TX

                                                                                                    Power High

                                                                                                    Alarm TX

                                                                                                    Power Low

                                                                                                    17-1 (Trunk/Interlink)

                                                                                                    Note   

                                                                                                    Port 17 is a trunk port in single-card configuration and an interlink port in double-card configuration (ADM-10G peer group).

                                                                                                    1.0 dBm

                                                                                                    –13.0 dBm

                                                                                                    1.0 dBm

                                                                                                    –8.0 dBm

                                                                                                    18-1 (Trunk/Interlink)

                                                                                                    Note   

                                                                                                    Port 18 is a trunk port in single-card configuration and an interlink port in double-card configuration (ADM-10G peer group).

                                                                                                    –5.0 dBm

                                                                                                    –30.0 dBm

                                                                                                    5.0 dBm

                                                                                                    –3.0 dBm

                                                                                                    19-1 (Trunk)

                                                                                                    –5.0 dBm

                                                                                                    –30.0 dBm

                                                                                                    5.0 dBm

                                                                                                    –3.0 dBm

                                                                                                    Step 9   Click Apply.
                                                                                                    Step 10   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                    DLP-G401 Provisioning the ADM-10G Client Port Alarm and TCA Thresholds

                                                                                                    Purpose

                                                                                                    This task provisions the client port alarm and TCA thresholds for the ADM-10G card.

                                                                                                    Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                    None

                                                                                                    Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                    DLP-G278 Provisioning the Optical Line Rate

                                                                                                    DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                    Required/As Needed

                                                                                                    Required

                                                                                                    Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                    Onsite or remote

                                                                                                    Security Level

                                                                                                    Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                    Procedure
                                                                                                      Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the ADM-10G card where you want to change the client port alarm and TCA settings.
                                                                                                      Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Optics Thresholds tabs.
                                                                                                      Step 3   Under Types, verify that the TCA radio button is checked. If not, check it, then click Refresh.
                                                                                                      Step 4   Referring to Table 1 and Table 2, verify the Port 1 to 16 (Client) Alarm thresholds for RX Power High, RX Power Low, TX Power High, and TX Power Low based on the client interface that is provisioned.
                                                                                                      Step 5   Provision new thresholds as needed by double-clicking the threshold value you want to change, deleting it, entering a new value, and pressing Enter.
                                                                                                      Note   

                                                                                                      You must modify 15 Min and 1 Day independently. To do so, choose the appropriate radio button and click Refresh.

                                                                                                      Step 6   Click Apply.
                                                                                                      Step 7   Under Types, click the Alarm radio button and click Refresh.
                                                                                                      Step 8   Referring to Table 1 and Table 2, verify the interlink ports 17-1 and 18-1 for RX Power High, RX Power Low, TX Power High, and TX Power Low settings.
                                                                                                      Step 9   Provision new thresholds as needed by double-clicking the threshold value you want to change, deleting it, entering a new value, and pressing Enter.
                                                                                                      Step 10   Click Apply.
                                                                                                      Step 11   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                      DLP-G402 Changing the ADM-10G OTN Settings

                                                                                                      Purpose

                                                                                                      This task changes the line OTN settings for the ADM-10G card.

                                                                                                      Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                      None

                                                                                                      Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                      DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                      Required/As Needed

                                                                                                      As needed

                                                                                                      Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                      Onsite or remote

                                                                                                      Security Level

                                                                                                      Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                      Procedure
                                                                                                        Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the ADM-10G card where you want to change the OTN settings.
                                                                                                        Step 2   Click the Provisioning > OTN tabs, then click one of the following subtabs: OTN Lines, ITU-T G.709 Thresholds, FEC Thresholds, or Trail Trace Identifier.
                                                                                                        Step 3   Modify any of the settings described in the following tables.
                                                                                                        Note   

                                                                                                        You must modify Near End and Far End independently; 15 Min and 1 Day independently; and SM and PM independently. To do so, choose the appropriate radio buttons and click Refresh.

                                                                                                        Table 97 ADM-10G Card OTN Lines Settings

                                                                                                        Parameter

                                                                                                        Description

                                                                                                        Options

                                                                                                        Port

                                                                                                        (Display only) Displays the port number and optional name.

                                                                                                        • 18-1 (Trunk/Interlink)

                                                                                                        • 19-1 (Trunk)

                                                                                                          Note   

                                                                                                          Port 18 is a trunk port in single-card configuration and an interlink port in double-card configuration (ADM-10G peer group).

                                                                                                        ITU-TG.709 OTN

                                                                                                        Sets the OTN lines according to ITU-T G.709.

                                                                                                        • Enable

                                                                                                        • Disable

                                                                                                        FEC

                                                                                                        Sets the OTN lines FEC mode. FEC mode can be Disabled, Enabled, or, for the TXP_MR_10E, Enhanced FEC mode can be enabled to provide greater range and lower bit error rate. For TXP_MR_10E cards, Standard is the same as enabling FEC.

                                                                                                        • Disable—FEC is off.

                                                                                                        • Standard—Standard FEC is on.

                                                                                                        • Enhanced—Enhanced FEC is on.

                                                                                                        SD BER

                                                                                                        Sets the signal degrade bit error rate.

                                                                                                        • 1E-5

                                                                                                        • 1E-6

                                                                                                        • 1E-7

                                                                                                        • 1E-8

                                                                                                        • 1E-9

                                                                                                        SF BER

                                                                                                        (Display only) Indicates the signal fail bit error rate.

                                                                                                        • 1E-5

                                                                                                        Synch Mapping

                                                                                                        Sets how the ODUk (client payload) is mapped to the optical channel (OTUk).

                                                                                                        Synch mapping

                                                                                                        Table 98 ADM-10G Card ITU-T G.709 Threshold Settings

                                                                                                        Parameter

                                                                                                        Description

                                                                                                        Options

                                                                                                        Port

                                                                                                        (Display only) Displays the port number and optional name.

                                                                                                        • 18-1 (Trunk/Interlink)

                                                                                                        • 19-1 (Trunk)

                                                                                                          Note   

                                                                                                          Port 18 is a trunk port in single-card configuration and an interlink port in double-card configuration (ADM-10G peer group).

                                                                                                        ES

                                                                                                        Errored seconds. Selecting the SM (OTUk) radio button selects FEC, overhead management, and PM using OTUk. Selecting the PM radio button selects path PM using ODUk.

                                                                                                        Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                        • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                        • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                        • Types—SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk)

                                                                                                        Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                        Note   

                                                                                                        SM (OTUk) is the ITU-T G.709 optical channel transport unit order of k overhead frame used for management and performance monitoring. PM (ODUk) is the ITU-T G.709 optical channel data unit order of k overhead frame unit used for path performance monitoring.

                                                                                                        SES

                                                                                                        Severely errored seconds

                                                                                                        Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                        • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                        • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                        • Types—SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk)

                                                                                                        Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                        UAS

                                                                                                        Unavailable seconds

                                                                                                        Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                        • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                        • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                        • Types—SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk)

                                                                                                        Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                        BBE

                                                                                                        Background block errors

                                                                                                        Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                        • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                        • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                        • Types—SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk)

                                                                                                        Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                        FC

                                                                                                        Failure counter

                                                                                                        Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                        • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                        • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                        • Types—SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk)

                                                                                                        Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                        Table 99 ADM-10G Card FEC Threshold Settings

                                                                                                        Parameter

                                                                                                        Description

                                                                                                        Options

                                                                                                        Port

                                                                                                        (Display only) Displays the port number and optional name.

                                                                                                        • 18-1 (Trunk/Interlink)

                                                                                                        • 19-1 (Trunk)

                                                                                                          Note   

                                                                                                          Port 18 is a trunk port in single-card configuration and an interlink port in double-card configuration (ADM-10G peer group).

                                                                                                        Bit Errors Corrected

                                                                                                        Displays the number of bit errors corrected during the selected time period.

                                                                                                        Numeric display. Can be set for 15-minute or 1 day intervals.

                                                                                                        Uncorrectable Words

                                                                                                        Displays the number of uncorrectable words in the selected time period.

                                                                                                        Numeric display. Can be set for 15-minute or 1 day intervals.

                                                                                                        Table 100 ADM-10GTrail Trace Identifier Settings

                                                                                                        Parameter

                                                                                                        Description

                                                                                                        Options

                                                                                                        Port

                                                                                                        Sets the port number.

                                                                                                        • 18-1 (Trunk/Interlink)

                                                                                                        • 19-1 (Trunk)

                                                                                                          Note   

                                                                                                          Port 18 is a trunk port in single-card configuration and an interlink port in double-card configuration (ADM-10G peer group).

                                                                                                        Level

                                                                                                        Sets the level.

                                                                                                        • Section

                                                                                                        • Path

                                                                                                        Received Trace Mode

                                                                                                        Sets the trace mode.

                                                                                                        • Off/None

                                                                                                        • Manual

                                                                                                        Disable FDI on TTIM

                                                                                                        If a Trace Identifier Mismatch on Section/Path overhead alarm arises because of a J0/J1 overhead string mismatch, no Forward Defect Indication (FDI) signal is sent to the downstream nodes if this box is checked.

                                                                                                        • Checked (FDI on TTIM is disabled)

                                                                                                        • Unchecked (FDI on TTIM is not disabled)

                                                                                                        Transmit

                                                                                                        Current Transmit String displays the current transmit string; New sets a new transmit string. You can click the button on the right to change the display. Its title changes, based on the current display mode. In Transmit String Type, click Hex to change the display to hexadecimal (button changes to ASCII); click ASCII to change the display to ASCII (button changes to Hex).

                                                                                                        String of trace string size;
trail trace identifier is 64 bytes in length.

                                                                                                        Expected

                                                                                                        Current Expected String displays the current expected string; New sets a new expected string. You can click the button on the right to change the display. Its title changes, based on the current display mode. In Expected String Type, click Hex to change the display to hexadecimal (button changes to ASCII); click ASCII to change the display to ASCII (button changes to Hex).

                                                                                                        String of trace string size

                                                                                                        Received

                                                                                                        (Display only) Current Received String displays the current received string. You can click Refresh to manually refresh this display, or check the Auto-refresh every 5 sec check box to keep this panel updated.

                                                                                                        String of trace string size

                                                                                                        Auto-refresh (every 5 sec)

                                                                                                        If checked, automatically refreshes the display every 5 seconds.

                                                                                                        Checked/unchecked (default)

                                                                                                        Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                        Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                        NTP-G333 Adding an ADM-10G Card to an Existing Topology

                                                                                                        Purpose

                                                                                                        This procedure adds an ADM-10G card to an existing topology. Perform the steps in this procedure when OCHNC and DCC are present in the network. In case of OCH trails, delete all the circuits in Step 3 that traverses the port before deleting the OCH-trail.

                                                                                                        Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                        None

                                                                                                        Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                        • DLP-G46 Log into CTC.

                                                                                                        • Complete the turn up procedures in the "Turning Up a Node" chapter for the node to be added.

                                                                                                        • An updated Cisco Transport Planner network plan recalculated with the new node.

                                                                                                        Required/As Needed

                                                                                                        As needed

                                                                                                        Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                        Onsite or remote

                                                                                                        Security Level

                                                                                                        Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                        Procedure
                                                                                                          Step 1   If path protected circuits exist between Node A and Node B, complete the DLP-A197 Initiate a Path Protection Force Switch task. This task applies a force switch on the path between Node A and Node B.
                                                                                                          Step 2   Complete the NTP-G129 Add a DWDM Node task to add Node C.
                                                                                                          Step 3   Complete the DLP-G106 Deleting Optical Channel Network Connections task to delete OCHNC circuit between Node A and Node B.
                                                                                                          Step 4   Complete the NTP-G59 Creating, Deleting, and Managing Optical Channel Network Connections task to create OCHNC circuit between Node A-->Node C and Node C-->Node B for wavelength connectivity.
                                                                                                          Note   

                                                                                                          The ports on the card in Node C must be tuned to the same wavelength as Node A and Node B.

                                                                                                          Step 5   Create DCC terminations on Node C. See the DLP-A377 Provision Section DCC Terminations task. Alternatively, if additional bandwidth is needed for CTC management, complete the DLP-A378 Provision Line DCC Terminations task.
                                                                                                          TNC reloads when SDCC and LDCC co-exist on the same card. This behavior is observed in the following cards:
                                                                                                          • TXP-MR-10G

                                                                                                          • TXP-MR-2.5G

                                                                                                          • TXPP-MR-2.5G

                                                                                                          • TXP-MR-10E

                                                                                                          • MXP-MR-2.5G

                                                                                                          • MXPP-MR-2.5G

                                                                                                          • MXP-MR-10DME

                                                                                                          • MXP-MR-10DMEX

                                                                                                          • ADM-10G

                                                                                                          • TXP-MR-10EX

                                                                                                          • TXPP-MR-10EX

                                                                                                          • OTU2-XP

                                                                                                          Step 6   Ensure that the DCCs are functional between Node A-->Node C and Node C-->Node B. See the "DLP-G76 Provision DCC/GCC Terminations" task.
                                                                                                          Step 7   Complete the following task to create pass-through STS or VC circuits in Node C.
                                                                                                          Step 8   Complete the NTP-A301 Merge Circuits task for each circuit created.
                                                                                                          Step 9   If path protected circuits exist between Node A and Node B, complete the DLP-A198 Clear a Path Protection Force Switch task. This task clears a force switch on the path between Node A and Node B.

                                                                                                          Stop. You have completed this procedure.


                                                                                                          NTP-G97 Modifying the 4x2.5G Muxponder Card Line Settings and PM Parameter Thresholds

                                                                                                          Purpose

                                                                                                          This procedure changes the line and threshold settings for the MXP_2.5G_10G, MXP_2.5G_10E, MXP_2.5G_10E_C, MXP_2.5G_10E_L, and MXP_2.5G_10EX_C muxponder cards.

                                                                                                          Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                          None

                                                                                                          Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                          Required/As Needed

                                                                                                          As needed

                                                                                                          Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                          Onsite or remote

                                                                                                          Security Level

                                                                                                          Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                          Procedure
                                                                                                            Step 1   As needed, complete the NTP-G103 Backing Up the Database task to preserve the existing transmission settings.
                                                                                                            Step 2   Perform any of the following tasks as needed:
                                                                                                            Step 3   As needed, complete the NTP-G103 Backing Up the Database task.

                                                                                                            Stop. You have completed this procedure.


                                                                                                            DLP-G222 Changing the 4x2.5G Muxponder Card Settings

                                                                                                            Purpose

                                                                                                            This task changes the card settings for the MXP_2.5G_10G, MXP_2.5G_10E, MXP_2.5G_10E_C, MXP_2.5G_10E_L, and MXP_2.5G_10EX_C muxponder cards, including payload type, termination mode, and wavelength.

                                                                                                            Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                            None

                                                                                                            Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                            DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                            Required/As Needed

                                                                                                            As needed

                                                                                                            Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                            Onsite or remote

                                                                                                            Security Level

                                                                                                            Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                            Procedure
                                                                                                              Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the MXP_2.5G_10G, MXP_2.5G_10E, MXP_2.5G_10E_C, MXP_2.5G_10E_L, or MXP_2.5G_10EX_C card where you want to change the card settings.
                                                                                                              Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Card tabs.
                                                                                                              Step 3   Modify any of the settings described in the following table. The Parameters shown in the following table do not apply to all 4x2.5G muxponder cards. If the parameter or option does not apply, it is not shown in CTC.
                                                                                                              Table 101 MXP_2.5G_10G, MXP_2.5G_10E, MXP_2.5G_10E_C, MXP_2.5G_10E_L, or MXP_2.5G_10EX_C Card Settings

                                                                                                              Parameter

                                                                                                              Description

                                                                                                              Options

                                                                                                              Termination Mode

                                                                                                              Sets the mode of operation. Options that do not apply to a card do not display.

                                                                                                              The MXP_2.5G_10G card is based on SONET/SDH multiplexing. The transparent mode terminates and rebuilds the B1 byte (as well as other bytes) of the incoming OC-48/STM-16 signal. The B2 byte is not touched.

                                                                                                              The MXP_2.5G_10E, MXP_2.5G_10E_C, MXP_2.5G_10E_L, and MXP_2.5G_10EX_C cards are fully transparent in transparent mode based on the OTN/ITU-T G.709 multiplexing scheme. It does not terminate the B1 byte or other bytes.

                                                                                                              It encapsulates OC-48/STM-16 bytes into ODU1 first, then multiplexes them into an OTU2.

                                                                                                              For ANSI platforms:

                                                                                                              • Transparent

                                                                                                              • Section (MXP_2.5G_10E, MXP_2.5G_10E_C, MXP_2.5G_10E_L, and MXP_2.5G_10EX_C only)

                                                                                                              • Line (MXP_2.5G_10G only)

                                                                                                              For ETSI platforms:

                                                                                                              • Transparent

                                                                                                              • Multiplex Section (MXP_2.5G_10G, only)

                                                                                                              • Regeneration Section (MXP_2.5G_10E, MXP_2.5G_10E_C, MXP_2.5G_10E_L, and MXP_2.5G_10EX_C only)

                                                                                                              AIS/Squelch

                                                                                                              (MXP_2.5G_10E, MXP_2.5G_10E_C, MXP_2.5G_10E_L, and MXP_2.5G_10EX_C only) Sets the transparent termination mode configuration.

                                                                                                              • Ais

                                                                                                              • Squelch

                                                                                                              Tunable Wavelengths

                                                                                                              (Display only) Shows the supported wavelengths of the trunk port after the card is installed. For the MXP_2.5G_10E_C, or MXP_2.5G_10E_L cards, the first and last supported wavelength, frequency spacing, and number of supported wavelengths are shown in the format: first wavelength-last wavelength-frequency spacing-number of supported wavelengths. For example, the MXP_2.5G_10E_C card would show: 1529.55nm-1561.83nm-50gHz-82. The MXP_2.5G_10G and MXP_2.5G_10E show the four wavelengths supported by the card that is installed.

                                                                                                              Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                              Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                              DLP-G223 Changing the 4x2.5G Muxponder Line Settings

                                                                                                              Purpose

                                                                                                              This task changes the line settings for the MXP_2.5G_10G, MXP_2.5G_10E, MXP_2.5G_10E_C, MXP_2.5G_10E_L, and MXP_2.5G_10EX_C muxponder cards.

                                                                                                              Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                              None

                                                                                                              Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                              DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                              Required/As Needed

                                                                                                              As needed

                                                                                                              Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                              Onsite or remote

                                                                                                              Security Level

                                                                                                              Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                              Procedure
                                                                                                                Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the MXP_2.5G_10G, MXP_2.5G_10E, MXP_2.5G_10E_C, MXP_2.5G_10E_L, or MXP_2.5G_10EX_C card where you want to change the line settings.
                                                                                                                Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line > SONET (ANSI) or SDH (ETSI) tabs.
                                                                                                                Note   

                                                                                                                The SONET tab appears only if you have created a PPM for a given port.

                                                                                                                Step 3   Modify any of the settings described in the following table.
                                                                                                                Note   

                                                                                                                You must modify Near End and Far End independently; 15 Min and 1 Day independently; and Line and Section independently. To do so, choose the appropriate radio button and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                Table 102 MXP_2.5G_10G, MXP_2.5G_10E, MXP_2.5G_10E_C, MXP_2.5G_10E_L, or MXP_2.5G_10EX_C Card Line Settings

                                                                                                                Parameter

                                                                                                                Description

                                                                                                                Options

                                                                                                                Port

                                                                                                                (Display only) Port number. Ports 1 to 4 are client ports (OC-48/STM-16). Port 5 is the DWDM trunk (OC-192/STM-64) that provides wavelength services. Client ports will not appear of the pluggable port module is not provisioned for it.

                                                                                                                • 1

                                                                                                                • 2

                                                                                                                • 3

                                                                                                                • 4

                                                                                                                • 5 (Trunk) (MXP_2.5G_10G only)

                                                                                                                Port Name

                                                                                                                Provides the ability to assign the specified port a logical name.

                                                                                                                User-defined. Name can be up to 80 alphanumeric/ special characters. Blank by default.

                                                                                                                Admin State

                                                                                                                Sets the port service state unless network conditions prevent the change. For more information about administrative states, see the Administrative and Service States document.

                                                                                                                • IS (ANSI) or Unlocked (ETSI)

                                                                                                                • IS,AINS (ANSI) or Unlocked,automaticInService (ETSI)

                                                                                                                • OOS,DSBLD (ANSI) or Locked,disabled (ETSI)

                                                                                                                • OOS,MT (ANSI) or Locked,maintenance (ETSI)

                                                                                                                Service State

                                                                                                                (Display only) Identifies the autonomously generated state that gives the overall condition of the port. Service states appear in the format: Primary State-Primary State Qualifier, Secondary State. For more information about service states, see the Administrative and Service States document.

                                                                                                                • IS-NR (ANSI) or Unlocked-enabled (ETSI)

                                                                                                                • OOS-AU,AINS (ANSI) or Unlocked-disabled,
automaticInService (ETSI)

                                                                                                                • OOS-MA,DSBLD (ANSI) or Locked-enabled,disabled (ETSI)

                                                                                                                • OOS-MA,MT (ANSI) or Locked-enabled,maintenance (ETSI)

                                                                                                                SF BER

                                                                                                                Sets the signal fail bit error rate.

                                                                                                                • 1E-3

                                                                                                                • 1E-4

                                                                                                                • 1E-5

                                                                                                                SD BER

                                                                                                                Sets the signal degrade bit error rate.

                                                                                                                • 1E-5

                                                                                                                • 1E-6

                                                                                                                • 1E-7

                                                                                                                • 1E-8

                                                                                                                • 1E-9

                                                                                                                ALS Mode

                                                                                                                Sets the ALS function mode. The DWDM transmitter supports ALS according to ITU-T G.644 (06/99). ALS can be disabled or can be set for one of three mode options.

                                                                                                                • Disable (default): ALS is off; the laser is not automatically shut down when traffic outages (LOS) occur.

                                                                                                                • Auto Restart: ALS is on; the laser automatically shuts down when traffic outages (LOS) occur. It automatically restarts when the conditions that caused the outage are resolved.

                                                                                                                • Manual Restart: ALS is on; the laser automatically shuts down when traffic outages (LOS) occur. However, the laser must be manually restarted when conditions that caused the outage are resolved.

                                                                                                                • Manual Restart for Test: Manually restarts the laser for testing.

                                                                                                                AINS Soak

                                                                                                                Sets the automatic in-service soak period. Double-click the time and use the up and down arrows to change settings.

                                                                                                                • Duration of valid input signal, in hh.mm format, after which the card becomes in service (IS) automatically

                                                                                                                • 0 to 48 hours, 15-minute increments

                                                                                                                Type

                                                                                                                Sets the optical transport type.

                                                                                                                • SONET

                                                                                                                • SDH

                                                                                                                SyncMsgIn

                                                                                                                Enables synchronization status messages (S1 byte), which allow the node to choose the best timing source. (This parameter does not appear for the MXP_2.5G_10E trunk port.)

                                                                                                                Checked or unchecked

                                                                                                                ProvidesSync

                                                                                                                Sets the ProvidesSync card parameter. If checked, the card is provisioned as an NE timing reference. (This parameter does not appear for the MXP_2.5G_10E trunk port.)

                                                                                                                Checked or unchecked

                                                                                                                Reach

                                                                                                                Displays the optical reach distance of the client port.

                                                                                                                Options: ANSI/ETSI

                                                                                                                • Autoprovision/Autoprovision (default)

                                                                                                                • SR

                                                                                                                • SR 1/I-1—Short reach up to 2-km distance

                                                                                                                • IR 1/S1—Intermediate reach, up to 15-km distance

                                                                                                                • IR 2/S2—Intermediate reach up to 40-km distance

                                                                                                                • LR 1/L1—long reach, up to 40-km distance

                                                                                                                • LR 2/L2—long reach, up to 80-km distance

                                                                                                                • LR 3/L3—long reach, up to 80-km distance

                                                                                                                Wavelength

                                                                                                                Displays the wavelength of the client port.

                                                                                                                • First Tunable Wavelength

                                                                                                                • Further wavelengths: 850 nm through 1560.61 nm
100-GHz ITU spacing CWDM spacing

                                                                                                                Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                DLP-G224 Changing the 4x2.5G Muxponder Section Trace Settings

                                                                                                                Purpose

                                                                                                                This task changes the section trace settings for the MXP_2.5G_10G, MXP_2.5G_10E, MXP_2.5G_10E_C, MXP_2.5G_10E_L, and MXP_2.5G_10EX_C muxponder cards.

                                                                                                                Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                None

                                                                                                                Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                As needed

                                                                                                                Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                Security Level

                                                                                                                Provisioning or higher


                                                                                                                Note


                                                                                                                The Section Trace tab appears only if you have created a PPM for the card.


                                                                                                                Procedure
                                                                                                                  Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the MXP_2.5G_10G, MXP_2.5G_10E, MXP_2.5G_10E_C, MXP_2.5G_10E_L, or MXP_2.5G_10EX_C card where you want to change the section trace settings.
                                                                                                                  Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line > Section Trace tabs.
                                                                                                                  Step 3   Modify any of the settings described in the following table.
                                                                                                                  Table 103 MXP_2.5G_10G, MXP_2.5G_10E, MXP_2.5G_10E_C, MXP_2.5G_10E_L, or MXP_2.5G_10EX_C Card Section Trace Settings

                                                                                                                  Parameter

                                                                                                                  Description

                                                                                                                  Options

                                                                                                                  Port

                                                                                                                  Sets the port number.

                                                                                                                  • 1

                                                                                                                  • 2

                                                                                                                  • 3

                                                                                                                  • 4

                                                                                                                  • 5 (Trunk; MXP_2.5G_10G only)

                                                                                                                  Received Trace Mode

                                                                                                                  Sets the trace mode.

                                                                                                                  • Off/None

                                                                                                                  • Manual

                                                                                                                  Disable AIS/RDI on TIM-S

                                                                                                                  If an TIM on Section overhead alarm arises because of a J0 overhead string mismatch, no alarm indication signal is sent to downstream nodes if this box is checked.

                                                                                                                  • Checked (AIS/RDI on TIM-S is disabled)

                                                                                                                  • Unchecked (AIS/RDI on TIM-S is not disabled)

                                                                                                                  Transmit Section Trace String Size

                                                                                                                  Sets the trace string size. Select either radio button.

                                                                                                                  • 1 byte

                                                                                                                  • 16 byte

                                                                                                                  Transmit

                                                                                                                  Displays the current transmit string; sets a new transmit string. You can click the button on the right to change the display. Its title changes, based on the current display mode. Click Hex to change the display to hexadecimal (button changes to ASCII); click ASCII to change the display to ASCII (button changes to Hex).

                                                                                                                  String of trace string size

                                                                                                                  Expected

                                                                                                                  Displays the current expected string; sets a new expected string. You can click the button on the right to change the display. Its title changes, based on the current display mode. Click Hex to change the display to hexadecimal (button changes to ASCII); click ASCII to change the display to ASCII (button changes to Hex).

                                                                                                                  String of trace string size

                                                                                                                  Received

                                                                                                                  (Display only) Displays the current received string. You can click Refresh to manually refresh this display, or check the Auto-refresh every 5 sec check box to keep this panel updated.

                                                                                                                  String of trace string size

                                                                                                                  Auto-refresh

                                                                                                                  If checked, automatically refreshes the display every 5 minutes.

                                                                                                                  Checked/unchecked (default)

                                                                                                                  Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                  Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                  DLP-G225 Changing the 4x2.5G Muxponder Trunk Settings

                                                                                                                  Purpose

                                                                                                                  This task provisions the trunk settings for the MXP_2.5G_10E, MXP_2.5G_10E_C, MXP_2.5G_10E_L, and MXP_2.5G_10EX_C muxponder cards.

                                                                                                                  Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                  None

                                                                                                                  Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                  DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                  Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                  As needed

                                                                                                                  Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                  Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                  Security Level

                                                                                                                  Provisioning or higher


                                                                                                                  Note


                                                                                                                  This task does not apply to the MXP_2.5G_10G card.


                                                                                                                  Procedure
                                                                                                                    Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the MXP_2.5G_10E, MXP_2.5G_10E_C, MXP_2.5G_10E_L, or MXP_2.5G_10EX_C card where you want to change the trunk settings.
                                                                                                                    Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line > Trunk tabs.
                                                                                                                    Step 3   Modify any of the settings described in the following table.
                                                                                                                    Table 104 MXP_2.5G_10E, MXP_2.5G_10E_C, MXP_2.5G_10E_L, or MXP_2.5G_10EX_C Card Trunk Settings

                                                                                                                    Parameter

                                                                                                                    Description

                                                                                                                    Options

                                                                                                                    Port

                                                                                                                    (Display only) Displays the port number. Port 5 is the DWDM trunk (OC-192/STM-64) that provides wavelength services.

                                                                                                                    5 (Trunk)

                                                                                                                    Port Name

                                                                                                                    Provides the ability to assign the specified port a logical name.

                                                                                                                    User-defined. Name can be up to 80 alphanumeric/ special characters. Blank by default.

                                                                                                                    Admin State

                                                                                                                    Sets the port service state unless network conditions prevent the change. For more information about administrative states, see the Administrative and Service States document.

                                                                                                                    • IS (ANSI) or Unlocked (ETSI)

                                                                                                                    • IS,AINS (ANSI) or Unlocked,automaticInService (ETSI)

                                                                                                                    • OOS,DSBLD (ANSI) or Locked,disabled (ETSI)

                                                                                                                    • OOS,MT (ANSI) or Locked,maintenance (ETSI)

                                                                                                                    Service State

                                                                                                                    (Display only) Identifies the autonomously generated state that gives the overall condition of the port. Service states appear in the format: Primary State-Primary State Qualifier, Secondary State. For more information about service states, see the Administrative and Service States document.

                                                                                                                    • IS-NR (ANSI) or Unlocked-enabled (ETSI)

                                                                                                                    • OOS-AU,AINS (ANSI) or Unlocked-disabled,
automaticInService (ETSI)

                                                                                                                    • OOS-MA,DSBLD (ANSI) or Locked-enabled,disabled (ETSI)

                                                                                                                    • OOS-MA,MT (ANSI) or Locked-enabled,maintenance (ETSI)

                                                                                                                    ALS Mode

                                                                                                                    Sets the ALS function mode. The DWDM transmitter supports ALS according to ITU-T G.644 (06/99). ALS can be disabled or can be set for one of three mode options.

                                                                                                                    • Disabled (default): ALS is off; the laser is not automatically shut down when traffic outages (LOS) occur.

                                                                                                                    • Auto Restart: ALS is on; the laser automatically shuts down when traffic outages (LOS) occur. It automatically restarts when the conditions that caused the outage are resolved.

                                                                                                                    • Manual Restart: ALS is on; the laser automatically shuts down when traffic outages (LOS) occur. However, the laser must be manually restarted when conditions that caused the outage are resolved.

                                                                                                                    • Manual Restart for Test: Manually restarts the laser for testing.

                                                                                                                    AINS Soak

                                                                                                                    (OC-N and STM-N payloads only) Sets the automatic in-service soak period.

                                                                                                                    • Duration of valid input signal, in hh.mm format, after which the card becomes in service (IS) automatically

                                                                                                                    • 0 to 48 hours, 15-minute increments

                                                                                                                    Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                    Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                    DLP-G369 Changing the 4x2.5G Muxponder Trunk Wavelength Settings

                                                                                                                    Purpose

                                                                                                                    This task changes the trunk wavelength settings for the MXP_2.5G_10G, MXP_2.5G_10E, MXP_2.5G_10E_C, MXP_2.5G_10E_L, and MXP_2.5G_10EX_C cards.

                                                                                                                    Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                    None

                                                                                                                    Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                    DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                    Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                    As needed

                                                                                                                    Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                    Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                    Security Level

                                                                                                                    Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                    Procedure
                                                                                                                      Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the MXP_2.5G_10G, MXP_2.5G_10E, MXP_2.5G_10E_C, MXP_2.5G_10E_L, and MXP_2.5G_10EX_C card where you want to change the trunk wavelength settings.
                                                                                                                      Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line > Wavelength Trunk Settings tabs.
                                                                                                                      Step 3   Modify any of the settings described in the following table.
                                                                                                                      Table 105 MXP_2.5G_10G, MXP_2.5G_10E, MXP_2.5G_10E_C, MXP_2.5G_10E_L, and MXP_2.5G_10EX_C Card Wavelength Trunk Settings

                                                                                                                      Parameter

                                                                                                                      Description

                                                                                                                      Options

                                                                                                                      Port

                                                                                                                      (Display only) Displays the port number.

                                                                                                                      5 (Trunk)

                                                                                                                      Band

                                                                                                                      (Display only) Indicates the wavelength band available from the card that is installed. If the card is preprovisioned, the field can be provisioned to the band of the card that will be installed.

                                                                                                                      • C—The C-band wavelengths are available in the Wavelength field.

                                                                                                                      • L—The L-band wavelengths are available in the Wavelength field.

                                                                                                                      Even/Odd

                                                                                                                      Sets the wavelengths available for provisioning for MXP_2.5G_10E_C and MXP_2.5G_10E_L cards. (This field does not apply to MXP_2.5G_10G or MXP_2.5G_10E cards.)

                                                                                                                      • Even—Displays even C-band or L-band wavelengths in the Wavelength field.

                                                                                                                      • Odd—Displays odd C-band or L-band wavelengths in the Wavelength field.

                                                                                                                      Wavelength

                                                                                                                      The wavelength provisioned for the trunk.

                                                                                                                      • First Tunable Wavelength

                                                                                                                      • Further wavelengths in 100-GHz ITU-T C-band or L-band spacing, depending on the card that is installed. For MXP_2.5G_10G and MXP_2.5G_10E cards, the wavelengths carried by the card are identified with two asterisks. If the card is not installed, all wavelengths appear with a dark grey background.

                                                                                                                      Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                      Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                      DLP-G226 Changing the 4x2.5G Muxponder SONET/SDH Line Thresholds Settings

                                                                                                                      Purpose

                                                                                                                      This task changes the SONET (ANSI) or SDH (ETSI) line threshold settings for the MXP_2.5G_10G, MXP_2.5G_10E, MXP_2.5G_10E_C, MXP_2.5G_10E_L, and MXP_2.5G_10EX_C muxponder cards.

                                                                                                                      Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                      None

                                                                                                                      Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                      DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                      Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                      As needed

                                                                                                                      Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                      Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                      Security Level

                                                                                                                      Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                      Procedure
                                                                                                                        Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the MXP_2.5G_10G, MXP_2.5G_10E, MXP_2.5G_10E_C, MXP_2.5G_10E_L, or MXP_2.5G_10EX_C card where you want to change the line threshold settings.
                                                                                                                        Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line Thresholds tabs.
                                                                                                                        Step 3   Modify any of the settings described in the following table. Some parameter tabs or selections do not always apply to all 4x2.5G muxponder cards. If the tabs or selections do not apply, they do not appear in CTC.
                                                                                                                        Table 106 MXP_2.5G_10G, MXP_2.5G_10E, MXP_2.5G_10E_C, MXP_2.5G_10E_L, or MXP_2.5G_10EX_C Card Line Threshold Settings

                                                                                                                        Parameter

                                                                                                                        Description

                                                                                                                        SONET Options

                                                                                                                        SDH Options

                                                                                                                        Port

                                                                                                                        (Display only) Port number

                                                                                                                        • 1

                                                                                                                        • 2

                                                                                                                        • 3

                                                                                                                        • 4

                                                                                                                        • 5 (MXP_2.5G_10G only)

                                                                                                                        • 1

                                                                                                                        • 2

                                                                                                                        • 3

                                                                                                                        • 4

                                                                                                                        • 5 (MXP_2.5G_10G only)

                                                                                                                        EB

                                                                                                                        Path Errored Block indicates that one or more bits are in error within a block

                                                                                                                        Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                        • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                        • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                        • Types—Multiplex Section or Regeneration Section (near end only)

                                                                                                                        Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                        CV

                                                                                                                        Coding violations

                                                                                                                        Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                        • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                        • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                        • Types—Line or Section (near end only)

                                                                                                                        Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                        ES

                                                                                                                        Errored seconds

                                                                                                                        Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                        • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                        • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                        • Types—Line or Section (near end only)

                                                                                                                        Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                        Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                        • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                        • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                        • Types—Multiplex Section or Regeneration Section (near end only)

                                                                                                                        Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                        SES

                                                                                                                        Severely errored seconds

                                                                                                                        Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                        • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                        • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                        • Types—Line or Section (near end only)

                                                                                                                        Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                        Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                        • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                        • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                        • Types—Multiplex Section or Regeneration Section (near end only)

                                                                                                                        Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                        SEFS

                                                                                                                        (Near End Section or Regeneration Section only) Severely errored framing seconds

                                                                                                                        Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                        • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                        • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                        • Types—Line or Section (near end only)

                                                                                                                        Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                        BBE

                                                                                                                        Background block errors

                                                                                                                        Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                        • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                        • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                        • Types—Multiplex Section or Regeneration Section (near end only)

                                                                                                                        Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                        FC

                                                                                                                        (Line or Multiplex Section only) Failure count

                                                                                                                        Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                        • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                        • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                        • Types—Line or Section (near end only)

                                                                                                                        Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                        UAS

                                                                                                                        (Line or Multiplex Section only) Unavailable seconds

                                                                                                                        Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                        • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                        • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                        • Types—Line or Section (near end only)

                                                                                                                        Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                        Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                        • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                        • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                        • Types—Multiplex Section or Regeneration Section (near end only)

                                                                                                                        Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                        Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                        Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                        DLP-G303 Provisioning the 4x2.5G Muxponder Trunk Port Alarm and TCA Thresholds

                                                                                                                        Purpose

                                                                                                                        This task changes the MXP_2.5G_10G, MXP_2.5G_10E, MXP_2.5G_10E_C, MXP_2.5G_10E_L, and MXP_2.5G_10EX_C trunk port alarm and TCA thresholds.

                                                                                                                        Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                        None

                                                                                                                        Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                        DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                        Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                        As needed

                                                                                                                        Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                        Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                        Security Level

                                                                                                                        Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                        Procedure
                                                                                                                          Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the MXP_2.5G_10G, MXP_2.5G_10E, MXP_2.5G_10E_C, MXP_2.5G_10E_L, or MXP_2.5G_10EX_C card where you want to change the trunk port alarm and TCA settings.
                                                                                                                          Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Optics Thresholds tabs.
                                                                                                                          Step 3   Select TCA (if not already selected), a 15 Min or 1 Day PM interval radio button and then click Refresh.
                                                                                                                          Note   

                                                                                                                          You must modify 15 Min and 1 Day independently. To do so, choose the appropriate radio button and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                          Step 4   Referring to the following table, verify the trunk port (Port 5) TCA thresholds for RX Power High, RX Power Low, TX Power High, and TX Power Low.
                                                                                                                          Step 5   Provision new thresholds as needed by double-clicking the threshold value you want to change, deleting it, entering a new value, and pressing Enter.
                                                                                                                          Note   

                                                                                                                          Do not modify the Laser Bias parameters.

                                                                                                                          Table 107 MXP_2.5G_10G, MXP_2.5G_10E, MXP_2.5G_10E_C, MXP_2.5G_10E_L, or MXP_2.5G_10EX_C Trunk Port TCA Thresholds

                                                                                                                          Card

                                                                                                                          TCA RX

                                                                                                                          Power High

                                                                                                                          TCA RX

                                                                                                                          Power Low

                                                                                                                          TCA TX

                                                                                                                          Power High

                                                                                                                          TCA TX

                                                                                                                          Power Low

                                                                                                                          MXP_2.5G_10G

                                                                                                                          –8 dBm

                                                                                                                          –18 dBm

                                                                                                                          7 dBm

                                                                                                                          –1 dBm

                                                                                                                          MXP_2.5G_10E

                                                                                                                          –9 dBm

                                                                                                                          –18 dBm

                                                                                                                          9 dBm

                                                                                                                          0 dBm

                                                                                                                          MXP_2.5G_10E_C

                                                                                                                          –9 dBm

                                                                                                                          –18 dBm

                                                                                                                          9 dBm

                                                                                                                          0 dBm

                                                                                                                          MXP_2.5G_10E_L

                                                                                                                          –9 dBm

                                                                                                                          –18 dBm

                                                                                                                          9 dBm

                                                                                                                          0 dBm

                                                                                                                          MXP_2.5G_10EX_C

                                                                                                                          –9 dBm

                                                                                                                          –18 dBm

                                                                                                                          9 dBm

                                                                                                                          0 dBm

                                                                                                                          Step 6   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                          Step 7   Under Types, click the Alarm radio button and click Refresh.
                                                                                                                          Step 8   Referring to the following table, verify the trunk port (Port 5) Alarm thresholds for RX Power High, RX Power Low, TX Power High, and TX Power Low.
                                                                                                                          Step 9   Provision new thresholds as needed by double-clicking the threshold value you want to change, deleting it, entering a new value, and pressing Enter.
                                                                                                                          Note   

                                                                                                                          Do not modify the Laser Bias parameters.

                                                                                                                          Table 108 MXP_2.5G_10G, MXP_2.5G_10E, MXP_2.5G_10E_C, MXP_2.5G_10E_L, or MXP_2.5G_10EX_C Trunk Port Alarm Thresholds

                                                                                                                          Card

                                                                                                                          Alarm RX

                                                                                                                          Power High

                                                                                                                          Alarm RX

                                                                                                                          Power Low

                                                                                                                          Alarm TX

                                                                                                                          Power High

                                                                                                                          Alarm TX

                                                                                                                          Power Low

                                                                                                                          MXP_2.5G_10G

                                                                                                                          –8 dBm

                                                                                                                          –20 dBm

                                                                                                                          4 dBm

                                                                                                                          2 dBm

                                                                                                                          MXP_2.5G_10E

                                                                                                                          –8 dBm

                                                                                                                          –20 dBm

                                                                                                                          7 dBm

                                                                                                                          3 dBm

                                                                                                                          MXP_2.5G_10E_C

                                                                                                                          –8 dBm

                                                                                                                          –20 dBm

                                                                                                                          7 dBm

                                                                                                                          3 dBm

                                                                                                                          MXP_2.5G_10E_L

                                                                                                                          –8 dBm

                                                                                                                          –20 dBm

                                                                                                                          7 dBm

                                                                                                                          3 dBm

                                                                                                                          MXP_2.5G_10EX_C

                                                                                                                          –8 dBm

                                                                                                                          –20 dBm

                                                                                                                          7 dBm

                                                                                                                          3 dBm

                                                                                                                          Step 10   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                          Step 11   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                          DLP-G304 Provisioning the 4x2.5G Muxponder Client Port Alarm and TCA Thresholds

                                                                                                                          Purpose

                                                                                                                          This task provisions the client port alarm and TCA thresholds for the MXP_2.5G_10G, MXP_2.5G_10E, MXP_2.5G_10E_C, MXP_2.5G_10E_L, and MXP_2.5G_10EX_C cards.

                                                                                                                          Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                          None

                                                                                                                          Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                          DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                          DLP-G278 Provisioning the Optical Line Rate

                                                                                                                          Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                          Required

                                                                                                                          Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                          Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                          Security Level

                                                                                                                          Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                          Procedure
                                                                                                                            Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the MXP_2.5G_10G, MXP_2.5G_10E, MXP_2.5G_10E_C, MXP_2.5G_10E_L, or MXP_2.5G_10EX_C card where you want to change the client port alarm and TCA settings.
                                                                                                                            Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Optics Thresholds tabs. The TCA thresholds are shown by default.
                                                                                                                            Step 3   Referring to the following table, verify the client Port N (where N = 1 through 4) TCA thresholds for RX Power High, RX Power Low, TX Power High, and TX Power Low based on the client interface at the other end.
                                                                                                                            Step 4   Provision new thresholds as needed by double-clicking the threshold value you want to change, deleting it, entering a new value, and pressing Enter.
                                                                                                                            Note   

                                                                                                                            You must modify 15 Min and 1 Day independently. To do so, choose the appropriate radio button and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                            Note   

                                                                                                                            Do not modify the Laser Bias parameters.

                                                                                                                            Note   

                                                                                                                            The hardware device that plugs into a TXP, MXP, GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, 10GE_XPE, or ADM-10G card faceplate to provide a fiber interface to the card is called a Small Form-factor Pluggable (SFP or XFP). In CTC, SFPs and XFPs are called pluggable port modules (PPMs). SFPs/XFPs are hot-swappable input/output devices that plug into a port to link the port with the fiber-optic network. Multirate PPMs have provisionable port rates and payloads. For more information about SFPs and XFPs, see the SFP, SFP+, QSFP+, XFP, CXP, CFP, and CPAK Modules

                                                                                                                            Table 109 MXP_2.5G_10G, MXP_2.5G_10E, MXP_2.5G_10E_C, MXP_2.5G_10E_L, or MXP_2.5G_10EX_C Card Client Interfaces TCA Thresholds

                                                                                                                            Port Type
(by CTC)

                                                                                                                            Pluggable Port Module 
(SFP)

                                                                                                                            TCA RX
Power High

                                                                                                                            TCA RX
Power Low

                                                                                                                            TCA TX
Power High

                                                                                                                            TCA TX
Power Low

                                                                                                                            OC-48

                                                                                                                            ONS-SE-2G-S1

                                                                                                                            –3

                                                                                                                            –18

                                                                                                                            3

                                                                                                                            –16

                                                                                                                            15454-SFP-OC48-IR

                                                                                                                            0

                                                                                                                            –18

                                                                                                                            6

                                                                                                                            –11

                                                                                                                            STM-16

                                                                                                                            ONS-SE-2G-S1

                                                                                                                            –3

                                                                                                                            –18

                                                                                                                            3

                                                                                                                            –16

                                                                                                                            15454E-SFP-L.16.1

                                                                                                                            0

                                                                                                                            –18

                                                                                                                            6

                                                                                                                            –11

                                                                                                                            Step 5   Provision each additional client port.
                                                                                                                            Step 6   Under Types, click the Alarm radio button and click Refresh.
                                                                                                                            Step 7   Referring to the following table, verify the client Port N (where N = 1 through 4) Alarm thresholds for RX Power High, RX Power Low, TX Power High, and TX Power Low based on the client interface that is provisioned.
                                                                                                                            Step 8   Provision new thresholds as needed by double-clicking the threshold value you want to change, deleting it, entering a new value, and pressing Enter.
                                                                                                                            Note   

                                                                                                                            Do not modify the Laser Bias parameters.

                                                                                                                            Table 110 MXP_2.5G_10G, MXP_2.5G_10E, MXP_2.5G_10E_C, or MXP_2.5G_10E_L Card Client Interfaces Alarm Thresholds

                                                                                                                            Port Type
(by CTC)

                                                                                                                            Pluggable Port Module 
(SFP)

                                                                                                                            Alarm RX
Power High

                                                                                                                            Alarm RX
Power Low

                                                                                                                            Alarm TX
Power High

                                                                                                                            Alarm TX
Power Low

                                                                                                                            OC-48

                                                                                                                            ONS-SE-2G-S1

                                                                                                                            0

                                                                                                                            –21

                                                                                                                            0

                                                                                                                            –13

                                                                                                                            15454-SFP-OC48-IR

                                                                                                                            3

                                                                                                                            –21

                                                                                                                            3

                                                                                                                            –8

                                                                                                                            STM-16

                                                                                                                            ONS-SE-2G-S1

                                                                                                                            0

                                                                                                                            –21

                                                                                                                            0

                                                                                                                            –13

                                                                                                                            15454E-SFP-L.16.1

                                                                                                                            3

                                                                                                                            –21

                                                                                                                            3

                                                                                                                            –8

                                                                                                                            Step 9   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                            Step 10   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                            DLP-G228 Changing the 4x2.5G Muxponder Line OTN Settings

                                                                                                                            Purpose

                                                                                                                            This task changes the line OTN settings for MXP_2.5G_10G, MXP_2.5G_10E, MXP_2.5G_10E_C, MXP_2.5G_10E_L, and MXP_2.5G_10EX_C muxponder cards.

                                                                                                                            Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                            None

                                                                                                                            Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                            DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                            Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                            As needed

                                                                                                                            Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                            Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                            Security Level

                                                                                                                            Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                            Procedure
                                                                                                                              Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the MXP_2.5G_10G, MXP_2.5G_10E, MXP_2.5G_10E_C, MXP_2.5G_10E_L, or MXP_2.5G_10EX_C card where you want to change the line OTN settings.
                                                                                                                              Step 2   Click the Provisioning > OTN tabs, then choose one of the following subtabs: OTN Lines, OTN G.709 Thresholds, FEC Thresholds, or Trail Trace Identifier.
                                                                                                                              Step 3   Modify any of the settings as described in the following tables.
                                                                                                                              Note   

                                                                                                                              You must modify Near End and Far End independently, 15 Min and 1 Day independently, and SM and PM independently. To do so, choose the appropriate radio button and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                              Note   

                                                                                                                              In the following table, some parameter tabs or values do not always apply to all MXP_2.5G_10G, MXP_2.5G_10E, MXP_2.5G_10E_C, or MXP_2.5G_10E_L cards. If the tabs or values do not apply, they do not appear in CTC.

                                                                                                                              Table 111 MXP_2.5G_10G, MXP_2.5G_10E, MXP_2.5G_10E_C, MXP_2.5G_10E_L, or MXP_2.5G_10EX_C Card Line OTN Settings

                                                                                                                              Parameter

                                                                                                                              Description

                                                                                                                              Options

                                                                                                                              Port

                                                                                                                              (Display only) Displays the port number.

                                                                                                                              5 (Trunk)

                                                                                                                              G.709 OTN

                                                                                                                              Sets the OTN lines according to ITU-T G.709.

                                                                                                                              • Enable

                                                                                                                              • Disable

                                                                                                                              FEC

                                                                                                                              Sets the OTN line FEC mode. FEC mode can be Disabled or Enabled. With the MXP_2.5G_10E card, Enhanced FEC (E-FEC) mode can be enabled to provide greater range and lower bit error rate. E-FEC applies only to the MXP_2.5G_10E card.

                                                                                                                              • Enable—(MXP_2.5G_10G only) FEC is on.

                                                                                                                              • Disable—FEC is off.

                                                                                                                              • Standard—(MXP_2.5G_10E only) FEC is on.

                                                                                                                              • Enhanced—(MXP_2.5G_10E only) Enhanced FEC is on.

                                                                                                                              SD BER

                                                                                                                              Sets the signal degrade bit error rate.

                                                                                                                              • 1E-5

                                                                                                                              • 1E-6

                                                                                                                              • 1E-7

                                                                                                                              • 1E-8

                                                                                                                              • 1E-9

                                                                                                                              SF BER

                                                                                                                              (Display only) Sets the signal fail bit error rate.

                                                                                                                              • 1E-5

                                                                                                                              Asynch/Synch Mapping

                                                                                                                              (MXP_2.5G_10E only) The MXP_2.5G_10E can perform standard ODU multiplexing according to ITU-T G.709. The card uses this to aggregate the four OC-48 client signals.

                                                                                                                              • ODU Multiplex

                                                                                                                              Table 112 MXP_2.5G_10G, MXP_2.5G_10E, MXP_2.5G_10E_C, MXP_2.5G_10E_L, or MXP_2.5G_10EX_C ITU-T G.709 Threshold Settings

                                                                                                                              Parameter

                                                                                                                              Description

                                                                                                                              Options

                                                                                                                              Port

                                                                                                                              (Display only) Port number

                                                                                                                              5 (Trunk)

                                                                                                                              ES

                                                                                                                              Errored seconds

                                                                                                                              Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                              • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                              • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                              • Types—SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk)

                                                                                                                              Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                              Note   

                                                                                                                              SM (OTUk) is the ITU-T G.709 optical channel transport unit order of k overhead frame used for management and performance monitoring. PM (ODUk) is the ITU-T G.709 optical channel data unit order of k overhead frame unit used for path performance monitoring.

                                                                                                                              SES

                                                                                                                              Severely errored seconds. Two types of thresholds can be asserted. Selecting the SM (OTUk) radio button selects FEC, overhead management, and PM using OTUk. Selecting the PM radio button selects path PM using ODUk.

                                                                                                                              Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                              • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                              • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                              • Types—SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk)

                                                                                                                              Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                              UAS

                                                                                                                              Unavailable seconds

                                                                                                                              Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                              • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                              • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                              • Types—SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk)

                                                                                                                              Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                              BBE

                                                                                                                              Background block errors

                                                                                                                              Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                              • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                              • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                              • Types—SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk)

                                                                                                                              Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                              FC

                                                                                                                              Failure counter

                                                                                                                              Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                              • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                              • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                              • Types—SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk)

                                                                                                                              Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                              Table 113 MXP_2.5G_10G, MXP_2.5G_10E, MXP_2.5G_10E_C, MXP_2.5G_10E_L, or MXP_2.5G_10EX_C FEC Threshold Settings

                                                                                                                              Parameter

                                                                                                                              Description

                                                                                                                              Options

                                                                                                                              Port

                                                                                                                              (Display only) Displays the port number.

                                                                                                                              5 (Trunk)

                                                                                                                              Bit Errors Corrected

                                                                                                                              Displays the number of bit errors corrected during the interval selected. The interval can be set for 15 minutes or one day.

                                                                                                                              Numeric

                                                                                                                              Uncorrectable Words

                                                                                                                              Displays the number of uncorrectable words during the interval selected. The interval can be set for 15 minutes or one day.

                                                                                                                              Numeric

                                                                                                                              Table 114 MXP_2.5G_10G, MXP_2.5G_10E, MXP_2.5G_10E_C, MXP_2.5G_10E_L, or MXP_2.5G_10EX_C Trail Trace Identifier Settings

                                                                                                                              Parameter

                                                                                                                              Description

                                                                                                                              Options

                                                                                                                              Port

                                                                                                                              Sets the port number. The trail trace identifier is applicable only to the trunk interface, which handles ITU-T G.709 frames.

                                                                                                                              5 (Trunk)

                                                                                                                              Level

                                                                                                                              Sets the level.

                                                                                                                              • Section

                                                                                                                              • Path

                                                                                                                              Received Trace Mode

                                                                                                                              Sets the trace mode.

                                                                                                                              • Off/None

                                                                                                                              • Manual

                                                                                                                              Disable FDI on TTIM

                                                                                                                              If a Trace Identifier Mismatch on Section overhead alarm arises because of a J0 overhead string mismatch, no Forward Defect Indication (FDI) signal is sent to the downstream nodes if this box is checked.

                                                                                                                              • Checked (FDI on TTIM is disabled)

                                                                                                                              • Unchecked (FDI on TTIM is not disabled)

                                                                                                                              Transmit

                                                                                                                              Displays the current transmit string; sets a new transmit string. You can click the button on the right to change the display. Its title changes, based on the current display mode. Click Hex to change the display to hexadecimal (button changes to ASCII); click ASCII to change the display to ASCII (button changes to Hex).

                                                                                                                              String of trace string size;
trail trace identifier is 64 bytes in length.

                                                                                                                              Expected

                                                                                                                              Displays the current expected string; sets a new expected string. You can click the button on the right to change the display. Its title changes, based on the current display mode. Click Hex to change the display to hexadecimal (button changes to ASCII); click ASCII to change the display to ASCII (button changes to Hex).

                                                                                                                              String of trace string size

                                                                                                                              Received

                                                                                                                              (Display only) Displays the current received string. You can click Refresh to manually refresh this display, or check the Auto-refresh every 5 sec box to keep this panel updated.

                                                                                                                              String of trace string size

                                                                                                                              Auto-refresh

                                                                                                                              If checked, automatically refreshes the display every 5 minutes.

                                                                                                                              Checked/unchecked (default)

                                                                                                                              Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                              Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                              NTP-G99 Modifying the 2.5G Data Muxponder Card Line Settings and PM Parameter Thresholds

                                                                                                                              Purpose

                                                                                                                              This procedure changes the line and threshold settings for the MXP_MR_2.5G and MXPP_MR_2.5G muxponder cards.

                                                                                                                              Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                              None

                                                                                                                              Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                              Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                              As needed

                                                                                                                              Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                              Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                              Security Level

                                                                                                                              Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                              Procedure
                                                                                                                                Step 1   As needed, complete the NTP-G103 Backing Up the Database task to preserve the existing transmission settings.
                                                                                                                                Step 2   Perform any of the following tasks as needed:
                                                                                                                                Note   

                                                                                                                                To use the Alarm Profiles tab, including creating alarm profiles and suppressing alarms, see the Alarm and TCA Monitoring and Management document.

                                                                                                                                Stop. You have completed this procedure.

                                                                                                                                DLP-G236 Changing the 2.5G or 10G Data Muxponder Client Line Settings

                                                                                                                                Purpose

                                                                                                                                This task changes the client line settings for MXP_MR_2.5G, MXPP_MR_2.5G, MXP_MR_10DME_C, MXP_MR_10DME_L, and MXP_MR_10DMEX_C muxponder cards.

                                                                                                                                Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                None

                                                                                                                                Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                As needed

                                                                                                                                Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                Security Level

                                                                                                                                Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                Procedure
                                                                                                                                  Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the card where you want to change the line settings.
                                                                                                                                  Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line > Client tabs. Tabs and parameter selections vary according to PPM provisioning.
                                                                                                                                  Note   

                                                                                                                                  The hardware device that plugs into a TXP, MXP, GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, 10GE_XPE, or ADM-10G card faceplate to provide a fiber interface to the card is called a Small Form-factor Pluggable (SFP or XFP). In CTC, SFPs and XFPs are called pluggable port modules (PPMs). SFPs/XFPs are hot-swappable input/output devices that plug into a port to link the port with the fiber-optic network. Multirate PPMs have provisionable port rates and payloads. For more information about SFPs and XFPs, see the SFP, SFP+, QSFP+, XFP, CXP, CFP, and CPAK Modules.

                                                                                                                                  Step 3   Modify any of the settings for the Client tab as described in the following table.
                                                                                                                                  Table 115 2.5G or 10G Data Muxponder Card Client Settings

                                                                                                                                  Parameter

                                                                                                                                  Description

                                                                                                                                  Options

                                                                                                                                  Port

                                                                                                                                  (Display only) Port number.

                                                                                                                                  • 1 and 2 for 2.5G data muxponder cards

                                                                                                                                  • 1 through 8 for 10G data muxponder cards

                                                                                                                                  Port Name

                                                                                                                                  The user can assign a logical name for each of the ports shown by filling in this field.

                                                                                                                                  User-defined. Name can be up to 80 alphanumeric/special characters. Blank by default.

                                                                                                                                  Note   

                                                                                                                                  You can provision a string (port name) for each fiber channel/FICON interface on the cards, which allows the MDS Fabric Manager to create a link association between that SAN port and a SAN port on a Cisco MDS 9000 switch.

                                                                                                                                  Admin State

                                                                                                                                  Sets the port service state unless network conditions prevent the change. For more information about administrative states, see the Administrative and Service States document.

                                                                                                                                  • IS (ANSI) or Unlocked (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                  • OOS,DSBLD (ANSI) or Locked,disabled (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                  • OOS,MT (ANSI) or Locked,maintenance (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                  Service State

                                                                                                                                  Identifies the autonomously generated state that gives the overall condition of the port. Service states appear in the format: Primary State-Primary State Qualifier, Secondary State. For more information about service states, see the Administrative and Service States document.

                                                                                                                                  • IS-NR (ANSI) or Unlocked-enabled (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                  • OOS-AU,AINS (ANSI) or Unlocked-disabled,
automaticInService (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                  • OOS-MA,DSBLD (ANSI) or Locked-enabled,disabled (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                  • OOS-MA,MT (ANSI) or Locked-enabled,maintenance (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                  ALS Mode

                                                                                                                                  Sets the ALS function mode.

                                                                                                                                  • Disabled (default): ALS is off; the laser is not automatically shut down when traffic outages (LOS) occur.

                                                                                                                                  • Auto Restart: (MXP_MR_2.5G only) ALS is on; the laser automatically shuts down when traffic outages (LOS) occur. It automatically restarts when the conditions that caused the outage are resolved.

                                                                                                                                  • Manual Restart: ALS is on; the laser automatically shuts down when traffic outages (LOS) occur. However, the laser must be manually restarted when conditions that caused the outage are resolved.

                                                                                                                                  • Manual Restart for Test: Manually restarts the laser for testing.

                                                                                                                                  Reach

                                                                                                                                  Displays the optical reach distance of the client port.

                                                                                                                                  The reach distances that appear in the drop-down list depend on the card:

                                                                                                                                  • Autoprovision—The system to automatically provision the reach from the pluggable port module (PPM) reach value on the hardware.

                                                                                                                                  • SX—Short laser wavelength on multimode fiber optic cable for a maximum length of 550 meters. The operating wavelength range is 770-860 nm.

                                                                                                                                  • LX—Long wavelength for a long haul fiber optic cable for a maximum length of 10 km. The operating wavelength range is 1270-1355 nm.

                                                                                                                                  • CX—Two pairs of 150-ohm shielded twisted pair cable for a maximum length of 25 meters.

                                                                                                                                  • T—Four pairs of Category 5 Unshielded Twisted Pair cable for a maximum length of 100 meters.

                                                                                                                                  • DX—Single mode up to 40 km. The operating wavelength range is 1430-1580 nm.

                                                                                                                                  • HX—Single mode up to 40 km. The operating wavelength range is 1280-1335 nm.

                                                                                                                                  • ZX—Extended wavelength single-mode optical fiber for up to 100 km. The operating wavelength range is 1500-1580 nm.

                                                                                                                                  • VX—Single mode up to 100 km. The operating wavelength range is 1500-1580 nm.

                                                                                                                                  Wavelength

                                                                                                                                  Displays the wavelength of the client port.

                                                                                                                                  • First Tunable Wavelength

                                                                                                                                  • Further wavelengths:850 nm through 1560.61 nm; 100-GHz ITU spacing; CWDM spacing

                                                                                                                                  Squelch

                                                                                                                                  Shuts down the far-end laser in response to certain defects. (Squelch does not apply to ISC COMPACT payloads.)

                                                                                                                                  • Squelch

                                                                                                                                  • Disable

                                                                                                                                  Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                  Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                  DLP-G237 Changing the 2.5G Data Muxponder Distance Extension Settings

                                                                                                                                  Purpose

                                                                                                                                  This task changes the distance extension settings for MXP_MR_2.5G and MXPP_MR_2.5G muxponder cards.

                                                                                                                                  Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                  None

                                                                                                                                  Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                  DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                  Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                  As needed

                                                                                                                                  Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                  Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                  Security Level

                                                                                                                                  Provisioning or higher


                                                                                                                                  Note


                                                                                                                                  Distance extension settings can be changed only if the facilities are out of service (OOS,DSBLD).



                                                                                                                                  Note


                                                                                                                                  The distance extension parameters only apply to client ports (Ports 1 to 8) and not to the trunk ports (Port 9 for MXP_MR_2.5G card or Ports 9 and 10 for the MXPP_MR_2.5G card).


                                                                                                                                  Procedure
                                                                                                                                    Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the MXP_MR_2.5G or MXPP_MR_2.5G card where you want to change the distance extension settings.
                                                                                                                                    Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line > Client tabs. A client port must be provisioned for the tab to be present.
                                                                                                                                    Note   

                                                                                                                                    The hardware device that plugs into a TXP, MXP, GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, 10GE_XPE, or ADM-10G card faceplate to provide a fiber interface to the card is called a Small Form-factor Pluggable (SFP or XFP). In CTC, SFPs and XFPs are called pluggable port modules (PPMs). SFPs/XFPs are hot-swappable input/output devices that plug into a port to link the port with the fiber-optic network. Multirate PPMs have provisionable port rates and payloads. For more information about SFPs and XFPs, see the SFP, SFP+, QSFP+, XFP, CXP, CFP, and CPAK Modules.

                                                                                                                                    Step 3   Locate the Client port table row and verify that the Service State column value is OOS-MA,DSBLD (ANSI) or Locked-enabled,disabled (ETSI). If yes, continue with Step 4. If not, complete the following substeps:
                                                                                                                                    1. Click the Admin State table cell and choose OOS,DSBLD (ANSI) or Locked,Maintenance (ETSI).
                                                                                                                                    2. Click Apply, then Yes.
                                                                                                                                    Step 4   Click the Provisioning > Line > Distance Extension tabs. Tabs and parameter selections vary according to PPM provisioning.
                                                                                                                                    Step 5   Modify any of the settings for the Distance Extension tab as described in the following table.
                                                                                                                                    Table 116 MXP_MR_2.5G or MXPP_MR_2.5G Card Line Distance Extension Settings

                                                                                                                                    Parameter

                                                                                                                                    Description

                                                                                                                                    Options

                                                                                                                                    Port

                                                                                                                                    (Display only) Port number

                                                                                                                                    • 1

                                                                                                                                    • 2

                                                                                                                                    Enable Distance Extension

                                                                                                                                    Allows end-to-end distances of up to 1600 km for FC1G and up to 800 km for FC2G. If Distance Extension is enabled, set the connected Fibre Channel switches to Interop or Open Fabric mode, depending on the Fibre Channel switch. By default, the MXP_MR_2.5G and MXPP_MR_2.5G card will interoperate with the Cisco Multilayer Director Switch (MDS) storage products.

                                                                                                                                    Checked or unchecked

                                                                                                                                    Auto Detect Credits

                                                                                                                                    Allows automatic detection of buffer credits for Fibre Channel flow control.

                                                                                                                                    Checked or unchecked

                                                                                                                                    Credits Available

                                                                                                                                    (Display only) Displays the number of buffer credits available.

                                                                                                                                    Numeric (range depends on the client equipment attached to the card)

                                                                                                                                    Autoadjust GFP Buffer Threshold

                                                                                                                                    Allows the threshold of the generic framing procedure (GFP) buffer between two MXP_MR_2.5G or two MXPP_MR_2.5G cards to be automatically adjusted.

                                                                                                                                    Checked or unchecked

                                                                                                                                    GFP Buffers Available

                                                                                                                                    Displays the number of GFP buffers available between two MXP_MR_2.5G or two MXPP_MR_2.5G cards.

                                                                                                                                    Numeric

                                                                                                                                    Step 6   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                    Step 7   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                    DLP-G238 Changing the 2.5G or 10G Data Muxponder SONET/SDH Settings

                                                                                                                                    Purpose

                                                                                                                                    This task changes the OC-48 (ANSI) or STM-16 (ETSI) settings for MXP_MR_2.5G and MXPP_MR_2.5G muxponder cards. This task also changes the OC-192 (ANSI) or STM-64 (ETSI) settings for the MXP_MR_10DME_C and MXP_MR_10DME_L muxponder cards.

                                                                                                                                    Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                    None

                                                                                                                                    Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                    DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                    Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                    As needed

                                                                                                                                    Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                    Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                    Security Level

                                                                                                                                    Provisioning or higher


                                                                                                                                    Note


                                                                                                                                    SONET (OC-48)/SDH (STM-16) settings apply only to the trunk ports (Port 9 for the MXP_MR_2.5G card and Ports 9 and 10 for the MXPP_MR_2.5G card.)


                                                                                                                                    Procedure
                                                                                                                                      Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the card where you want to change the OC-48/STM-64 settings.
                                                                                                                                      Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line > SONET (ANSI) or SDH (ETSI). Tabs and parameter selections vary according to PPM provisioning.
                                                                                                                                      Step 3   Modify any of the settings for the SONET or SDH tab as described in the following table.
                                                                                                                                      Table 117 MXP_MR_2.5G or MXPP_MR_2.5G Card Line SONET or SDH Settings

                                                                                                                                      Parameter

                                                                                                                                      Description

                                                                                                                                      Options

                                                                                                                                      Port

                                                                                                                                      (Display only) Port number.

                                                                                                                                      9 (trunk for MXP_MR_2.5G, MXP_MR_10DME_C, and MXP_MR_10DME_L) or 9 and 10 (trunks for MXPP_MR_2.5G)

                                                                                                                                      Port Name

                                                                                                                                      Provides the ability to assign the specified port a name.

                                                                                                                                      User-defined. Name can be up to 80 alphanumeric/ special characters. Blank by default.

                                                                                                                                      Admin State

                                                                                                                                      Sets the port service state unless network conditions prevent the change. For more information about administrative states, see the Administrative and Service States document.

                                                                                                                                      • IS (ANSI) or Unlocked (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                      • IS,AINS (ANSI) or Unlocked,automaticInService (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                      • OOS,DSBLD (ANSI) or Locked,disabled (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                      • OOS,MT (ANSI) or Locked,maintenance (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                      Service State

                                                                                                                                      (Display only) Identifies the autonomously generated state that gives the overall condition of the port. Service states appear in the format: Primary State-Primary State Qualifier, Secondary State. For more information about service states, see the Administrative and Service States document.

                                                                                                                                      • IS-NR (ANSI) or Unlocked-enabled (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                      • OOS-AU,AINS (ANSI) or Unlocked-disabled,
automaticInService (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                      • OOS-MA,DSBLD (ANSI) or Locked-enabled,disabled (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                      • OOS-MA,MT (ANSI) or Locked-enabled,maintenance (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                      SF BER

                                                                                                                                      Sets the signal fail bit error rate.

                                                                                                                                      • 1E-3

                                                                                                                                      • 1E-4

                                                                                                                                      • 1E-5

                                                                                                                                      SD BER

                                                                                                                                      Sets the signal degrade bit error rate.

                                                                                                                                      • 1E-5

                                                                                                                                      • 1E-6

                                                                                                                                      • 1E-7

                                                                                                                                      • 1E-8

                                                                                                                                      • 1E-9

                                                                                                                                      ALS Mode

                                                                                                                                      Sets the ALS function mode. The DWDM transmitter supports ALS according to ITU-T G.644 (06/99). ALS can be disabled or can be set for one of three mode options.

                                                                                                                                      • Disable (default): ALS is off; the laser is not automatically shut down when traffic outages (LOS) occur.

                                                                                                                                      • Auto Restart: ALS is on; the laser automatically shuts down when traffic outages (LOS) occur. It automatically restarts when the conditions that caused the outage are resolved.

                                                                                                                                      • Manual Restart: ALS is on; the laser automatically shuts down when traffic outages (LOS) occur. However, the laser must be manually restarted when conditions that caused the outage are resolved.

                                                                                                                                      • Manual Restart for Test: Manually restarts the laser for testing.

                                                                                                                                      AINS Soak

                                                                                                                                      Sets the automatic in-service soak period. Double-click the time and use the up and down arrows to change settings.

                                                                                                                                      • Duration of valid input signal, in hh.mm format, after which the card becomes in service (IS) automatically

                                                                                                                                      • 0 to 48 hours, 15-minute increments

                                                                                                                                      Type

                                                                                                                                      The optical transport type.

                                                                                                                                      • SONET (ANSI)

                                                                                                                                      • SDH (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                      SyncMsgIn

                                                                                                                                      Sets the EnableSync card parameter. Enables synchronization status messages (S1 byte), which allow the node to choose the best timing source.

                                                                                                                                      Checked or unchecked

                                                                                                                                      Send DoNotUse

                                                                                                                                      Sets the Send DoNotUse card state. When checked, sends a DUS message on the S1 byte.

                                                                                                                                      Checked or unchecked

                                                                                                                                      ProvidesSync

                                                                                                                                      Sets the ProvidesSync card parameter. If checked, the card is provisioned as an NE timing reference.

                                                                                                                                      Checked or unchecked

                                                                                                                                      SF BER and SD BER thresholds apply only to trunk ports (Port 9 for MXP_MR_2.5G and Ports 9 and 10 for MXPP_MR_2.5G).

                                                                                                                                      Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                      Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                      DLP-G239 Changing the 2.5G or 10G Data Muxponder Section Trace Settings

                                                                                                                                      Purpose

                                                                                                                                      This task changes the section trace settings for the MXP_MR_2.5G, MXPP_MR_2.5G, MXP_MR_10DME_C and MXP_MR_10DME_L muxponder cards.

                                                                                                                                      Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                      None

                                                                                                                                      Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                      DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                      Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                      As needed

                                                                                                                                      Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                      Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                      Security Level

                                                                                                                                      Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                      Procedure
                                                                                                                                        Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the card where you want to change the section trace settings.
                                                                                                                                        Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line > Section Trace tabs. Tabs and parameter selections vary according to PPM provisioning.
                                                                                                                                        Note   

                                                                                                                                        The hardware device that plugs into a TXP, MXP, GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, 10GE_XPE, or ADM-10G card faceplate to provide a fiber interface to the card is called a Small Form-factor Pluggable (SFP or XFP). In CTC, SFPs and XFPs are called pluggable port modules (PPMs). SFPs/XFPs are hot-swappable input/output devices that plug into a port to link the port with the fiber-optic network. Multirate PPMs have provisionable port rates and payloads. For more information about SFPs and XFPs, see the SFP, SFP+, QSFP+, XFP, CXP, CFP, and CPAK Modules.

                                                                                                                                        Step 3   Modify any of the settings in the Section Trace tab as described in the following table.
                                                                                                                                        Table 118 2.5G or 10G Data Muxponder Card Line Section Trace Settings

                                                                                                                                        Parameter

                                                                                                                                        Description

                                                                                                                                        Options

                                                                                                                                        Port

                                                                                                                                        (Display only) Port number.

                                                                                                                                        • 9 (trunk port for MXP_MR_2.5G, MXP_MR_10DME_C, and MXP_MR_10DME_L)

                                                                                                                                        • 9 and 10 (trunk ports for MXPP_MR_2.5G)

                                                                                                                                        Received Trace Mode

                                                                                                                                        Sets the received trace mode.

                                                                                                                                        • Off/None

                                                                                                                                        • Manual

                                                                                                                                        Disable AIS/RDI on TIM-S

                                                                                                                                        If an TIM on Section overhead alarm arises because of a J0 overhead string mismatch, no alarm indication signal is sent to downstream nodes if this box is checked.

                                                                                                                                        • Checked (AIS/RDI on TIM-S is disabled)

                                                                                                                                        • Unchecked (AIS/RDI on TIM-S is not disabled)

                                                                                                                                        Transmit Section Trace String Size

                                                                                                                                        Sets the trace string size.

                                                                                                                                        • 1 byte

                                                                                                                                        • 16 byte

                                                                                                                                        Transmit

                                                                                                                                        Displays the current transmit string; sets a new transmit string. You can click the button on the right to change the display. Its title changes, based on the current display mode. Click Hex to change the display to hexadecimal (button changes to ASCII); click ASCII to change the display to ASCII (button changes to Hex).

                                                                                                                                        String of trace string size

                                                                                                                                        Expected

                                                                                                                                        Displays the current expected string; sets a new expected string. You can click the button on the right to change the display. Its title changes, based on the current display mode. Click Hex to change the display to hexadecimal (button changes to ASCII); click ASCII to change the display to ASCII (button changes to Hex).

                                                                                                                                        String of trace string size

                                                                                                                                        Received

                                                                                                                                        (Display only) Displays the current received string. You can click Refresh to manually refresh this display, or check the Auto-refresh every 5 sec check box to keep this panel updated.

                                                                                                                                        String of trace string size

                                                                                                                                        Auto-refresh

                                                                                                                                        If checked, automatically refreshes the display every 5 seconds.

                                                                                                                                        Checked/unchecked (default)

                                                                                                                                        Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                        Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                        DLP-G370 Changing the 2.5G or 10G Data Muxponder Trunk Wavelength Settings

                                                                                                                                        Purpose

                                                                                                                                        This task changes the trunk wavelength settings for the MXP_MR_2.5G, MXPP_MR_2.5G, MXP_MR_10DME_C, and MXP_MR_10DME_L cards.

                                                                                                                                        Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                        None

                                                                                                                                        Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                        DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                        Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                        As needed

                                                                                                                                        Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                        Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                        Security Level

                                                                                                                                        Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                        Procedure
                                                                                                                                          Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the card where you want to change the trunk wavelength settings.
                                                                                                                                          Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line > Wavelength Trunk Settings tabs.
                                                                                                                                          Step 3   Modify any of the settings as described in the following table.
                                                                                                                                          Table 119 2.5G or 10G Data Muxponder Card Wavelength Trunk Settings

                                                                                                                                          Parameter

                                                                                                                                          Description

                                                                                                                                          Options

                                                                                                                                          Port

                                                                                                                                          (Display only) Displays the port number.

                                                                                                                                          9 (Trunk)

                                                                                                                                          10 (Trunk) (MXPP_MR_2.5G only)

                                                                                                                                          Band

                                                                                                                                          (Display only) Indicates the wavelength band that can be provisioned. The field is display-only when a physical MXP_MR_10DME_C or MXP_MR_10DME_L is installed. If the card is provisioned in CTC only, you can provision the band for the card that will be installed.

                                                                                                                                          • C—The C band wavelengths are available in the Wavelength field.

                                                                                                                                          • (MXP_MR_10DME_C, and MXP_MR_10DME_L only) L—The L-band wavelengths are available in the Wavelength field.

                                                                                                                                          Even/Odd

                                                                                                                                          Sets the wavelengths available for provisioning. This field does not apply to MXP_MR_2.5G or MXPP_MR_2.5G cards

                                                                                                                                          • Even—Displays even C-band or L-band wavelengths in the Wavelength field.

                                                                                                                                          • Odd—Displays odd C-band or L-band wavelengths in the Wavelength field.

                                                                                                                                          Wavelength

                                                                                                                                          The wavelength provisioned for the trunk.

                                                                                                                                          • First Tunable Wavelength

                                                                                                                                          • Further wavelengths in 100-GHz ITU-T, C-band spacing. If the card is installed, the wavelengths it carries are identified with two asterisks. Other wavelengths have a dark grey background. If the card is not installed, all wavelengths appear with a dark grey background.

                                                                                                                                          Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                          Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                          DLP-G240 Changing the 2.5G or 10G Data Muxponder SONET or SDH Line Thresholds

                                                                                                                                          Purpose

                                                                                                                                          This task changes the SONET or SDH line threshold settings for MXP_MR_2.5G, MXPP_MR_2.5G, MXP_MR_10DME_C, and MXP_MR_10DME_L muxponder cards.

                                                                                                                                          Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                          None

                                                                                                                                          Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                          DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                          Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                          As needed

                                                                                                                                          Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                          Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                          Security Level

                                                                                                                                          Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                          Procedure
                                                                                                                                            Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the card where you want to change the line threshold settings.
                                                                                                                                            Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line Thresholds > SONET Thresholds (ANSI) or SDH Thresholds (ETSI) tabs.
                                                                                                                                            Step 3   Modify any of the settings as shown in the following table.
                                                                                                                                            Note   

                                                                                                                                            You must modify Near End and Far End independently, 15 Min and 1 Day independently, and Line and Section independently. To do so, choose the appropriate radio button and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                            Note   

                                                                                                                                            In the following table, some parameters or options do not apply to all the cards. If the parameters or options do not apply, they do not appear in CTC.

                                                                                                                                            Table 120 2.5G or10G Data Muxponder Card Line Threshold Settings

                                                                                                                                            Field

                                                                                                                                            Description

                                                                                                                                            ONS 15454 Options

                                                                                                                                            ONS 15454 SDH Options

                                                                                                                                            Port

                                                                                                                                            (Display only) Port number

                                                                                                                                            • 9 (MXP_MR_2.5G)

                                                                                                                                            • 9 and 10 (MXPP_MR_2.5G)

                                                                                                                                            • 9 (Trunk) for MXP_MR_10DME_C and MXP_MR_10DME_L

                                                                                                                                            • 9 (MXP_MR_2.5G)

                                                                                                                                            • 9 and 10 (MXPP_MR_2.5G)

                                                                                                                                            • 9 (Trunk) for MXP_MR_10DME_C and MXP_MR_10DME_L

                                                                                                                                            EB

                                                                                                                                            Path Errored Block indicates that one or more bits are in error within a block

                                                                                                                                            Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                                            • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                                            • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                                            • Types—Multiplex Section or Regeneration Section (near end only)

                                                                                                                                            Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                            CV

                                                                                                                                            Coding violations

                                                                                                                                            Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                                            • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                                            • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                                            • Types—Line or Section (near end only)

                                                                                                                                            Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                            ES

                                                                                                                                            Errored seconds

                                                                                                                                            Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                                            • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                                            • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                                            • Types—Line or Section (near end only)

                                                                                                                                            Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                            Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                                            • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                                            • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                                            • Types—Multiplex Section or Regeneration Section (near end only)

                                                                                                                                            Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                            SES

                                                                                                                                            Severely errored seconds

                                                                                                                                            Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                                            • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                                            • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                                            • Types—Line or Section (near end only)

                                                                                                                                            Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                            Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                                            • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                                            • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                                            • Types—Multiplex Section or Regeneration Section (near end only)

                                                                                                                                            Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                            BBE

                                                                                                                                            Background block errors

                                                                                                                                            Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                                            • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                                            • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                                            • Types—SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk)

                                                                                                                                            Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                            SEFS

                                                                                                                                            (Section or Regeneration Section only) Severely errored framing seconds

                                                                                                                                            Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                                            • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                                            • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                                            • Types—Section only

                                                                                                                                            Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                            FC

                                                                                                                                            (Line or Multiplex Section only) Failure count

                                                                                                                                            Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                                            • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                                            • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                                            • Types—Section only

                                                                                                                                            Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                            UAS

                                                                                                                                            (Line or Multiplex Section only) Unavailable seconds

                                                                                                                                            Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                                            • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                                            • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                                            • Types—Section only

                                                                                                                                            Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                            Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                                            • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                                            • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                                            • Types—Regeneration Section (only)

                                                                                                                                            Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                            Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                            Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                            DLP-G321 Changing the 2.5G or 10G Data Muxponder Line RMON Thresholds

                                                                                                                                            Purpose

                                                                                                                                            This task changes the line threshold settings for MXP_MR_10G and MXPP_MR_2.5G transponder cards carrying the 1G Ethernet or 1G FC/FICON payloads. This task changes the line threshold settings for MXP_MR_10DME_C and MXP_MR_10DME_L cards carrying Ethernet, FC/FICON, or ISC/ISC3 payloads.

                                                                                                                                            Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                            None

                                                                                                                                            Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                            DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                            Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                            As needed

                                                                                                                                            Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                            Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                            Security Level

                                                                                                                                            Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                            Procedure
                                                                                                                                              Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), display the card where you want to change the line RMON threshold settings.
                                                                                                                                              Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line Thresholds > RMON Thresholds tabs.
                                                                                                                                              Step 3   Click Create. The Create Threshold dialog box appears.
                                                                                                                                              Step 4   From the Port drop-down list, choose the applicable port, either the payload port, for example “1-1 (ONE_GE)”, or the equivalent ITU-T G.7041 GFP (Generic Frame Procedure) port.
                                                                                                                                              Step 5   From the Variable drop-down list, choose an Ethernet, FC, FICON, or ISC variable.
                                                                                                                                              Table 121 MXP_MR_2.5G and MXPP_MR 2.5G Card 1G Ethernet or 1G, 2G FC/FICON Variables

                                                                                                                                              Variable

                                                                                                                                              Description

                                                                                                                                              ifInOctets

                                                                                                                                              Number of bytes received since the last counter reset.

                                                                                                                                              rxTotalPkts

                                                                                                                                              Total number of receive packets.

                                                                                                                                              ifInDiscards

                                                                                                                                              Number of inbound packets that were chosen to be discarded even though no errors had been detected to prevent their being deliverable to a higher-layer protocol.

                                                                                                                                              ifInErrors

                                                                                                                                              Total number of receive errors.

                                                                                                                                              ifOutOctets

                                                                                                                                              The total number of octets transmitted out of the interface, including framing characters.

                                                                                                                                              txTotalPkts

                                                                                                                                              Total number of transmitted packets.

                                                                                                                                              ifOutDiscards

                                                                                                                                              Number of outbound packets that were chosen to be discarded even though no errors had been detected to prevent their being transmitted.

                                                                                                                                              mediaIndStatsRxFramesTruncated

                                                                                                                                              Total number of frames received that are less than 5 bytes. This value is a part of high-level data link control (HDLC) and GFP port statistics.

                                                                                                                                              mediaIndStatsRxFramesTooLong

                                                                                                                                              Number of received frames that exceed the maximum transmission unit (MTU). This value is part of HDLC and GFP port statistics.

                                                                                                                                              mediaIndStatsRxFramesBadCRC

                                                                                                                                              Number of receive data frames with payload cyclic redundancy check (CRC) errors when HDLC framing is used.

                                                                                                                                              mediaIndStatsTxFramesBadCRC

                                                                                                                                              Number of transmitted data frames with payload CRC errors when HDLC framing is used.

                                                                                                                                              8b10bInvalidOrderedSets

                                                                                                                                              Number of 8b10b disparity violations on the Fibre Channel line side.

                                                                                                                                              8b10bStatsEncodingDispErrors

                                                                                                                                              Number of 8b10b disparity violations on the Fibre Channel line side.

                                                                                                                                              Table 122 MXP_MR_10DME_C or MXP_MR_10DME_L Ethernet Variables

                                                                                                                                              Variable

                                                                                                                                              Description

                                                                                                                                              ifInOctets

                                                                                                                                              Number of bytes received since the last counter reset.

                                                                                                                                              rxTotalPkts

                                                                                                                                              Total number of receive packets.

                                                                                                                                              ifInErrors

                                                                                                                                              Total number of receive errors.

                                                                                                                                              ifOutOctets

                                                                                                                                              The total number of octets transmitted out of the interface, including framing characters.

                                                                                                                                              txTotalPkts

                                                                                                                                              Total number of transmitted packets.

                                                                                                                                              mediaIndStatsRxFramesTruncated

                                                                                                                                              Total number of frames received that are less than 5 bytes. This value is a part of HDLC and GFP port statistics.

                                                                                                                                              mediaIndStatsRxFramesTooLong

                                                                                                                                              Number of received frames that exceed the MTU. This value is part of HDLC and GFP port statistics.

                                                                                                                                              mediaIndStatsRxFramesBadCRC

                                                                                                                                              Number of receive data frames with payload CRC errors when HDLC framing is used.

                                                                                                                                              mediaIndStatsTxFramesBadCRC

                                                                                                                                              Number of transmitted data frames with payload CRC errors when HDLC framing is used.

                                                                                                                                              8b10bInvalidOrderedSetsDispErrorsSum

                                                                                                                                              Number of code violations/running disparity errors in the 8b/10b encoded characters received.

                                                                                                                                              Table 123 MXP_MR_10DME_C or MXP_MR_10DME_L FC/FICON Variables

                                                                                                                                              Variable

                                                                                                                                              Description

                                                                                                                                              ifInOctets

                                                                                                                                              Number of bytes received since the last counter reset.

                                                                                                                                              rxTotalPkts

                                                                                                                                              Total number of receive packets.

                                                                                                                                              ifInErrors

                                                                                                                                              Total number of receive errors.

                                                                                                                                              ifOutOctets

                                                                                                                                              The total number of octets transmitted out of the interface, including framing characters.

                                                                                                                                              txTotalPkts

                                                                                                                                              Total number of transmitted packets.

                                                                                                                                              ifOutOversizePkts

                                                                                                                                              Total number of oversized packets output from the interface.

                                                                                                                                              mediaIndStatsRxFramesTruncated

                                                                                                                                              Total number of frames received that are less than 5 bytes. This value is a part of HDLC and GFP port statistics.

                                                                                                                                              mediaIndStatsRxFramesTooLong

                                                                                                                                              Number of received frames that exceed the MTU. This value is part of HDLC and GFP port statistics.

                                                                                                                                              mediaIndStatsRxFramesBadCRC

                                                                                                                                              Number of receive data frames with payload CRC errors when HDLC framing is used.

                                                                                                                                              mediaIndStatsTxFramesBadCRC

                                                                                                                                              Number of transmitted data frames with payload CRC errors when HDLC framing is used.

                                                                                                                                              fcStatsZeroTxCredits

                                                                                                                                              This is a count that increments when the FC/FICON Tx credits go from a non-zero value to zero.

                                                                                                                                              fcStatsRxRecvrReady

                                                                                                                                              Number of received RDY (Receive Ready) order set.

                                                                                                                                              fcStatsTxRecvrReady

                                                                                                                                              Number of transmitted RDY (Receive Ready) order set.

                                                                                                                                              8b10bInvalidOrderedSetsDispErrorsSum

                                                                                                                                              Number of Code Violations/Running Disparity errors in the 8b/10b encoded characters received.

                                                                                                                                              Table 124 MXP_MR_10DME_C or MXP_MR_10DME_L ISC and ISC3Variables

                                                                                                                                              Variable

                                                                                                                                              Description

                                                                                                                                              ifInOctets

                                                                                                                                              Number of bytes received since the last counter reset.

                                                                                                                                              rxTotalPkts

                                                                                                                                              Total number of receive packets.

                                                                                                                                              ifOutOctets

                                                                                                                                              The total number of octets transmitted out of the interface, including framing characters.

                                                                                                                                              txTotalPkts

                                                                                                                                              Total number of transmitted packets.

                                                                                                                                              8b10bInvalidOrderedSetsDispErrorsSum

                                                                                                                                              Number of Code Violations/Running Disparity errors in the 8b/10b encoded characters received.

                                                                                                                                              Table 125 MXP_MR_10DME_C or MXP_MR_10DME_L GFP RMON Variables

                                                                                                                                              Variable

                                                                                                                                              Description

                                                                                                                                              gfpStatsRxSBitErrors

                                                                                                                                              Received generic framing protocol (GFP) frames with single bit errors in the core header (these errors are correctable).

                                                                                                                                              gfpStatsRxTypeInvalid

                                                                                                                                              Received GFP frames with invalid type (these are discarded). For example, receiving GFP frames that contain Ethernet data when we expect Fibre Channel data.

                                                                                                                                              gfpStatsRxSblkCRCErrors

                                                                                                                                              Total number of superblock CRC errors with the receive transparent GFP frame. A transparent GFP frame has multiple superblocks which each contain Fibre Channel data.

                                                                                                                                              gfpStatsCSFRaised

                                                                                                                                              Number of Rx client management frames with Client Signal Fail indication.

                                                                                                                                              gfpStatsLFDRaised

                                                                                                                                              The number of Core HEC CRC Multiple Bit Errors.

                                                                                                                                              Note   

                                                                                                                                              This count is only for cHEC multiple bit error when in frame. It is a count of when the state machine goes out of frame.

                                                                                                                                              Step 6   From the Alarm Type drop-down list, indicate whether the event will be triggered by the rising threshold, the falling threshold, or both the rising and falling thresholds.
                                                                                                                                              Step 7   From the Sample Type drop-down list, choose either Relative or Absolute. Relative restricts the threshold to use the number of occurrences in the user-set sample period. Absolute sets the threshold to use the total number of occurrences, regardless of time period.
                                                                                                                                              Step 8   Type in an appropriate number of seconds for the Sample Period.
                                                                                                                                              Step 9   Type in the appropriate number of occurrences for the Rising Threshold.

                                                                                                                                              For a rising type of alarm, the measured value must move from below the falling threshold to above the rising threshold. For example, if a network is running below a rising threshold of 1000 collisions every 15 seconds and a problem causes 1001 collisions in 15 seconds, the excess occurrences trigger an alarm.

                                                                                                                                              Step 10   Enter the appropriate number of occurrences in the Falling Threshold field. In most cases a falling threshold is set lower than the rising threshold.

                                                                                                                                              A falling threshold is the counterpart to a rising threshold. When the number of occurrences is above the rising threshold and then drops below a falling threshold, it resets the rising threshold. For example, when the network problem that caused 1001 collisions in 15 seconds subsides and creates only 799 collisions in 15 seconds, occurrences fall below a falling threshold of 800 collisions. This resets the rising threshold so that if network collisions again spike over a 1000 per 15-second period, an event again triggers when the rising threshold is crossed. An event is triggered only the first time a rising threshold is exceeded (otherwise, a single network problem might cause a rising threshold to be exceeded multiple times and cause a flood of events).

                                                                                                                                              Step 11   Click OK.
                                                                                                                                              Note   

                                                                                                                                              To view all RMON thresholds, click Show All RMON thresholds.

                                                                                                                                              Step 12   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                              DLP-G307 Provisioning the 2.5G Data Muxponder Trunk Port Alarm and TCA Thresholds

                                                                                                                                              Purpose

                                                                                                                                              This task changes the MXP_MR_2.5G and MXPP_MR_2.5G trunk port alarm and TCA thresholds.

                                                                                                                                              Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                              None

                                                                                                                                              Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                              DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                              Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                              As needed

                                                                                                                                              Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                              Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                              Security Level

                                                                                                                                              Provisioning or higher


                                                                                                                                              Note


                                                                                                                                              Throughout this task, trunk port refers to Port 9 (MXP_MR_2.5G and MXPP_MR_2.5G) and Port 10 (MXPP_MR_2.5G only).


                                                                                                                                              Procedure
                                                                                                                                                Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the MXP_MR_2.5G or MXPP_MR_2.5G card where you want to change the trunk port alarm and TCA settings.
                                                                                                                                                Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Optics Thresholds tabs.
                                                                                                                                                Note   

                                                                                                                                                You must modify 15 Min and 1 Day independently. To do so, choose the appropriate radio button and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                Step 3   Verify the trunk port TCA thresholds for RX Power High is –9 dBm and for RX Power Low is –23 dBm.
                                                                                                                                                Step 4   Provision new thresholds as needed by double-clicking the threshold value you want to change, deleting it, entering a new value, and hitting Enter.
                                                                                                                                                Step 5   Under Types, click the Alarm radio button and click Refresh.
                                                                                                                                                Note   

                                                                                                                                                Do not modify the Laser Bias parameters.

                                                                                                                                                Step 6   Verify the trunk port Alarm thresholds for RX Power High is –7 dBm and for RX Power Low is –26 dBm.
                                                                                                                                                Step 7   Provision new thresholds as needed by double-clicking the threshold value you want to change, deleting it, entering a new value, and hitting Enter.
                                                                                                                                                Step 8   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                Step 9   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                DLP-G308 Provisioning the 2.5G Data Muxponder Client Port Alarm and TCA Thresholds

                                                                                                                                                Purpose

                                                                                                                                                This task provisions the client port alarm and TCA thresholds for the MXP_MR_2.5G and MXPP_MR_2.5G cards.

                                                                                                                                                Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                None

                                                                                                                                                Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                DLP-G278 Provisioning the Optical Line Rate

                                                                                                                                                DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                Required

                                                                                                                                                Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                Security Level

                                                                                                                                                Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                Procedure
                                                                                                                                                  Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the MXP_MR_2.5G or MXPP_MR_2.5G card where you want to change the client port alarm and TCA settings.
                                                                                                                                                  Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Optics Thresholds tabs. The TCA thresholds are shown by default.
                                                                                                                                                  Step 3   Referring to the following table, verify the client port (Ports 1 through 8) TCA thresholds for RX Power High, RX Power Low, TX Power High, and TX Power Low based on the client interface at the other end. Provision new thresholds as needed by double-clicking the threshold value you want to change, deleting it, entering a new value, and hitting Enter.
                                                                                                                                                  Note   

                                                                                                                                                  Do not modify the Laser Bias parameters.

                                                                                                                                                  Note   

                                                                                                                                                  You must modify 15 Min and 1 Day independently. To do so, choose the appropriate radio button and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                  Note   

                                                                                                                                                  The hardware device that plugs into a TXP, MXP, GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, 10GE_XPE, or ADM-10G card faceplate to provide a fiber interface to the card is called a Small Form-factor Pluggable (SFP or XFP). In CTC, SFPs and XFPs are called pluggable port modules (PPMs). SFPs/XFPs are hot-swappable input/output devices that plug into a port to link the port with the fiber-optic network. Multirate PPMs have provisionable port rates and payloads. For more information about SFPs and XFPs, see the SFP, SFP+, QSFP+, XFP, CXP, CFP, and CPAK Modules.

                                                                                                                                                  Table 126 MXP_MR_2.5G and MXPP_MR_2.5G Card Client Interface TCA Thresholds

                                                                                                                                                  Port Type
(by CTC)

                                                                                                                                                  Pluggable Port Module (XFP)

                                                                                                                                                  TCA RX
Power Low

                                                                                                                                                  TCA RX
Power High

                                                                                                                                                  TCA TX
Power Low

                                                                                                                                                  TCA TX
Power High

                                                                                                                                                  FC1G

                                                                                                                                                  15454-SFP-GEFC-SX
15454E-SFP-GEFC-S
ONS-SE-G2F-SX

                                                                                                                                                  –17

                                                                                                                                                  0

                                                                                                                                                  –16

                                                                                                                                                  3

                                                                                                                                                  15454-SFP-GE+-LX
15454E-SFP-GE+-LX
ONS-SE-G2F-LX

                                                                                                                                                  –20

                                                                                                                                                  –3

                                                                                                                                                  –16

                                                                                                                                                  3

                                                                                                                                                  FC2G

                                                                                                                                                  15454-SFP-GEFC-SX
15454E-SFP-GEFC-S
ONS-SE-G2F-SX

                                                                                                                                                  –15

                                                                                                                                                  0

                                                                                                                                                  –16

                                                                                                                                                  3

                                                                                                                                                  15454-SFP-GE+-LX
15454E-SFP-GE+-LX
ONS-SE-G2F-LX

                                                                                                                                                  –20

                                                                                                                                                  –3

                                                                                                                                                  –16

                                                                                                                                                  3

                                                                                                                                                  FICON1G

                                                                                                                                                  15454-SFP-GEFC-SX
15454E-SFP-GEFC-S
ONS-SE-G2F-SX

                                                                                                                                                  –17

                                                                                                                                                  0

                                                                                                                                                  –16

                                                                                                                                                  3

                                                                                                                                                  15454-SFP-GE+-LX
15454E-SFP-GE+-LX
ONS-SE-G2F-LX

                                                                                                                                                  –20

                                                                                                                                                  –3

                                                                                                                                                  –16

                                                                                                                                                  3

                                                                                                                                                  FICON2G

                                                                                                                                                  15454-SFP-GEFC-SX
15454E-SFP-GEFC-S
ONS-SE-G2F-SX

                                                                                                                                                  –17

                                                                                                                                                  0

                                                                                                                                                  –16

                                                                                                                                                  3

                                                                                                                                                  15454-SFP-GE+-LX
15454E-SFP-GE+-LX
ONS-SE-G2F-LX

                                                                                                                                                  –20

                                                                                                                                                  –3

                                                                                                                                                  –16

                                                                                                                                                  3

                                                                                                                                                  ONE_GE

                                                                                                                                                  15454-SFP-GEFC-SX
15454E-SFP-GEFC-S
ONS-SE-G2F-SX

                                                                                                                                                  –17

                                                                                                                                                  0

                                                                                                                                                  –16

                                                                                                                                                  3

                                                                                                                                                  15454-SFP-GE+-LX
15454E-SFP-GE+-LX
ONS-SE-G2F-LX

                                                                                                                                                  –20

                                                                                                                                                  –3

                                                                                                                                                  –16

                                                                                                                                                  3

                                                                                                                                                  ESCON

                                                                                                                                                  ONS-SE-200-MM

                                                                                                                                                  –21

                                                                                                                                                  –14

                                                                                                                                                  –32

                                                                                                                                                  –11

                                                                                                                                                  Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                  Step 5   Repeat Steps 3 and 4 to provision each additional client port.
                                                                                                                                                  Step 6   Under Types, click the Alarm radio button and click Refresh.
                                                                                                                                                  Step 7   Referring to the following table, verify the client port (Ports 1 through 8) Alarm thresholds for RX Power High, RX Power Low, TX Power High, and TX Power Low based on the client interface that is provisioned. Provision new thresholds as needed by double-clicking the threshold value you want to change, deleting it, entering a new value, and hitting Enter.
                                                                                                                                                  Table 127 MXP_MR_2.5G and MXPP_MR_2.5G Card Client Interface Alarm Thresholds

                                                                                                                                                  Port Type
(by CTC)

                                                                                                                                                  Pluggable Port Module (XFP)

                                                                                                                                                  Alarm RX
Power Low

                                                                                                                                                  Alarm RX
Power High

                                                                                                                                                  Alarm TX
Power Low

                                                                                                                                                  Alarm TX
Power High

                                                                                                                                                  FC1G

                                                                                                                                                  15454-SFP-GEFC-SX
15454E-SFP-GEFC-S
ONS-SE-G2F-SX

                                                                                                                                                  –20

                                                                                                                                                  3

                                                                                                                                                  –13

                                                                                                                                                  –1

                                                                                                                                                  15454-SFP-GE+-LX
15454E-SFP-GE+-LX
ONS-SE-G2F-LX

                                                                                                                                                  –23

                                                                                                                                                  0

                                                                                                                                                  –13

                                                                                                                                                  0

                                                                                                                                                  FC2G

                                                                                                                                                  15454-SFP-GEFC-SX
15454E-SFP-GEFC-S
ONS-SE-G2F-SX

                                                                                                                                                  –18

                                                                                                                                                  3

                                                                                                                                                  –13

                                                                                                                                                  –1

                                                                                                                                                  15454-SFP-GE+-LX
15454E-SFP-GE+-LX
ONS-SE-G2F-LX

                                                                                                                                                  –23

                                                                                                                                                  0

                                                                                                                                                  –13

                                                                                                                                                  0

                                                                                                                                                  FICON1G

                                                                                                                                                  15454-SFP-GEFC-SX
15454E-SFP-GEFC-S
ONS-SE-G2F-SX

                                                                                                                                                  –20

                                                                                                                                                  3

                                                                                                                                                  –13

                                                                                                                                                  –1

                                                                                                                                                  15454-SFP-GE+-LX
15454E-SFP-GE+-LX
ONS-SE-G2F-LX

                                                                                                                                                  –23

                                                                                                                                                  0

                                                                                                                                                  –13

                                                                                                                                                  0

                                                                                                                                                  FICON2G

                                                                                                                                                  15454-SFP-GEFC-SX
15454E-SFP-GEFC-S
ONS-SE-G2F-SX

                                                                                                                                                  –20

                                                                                                                                                  3

                                                                                                                                                  –13

                                                                                                                                                  –1

                                                                                                                                                  15454-SFP-GE+-LX
15454E-SFP-GE+-LX
ONS-SE-G2F-LX

                                                                                                                                                  –23

                                                                                                                                                  0

                                                                                                                                                  –13

                                                                                                                                                  0

                                                                                                                                                  ONE_GE

                                                                                                                                                  15454-SFP-GEFC-SX
15454E-SFP-GEFC-S
ONS-SE-G2F-SX

                                                                                                                                                  –20

                                                                                                                                                  3

                                                                                                                                                  –13

                                                                                                                                                  –1

                                                                                                                                                  15454-SFP-GE+-LX
15454E-SFP-GE+-LX
ONS-SE-G2F-LX

                                                                                                                                                  –23

                                                                                                                                                  0

                                                                                                                                                  –13

                                                                                                                                                  0

                                                                                                                                                  ESCON

                                                                                                                                                  ONS-SE-200-MM

                                                                                                                                                  –24

                                                                                                                                                  –11

                                                                                                                                                  –35

                                                                                                                                                  –8

                                                                                                                                                  Step 8   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                  Step 9   Repeat Steps 7 and 8 to provision each additional client port.
                                                                                                                                                  Step 10   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                  NTP-G148 Modifying the 10G Data Muxponder Card Line Settings and PM Parameter Thresholds

                                                                                                                                                  Purpose

                                                                                                                                                  This procedure changes the line and threshold settings for the MXP_MR_10DME_C, MXP_MR_10DME_L, and MXP_MR_10DMEX_C muxponder cards.

                                                                                                                                                  Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                  None

                                                                                                                                                  Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                  Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                  As needed

                                                                                                                                                  Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                  Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                  Security Level

                                                                                                                                                  Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                  Procedure
                                                                                                                                                    Step 1   As needed, complete the NTP-G103 Backing Up the Database task to preserve the existing transmission settings.
                                                                                                                                                    Step 2   Perform any of the following tasks as needed:
                                                                                                                                                    Note   

                                                                                                                                                    To use the Alarm Profiles tab, including creating alarm profiles and suppressing alarms, see the Alarm and TCA Monitoring and Management document.

                                                                                                                                                    Stop. You have completed this procedure.

                                                                                                                                                    DLP-G334 Changing the 10G Data Muxponder Distance Extension Settings

                                                                                                                                                    Purpose

                                                                                                                                                    This task changes the distance extension settings for the MXP_MR_10DME_C, MXP_MR_10DME_L, and MXP_MR_10DMEX_C muxponder card ports provisioned for Fibre Channel or FICON payloads.

                                                                                                                                                    Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                    None

                                                                                                                                                    Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                    DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                    Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                    As needed

                                                                                                                                                    Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                    Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                    Security Level

                                                                                                                                                    Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                    Procedure
                                                                                                                                                      Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the MXP_MR_10DME_C, MXP_MR_10DME_L, or MXP_MR_10DMEX_C card where you want to change the distance extension settings.
                                                                                                                                                      Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line > Distance Extension tabs.
                                                                                                                                                      Note   

                                                                                                                                                      The distance extension parameters only apply to client ports (Ports 1 to 8) and not to the trunk port (Port 9).

                                                                                                                                                      Note   

                                                                                                                                                      The client port must be in the OOS,DSBLD (ANSI) or Locked,disabled (ETSI) state in order to change the distance extension settings. If a Y-cable is provisioned on the client port, both the working and protect client ports must be in OOS,DSBLD (ANSI) or Locked,disabled (ETSI) state before you change the distance extension settings.

                                                                                                                                                      Step 3   Modify any of the settings as described in the following table.
                                                                                                                                                      Table 128 MXP_MR_10DME_C, MXP_MR_10DME_L, or MXP_MR_10DMEX_C Card Line Distance Extension Settings

                                                                                                                                                      Parameter

                                                                                                                                                      Description

                                                                                                                                                      Options

                                                                                                                                                      Port

                                                                                                                                                      (Display only) Port number. Up to eight ports might appear based on the number of pluggable port modules that are provisioned.

                                                                                                                                                      Enable Distance Extension

                                                                                                                                                      Allows end-to-end distances of up to 1600 km for FC1G and up to 800 km for FC2G. If Distance Extension is enabled, set the connected Fibre Channel switches to Interop or Open Fabric mode, depending on the Fibre Channel switch. By default, the MXP_MR_10DME_C and MXP_MR_10DME_L card will interoperate with the Cisco MDS storage products.

                                                                                                                                                      Checked or unchecked

                                                                                                                                                      Fast Switch

                                                                                                                                                      If unchecked, the end-to-end fiber channel link is reinitialized every time a Y-cable protection switch occurs. If checked, reinitialization of the link is avoided when a Y-cable protection switch occurs, thus reducing the traffic hit considerably.

                                                                                                                                                      This feature is supported for FC1G, FC2G, FC4G, FICON1G, FICON2G, and FICON4G trunk failures as well as user-initiated Y-cable protection switch such as, Manual, Force, or Lockout. It is recommended that you do not enable the Fast Switch option as the link may not come up after a Y-cable protection switch in certain cases.

                                                                                                                                                      Note   

                                                                                                                                                      This option can be used only if you have unchecked Enable Distance Extension option.

                                                                                                                                                      Checked or unchecked (default)

                                                                                                                                                      Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                      Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                      DLP-G338 Provisioning the 10G Data Muxponder Trunk Port Alarm and TCA Thresholds

                                                                                                                                                      Purpose

                                                                                                                                                      This task changes the MXP_MR_10DME_C and MXP_MR_10DME_L trunk port alarm and TCA thresholds.

                                                                                                                                                      Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                      None

                                                                                                                                                      Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                      DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                      Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                      As needed

                                                                                                                                                      Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                      Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                      Security Level

                                                                                                                                                      Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                      Procedure
                                                                                                                                                        Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the MXP_MR_10DME_C or MXP_MR_10DME_L card where you want to change the trunk port alarm and TCA settings.
                                                                                                                                                        Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Optics Thresholds tabs.
                                                                                                                                                        Note   

                                                                                                                                                        You must modify 15 Min and 1 Day independently. To do so, choose the appropriate radio button and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                        Note   

                                                                                                                                                        Do not modify the Laser Bias parameters.

                                                                                                                                                        Step 3   If TCA is not selected, click TCA and then click Refresh.
                                                                                                                                                        Step 4   Verify the trunk port (Port 9) TCA thresholds are set at the values shown as follows. Provision new thresholds as needed by double-clicking the threshold value you want to change, deleting it, entering a new value, and press Enter.
                                                                                                                                                        • RX Power High: –9 dBm

                                                                                                                                                        • RX Power Low: –18 dBm

                                                                                                                                                        • TX Power High: 9 dBm

                                                                                                                                                        • TX Power Low: 0 dBm

                                                                                                                                                        Step 5   Under Types, click the Alarm radio button and click Refresh.
                                                                                                                                                        Note   

                                                                                                                                                        Do not modify the Laser Bias parameters.

                                                                                                                                                        Step 6   Verify the trunk port (Port 9) Alarm thresholds are set at the values shown as follows. Provision new thresholds as needed by double-clicking the threshold value you want to change, deleting it, entering a new value, and press Enter.
                                                                                                                                                        • RX Power High: –8 dBm

                                                                                                                                                        • RX Power Low: –20 dBm

                                                                                                                                                        • TX Power High: 7 dBm

                                                                                                                                                        • TX Power Low: 3 dBm

                                                                                                                                                        Step 7   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                        Step 8   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                        DLP-G339 Provisioning the 10G Data Muxponder Client Port Alarm and TCA Thresholds

                                                                                                                                                        Purpose

                                                                                                                                                        This task provisions the client port alarm and TCA thresholds for the MXP_MR_10DME_C and MXP_MR_10DME_L cards.

                                                                                                                                                        Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                        None

                                                                                                                                                        Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                        DLP-G278 Provisioning the Optical Line Rate

                                                                                                                                                        DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                        Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                        Required

                                                                                                                                                        Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                        Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                        Security Level

                                                                                                                                                        Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                        Procedure
                                                                                                                                                          Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the MXP_MR_10DME_C and MXP_MR_10DME_L card where you want to change the client port alarm and TCA settings.
                                                                                                                                                          Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Optics Thresholds tabs. The TCA thresholds are shown by default.
                                                                                                                                                          Step 3   Referring to the following table, verify the client ports (Ports 1 through 8) TCA thresholds for RX Power High, RX Power Low, TX Power High, and TX Power Low based on the client interface at the other end. Provision new thresholds as needed by double-clicking the threshold value you want to change, deleting it, entering a new value, and hitting Enter.
                                                                                                                                                          Note   

                                                                                                                                                          Do not modify the Laser Bias parameters.

                                                                                                                                                          Note   

                                                                                                                                                          You must modify 15 Min and 1 Day independently. To do so, choose the appropriate radio button and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                          Note   

                                                                                                                                                          The hardware device that plugs into a TXP, MXP, GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, 10GE_XPE, or ADM-10G card faceplate to provide a fiber interface to the card is called a Small Form-factor Pluggable (SFP or XFP). In CTC, SFPs and XFPs are called pluggable port modules (PPMs). SFPs/XFPs are hot-swappable input/output devices that plug into a port to link the port with the fiber-optic network. Multirate PPMs have provisionable port rates and payloads. For more information about SFPs and XFPs, see the DLP-G278 Provisioning the Optical Line Rate.

                                                                                                                                                          Table 129 MXP_MR_10DME_C and MXP_MR_10DME_L Card Client Interfaces TCA Thresholds

                                                                                                                                                          PPM Port Rate

                                                                                                                                                          Pluggable Port Module 
(XFP)

                                                                                                                                                          TCA RX
Power High

                                                                                                                                                          TCA RX
Power Low

                                                                                                                                                          TCA TX
Power High

                                                                                                                                                          TCA TX
Power Low

                                                                                                                                                          FC1G

                                                                                                                                                          15454-SFP-GEFC-SX
15454E-SFP-GEFC-S
ONS-SE-G2F-SX

                                                                                                                                                          0

                                                                                                                                                          –17

                                                                                                                                                          3

                                                                                                                                                          –16

                                                                                                                                                          15454-SFP-GE+-LX
15454E-SFP-GE+-LX
ONS-SE-G2F-LX

                                                                                                                                                          –3

                                                                                                                                                          –20

                                                                                                                                                          3

                                                                                                                                                          –16

                                                                                                                                                          FC2G

                                                                                                                                                          15454-SFP-GEFC-SX
15454E-SFP-GEFC-S
ONS-SE-G2F-SX

                                                                                                                                                          0

                                                                                                                                                          –15

                                                                                                                                                          3

                                                                                                                                                          –16

                                                                                                                                                          15454-SFP-GE+-LX
15454E-SFP-GE+-LX
ONS-SE-G2F-LX

                                                                                                                                                          –3

                                                                                                                                                          –20

                                                                                                                                                          3

                                                                                                                                                          –16

                                                                                                                                                          FICON1G

                                                                                                                                                          15454-SFP-GEFC-SX
15454E-SFP-GEFC-S
ONS-SE-G2F-SX

                                                                                                                                                          0

                                                                                                                                                          –17

                                                                                                                                                          3

                                                                                                                                                          –16

                                                                                                                                                          15454-SFP-GE+-LX
15454E-SFP-GE+-LX
ONS-SE-G2F-LX

                                                                                                                                                          –3

                                                                                                                                                          –20

                                                                                                                                                          3

                                                                                                                                                          –16

                                                                                                                                                          FICON2G

                                                                                                                                                          15454-SFP-GEFC-SX
15454E-SFP-GEFC-S
ONS-SE-G2F-SX

                                                                                                                                                          0

                                                                                                                                                          –17

                                                                                                                                                          3

                                                                                                                                                          –16

                                                                                                                                                          15454-SFP-GE+-LX
15454E-SFP-GE+-LX
ONS-SE-G2F-LX

                                                                                                                                                          –3

                                                                                                                                                          –20

                                                                                                                                                          3

                                                                                                                                                          –16

                                                                                                                                                          ISC3 PEER 1G

                                                                                                                                                          ISC3 PEER 2G

                                                                                                                                                          ONS-SE-G2F-SX

                                                                                                                                                          0

                                                                                                                                                          –17

                                                                                                                                                          3

                                                                                                                                                          –16

                                                                                                                                                          ONS-SE-G2F-LX

                                                                                                                                                          0

                                                                                                                                                          –20

                                                                                                                                                          3

                                                                                                                                                          –16

                                                                                                                                                          FC4G

                                                                                                                                                          ONS-SE-4G-MM

                                                                                                                                                          0

                                                                                                                                                          –12

                                                                                                                                                          4

                                                                                                                                                          –15

                                                                                                                                                          ONS-SE-4G-SM

                                                                                                                                                          –1

                                                                                                                                                          –15

                                                                                                                                                          4

                                                                                                                                                          –15

                                                                                                                                                          FICON4G

                                                                                                                                                          ONS-SE-4G-MM

                                                                                                                                                          0

                                                                                                                                                          –12

                                                                                                                                                          4

                                                                                                                                                          –15

                                                                                                                                                          ONS-SE-4G-SM

                                                                                                                                                          –1

                                                                                                                                                          –15

                                                                                                                                                          4

                                                                                                                                                          –15

                                                                                                                                                          Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                          Step 5   Repeat Steps 3 and 4 to provision each additional client port.
                                                                                                                                                          Step 6   Under Types, click the Alarm radio button and click Refresh.
                                                                                                                                                          Step 7   Referring to the following table, verify the client port (Ports 1 through 8) Alarm thresholds for RX Power High, RX Power Low, TX Power High, and TX Power Low based on the client interface that is provisioned. Provision new thresholds as needed by double-clicking the threshold value you want to change, deleting it, entering a new value, and hitting Enter.
                                                                                                                                                          Table 130 MXP_MR_10DME_C and MXP_MR_10DME_L Card Client Interface Alarm Thresholds

                                                                                                                                                          PPM Port Rate

                                                                                                                                                          Pluggable Port Module 
(XFP)

                                                                                                                                                          Alarm RX
Power Low

                                                                                                                                                          Alarm RX
Power High

                                                                                                                                                          Alarm TX
Power Low

                                                                                                                                                          Alarm TX
Power High

                                                                                                                                                          FC1G

                                                                                                                                                          15454-SFP-GEFC-SX
15454E-SFP-GEFC-S
ONS-SE-G2F-SX

                                                                                                                                                          –20

                                                                                                                                                          3

                                                                                                                                                          –13

                                                                                                                                                          –1

                                                                                                                                                          15454-SFP-GE+-LX
15454E-SFP-GE+-LX
ONS-SE-G2F-LX

                                                                                                                                                          –23

                                                                                                                                                          0

                                                                                                                                                          –13

                                                                                                                                                          0

                                                                                                                                                          FC2G

                                                                                                                                                          15454-SFP-GEFC-SX
15454E-SFP-GEFC-S
ONS-SE-G2F-SX

                                                                                                                                                          –18

                                                                                                                                                          3

                                                                                                                                                          –13

                                                                                                                                                          –1

                                                                                                                                                          15454-SFP-GE+-LX
15454E-SFP-GE+-LX
ONS-SE-G2F-LX

                                                                                                                                                          –23

                                                                                                                                                          0

                                                                                                                                                          –13

                                                                                                                                                          0

                                                                                                                                                          FICON1G

                                                                                                                                                          15454-SFP-GEFC-SX
15454E-SFP-GEFC-S
ONS-SE-G2F-SX

                                                                                                                                                          –20

                                                                                                                                                          3

                                                                                                                                                          –13

                                                                                                                                                          –1

                                                                                                                                                          15454-SFP-GE+-LX
15454E-SFP-GE+-LX
ONS-SE-G2F-LX

                                                                                                                                                          –23

                                                                                                                                                          0

                                                                                                                                                          –13

                                                                                                                                                          0

                                                                                                                                                          FICON2G

                                                                                                                                                          15454-SFP-GEFC-SX
15454E-SFP-GEFC-S
ONS-SE-G2F-SX

                                                                                                                                                          –20

                                                                                                                                                          3

                                                                                                                                                          –13

                                                                                                                                                          –1

                                                                                                                                                          15454-SFP-GE+-LX
15454E-SFP-GE+-LX
ONS-SE-G2F-LX

                                                                                                                                                          –23

                                                                                                                                                          0

                                                                                                                                                          –13

                                                                                                                                                          0

                                                                                                                                                          ISC3 PEER 1G

                                                                                                                                                          ISC3 PEER 2G

                                                                                                                                                          ONS-SE-G2F-SX

                                                                                                                                                          –20

                                                                                                                                                          3

                                                                                                                                                          –13

                                                                                                                                                          –1

                                                                                                                                                          ONS-SE-G2F-LX

                                                                                                                                                          –23

                                                                                                                                                          0

                                                                                                                                                          –13

                                                                                                                                                          0

                                                                                                                                                          FC4G

                                                                                                                                                          ONS-SE-4G-MM

                                                                                                                                                          –15

                                                                                                                                                          3

                                                                                                                                                          –11

                                                                                                                                                          –1

                                                                                                                                                          ONS-SE-4G-SM

                                                                                                                                                          –18

                                                                                                                                                          2

                                                                                                                                                          –11

                                                                                                                                                          0

                                                                                                                                                          FICON4G

                                                                                                                                                          ONS-SE-4G-MM

                                                                                                                                                          –15

                                                                                                                                                          3

                                                                                                                                                          –11

                                                                                                                                                          –1

                                                                                                                                                          ONS-SE-4G-SM

                                                                                                                                                          –18

                                                                                                                                                          2

                                                                                                                                                          –11

                                                                                                                                                          0

                                                                                                                                                          Step 8   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                          Step 9   Repeat Steps 7 and 8 to provision each additional client port.
                                                                                                                                                          Step 10   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                          DLP-G366 Changing the 10G Data Muxponder OTN Settings

                                                                                                                                                          Purpose

                                                                                                                                                          This task changes the OTN settings for the MXP_MR_10DME_C and MXP_MR_10DME_L cards.

                                                                                                                                                          Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                          None

                                                                                                                                                          Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                          DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                          Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                          As needed

                                                                                                                                                          Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                          Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                          Security Level

                                                                                                                                                          Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                          Procedure
                                                                                                                                                            Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the MXP_MR_10DME_C and MXP_MR_10DME_L card where you want to change the OTN settings.
                                                                                                                                                            Step 2   Click the Provisioning > OTN tabs, then choose one of the following subtabs: OTN Lines, G.709 Thresholds, FEC Thresholds, or Trail Trace Identifier.
                                                                                                                                                            Step 3   Modify any of the settings described in the following tables.
                                                                                                                                                            Note   

                                                                                                                                                            You must modify Near End and Far End; 15 Min and 1 Day; and SM and PM independently. To do so, choose the appropriate radio button and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                            Table 131 MXP_MR_10DME_C and MXP_MR_10DME_L Card OTN Line Settings

                                                                                                                                                            Parameter

                                                                                                                                                            Description

                                                                                                                                                            Options

                                                                                                                                                            Port

                                                                                                                                                            (Display only) Displays the port number.

                                                                                                                                                            9 (Trunk)

                                                                                                                                                            G.709 OTN

                                                                                                                                                            Sets the OTN lines according to ITU-T G.709.

                                                                                                                                                            • Enable

                                                                                                                                                            • Disable

                                                                                                                                                            FEC

                                                                                                                                                            Sets the OTN lines to forward error correction (FEC).

                                                                                                                                                            • Standard

                                                                                                                                                            • Enhanced

                                                                                                                                                            SF BER

                                                                                                                                                            (Display only) Sets the signal fail bit error rate.

                                                                                                                                                            • 1E-5

                                                                                                                                                            SD BER

                                                                                                                                                            Sets the signal degrade bit error rate.

                                                                                                                                                            • 1E-5

                                                                                                                                                            • 1E-6

                                                                                                                                                            • 1E-7

                                                                                                                                                            • 1E-8

                                                                                                                                                            • 1E-9

                                                                                                                                                            Asynch/Synch Mapping

                                                                                                                                                            Sets how the ODUk (client payload) is mapped to the optical channel (OTUk).

                                                                                                                                                            • Asynch mapping

                                                                                                                                                            • Synch mapping

                                                                                                                                                            Table 132 MXP_MR_10DME_C and MXP_MR_10DME_L Card ITU-T G.709 Threshold Settings

                                                                                                                                                            Parameter

                                                                                                                                                            Description

                                                                                                                                                            Options

                                                                                                                                                            Port

                                                                                                                                                            (Display only) Port number.

                                                                                                                                                            9 (Trunk)

                                                                                                                                                            ES

                                                                                                                                                            Errored seconds

                                                                                                                                                            Numeric. Can be set for Near End or Far End, for 15-minute or one-day intervals, or for SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk). Select a bullet and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                            SES

                                                                                                                                                            Severely errored seconds

                                                                                                                                                            Numeric. Can be set for Near End or Far End, for 15-minute or one-day intervals, or for SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk). Select a bullet and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                            UAS

                                                                                                                                                            Unavailable seconds

                                                                                                                                                            Numeric. Can be set for Near End or Far End, for 15-minute or one-day intervals, or for SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk). Select a bullet and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                            BBE

                                                                                                                                                            Background block errors

                                                                                                                                                            Numeric. Can be set for Near End or Far End, for 15-minute or one-day intervals, or for SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk). Select a bullet and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                            FC

                                                                                                                                                            Failure counter

                                                                                                                                                            Numeric. Can be set for Near End or Far End, for 15-minute or one-day intervals, or for SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk). Select a bullet and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                            Latency for a 1G-FC payload without ITU-T G.709 is 4 microseconds, and with ITU-T G.709 is 40 microseconds. Latency for a 2G-FC payload without ITU-T G.709 is 2 microseconds, and with ITU-T G.709 is 20 microseconds. Consider these values when planning a FC network that is sensitive to latency.

                                                                                                                                                            Table 133 MXP_MR_10DME_C and MXP_MR_10DME_L Card FEC Threshold Settings

                                                                                                                                                            Parameter

                                                                                                                                                            Description

                                                                                                                                                            Options

                                                                                                                                                            Port

                                                                                                                                                            (Display only) Port number.

                                                                                                                                                            2

                                                                                                                                                            Bit Errors Corrected

                                                                                                                                                            Sets the value for bit errors corrected.

                                                                                                                                                            Numeric. Can be set for 15-minute or one-day intervals.

                                                                                                                                                            Uncorrectable Words

                                                                                                                                                            Sets the value for uncorrectable words.

                                                                                                                                                            Numeric. Can be set for 15-minute or one-day intervals.

                                                                                                                                                            Table 134 MXP_MR_10DME_C and MXP_MR_10DME_L Card Trail Trace Identifier Settings

                                                                                                                                                            Parameter

                                                                                                                                                            Description

                                                                                                                                                            Options

                                                                                                                                                            Port

                                                                                                                                                            (Display only) Port number.

                                                                                                                                                            2

                                                                                                                                                            Level

                                                                                                                                                            Sets the level.

                                                                                                                                                            • Section

                                                                                                                                                            • Path

                                                                                                                                                            Received Trace Mode

                                                                                                                                                            Sets the trace mode.

                                                                                                                                                            • Off/None

                                                                                                                                                            • Manual

                                                                                                                                                            Transmit

                                                                                                                                                            Displays the current transmit string; sets a new transmit string. You can click the button on the right to change the display. Its title changes, based on the current display mode. Click Hex to change the display to hexadecimal (button changes to ASCII); click ASCII to change the display to ASCII (button changes to Hex).

                                                                                                                                                            String of trace string size

                                                                                                                                                            Disable FDI on TTIM

                                                                                                                                                            If a Trace Identifier Mismatch on Section overhead alarm arises because of a J0 overhead string mismatch, no Forward Defect Indication (FDI) signal is sent to the downstream nodes if this box is checked.

                                                                                                                                                            • Checked (FDI on TTIM is disabled)

                                                                                                                                                            • Unchecked (FDI on TTIM is not disabled)

                                                                                                                                                            Expected

                                                                                                                                                            Displays the current expected string; sets a new expected string. You can click the button on the right to change the display. Its title changes, based on the current display mode. Click Hex to change the display to hexadecimal (button changes to ASCII); click ASCII to change the display to ASCII (button changes to Hex).

                                                                                                                                                            String of trace string size

                                                                                                                                                            Received

                                                                                                                                                            (Display only) Displays the current received string. You can click Refresh to manually refresh this display, or check the Auto-refresh every 5 sec check box to keep this panel updated.

                                                                                                                                                            String of trace string size

                                                                                                                                                            Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                            Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                            NTP-G293 Modifying the 40G Muxponder Card Line Settings and PM Parameter Thresholds

                                                                                                                                                            Purpose

                                                                                                                                                            This procedure changes the line and parameter threshold settings of the 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C muxponder cards.

                                                                                                                                                            Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                            None

                                                                                                                                                            Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                            Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                            As needed

                                                                                                                                                            Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                            Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                            Security Level

                                                                                                                                                            Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                            Procedure
                                                                                                                                                              Step 1   Complete the NTP-G103 Backing Up the Database task to save the existing settings before modifying.
                                                                                                                                                              Step 2   Perform any of the following tasks as needed:
                                                                                                                                                              Note   

                                                                                                                                                              To use the Alarm Profiles tab, including creating alarm profiles and suppressing alarms, see the Alarm and TCA Monitoring and Management document.

                                                                                                                                                              Stop. You have completed this procedure.

                                                                                                                                                              DLP-G662 Changing the 40G Multirate Muxponder Card Settings

                                                                                                                                                              Purpose

                                                                                                                                                              This task changes the card settings of the 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C cards.

                                                                                                                                                              Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                              None

                                                                                                                                                              Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                              DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                              Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                              As needed

                                                                                                                                                              Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                              Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                              Security Level

                                                                                                                                                              Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                              Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the 40G-MXP-C, or 40E-MXP-C card where you want to change the card settings.
                                                                                                                                                                Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Card tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                Step 3   Modify either of the settings described in the following table.
                                                                                                                                                                Table 135 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C Card Settings

                                                                                                                                                                Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                Description

                                                                                                                                                                ANSI Options

                                                                                                                                                                ETSI Options

                                                                                                                                                                Card Mode

                                                                                                                                                                Sets the card mode.

                                                                                                                                                                • Muxponder

                                                                                                                                                                • Unidirectional Regen
Set the mode to Unidirectional Regen under the following conditions:

                                                                                                                                                                  • Trunk port is in OOS,DSBLD state.

                                                                                                                                                                  • Pluggable port modules of the card must not be configured for payload.

                                                                                                                                                                  • Regeneration peer slot must be set to None.

                                                                                                                                                                • Muxponder

                                                                                                                                                                • Unidirectional Regen
Set the mode to Unidirectional Regen under the following conditions:

                                                                                                                                                                  • Trunk port is in locked,disabled state.

                                                                                                                                                                  • Pluggable port modules of the card must not be configured for payload.

                                                                                                                                                                  • Regeneration peer slot must be set to None.

                                                                                                                                                                Timing Source

                                                                                                                                                                Sets the clock selection. The line card sets the clock switch based on the provisioning of the card. The clock can be set in two ways: Internal Clock and TNC Clock.

                                                                                                                                                                • Internal Clock: This is the default value for normal operations; to avoid the traffic hits in case of missing TNC.
                                                                                                                                                                • TNC Clock: This is the default value to avoid traffic hit during maintenance activities like software download. After the maintenance activity is complete, the clock must be set to use the internal clock.
                                                                                                                                                                Note    A warning message is displayed when the provisioning is set because this activity affects traffic.

                                                                                                                                                                Trunk Wavelengths

                                                                                                                                                                (Display only) Shows supported wavelengths of the trunk port after the card is installed. The 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C card that is installed shows the C-band wavelengths that it supports.

                                                                                                                                                                Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                DLP-G666 Changing the 40G Muxponder Line Settings

                                                                                                                                                                Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                This task changes the line settings of the 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C muxponder cards.

                                                                                                                                                                Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                None

                                                                                                                                                                Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                As needed

                                                                                                                                                                Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                  Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the 40G-MXP-C or 40E-MXP-C card where you want to change the line settings.
                                                                                                                                                                  Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line > Ports tabs. Tabs and parameters vary according to the PPM provisioning.
                                                                                                                                                                  Step 3   Modify any of the settings as described in the following table.
                                                                                                                                                                  Table 136 Line Settings of the 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C Cards

                                                                                                                                                                  Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                  Description

                                                                                                                                                                  Options

                                                                                                                                                                  Port

                                                                                                                                                                  (Display only) Displays the port number.

                                                                                                                                                                  • 1 through 4 (client)

                                                                                                                                                                  • 5 (trunk)

                                                                                                                                                                  Port Name

                                                                                                                                                                  Assigns a logical name for each of the port.

                                                                                                                                                                  User-defined. This can be up to 80 alphanumeric or special characters, or both. The port name is blank by default.

                                                                                                                                                                  Note   

                                                                                                                                                                  You can assign a port name for each fiber channel/FICON interface on the 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C card, enabling the MDS Fabric Manager to associate the SAN port and a SAN port on the Cisco MDS 9000 switch.

                                                                                                                                                                  Admin State

                                                                                                                                                                  Sets the port service state unless network conditions prevent the change. For more information, see the Administrative and Service States document.

                                                                                                                                                                  • IS (ANSI) or Unlocked (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                  • OOS,DSBLD (ANSI) or Locked,disabled (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                  • OOS,MT (ANSI) or Locked,maintenance (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                  • IS,AINS (ANSI) or Unlocked,automaticInService (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                  Service State

                                                                                                                                                                  (Display only) Shows the general condition of the port. Service states appear in the format: Primary State-Primary State Qualifier, Secondary State. For more information about service states, see the Administrative and Service States document.

                                                                                                                                                                  • IS-NR (ANSI) or Unlocked-enabled (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                  • OOS-AU,AINS (ANSI) or Unlocked-disabled,
automaticInService (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                  • OOS-MA,DSBLD (ANSI) or Locked-enabled,disabled (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                  • OOS-MA,MT (ANSI) or Locked-enabled,maintenance (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                  ALS Mode

                                                                                                                                                                  (Client ports only) Activates the ALS mode.

                                                                                                                                                                  • Disabled (default)—ALS is off; the laser is not automatically shut down when traffic outage or loss of signal (LOS) occurs.

                                                                                                                                                                  • Auto Restart—(OC-192/STM-64 only) ALS is on; the laser automatically shuts down during LOS. It automatically restarts when the conditions that caused the outage are resolved.

                                                                                                                                                                  • Manual Restart—ALS is on; the laser automatically shuts down when traffic outage or LOS occurs. However, the laser must be manually restarted when conditions that caused the outage are resolved.

                                                                                                                                                                  • Manual Restart for Test—Manually restarts the laser for testing.

                                                                                                                                                                  AINS Soak

                                                                                                                                                                  Sets the automatic in-service soak period. Double-click the time and use the up and down arrows to the change settings.

                                                                                                                                                                  • Duration of valid input signal, in hh.mm format, after which the card status changes to in service (IS) automatically

                                                                                                                                                                  • 0 to 48 hours, 15-minute increments

                                                                                                                                                                  Reach

                                                                                                                                                                  Sets the optical reach distance of the client port.

                                                                                                                                                                  • Autoprovision—The system automatically provisions the reach from the pluggable port module (PPM) reach value on the hardware.

                                                                                                                                                                  • EW

                                                                                                                                                                  • LW

                                                                                                                                                                  • SW

                                                                                                                                                                  • LRM

                                                                                                                                                                  • ER

                                                                                                                                                                  • LR

                                                                                                                                                                  • SR

                                                                                                                                                                  • ZR

                                                                                                                                                                  • IR 2

                                                                                                                                                                  • LR 2

                                                                                                                                                                  • DWDM

                                                                                                                                                                  • CWDM40km

                                                                                                                                                                  Wavelength

                                                                                                                                                                  Provisions the port wavelength.

                                                                                                                                                                  • First Tunable Wavelength

                                                                                                                                                                  • Further wavelengths:
Further wavelengths in the 100-GHz ITU-T C-band spacing. The card wavelengths are marked by asterisks. If the card is not installed, all wavelengths appear with a dark grey background.

                                                                                                                                                                  Fault Signalling

                                                                                                                                                                  Shuts down the far-end laser in response to certain defects.

                                                                                                                                                                  • Squelch/Laser-Off

                                                                                                                                                                    Note   

                                                                                                                                                                    Squelch does not apply to ISC COMPACT payloads.

                                                                                                                                                                  • Disable/Transparent

                                                                                                                                                                    Note   

                                                                                                                                                                    Both Squelch/Laser-Off and AIS/Send Local Fault options are supported when the selected Termination Mode is Disable/Transparent. If the Termination Mode selected is Section or Line, then only AIS is supported. This is applicable for OC-192/STM-64 and OC-768/STM-256.
For OTN payloads, both Squelch/Laser-Off and AIS/Send Local Fault options are supported.

                                                                                                                                                                  Overclock

                                                                                                                                                                  (Trunk port only) Enables or disables overclock mode on the trunk port.

                                                                                                                                                                  • OFF (default)

                                                                                                                                                                  • ON

                                                                                                                                                                    Note   

                                                                                                                                                                    Before the overclock is changed, delete any existing 10G Ethernet LAN-Phy payload that is present on the 40E-MXP-C and 40ME-MXP-C cards.

                                                                                                                                                                  Rx Wavelength

                                                                                                                                                                  (Trunk port only) Provisions the trunk port wavelength.

                                                                                                                                                                  • First Tunable Wavelength

                                                                                                                                                                  • Further wavelengths:
Further wavelengths in the 100-GHz ITU-T C-band spacing. The card wavelengths are marked by asterisks. If the card is not installed, all wavelengths appear with a dark grey background.

                                                                                                                                                                  Squelch Hold Off Timer

                                                                                                                                                                  (Only for 40E-MXP-C card) Sets the period in milliseconds that the client interface waits for resolution of issues on the trunk side. The client squelching starts after this period.

                                                                                                                                                                  The user can configure the squelch hold off timer in CTC only under the following conditions:

                                                                                                                                                                  • The card must be configured in TXP or MXP operating modes.

                                                                                                                                                                  • The client payload must be 10GE or 100GE.

                                                                                                                                                                  • The Squelch drop-down in CTC must be set to Squelch.

                                                                                                                                                                  • Disable (0 ms) - Default value

                                                                                                                                                                  • 50 ms

                                                                                                                                                                  • 100 ms

                                                                                                                                                                  • 250 ms

                                                                                                                                                                  • 500 ms

                                                                                                                                                                  Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                  Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                  DLP-G735 Provisioning the 40G Muxponder Ethernet Settings

                                                                                                                                                                  Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                  This task changes the Ethernet settings for the 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C cards.

                                                                                                                                                                  Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                  None

                                                                                                                                                                  Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                  DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                  Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                  As needed

                                                                                                                                                                  Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                  Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                  Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                  Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                  Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                    Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the 40G Muxponder card (40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, or 40ME-MXP-C card) where you want to change the Ethernet settings. The card view appears.
                                                                                                                                                                    Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line > Ethernet tabs. The Ethernet tab is available once the 10G Ethernet LAN Phy payload is selected as the port rate for the pluggable port module.
                                                                                                                                                                    Step 3   Modify any of the settings for the Ethernet tab as described in the following table.
                                                                                                                                                                    Table 137 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C Card Ethernet Settings

                                                                                                                                                                    Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                    Description

                                                                                                                                                                    Options

                                                                                                                                                                    Port

                                                                                                                                                                    (Display only) The Port number (n-n) and rate.

                                                                                                                                                                    Port Name

                                                                                                                                                                    Allows you to enter a port name.

                                                                                                                                                                    MTU

                                                                                                                                                                    (Display only) The maximum size of the Ethernet frames accepted by the port.

                                                                                                                                                                    Jumbo: 64 to 9216 bytes (Default)

                                                                                                                                                                    Mapping Mode

                                                                                                                                                                    Sets the Ethernet mapping mode.

                                                                                                                                                                    • GFP

                                                                                                                                                                    • WIS

                                                                                                                                                                    • CBR (only for 40E-MXP-C and 40ME-MXP-C)

                                                                                                                                                                      Note   

                                                                                                                                                                      CBR is automatically mapped when a 10G Ethernet LAN Phy payload is configured with overclock on the trunk port turned ON. This mapping cannot be changed.

                                                                                                                                                                    Enable Flow Control

                                                                                                                                                                    Activates flow control when the check box is selected.

                                                                                                                                                                    Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                    Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                    DLP-G667 Changing the 40G Muxponder SONET (OC-192)/SDH (STM-64) Settings

                                                                                                                                                                    Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                    This task changes the SONET OC-192 or SDH STM-64 settings for the 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C muxponder cards.

                                                                                                                                                                    Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                    None

                                                                                                                                                                    Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                    DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                    Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                    As needed

                                                                                                                                                                    Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                    Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                    Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                    Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                    Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                      Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the 40G-MXP-C, or 40E-MXP-C card where you want to change the SONET (OC-192) or SDH (STM-64) settings.
                                                                                                                                                                      Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line > SONET (ANSI) or SDH (ETSI). Tabs and parameters vary according to the PPM provisioning.
                                                                                                                                                                      Step 3   Modify any of the settings described in the following table.
                                                                                                                                                                      Table 138 Line SONET or SDH Settings of the 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C Cards

                                                                                                                                                                      Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                      Description

                                                                                                                                                                      Options

                                                                                                                                                                      Port

                                                                                                                                                                      (Display only) Displays the port number.

                                                                                                                                                                      5 (Trunk)

                                                                                                                                                                      Port Name

                                                                                                                                                                      Assigns a logical name assigned to a port. This field is blank by default.

                                                                                                                                                                      User-defined. This can be up to 80 alphanumeric or special characters, or both. The port name is blank by default.

                                                                                                                                                                      SF BER

                                                                                                                                                                      Sets the signal fail bit error rate.

                                                                                                                                                                      • 1E-3

                                                                                                                                                                      • 1E-4

                                                                                                                                                                      • 1E-5

                                                                                                                                                                      SD BER

                                                                                                                                                                      Sets the signal degrade bit error rate.

                                                                                                                                                                      • 1E-5

                                                                                                                                                                      • 1E-6

                                                                                                                                                                      • 1E-7

                                                                                                                                                                      • 1E-8

                                                                                                                                                                      • 1E-9

                                                                                                                                                                      ProvidesSync

                                                                                                                                                                      (Display only) Displays the ProvidesSync card parameter state.

                                                                                                                                                                      Checked or unchecked

                                                                                                                                                                      SyncMsgIn

                                                                                                                                                                      Sets the EnableSync card parameter. Enables synchronization status messages (S1 byte), which allow the node to choose the best timing source.

                                                                                                                                                                      Checked or unchecked

                                                                                                                                                                      Send DoNotUse

                                                                                                                                                                      Sets the Send DoNotUse card state. When checked, sends a DUS (do not use) message on the S1 byte.

                                                                                                                                                                      Checked or unchecked

                                                                                                                                                                      Type

                                                                                                                                                                      Indicates the optical transport type.

                                                                                                                                                                      • SONET (ANSI)

                                                                                                                                                                      • SDH (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                      Termination Mode

                                                                                                                                                                      (Display-only for Standard Regeneration and Enhanced FEC card configurations) Sets the mode of operation.

                                                                                                                                                                      • Transparent

                                                                                                                                                                      • Section (ANSI) or Regeneration Section (RS) (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                      • Line (ANSI) or Multiplex Section (MS) (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                      Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                      Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                      DLP-G668 Changing the 40G Muxponder Section Trace Settings

                                                                                                                                                                      Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                      This task changes the section trace settings of the 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C muxponder cards.

                                                                                                                                                                      Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                      None

                                                                                                                                                                      Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                      DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                      Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                      As needed

                                                                                                                                                                      Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                      Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                      Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                      Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                      Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                        Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the 40G-MXP-C, or 40E-MXP-C card where you want to change the section trace settings.
                                                                                                                                                                        Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line > Section Trace tabs. Tabs and parameter selections vary according to the PPM provisioning.
                                                                                                                                                                        Step 3   Modify any of the settings described in the following table.
                                                                                                                                                                        Table 139 Line Section Trace Settings of the 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C Cards

                                                                                                                                                                        Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                        Description

                                                                                                                                                                        Options

                                                                                                                                                                        Port

                                                                                                                                                                        (Display only) Displays the port number that is applicable only for OC-192/STM-64 payloads.

                                                                                                                                                                        • 1-1

                                                                                                                                                                        • 2-1

                                                                                                                                                                        • 3-1

                                                                                                                                                                        • 4-1

                                                                                                                                                                        Received Trace Mode

                                                                                                                                                                        Sets the trace mode.

                                                                                                                                                                        • Off/None

                                                                                                                                                                        • Manual

                                                                                                                                                                        Disable AIS/RDI on TIM-S

                                                                                                                                                                        Disables the alarm indication signal.

                                                                                                                                                                        • Checked (AIS/RDI on TIM-S is disabled)

                                                                                                                                                                        • Unchecked (AIS/RDI on TIM-S is not disabled)

                                                                                                                                                                        Transmit Section Trace String Size

                                                                                                                                                                        Sets the trace string size.

                                                                                                                                                                        • 1 byte

                                                                                                                                                                        • 16 byte

                                                                                                                                                                        Transmit

                                                                                                                                                                        Displays and sets the current transmit string.
You can click the button on the right to change the display. Its title changes, based on the current display mode. In Transmit String Type, click Hex Mode to change the display to hexadecimal (button changes to ASCII); click ASCII to change the display to ASCII (button changes to Hex Mode). The supported range for 1 bit Hex TX trace is 20 to 7E. If TX trace is provisioned outside this range, client transmits 00.

                                                                                                                                                                        Transmit string size

                                                                                                                                                                        Expected

                                                                                                                                                                        Displays and sets the current expected string.
You can click the button on the right to change the display. Its title changes, based on the current display mode. In Expected String Type, click Hex Mode to change the display to hexadecimal (button changes to ASCII); click ASCII to change the display to ASCII (button changes to Hex Mode). The supported range for 1 bit Hex TX trace is 20 to 7E. If TX trace is provisioned outside this range, client transmits 00.

                                                                                                                                                                        Expected string size

                                                                                                                                                                        Received

                                                                                                                                                                        (Display only) Displays the current received string. Click Refresh to manually refresh this display, or check the Auto-refresh every 5 sec check box to keep this panel updated.

                                                                                                                                                                        Received string size

                                                                                                                                                                        Auto-refresh

                                                                                                                                                                        Automatically refreshes the display every 5 seconds.

                                                                                                                                                                        • Checked

                                                                                                                                                                        • Unchecked (default)

                                                                                                                                                                        Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                        Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                        DLP-G691 Changing the 40G Muxponder OTU Settings

                                                                                                                                                                        Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                        This task changes the OTU settings of the 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C muxponder cards.

                                                                                                                                                                        Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                        None

                                                                                                                                                                        Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                        DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                        Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                        As needed

                                                                                                                                                                        Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                        Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                        Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                        Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                        Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                          Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the 40G-MXP-C, or 40E-MXP-C card where you want to change the OTU settings.
                                                                                                                                                                          Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line > OTU tabs. Tabs and parameter selections vary according to the PPM provisioning.
                                                                                                                                                                          Step 3   Modify any of the settings described in the following table.
                                                                                                                                                                          Table 140 OTU Settings of the 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C Cards

                                                                                                                                                                          Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                          Description

                                                                                                                                                                          ANSI Options

                                                                                                                                                                          ETSI Options

                                                                                                                                                                          Port

                                                                                                                                                                          (Display only) Displays the port number that is applicable only for OC-192/STM-64 payloads.

                                                                                                                                                                          • 1-1

                                                                                                                                                                          • 2-1

                                                                                                                                                                          • 3-1

                                                                                                                                                                          • 4-1

                                                                                                                                                                          • 1-1

                                                                                                                                                                          • 2-1

                                                                                                                                                                          • 3-1

                                                                                                                                                                          • 4-1

                                                                                                                                                                          SyncMsgIn

                                                                                                                                                                          (Display only) (OC-768/STM-256 only) Sets the EnableSync card parameter. Enables synchronization status messages (S1 byte), which allow the node to choose the best timing source.

                                                                                                                                                                          Checked or unchecked

                                                                                                                                                                          Checked or unchecked

                                                                                                                                                                          Admin SSM

                                                                                                                                                                          Overrides the synchronization status message (SSM) and the synchronization traceability unknown (STU) value. If the node does not receive an SSM signal, it defaults to STU.

                                                                                                                                                                          • PRS—Primary Reference Source (Stratum 1)

                                                                                                                                                                          • STU—Sync traceability unknown

                                                                                                                                                                          • ST2—Stratum 2

                                                                                                                                                                          • ST3—Stratum 3

                                                                                                                                                                          • SMC—SONET minimum clock

                                                                                                                                                                          • ST4—Stratum 4

                                                                                                                                                                          • DUS—Do not use for timing synchronization

                                                                                                                                                                          • RES—Reserved; quality level set by user

                                                                                                                                                                          • G811—Primary reference clock

                                                                                                                                                                          • STU—Sync traceability unknown

                                                                                                                                                                          • G812T—Transit node clock traceable

                                                                                                                                                                          • G812L—Local node clock traceable

                                                                                                                                                                          • SETS—Synchronous equipment

                                                                                                                                                                          • DUS—Do not use for timing synchronization

                                                                                                                                                                          ProvidesSync

                                                                                                                                                                          (Display only) (OC-768/STM-256 only) Sets the ProvidesSync card parameter. If checked, the card is provisioned as a network element (NE) timing reference.

                                                                                                                                                                          Checked or unchecked

                                                                                                                                                                          Checked or unchecked

                                                                                                                                                                          Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                          Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                          DLP-G669 Changing the 40G Muxponder SONET or SDH Line Thresholds

                                                                                                                                                                          Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                          This task changes the SONET or SDH line threshold settings of the 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C muxponder cards.

                                                                                                                                                                          Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                          None

                                                                                                                                                                          Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                          DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                          Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                          As needed

                                                                                                                                                                          Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                          Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                          Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                          Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                          Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                            Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the 40G-MXP-C, or 40E-MXP-C card where you want to change the line threshold settings.
                                                                                                                                                                            Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line Thresholds > SONET Thresholds (ANSI) or SDH Thresholds (ETSI) tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                            Step 3   Modify any of the settings shown in the following table. Some parameters and options do not apply to all 40-G-MXP-C cards. If the parameter or options do not apply, they do not appear in CTC.
                                                                                                                                                                            Table 141 Line Threshold Settings of the 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C Cards

                                                                                                                                                                            Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                            Description

                                                                                                                                                                            ANSI Options

                                                                                                                                                                            ETSI Options

                                                                                                                                                                            Port

                                                                                                                                                                            (Display only) Port number.
Applicable for only OC-192/STM-64 payloads.

                                                                                                                                                                            • 1-1

                                                                                                                                                                            • 2-1

                                                                                                                                                                            • 3-1

                                                                                                                                                                            • 4-1

                                                                                                                                                                            • 1-1

                                                                                                                                                                            • 2-1

                                                                                                                                                                            • 3-1

                                                                                                                                                                            • 4-1

                                                                                                                                                                            CV

                                                                                                                                                                            Coding violations

                                                                                                                                                                            Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                                                                            • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                                                                            • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                                                                            • Types—Line or Section (near end only)

                                                                                                                                                                            Choose an option individually in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                            ES

                                                                                                                                                                            Errored seconds

                                                                                                                                                                            Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                                                                            • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                                                                            • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                                                                            • Types—Line or Section (near end only)

                                                                                                                                                                            Choose an option individually in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                            Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                                                                            • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                                                                            • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                                                                            • Types—Multiplex Section or Regeneration Section (near end only)

                                                                                                                                                                            Choose an option individually in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                            SES

                                                                                                                                                                            Severely errored seconds

                                                                                                                                                                            Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                                                                            • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                                                                            • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                                                                            • Types—Line or Section (near end only)

                                                                                                                                                                            Choose an option individually in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                            Click Reset to Default to restore default values.

                                                                                                                                                                            Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                                                                            • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                                                                            • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                                                                            • Types—Multiplex Section or Regeneration Section (near end only)

                                                                                                                                                                            Choose an option individually in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                            Click Reset to Default to restore default values.

                                                                                                                                                                            FC

                                                                                                                                                                            (Line or Multiplex Section only) Failure count

                                                                                                                                                                            Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                                                                            • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                                                                            • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                                                                            • Types—Line or Section (near end only)

                                                                                                                                                                            Choose an option individually in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                            Click Reset to Default to restore default values.

                                                                                                                                                                            UAS

                                                                                                                                                                            (Line or Multiplex Section only) Unavailable seconds

                                                                                                                                                                            Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                                                                            • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                                                                            • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                                                                            • Types—Line or Section (near end only)

                                                                                                                                                                            Choose an option individually in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                            Click Reset to Default to restore default values.

                                                                                                                                                                            Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                                                                            • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                                                                            • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                                                                            • Types—Multiplex Section or Regeneration Section (near end only)

                                                                                                                                                                            Choose an option individually in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                            Click Reset to Default to restore default values.

                                                                                                                                                                            Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                            Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                            DLP-G670 Changing the 40G Muxponder Line RMON Thresholds for Ethernet, 8G FC, or 10G FC Payloads

                                                                                                                                                                            Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                            This task changes the line threshold settings of 40G-MXP-C, or 40E-MXP-C card carrying Ethernet, 8G FC, or 10G FC payloads.

                                                                                                                                                                            Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                            None

                                                                                                                                                                            Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                            DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                            Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                            As needed

                                                                                                                                                                            Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                            Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                            Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                            Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                            Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                              Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), display the 40G-MXP-C, or 40E-MXP-C card where you want to change the line threshold settings in the card view.
                                                                                                                                                                              Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line Thresholds > RMON Thresholds tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                              Step 3   Click Create. The Create Threshold dialog box appears.
                                                                                                                                                                              Step 4   From the Port drop-down list, choose the payload port— for example “1-1 (TEN_GE)”, or the equivalent ITU-T G.7041 GFP (Generic Frame Procedure) port.
                                                                                                                                                                              Step 5   From the Variable drop-down list, choose an Ethernet or FC variable.
                                                                                                                                                                              Table 142 Ethernet Variables of the 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C Cards

                                                                                                                                                                              Variable

                                                                                                                                                                              Description

                                                                                                                                                                              ifInOctets

                                                                                                                                                                              Number of bytes received since the last counter reset.

                                                                                                                                                                              rxTotalPkts

                                                                                                                                                                              Total number of received packets.

                                                                                                                                                                              ifInUcastPkts

                                                                                                                                                                              Number of packets, delivered by this sub-layer to a higher sub-layer, which were not addressed to a multicast or broadcast address at this sub-layer.

                                                                                                                                                                              inInMulticastPkts

                                                                                                                                                                              Number of packets, delivered by this sub-layer to a higher sub-layer, which were addressed to a multicast address at this sub-layer. For a MAC layer protocol, this includes both Group and Functional addresses.

                                                                                                                                                                              ifInBroadcastPkts

                                                                                                                                                                              Number of packets, delivered by this sub-layer to a higher sub-layer, which were addressed to a broadcast address at this sub-layer.

                                                                                                                                                                              ifInErrors

                                                                                                                                                                              Total number of received errors.

                                                                                                                                                                              ifOutOctets

                                                                                                                                                                              Total number of octets transmitted out of the interface, including framing characters.

                                                                                                                                                                              txTotalPkts

                                                                                                                                                                              Total number of transmitted packets.

                                                                                                                                                                              dot3StatsFCSErrors

                                                                                                                                                                              Count of frames received on a particular interface that are an integral number of octets in length but do not pass the Frame Check Sequence (FCS) check.

                                                                                                                                                                              dot3StatsFrameTooLong

                                                                                                                                                                              Count of frames received on a particular interface that exceed the maximum permitted frame size.

                                                                                                                                                                              dot3StatsInPauseFrames

                                                                                                                                                                              Count of frames received on this interface with an opcode indicating the PAUSE operation.

                                                                                                                                                                              dot3StatsOutPauseFrames

                                                                                                                                                                              Count of MAC control frames transmitted on this interface with an opcode indicating the PAUSE operation.

                                                                                                                                                                              etherStatsUndersizePkts

                                                                                                                                                                              Total number of packets transmitted and received by the interface that were less than 64 octets long (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets) and were otherwise well formed.

                                                                                                                                                                              etherStatsFragments

                                                                                                                                                                              Total number of packets received that were less than 64 octets in length (excluding framing bits but including FCS octets) and had either a bad Frame Check Sequence (FCS) with an integral number of octets (FCS Error) or a bad FCS with a non-integral number of octets.

                                                                                                                                                                              etherStatsPkts

                                                                                                                                                                              Total number of packets (including bad packets, broadcast packets, and multicast packets) transmitted and received by the interface.

                                                                                                                                                                              etherStatsPkts64Octets

                                                                                                                                                                              Total number of packets (including bad packets) transmitted and received by the interface that were 64 octets in length (excluding framing bits but including FCS octets).

                                                                                                                                                                              etherStatsPkts65to127Octets

                                                                                                                                                                              Total number of packets (including error packets) transmitted and received by the interface that were between 65 and 127 octets in length inclusive (excluding framing bits but including FCS octets).

                                                                                                                                                                              etherStatsPkts128to255Octets

                                                                                                                                                                              Total number of packets (including error packets) transmitted and received by the interface that were between 128 and 255 octets in length inclusive (excluding framing bits but including FCS octets).

                                                                                                                                                                              etherStatsPkts256to511Octets

                                                                                                                                                                              Total number of packets (including error packets) transmitted and received by the interface that were between 256 and 511 octets in length inclusive (excluding framing bits but including FCS octets).

                                                                                                                                                                              etherStatsPkts512to1023Octets

                                                                                                                                                                              Total number of packets (including error packets) transmitted and received by the interface that were between 512 and 1023 octets in length inclusive (excluding framing bits but including FCS octets).

                                                                                                                                                                              etherStatsPkts1024to1518Octets

                                                                                                                                                                              Total number of packets (including error packets) transmitted and received by the interface that were between 1024 and 1518 octets in length inclusive (excluding framing bits but including FCS octets).

                                                                                                                                                                              etherStatsBroadcastPkts

                                                                                                                                                                              Total number of good packets transmitted and received by the interface that were directed to the broadcast address.

                                                                                                                                                                              etherStatsMulticastPkts

                                                                                                                                                                              Total number of good packets transmitted and received by the interface that were directed to a multicast address. Note that this number does not include packets directed to the broadcast address.

                                                                                                                                                                              etherStatsOversizePkts

                                                                                                                                                                              Total number of packets transmitted and received by the interface that were longer than 1518 octets (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets) and were otherwise well formed.

                                                                                                                                                                              etherStatsJabbers

                                                                                                                                                                              Total number of packets transmitted and received by the interface that were longer than 1518 octets (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets), and were not an integral number of octets in length or had a bad FCS.

                                                                                                                                                                              etherStatsOctets

                                                                                                                                                                              Total number of octets of data (including those in bad packets) transmitted and received by the interface on the network (excluding framing bits but including FCS octets).

                                                                                                                                                                              Table 143 FC Variables of the 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C Cards

                                                                                                                                                                              Variable

                                                                                                                                                                              Description

                                                                                                                                                                              ifInOctets

                                                                                                                                                                              Number of bytes received since the last counter reset.

                                                                                                                                                                              rxTotalPkts

                                                                                                                                                                              Total number of received packets.

                                                                                                                                                                              ifInErrors

                                                                                                                                                                              Total number of received errors.

                                                                                                                                                                              ifOutOctets

                                                                                                                                                                              Total number of octets transmitted out of the interface, including framing characters.

                                                                                                                                                                              txTotalPkts

                                                                                                                                                                              Total number of transmitted packets.

                                                                                                                                                                              ifOutErrors

                                                                                                                                                                              Number of outbound packets or transmission units that could not be transmitted because of errors.

                                                                                                                                                                              mediaIndStatsRxFramesTruncated

                                                                                                                                                                              Total number of frames received that are less than 5 bytes. This value is a part of HDLC and GFP port statistics.

                                                                                                                                                                              mediaIndStatsRxFramesTooLong

                                                                                                                                                                              Number of received frames that exceed the MTU. This value is part of HDLC and GFP port statistics.

                                                                                                                                                                              mediaIndStatsRxFramesBadCRC

                                                                                                                                                                              Number of receive data frames with payload CRC errors when HDLC framing is used.

                                                                                                                                                                              mediaIndStatsTxFramesBadCRC

                                                                                                                                                                              Number of transmitted data frames with payload CRC errors when HDLC framing is used.

                                                                                                                                                                              mediaIndStatsTxFramesTooLong

                                                                                                                                                                              Total number of transmitted data frames that are less than 5 bytes. This value is a part of HDLC and GFP port statistics.

                                                                                                                                                                              mediaIndStatsTxFramesTruncated

                                                                                                                                                                              Number of transmitted data frames that exceed the MTU. This value is part of HDLC and GFP port statistics.

                                                                                                                                                                              Table 144 GFP RMON Variables of the 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C Cards

                                                                                                                                                                              Variable

                                                                                                                                                                              Description

                                                                                                                                                                              gfpStatsRxFrame

                                                                                                                                                                              Total number of received data frames.

                                                                                                                                                                              gfpStatsTxFrame

                                                                                                                                                                              Total number of transmitted data frames.

                                                                                                                                                                              gfpStatsRxSblkCRCErrors

                                                                                                                                                                              Total number of superblock CRC errors with the receive transparent GFP frame. A transparent GFP frame has multiple superblocks where each contains Fibre Channel data.

                                                                                                                                                                              gfpStatsRxOctets

                                                                                                                                                                              Total number of GFP data octets received.

                                                                                                                                                                              gfpStatsTxOctets

                                                                                                                                                                              Total number of GFP data octets transmitted.

                                                                                                                                                                              gfpStatsRxSBitErrors

                                                                                                                                                                              Received GFP frames with single bit errors in the core header (these errors can be corrected).

                                                                                                                                                                              gfpStatsRxMBitErrors

                                                                                                                                                                              Received GFP frames with multiple bit errors in the core header (these errors cannot be corrected).

                                                                                                                                                                              gfpStatsRxTypeInvalid

                                                                                                                                                                              Received GFP frames with invalid type (these are discarded). For example, receiving GFP frames that contain Ethernet data when we expect Fibre Channel data.

                                                                                                                                                                              gfpStatsLFDRaised

                                                                                                                                                                              Count of core HEC CRC multiple bit errors.

                                                                                                                                                                              Note   

                                                                                                                                                                              This count is only of eHec multiple bit errors when in frame. This can be looked at as a count of when the state machine goes out of frame.

                                                                                                                                                                              gfpRxCmfFrame

                                                                                                                                                                              gfpTxCmfFrame

                                                                                                                                                                              Step 6   From the Alarm Type drop-down list, choose an alarm type. The alarm type indicates whether or not an event is triggered by the type of threshold.
                                                                                                                                                                              Step 7   From the Sample Type drop-down list, choose either Relative or Absolute. Relative restricts the threshold to use the number of occurrences in the user-set sample period. Absolute sets the threshold to use the total number of occurrences, regardless of time period.
                                                                                                                                                                              Step 8   Enter the number of Sample Period occurrences.
                                                                                                                                                                              Step 9   Enter the number of Rising Threshold occurrences.

                                                                                                                                                                              To trigger the alarm, the measured value of a threshold must always move from below the falling threshold to above the rising threshold. For example, if a network moves from below a rising threshold of 1000 collisions every 15 seconds to 1001 collisions.

                                                                                                                                                                              Step 10   Enter the appropriate number of occurrences for the Falling Threshold field. In most cases a falling threshold is set lower than the rising threshold.

                                                                                                                                                                              A falling threshold is the exact opposite of a rising threshold. When the number of occurrences is above the rising threshold and then drops below a falling threshold, it resets the rising threshold. For example, when the network problem that caused 1001 collisions in 15 seconds subsides and creates only 799 collisions in 15 seconds, occurrences fall below a falling threshold of 800 collisions. This resets the rising threshold so that if network collisions again spike over a 1000 per 15-second period, an event again triggers when the rising threshold is crossed. An event is triggered only the first time a rising threshold is exceeded.

                                                                                                                                                                              Step 11   Click OK.
                                                                                                                                                                              Step 12   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                              DLP-G671 Provisioning the 40G Muxponder Trunk Port Alarm and TCA Thresholds

                                                                                                                                                                              Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                              This task changes the trunk port alarm and TCA thresholds of the 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C cards.

                                                                                                                                                                              Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                              None

                                                                                                                                                                              Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                              DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                              Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                              As needed

                                                                                                                                                                              Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                              Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                              Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                              Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                              Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the 40G-MXP-C, or 40E-MXP-C card where you want to change the trunk port alarm and TCA settings.
                                                                                                                                                                                Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Optics Thresholds tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                You must modify 15 Min and 1 Day independently. To do so, select the appropriate radio button and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                Do not modify the Laser Bias parameters.

                                                                                                                                                                                Step 3   If TCA is not selected, click TCA and then click Refresh. If it is selected, continue with Step 4.
                                                                                                                                                                                Step 4   Verify the trunk port (Port 5) TCA thresholds are set at the values shown as follows:
                                                                                                                                                                                • Laser Bias High (%): 95.0

                                                                                                                                                                                • RX Power High (dBm): –9.0

                                                                                                                                                                                • RX Power Low (dBm): –22.0

                                                                                                                                                                                • TX Power High (dBm): 9.0

                                                                                                                                                                                • TX Power Low (dBm): 0.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  Provision new thresholds as needed by replacing the old values with new ones.

                                                                                                                                                                                Step 5   Under Types area, click the Alarm radio button and click Refresh.
                                                                                                                                                                                Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                Do not modify the Laser Bias parameters.

                                                                                                                                                                                Step 6   Verify the trunk port (Port 5) alarm thresholds are set at the values shown as follows:
                                                                                                                                                                                • Laser Bias High (%): 98.0

                                                                                                                                                                                • RX Power High (dBm): –8.0

                                                                                                                                                                                • RX Power Low (dBm): –24.0

                                                                                                                                                                                • TX Power High (dBm): 7.0

                                                                                                                                                                                • TX Power Low (dBm): 3.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  Provision new thresholds as needed replacing the old values with new ones.

                                                                                                                                                                                Step 7   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                Step 8   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                DLP-G672 Provisioning the 40G Muxponder Client Port Alarm and TCA Thresholds

                                                                                                                                                                                Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                This task provisions the client port alarm and TCA thresholds of the 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                None

                                                                                                                                                                                Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                Required

                                                                                                                                                                                Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the 40G-MXP-C, or 40E-MXP-C card where you want to change the client port alarm and TCA settings.
                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Optics Thresholds tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 3   If TCA is not selected, click TCA and then click Refresh. If it is selected, continue with Step 4.
                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 4   Referring to the following table, verify the client ports (Ports 1 through 4) TCA thresholds for RX Power High, RX Power Low, TX Power High, and TX Power Low based on the client interface at the other end. Provision new thresholds as needed by replacing the old values with new ones.
                                                                                                                                                                                  Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                  Do not modify the Laser Bias parameters.

                                                                                                                                                                                  Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                  You must modify 15 Min and 1 Day independently. To do so, select the appropriate radio button and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                  Table 145 Client Interfaces TCA Thresholds of the 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C Cards

                                                                                                                                                                                  PPM Port Rate

                                                                                                                                                                                  Pluggable Port Module 
(XFP)

                                                                                                                                                                                  TCA RX
Power High

                                                                                                                                                                                  TCA RX
Power Low

                                                                                                                                                                                  TCA TX
Power High

                                                                                                                                                                                  TCA TX
Power Low

                                                                                                                                                                                  FC8G

                                                                                                                                                                                  ONS-XC-8G-FC-SM

                                                                                                                                                                                  –9

                                                                                                                                                                                  –22

                                                                                                                                                                                  9.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  0.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  FC10G

                                                                                                                                                                                  ONS-XC-10G-1470 through ONS-XC-10G-1610
ONS-XC-10G-C
ONS-XC-10G-S1

                                                                                                                                                                                  –9

                                                                                                                                                                                  –22

                                                                                                                                                                                  9.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  0.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  ONS-XC-10G-I2

                                                                                                                                                                                  2.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  –15.8

                                                                                                                                                                                  8.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  –7.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  ONS-XC-10G-L2

                                                                                                                                                                                  1.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  –14.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  5.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  –12.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  ONS-XC-10G-SR-MM

                                                                                                                                                                                  0.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  0.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  6.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  –6.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  10GE

                                                                                                                                                                                  ONS-XC-10G-30.3 through ONS-XC-10G-61.4
ONS-XC-10G-C
ONS-XC-10G-SR-M
ONS-XC-10G-S1

                                                                                                                                                                                  –9

                                                                                                                                                                                  –22

                                                                                                                                                                                  9.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  0.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  ONS-XC-10G-I2

                                                                                                                                                                                  2.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  –15.8

                                                                                                                                                                                  8.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  –7.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  ONS-XC-10G-L2

                                                                                                                                                                                  –7.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  –24.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  6.5

                                                                                                                                                                                  –2.5

                                                                                                                                                                                  OC-192

                                                                                                                                                                                  ONS-XC-10G-30.3 through ONS-XC-10G-61.4
ONS-XC-10G-C
ONS-XC-10G-1470 through ONS-XC-10G-1610
ONS-XC-10G-I2
ONS-XC-10G-SR-MM

                                                                                                                                                                                  –9

                                                                                                                                                                                  –22

                                                                                                                                                                                  9.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  0.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  ONS-XC-10G-L2

                                                                                                                                                                                  –9.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  –26.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  8.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  –8.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  ONS-XC-10G-S1

                                                                                                                                                                                  –1.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  –11.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  5.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  –12.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  OTU2

                                                                                                                                                                                  ONS-XC-10G-30.3 through ONS-XC-10G-61.4
ONS-XC-10G-C
ONS-XC-10G-1470 through ONS-XC-10G-1610
ONS-XC-10G-I2
ONS-XC-10G-L2
ONS-XC-10G-SR-MM
ONS-XC-10G-S1

                                                                                                                                                                                  –9

                                                                                                                                                                                  –22

                                                                                                                                                                                  9.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  0.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 5   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 6   Repeat Steps 3 and 4 to provision the additional client ports.
                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 7   Under Types area, click the Alarm radio button and click Refresh.
                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 8   Referring to the following table, verify the client port (Ports 1 through 8) Alarm thresholds for RX Power High, RX Power Low, TX Power High, and TX Power Low based on the client interface that is provisioned. Provision new thresholds as needed replacing the old values with new ones.
                                                                                                                                                                                  Table 146 Client Interface Alarm Thresholds of the 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C Cards

                                                                                                                                                                                  PPM Port Rate

                                                                                                                                                                                  Pluggable Port Module 
(XFP)

                                                                                                                                                                                  Alarm RX
Power Low

                                                                                                                                                                                  Alarm RX
Power High

                                                                                                                                                                                  Alarm TX
Power Low

                                                                                                                                                                                  Alarm TX
Power High

                                                                                                                                                                                  FC8G

                                                                                                                                                                                  ONS-XC-8G-FC-SM 
ONS-XC-10G-S1

                                                                                                                                                                                  –9

                                                                                                                                                                                  –22

                                                                                                                                                                                  9.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  0.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  FC10G

                                                                                                                                                                                  ONS-XC-10G-30.3 through ONS-XC-10G-61.4
ONS-XC-10G-C
ONS-XC-10G-1470 through ONS-XC-10G-1610
ONS-XC-10G-S1

                                                                                                                                                                                  –9

                                                                                                                                                                                  –22

                                                                                                                                                                                  9.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  0.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  ONS-XC-10G-I2

                                                                                                                                                                                  4.5

                                                                                                                                                                                  –18.3

                                                                                                                                                                                  4.5

                                                                                                                                                                                  –3.5

                                                                                                                                                                                  ONS-XC-10G-L2

                                                                                                                                                                                  –4.5

                                                                                                                                                                                  –26.5

                                                                                                                                                                                  6.5

                                                                                                                                                                                  –2.5

                                                                                                                                                                                  ONS-XC-10G-SR-MM

                                                                                                                                                                                  2.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  –2.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  2.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  –2.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  10GE

                                                                                                                                                                                  ONS-XC-10G-30.3 through ONS-XC-10G-61.4
ONS-XC-10G-C
ONS-XC-10G-S1
ONS-XC-10G-SR-MM

                                                                                                                                                                                  –9

                                                                                                                                                                                  –22

                                                                                                                                                                                  9.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  0.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  ONS-XC-10G-I2

                                                                                                                                                                                  4.5

                                                                                                                                                                                  –18.3

                                                                                                                                                                                  4.5

                                                                                                                                                                                  –3.5

                                                                                                                                                                                  ONS-XC-10G-L2

                                                                                                                                                                                  –4.5

                                                                                                                                                                                  –26.5

                                                                                                                                                                                  6.5

                                                                                                                                                                                  –2.5

                                                                                                                                                                                  OC-192

                                                                                                                                                                                  ONS-XC-10G-30.3 through ONS-XC-10G-61.4
ONS-XC-10G-C
ONS-XC-10G-1470 through ONS-XC-10G-1610
ONS-XC-10G-I2
ONS-XC-8G-FC-SM
ONS-XC-10G-SR-MM

                                                                                                                                                                                  –9

                                                                                                                                                                                  –22

                                                                                                                                                                                  9.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  0.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  ONS-XC-10G-L2

                                                                                                                                                                                  –7.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  –28.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  4.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  –4.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  ONS-XC-10G-S1

                                                                                                                                                                                  –1.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  –13.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  1.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  –8.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  OTU2

                                                                                                                                                                                  ONS-XC-10G-30.3 through ONS-XC-10G-61.4
ONS-XC-10G-C
ONS-XC-10G-1470 through ONS-XC-10G-1610
ONS-XC-10G-S1
ONS-XC-10G-I2
ONS-XC-10G-L2
ONS-XC-8G-FC-SM
ONS-XC-10G-SR-MM

                                                                                                                                                                                  –9

                                                                                                                                                                                  –22

                                                                                                                                                                                  9.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  0.0

                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 9   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 10   Repeat Steps 7 and 8 to provision additional client ports.
                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 11   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                  DLP-G673 Changing the 40G Muxponder OTN Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                  Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                  This task changes the OTN settings for the 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                  Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                  None

                                                                                                                                                                                  Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                  DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                  Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                  As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                  Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                  Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                  Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                  Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                  Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the 40G-MXP-C, or 40E-MXP-C card where you want to change the OTN settings.
                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 2   Click the Provisioning > OTN tabs, then choose one of the following subtabs: OTN Lines, ITU-T G.709 Thresholds, FEC Thresholds, or Trail Trace Identifier.
                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 3   Modify any of the settings described in the following tables.
                                                                                                                                                                                    Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                    You must modify Near End and Far End, 15 Min and 1 Day, and SM and PM independently. To do so, select the appropriate radio button and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                    Table 147 OTN Line Settings of the 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C Cards

                                                                                                                                                                                    Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                    Description

                                                                                                                                                                                    Options

                                                                                                                                                                                    Port

                                                                                                                                                                                    (Display only) Displays the port number.

                                                                                                                                                                                    Applicable for trunk ports and ports with OTU2 payload.

                                                                                                                                                                                    • 1-1

                                                                                                                                                                                    • 2-1

                                                                                                                                                                                    • 3-1

                                                                                                                                                                                    • 4-1

                                                                                                                                                                                    • 5 (Trunk)

                                                                                                                                                                                    ITU-T G.709 Thresholds

                                                                                                                                                                                    Sets the OTN lines according to ITU-T G.709.

                                                                                                                                                                                    • Enable

                                                                                                                                                                                    • Disable

                                                                                                                                                                                    FEC

                                                                                                                                                                                    Sets the OTN lines to forward error correction (FEC).

                                                                                                                                                                                    • Standard

                                                                                                                                                                                    • Enhanced

                                                                                                                                                                                    SF BER

                                                                                                                                                                                    (Display only) Sets the signal fail bit error rate.

                                                                                                                                                                                    • 1E-5

                                                                                                                                                                                    SD BER

                                                                                                                                                                                    Sets the signal degrade bit error rate.

                                                                                                                                                                                    • 1E-5

                                                                                                                                                                                    • 1E-6

                                                                                                                                                                                    • 1E-7

                                                                                                                                                                                    • 1E-8

                                                                                                                                                                                    • 1E-9

                                                                                                                                                                                    Table 148 ITU-T G.709 Threshold Settings of the 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C Cards

                                                                                                                                                                                    Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                    Description

                                                                                                                                                                                    Options

                                                                                                                                                                                    Port

                                                                                                                                                                                    (Display only) Displays the port number.

                                                                                                                                                                                    Applicable for trunk ports and ports with OTU2 payload.

                                                                                                                                                                                    • 1-1

                                                                                                                                                                                    • 2-1

                                                                                                                                                                                    • 3-1

                                                                                                                                                                                    • 4-1

                                                                                                                                                                                    • 5 (Trunk)

                                                                                                                                                                                    ES

                                                                                                                                                                                    Errored seconds

                                                                                                                                                                                    Numeric. Can be set for Near End or Far End, for 15-minute or one-day intervals, or for SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk). Select the radio button individually and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                    Click Reset to Default to restore default values.

                                                                                                                                                                                    SES

                                                                                                                                                                                    Severely errored seconds

                                                                                                                                                                                    Numeric. Can be set for Near End or Far End, for 15-minute or one-day intervals, or for SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk). Select the radio button individually and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                    UAS

                                                                                                                                                                                    Unavailable seconds

                                                                                                                                                                                    Numeric. Can be set for Near End or Far End, for 15-minute or one-day intervals, or for SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk). Select the radio button individually and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                    BBE

                                                                                                                                                                                    Background block errors

                                                                                                                                                                                    Numeric. Can be set for Near End or Far End, for 15-minute or one-day intervals, or for SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk). Select the radio button individually and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                    FC

                                                                                                                                                                                    Failure counter

                                                                                                                                                                                    Numeric. Can be set for Near End or Far End, for 15-minute or one-day intervals, or for SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk). Select radio button individually and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                    Table 149 FEC Threshold Settings of the 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C Cards

                                                                                                                                                                                    Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                    Description

                                                                                                                                                                                    Options

                                                                                                                                                                                    Port

                                                                                                                                                                                    (Display only) Displays the port number.

                                                                                                                                                                                    Applicable for trunk ports and ports with OTU2 payload.

                                                                                                                                                                                    • 1-1

                                                                                                                                                                                    • 2-1

                                                                                                                                                                                    • 3-1

                                                                                                                                                                                    • 4-1

                                                                                                                                                                                    • 5 (Trunk)

                                                                                                                                                                                    Bit Errors Corrected

                                                                                                                                                                                    Sets the value for bit errors corrected.

                                                                                                                                                                                    Numeric. Can be set for 15-minute or one-day intervals.

                                                                                                                                                                                    Uncorrectable Words

                                                                                                                                                                                    Sets the value for uncorrectable words.

                                                                                                                                                                                    Numeric. Can be set for 15-minute or one-day intervals.

                                                                                                                                                                                    Table 150 Trail Trace Identifier Settings of the 40G-MXP-C, 40E-MXP-C, and 40ME-MXP-C Cards

                                                                                                                                                                                    Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                    Description

                                                                                                                                                                                    Options

                                                                                                                                                                                    Port

                                                                                                                                                                                    (Display only) Displays the port number.

                                                                                                                                                                                    Applicable for trunk ports and ports with OTU2 payload.

                                                                                                                                                                                    • 1-1

                                                                                                                                                                                    • 2-1

                                                                                                                                                                                    • 3-1

                                                                                                                                                                                    • 4-1

                                                                                                                                                                                    • 5 (Trunk)

                                                                                                                                                                                    Received Trace Mode

                                                                                                                                                                                    Sets the trace mode.

                                                                                                                                                                                    • Off/None

                                                                                                                                                                                    • Manual

                                                                                                                                                                                    Disable AIS/RDI on TIM-S

                                                                                                                                                                                    Disables alarm indication signal.

                                                                                                                                                                                    • Checked (AIS/RDI on TIM-S is disabled)

                                                                                                                                                                                    • Unchecked (AIS/RDI on TIM-S is not disabled)

                                                                                                                                                                                    Transmit Section Trace String Size

                                                                                                                                                                                    Sets the trace string size.

                                                                                                                                                                                    • 1 byte

                                                                                                                                                                                    • 16 byte

                                                                                                                                                                                    Transmit

                                                                                                                                                                                    Displays and sets the current transmit string.
You can click the button on the right to change the display. Its title changes, based on the current display mode. In Transmit String Type, click Hex Mode to change the display to hexadecimal (button changes to ASCII); click ASCII to change the display to ASCII (button changes to Hex Mode).

                                                                                                                                                                                    Transmit string size

                                                                                                                                                                                    Expected

                                                                                                                                                                                    Displays and sets the current expected string.
You can click the button on the right to change the display. Its title changes, based on the current display mode. In Expected String Type, click Hex Mode to change the display to hexadecimal (button changes to ASCII); click ASCII to change the display to ASCII (button changes to Hex Mode).

                                                                                                                                                                                    Expected string size

                                                                                                                                                                                    Received

                                                                                                                                                                                    (Display only) Displays the current received string. Click Refresh to manually refresh this display, or check the Auto-refresh every 5 sec check box to keep this panel updated.

                                                                                                                                                                                    Received string size

                                                                                                                                                                                    Auto-refresh

                                                                                                                                                                                    Refreshes the display automatically every 5 seconds.

                                                                                                                                                                                    • Checked

                                                                                                                                                                                    • Unchecked (default)

                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                    NTP-G281 Managing the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE Card Channel Group Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                    Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                    This procedure changes the channel group settings for GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                    Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                    None

                                                                                                                                                                                    Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                    Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                    As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                    Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                    Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                    Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                    Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                    Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                    Perform any of the following tasks as needed: Stop. You have completed this procedure.

                                                                                                                                                                                    DLP-G611 Creating a Channel Group Using CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                    Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                    This task creates a channel group on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                    Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                    None

                                                                                                                                                                                    Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                    DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                    Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                    As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                    Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                    Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                    Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                    Provisioning or higher


                                                                                                                                                                                    Note


                                                                                                                                                                                    You can create up to 11 channel groups on the GE_XP and GE_XPE cards and up to 2 channel groups on the 10GE_XP and 10GE_XPE cards. You can create a channel group with ports only when the ports do not have any UNI QinQ settings or NNI SVLAN settings. Otherwise, the channel group will be created with empty ports.


                                                                                                                                                                                    For information about interaction of LACP with other protocols, see the Protocol Compatibility list.

                                                                                                                                                                                    Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 1   Verify that the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card is installed according to the requirements specified in Cable Connections for Y-Cable Protection of One Client Signal table.
                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 2   Verify that the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card is installed in L2-over-DWDM mode. See the DLP-G379 Changing the GE_​XP, 10GE_​XP, GE_​XPE, and 10GE_​XPE Card Mode.
                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 3   In card view, click the Provisioning > Channel Groups tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 4   Click Create. The Channel Group Creation dialog box appears.
                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 5   Enter the name of the channel group in the Name field.
                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 6   From the Stand Alone list, choose the ports that will belong to this channel group and click the right arrow button to move the selected ports to the Bundled list.
                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 7   From the LACP Mode drop-down list, choose the LACP mode as needed:
                                                                                                                                                                                      • On—Default mode. In this mode, the ports will not exchange LACP packets with the partner ports.

                                                                                                                                                                                      • Active—In this mode, the ports will send LACP packets at regular intervals to the partner ports.

                                                                                                                                                                                      • Passive—In this mode, the ports will not send LACP packets until the partner ports send LACP packets. After receiving the LACP packets from the partner ports, the ports will send LACP packets.

                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 8   From the LACP Hashing drop-down list, select the LACP hashing algorithm that the protocol uses to perform the load balancing task between the bundled ports.

                                                                                                                                                                                      The following hashing algorithms are supported:

                                                                                                                                                                                      • Ucast SA VLAN Incoming Port

                                                                                                                                                                                      • Ucast DA VLAN Incoming Port

                                                                                                                                                                                      • Ucast SA DA VLAN Incoming port

                                                                                                                                                                                      • Ucast Src IP TCP UDP

                                                                                                                                                                                      • Ucast Dst IP TCP UDP

                                                                                                                                                                                      • Ucast Src Dst IP TCP UDP

                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 9   Click Create.

                                                                                                                                                                                      A new row is added in the LACP table and all the other parameters in the channel group are set to default values. The default values of these parameters are taken from the first port that is attached to the channel group.

                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 10   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                      DLP-G612 Modifying the Parameters of the Channel Group Using CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                      Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                      This task modifies the parameters of the channel group.

                                                                                                                                                                                      Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                      None

                                                                                                                                                                                      Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                      DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                      Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                      As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                      Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                      Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                      Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                      Provisioning or higher


                                                                                                                                                                                      Note


                                                                                                                                                                                      Ports cannot be added or removed using this procedure. For adding or removing the ports, see the DLP-G613 Managing Ports in a Channel Group.


                                                                                                                                                                                      Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card where you want to modify the parameters of the channel group.
                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 2   In card view, click the Provisioning > Channel Groups tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 3   Choose a channel group from the existing channel groups.
                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 4   Modify the channel group settings as described in the following table.
                                                                                                                                                                                        Table 151 Channel Group Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                        Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                        Description

                                                                                                                                                                                        Options

                                                                                                                                                                                        Channel Group

                                                                                                                                                                                        (Display only) ID and name of the channel group.

                                                                                                                                                                                        N.A.

                                                                                                                                                                                        Name

                                                                                                                                                                                        Sets the name of the channel group.

                                                                                                                                                                                        Ports

                                                                                                                                                                                        (Display only) Port number (n-n) and rate (GE or TEN_GE of the channel group).

                                                                                                                                                                                        N.A.

                                                                                                                                                                                        LACP Mode

                                                                                                                                                                                        Sets the LACP mode. The channel group must be in OOS-DSBLD admin state.

                                                                                                                                                                                        • On

                                                                                                                                                                                        • Active

                                                                                                                                                                                        • Passive

                                                                                                                                                                                        Hashing

                                                                                                                                                                                        Sets the LACP hashing algorithm. The channel group must be in OOS-DSBLD admin state.

                                                                                                                                                                                        • Ucast SA VLAN Incoming Port

                                                                                                                                                                                        • Ucast DA VLAN Incoming Port

                                                                                                                                                                                        • Ucast SA DA VLAN Incoming port

                                                                                                                                                                                        • Ucast Src IP TCP UDP

                                                                                                                                                                                        • Ucast Dst IP TCP UDP

                                                                                                                                                                                        • Ucast Src Dst IP TCP UDP

                                                                                                                                                                                        Admin State

                                                                                                                                                                                        Sets the administrative state on the channel group.

                                                                                                                                                                                        • IS

                                                                                                                                                                                        • OOS, DSBLD

                                                                                                                                                                                        Service State

                                                                                                                                                                                        (Display only) Sets the service state that indicates the operational state of the channel group.

                                                                                                                                                                                        • IS-NR

                                                                                                                                                                                        • OOS-MA, DSBLD

                                                                                                                                                                                        MTU

                                                                                                                                                                                        Sets the maximum transfer unit (MTU), which sets the maximum number of bytes per frame accepted on the port. The member ports must be in OOS-DSBLD admin state. The default MTU value in the channel group is taken from the default settings in the node.

                                                                                                                                                                                        Numeric. Default: 9700

                                                                                                                                                                                        Range: 64 to 9700

                                                                                                                                                                                        Mode

                                                                                                                                                                                        Sets the provisional port mode. If the port mode is Auto, the Expected Speed field determines which ports can belong to the bundle. The member ports must be in OOS-DSBLD admin state.

                                                                                                                                                                                        • Auto

                                                                                                                                                                                        • 1000 Mbps

                                                                                                                                                                                        Expected Speed

                                                                                                                                                                                        Sets the expected speed of ports of the channel group. The channel group must be in OOS-DSBLD admin state.

                                                                                                                                                                                        • 10 Mbps

                                                                                                                                                                                        • 100 Mbps

                                                                                                                                                                                        • 1000 Mbps

                                                                                                                                                                                        Duplex

                                                                                                                                                                                        (Display only) Expected duplex capability of ports of the channel group.

                                                                                                                                                                                        • Full

                                                                                                                                                                                        Committed Info Rate

                                                                                                                                                                                        Sets the guaranteed information rate based on the service-level agreement of the service provider. The channel group must be in OOS-DSBLD admin state.

                                                                                                                                                                                        Numeric. Default: 100%

                                                                                                                                                                                        Range: 0 to 100%

                                                                                                                                                                                        Granularity: 0.1%

                                                                                                                                                                                        Committed Burst Size

                                                                                                                                                                                        Sets the maximum number of bits transferred per second. The channel group must be in OOS-DSBLD admin state.

                                                                                                                                                                                        • 4k (default)

                                                                                                                                                                                        • 8k

                                                                                                                                                                                        • 16k

                                                                                                                                                                                        • 32k

                                                                                                                                                                                        • 64k

                                                                                                                                                                                        • 128k

                                                                                                                                                                                        • 256k

                                                                                                                                                                                        • 512k

                                                                                                                                                                                        • 1M

                                                                                                                                                                                        • 2M

                                                                                                                                                                                        • 4M

                                                                                                                                                                                        • 8M

                                                                                                                                                                                        • 16M

                                                                                                                                                                                        Excess Burst Size

                                                                                                                                                                                        Sets the maximum number of bits credited for later transfer if the committed burst rate cannot be transmitted. The channel group must be in OOS-DSBLD admin state.

                                                                                                                                                                                        • 4k (default)

                                                                                                                                                                                        • 8k

                                                                                                                                                                                        • 16k

                                                                                                                                                                                        • 32k

                                                                                                                                                                                        • 64k

                                                                                                                                                                                        • 128k

                                                                                                                                                                                        • 256k

                                                                                                                                                                                        • 512k

                                                                                                                                                                                        • 1M

                                                                                                                                                                                        • 2M

                                                                                                                                                                                        • 4M

                                                                                                                                                                                        • 8M

                                                                                                                                                                                        • 16M

                                                                                                                                                                                        NIM

                                                                                                                                                                                        Sets the network interface mode (NIM) for the channel group. The member ports must be in OOS-DSBLD admin state.

                                                                                                                                                                                        The channel group NIM is set to UNI or NNI based on the mode of the first port that is added to the channel group.

                                                                                                                                                                                        • UNI Mode (Default)—provisions the port as a User-Network Interface (UNI). This is the interface that faces the subscriber.

                                                                                                                                                                                        • NNI Mode—provisions the port as a Network-to-Network Interface (NNI). This is the interface that faces the service provider network.

                                                                                                                                                                                        Ingress CoS

                                                                                                                                                                                        Provisions the IEEE 802.1p ingress class of service (CoS). Ingress CoS is used to set the priority of the Ethernet frame in the service provider network. The member ports must be in OOS-DSBLD admin state.

                                                                                                                                                                                        • 0

                                                                                                                                                                                        • 1

                                                                                                                                                                                        • 2

                                                                                                                                                                                        • 3

                                                                                                                                                                                        • 4

                                                                                                                                                                                        • 5

                                                                                                                                                                                        • 6

                                                                                                                                                                                        • 7

                                                                                                                                                                                        • Trust

                                                                                                                                                                                        • CVLAN

                                                                                                                                                                                        • DSCP

                                                                                                                                                                                        Inner Ethertype (Hex)


                                                                                                                                                                                        Defines the inner Ethertype field. The Ethertype field indicates which protocol is being transported in an Ethernet frame. The member ports must be in OOS-DSBLD admin state to modify the Inner Ethertype value to a non-default value.

                                                                                                                                                                                        Numeric.

                                                                                                                                                                                        Default: 8100 (IEEE Std 802.1Q customer VLAN tag type)

                                                                                                                                                                                        Range: 0x600 to 0xffff.

                                                                                                                                                                                        Outer Ethertype (Hex)

                                                                                                                                                                                        Defines the outer Ethertype field. The Ethertype field identifies which protocol is being transported in an Ethernet frame. The member ports must be in OOS-DSBLD admin state.

                                                                                                                                                                                        Numeric.

                                                                                                                                                                                        Default: 8100 (IEEE standard 802.1Q service provider VLAN tag type)

                                                                                                                                                                                        Range: 0x600 to 0xffff

                                                                                                                                                                                        MAC Learning

                                                                                                                                                                                        Enables or disables MAC learning for the port on GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards. MAC learning is used by Layer 2 switches to learn the MAC addresses of network nodes so that the Layer 2 switches send traffic to the right location. In GE_XPE or 10GE_XPE cards, enable MAC address learning per SVLAN.

                                                                                                                                                                                        • Checked—MAC learning is enabled for this port.

                                                                                                                                                                                        • Unchecked—(Default) MAC learning is disabled for this port.

                                                                                                                                                                                        Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                        When you set the Committed Info Rate above 40% on 10GE_XP and 10GE_XPE cards, the Committed Burst Size and Excess Burst Size must be set to at least 32K. The Committed Burst Size and Excess Burst Size can be increased based on the packet size and Committed Info Rate value.

                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 5   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 6   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                        DLP-G613 Managing Ports in a Channel Group

                                                                                                                                                                                        Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                        This task adds or removes ports to or from an existing channel group.

                                                                                                                                                                                        Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                        None

                                                                                                                                                                                        Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                        DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                        Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                        As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                        Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                        Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                        Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                        Provisioning or higher


                                                                                                                                                                                        Note


                                                                                                                                                                                        • You can assign up to eight ports to a channel group on GE_XP and GE_XPE cards and up to three ports on the 10GE_XP and 10GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                        • You can assign the ports to a channel group only if the ports are in OOS-DSBLD admin state. The ports must not have any UNI QinQ rule or NNI SVLAN configuration.

                                                                                                                                                                                        • If the channel group is configured in UNI mode, only the UNI ports can be added to the channel group. If the channel group is configured in NNI mode, only the NNI ports can be added to the channel group.


                                                                                                                                                                                        Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card where you want to add ports to an existing channel group.
                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 2   In card view, click the Provisioning > Channel Groups tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 3   Choose a channel group from the existing channel groups.
                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 4   Click Add/Remove Ports.
                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 5   To add ports to an existing channel group, from the Stand Alone list, choose the required ports and click the right arrow button to move the selected ports to the Bundled list.
                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 6   To remove ports from an existing channel group, complete the following: from the Bundled list, choose the required ports and click the left arrow button to move the selected ports to the Stand Alone list.
                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 7   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 8   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                          DLP-G614 Deleting a Channel Group

                                                                                                                                                                                          Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                          This task deletes a channel group.

                                                                                                                                                                                          Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                          None

                                                                                                                                                                                          Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                          DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                          Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                          As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                          Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                          Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                          Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                          Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                          Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XP card where you want to delete the channel group.
                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 2   In card view, click the Provisioning > Channel Groups tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 3   Choose a channel group that you want to delete.
                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 4   Click Delete.
                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                            DLP-G615 Retrieving Information on Channel Group, REP, CFM, and EFM

                                                                                                                                                                                            Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                            This task enables you to view and retrieve information on the channel group, Resilient Ethernet Protocol (REP), Connectivity Fault Management (CFM), and Ethernet in the First Mile (EFM) on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                            Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                            None

                                                                                                                                                                                            Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                            DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                            Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                            As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                            Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                            Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                            Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                            Retrieve or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                            Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 1   Verify that the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card is installed in L2-over-DWDM mode. See the DLP-G379 Changing the GE_​XP, 10GE_​XP, GE_​XPE, and 10GE_​XPE Card Mode
                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 2   In card view, click the Maintenance > Show Commands tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 3   From the Command drop-down list, choose a command.
                                                                                                                                                                                              The following commands are supported:
                                                                                                                                                                                              • ETH LACP—Displays detailed LACP information from the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                              • REP TOPO—Displays the topology information for a specific REP segment.

                                                                                                                                                                                              • REP TOPO ARCHIVE—Displays the previous topology information for a specific REP segment.

                                                                                                                                                                                              • REP INTERFACE—Displays information on the REP interface status and configuration. You can retrieve detailed information for each segment by selecting Detailed from the Level drop-down list and providing the segment ID.

                                                                                                                                                                                              • OAM DISCOVERY—Displays discovery information for all the EFM interfaces or for a specific EFM interface.

                                                                                                                                                                                              • OAM SUMMARY—Displays the active EFM sessions on a device.

                                                                                                                                                                                              • OAM STATISTICS—Displays detailed information about the EFM packets.

                                                                                                                                                                                              • OAM STATUS—Displays information about the EFM configurations for all the EFM interfaces or for a specific interface.

                                                                                                                                                                                              For more information, see the Pseudo Command Line Interface Reference document.

                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 4   From the Level drop-down list, choose Normal or Detailed.
                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 5   Click Show. Depending on the command, the appropriate output appears in the text area.
                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 6   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                              DLP-G616 Viewing PM Parameters of a Channel Group

                                                                                                                                                                                              Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                              This task enables you to view current statistical performance monitoring (PM) counts on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards and channel groups to detect possible performance problems.

                                                                                                                                                                                              Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                              None

                                                                                                                                                                                              Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                              DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                              Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                              As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                              Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                              Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                              Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                              Retrieve or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                              Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf mode), double-click the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card where you want to view the channel group statistics. The card view appears.
                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 2   Click the Performance > Channel Groups > Statistics tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 3   Click Refresh. Performance monitoring statistics for each channel group on the card appear in the Statistics tab.

                                                                                                                                                                                                View the PM parameter names in the Param column. The current PM parameter values appear in the Port # (CHGRP) column. For PM parameter definitions, see the Monitor Performance document.

                                                                                                                                                                                                Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                To refresh, reset, or clear PM counts, see the “NTP-G73 Change the PM Display” procedure.

                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 4   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                DLP-G617 Viewing Utilization PM Parameters of a Channel Group

                                                                                                                                                                                                Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                This task enables you to view line utilization PM counts on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards and channel groups to detect possible performance problems.

                                                                                                                                                                                                Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                None

                                                                                                                                                                                                Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                Retrieve or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 1   In node view, double-click the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card where you want to view the channel group utilization. The card view appears.
                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 2   Click the Performance > Channel Groups > Utilization tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 3   Click Refresh. The utilization percentages for each channel group on the card appear in the Utilization tab.

                                                                                                                                                                                                  View the Port # column to find the channel group you want to monitor.

                                                                                                                                                                                                  The transmit (Tx) and receive (Rx) bandwidth utilization values, for the previous time intervals, appear in the Prev-n columns. For PM parameter definitions, see the Monitor Performance document.

                                                                                                                                                                                                  Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                  To refresh, reset, or clear PM counts, see the “NTP-G73 Change the PM Display” procedure.

                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 4   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                  DLP-G618 Viewing History PM Parameters of a Channel Group

                                                                                                                                                                                                  Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                  This task enables you to view historical PM counts at selected time intervals on GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards and channel groups to detect possible performance problems.

                                                                                                                                                                                                  Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                  None

                                                                                                                                                                                                  Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                  DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                  Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                  As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                  Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                  Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                  Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                  Retrieve or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                  Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf mode), double-click the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE card where you want to view the channel group history PM data. The card view appears.
                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 2   Click the Performance > Channel Groups > History tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 3   From the Port field, choose a channel group.
                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 4   Click Refresh. Performance monitoring statistics for each channel group on the card appear in the History tab.

                                                                                                                                                                                                    View the PM parameter names that appear in the Param column. The PM parameter values appear in the Prev-n columns. For PM parameter definitions, see the Monitor Performance document.

                                                                                                                                                                                                    Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                    To refresh, reset, or clear PM counts, see the “NTP-G73 Change the PM Display” procedure.

                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                    NTP-G283 Managing the Card CFM Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                    Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                    This procedure changes the CFM settings for GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                    Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                    None

                                                                                                                                                                                                    Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                    Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                    As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                    Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                    Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                    Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                    Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                    Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                    Perform any of the following tasks as needed:

                                                                                                                                                                                                    Stop. You have completed this procedure.


                                                                                                                                                                                                    DLP-G621 Enabling CFM on a Card

                                                                                                                                                                                                    Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                    This task allows you to enable or disable CFM on GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                    Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                    None

                                                                                                                                                                                                    Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                    DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                    Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                    As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                    Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                    Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                    Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                    Retrieve or higher


                                                                                                                                                                                                    Note


                                                                                                                                                                                                    CFM is disabled on the card by default. CFM must be enabled at both card and port levels for the CFM service to work.


                                                                                                                                                                                                    For information about interaction of CFM with other protocols, see the “Protocol Compatibility list” section.

                                                                                                                                                                                                    Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 1   Verify that the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card is installed in L2-over-DWDM mode. See the DLP-G379 Changing the GE_​XP, 10GE_​XP, GE_​XPE, and 10GE_​XPE Card Mode.
                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 2   In card view, click the Provisioning > Security tab.
                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 3   Uncheck the MAC security check box to disable MAC security.
                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 4   In card view, click the Provisioning > CFM > Configuration > Global Settings tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 5   Check the Enable CFM check box that is present at the bottom of the screen.
                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 6   Choose the value for CC Timer field. The value can be 1 second, 10 seconds, or 1 minute.
                                                                                                                                                                                                      Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                      Continuity Check (CC) messages are periodically exchanged between maintenance end points (MEPs). The CC Timer field is used to set the time frequency for transmission of CC messages.

                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 7   Click Apply to enable CFM on the card.
                                                                                                                                                                                                      Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                      Uncheck the Enable CFM check box to disable CFM on the card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 8   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                      DLP-G622 Enabling CFM for a Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                      Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                      This task allows you to enable or disable CFM for each port on GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                      Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                      None

                                                                                                                                                                                                      Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                      DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                      Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                      As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                      Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                      Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                      Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                      Retrieve or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                      Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 1   Verify that the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card is installed in L2-over-DWDM mode. See the DLP-G379 Changing the GE_​XP, 10GE_​XP, GE_​XPE, and 10GE_​XPE Card Mode
                                                                                                                                                                                                        Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                        CFM must be enabled at both card and port levels for the CFM service to work. However, CFM is enabled on all the ports by default.

                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 2   In card view, click the Provisioning > CFM > Configuration > Global Settings tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 3   If you want to enable CFM on a specific port, check the Enable CFM check box against that port.
                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 4   Choose the value for CC Timer field. The value can be 1 second, 10 seconds, or 1 minute.
                                                                                                                                                                                                        Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                        Continuity Check (CC) messages are periodically exchanged between MEPs. The CC Timer field is used to set the time frequency for transmission of CC messages.

                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 5   Click Apply to enable CFM on the port.
                                                                                                                                                                                                        Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                        Uncheck the Enable CFM check box against the port to disable CFM on the port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 6   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                        DLP-G623 Creating a Maintenance Domain Profile

                                                                                                                                                                                                        Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                        This task allows you to create a maintenance domain profile on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                        Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                        None

                                                                                                                                                                                                        Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                        DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                        Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                        As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                        Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                        Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                        Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                        Retrieve or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                        You can create up to eight maintenance domain profiles on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE cards. The maximum number of characters for the maintenance domain profile and the maintenance association profile must not exceed 43 characters.
                                                                                                                                                                                                        Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 1   Verify that the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card is installed in L2-over-DWDM mode. See the DLP-G379 Changing the GE_​XP, 10GE_​XP, GE_​XPE, and 10GE_​XPE Card Mode.
                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 2   In card view, click the Provisioning > CFM > Configuration > Domain Profiles tabs or in node/network view, click the Provisioning > CFM Profiles > Domain Profiles tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                          Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                          Use the network view to store the domain profile on multiple nodes.

                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 3   Click Add row(s).
                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 4   Enter the name of the domain in the Domain Name field.
                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 5   Enter the level of the domain profile in the Level field. The range of the domain profile level is from 0 to 7.
                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 6   Click Store.
                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 7   Choose the card slot where you want to store this domain profile and click OK.
                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 8   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                          DLP-G624 Deleting a Maintenance Domain Profile

                                                                                                                                                                                                          Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                          This task allows you to delete a maintenance domain profile on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                          Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                          None

                                                                                                                                                                                                          Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                          DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                          Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                          As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                          Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                          Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                          Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                          Retrieve or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                          Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 1   Verify that the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card is installed in L2-over-DWDM mode. See the DLP-G379 Changing the GE_​XP, 10GE_​XP, GE_​XPE, and 10GE_​XPE Card Mode.
                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 2   In card view, click the Provisioning > CFM > Configuration > Domain Profiles tabs or in node/network view, click the Provisioning > CFM Profiles > Domain Profiles tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 3   Select the domain profiles that you want to delete.
                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 4   Check the on Node check box.
                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 5   Click Delete Sel. row(s).
                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 6   Choose the card slot where you want to delete this profile and click OK.
                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 7   In the Deleting Profile dialog box, click Yes.
                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 8   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                            DLP-G625 Creating a Maintenance Association Profile

                                                                                                                                                                                                            Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                            This task allows you to create a maintenance association profile on GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                            Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                            None

                                                                                                                                                                                                            Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                            DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                            Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                            As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                            Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                            Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                            Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                            Retrieve or higher


                                                                                                                                                                                                            Note


                                                                                                                                                                                                            You can create up to 1500 maintenance association profiles on GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE cards.


                                                                                                                                                                                                            Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 1   Verify that the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card is installed in L2-over-DWDM mode. See theDLP-G379 Changing the GE_​XP, 10GE_​XP, GE_​XPE, and 10GE_​XPE Card Mode.
                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 2   In card view, click the Provisioning > CFM > Configuration > MA Profiles tabs or in node/network view, click the Provisioning > CFM Profiles > MA Profiles tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                              Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                              Use the network view to store the maintenance association profile on multiple nodes.

                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 3   Click Add row(s).
                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 4   Enter the name of the maintenance association in the Maintenance Profile Name field.
                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 5   Enter the VLAN ID in the VLAN ID field. The range of the VLAN ID is from 1 to 4093.
                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 6   Check the CC Enable check box to receive Continuity Check messages.
                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 7   Click Store.
                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 8   Choose the card slot where you want to store this maintenance association profile and click OK.
                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 9   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                              DLP-G626 Modifying a Maintenance Association Profile

                                                                                                                                                                                                              Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                              This task allows you to modify a maintenance association profile on GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                              Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                              None

                                                                                                                                                                                                              Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                              DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                              Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                              As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                              Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                              Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                              Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                              Retrieve or higher


                                                                                                                                                                                                              Note


                                                                                                                                                                                                              Ensure that the maintenance association profile you want to modify is not associated with a maintenance domain profile.


                                                                                                                                                                                                              Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 1   Verify that the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card is installed in L2-over-DWDM mode. See the DLP-G379 Changing the GE_​XP, 10GE_​XP, GE_​XPE, and 10GE_​XPE Card Mode.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 2   In card view, click the Provisioning > CFM > Configuration > MA Profiles tabs or in node/network view, click the Provisioning > CFM Profiles > MA Profiles tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 3   Select the maintenance association profiles that you want to modify.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 4   Click Modify Selected Profile(s).
                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 5   Modify the values as required and click OK.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 6   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                DLP-G627 Deleting a Maintenance Association Profile

                                                                                                                                                                                                                Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                This task allows you to delete a maintenance association profile on GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                Retrieve or higher


                                                                                                                                                                                                                Note


                                                                                                                                                                                                                Ensure that the maintenance association profile you want to delete is not associated with a maintenance domain profile.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 1   Verify that the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card is installed in L2-over-DWDM mode. See the DLP-G379 Changing the GE_​XP, 10GE_​XP, GE_​XPE, and 10GE_​XPE Card Mode.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 2   In card view, click the Provisioning > CFM > Configuration > MA Profiles tabs or in node/network view, click the Provisioning > CFM Profiles > MA Profiles tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 3   Select the maintenance association profiles that you want to delete.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 4   Check the on Node check box.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 5   Click Delete Sel. row(s).
                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 6   Choose the card slot where you want to delete this profile and click OK.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 7   In the Deleting Profile dialog box, click Yes.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 8   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                  DLP-G628 Mapping Profiles

                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                  This task allows you to map a maintenance association profile to a maintenance domain profile on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                  None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                  DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                  As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Retrieve or higher


                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Note


                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Ensure that you have already created maintenance domain profiles and maintenance association profiles.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 1   Verify that the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card is installed in L2-over-DWDM mode. See the DLP-G379 Changing the GE_​XP, 10GE_​XP, GE_​XPE, and 10GE_​XPE Card Mode.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 2   In card view, click the Provisioning > CFM > Configuration > MA-Domain Mapping tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 3   From the main drop-down list, choose a maintenance domain profile.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 4   Click Link MA Profiles.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 5   From the Available Profiles list, choose the required MA profiles and click the right arrow button to move the MA profiles to the Linked Profiles list and click OK.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                    The maintenance association profiles that are mapped with a specific maintenance domain profile must have a unique SVLAN ID.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 6   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                    DLP-G629 Creating a MEP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                    This task allows you to create a Maintenance End Point (MEP) for a given VLAN range on a specific maintenance domain.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                    None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                    DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                    As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Retrieve or higher


                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Note


                                                                                                                                                                                                                    You can create up to 255 MEPs and MIPs on the GE_XP and 10GE_XP cards. You can create up to 500 MEPs and MIPs on the GE_XPE and 10GE_XPE cards.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 1   Verify that the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card is installed in L2-over-DWDM mode. See the DLP-G379 Changing the GE_​XP, 10GE_​XP, GE_​XPE, and 10GE_​XPE Card Mode.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 2   In card view, click the Provisioning > CFM > Configuration > MEP tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 3   Click Create.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 4   From the Port drop-down list, choose a port where you want to create the MEP.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                      CFM must be enabled on the port to create a MEP. The port must not belong to a channel group.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 5   From the Domain drop-down list, choose a maintenance domain.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 6   Enter the SVLAN ID in the Vlan Id field.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                      The specified VLAN must be configured on the selected port. The specified VLAN must also appear in the MA-Domain Mapping table.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 7   Enter the MP ID (identifier of the maintenance end point) in the MPID field and click OK. The range of the MP ID is from 1 to 8191.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                      The MP ID must not be the same between the maintenance end points.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 8   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                      DLP-G630 Deleting a MEP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                      This task allows you to delete a MEP on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                      None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                      DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                      As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Retrieve or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 1   Verify that the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card is installed in L2-over-DWDM mode. See the DLP-G379 Changing the GE_​XP, 10GE_​XP, GE_​XPE, and 10GE_​XPE Card Mode.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 2   In card view, click the Provisioning > CFM > Configuration > MEP tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 3   Select the MEPs that you want to delete.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 4   Click Delete.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                        DLP-G631 Creating a MIP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                        This task allows you to create a Maintenance Intermediate Point (MIP) for a given VLAN range with a specific maintenance level.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                        None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                        DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                        As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Retrieve or higher


                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Note


                                                                                                                                                                                                                        You can create up to 255 MEPs and MIPs on the GE_XP and 10GE_XP cards. You can create up to 500 MEPs and MIPs on the GE_XPE and 10GE_XPE cards.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 1   Verify that the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card is installed in L2-over-DWDM mode. See the DLP-G379 Changing the GE_​XP, 10GE_​XP, GE_​XPE, and 10GE_​XPE Card Mode
                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 2   In card view, click the Provisioning > CFM > Configuration > MIP tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 3   Click Create.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 4   From the Port drop-down list, choose a port where you want to create the MIP.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                          The port must not belong to a channel group.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 5   From the Level drop-down list, choose a maintenance level. The range of the maintenance level is from 0 to 7.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 6   Enter the SVLAN range in the Vlan range field. The range of the SVLAN is from 1 to 4093.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                          The specified SVLAN must be configured on the selected port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 7   Click OK.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 8   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                          DLP-G632 Deleting a MIP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                          This task allows you to delete a MIP on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                          None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                          DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                          As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Retrieve or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 1   Verify that the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card is installed in L2-over-DWDM mode. See the DLP-G379 Changing the GE_​XP, 10GE_​XP, GE_​XPE, and 10GE_​XPE Card Mode.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 2   In card view, click the Provisioning > CFM > Configuration > MIP tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 3   Select the MIPs that you want to delete.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 4   Click Delete.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                            DLP-G633 Pinging a MEP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                            This task allows you to display the output of the ping command on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                            None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                            DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                            As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Retrieve or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 1   Verify that the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card is installed in L2-over-DWDM mode. See the DLP-G379 Changing the GE_​XP, 10GE_​XP, GE_​XPE, and 10GE_​XPE Card Mode task.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 2   In card view, click the Provisioning > CFM > Ping tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 3   Enter the MP ID value in the MPID field. The range of the MP ID is from 1 to 8191.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Remote MP ID user cannot ping local MP ID.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 4   (Optional) Enter the MAC address of the remote maintenance point in the Mac Addr field. The format of MAC address is abcd.abcd.abcd.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 5   Enter the SVLAN ID in the VLAN ID field. The range of the SVLAN ID is from 1 to 4093.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 6   Enter the domain name in the Domain Name field.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 7   Enter the size of the ping packet in the DataGram Size field. The default value is 100.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 8   Enter the number of ping packets in the No of Requests field. The default value is 5.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 9   Click Ping. The output of the ping command appears in the Ping Response area.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 10   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                              DLP-G634 Displaying Output of a Traceroute MEP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                              This task allows you to display the output of the traceroute command on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                              None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                              DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                              As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Retrieve or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 1   Verify that the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card is installed in L2-over-DWDM mode. See the DLP-G379 Changing the GE_​XP, 10GE_​XP, GE_​XPE, and 10GE_​XPE Card Mode
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 2   In card view, click the Provisioning > CFM > Traceroute tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 3   Enter the remote MP ID value in the MPID field. The range of the MP ID is from 1 to 8191.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 4   (Optional) Enter the MAC address of the remote maintenance point in the Mac Addr field. The format of MAC address is abcd.abcd.abcd.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 5   Enter the SVLAN ID in the VLAN ID field. The range of the SVLAN ID is from 1 to 4093.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 6   Enter the domain name in the Domain Name field.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 7   Click TraceRoute Response.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                The output of the traceroute command appears in the TraceRoute Response area.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Verify the RlyHit message is shown in the traceroute display and LTM reaches a maintenance point whose MAC address matches the target MAC address.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Verify the RlyFDB message is shown in the traceroute display when the next hop address is found in the forwarding database.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Verify the RlyMPDB message is shown in the traceroute display when the next hop address is found in the CCDN.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 8   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                NTP-G285 Managing the Card EFM Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                This procedure changes the EFM settings of the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Perform any of the following tasks as needed:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Stop. You have completed this procedure.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                DLP-G639 Enabling EFM for a Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                This task allows you to enable or disable EFM for each port on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Retrieve or higher


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Note


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                You can enable EFM on both UNI and NNI ports. You cannot enable or disable EFM for ports that belong to a channel group. For information about interaction of EFM with other protocols, see the “11.14.2  Protocol Compatibility list” section on page 11-62.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 1   Verify that the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card is installed in L2-over-DWDM mode. See the DLP-G379 Changing the GE_​XP, 10GE_​XP, GE_​XPE, and 10GE_​XPE Card Mode.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 2   In card view, click the Provisioning > EFM > Configuration tabs. The EFM details appear for each port.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 3   From the EFM State drop-down list, choose Enabled.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 4   Click Apply to enable EFM for that port.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  From the EFM State drop-down list, choose Disabled to disable EFM for that port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  DLP-G640 Configuring EFM Parameters

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  This task allows you to configure EFM parameters on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Retrieve or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 1   Verify that the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card is installed in L2-over-DWDM mode. See the DLP-G379 Changing the GE_​XP, 10GE_​XP, GE_​XPE, and 10GE_​XPE Card Mode.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 2   In card view, click the Provisioning > EFM > Configuration tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 3   Modify the EFM parameter settings as described in the table.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Table 152 EFM Parameter Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Options

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    (Display only) Port number (n-n) and rate (GE or TEN_GE).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    EFM State

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Sets the state of the EFM protocol for each port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    • Enabled

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    • Disabled

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Mode

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Sets the operating mode of the port. If the mode is Active, the port sends OAM Protocol Data Units (OAMPDUs) at regular intervals to the partner ports. If the mode is Passive, the port will not send OAMPDUs until the partner ports send OAMPDUs.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    • Active

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    • Passive

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Link Fault

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Sets the Remote Failure Indication (RFI) action. If the link is down on a port, the link fault RFI is sent to the partner port through OAMPDU. An alarm indicating the remote failure indication link fault (RFI-LF) is raised. The alarm is cleared after you clear the link fault condition.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    You can specify the following actions for link fault RFI:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    • Error Block—The interface is placed in the error-block state and the RFI-LF alarm is raised.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    • None—Only the RFI-LF alarm is raised.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Dying Gasp and critical events are not supported.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    • Error Block

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    • None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Session Timer

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Sets the duration up to when the EFM session is retained with the partner port without receiving OAMPDUs.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Default: 5 seconds

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Range: 2 to 30 seconds

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 4   Click Apply to save the changes.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    DLP-G641 Configuring EFM Link Monitoring Parameters

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    This task allows you to configure EFM link monitoring parameters for each port on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Retrieve or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 1   Verify that the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card is installed in L2-over-DWDM mode. See the DLP-G379 Changing the GE_​XP, 10GE_​XP, GE_​XPE, and 10GE_​XPE Card Mode
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 2   In card view, click the Provisioning > EFM > Link Monitoring tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 3   Modify the EFM link monitoring parameter settings as described in the table.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Table 153 EFM Link Monitoring Parameter Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Options

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      (Display only) Port number (n-n) and rate (GE or TEN_GE).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      EF Max

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Sets the threshold value for the maximum number of errored frames to detect during a specific period.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Range: 1 to 65535

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      EF Min

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Sets the threshold value for the minimum number of errored frames to detect during a specific period.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Range: 0 to 65535

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      EF Action

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Specifies that when the parameter value exceeds the maximum threshold value, the applicable action is None.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      When the parameter value falls below the minimum threshold value, a threshold crossing alert (transient condition) is generated.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • Squelch

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      EF Window

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Period in which the errored frame parameters are monitored.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Range: 10 to 600

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      EFP Max

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Sets the threshold value for the maximum number of errored frames within the last n frames.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Range: 1 to 65535

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      EFP Min

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Sets the threshold value for the minimum number of errored frames within the last n frames.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Range: 0 to 65535

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      EFP Action

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Specifies that when the parameter value exceeds the maximum threshold value, the applicable action is None.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      When the parameter value falls below the minimum threshold value, a threshold crossing alert (transient condition) is generated.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • Squelch

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      EFP Window

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Period in which the EFP parameters are monitored.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Range: 1 to 65535

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      EFSS Max

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Sets the threshold value for the maximum number of errored seconds within the last m seconds.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Range: 1 to 900

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      EFSS Min

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Sets the threshold value for the minimum number of errored seconds within the last m seconds.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Range: 0 to 900

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      EFSS Action

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Specifies that when the parameter value exceeds the maximum threshold value, the applicable action is None.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      When the parameter value falls below the minimum threshold value, a threshold crossing alert (transient condition) is generated.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • Squelch

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      EFSS Window

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Specifies the period when the EFSS parameters are monitored.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Range: 100 to 9000

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 4   Click Apply to save the changes.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      DLP-G642 Enabling Remote Loopback for a Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      This task allows you to enable remote loopback for each port on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Retrieve or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 1   Verify that the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card is installed in L2-over-DWDM mode. See the DLP-G379 Changing the GE_​XP, 10GE_​XP, GE_​XPE, and 10GE_​XPE Card Mode.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 2   In card view, click the Provisioning > EFM > Loopback tabs.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        The remote loopback type details appear for each port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 3   From the Remote Loopback Type drop-down list, choose Remote Loopback.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 4   Click Apply to save the changes.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        NTP-G287 Managing the Card REP Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        This procedure changes the REP settings for the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Perform any of the following tasks as needed:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Stop. You have completed this procedure.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        DLP-G713 Provisioning Administrative VLAN for Ports in a REP Segment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        This task allows you to provision administrative VLAN for NNI and UNI ports in a REP segment on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Retrieve or higher


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Note


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        One administrative CVLAN and one administrative SVLAN can be provisioned for each card. The REP segments using NNI ports send Hardware Flood Layer (HFL) messages using the administrative SVLAN. The REP segments using UNI ports send HFL messages using the administrative CVLAN. The two VLANs need not be the same.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 1   Verify that the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card is installed in L2-over-DWDM mode. See DLP-G379 Changing the GE_​XP, 10GE_​XP, GE_​XPE, and 10GE_​XPE Card Mode.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 2   In card view, click the Provisioning > REP > Admin VLAN Configuration tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 3   To provision administrative VLAN for NNI ports in a REP segment, perform the following steps:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          1. From the SVLAN drop-down list, choose a SVLAN. The following table describes the REP convergence time for SVLANs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Table 154 REP Convergence Time for SVLANs

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            SVLAN

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Administrative VLAN

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            REP Convergence Time

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            0 (default)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Not configured

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            4 to 5 seconds

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            1 to 4093

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Configured

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Less than 200 milliseconds

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          2. Click Apply
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          3. To associate the chosen SVLAN with the NNI ports, see “DLP-G382 Adding SVLANS to NNI ports” task.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 4   To provision administrative VLAN for UNI ports in a REP segment, perform the following steps:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          1. Enter the CVLAN in the CVLAN field.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          2. Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          3. To associate the CVLAN with the UNI ports, see “DLP-G384 Provisioning the QinQ settings” task.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          DLP-G645 Creating a Segment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          This task allows you to create a segment on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Retrieve or higher


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Note


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • You can create up to three segments on a card. Each segment can have up to two ports on the same switch.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • You must configure the REP administrative VLAN to activate the Hardware Flood Layer (HFL).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • Before creating REP segments, you must configure the administrative VLAN or use the default VLAN 1 and add the ports to the segment. Only one SVLAN can be configured per card for all the three segments. REP uses the administrative VLAN to flood its own control traffic.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • The administrative CVLAN is required if a REP port is configured as a UNI port. However, the REP ports are configured as NNI ports in many configurations, and hence the administrative CVLAN is not required in these configurations. The option to configure the administrative CVLAN is present in CTC.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • You must configure two edge ports in the segment. A segment has only one primary edge port. If you configure two ports in a segment as the primary edge port, for example, ports on different switches, REP selects one of the ports to serve as the primary edge port based on port priority.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • If REP is enabled on two ports on a switch, both the ports must be either regular ports or edge ports. However, if the No-neighbor port is configured, one port can be an edge port and another port can be a regular port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • You can also optionally configure where to send segment topology change notifications (STCNs) and VLAN load balancing (VLB). STCNs are enabled only for primary edge ports. VLB configurations are enabled on any edge ports. For information about interaction of REP with other protocols, see the “11.14.2  Protocol Compatibility list” section on page 11-62


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 1   Verify that the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card is installed in L2-over-DWDM mode. SeeDLP-G379 Changing the GE_​XP, 10GE_​XP, GE_​XPE, and 10GE_​XPE Card Mode.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 2   In card view, click the Provisioning > REP > Segment tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 3   Click Create.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 4   Enter the segment ID in the Segment field. The range of the segment ID is from 1 to 1024.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 5   From the Port drop-drown list, choose a REP port that must belong to this segment.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Note    A REP port can belong to only one segment.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 6   From the Port Role area, choose whether you want to configure the port as an edge port or a regular port. The options are:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            1. Edge—The port is configured as an edge port.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              • Check the Primary check box to configure the edge port as a primary edge port. A segment can have only one primary edge port.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                If an edge port is configured as primary edge port, the other edge port in the ring automatically becomes secondary edge port. If neither edge port is configured as primary edge port, one edge port is automatically selected as primary edge port, and the other edge port is secondary edge port. Configuring an edge port as a primary edge port is not mandatory. However, it is recommended since VLAN load balancing must be configured on the node with the primary edge port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              • Uncheck the Primary check box to configure the edge port as a secondary edge port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              • (Optional) Check the Preferred check box to configure the regular or edge port as a preferred alternate port (alternate to primary edge port). This port blocks a range of SVLANs for VLAN load balancing. There is no limit on the number of preferred ports in a REP ring. The preferred port, if configured, is relevant even without VLAN load balancing, as it takes priority over non-preferred ports for alternate port election.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Configuring a port as preferred does not ensure that it becomes the alternate port; it only gets preference over the other ports that are not configured as preferred when an alternate port is elected.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              • Check the NoNeighbor check box if the edge port must not have a neighbor port. REP does not check for neighbor adjacency.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                When the NoNeighbor check box is checked, ensure that only one segment is created.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            2. None—The port is configured as a regular port. If you choose this option, Segment Topology Change Notifications (STCN) and VLAN Load Balancing (VLB) configurations are disabled.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Check the Preferred check box to configure the regular port as a preferred alternate port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 7   From the STCN area, configure the destination of STCN messages:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            1. Check the Enable check box to enable sending STCN messages.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            2. From the Port drop-down list, choose the STCN port to send STCN messages or enter the segment ID in the Segment field to send STCN messages. The STCN port and REP port must be unique.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 8   From the VLAN Load Balancing area, configure VLAN Load Balancing on the primary edge port:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            1. Check the Enable check box to enable VLB.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            2. Enter a single SVLAN or range of SVLANs in the SVLAN field. These SVLANs are blocked at the alternate ports. The primary edge port blocks the remaining VLANs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            3. Enter the Rep PortId in the Rep PortId field to identify the VLAN blocking alternate port. This unique port ID is automatically generated when REP is enabled.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            4. Check the Preferred check box to select the segment port previously identified as the preferred alternate port for VLAN load balancing.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              When you check Preferred under VLAN Load Balancing area, you configure VLAN load balancing to use one of the previously configured preferred ports (under the Port Role area) to be the load balancing port. This restricts the load balancing port to be one among the preferred ports, but you cannot select a specific preferred port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 9   From the VLB Preempt Delay area, enter the trigger delay for automatic VLB activation. The range is 15 to 300 seconds.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 10   Click Next.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 11   Enter the details of the second port to add it to the segment.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 12   Repeat step6 to step 10 when the first port is configured as a regular port and the second port is configured as a primary edge port. Repeat step 6 to step 7 when the first port is configured as a primary edge port and the second port is configured as a regular port.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 13   Click Finish.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 14   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            DLP-G646 Editing a Segment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            This task allows you to edit a segment on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Retrieve or higher


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Note


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            You can edit only the STCN and VLB entries for a segment.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 1   Verify that the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card is installed in L2-over-DWDM mode. See DLP-G379 Changing the GE_​XP, 10GE_​XP, GE_​XPE, and 10GE_​XPE Card Mode.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 2   In card view, click the Provisioning > REP > Segment tabs. The list of segments appear.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 3   Choose a segment from the list of segments.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 4   Click Edit.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 5   Modify the values as required and click Finish.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 6   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              DLP-G647 Activating VLAN Load Balancing

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              This task allows you to activate VLAN load balancing on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Retrieve or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 1   Verify that the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card is installed in L2-over-DWDM mode. See DLP-G379 Changing the GE_​XP, 10GE_​XP, GE_​XPE, and 10GE_​XPE Card Mode.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 2   In card view, click the Provisioning > REP > Segment tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 3   Choose a segment from the list of segments.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 4   Click Activate VLB.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                When VLAN load balancing is activated, the default configuration is manual preemption with the delay timer disabled.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                DLP-G648 Deactivating VLAN Load Balancing

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                This task allows you to deactivate VLAN load balancing on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Retrieve or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 1   Verify that the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card is installed in L2-over-DWDM mode. See DLP-G379 Changing the GE_​XP, 10GE_​XP, GE_​XPE, and 10GE_​XPE Card Mode.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 2   In card view, click the Provisioning > REP > Segment tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 3   Choose a segment from the list of segments.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 4   Click Deactivate VLB.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  NTP-G165 Modifying the Ethernet, Line and PM Thresholds

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  This procedure changes Ethernet, line, and PM threshold settings for the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 1   As needed, complete the NTP-G103 Backing Up the Database procedure, to preserve the existing transmission settings.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 2   Verify the card mode:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    1. Display the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE card in card view.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    2. Click the Provisioning > Card tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    3. Verify that the card mode is set to the mode designated by your site plan:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 3   Complete the “DLP-G380 Provisioning ethernet settings” task.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 4   If the ONS-SC-E1-T1-PW or ONS-SC-E3-T3-PW SFP is inserted in the GE_XPE card, complete the following tasks, as needed.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 5   If the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card mode is L2-over-DWDM, complete the following tasks, as needed. If the card mode is not L2-over-DWDM, continue with step 7.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 6   Complete the following tasks, as needed:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Stop. You have completed this procedure.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    DLP-G380 Provisioning Ethernet Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    This task changes the Ethernet settings for the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card where you want to change the Ethernet settings. The card view appears.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Ether Ports > Ethernet tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 3   Modify any of the settings for the Ethernet tab as described in the table. The parameters that appear depend on the card mode.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Table 155 GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPEEthernet Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Card Mode

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Options

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      (Display only) The Port number (n-n) and rate (GE or TEN_GE).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • L2-over-DWDM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 10GE TXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 10GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 20GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      MTU

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      The maximum size of the Ethernet frames accepted by the port. The port must be in OOS/locked state.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • L2-over-DWDM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 10GE TXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 10GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 20GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Numeric. Default: 9700

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Range 64 to 9700 (for R9.1 and later) (jumbo frame)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Mode

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Sets the Ethernet mode. The port must be in OOS/locked state before setting the card mode.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      For GE_XP and GE_XPE cards that are in Y-cable protection groups, Mode must be set to 1000 Mbps for those client ports that are configured in Y-cable. 
For 10GE_XP and 
10GE_XPE cards that are in Y-cable protection groups, Mode must be set to 10000 Mbps.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • L2-over-DWDM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 10GE TXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 10GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 20GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • Auto (default)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • Display Only

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 1000 Mbps

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 10000 Mbps

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • Auto_Fdx (10Mbps Full). This option applies to ONS-SE-ZE-EL copper SFP that carries traffic from GE_XP and GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        If Mode is set to Auto on the GE_XP or GE_XPE port, autonegotiation gets enabled on the peer port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        On GE_XP card, the copper Pluggable Port Module (PPM) interface can auto-negotiate and carry traffic even when the peer interface operates at rates other than 1000 Mbps.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Flow Control

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Enables/disables flow control messaging with its peer port. When enabled, the port can send and receive PAUSE frames when buffer congestion occurs. When disabled, no PAUSE frames are transmitted and the PAUSE frames received are discarded.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Flow control messaging is symmetric and not negotiated. When flow control is enabled on one port, the other end of the link (peer port) is not considered. That is, even if flow control is disabled on the peer port, the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card will send PAUSE frames.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • L2-over-DWDM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 10GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 10GE TXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 20GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • ON—Flow control is enabled.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • OFF (default)—Flow control is disabled.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • Display Only.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Media Type

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      PROV-MISMATCH alarm is raised if the Media Type is not set to Ethernet Over DS1 (ANSI) or Ethernet Over E1 (ETSI) for ONS-SC-EOP1,Ethernet Over DS3 (ANSI) or Ethernet Over E3 (ETSI) for ONS-SC-EOP3, or DS1 Over Ethernet (ANSI) or E1 Over Ethernet (ETSI) for ONS-SC-E1-T1-PW or DS3 Over Ethernet (ANSI) or E3 Over Ethernet (ETSI) ONS-SC-E3-T3-PW. Set the correct Media Type to clear the PROV-MISMATCH alarm.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • L2-over-DWDM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 10GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 20GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • DS1 over Ethernet (ANSI) ONS-SC-E1-T1-PW)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • DS3 over Ethernet (ANSI) ONS-SC-E3-T3-PW)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • E1 Over Ethernet (ETSI) ONS-SC-E1-T1-PW)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • E3 Over Ethernet (ETSI) ONS-SC-E3-T3-PW)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Committed Info Rate

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Sets the guaranteed information rate based on the service-level agreement of the service provider. The port must be in OOS/locked state.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • L2-over-DWDM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 10GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 20GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Numeric. Default: 100%

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Range: 0 to 100%

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Granularity: 0.1%

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Committed Burst Size

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Sets the maximum number of bits that will be transferred per second. The port must be in OOS/locked state before the Committed Burst Size is provisioned.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • L2-over-DWDM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 10GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 20GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 4k (default)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 8k

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 16k

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 32k

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 64k

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 128k

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 256k

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 512k

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 1MB

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 2MB

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 8MB

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 16MB

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Excess Burst Size

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      The maximum number of bits that are credited for later transfer in the event the committed burst rate cannot be transmitted. The port must be in OOS/locked state before the Excess Burst Size is provisioned.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • L2-over-DWDM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 10GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 20GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 4k (default)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 8k

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 16k

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 32k

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 64k

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 128k

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 256k

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 512k

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 1MB

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 2MB

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 8MB

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 16MB

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      NIM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Sets the port network interface mode (NIM). This parameter classifies port types designed for the Metro Ethernet market to simplify deployment, management, and troubleshooting. The port must be in OOS/locked state before the NIM is provisioned.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      L2-over-DWDM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • UNI Mode—provisions the port as a user-to-network interface (UNI). This is the interface that faces the subscriber.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • NNI Mode—provisions the port as a network-to-network interface. This is the interface that faces the service provider network.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Egress QoS

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Enables Quality of Service (QoS) on the port’s egress or output queues. The port must be in OOS/locked state before the Egress QoS is provisioned.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      L2-over-DWDM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • Checked—QoS is enabled on the port’s egress queues.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • Unchecked—(Default) QoS is disabled on the port’s egress queues.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      MAC Learning

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Enables or disables MAC learning for the port on GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards. MAC learning is used by Layer 2 switches to learn the MAC addresses of network nodes so the Layer 2 switches send traffic to the right location. Layer 2 switches, including the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards in L2-over-DWDM mode with MAC Learning configured, maintain a MAC learning table that associates the MAC addresses and VLANs with a given port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      MAC addresses on SVLANs attached to the port must also be enabled to provision MAC address learning on GE_XPE and 10GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      MAC address table aging is 300 seconds. It cannot be changed.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      L2-over-DWDM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • Checked—MAC learning is enabled for this port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • Unchecked—(Default) MAC learning is disabled.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Ingress CoS

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Provisions the IEEE 802.1p ingress Class of Service (CoS). The CoS .1p bits set the Ethernet frame priority. The port must be in OOS/locked state before the Ingress CoS is provisioned.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Ingress CoS is used to set the priority of the Ethernet frame in the service provider network, This parameter is used to set the CoS.1p bits in the SVLAN tag.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Ingress CoS applies only to ports provisioned as UNI mode. It does not apply to ports provisioned as NNI mode.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      L2-over-DWDM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 0—(default) All incoming frames on the port will have the CoS.1p bits in the SVLAN tag set to 0.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 1—All incoming frames on the port will have the CoS.1p bits in the SVLAN tag set to 1.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 2—All incoming frames on the port will have the CoS.1p bits in the SVLAN tag set to 2.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 3—All incoming frames on the port will have the CoS.1p bits in the SVLAN tag set to 3.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 4—All incoming frames on the port will have the CoS.1p bits in the SVLAN tag set to 4.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 5—All incoming frames on the port will have the CoS.1p bits in the SVLAN tag set to 5.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 6—All incoming frames on the port will have the CoS.1p bits in the SVLAN tag set to 6.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 7—All incoming frames on the port will have the CoS.1p bits in the SVLAN tag set to 7.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • Trust—Automatically copies customer VLAN tag into the service provider VLAN tag.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • CVLAN—CoS can be provisioned based on CVLAN. For information on how CoS can be provisioned on the IEEE 802.1QinQ CVLAN tags, refer to the “DLP-G384 Provisioning the QinQ settings” task.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        If CVLAN CoS is configured on a GE_XP or a 10GE_XP card, a PROV-MISMATCH alarm is raised. Until this alarm is cleared, provisioning on the card is not possible.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        The CVLAN CoS configuration takes effect only after QinQ is configured.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Inner Ethertype (Hex)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Defines the inner Ethertype field. The Ethertype field indicates which protocol is being transported in an Ethernet frame.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      The inner Ethertype applies to ports provisioned in UNI mode only. It does not apply to ports provisioned as NNI mode. The ports must be OOS/locked before the inner Ethertype is provisioned.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      L2-over-DWDM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Numeric.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Default: 8100 (IEEE Std 802.1Q customer VLAN tag type)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Range: 0x0600 to 0xFFFF

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Outer Ethertype (Hex)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Defines the outer Ethertype field. The Ethertype field identifies which protocol is being transported in an Ethernet frame. The ports must be OOS/locked before the Outer Ethertype is provisioned.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      The PROV-MISMATCH alarm is raised on GE_XPE and 10GE_XPE cards if more than four different Outer Ethertype options are configured per card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      L2-over-DWDM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Numeric.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Default: 8100 (IEEE 802.1Q customer VLAN tag type)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Range: 0x0600 to 0xFFFF

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      IGMP Static Router Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Adds multicast-capable ports to the forwarding table for every IP multicast.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      L2-over-DWDM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • Checked—IGMP static router port is enabled.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • Unchecked—(Default) IGMP static router port is disabled.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      AIS Action

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Defines the AIS action type provisioned on the port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      L2-over-DWDM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • None—No action.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • Squelch—When an AIS packet is received on a SVLAN terminating on the UNI-port, the UNI port is squelched.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Protection Action

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Configures the standby port behavior.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Set Protection Action to None if Media Type is set to Ethernet Over DS1 (ANSI) or Ethernet Over E1 (ETSI) for ONS-SC-EOP1, Ethernet Over DS3 (ANSI) or Ethernet Over E3 (ETSI) for ONS-SC-EOP3, or DS1 Over Ethernet (ANSI) or E1 Over Ethernet (ETSI) for ONS-SC-E1-T1-PW or DS3 Over Ethernet (ANSI) or E3 Over Ethernet (ETSI) for ONS-SC-E3-T3-PW.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      L2-over-DWDM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • None—No action.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • Squelch—The laser on the standby port in a 1+1 protection group is squelched. This setting has no effect if the port is not part of the 1+1 protection group.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      The table shows the inner and outer Ethertype behavior based on the NIM setting (either NNI mode or UNI mode). When the NIM is set to UNI, and the QinQ mode is set to Selective, the Ethertype behavior depends on the SVLAN/CVLAN operation that is provisioned, either Add or Translate. (QinQ parameters are provisioned in the “DLP-G384 Provisioning the QinQ settings” task.)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      A packet can exit out of any UNI/NNI port if the outermost tag in the packet matches with the SVLAN provisioned on that port. In other words, in the egress path, the inner tags (even if present) of the packet are not matched with the inner SVLAN or CVLAN provisioned on the port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      The Committed Burst Size and Excess Burst Size must be configured based on the expected packet size to ensure that no packets are dropped when Flow Control is enabled. For example, if the CIR is 40% and packet size is 1 KB, the Committed Burst Size and Excess Burst Size should be set to 1 MB.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      When you set the Committed Info Rate above 40% on 10GE_XP and 10GE_XPE cards, the Committed Burst Size and Excess Burst Size must be set to at least 32K. The Committed Burst Size and Excess Burst Size can be increased based on the packet size and Committed Info Rate value.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Table 156 Ethertype Behavior

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Port Type/
Ethertype

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      NNI Mode

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      UNI Mode

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Transparent

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Selective
Operation: Add

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Selective
Operation: Translate

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Inner Ethertype

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Not applicable: the outer Ethertype value is used.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Not applicable: all packets are mapped over the SVLAN.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Working (card-based)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Working (card-based)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Outer Ethertype

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Working (per port)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Not applicable: the outer Ethertype is contained in the inner VLAN (same as UNI Selective mode).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Not applicable: the outer Ethertype is the one contained in the inner VLAN.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      This cannot be set by port, only by card. The outer Ethertype is automatically set to the inner Ethertype.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      DLP-G684 Provisioning the PDH Ethernet Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      This task changes the PDH Ethernet settings for the GE_XPE card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the GE_XPE card where you want to change the PDH Ethernet settings. The card view appears.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Ether Ports > PDH Ethernet Parameters tabs. The PDH Ethernet Parameters tab appear only when the . The PDH Ethernet Parameters tab is available in GE_XPE card view only, provided the PPM for GE_XPE port is created in FE mode.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 3   Modify any of the settings for the PDH Ethernet Parameters tab as described in table.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Table 157 GE_XPE Card PDH Ethernet Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Card Mode

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Options

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        (Display only) The Port number (n-n) and rate.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • L2-over-DWDM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 10GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 20GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Port Name

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        (Display only) The port name.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • L2-over-DWDM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 10GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 20GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Sets the MPLS Inner Label value.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • L2-over-DWDM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 10GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 20GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Sets the MPLS Outer Label value.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • L2-over-DWDM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 10GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 20GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Sets the jitter buffer value.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • L2-over-DWDM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 10GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 20GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Table 11-7 provides jitter buffer values for different payloads.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        The traffic is down if the jitter buffer is set to >=192000 when Media Type is set to DS1 over Ethernet (ANSI) ONS-SC-E1-T1-PW) and E1 Over Ethernet (ETSI) ONS-SC-E1-T1-PW).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        (ONS-SC-E1-T1-PW only) Sets the RX sensitivity value.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • L2-over-DWDM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 10GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 20GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Only Unicast IP addresses are accepted.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • L2-over-DWDM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 10GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 20GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                         

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Only Unicast IP addresses are accepted.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • L2-over-DWDM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 10GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 20GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Table 158 Jitter Buffer Values for Various Payload Types

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Payload Type

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Jitter Buffer Value

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Lower Limit

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Upper Limit

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        T1 (DS1)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        1500

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        20000

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        T3 (DS3)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        400

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        4500

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        E1

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        1500

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        200000

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        E3

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        400

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        60000

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        DLP-G685 Provisioning the Electrical Lines

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        This task changes the Electrical Lines settings for the GE_XPE card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the GE_XPE card where you want to change the Electrical Lines settings. The card view appears.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Ether Ports > Electrical Lines tabs. The Electrical Lines tab appear only when the ONS-SC-E1-T1-PW or ONS-SC-E3-T3-PW SFP is inserted. The Electrical Lines tab is available in GE_XPE card view only, provided the PPM for GE_XPE port is created in FE mode.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 3   Modify any of the settings for the Electrical Lines > DS1 or Electrical Lines > DS3 tab as described in table.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Table 159 GE_XPE Card Electrical Lines Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Card Mode

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Options

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          (Display only) The Port number (n-n

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          ) and rate
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • L2-over-DWDM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • 10GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • 20GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Port Name

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          (Display only) The port name.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • L2-over-DWDM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • 10GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • 20GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Clock Source

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Sets the Clock Source

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • L2-over-DWDM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • 10GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • 20GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Default:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • Internal (for ONS-SC-E3-T3-PW)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • Adaptive (for ONS-SC-E1-T1-PW)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Options:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • Loopback Timing

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • Internal

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • Adaptive

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • L2-over-DWDM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • 10GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • 20GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Default:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • C-BIT (for ONS-SC-E3-T3-PW ANSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • Unframed (for ONS-SC-E3-T3-PW ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • ESF (for ONS-SC-E1-T1-PW ANSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • Framed (for ONS-SC-E1-T1-PW ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Options:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • L2-over-DWDM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • 10GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • 20GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • (for ONS-SC-E3-T3-PW ANSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • HDB3 (for ONS-SC-E3-T3-PW ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • (for ONS-SC-E1-T1-PW ANSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • HDB3 (for ONS-SC-E1-T1-PW ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • HDB3 (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • L2-over-DWDM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • 10GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • 20GE MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • 0-225 ft(for ONS-SC-E3-T3-PW ANSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • (for ONS-SC-E1-T1-PW ANSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • 0-225 ft

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • 225-450 ft

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          DLP-G381 Provisioning Layer 2 Protection Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          This task provisions the Layer 2 protection settings for the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards when the cards are provisioned in L2-over-DWDM mode.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE Layer 2 protection settings must be planned for the entire VLAN ring. One card in the ring is provisioned as the master card and one of its port is set to Blocking. The master card coordinates the protection switching for the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE in a VLAN ring.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Up to 1024 SVLANs can be protected. This protection is used in FAPS ring. When a fault occurs on the working path of FAPs ring, all the SVLANs whose protection is set, are moved to the protection path of the FAPS ring. All the SVLANs can be protected or a range of SVLANs can be protected.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Note


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          To perform this task, the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card must be in L2-over-DWDM mode. To change the card mode, complete the DLP-G379 Change the GE_​XP, 10GE_​XP, GE_​XPE, and 10GE_​XPE Card Mode task.



                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Note


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          You can choose to enable another card in the ring to be the master card. However, only one card in the ring can be provisioned as master card. Make sure that the provisioning settings on the card that was previously configured as the master are disabled as soon as another card is enabled as the master card. To perform this task complete the “DLP-G507 Enabling a master card” task.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card where you want to change the protection settings. The card view appears.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Protection tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 3   In the Status column, modify the port protection status by clicking the appropriate table cell and choosing one of the following from the drop-down list:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Forwarding—Forwards the Ethernet packets that are received by the port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Blocking—Blocks the Ethernet packets that are received by the port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              One port of the master card within a VLAN ring must be set to Blocking. All other ports must be set to Forwarding.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 4   Check the Master check box if you want the card to serve as the protection coordinator for the VLAN ring. If not, continue with step 5.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 5   From the Protection drop-down list, choose one of the following:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Enabled—Enables protection.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Disabled—Disables protection.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Forced—Converts all the SVLANs to protected SVLANs irrespective of the SVLAN protection configuration in the SVLAN database. This is applicable to a point-to-point linear topology. The SVLAN protection must be forced to move all SVLANs, including protected and unprotected SVLANs, to the protect path irrespective of provisioned SVLAN attributes.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 6   From the Hold Off Time drop-down list, choose one of the following:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Disabled (default)—A FAPS switchover occurs immediately.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • 50 msec, 100 msec, 200 msec, 500 msec, 1 sec, 2 sec, or 5 sec—Holds off FAPS protection for the selected duration.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              To get consistent results ensure Hold Off Time values are the same throughout the ring.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              FAPS is an Layer 2 protection enabled on a VLAN. When a fiber fault occurs, Layer 1 protection is triggered immediately to restore the traffic. Setting the Hold Off Time option prevents Layer 2 FAPS protection from triggering at the same time as Layer 1 protection thereby avoiding traffic hits.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 7   Click Protect SVLAN's to protect the SVLANs.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            The Protect All SVLAN's dialog appears.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            1. Choose the Select All option to protect all the SVLANs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            2. Choose the Range option to provide the range of SVLANs to protect.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Upto 1024 SVLANs can be protected. SVLANs that are in use are excluded.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            3. Click OK.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 8   Set the following parameters for FAPS switching with CRC errors:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            1. Switch with CRC Alarm—Check this check box to enable FAPS switching with CRC errors.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            2. CRC Threshold—Threshold for CRC error count. The default CRC threshold value is 10(-e)2. The available options are 10(-e)2, 10(-e)3, and 10(-e)4.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            3. CRC Soak Count—Number of times the CRC error rate exceeds the CRC threshold value before raising the DATA-CRC alarm. The default CRC Soak Count is 10. The valid range is from 3 to 10.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            4. CRC Poll Interval—Time interval (in seconds) between the successive polls. The default CRC Poll Interval is 60 seconds.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              For example, if the CRC Threshold value = 10(-e)2, CRC Soak Count = 10, and CRC Poll Interval = 60 seconds, then FAPS occurs when the incoming CRC error rate is more than 10(-e)2 continuously across 10 poll intervals (10*60 = 600 seconds).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            5. Clear/Suppress CRC Alarm—Uncheck the Clear/Suppress CRC Alarm check box for FAPS to occur. If you check this check box, the DATA-CRC alarm gets cleared and FAPS does not occur.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              As along as the Clear/Suppress CRC Alarm checkbox is checked, the DATA-CRC alarm is not raised on that port and FAPS does not occur.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              For consistent result, ensure that all the values that are set in Step 7 are same throughout the ring.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 9   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 10   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            DLP-G507 Enabling a Different GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE Card as Master Card

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            This task provisions another GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card on a stable VLAN ring, to be the master card when the cards are provisioned in L2-over-DWDM mode.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Layer 2 protection must be enabled for the entire VLAN ring. One card in the ring is provisioned as the master card and one of its port is set to Blocking. The master card coordinates the protection switching for the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE cards in a VLAN ring.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            DLP-G381 Provisioning layer 2 protection settings, page 11-41

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            To perform this task, the card must be in L2-over-DWDM mode. To change the card mode, complete the DLP-G379 Changing the GE_​XP, 10GE_​XP, GE_​XPE, and 10GE_​XPE Card Mode .

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            You can choose to enable another card in the ring to be the master card. However, only one card in the ring can be provisioned as master card. Make sure that the provisioning settings on the card that was previously configured as the master are disabled as soon as another card is enabled as the master card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card in a VLAN ring where you want to enable master card provisioning.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 2   Perform the following steps:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              1. Click the Provisioning > Protection tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              2. From the Status drop-down list, choose Blocking for a trunk port.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                One port of the master card within a VLAN ring must be set to Blocking. All other ports must be set to Forwarding.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              3. Check the Master check box for the card that serves as the protection coordinator for the VLAN ring.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              4. From the Protection drop-down list, choose Enabled.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              5. Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 3   The master card provisioning on the other card must be disabled. Perform the following steps:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              1. Click the Provisioning > Protection tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              2. Uncheck the Master check box for the card where Master node provisioning must be disabled.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              3. Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              4. From the Protection drop-down list, choose Disabled.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              5. Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 4   The protection on the card that was disabled in step 2 must be enabled again. Perform the following steps:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              1. Click the Provisioning > Protection tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              2. From the Protection drop-down list, choose Enabled.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              3. Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              4. From the Status drop-down list, choose Forwardingon both ports.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              5. Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              DLP-G382 Adding SVLANS to NNI Ports

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              This task adds or removes service provider VLAN (SVLAN) provisioning to/from GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE ports. This task only applies to GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards in 
L2-over- DWDM mode.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card where you want to change the SVLAN port settings. The card view appears.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 2   Click the Provisioning > SVLAN tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 3   For each SVLAN shown in the table, click the check box under the Port [port name] table cell to include the SVLAN in that port. If you do not want the SVLAN included, uncheck the check box.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                If no SVLANs appear in the SVLAN tab, complete the DLP-G421 Creating and Storing an SVLAN Database.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                DLP-G383 Provisioning the Quality of Service Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                This task provisions the Weighted Round Robin (WRR) value and bandwidth for QoS Class of Service (CoS) egress queues on a GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE card port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card where you want to change the QoS settings.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 2   Click the Provisioning > QoS tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 3   In the Port field at the bottom of the window, choose the port where you want to provision the QoS settings.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 4   For each CoS egress queue, 0 through 7, define the following:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • WRR weight—sets the Weighted Round Robin (WRR) level for the CoS egress queue. The default is 1. The range is 0 to 15, where 0 is Strict Priority.)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    The GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE define a set of eight queues, one queue for each CoS. Only one of the queues can be assigned the 0 WRR weight (Strict Priority).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • Bandwidth—sets the bandwidth allocated for the CoS egress queue, 100 is the default. This bandwidth value is the percentage (%) of bandwidth with respect to the SFP, XFP, or port speed (100 Mbps for FE, 1 Gbps for GE, and 10 Gbps for 10GE) of the interface.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 5   Click Apply. Click Yes in the confirmation dialog box.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 6   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  DLP-G470 Provisioning the CoS Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  This task provisions Class of Service (CoS) settings on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • To perform this task, the card must be in L2-over-DWDM mode and the port must be in OOS state.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card where you want to change the CoS settings.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 2   Complete Ingress CoS section in the “DLP-G380 Provisioning ethernet settings” task.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 3   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    DLP-G384 Provisioning the QinQ Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    This task provisions the IEEE 802.1QinQ VLAN tags on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card UNI ports. QinQ tags expand the VLAN capability by tagging the tagged packets to produce a “double-tagged” Ethernet frame. For service providers the expanded VLAN allows specific services to be provided on specific VLANs for specific customers, while other types of services can be provided to other customers on other VLANs.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card where you want to change the QinQ settings.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 2   Click the Provisioning > QinQ tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 3   Click the Port field and choose the port where you want to provision QinQ. Channel groups configured in UNI mode appear in the Port field along with the physical ports.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 4   Click the Mode field and choose one of the following modes from the drop-down list:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • Selective—The incoming Ethernet packet is checked against the CVLAN and SVLAN table. If the CVLAN is not found, the packet is dropped. If you choose Selective, add an entry in the QinQ tab to map the administrative CVLAN to the SVLAN (if it is not same as the one used for data).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • Transparent—All incoming packets are transported with the additional VLAN chosen in the SVLAN field. If you choose transparent, the traffic on administrative CVLAN will pass through.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 5   Click the BPDU field and choose one of the following bridge protocol data unit (BPDU) modes from the drop-down list:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • Drop (default)—If checked, drops incoming packets with any of the following destination MAC addresses. The BPDU default can be applied for any UNI port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 01-80-c2-00-00-00—IEEE 802.1D

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 01-80-c2-00-00-02—Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 01-80-0c-cc-cc-cc—VLAN Spanning Tree Plus (PVST+)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 01-00-c-cc-cc-cc—Cisco Discovery Protocol (CDP) type 0x2000, VLAN Trunk Protocol (VTP) type 0x2003, Port Aggregation Protocol (PAgP), type 0x0104, Uni-Directional Link Detection (UDLD) type 0x111, Dynamic Trunking Protocol (DTP) type 0x2004

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • Tunnel—If checked, transparently sends any of the destination MAC addresses listed above.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 6   If the Mode was set to Selective, complete the following steps. If not, continue with step 7.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      1. To add a row, click Add.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      2. Click the CVLAN table and type in the CVLAN range. You can enter a single value or a range using “–” between the two ends of the range.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        If you are using Software Release 8.5 or earlier, it is recommended that you do not specify a CVLAN range due to certain limitations in the feature.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      3. Click the SVLAN table cell and choose an SVLAN from the drop-down list.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      4. Click the Operation table cell and choose an operation:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • Add (default)—Adds the SVLAN on top of the CVLAN. The operation default can be applied for any UNI port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • Translate—CVLAN is translated with the SVLAN value.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • Double Add—(GE_XPE and 10GE_XPE cards only) Adds an inner and an outer SVLAN to double tagged packets only. CVLAN settings are not required. If this double tagged selective operation is present on a port, no other selective operation can be present.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • Translate Add—(GE_XPE and 10GE_XPE cards only) CVLAN gets translated to inner SVLAN and the SVLAN is added.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          If Double Add and Translate Add are configured on a GE_XP or a 10GE_XP card, a PROV-MISMATCH alarm is raised. Until this alarm is cleared, provisioning on the card is not possible.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          A CVLAN with a value of 0 means “untagged packet”.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Two or more CVLANs cannot be translated over the same SVLAN.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      5. (GE_XPE and 10GE_XPE cards only) Click the COS table cell and choose a value from the drop down list.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      6. Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      7. Continue with step 9.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 7   If the Mode was set to Transparent, in the SVLAN field, choose the SVLAN to be added to incoming packets.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 8   Click DSCP-Cos mapping Table to provision CoS based on DSCP for each port.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 9   For each DSCP, choose a CoS value from 0 to 7 and click OK.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 10   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      DLP-G221 Enabling MAC Address Learning on SVLANs

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      This task enables MAC address learning on SVLANS for GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      VLANs must already be created on the selected card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 1   Complete the following tasks, as needed:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 2   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        DLP-G460 Enabling MAC Address Learning on SVLANs for GE_XPE or 10GE_XPE Cards

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        This task enables MAC address learning on SVLANs attached to the port of a GE_XPE or 10GE_XPE card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Provisioning or higher


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Note


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        MAC address learning is applicable only for GE_XPE and 10GE_XPE cards. If MAC address learning is configured on a GE_XP or a 10GE_XP card, a PROV-MISMATCH alarm is raised. Until this alarm is cleared, provisioning on the card is not possible.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the GE_XPE or 10GE_XPE card where you want to enable MAC address learning.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 2   Enable MAC address learning on the port. Perform the following steps:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          1. Click Provisioning > Ethernet.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          2. Check the MAC Learning check box.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          If the per port MAC address learning is configured on a GE_XP or 10 GE_XP cards, before upgrading to a GE_XPE or 10 GE_XPE card, enable MAC address learning per SVLAN. Not doing so disables MAC address learning.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 3   Enable MAC address learning on the SVLAN attached to the port. Perform the following steps:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          1. Click SVLAN > SVLAN DB tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          2. Click Load. This loads an SVLAN database from a network node or local file and replaces any SVLANs that are in the network view VLAN DB table.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          3. Check the MAC Learning check box related to the SVLAN (one or more than one SVLAN) to be configured with MAC address learning.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          4. Click Store. This records and enables the new configuration.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 4   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          DLP-G385 Provisioning the MAC Filter Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          This task provisions the MAC address filter for the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE cards when the cards are provisioned in L2-over-DWDM mode. The MAC address filter is a list of MAC addresses whose packets should be accepted or dropped.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card where you want to change the MAC filter settings.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Security > MAC Filter tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 3   Click the port for which you want to create a MAC filter.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 4   Click Edit.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 5   In the Edit MAC Address dialog box, click Add. A new table entry appears with the MAC address 00-00-00-00-00-00.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 6   In the MAC Address Port field, type in the MAC address you want to filter over the default 00-00-00-00-00-00 address.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 7   If you want to add more MAC addresses, repeat step 5 and step 6. (Up to eight MAC addresses can be added for each port.) If not, click OK.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 8   On the MAC Filter table, provision the Allowed check box:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Checked—All MAC addresses different from the address(es) entered in the table will be dropped.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Unchecked—All MAC addresses matching the address(es) entered in the table will be dropped.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 9   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 10   Repeat step 3 to step 9 for each port of the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card that you want to set up.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 11   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            NTP-G237 Retrieving and Clearing MAC Addresses on SVLANs

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            This procedure retrieves and clears MAC addresses learned on GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Provisioning or higher


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Caution


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Retrieving and clearing learned MAC addresses are CPU intensive and traffic affecting. You must clear the MAC addresses only during a scheduled maintenance window.



                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Note


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            It is not possible to simultaneously retrieve learned MAC addresses from both CTC and TL1 interfaces.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 1   In the node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card where you want to retrieve the MAC addresses.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 2   To retrieve the MAC addresses learned, perform the following steps:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              1. Click Maintenance > MAC Addresses > Learned.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              2. In the SVLAN field, type a valid SVLAN range. The SVLAN range is from 1 to 4093.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              3. Click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                The table displays the following fields:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • MAC Address—Displays the MAC address for the port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • VLAN—Displays the VLAN identifier for the port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Port—Displays the port number.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              4. Right-click the column heading to display the following options:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Row Count—Displays the number of learned MAC addresses retrieved.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Sort Column—Sorts the table by the column’s values.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Hide Column—Hides the column from view.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Reorder Columns Visibility—Displays all hidden columns.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 3   Click Refresh to refresh the list of MAC addresses learned.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 4   Click Clear to clear the MAC addresses learned on all the SVLANS of the card.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              It is not possible to delete the MAC addresses learned on a per SVLAN basis.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 5   To view card MAC addresses, complete the “DLP-G546 Viewing MAC Addresses on a card” task.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Stop. You have completed this procedure.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              DLP-G546 Viewing MAC Addresses on a Card

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              This task allows you to view the MAC addresses for each client and trunk port and the CPU port of the card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 1   To view the card MAC addresses, click Maintenance > MAC Addresses > Card. The MAC addresses for each client and trunk port and the CPU port are displayed.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                The table displays these fields:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Port—Displays the port number.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • MAC Address—Displays the MAC address for the port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 2   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                NTP-G311 Provisioning the Storm Control Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                This task provisions the storm control settings for the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE cards when the cards are provisioned in L2-over-DWDM mode.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                To perform this task, the card must be in L2-over-DWDM mode. To change the card mode, complete the DLP-G379 Changing the GE_​XP, 10GE_​XP, GE_​XPE, and 10GE_​XPE Card Mode .

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card where you want to change the storm control settings.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Security > Storm Control tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 3   Modify any of the settings as described in table.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Table 160 Storm Control Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Options

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  (Display only) The Port number (n-n) and rate (GE or TEN_GE).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  DLF Storm Control

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Enables or disables DLF storm control on the card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • Checked—DLF storm control is enabled.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • Unchecked—DLF storm control is disabled.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  DLF Storm Control Threshold (pps)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Threshold value to set the number of unknown unicast packets per second.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Range: 0 to 16777215 packets per second

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Mcast Storm Control

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Enables or disables Multicast storm control on the card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • Checked—Multicast storm control is enabled.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • Unchecked—Multicast 
storm control is disabled.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Mcast Storm Control Threshold (pps)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Threshold value to set the number of multicast packets per second.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Range: 0 to 16777215 packets per second

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Bcast Storm Control

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Enables or disables Broadcast storm control on the card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • Checked—Broadcast storm control is enabled.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • Unchecked—Broadcast storm control is disabled.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Bcast Storm Control Threshold (pps)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Threshold value to set the number of broadcast packets per second.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Range: 0 to 16777215 packets per second

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 4   Click Apply.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Stop. You have completed this procedure.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  NTP-G205 Enabling Link Integrity on a Card

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  This task enables link integrity on GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Complete these tasks, as needed:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Stop. You have completed this procedure.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  DLP-G509 Enabling Link Integrity Using CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  This task enables link integrity on GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 1   From the View menu, choose Go to Network View.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 2   Create or load an SVLAN profile. To create a SVLAN profile see the DLP-G471 Creating SVLAN or CVLAN Profile task.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Make sure the Link Integrity check box is selected to enable link integrity for a profile and save it to the node.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 3   Associate the SVLAN profile (with Link Integrity enabled) to a SVLAN on a port. To do this perform these steps:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    1. In node view (single-shelf mode), or shelf view (multishelf mode), double-click the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card. The card view appears.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    2. Click the Provisioning > Profiles Mapping > SVLAN tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    3. Enter the SVLANs or SVLAN range in the SVLAN to View text box.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      A table appears that displays SVLANs and available ports. The SVLAN profiles that was created must be applied to a SVLAN and a port. However, make sure the SVLAN has already been associated with the port via the QinQ tab (For information on how to associate a SVLAN to a port, see the “DLP-G384 Provisioning the QinQ settings” task).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    4. Select the SVLAN for a port and choose the available SVLAN profile from the drop-box.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    5. Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 4   AIS action must be set on a per-UNI port basis. Select None or Squelch from the AIS action drop-down list. For detailed instructions, see the “DLP-G380 Provisioning ethernet settings” task.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    DLP-G289 Provisioning CVLAN Rate Limiting on a Card

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    This task provisions CVLAN rate limiting on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 1   From the View menu, choose Go to Network View.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 2   Create or load a CVLAN profile by setting Committed Info Rate, Committed Burst, Excess Info, Excess Burst. To create a CVLAN Profile see the “DLP-G471 Creating SVLAN or CVLAN Profile” task on page 11-57.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      You cannot provision CVLAN rate limiting on channel groups.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 3   Associate the CVLAN profile to a CVLAN on a UNI port. To do this perform theae steps:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      1. In node view (single-shelf mode), or shelf view (multishelf mode), double-click the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE card. The card view appears.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      2. Click the Provisioning > Profiles Mapping > CVLAN tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      3. Enter the CVLANs or CVLAN range in the CVLANS to View text box.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        A table appears that displays CVLANs and available ports. The CVLAN profiles that were created must be applied to a CVLAN and port. However, make sure the CVLAN has already been associated with the port via the QinQ tab (For information on how to associate a CVLAN profile to a UNI port, see the “DLP-G384 Provisioning the QinQ settings” task on page 11-46).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      4. Select the CVLAN for a given port and choose the available CVLAN profile from the drop-down list.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      5. Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 4   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      NTP-G208 Provisioning SVLAN Rate Limiting on a Card

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      This task provisions SVLAN rate limiting on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Complete the following tasks, as needed:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Stop. You have completed this procedure.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      DLP-G515 Provisioning SVLAN Rate Limiting Using CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      This task provisions SVLAN rate limiting on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 1   From the View menu, choose Go to Network View.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 2   Create or load a SVLAN profile by setting Committed Info Rate, Committed Burst, Excess Info, Excess Burst. To create a SVLAN Profile see the DLP-G471 Creating SVLAN or CVLAN Profile task.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 3   Associate the SVLAN profile to a SVLAN on a port. To do this, perform the following steps:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        1. In node view (single-shelf mode), or shelf view (multishelf mode), double-click the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE card. The card view appears.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        2. Click the Provisioning > Profiles Mapping > SVLAN tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        3. Enter the SVLANs or SVLAN range in the SVLAN to View text box.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          A table appears that displays SVLANs and available ports. The SVLAN profiles that were created must be applied to a SVLAN and port. However, make sure the SVLAN has already been associated with the port via the QinQ tab (For information on how to associate a SVLAN profile to a UNI port, see the DLP-G384 Provisioning the QinQ settings task and to a NNI port see the DLP-G382 Adding SVLANS to NNI ports task).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        4. Select the SVLAN for a given port and choose the available SVLAN profile from the drop-down list.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        5. Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 4   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        DLP-G471 Creating SVLAN or CVLAN Profile

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        This task creates an SVLAN profile.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Provisioning or higher


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Note


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        You cannot associate SVLAN or CVLAN profiles to channel groups. You can associate a CVLAN profile only to a UNI port.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 1   From the View menu, choose Go to Network View.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 2   Click the Provisioning > SVLAN > Profiles tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 3   Click Add and a profile is added to the Profiles tab. Modify any of these settings:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • Name—The profile name can be up to 32 alphanumeric/special characters.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • Committed Info Rate—Sets the guaranteed information rate based on the service-level agreement of the service provider. The valid value ranges from 0 to 100% with 0.1% granularity. The default value is 100%.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • Committed Burst—Sets the maximum number of bits that will be transferred per second.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • Peak Info rate—Sets the maximum access rate based on the service-level agreement of the service provider. The valid value ranges from 0 to 100% with 0.1% granularity. The default value is 100%. However, the value must be greater than or equal to the Committed Info Rate.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • Peak Burst Size—The maximum number of bits that are credited for later transfer in the event the committed burst rate cannot be transmitted.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • Link Integrity—Enables link integrity for the SVLAN profile. Do not check this check box if you are creating a CVLAN profile.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            When you set the Committed Info Rate above 40% on 10GE_XP and 10GE_XPE cards, the Committed Burst Size and Excess Burst Size must be set to at least 32K. The Committed Burst Size and Excess Burst Size can be increased based on the packet size and Committed Info Rate value.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 4   Click Store.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          In the Store Profile(s) dialog box, choose one of the following:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • To Node(s)—Stores the SVLAN profile at one or more network nodes. Choose the network nodes where you want to store the SVLAN profile. To choose more than one node, press the Shift key, or click Select All.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • To File—Stores the SVLAN profile in a file. Enter a file name, then click Browse to navigate to a local or network drive where you want to store the file.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 5   Click OK.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 6   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          NTP-G204 Enabling IGMP Snooping on a Card

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          This procedure enables Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) snooping on a per-SVLAN basis on GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Complete the following tasks, as needed:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Stop. You have completed this procedure.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          DLP-G511 Enabling IGMP Snooping, Fast Leave, Report Suppression, and Protection

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          This procedure explains how to enable IGMP snooping, IGMP fast leave and IGMP report suppression on GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE cards using CTC.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 1   From the View menu, choose Go to Network View.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 2   Click the Provisioning > SVLAN > SVLAN DB tabs. Click Load to load the SVLANs on the card where IGMP must be enabled.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 3   For each SVLAN shown in the table, select the following:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Protection—Check the Protection check box to protect the SVLAN.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Check the Protect All SVLANS check box to protect all the SVLANs. Up to 1024 SVLANs can be protected.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • MAC Learning—(GE_XP card only) Check the MAC Learning check box to enable or disable MAC learning for the port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • IGMP—Check the IGMP check box to enable IGMP for the selected SVLAN.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • IGMP Fast Leave—Checking the IGMP Fast Leave check box causes the switch to immediately remove a port from the IP multicast group when it detects an IGMP, version 2 (IGMPv2) leave message on that port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • IGMP Suppression—Check the IGMP Suppression check box to enable a single IGMP report to be sent to each multicast group in response to a single query.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 4   Click Store SVLAN DB.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            If card protection is enabled and one or more SVLANs are not protected, CTC informs the user that protection check box is disabled on one or more SVLANs. This allows the user to check the Protection check box for SVLANs if required.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            In the Store SVLAN DB dialog box, choose one of the following:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • To Node/Shelf/Card—Select the node and shelf. All the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE cards in L2 over DWDM mode are displayed. Select the card where you want to store the SVLAN DB.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Stores the SVLAN database at one or more network nodes. Choose the network nodes where you want to store the SVLAN database. To choose more than one node, press the Shift key, or click Select All.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • To File—Stores the SVLAN database in a file. Enter a file name, then click Browse to navigate to a local or network drive where you want to store the file.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Select the card on which you want to save the changes made in step 3.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 5   Click OK.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            If you want to add the multicast-capable ports to the forwarding table for every IP multicast, select the IGMP Static Router Port check box as described in the DLP-G380 Provisioning ethernet settings task.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 6   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            NTP-G206 Enabling MVR on a Card

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            This procedure enables Multicast VLAN Registration (MVR) on GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Complete the following tasks, as needed:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Stop. You have completed this procedure.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            DLP-G513 Enabling MVR Using CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            This procedure enables Multicast VLAN Registration (MVR) on GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE cards using CTC.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            DLP-G382 Adding SVLANS to NNI ports

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode), or shelf view (multishelf mode), double-click the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card where you want to enable MVR. The card view appears.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              At least one SVLAN must be configured on the card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 2   Click the Provisioning > MVR tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 3   Check the Enabled check box and enter the following information:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              • IGMP CVLAN—Check box to enable IGMP snooping on CVLAN. This check box is enabled only when MVR is enabled through the Enabled check box.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              • Multicast SVLAN—Select the MVR SVLAN ID. The default value is the SVLAN with the lowest ID configured on the card. The drop box lists all the SVLANs on the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                SVLAN selected here can not be used for UNI port, make sure that the corresponding SVLAN on the NNI port is checked.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              • Multicast Address—Sets the specified multicast group address as the MVR multicast group. The default address is 239.255.255.255 and the range is 224.0.0.0 to 239.255.255.255. Except the subrange [224-239].[0/128].0.x.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              • Count—Sets the range of any additional multicast group addresses. The default is 1, and range is 1 to 256.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 4   Click Apply
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              DLP-G386 Provisioning the Trunk Port Alarm and TCA Threshold

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              This task changes the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card trunk port alarm and TCA thresholds.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Provisioning or higher


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Note


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              The GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards have two trunk ports. The GE_XP and GE_XPE trunk ports are 21-1 and 22-1 on the card graphic and 21 (Trunk) and 22 (Trunk) on the Optics Thresholds table. The 10GE_XP and 10GE_XPE card trunk ports are 3-1 and 4-1 on the card graphic and 3 (Trunk) and 4 (Trunk) on the Optics Thresholds table.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card where you want to change the trunk port alarm and TCA settings.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Optics Thresholds tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                You must modify 15 Min and 1 Day independently. To do so, choose the appropriate radio button and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Do not modify the Laser Bias parameters.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                The hardware device that plugs into a TXP, MXP, GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, 10GE_XPE or ADM-10G card faceplate to provide a fiber interface to the card is called a Small Form-factor Pluggable (SFP or XFP). In CTC, SFPs and XFPs are called pluggable port modules (PPMs). SFPs/XFPs are hot-swappable input/output devices that plug into a port to link the port with the fiber-optic network. Multirate PPMs have provisionable port rates and payloads. For more information about SFPs and XFPs, see the “11.26  SFP, SFP+, XFP, CXP, and CFP Modules” section.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 3   If TCA is not selected, click TCA and then click Refresh. When TCA is selected, continue with step 4.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 4   Verify the trunk port TCA thresholds are provisioned as shown in table. Provision new thresholds as needed by double-clicking the threshold value you want to change, deleting it, entering a new value, and hitting Enter.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Table 161 GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPECard Trunk Interface TCA Thresholds

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Pluggable Port Module (XFP)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                TCA RX
Power High

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                TCA RX
Power Low

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                TCA TX
Power High

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                TCA TX
Power Low

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                XFP WDM no FEC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                –7

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                –23

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                6

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                –4

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                XFP WDM standard FEC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                –7

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                –27

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                6

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                –4

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                XFP WDM Enhanced FEC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                –7

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                –27

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                6

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                –4

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 5   Under Types, click the Alarm radio button and click Refresh.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Do not modify the Laser Bias parameters.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 6   Verify the trunk port alarm thresholds are provisioned as shown in table. Provision new thresholds as needed by double-clicking the threshold value you want to change, deleting it, entering a new value, and hitting Enter.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Table 162 GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPECard Trunk Interface Alarm Thresholds

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Pluggable Port Module (XFP)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Alarm RX
Power High

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Alarm RX
Power Low

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Alarm TX
Power High

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Alarm TX
Power Low

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                XFP WDM no FEC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                –5

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                –26

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                5

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                –3

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                XFP WDM standard FEC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                –5

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                –30

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                5

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                –3

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                XFP WDM Enhanced FEC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                –5

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                –30

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                5

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                –3

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 7   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 8   Repeat step 3 to step 7 to provision the second trunk port.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 9   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                DLP-G387 Provisioning the Client Port Alarm and TCA Thresholds

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                This task provisions the client port alarm and TCA thresholds for the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                DLP-G726 Preprovisioning a Multirate PPM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Required

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Provisioning or higher


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Note


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                The GE_XP card has 20 client ports. The ports are 1-1 through 20-1 on the card graphic and 1 (Client) through 20 (Client) on the Optics Thresholds table. The 10GE_XP card has 2 client ports. The ports are 1-1 and 2-1 on the card graphic and 1 (Client) and 2 (Client) on the Optics Thresholds table.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                The hardware device that plugs into the card faceplate to provide a fiber interface to the card is called a Small Form-factor Pluggable (SFP or XFP). In CTC, SFPs and XFPs are called pluggable port modules (PPMs). SFPs/XFPs are hot-swappable input/output devices that plug into a port to link the port with the fiber-optic network. Multirate PPMs have provisionable port rates and payloads. For more information about SFPs and XFPs, see the SFP, SFP+, QSFP+, XFP, CXP, CFP, and CPAK Modules section.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card where you want to change the client port alarm and TCA settings.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Optics Thresholds tabs. The TCA thresholds are shown by default.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  1. If TCA is not selected, click TCA and then click Refresh. When TCA is selected, continue with step 4.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  2. Verify the client port TCA thresholds are provisioned as shown in table. Provision new thresholds as needed by double-clicking the threshold value you want to change, deleting it, entering a new value, and hitting Enter.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Table 163 GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPECard Client Interface TCA Thresholds

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Pluggable Port Module (XFP)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    TCA RX
Power High

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    TCA RX
Power Low

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    TCA TX
Power High

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    TCA TX
Power Low

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    10GE LAN PHY 10GBASE-LR

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    1

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    –14

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    5

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    –12

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    1000Base-SX (1Gbps)5

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    0

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    –17

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    3

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    –16

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    1000Base-LX 1

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    –3

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    –20

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    3

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    –16

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    5 Gigabit Ethernet client
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    You must modify 15 Min and 1 Day independently. To do so, choose the appropriate radio button and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 3   Under Types, click the Alarm radio button and click Refresh.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Do not modify the Laser Bias parameters.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 4   Verify the client port Alarm thresholds are provisioned as shown in table. Provision new thresholds as needed by double-clicking the threshold value you want to change, deleting it, entering a new value, and hitting Enter.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Table 164 GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPEcard Client Interface Alarm Thresholds

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Pluggable Port Module (XFP)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Alarm RX
Power High

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Alarm RX
Power Low

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Alarm TX
Power High

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Alarm TX
Power Low

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  10GE LAN PHY 10GBASE-LR

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  3

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  –16

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  1

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  –8

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  1000Base-SX (1Gbps)6

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  3

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  –20

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  –2

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  –12

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  1000Base-SX (2Gbps)1

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  3

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  –18

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  –2

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  –12

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  1000Base-LX 1

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  0

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  –23

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  –1

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  –12

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  6 Gigabit Ethernet client
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 5   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 6   Repeat step 3 to step 5 to provision each additional client port.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 7   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  DLP-G388 Changing the RMON Threshold

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  This task changes the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card RMON threshold settings.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), display the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card where you want to change the RMON thresholds.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 2   Click the Provisioning > RMON Thresholds tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 3   Click Create. The Create Threshold dialog box appears.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 4   From the Port drop-down list, choose an individual port, or choose All to provision RMON thresholds for all ports.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 5   From the Variable drop-down list, choose an Ethernet variable. See the table for a list of available Ethernet RMON variables.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Variable descriptions were obtained from the following Internet Engineering Task Force (IETF) Requests for Comment (RFCs): RFC 3635, RFC 2233, and RFC 1757. Refer to the RFCs for additional information.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Table 165 Gigabit Ethernet RMON Variables

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Variable

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    rxTotalPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Total number of receive packets.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    ifInUcastPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    The number of packets, delivered by this sub-layer to a higher (sub-)layer, which were not addressed to a multicast or broadcast address at this sub-layer.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    ifInMulticastPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    The number of packets, delivered by this sub-layer to a higher (sub-)layer, which were addressed to a multicast address at this sub-layer. For a MAC layer protocol, this includes both Group and Functional addresses.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    ifInBroadcastPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    The number of packets, delivered by this sub-layer to a higher (sub-)layer, which were addressed to a broadcast address at this sub-layer.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    ifInDiscards

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    The number of inbound packets which were chosen to be discarded even though no errors had been detected to prevent their being deliverable to a higher-layer protocol. One possible reason for discarding such a packet could be to free up buffer space.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    ifInOctets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Total number of octets received on the interface, including framing characters.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    ifOutOctets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Total number of octets transmitted out of the interface, including framing characters.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    txTotalPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Total number of transmitted packets.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    ifOutMulticastPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    The total number of packets that higher-level protocols requested be transmitted, and which were addressed to a multicast address at this sub-layer, including those that were discarded or not sent. For a MAC layer protocol, this includes both group and functional addresses.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    ifOutBroadcastPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    The total number of packets that higher-level protocols requested be transmitted, and which were addressed to a broadcast address at this sub-layer, including those that were discarded or not sent.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    ifOutDiscards

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    The number of outbound packets which were chosen to be discarded even though no errors had been detected to prevent their being transmitted. One possible reason for discarding such a packet could be to free up buffer space.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    IfOutErrors

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Number of outbound packets or transmission units that could not be transmitted because of errors.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    dot3StatsFCSErrors

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    A count of frames received on a particular interface that are an integral number of octets in length but do not pass the FCS check.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    dot3StatsFrameTooLong

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    A count of frames received on a particular interface that exceed the maximum permitted frame size.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    dot3ControlInUnknownOpCode

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    A count of MAC control frames received on this interface that contain an opcode that is not supported by this device.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    dot3InPauseFrames

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    A count of MAC control frames received on this interface with an opcode indicating the PAUSE operation.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    dot33StatsFCSErrors

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    A count of frames received on a particular interface that are an integral number of octets in length but do not pass the FCS check.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    dot3StatsFrameTooLong

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    A count of frames received on a particular interface that exceed the maximum permitted frame size.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    dot3ControlInUnknownOpCode

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    A count of MAC control frames received on this interface that contain an opcode that is not supported by this device.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    dot3InPauseFrames

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    A count of MAC control frames received on this interface with an opcode indicating the PAUSE operation.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    dot3OutPauseFrames

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    A count of MAC Control frames transmitted on this interface with an opcode indicating the PAUSE operation.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    etherStatsCRCAlignErrors

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Total number of packets received that had a length (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets) of between 64 and 1518 octets, inclusive, but had either a bad FCS with an integral number of octets (FCS Error) or a bad FCS with a non-integral number of octets (Alignment Error).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    etherStatsUndersizePkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    The total number of packets received that were less than 64 octets long (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets) and were otherwise well formed.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    etherStatsFragments

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    The total number of packets received that were less than 64 octets in length (excluding framing bits but including FCS octets) and had either a bad Frame Check Sequence (FCS) with an integral number of octets (FCS Error) or a bad FCS with a non-integral.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    etherStatsPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    The total number of packets (including bad packets, broadcast packets, and multicast packets) received.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    etherStatsPkts64Octets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    The total number of packets (including bad packets) received that were 64 octets in length (excluding framing bits but including FCS octets).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    etherStatsPkts65to127Octets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    The total number of packets (including error packets) received that were between 65 and 127 octets in length inclusive (excluding framing bits but including FCS octets).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    etherStatsPkts128to255Octets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    The total number of packets (including error packets) received that were between 128 and 255 octets in length inclusive (excluding framing bits but including FCS octets).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    etherStatsPkts256to511Octets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    The total number of packets (including error packets) received that were between 256 and 511 octets in length inclusive (excluding framing bits but including FCS octets).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    etherStatsPkts512to1023Octets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    The total number of packets (including error packets) received that were between 512 and 1023 octets in length inclusive (excluding framing bits but including FCS octets).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    etherStatsPkts1024to1518Octets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    The total number of packets (including error packets) received that were between 1024 and 1518 octets in length inclusive (excluding framing bits but including FCS octets).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    etherStatsPkts1519to1522Octets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    The total number of packets (including error packets) received that were between 1519 and 1522 octets in length inclusive (excluding framing bits but including FCS octets).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    This variable is supported only on client ports.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    etherStatsBroadcastPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    The total number of good packets received that were directed to the broadcast address

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    etherStatsMulticastPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    The total number of good packets received that were directed to a multicast address. Note that this number does not include packets directed to the broadcast address.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    etherStatsOversizePkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    The total number of packets received that were longer than 1518 octets (for untagged packets) or 1522 octets (for tagged packets) (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets) and were otherwise well formed.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    etherStatsJabbers

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    The total number of packets received that were longer than 1518 octets (for untagged packets) or 1522 octets (for tagged packets) (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets), and were not an integral number of octets in length or had a bad FCS.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    etherStatsOctets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    The total number of octets of data (including those in bad packets) received on the network (excluding framing bits but including FCS octets).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 6   From the Alarm Type drop-down list, indicate whether the event will be triggered by the rising threshold, the falling threshold, or both the rising and falling thresholds.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 7   From the Sample Type drop-down list, choose either Relative or Absolute. Relative restricts the threshold to use the number of occurrences in the user-set sample period. Absolute sets the threshold to use the total number of occurrences, regardless of time period.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 8   Type in an appropriate number of seconds for the Sample Period.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 9   Type in the appropriate number of occurrences for the Rising Threshold.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    For a rising type of alarm, the measured value must move from below the falling threshold to above the rising threshold. For example, if a network is running below a rising threshold of 1000 collisions every 15 seconds and a problem causes 1001 collisions in 15 seconds, the excess occurrences trigger an alarm.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 10   Enter the appropriate number of occurrences in the Falling Threshold field. In most cases a falling threshold is set lower than the rising threshold.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    A falling threshold is the counterpart to a rising threshold. When the number of occurrences is above the rising threshold and then drops below a falling threshold, it resets the rising threshold. For example, when the network problem that caused 1001 collisions in 15 seconds subsides and creates only 799 collisions in 15 seconds, occurrences fall below a falling threshold of 800 collisions. This resets the rising threshold so that if network collisions again spike over a 1000 per 15-second period, an event again triggers when the rising threshold is crossed. An event is triggered only the first time a rising threshold is exceeded (otherwise, a single network problem might cause a rising threshold to be exceeded multiple times and cause a flood of events).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 11   Click OK.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 12   To view all RMON thresholds, click Show All RMON thresholds.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 13   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    DLP-G389 Changing OTN Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    This task changes the optical transport network (OTN) settings for the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPE card where you want to change the OTN settings.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 2   Click the Provisioning > OTN tabs, then choose one of the following subtabs: OTN Lines, G.709 Thresholds, FEC Thresholds, or Trail Trace Identifier.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 3   Modify any of the settings described in the tables.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      You must modify Near End and Far End; 15 Min and 1 Day; and SM and PM independently. To do so, choose the appropriate radio button and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      The table describes the values on the Provisioning > OTN > OTN Lines tab.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Table 166 GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPECard OTN Line Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Options

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      (Display only) Port number and description:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      3 (Trunk) and 4 (Trunk). 10GE_XP and 10GE_XPE cards

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      21 (Trunk) and 22 (Trunk). GE_XP and GE_XPE cards

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      ITU-T G.709 OTN

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Sets the OTN lines according to ITU-T G.709.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • Enable

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • Disable

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      FEC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Sets the OTN lines to forward error correction (FEC).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • Standard

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • Enhanced

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      SF BER

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      (Display only) Sets the signal fail bit error rate.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 1E-5

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      SD BER

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Sets the signal degrade bit error rate.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 1E-5

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 1E-6

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 1E-7

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 1E-8

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • 1E-9

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      The table describes the values on the Provisioning > OTN > ITU-T G.709 Thresholds tab.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Table 167 GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPECard ITU-T G.709 Threshold Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Options

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      (Display only) Port number and description:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      3 (Trunk) and 4 (Trunk). 10GE_XP and 10GE_XPE cards

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      21 (Trunk) and 22 (Trunk). GE_XP and GE_XPE cards

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      ES

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Errored seconds

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Numeric. Can be set for Near End or Far End, for 15-minute or one-day intervals, or for SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk). Select a bullet and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      SES

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Severely errored seconds

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Numeric. Can be set for Near End or Far End, for 15-minute or one-day intervals, or for SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk). Select a bullet and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      UAS

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Unavailable seconds

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Numeric. Can be set for Near End or Far End, for 15-minute or one-day intervals, or for SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk). Select a bullet and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      BBE

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Background block errors

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Numeric. Can be set for Near End or Far End, for 15-minute or one-day intervals, or for SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk). Select a bullet and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      FC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Failure counter

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Numeric. Can be set for Near End or Far End, for 15-minute or one-day intervals, or for SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk). Select a bullet and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      The table describes the values on the Provisioning > OTN > FEC Threshold tab.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Table 168 GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, or 10GE_XPECard FEC Threshold Settings 

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Options

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      (Display only) Port number and description:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      3 (Trunk) and 4 (Trunk). 10GE_XP and 10GE_XPE cards

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      21 (Trunk) and 22 (Trunk). GE_XP and GE_XPE cards

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Bit Errors Corrected

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Sets the value for bit errors corrected.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Numeric. Can be set for 15-minute or one-day intervals.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Uncorrectable Words

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Sets the value for uncorrectable words.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Numeric. Can be set for 15-minute or one-day intervals.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      The table describes the values on the Provisioning > OTN > Trail Trace Identifier tab.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Table 169 GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, and 10GE_XPECard Trail Trace Identifier Settings 

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Options

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      (Display only) Port number.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      2

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Sets the level.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • Section

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • Path

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Received Trace Mode

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Sets the trace mode.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • Off/None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • Manual

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Transmit

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Displays the current transmit string; sets a new transmit string. You can click the button on the right to change the display. Its title changes, based on the current display mode. Click Hex to change the display to hexadecimal (button changes to ASCII); click ASCII to change the display to ASCII (button changes to Hex).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      String of trace string size

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Disable FDI on TTIM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      If a Trace Identifier Mismatch on Section overhead alarm arises because of a J0 overhead string mismatch, no Forward Defect Indication (FDI) signal is sent to the downstream nodes if this box is checked.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • Checked (FDI on TTIM is disabled)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • Unchecked (FDI on TTIM is not disabled)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Expected

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Displays the current expected string; sets a new expected string. You can click the button on the right to change the display. Its title changes, based on the current display mode. Click Hex to change the display to hexadecimal (button changes to ASCII); click ASCII to change the display to ASCII (button changes to Hex).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      String of trace string size

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Received

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      (Display only) Displays the current received string. You can click Refresh to manually refresh this display, or check the Auto-refresh every 5 sec check box to keep this panel updated.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      String of trace string size

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      NTP-G314 Adding a Card on FAPS Ring

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      This procedure adds a GE_XP or 10GE_XP card on a FAPS ring.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Installed GE_XP or 10GE_XP cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Complete the "NTP-G179 Install the Transponder and Muxponder Cards" procedure in "Turn up a node" chapter.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      DLP-G379 Changing the GE_​XP, 10GE_​XP, GE_​XPE, and 10GE_​XPE Card Mode

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Perform any of the following tasks as needed:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Stop. You have completed this procedure.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      DLP-G687 Adding a Card Facing the Master Card on FAPS Ring

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      This procedure adds a GE_XP or 10GE_XP card that faces the master card on a FAPS ring.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 1   Verify that the GE_XP or 10GE_XP card is installed according to the requirements specified in table in DLP-G375 Installing Fiber-Optic Cables on the Y-Cable Modules in the FlexLayer Shelf task.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 2   Insert the new GE-XP card with XFP on the slot.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 3   Change the GE_XP card mode to L2-over-DWDM. See DLP-G379 Changing the GE_​XP, 10GE_​XP, GE_​XPE, and 10GE_​XPE Card Mode.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 4   Create and store an SVLAN database on the new GE_XP card. See the DLP-G421 Creating and Storing an SVLAN Database task.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 5   Enable FAPS protection on the new card.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 6   Attach SVLAN to the trunk ports of the new card.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 7   Choose OOS,DSBLD from the Admin State column for port 22 on the master card that is facing toward the new card. This action places port 22 in the blocking state and port 21 in the forwarding state.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        FAPS configuration mismatch alarm is raised on the master card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 8   Switch the traffic to the protect path.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 9   Choose OOS,DSBLD from the Admin State column for port 21 on the slave card that is facing toward the new card.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 10   Connect the fiber from the slave card (that is facing toward the new card) to the new card in segment B.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 11   Connect the fiber from the master card to the new card in segment A.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 12   Choose IS from the Admin State column for port 21 on the slave card that is facing toward the new card.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 13   Choose IS from the Admin State column for port 22 on the new card to bring up segment B.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 14   Choose IS from the Admin State column for port 21 on the new card.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        The FAPS state of the new card will be in the forwarding state for both the ports and port 21 of the slave card will be in the blocking state.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 15   Choose IS from the Admin State column for port 22 on the master card to bring up segment A.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        The FAPS state of port 21 on the master card will be in the blocking state and port 22 will be in the forwarding state. The trunk ports of the remaining GE_XP cards will be in the forwarding state. The port 21 of the slave card (that is facing toward the new card) will change to the forwarding state.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 16   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        DLP-G688 Adding a Card Between Slave Cards on FAPS Ring

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        This procedure adds a GE_XP or 10GE_XP card between the two slave cards on a FAPS ring.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 1   Verify that the GE_XP or 10GE_XP card is installed according to the requirements specified in table in the DLP-G375 Installing Fiber-Optic Cables on the Y-Cable Modules in the FlexLayer Shelf task.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 2   Insert the new GE-XP card with XFP on the slot.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 3   Change the GE_XP card mode to L2-over-DWDM. See the DLP-G379 Changing the GE_​XP, 10GE_​XP, GE_​XPE, and 10GE_​XPE Card Mode.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 4   Create and store an SVLAN database on the new GE_XP card. See the DLP-G421 Creating and Storing an SVLAN Database task.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 5   Attach SVLAN to the trunk ports of the new card.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 6   Choose OOS,DSBLD from the Admin State column for port 22 on both the slave cards that are facing toward the new card.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 7   Connect the fiber from the slave card to the new card in segment B.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 8   Connect the fiber from the master card to the new card in segment A.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 9   Choose IS from the Admin State column for port 22 on the slave card.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 10   Choose IS from the Admin State column for port 22 on the new card to bring up segment B.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 11   Choose IS from the Admin State column for port 21 on the new card.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 12   Choose IS from the Admin State column for port 21 on the slave card to bring up segment A.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 13   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          NTP-G162 Changing the ALS Maintenance Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          This procedure changes the ALS maintenance settings for the TXP, MXP, GE_XP, 10GE_XP, GE_XPE, 10GE_XPE, OTU2_XP, 100G-LC-C, 10x10G-LC, CFP-LC, 100G-CK-C, 100G-ME-C, 100ME-CKC, 100GS-CK-LC, 400G-XP-LC, WSE, MR-MXP, AR_MXP, AR_XP, and AR_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          The automatic laser shutdown (ALS) function is normally disabled. Enable ALS only when the cards are directly connected to each other.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Provisioning or higher


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Note


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          ALS is applicable only for OCn and OTN payloads.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf mode), double-click the card where you want to change the ALS maintenance settings.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 2   Click the Maintenance > ALS tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 3   Modify any of the settings described in table. The provisionable parameters are listed in the Options column in the table.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Table 170 ALS Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Options

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            (Display only) Displays the port name.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            ALS Mode

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Automatic laser shutdown. ALS provides the ability to shut down the laser when the card detects an LOS or LOS-P.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            From the drop-down list, choose one of the following:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Disable—Deactivates ALS.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Auto Restart—(Default) ALS is active. The power is automatically shut down when needed and automatically tries to restart using a probe pulse until the cause of the failure is repaired.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Manual Restart

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Manual Restart for Test

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Recovery Pulse Duration

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            (Display only) Displays the duration of the optical power pulse that begins when an amplifier restarts.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Recovery Pulse Interval

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            (Display only) Displays the interval between optical power pulses.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Currently Shutdown

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            (Display only) Displays the current status of the laser.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Request Laser Restart

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            If checked, allows you to restart the laser for maintenance.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Checked or unchecked

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 4   Click Apply. If the change affects traffic, a warning message displays. Click Yes to complete the change.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Stop. You have completed this procedure.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            NTP-G302 Configuring Loopback on a Card

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            This procedure configures or clears terminal or facility loopback on the 100G-LC-C, 10x10G-LC, CFP-LC, MR-MXP, 100G-CK-C, 100G-ME-C, 100ME-CKC, 100GS-CK-LC, 200G-CK-LC, 400G-XP-LC, and WSE cards. The loopback on the CFP-LC card can be configured on the backplane of the peer 100G-LC-C card. The facility loopback (drop) can be configured on the 100G-LC-C, CFP-LC, and 100G-CK-C cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            In WSE card, do not enable encryption with far-end client loop back. Enabling encryption with far-ed client loopback will result in sync loss until the key is exchanged. The key is exchanged only after the ODUk-AIS on the trunk is cleared.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Provisioning or higher


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Caution


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            This procedure is traffic-affecting.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf mode), double-click the card where you want to change the loopback settings.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 2   Click Maintenance > Loopback tab.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              In WSE card, do not enable encryption with far-end client loopback. This affects the traffic.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 3   Modify any of the settings described in table. The provisionable parameters are listed in the Options column of the table.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Before you configure a loopback, the port admin state must be set to OOS,MT(ANSI) or Locked,maintenance (ETSI).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Table 171 Loopback Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Options

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              (Display only) Name of the port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Admin State

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Sets the port service state unless network conditions prevent the change. For more information about administrative states, see the Administrative and Service States document.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              • IS (ANSI) or Unlocked (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              • OOS,MT (ANSI) or Locked,maintenance (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              • OOS,DSBLD (ANSI) or Locked,disabled (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              • IS,AINS (ANSI) or Unlocked,AutomaticInService (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Service State

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              (Display only) Identifies the autonomously generated state that gives the overall condition of the port. Service states appear in the format: Primary State-Primary State Qualifier, Secondary State. For more information about service states, see the Administrative and Service States document.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              • IS-NR (ANSI) or Unlocked-enabled (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              • OOS-AU,AINS (ANSI) or Unlocked-disabled,
automaticInService (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              • OOS-MA,DSBLD (ANSI) or Locked-enabled,disabled (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              • OOS-MA,MT (ANSI) or Locked-enabled,maintenance (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Loopback

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Configures or clears a port for a terminal (inward), facility (line), facility loopback (drop), or terminal loopback (drop) on the required port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              • None—Clears loopback

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              • Terminal (Inward)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              • Facility (Line)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              • Facility Loopback (Drop)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              • Terminal Loopback (Drop)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 4   Click Apply.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Stop. You have completed this procedure.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              NTP-G299 Configuring Backplane Loopback on a Card

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              This procedure configures or clears the backplane terminal or facility loopback on the 100G-LC-C, 10x10G-LC, CFP-LC, 100G-CK-C, 100G-ME-C, 100ME-CKC, and 100GS-CK-LC cards. The backplane facility (drop) loopback can be configured on the 100G-LC-C, CFP-LC, and 100G-CK-C cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              The loopback on the CFP-LC card can be configured on the backplane of the peer 100G-LC-C card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Provisioning or higher


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Caution


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              This procedure is traffic-affecting.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf mode), double-click the card where you want to change the backplane loopback settings. The card view appears.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 2   Click Maintenance > Card tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 3   Modify any of the settings described in the table. The provisionable parameters are listed in the Options column in the table.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Before you configure a backplane loopback, the port admin state must be set to OOS,MT(ANSI) or Locked,maintenance (ETSI).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Table 172 Backplane Loopback Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Options

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Admin State

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Sets the port service state unless network conditions prevent the change. For more information about administrative states, see the Administrative and Service States document.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • IS (ANSI) or Unlocked (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • OOS,MT (ANSI) or Locked,maintenance (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Service State

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                (Display only) Identifies the autonomously generated state that gives the overall condition of the port. Service states appear in the format: Primary State-Primary State Qualifier, Secondary State. For more information about service states, see the Administrative and Service States document.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • IS-NR (ANSI) or Unlocked-enabled (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • OOS-MA,MT (ANSI) or Locked-enabled,maintenance (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Loopback

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Configures or clears backplane terminal (Inward), facility (Line),or facility (Drop) loopback on the card. You can configure the backplane loopback only if the card is removed from service.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Backplane Facility

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Backplane Terminal

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Backplane Facility (Drop)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 4   Click Apply.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Stop. You have completed this procedure.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                NTP-G192 Forcing FPGA Update

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                This procedure forces an upgrade of the FPGA image on the MXP_MR_10DME_C and MXP_MR_10DME_L cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 1   Perform step 1 only if you are updating the node software, else proceed to step 2.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  1. Close the CTC window, if open.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  2. Delete the CTC Cache from the CTC Launcher browser window.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  3. Close the CTC Launcher browser window.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  4. Relaunch the CTC Launcher browser window.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 2   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf mode), double-click the MXP_MR_10DME_C or MXP_MR_10DME_L card to be upgraded.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 3   For all ports being provisioned on the card, click the Provisioning > Line tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  1. Click the Admin State table cell and choose OOS,DSBLD (ANSI) or Locked,Disabled (ETSI).
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  2. Click Apply, then Yes.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 4   Click the Provisioning > Card tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 5   Change the Card Mode as needed:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • FC-GE_ISC—Choose this option if you will provision any of the following PPM port rates: FC1G (Ports 1-1 through 4-1), FC2G (Ports 1-1 and 3-1 only), FICON1G (Ports 1-1 through 4-1), FICON2G (Ports 1-1 and 3-1 only), ONE_GE (Ports 1-1 through 4-1), ISC3 COMPAT (Ports 1-1 through 4-1), ISC3 PEER 1G (Ports 1-1 through 4-1), and ISC3 PEER 2G (Ports 1-1 and 3-1 only).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • FC4G—Choose this option if you will provision an FC4G or FICON4G PPM (Port 1-1 only).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 6   Click the Force FPGA Update button. This upgrades the FPGA image in the MXP_MR_10DME_C or MXP_MR_10DME_L card, as appropriate. The MXP_MR_10DME_C or MXP_MR_10DME_L card reboots and the FPGA now contains the updated image.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 7   For all ports being provisioned on the card, click the Provisioning > Line tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  1. Click the Admin State table cell and choose IS (ANSI) or Unlocked (ETSI).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  2. Click Apply, then Yes.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Stop. You have completed this procedure.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  NTP-G196 Forcing FPGA Update on a Card in Protection Group

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  This procedure forces an upgrade of the FPGA image on the MXP_MR_10DME_C and MXP_MR_10DME_L cards when the card is part of a protection group.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  This procedure applies to a near-end node that has two MXP_MR_10DME_C or MXP_MR_10DME_L cards, one card acting as the working card and the other as the protect card. The far-end node has a similar configuration. The near-end working card trunk port is connected to the far-end working card trunk port. The near-end protect card trunk port is connected to the far-end protect card trunk port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 1   Perform step 1 only if you are updating the node software. Else, proceed to step 2.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    1. Close the CTC window, if open.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    2. Delete the CTC Cache from the CTC Launcher browser window.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    3. Close the CTC Launcher browser window.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    4. Relaunch the CTC Launcher browser window.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 2   Ensure traffic is running on the near-end and far-end working cards for each protection group on the MXP_MR_10DME_C or MXP_MR_10DME_L card.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 3   In node view (single-node mode) or multishelf view (multishelf mode), click the Provisioning > Protection tab.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 4   For each protection group, verify that the working card client port is reported as working/active and the protect card client port is reported as protect/standby.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 5   Repeat step 6 and step 7 for the far-end node.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 6   For each protection group on the near-end and far-end nodes, complete the DLP-G182 Apply a Lockout task to prevent traffic from switching to the protect card.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 7   At the near-end and far-end nodes, complete the NTP-G192 Forcing FPGA update task to force an upgrade of the FPGA image on the protect card.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 8   For each protection group on the near-end and far-end nodes, complete the DLP-G183 Clear a Lock-On or Lockout task to remove a lockout and return a protection group to its usual switching method.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 9   For each protection group on the near-end and far-end nodes, complete the DLP-G179 Apply a Force Y-Cable or Splitter Protection Switch task to move traffic from the working to the protect card.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 10   At the near-end and far-end nodes, complete the NTP-G192 Forcing FPGA update task to force an upgrade of the FPGA image on the working card.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 11   For each protection group on the near-end and far-end nodes, complete the DLP-G180 Clear a Manual or Force Y-Cable or Splitter Protection Switch task to clear a Force protection switch on the working card. If the protection group is revertive, this operation causes the traffic to revert to the working card. If the protection group is non-revertive, this operation causes the traffic to remain on the protect card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Stop. You have completed this procedure.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    NTP-G232 Enabling Error Decorrelator

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    This task enables error decorrelator on a TXP_MR_10EX_C, MXP_2.5G_10EX_C, or MXP_MR_10DMEX_C card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the TXP_MR_10EX_C, MXP_2.5G_10EX_C, or MXP_MR_10DMEX_C card where you want to enable error decorrelator.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line > Error Decorrelator Settings tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 3   In the Error Decorrelator Settings area, select Enable.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      To inter-operate with other cards, disable the error decorrelator.
Click the Provisioning > Line > Error Decorrelator Settings tabs and then select Disable.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Stop. You have completed this procedure.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      NTP-G315 Enabling the Wavelength Drifted Channel Automatic Shutdown Feature

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      This procedure allows you to enable or disable the wavelength drifted channel automatic shutdown feature for 40-SMR1-C, 40-SMR2-C, 80-WXC-C, 40-WXC-C, and 40-WSS-C cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 1   In the node view (single-shelf mode) or multishelf view (multishelf mode), click the Provisioning > Defaults tabs. The Node Defaults page opens.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 2   Select the card from the Defaults Selector pane where you want to enable or disable the wavelength drifted channel automatic shutdown feature.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 3   Select the <card name>.config.card.WavelengthDrift from the Default Name column. Choose Disable or Enable from the Default Value drop-down list for the selected card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        For example, if you select 40-SMR2-C card from the Defaults Selector folder, the Default Name column reads “40-SMR2-C.config.card.WavelengthDrift”.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 4   Click Apply to save changes.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Stop. You have completed this procedure.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        NTP-G316 Enabling REP and FAPS on the Same Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        This task allows you enable REP and FAPS on the same port for the GE_XP and 10GE_XP cards. You can configure REP and FAPS on port 22 and 21 for GE_XP cards, and port 4 and 3 for 10GE_XP cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        The FAPS master node on the edge ring should never be the node that has a common FAPS and REP port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 1   To enable REP, complete the following procedures:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          1. DLP-G645 Creatig a segment
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          2. DLP-G647 Activating VLAN load balancing
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 2   To enable FAPS, complete the DLP-G381 Provisioning layer 2 protection settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Stop. You have completed this procedure.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          NTP-G321 Provisioning Multiple Operating Modes

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          This procedure enables you to provision multiple operating modes on the AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card where you want to provision an operating mode. The card view appears.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Card tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 3   In the Card tab, click Create.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 4   From the Card Config Rate Selection section, select Low Rate Mode or High Rate Mode.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 5   In the Card Config Selection section:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            1. Choose the Operating Mode from the drop-down list.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              The Operating Mode options vary depending on the Card Type (AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE) and Card Config Rate Selection.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            2. For MXP_DME and MXPP_DME card modes, choose the Client Trunk Mapping from the drop-down list. For other card modes, CTC automatically selects the client trunk mapping.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 6   Click Next.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 7   Select the appropriate trunk port that is available and click Next.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 8   Select the appropriate client port that is available and click Finish.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            The selected operating mode is provisioned on the AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            When you want to upgrade the FPGA image on the AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card, click the FPGA/FIRMWARE Upgrade button. This upgrades the FPGA image on the AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card as appropriate, without the need of upgrading the whole network.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Stop. You have completed this procedure.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            NTP-G322 Modifying the Card Line Settings and PM Parameter Thresholds

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            This procedure changes the line and PM parameter threshold settings of the AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 1   As needed, complete the NTP-G103 Backing Up the Database task, to preserve the existing transmission settings.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 2   Perform any of the following tasks as needed:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Stop. You have completed this procedure.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              DLP-G695 Changing the Card Line Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              This task changes the line settings of the AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card where you want to change the line settings.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line > Ports tabs. Tabs and parameter selections vary according to PPM provisioning.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 3   Modify any of the line settings in the Ports tab as described in table.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Table 173 AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE Card Line Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Options

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                (Display only) Displays the port number.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                1 through 10

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Port Name

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Assigns a logical name for the specified port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                User-defined. Name can be up to 80 alphanumeric or special characters, or both. Blank by default.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                See, DLP-G104 Assigning a Name to a Port
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                You can provision a string (port name) for each fiber channel/FICON interface on the AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card, which allows the MDS Fabric Manager to create a link association between that SAN port and a SAN port on a Cisco MDS 9000 switch.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Admin State

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Sets the port service state unless network conditions prevent the change. For more information about administrative states, see the Administrative and Service States document.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • IS (ANSI) or Unlocked (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • OOS,DSBLD (ANSI) or Locked,disabled (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • OOS,MT (ANSI) or Locked,maintenance (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • IS,AINS (ANSI) or Unlocked,AutomaticInService (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Service State

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                (Display only) Identifies the autonomously generated state that gives the overall condition of the port. Service states appear in the format: Primary State-Primary State Qualifier, Secondary State. For more information about service states, see the Administrative and Service States document.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • IS-NR (ANSI) or Unlocked-enabled (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • OOS-AU,AINS (ANSI) or Unlocked-disabled,
automaticInService (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • OOS-MA,DSBLD (ANSI) or Locked-enabled,disabled (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • OOS-MA,MT (ANSI) or Locked-enabled,maintenance (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                ALS Mode

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Sets the ALS function mode.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Disabled (default)— ALS is off; the laser is not automatically shut down when traffic outage or loss of signal (LOS) occurs.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Manual Restart— ALS is on; the laser automatically shuts down when traffic outage or loss of signal (LOS) occurs. However, the laser must be manually restarted when conditions that caused the outage are resolved.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Manual Restart for Test— Manually restarts the laser for testing.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                AINS Soak

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Sets the automatic in-service soak period. Double-click the time and use the up and down arrows to change settings.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Duration of valid input signal, in hh.mm format, after which the card state changes to in service (IS) automatically.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • 0 to 48 hours, 15-minute increments.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Reach

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Sets the optical reach distance of the client port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                The reach distances that appear in the drop-down list depend on the card:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Autoprovision—The system automatically provisions the reach from the pluggable port module (PPM) reach value on the hardware.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • I1—Intermediate reach

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • S1—Short reach, up to 15-km distance

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • S2—Short reach up to 40-km distance

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • L1—long reach, up to 40-km distance

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • L2—long reach, up to 80-km distance

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • L3—long reach, up to 80-km distance

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • CWDM— CWDM Reach

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • MM—

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • ULH—Ultra long-haul (ULH)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • DWDM—DWDM Reach

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Wavelength

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Displays the wavelength of the client port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • First Tunable Wavelength

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Further wavelengths:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • 850 nm through 1561.83 nm

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • 100-GHz ITU spacing

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • CWDM spacing

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Fault Signalling

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Shuts down the far-end laser in response to certain defects. (Squelch does not apply to ISC COMPACT payloads.)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • G AIS/Send Local Fault

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Squelch/Laser-Off

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • NOS

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Termination Mode

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Sets the mode of operation. (This option is only available for SONET/SDH payloads).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Transparent

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                DLP-G698 Changing the AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE Card Section Trace Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                This task changes the section trace settings of the AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card where you want to change the section trace settings.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line > Section Trace tabs. Tabs and parameter selections vary according to PPM provisioning.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 3   Modify any of the settings in the Section Trace tab as described in the table.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Table 174 AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE Card Line Section Trace Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Options

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  (Display only) Displays the port number.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • Client Ports (1-8)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Received Trace Mode

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Sets the received trace mode.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • Off/None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • Manual

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Disable AIS/RDI on TIM-S

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  If a TIM on section overhead alarm arises because of a J0 overhead string mismatch, no alarm indication signal is sent to downstream nodes if this box is checked.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • Checked (AIS/RDI on TIM-S is disabled)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • Unchecked (AIS/RDI on TIM-S is not disabled)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Transmit Section Trace String Size

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Sets the trace string size.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • 1 byte

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • 16 byte

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Transmit

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Displays the current transmit string or sets a new transmit string. Click the button on the right to change the display. Its title changes, based on the current display mode. Click Hex to change the display to hexadecimal (button changes to ASCII); click ASCII to change the display to ASCII (button changes to Hex).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  For OCn and OTU traces, the junk squares appear in the New Transmit String field when you click the default button. Ignore the junk squares that appear in the New Transmit String field.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  String of trace string size

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Expected

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Displays the current expected string or sets a new expected string. Click the button on the right to change the display. Its title changes, based on the current display mode. Click Hex to change the display to hexadecimal (button changes to ASCII); click ASCII to change the display to ASCII (button changes to Hex).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  For OCn and OTU traces, the junk squares appear in the New Expected String field when you click the default button. Ignore the junk squares that appear in the New Expected String field.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  String of trace string size

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Received

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  (Display only) Displays the current received string. Click Refresh to manually refresh this display, or select the Auto-refresh every 5 sec check box to keep this panel updated.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  String of trace string size

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Auto-refresh

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  If checked, automatically refreshes the display every 5 seconds.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Checked or unchecked (default)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  DLP-G699 Enabling Auto-sensing for AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE Cards

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  This task enables the auto sensing for AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card where you want to enable auto sensing.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line > Auto Ports tabs. Tabs and parameter selections vary according to PPM provisioning.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 3   Modify any of the settings in the Auto Ports tab as described in table.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Table 175 AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE Auto Sensing Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Options

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    (Display only) Displays the port number.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Client Ports (1-8)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Auto Sensing

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    If checked, enables auto sensing.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Checked or Unchecked

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Actual Port Type

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Displays the auto-sensed signal type.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 4   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    DLP-G701 Changing the AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE Card Line RMON Thresholds

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    This task changes the line threshold settings for AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE cards carrying Ethernet, FC/FICON, or ISC/ISC3 payloads.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card where you want to change the line RMON threshold settings in card view.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line Thresholds > RMON Thresholds tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 3   Click Create.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 4   From the Port drop-down list, choose the applicable port, either the payload port, for example “1-1 (ONE_GE)”, or the equivalent ITU-T G.7041 GFP (Generic Frame Procedure) port.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 5   From the Variable drop-down list, choose an Ethernet, FC, FICON, or ISC variable. To change the values of the variables, see the following tables.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Table 176 AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE Card Ethernet Variables

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Variable

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      ifInOctets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Number of bytes received since the last counter reset.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      rxTotalPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Total number of received packets.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      ifInUcastPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Number of packets delivered by this sublayer to a higher sublayer that are not addressed to a multicast or broadcast address.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      ifInMulticastPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Number of packets delivered by this sublayer to a higher sublayer that are addressed to a multicast address. For a MAC layer protocol, this includes both group and functional addresses.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      ifInBroadcastPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Number of packets delivered by this sublayer to a higher sublayer that are addressed to a broadcast address.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      ifInErrors

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Total number of received errors.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      ifOutOctets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Total number of octets transmitted out of the interface, including framing characters.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      txTotalPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Total number of transmitted packets.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      IfOutUcastPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Total count of good frames transmitted to a unicast group destination address.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      ifOutMulticastPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Total number of packets that higher-level protocols requested to be transmitted, which were addressed to a multicast address at this sublayer. These include packets that were discarded or not sent. For a MAC layer protocol, this includes both group and functional addresses.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      ifOutBroadcastPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Total number of packets that higher-level protocols requested to be transmitted, which were addressed to a broadcast address at this sublayer. These include packets that were discarded or not sent.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      dot3StatsFCSErrors

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Number of frames received on a particular interface that are an integral number of octets in length but do not pass the FCS check.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      dot3StatsAlignmentErrors

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Total number of frames received on a particular interface that are not an integral number of octets in length and do not pass the FCS check. This counter is only valid for FE modes of operation.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      dot3StatsFrameTooLong

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Number of frames received on a particular interface that exceed the maximum permitted frame size.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      dot3StatsSymbolErrors

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Number of frames received on an associated RX_ER assertion during a data reception error event (MII) or data reception error event, or carrier extension error (GMII) from the PCS.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      dot3StatsLayer1Errors

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Number of Layer 1 errors as defined within the following conditions:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • During Packet Reception—Layer 1 errors are only counted one time per packet. The Layer 1 error is indicated as a direct result of a line side protocol violation in which RX_DV is asserted. This is an uncommon event from which may be the reason why the device loses synchronization.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • During Interpacket Reception—The Layer 1 error is indicated as a direct result of a line side protocol violation in which RX_DV is de-asserted. This is an uncommon event. The Layer 1 error is also asserted on detection of a False Carrier indication and is asserted on detection of Erred byte (interpacket) signal encoding. When the Layer 1 error is asserted during inter-packet reception, it is only statistically asserted in the vector.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      dot3StatsLCVErrors

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Number of received line code violations at the PCS layer.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      etherStatsUndersizePkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Total number of packets received that were less than 64 octets long (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets) and were otherwise well formed.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      etherStatsFragments

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Total number of packets received that were less than 64 octets in length (excluding framing bits but including FCS octets) and had either a bad FCS with an integral number of octets (FCS Error) or a bad FCS with a non-integral number of octets (Alignment Error). Note that it is entirely normal for etherStatsFragments to increment. This is because it counts both runts (which are normal occurrences due to collisions) and noise hits.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      etherStatsPkts64Octets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Total number of packets (including bad packets) received that were 64 octets in length (excluding framing bits but including FCS octets).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      etherStatsPkts65to127Octets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Total number of packets (including bad packets) received that were between 65 and 127 octets in length inclusive (excluding framing bits but including FCS octets).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      etherStatsPkts128to255Octets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Total number of packets (including bad packets) received that were between 128 and 255 octets in length inclusive (excluding framing bits but including FCS octets).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      etherStatsPkts256to511Octets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Total number of packets (including bad packets) received that were between 256 and 511 octets in length inclusive (excluding framing bits but including FCS octets).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      etherStatsPkts512to1023Octets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Total number of packets (including bad packets) received that were between 512 and 1023 octets in length inclusive (excluding framing bits but including FCS octets).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      etherStatsPkts1024to1518Octets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Total number of packets (including bad packets) received that were between 1024 and 1518 octets in length inclusive (excluding framing bits but including FCS octets).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      etherStatsPkts1519toMaxSizeOctets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Total number of packets (including bad packets) received that were between 1519 and the maximum frame size as programmed within the RMAC Max Frame Length Configuration Register in length inclusive (excluding framing bits but including FCS octets).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      etherStatsBroadcastPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Total number of good packets received that were directed to the broadcast address. Note that this does not include multicast packets.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      etherStatsMulticastPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Total number of good packets received that were directed to a multicast address. Note that this number does not include packets directed to the broadcast address.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      etherStatsOversizePkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Total number of packets received that were longer than 1518 octets (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets) and were otherwise well-formed.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      etherStatsOversizePkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Total number of packets received that were longer than 1518 octets (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets) and were otherwise well formed.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      etherStatsJabbers

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Total number of packets received that were longer than 1518 octets (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets), and had either a bad FCS with an integral number of octets (FCS Error) or a bad FCS with a non-integral number of octets (Alignment Error).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      etherStatsOctets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Total number of octets of data (including those in bad packets) received on the network (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      etherStatsPkts1519tomaxOctets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Total number of packets (including bad packets) received that were 1591 octets in length (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      mediaIndStatsTXShortPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Number of transmitted frames containing less than the minimum permitted frame size as programmed with the transmit MAC Min Frame Length Configuration Register.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Table 177 AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE FC/FICON Variables

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Variable

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      rxTotalPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Total number of received packets.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      txTotalPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Total number of transmitted packets.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      mediaIndStatsRxFramesBadCRC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Number of received data frames with payload CRC errors when HDLC framing is used.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      mediaIndStatsTxFramesBadCRC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Number of transmitted data frames with payload CRC errors when HDLC framing is used.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      mediaIndStatsRxLcvErrors

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Number of L1 line code violations received for lower rate FC, which equate to invalid 8b10b ordered sets.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      mediaIndStatsTxLcvErrors

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Number of L1 line code violations transmitted for lower rate FC, which equate to invalid 8b10b ordered sets.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      rx8b10bWords

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Number of 8B/10B words received.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      tx8b10bWords

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Number of 8B/10B words transmitted.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Table 178 AR_MXP, AR_XP, and AR_XPE ISC Variables

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Variable

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      mediaIndStatsRxLcvErrors

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Number of L1 line code violations received for constant bit rate protocols, which equate to invalid 8b10b ordered sets.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      mediaIndStatsTxLcvErrors

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Number of L1 line code violations transmitted for constant bit rate protocols, which equate to invalid 8b10b ordered sets.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Table 179 AR_MXP, AR_XP, and AR_XPE GFP RMON Variables

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Variable

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      gfpStatsRxCRCErrors

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Total number of CRC errors with the receive transparent GFP frame.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      gfpStatsRxSblkCRCErrors

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Total number of superblock CRC errors with the receive transparent GFP frame. A transparent GFP frame has multiple superblocks which each contain fiber channel data.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      gfpStatsCSFRaised

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Number of Rx client management frames with Client Signal Fail indication.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      gfpStatsLFDRaised

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Number of Core HEC CRC Multiple Bit Errors.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      This count is only for cHEC multiple bit error when in frame. It is a count of when the state machine goes out of frame.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      gfpStatscHecRxMBitErrors

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Number of received GFP frames with single bit errors in the core header (these errors are uncorrectable).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      gfpStatstHecRxMBitErrors

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Number of received GFP frames with single bit errors in the tHec (these errors are uncorrectable).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 6   From the Alarm Type drop-down list, indicate whether the event will be triggered by the rising threshold, the falling threshold, or both the rising and falling thresholds.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      The available options are Rising Threshold, Falling Threshold, and Both Rising and Falling Threshold.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 7   From the Sample Type drop-down list, choose either Relative or Absolute.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Relative restricts the threshold to use the number of occurrences in the user-set sample period. Absolute sets the threshold to use the total number of occurrences, regardless of time period.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 8   Enter the appropriate number of seconds in the Sample Period field.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 9   Enter the appropriate number of occurrences in the Rising Threshold field.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      For a rising type of alarm, the measured value must move from below the falling threshold to above the rising threshold. For example, if a network is running below a rising threshold of 1000 collisions every 15 seconds and a problem causes 1001 collisions in 15 seconds, the excess occurrences trigger an alarm.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 10   Enter the appropriate number of occurrences in the Falling Threshold field. In most cases a falling threshold is set lower than the rising threshold.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      A falling threshold is the counterpart to a rising threshold. When the number of occurrences is above the rising threshold and then drops below a falling threshold, it resets the rising threshold. For example, when the network problem that caused 1001 collisions in 15 seconds subsides and creates only 799 collisions in 15 seconds, occurrences fall below a falling threshold of 800 collisions. This resets the rising threshold so that if network collisions again spike over a 1000 per 15-second period, an event again triggers when the rising threshold is crossed. An event is triggered only the first time a rising threshold is exceeded (otherwise, a single network problem might cause a rising threshold to be exceeded multiple times and cause a flood of events).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 11   Click OK.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      To view all RMON thresholds, click Show All RMON thresholds.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 12   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      DLP-G702 Provisioning the AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE Card with Trunk Port Alarm and TCA Thresholds

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      This task provisions the AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card with trunk port alarm and TCA thresholds.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card where you want to provision the trunk port alarm and TCA threshold settings.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Optics Thresholds tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        You must modify 15 Min and 1 Day independently. To do so, choose the appropriate radio button and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Do not modify the Laser Bias parameters.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 3   If TCA is not checked, check the TCA check box and then click Refresh. If it is checked, continue with step 4.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 4   Verify if the trunk port (Port 9) TCA thresholds are set. Provision new thresholds as needed by double-clicking the threshold value you want to change, deleting it, entering a new value, and pressing Enter.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 5   Under Types, click the Alarm radio button and click Refresh.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Do not modify the Laser Bias parameters.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 6   Verify if the trunk port (Port 9) Alarm thresholds are set. Provision new thresholds as needed by double-clicking the threshold value you want to change, deleting it, entering a new value, and pressing Enter.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 7   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 8   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        DLP-G703 Provisioning the AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE Card Client Port Alarm and TCA Thresholds

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        This task provisions the client port alarm and TCA thresholds for the AR_MXP, AR_XP, and AR_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        DLP-G278 Provision the Optical Line Rate

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Required

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card where you want to change the client port alarm and TCA threshold settings.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Optics Thresholds tabs. The TCA thresholds are shown by default.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 3   Referring to the following table, verify the TCA thresholds for client ports (ports 1 through 8) for RX Power High, RX Power Low, TX Power High, and TX Power Low based on the client interface at the other end. Provision new thresholds as needed by double-clicking the threshold value you want to change, deleting it, entering a new value, and pressing Enter.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Do not modify the Laser Bias parameters.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          You must modify 15 Min and 1 Day independently. To do so, choose the appropriate radio button and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          The hardware device that plugs into a AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card faceplate to provide a fiber interface to the card is called a Small Form-factor Pluggable (SFP or XFP). In CTC, SFPs and XFPs are called pluggable port modules (PPMs). SFPs/XFPs are hot-swappable I/O devices that plug into a port to link the port with the fiber-optic network. Multirate PPMs have provisionable port rates and payloads. For more information about SFPs and XFPs, see SFP, SFP+, QSFP+, XFP, CXP, CFP, and CPAK Modules.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Table 180 AR_MXP, AR_XP, and AR_XPE Card Client Interfaces TCA Thresholds

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          PPM Port Rate

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Pluggable Port Module 
(XFP)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          TCA RX
Power High

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          TCA RX
Power Low

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          TCA TX
Power High

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          TCA TX
Power Low

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          FC1G

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          ONS-SE-4G-SM
ONS-SC-2G-XX.X
ONS-SC-4G-XX.X

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          0

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          –17

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          3

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          –16

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          FC2G

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          ONS-SE-4G-SM
ONS-SC-2G-XX.X
ONS-SC-4G-XX.X

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          0

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          –15

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          3

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          –16

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          FICON1G

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          ONS-SE-4G-SM
ONS-SC-2G-XX.X
ONS-SC-4G-XX.X

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          0

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          –17

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          3

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          –16

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          FICON2G

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          ONS-SE-4G-SM
ONS-SC-2G-XX.X
ONS-SC-4G-XX.X

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          0

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          –17

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          3

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          –16

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          FC4G

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          ONS-SE-4G-SM
ONS-SC-2G-XX.X
ONS-SC-4G-XX.X

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          0

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          –12

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          4

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          –15

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          FICON4G

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          ONS-SE-4G-SM
ONS-SC-2G-XX.X
ONS-SC-4G-XX.X

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          0

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          –12

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          4

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          –15

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          FC8G

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          ONS-XC-8G-MM
ONS-XC-8G-SM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          0

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          –12

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          4

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          –15

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          FICON8G

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          ONS-XC-8G-MM
ONS-XC-8G-SM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          0

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          –12

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          4

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          –15

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          1GE

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          ONS-SI-GE-SX
ONS-SI-GE-LX
ONS-SI-GE-ZX
ONS-SE-ZE-EL

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          FE

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          ONS-SE-GE-BXU
ONS-SE-GE-BXD

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          ESCON

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          ONS-SE-200-MM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          OC3/STM1

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          ONS-SC-155-EL
ONS-SI-155-SR-MM
ONS-SI-155-I1
ONS-SI-155-L1
ONS-SI-155-L2

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          OC12

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          ONS-SI-622-SR-MM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          OC12/STM4

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          ONS-SI-622-I1
ONS-SI-622-L1
ONS-SI-622-L2

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          OC48/STM16

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          ONS-SI-2G-S1
ONS-SI-2G-L1
ONS-SI-2G-L2

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          OTU1

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          ONS-SI-2G-S1
ONS-SE-Z1
ONS-SI-2G-L2
ONS-SC-2G-xxxx

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          OTU2

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          ONS-XC-10G-96C

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          3G-SDI, HD-SDI, SD-SDI

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          ONS-SC-HD3GV-RX=

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 5   Repeat step 3 and step 4 to provision each additional client port.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 6   Under Types, click the Alarm radio button and click Refresh.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 7   Referring to the following table, verify the client port (Ports 1 through 8) Alarm thresholds for RX Power High, RX Power Low, TX Power High, and TX Power Low based on the client interface that is provisioned. Provision new thresholds as needed by double-clicking the threshold value you want to change, deleting it, entering a new value, and hitting Enter.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Table 181 AR_MXP, AR_XP, and AR_XPE Card Client Interface Alarm Thresholds

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          PPM Port Rate

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Pluggable Port Module 
(XFP)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Alarm RX
Power Low

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Alarm RX
Power High

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Alarm TX
Power Low

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Alarm TX
Power High

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          FC1G

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          ONS-SE-4G-SM
ONS-SC-2G-XX.X
ONS-SC-4G-XX.X

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          0

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          –17

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          3

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          –16

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          FC2G

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          ONS-SE-4G-SM
ONS-SC-2G-XX.X
ONS-SC-4G-XX.X

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          0

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          –15

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          3

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          –16

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          FICON1G

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          ONS-SE-4G-SM
ONS-SC-2G-XX.X
ONS-SC-4G-XX.X

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          0

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          –17

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          3

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          –16

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          FICON2G

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          ONS-SE-4G-SM
ONS-SC-2G-XX.X
ONS-SC-4G-XX.X

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          0

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          –17

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          3

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          –16

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          FC4G

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          ONS-SE-4G-SM
ONS-SC-2G-XX.X
ONS-SC-4G-XX.X

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          0

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          –12

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          4

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          –15

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          FICON4G

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          ONS-SE-4G-SM
ONS-SC-2G-XX.X
ONS-SC-4G-XX.X

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          0

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          –12

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          4

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          –15

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          FC8G

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          ONS-XC-8G-MM
ONS-XC-8G-SM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          0

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          –12

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          4

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          –15

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          FICON8G

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          ONS-XC-8G-MM
ONS-XC-8G-SM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          0

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          –12

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          4

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          –15

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          1GE

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          ONS-SI-GE-SX
ONS-SI-GE-LX
ONS-SI-GE-ZX
ONS-SE-ZE-EL

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          FE

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          ONS-SE-GE-BXU
ONS-SE-GE-BXD

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          ESCON

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          ONS-SE-200-MM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          OC3/STM1

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          ONS-SC-155-EL
ONS-SI-155-SR-MM
ONS-SI-155-I1
ONS-SI-155-L1
ONS-SI-155-L2

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          OC12

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          ONS-SI-622-SR-MM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          OC12/STM4

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          ONS-SI-622-I1
ONS-SI-622-L1
ONS-SI-622-L2

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          OC48/STM16

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          ONS-SI-2G-S1
ONS-SI-2G-L1
ONS-SI-2G-L2

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          OTU1

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          ONS-SI-2G-S1
ONS-SE-Z1
ONS-SI-2G-L2
ONS-SC-2G-xxxx

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          3G-SDI, HD-SDI, SD-SDI

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          ONS-SC-HD3GV-RX=

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                 
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 8   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 9   Repeat step 7 and step 8 to provision each additional client port.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 10   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          DLP-G704 Changing the AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE Card OTN Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          This task changes the OTN settings for the AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the AR_MXP, AR_XP, or AR_XPE card where you want to change the OTN settings.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 2   Click the Provisioning > OTN tabs, then choose one of the following subtabs: OTN Lines, G.709 Thresholds, FEC Thresholds, Trail Trace Identifier, or Proactive Protection Regen.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 3   Modify any of the settings described in the following tables.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            You must modify Near End and Far End; 15 Min and 1 Day; and SM and PM independently. To do so, choose the appropriate radio button and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            The following table describes the values on the Provisioning > OTN > OTN Lines tab.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Table 182 AR_MXP, AR_XP, and AR_XPE Card OTN Line Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Options

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            (Display only) Displays the port number.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            All client and trunk ports

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            G.709 OTN

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Sets the OTN lines according to ITU-T G.709.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Enabled by default

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            FEC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Sets the OTN lines to forward error correction (FEC).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Disable

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Standard

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Enhanced-I.4

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Enhanced-I.7

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            SF BER

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            (Display only) Displays the signal fail bit error rate.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • 1E-5

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            SD BER

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Sets the signal degrade bit error rate.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • 1E-5

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • 1E-6

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • 1E-7

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • 1E-8

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • 1E-9

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Asynch/Synch Mapping

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Sets how the ODUk (client payload) is mapped to the optical channel (OTUk).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Asynch mapping

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Synch mapping

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            OTU Mapping

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Sets the client payload mapping to the trunk

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • ODU1e

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • ODU2e

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • CBR10G

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • ODU1Mux

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • ODU1

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            ProvidesSync

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Sets the ProvidesSync card parameter. If checked, the card is provisioned as a NE timing reference.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Checked or unchecked

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            SyncMsgIn

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Sets the EnableSync card parameter. Enables synchronization status messages (S1 byte), which allow the node to choose the best timing source.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Checked or unchecked

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Admin SSM In

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Overrides the synchronization status message (SSM) and the synchronization traceability unknown (STU) value. If the node does not receive an SSM signal, it defaults to STU.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            STU

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Send DoNotUse

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            If checked, sends a DUS message on the S1 byte.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Checked or unchecked

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            ODU Transparency

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Sets the ODU overhead byte configuration.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Transparent Standard Use

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Cisco Extended Use

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Proactive Protection Regen

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Enables or disables the proactive protection regen mode.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Enable

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Disable

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            The following table describes the values on the Provisioning > OTN > G.709 Thresholds tab.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Table 183 AR_MXP, AR_XP, and AR_XPE ITU-T G.709 Threshold Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Options

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Port 7

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            (Display only) Displays the port number.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            9 (Trunk)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            ES

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Errored seconds

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Numeric. Can be set for Near End or Far End, for 15-minute or one-day intervals, or for SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk). Select an option and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            SES

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Severely errored seconds

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Numeric. Can be set for Near End or Far End, for 15-minute or one-day intervals, or for SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk). Select an option and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            UAS

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Unavailable seconds

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Numeric. Can be set for Near End or Far End, for 15-minute or one-day intervals, or for SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk). Select an option and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            BBE

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Background block errors

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Numeric. Can be set for Near End or Far End, for 15-minute or one-day intervals, or for SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk). Select an option and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            FC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Failure counter

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Numeric. Can be set for Near End or Far End, for 15-minute or one-day intervals, or for SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk). Select an option and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            7 Latency for a 1G-FC payload without ITU-T G.709 is 4 microseconds, and with ITU-T G.709 is 40 microseconds. Latency for a 2G-FC payload without ITU-T G.709 is 2 microseconds, and with ITU-T G.709 is 20 microseconds. Consider these values when planning a FC network that is sensitive to latency.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            The following table describes the values on the Provisioning > OTN > FEC Threshold tab.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Table 184 AR_MXP, AR_XP, and AR_XPE Card FEC Threshold Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Options

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            (Display only) Displays the port number.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            2

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Bit Errors Corrected

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Sets the value for bit errors corrected.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Numeric. Can be set for 15-minute or one-day intervals.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Uncorrectable Words

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Sets the value for uncorrectable words.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Numeric. Can be set for 15-minute or one-day intervals.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            The following table describes the values on the Provisioning > OTN > Trail Trace Identifier tab.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Table 185 AR_MXP, AR_XP, and AR_XPE Card Trail Trace Identifier Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Options

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            (Display only) Displays the port number.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            2

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Sets the level.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Section

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Path

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Received Trace Mode

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Sets the trace mode.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Off/None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Manual

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Transmit

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Displays the current transmit string or sets a new transmit string. Click the button on the right to change the display. Its title changes, based on the current display mode. Click Hex to change the display to hexadecimal (button changes to ASCII); click ASCII to change the display to ASCII (button changes to Hex).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            String of trace string size

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Disable FDI on TTIM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            If a Trace Identifier Mismatch on Section overhead alarm arises because of a J0 overhead string mismatch, no Forward Defect Indication (FDI) signal is sent to the downstream nodes if this box is checked.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Checked (FDI on TTIM is disabled)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Unchecked (FDI on TTIM is not disabled)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Expected

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Displays the current expected string or sets a new expected string. Click the button on the right to change the display. Its title changes, based on the current display mode. Click Hex to change the display to hexadecimal (button changes to ASCII); click ASCII to change the display to ASCII (button changes to Hex).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            String of trace string size

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Received

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            (Display only) Displays the current received string. You can click Refresh to manually refresh this display, or check the Auto-refresh every 5 sec check box to keep this panel updated.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            String of trace string size

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Auto-refresh

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            If checked, automatically refreshes the display every 5 seconds.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Checked

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Unchecked (default)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            DLP-G734 Viewing the Mapping of ODU Object with Client Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            This procedure allows you to view the mapping of ODU object with the corresponding client port for the AR_XPE card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the AR_XPE card to view the ODU object mapping with the corresponding client port. The card view appears.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Card ODU Interfaces tabs. Displays the parameters as described in the table.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Table 186 ODU Object and Client Port Mapping

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              ODU Object

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Displays the ODUk(k=0) AID that is used to raise the ODU0 level alarms.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Trunk Port Number

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Displays the physical trunk port details that map to the virtual ODUk(k=0) port or object.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              ODU1

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Displays the ODU1 frame number within the ODU-2 frame, which has the corresponding ODUk(k=0) frame.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              ODU0

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Displays the ODU0 frame number within a ODU1 frame.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Client Port Number

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Displays the physical client port number that maps to the virtual ODUk(k=0) port or object.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 3   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              NTP-G235 Provisioning an Operating Mode

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              This procedure enables you to provision an operating mode on the 100G-LC-C, 100G-CK-C, , 200G-CK-LC,100G-ME-C, 100ME-CKC, 10x10G-LC, CFP-LC, or MR-MXP card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the card where you want to provision an operating mode. The card view appears.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Card tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 3   In the Card tab, click Create. The Operating Mode Configuration Creation window appears.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 4   From the Card Configuration drop-down list, choose the configuration. The card configuration options vary depending on the card. If the TXP-10G, TXPP-10G, RGN-10G, or LOW LATENCY mode is selected on the 10x10G-LC card, go to Step 7. If the FANOUT-10x10G mode is selected in the 10x10G-LC card, go to Step 8.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                For more information about the card configurations, see Key Features of 100G-LC-C, 100G-ME-C, 100G-CK-C, 100ME-CKC, 10x10G-LC, 200G-CK-LC, CFP-LC, and MR-MXP Cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 5   Choose the slot number from the Peer Card drop-down list. This field is enabled only if a peer card is required for the configuration.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 6   Choose the slot number from the Skip Peer card drop-down list. This field is enabled only for MXP_200G and MXP_10x10G_100G operating modes.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 7   Select the port pair in the Card Configuration Dialog area.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                The 10x10G-LC card supports a maximum of five TXP-10G modes, two TXPP-10G modes, five RGN-10G modes, five LOW LATENCY modes, or a combination of five TXP-10G, RGN-10G, and LOW LATENCY modes. For the TXPP-10G mode configuration, client ports can be port 3, port 7, or both. Port 4 and port 6 are selected as trunk ports when port 3 is selected as the client port. Port 8 and port 10 are selected as trunk ports when port 7 is selected as the client port. For MXP_200G, MXP_10x10G_100G, and MXP_CK_100G operating modes, the required ports are selected by default.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 8   Click Finish. The selected operating mode is provisioned on the card.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 9   Complete the DLP-G726 Preprovisioning a Multirate PPM task.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 10   Complete the DLP-G278 Provisioning the Optical Line Rate task.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Stop. You have completed this procedure.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                NTP-G361 Provisioning an Operating Mode on the 400G-XP-LC Card

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                This procedure enables you to provision an operating mode on the 400G-XP-LC card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Provisioning or higher


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Note


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Provision the PPM on the trunk ports ( Port 11 and 12) of the 400G-XP-LC card before you provision the operating mode.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  To create an operating mode: To edit an operating mode: Rules for Editing an Operating Mode on the 400G-XP-LC Card Editing an Op Mode Trunk Port Client Port Restrictions/Information Modifying a slice mode within a trunk Allowed with trunk in IS Blocked if client payloads are provisioned on the slice being edited. Adding a trunk - - Related trunk PPM must be provisioned. Deleting a trunk Blocked if trunk is in IS or if trunk is associated with internal patch cords (IPCs) or provisional patch cords (PPCs). Blocked if client payloads are provisioned for the trunk being deleted Blocked, if the trunk to be deleted is the only provisioned trunk on the card. Modifying the trunk operating mode Blocked if trunk is in IS or if trunk is associated IPCs or PPCs. Blocked if client payloads are provisioned for the trunk being modified The existing OTU4 or OTU4C2 trunk port is deleted and recreated. To delete an operating mode:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the 400G-XP-LC card where you want to provision an operating mode. The card view appears.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Card tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 3   In the Card tab, click Create. The Operating Mode Configuration Creation window appears.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 4   From the Card Configuration drop-down list, choose MXP.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 5   To configure the trunk port (CFP2 - 11, CFP2 - 12, or both trunk ports), perform the following steps:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  1. Choose the operating mode from the Trunk Operating Mode drop-down list.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    If the mode selected is M_100G, the Slice 1 or Slice 3 fields are disabled.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  2. Choose the slice mode from the Slice drop-down list.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  For more information about the trunk, slice, and port configuration, see Slice Definition and Line Card Configuration for 400G-XP-LC Card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 6   Click Finish.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  The operating mode is provisioned on the card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 7   Complete the DLP-G726 Preprovisioning a Multirate PPM task.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 8   Complete the DLP-G278 Provisioning the Optical Line Rate task.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 9   In the Card tab, choose the configured operating mode and click Edit. The Operating Mode Configuration window appears.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 10   Choose the trunk port to be edited from the Edit Trunk Configuration drop-down list.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Note    Only one trunk port configuration can be edited at a time. The table above details the rules for editing an operating mode.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 11   Modify the Trunk Operating Mode and the Slice modes as needed.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 12   Click Finish.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  The operating mode is updated with the new configuration on the card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 13   Complete the DLP-G726 Preprovisioning a Multirate PPM task.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 14   Complete the DLP-G278 Provisioning the Optical Line Rate task.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 15   In the Card tab, choose the configured operating mode and click Delete.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  The operating mode is deleted.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  A card operating mode can be deleted only if client payloads are not provisioned and the trunk ports in the out-of-service (OOS) state with no IPCs or PPCs associated.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Stop. You have completed this procedure.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  NTP-G362 Manual FPGA Upgrade on the 400G-XP-LC Card

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  This procedure manually upgrades the FPGA images in the 400G-XP-LC card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Provisioning or higher


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Note


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  The manual FPGA upgrade is allowed only when there is a firmware version mismatch. A Different FPGA image available condition is raised to notify the user of the availability of a new firmware image.



                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Caution


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  This procedure is traffic-affecting.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the 400G-XP-LC card where you want to provision an operating mode. The card view appears.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Card tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 3   Click the FPGA/FIRMWARE Upgrade button.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    A warning message is displayed.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 4   Click Yes.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    The card undergoes a cold reset and the FPGA now contains the updated image. To view the firmware versions, click the Card view > Maintenance > Info tabs.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Stop. You have completed this procedure.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    NTP-G236 Modifying the 100G-LC-C, 100G-CK-C, 100G-ME-C, 100ME-CKC, 10x10G-LC, , 200G-CK-LC, CFP-LC, WSE, MR-MXP, or 400G-XP-LC Card Line Settings and PM Parameter Thresholds

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    This procedure changes the line and PM parameter threshold settings of the 100G-LC-C, 100G-CK-C, 100G-ME-C, 100ME-CKC, 10x10G-LC, CFP-LC, 200G-CK-LC, WSE, MR-MXP, or 400G-XP-LC cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 1   As needed, complete the NTP-G103 Backing Up the Database task, to preserve the existing transmission settings.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 2   Perform any of the following tasks as needed:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      To use the Alarm Profiles tab, including creating alarm profiles and suppressing alarms, see the Alarm and TCA Monitoring and Management document.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Stop. You have completed this procedure.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      DLP-G714 Changing the Card Line Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      This task changes the line settings of the 100G-LC-C, 100G-CK-C, 100G-ME-C, 100ME-CKC, 10x10G-LC, 200G-CK-LC, CFP-LC, MR-MXP, MR-MXP-LIC, WSE, or 400G-XP-LC cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the card where you want to change the line settings.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line > Ports tabs. Tabs and parameter selections vary according to pluggable port modules (PPM) provisioning.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 3   Modify any of the line settings in the Ports tab as described in the following table.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Table 188 Card Line Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Options

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        (Display only) Displays the port number.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        1 through 12

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Port Name

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Assigns a logical name for the specified port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        User-defined. Name can be up to 80 alphanumeric or special characters, or both. Blank by default.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        See the"NTP-G104 Assign a Name to a Port" task in "Maintain the Node" chapter.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Admin State

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Sets the port service state unless network conditions prevent the change. For more information about administrative states, see the Administrative and Service States document.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • IS (ANSI) or Unlocked (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • OOS, DSBLD (ANSI) or Locked,disabled (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • OOS, MT (ANSI) or Locked,maintenance (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • IS, AINS (ANSI) or Unlocked,AutomaticInService (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Service State

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        (Display only) Identifies the autonomously generated state that gives the overall condition of the port. Service states appear in the format: Primary State-Primary State Qualifier, Secondary State. For more information about service states, see the Administrative and Service States document.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • IS-NR (ANSI) or Unlocked-enabled (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • OOS-AU, AINS (ANSI) or Unlocked-disabled,
automaticInService (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • OOS-MA, DSBLD (ANSI) or Locked-enabled,disabled (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • OOS-MA, MT (ANSI) or Locked-enabled,maintenance (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • OOS-MA, LPBK&MT (ANSI) or Locked-enabled,loopback & maintenance (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        ALS Mode

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Sets the automatic laser shutdown (ALS) function mode.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • Disabled (default)— ALS is off; the laser is not automatically shut down when traffic outage or loss of signal (LOS) occurs.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • Auto Restart-ALS is on; the laser automatically shuts down when traffic outage or LOS occurs. It automatically restarts when the conditions that caused the outage are resolved.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • Manual Restart— ALS is on; the laser automatically shuts down when traffic outage or LOS occurs. However, the laser must be manually restarted when conditions that caused the outage are resolved.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • Manual Restart for Test— Manually restarts the laser for testing.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        AINS Soak

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Sets the automatic in-service (AINS) soak period. Double-click the time and use the up and down arrows to change settings.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • Duration of valid input signal, in hh.mm format, after which the card state changes to in-service (IS) automatically.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 0 to 48 hours, 15-minutes increments.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Reach

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Sets the optical reach distance of the client port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • Autoprovision—The system automatically provisions the reach from the pluggable port module (PPM) reach value on the hardware.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        The reach distances that appear in the drop-down list depends on the card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Wavelength

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Displays the wavelength of the client port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • First Tunable Wavelength

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • Further wavelengths:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • 850 nm through 1610 nm

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        OverClock

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Enables or disables overclock mode.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • OFF

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • ON

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          When an OTU2 payload is provisioned on the 10x10G-LC card in the TXP-10G or RGN-10G operating mode, the overclock parameter is automatically set to ON.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Cd (Working Range) Low

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Sets the threshold for minimum chromatic dispersion.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Cd (Working Range) High

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Sets the threshold for maximum chromatic dispersion.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        In 200G-CK-LC card, the CD (Working Range) High and CD (Working Range) Low thresholds value in Provisioning > Line > Ports tab in CTC do not change automatically after installing the 100G_SD_FEC_OR_CD_RANGE license. Hence, it is required to manually change the threshold values in CTC. Otherwise, the Chromatic Dispersion (CD) alarm is raised.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        TX SHUTDOWN


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        If checked, the Tx optical power is turned off. This can be done when the port is out of service or in maintenance.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        TX Power

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Sets the Tx power to a specific value.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        The range is from -10.0 to 0.25 dBm.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        The range for 100G is from -0.5 to -10.0 dBm; The range for 200G is from -1.5 to -10.0 dBm.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Fault Signalling

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Shuts down the far-end laser in response to certain defects. (Squelch does not apply to ISC COMPACT payloads.)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • AIS/Send Local Fault

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          AIS/Send Local Fault is not supported on all the payloads . However, this option is present in the drop-down menu in CTC to allow a proper software upgrade from the previous release.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • Squelch/Laser-Off

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          When the 100G-LC-C, 100G-CK-C, 100G-ME-C, 100ME-CKC, , 100GS-CK-LC, 200G-CK-LC cards are used in the standalone mode or with the CFP-LC card configured in the CFP-TXP mode, the value can be set to Squelch/Laser-Off or AIS/Send Local Fault on the trunk port of the 100G-LC-C, 100G-CK-C, 100G-ME-C, , 200G-CK-LC card. When the 100G-LC-C, 100G-CK-C, 100G-ME-C, 100ME-CKC, and card is used with the CFP-LC card configured CFP-MXP mode, the value can be set to AIS on the trunk port of the 100G-LC-C, 100G-CK-C, 100G-ME-C, 200G-CK-LC, and 100ME-CKC card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • LF/Local Fault —Supported for 10GE, 40GE, and 100GE payloads.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • Disable/Transparent—Supported for any data traffic such as 10GE, 8G FC, 10G FC, 40GE, 100GE.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Mapping Mode (10x10G-LC and WSE)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Sets the mapping mode.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • CBR

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          CBR mapping mode supports Sync-E transparency.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • GFP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          The mapping mode can be configured to GFP for 10GE payloads. The GFP port is placed in service when both the client and trunk ports of the 10x10G-LC card are in service.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          When the mapping mode is set to CBR on the 10x10G-LC card, the overclock parameter is set to On.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          When the mapping mode is set to GFP on the 10x10G-LC card, the overclock parameter is set to Off.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Termination Mode

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Sets the termination mode.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • Transparent

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Squelch Hold Off Timer

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        (Only for 100G-LC-C, 100G-CK-C, 100ME-CK-C, CFP-LC, 10x10G-LC, 100GS-CK-LC, 200G-CK-LC, and MR-MXP cards) Sets the period in milliseconds that the client interface waits for resolution of issues on the trunk side. The client squelching starts after this period.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        The user can configure the squelch hold off timer in CTC only under the following conditions:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • The card must be configured in TXP or MXP operating modes.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • The client payload must be 10GE or 100GE.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • The Squelch drop-down in CTC must be set to Squelch.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Note   
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • The squelch hold off timer value can be changed without changing the port admin state.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • When the squelch holdoff timer is set to a value other than 0 ms, Y-Cable cannot be provisioned.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • When the Squelch drop-down is changed from non-squelch to squelch, the squelch holdoff timer is set to 0 ms.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • When the node is upgraded to R10.5.2, the squelch hold-off timer is set to 0 ms.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • When the squelch timer value is changed, the changed value will be applicable in the next squelch interval.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • When squelch hold off timer is active, the OTU2_XP, TXP_MR_10E , and 40E-MXP-C cards send junk frames; the 100G-LC-C, 100G-CK-C, 100ME-CK-C, CFP-LC, 10x10G-LC, MR-MXP cards send Local Fault (LF).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • Disable (0 ms) - Default value

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 50 ms

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 100 ms

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 250 ms

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 500 ms

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Table 189 Reach Distances for 10x10G-LC, 100G-LC-C, 100G-CK-C, CFP-LC, MR-MXP, 200G-CK-LC, 400G-XP-LC, and WSE Cards

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Card

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Payload

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Reach

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        10x10G-LC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        OTU2

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        SR-MM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        P1I1-2D1

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        P1S1-2D2b

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        P1L1-2D2

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        DWDM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        OC192

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        SR-MM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        SR-1

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        IR-2

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        LR-2

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        DWDM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        10G FC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        10GFC-SW

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        10GFC-LW

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        10GFC-EW

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        10GFC-ZW

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        DWDM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        8G FC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        8GFC-SW

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        8GFC-LW

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        10 GE

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        TEN_GE_SR

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        TEN_GE_LR

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        TEN_GE_ER

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        TEN_GE_ZR

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        DWDM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        IB-5G

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        LX and SR-MM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        100G-CK-C

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        100 GE

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        100GBASE-SR10 and 100GBASE-LR4

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        OTU4

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        4I1-9D1F

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        40 GE

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        40GBASE-SR4

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        100G-LC-C

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        100 GE

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        100GBASE-SR10

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        CFP-LC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        40 GE

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        40GBASE-FR

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        40GBASE-LR4

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        100 GE

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        100GBASE-LR4

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        OTU3

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        VSR2000-3R2

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        C4S1-2D1

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        OTU4

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        4I1-9D1F

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        MR-MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        10 GE

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        SR

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        TEN_GE_SR

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        MR-MXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        TEN_GE_ER

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        TEN_GE_ZR

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        DWDM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        CX1

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        CWDM40km

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        100 GE

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        100GBASE-SR10

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        100GBASE-LR4

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        400G-XP-LC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Trunk ports

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        OTU4

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        DWDM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        OTU4C2

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Client ports

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        100 GE

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        100GBASE-LR4

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        100GBASE-SR4

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        OTU4

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        4I1-9D1F

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        10 GE

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        TEN_GE_LR

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        OTU2

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        P1I1 2D1

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        DLP-G715 Changing the Card Ethernet Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        This task changes the Ethernet settings of the 100G-LC-C, 100G-CK-C, 100G-ME-C, 100ME-CKC, 10x10G-LC, CFP-LC, 200G-CK-LC, MR-MXP, WSE, or 400G-XP-LC cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        The ethernet settings of the CFP-LC card can be changed on the virtual port of the peer 100G-LC-C, 100G-CK-C, 100G-ME-C, or 100ME-CKC card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the card where you want to change the Ethernet settings. The card view appears.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line > Ethernet tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 3   Modify any of the Ethernet settings in the Ethernet tab. The parameters that appear depend on the card mode.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Table 190  Card Ethernet Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Options

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          (Display only) Displays the port number n (-n) and rate.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Port Name

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          (Display only) Displays the port name.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Admin State

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Sets the port service state unless network conditions prevent the change. For more information about administrative states, see the Administrative and Service States document.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • IS (ANSI) or Unlocked (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • OOS, DSBLD (ANSI) or Locked,disabled (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • OOS, MT (ANSI) or Locked,maintenance (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • IS, AINS (ANSI) or Unlocked,AutomaticInService (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Service State

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          (Display only) Identifies the autonomously generated state that gives the overall condition of the port. Service states appear in the format: Primary State-Primary State Qualifier, Secondary State. For more information about service states, see the Administrative and Service States document.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • IS-NR (ANSI) or Unlocked-enabled (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • OOS-AU, AINS (ANSI) or Unlocked-disabled,
automaticInService (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • OOS-MA, DSBLD (ANSI) or Locked-enabled,disabled (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • OOS-MA, MT (ANSI) or Locked-enabled,maintenance (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • OOS-MA, LPBK&MT (ANSI) or Locked-enabled,loopback & maintenance (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          ALS Mode

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Sets the automatic laser shutdown (ALS) function mode.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • Disabled (default)— ALS is off; the laser is not automatically shut down when traffic outage or loss of signal (LOS) occurs.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • Manual Restart— ALS is on; the laser automatically shuts down when traffic outage or LOS occurs. However, the laser must be manually restarted when conditions that caused the outage are resolved.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • Manual Restart for Test— Manually restarts the laser for testing.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          AINS Soak

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Sets the automatic in-service (AINS) soak period. Double-click the time and use the up and down arrows to change settings.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • Duration of valid input signal, in hh.mm format, after which the card state changes to in-service (IS) automatically.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • 0 to 48 hours, 15-minutes increments.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Reach

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Sets the optical reach distance of the client port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • Autoprovision—The system automatically provisions the reach from the pluggable port module (PPM) reach value on the hardware.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            The reach distances that appear in the drop-down list depend on the card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Wavelength

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Displays the wavelength of the client port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • First Tunable Wavelength

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • Further wavelengths:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • 850 nm through 1610 nm

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          MTU

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Sets the maximum size of the Ethernet frames accepted by the port. The port must be in OOS/locked state.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Numeric. Default: 1548

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Range 64 to 9700

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Incoming MAC address

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          (100G-LC-C and 10x10G-LC)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Sets the MAC address of the incoming Ethernet signal.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Value of the MAC address. Six bytes in hexadecimal format.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Mapping Mode

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          (10x10G-LC)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Sets the mapping mode.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • CBR

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • GFP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Termination Mode

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          (Display-only) Sets the mode of operation.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • Transparent

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Video Type

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          (100G-LC-C and 10x10G-LC)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Video

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          BJ Fec (400G-XP-LC)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Enables or disables BJ Fec on 100G ethernet client interfaces based on the QSP28 pluggables used

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • Auto (default)
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            When the auto mode is used, BJ Fec is set to Off for QSFP28-LR4 and set to On for QSFP28-SR4.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • Force-Fec-On

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • Force-Fec-Off

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          DLP-G716 Changing the 10x10G-LC and WSE Card SONET/SDH Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          This task changes the SONET (OC-192)/SDH (STM-64) settings of the 10x10G-LC and WSE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the card where you want to change the SONET (OC-192)/SDH (STM-64) settings.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line > SONET (ANSI) or SDH (ETSI) tabs. Tabs and parameter selections vary according to PPM provisioning.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 3   Modify any of the settings as described in the table.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Table 191 10x10G-LC and WSE Card SONET/SDH Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Options

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            (Display only) Displays the port number.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Port Name

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Assign a name for the specified port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            User-defined. Name can be up to 80 alphanumeric or special characters, or both. Blank by default.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            DLP-G104 Assigning a Name to a Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Admin State

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Sets the port service state unless network conditions prevent the change. For more information about administrative states, see the Administrative and Service States document.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • IS (ANSI) or Unlocked (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • IS, AINS (ANSI) or Unlocked,automaticInService (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • OOS, DSBLD (ANSI) or Locked,disabled (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • OOS, MT (ANSI) or Locked,maintenance (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Service State

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            (Display only) Identifies the autonomously generated state that gives the overall condition of the port. Service states appear in the format: Primary State-Primary State Qualifier, Secondary State. For more information about service states, see the Administrative and Service States document.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • IS-NR (ANSI) or Unlocked-enabled (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • OOS-AU, AINS (ANSI) or Unlocked-disabled,
automaticInService (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • OOS-MA, DSBLD (ANSI) or Locked-enabled,disabled (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • OOS-MA, MT (ANSI) or Locked-enabled,maintenance (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            SF BER

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Sets the signal fail (SF) bit error rate (BER).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • 1E-3

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • 1E-4 (default)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • 1E-5

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            SD BER

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Sets the signal degrade (SD) bit error rate (BER).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • 1E-5

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • 1E-6

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • 1E-7 (default)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • 1E-8

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • 1E-9

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Type

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Sets the optical transport type.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • SONET (ANSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • SDH (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            ALS Mode

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Sets the automatic laser shutdown (ALS) function mode. The DWDM transmitter supports ALS according to ITU-T G.644 (06/99). ALS can be disabled or enabled for one of the three mode options.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Disabled (default)—ALS is off; the laser is not automatically shut down when traffic outage or loss of signal (LOS) occurs.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Auto Restart—ALS is on; the laser automatically shuts down when traffic outage or LOS occurs. It automatically restarts when the conditions that caused the outage are resolved.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Manual Restart—ALS is on; the laser automatically shuts down when traffic outage or LOS occurs. However, the laser must be manually restarted when conditions that caused the outage are resolved.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Manual Restart for Test—Manually restarts the laser for testing.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            AINS Soak

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Sets the automatic in-service (AINS) soak period. Double-click the time and use the up and down arrows to change settings.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Duration of valid input signal, in hh.mm format, after which the card state changes to in-service (IS) automatically.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • 0 to 48 hours, 15-minutes increments.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            ProvidesSync

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Sets the ProvidesSync card parameter. If checked, the card is provisioned as a NE timing reference.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Checked

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Unchecked

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            SyncMsgIn

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Sets the EnableSync card parameter. Enables synchronization status messages (S1 byte), which allow the node to choose the best timing source.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Checked

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Unchecked

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Send

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            DoNotUse

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            (WSE)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Sets the Send DoNotUse card state. When checked, sends a do not use (DUS) message on the S1 byte.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Checked

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Unchecked

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Admin SSM In

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Overrides the synchronization status message (SSM) and the synchronization traceability unknown (STU) value. If the node does not receive an SSM signal, it defaults to STU.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            STU

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Reach

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Sets the optical reach distance of the client port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Autoprovision—The system to automatically provision the reach from the pluggable port module (PPM) reach value on the hardware.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              The reach distances that appear in the drop-down list depend on the card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Wavelength

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Displays the wavelength of the client port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • First Tunable Wavelength

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            DLP-G717 Changing the 10x10G-LC and WSE Card Section Trace Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            This task changes the section trace settings of the 10x10G-LC and WSE cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the card where you want to change the section trace settings.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line > Section Trace tabs. Tabs and parameter selections vary according to PPM provisioning.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 3   Modify any of the settings in the Section Trace tab as described in the table.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Table 192 10x10G-LC and WSE Card Line Section Trace Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Options

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              (Display only) Displays the port number.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Received Trace Mode

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Sets the received trace mode.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              • Off/None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              • Manual

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Disable AIS/RDI on TIM-S?

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              If a trace identifier mismatch (TIM) on a section overhead alarm arises because of a J0 overhead string mismatch, no alarm indication signal (AIS) is sent to the downstream nodes if this box is checked.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              If the Received Trace Mode field is set to Manual, the Disable AIS/RDI on TIM-S? checkbox is automatically checked.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              • Checked (AIS/RDI on TIM-S is disabled)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              • Unchecked (AIS/RDI on TIM-S is not disabled)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Transmit Section Trace String Size

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Sets the trace string size.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              • 1 byte

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              • 16 byte

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Transmit

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Displays the current transmit string or sets a new transmit string.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              The transmit string cannot be configured when the termination mode is transparent.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              • Hex Mode— Click to change the display to hexadecimal (button changes to ASCII Mode).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              • ASCII Mode— Click to change the display to ASCII (button changes to Hex Mode).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                The button title changes based on the current display mode.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Expected

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Displays the current expected string or sets a new expected string.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              • Hex Mode— Click to change the display to hexadecimal (button changes to ASCII Mode).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              • ASCII Mode— Click to change the display to ASCII (button changes to Hex Mode).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                The button title changes based on the current display mode.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Received

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              (Display only) Displays the current received string.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              • Hex Mode— Click to change the display to hexadecimal (button changes to ASCII Mode).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              • ASCII Mode— Click to change the display to ASCII (button changes to Hex Mode).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                The button title changes based on the current display mode.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Auto-refresh

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              If checked, automatically refreshes the display every 5 seconds.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              • Checked

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              • Unchecked (default)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              DLP-G718 Changing the 10x10G-LC and WSE Card SONET/SDH Line Thresholds

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              This task changes the SONET/SDH line threshold settings of the 10x10G-LC card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the 10x10G-LC card where you want to change the SONET/SDH line threshold settings.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line Thresholds > SONET Thresholds (ANSI) or SDH Thresholds (ETSI) tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 3   Modify any of the settings as shown in the table.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                You must modify each of these options independently: Near End and Far End, 15 Min and 1 Day, and Line and Section. To do so, choose the appropriate radio button and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Table 193 10x10G-LC and WSE Card SONET/SDH Line Threshold Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                SONET Options

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                SDH Options

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                (Display only) Displays the port number.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Client Ports

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Client Ports

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                CV

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Coding violations (CV)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Types—Line or Section (near end only)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                EB

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Errored Block (EB)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Types—Multiplex Section or Regeneration Section (near end only)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                ES

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Errored seconds (ES)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Types—Line or Section (near end only)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Types—Multiplex Section or Regeneration Section (near end only)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                SES

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Severely errored seconds (SES)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Types—Line or Section (near end only)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Types—Multiplex Section or Regeneration Section (near end only)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                FC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                (Line or Multiplex Section only) Failure count (FC)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Types—Line or Section (near end only)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                BBE

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Background block error (BBE)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Types—Multiplex Section or Regeneration Section (near end only)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                UAS

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                (Line or Multiplex Section only) Unavailable seconds (UAS)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Types—Line or Section (near end only)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Numeric. Threshold display options include:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Direction—Near End or Far End

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Interval—15 Min (minutes) or 1 day

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                • Types—Multiplex Section or Regeneration Section (near end only)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Choose an option in each category and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                DLP-G719 Changing the Card Line RMON Thresholds

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                This task changes the line RMON threshold settings for 100G-LC-C, 100G-CK-C, 100G-ME-C, 100ME-CKC, 10x10G-LC, CFP-LC, 200G-CK-LC, MR-MXP, WSE, or 400G-XP-LC cards carrying Ethernet or FC payloads.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                The RMON threshold settings for the CFP-LC card can be changed on the virtual port of the peer 100G-LC-C, 100G-CK-C, 100G-ME-C, or 100ME-CKC card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the card where you want to change the line RMON threshold settings in the card view.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line Thresholds > RMON Thresholds tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 3   Click Create.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 4   From the Port drop-down list, choose the applicable port, either the payload port, for example “1-1 (ONEHUNDRED_GE)” port.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 5   From the Variable drop-down list, choose an Ethernet, FC, FICON, or GFP variable. See the following tables for the list of the available variables.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Table 194 Card Ethernet Variables

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Variable

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  ifInOctets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Number of bytes received since the last counter reset.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  rxTotalPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of received packets.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  ifInUcastPkts 8

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of packets delivered by this sublayer to a higher sublayer that are not addressed to a multicast or broadcast address.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  ifInMulticastPkts 1

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of packets delivered by this sublayer to a higher sublayer that are addressed to a multicast address. For a MAC layer protocol, this includes both group and functional addresses.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  ifInBroadcastPkts 1

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of packets delivered by this sublayer to a higher sublayer that are addressed to a broadcast address.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  ifInErrors

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of received errors.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  ifOutOctets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of octets transmitted out of the interface, including framing characters.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  txTotalPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of transmitted packets.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  IfOutUcastPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total count of packets transmitted to a unicast group destination address.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  ifOutMulticastPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of packets that higher-level protocols requested to be transmitted, which were addressed to a multicast address at this sublayer. These include packets that were discarded or not sent. For a MAC layer protocol, this includes both group and functional addresses.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  ifOutBroadcastPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of packets that higher-level protocols requested to be transmitted, which were addressed to a broadcast address at this sublayer. These include packets that were discarded or not sent.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  dot3StatsAlignmentErrors

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of frames received on a particular interface that are not an integral number of octets in length and do not pass the FCS check. This counter is only valid for FE modes of operation.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  dot3StatsFCSErrors

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of frames received on a particular interface that are an integral number of octets in length but do not pass the FCS check.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  dot3StatsFrameTooLong

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of frames received on a particular interface that exceed the maximum permitted frame size.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  etherStatsUndersizePkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of packets received that were less than 64 octets long (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets) and were otherwise well-formed.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  etherStatsFragments

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of packets received that were less than 64 octets in length (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets) and had either a bad FCS with an integral number of octets (FCS error) or a bad FCS with a non-integral number of octets (alignment error). Note that it is entirely normal for etherStatsFragments to increment. This is because it counts both runts (which are normal occurrences due to collisions) and noise hits.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  etherStatsPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of frames received on an interface in both Rx and Tx directions.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  etherStatsPkts64Octets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of packets (including bad packets) received that were 64 octets in length (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  etherStatsPkts65to127Octets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of packets (including bad packets) received that were between 65 and 127 octets in length inclusive (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  etherStatsPkts128to255Octets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of packets (including bad packets) received that were between 128 and 255 octets in length inclusive (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  etherStatsPkts256to511Octets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of packets (including bad packets) received that were between 256 and 511 octets in length inclusive (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  etherStatsPkts512to1023Octets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of packets (including bad packets) received that were between 512 and 1023 octets in length inclusive (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  etherStatsPkts1024to1518Octets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of packets (including bad packets) received that were between 1024 and 1518 octets in length inclusive (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  etherStatsBroadcastPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of good packets received that were directed to the broadcast address. Note that this number does not include multicast packets.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  etherStatsMulticastPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of good packets received that were directed to a multicast address. Note that this number does not include packets directed to the broadcast address.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  etherStatsOversizePkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of packets received that were longer than 1518 octets (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets) and were otherwise well-formed.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  etherStatsJabbers

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of packets received that were longer than 1518 octets (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets), and had either a bad FCS with an integral number of octets (FCS error) or a bad FCS with a non-integral number of octets (alignment error).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  etherStatsOctets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of octets of data (including those in bad packets) received on the network (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  etherStatsPkts1519tomaxOctets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of packets (including bad packets) received that were 1591 octets in length (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  pcs49RxErrBer

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  pcs49RxErrDec

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  8 The counter does not increment for traffic with incorrect Ethertype and packet size of more than 64 bytes on the 10x10G-LC and 100G-LC-C cards.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Table 195 10x10G-LC and WSE FC/FICON Variables

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Variable

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  rxTotalPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of received packets.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  txTotalPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of transmitted packets.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  mediaIndStatsRxFramesBadCRC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of received data frames with payload CRC errors when HDLC framing is used.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  mediaIndStatsTxFramesBadCRC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of transmitted data frames with payload CRC errors when HDLC framing is used.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  mediaIndStatsRxFramesTruncated

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of frames received that are less than 5 bytes. This value is a part of the high-level data link control (HDLC) and GFP port statistics.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  mediaIndStatsTxFramesTruncated

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of transmitted data frames that exceed the MTU. This value is a part of the HDLC and GFP port statistics.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  mediaIndStatsRxFramesTooLong

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of received frames that exceed the maximum transmission unit (MTU). This value is a part of the HDLC and GFP port statistics.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  mediaIndStatsTxFramesTooLong

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of transmitted data frames that are less than 5 bytes. This value is a part of the HDLC and GFP port statistics.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  ifInOctets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of octets received on the interface, including the framing octet.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  ifOutOctets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of octets transmitted out of the interface, including framing characters.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  ifInErrors

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of inbound packets that contained errors preventing them from being delivered to a higher-layer protocol.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  ifOutErrors

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of outbound packets or transmission units that could not be transmitted because of errors.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  pcs49RxErrBer

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  pcs49RxErrDec

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Table 196 10x10G-LC and WSE GFP RMON Variables

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Variable

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  gfpStatsRxFrame

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of received data frames.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  gfpStatsTxFrame

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of transmitted data frames.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  gfpStatsRxCRCErrors

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of CRC errors with the receive transparent GFP frame.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  gfpStatsRxOctets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of GFP data octets received.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  gfpStatsTxOctets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Total number of GFP data octets transmitted.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  gfpStatsRxSBitErrors

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Received GFP frames with single bit errors in the core header (these errors can be corrected).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  gfpStatsRxMBitErrors

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Received GFP frames with multiple bit errors in the core header (these errors cannot be corrected).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  gfpStatsRxTypeInvalid

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Received GFP frames with invalid type (these are discarded). For example, receiving GFP frames that contain Ethernet data when we expect Fibre Channel data.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  gfpRxCmfFrame

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  gfpRxCmfFrame

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 6   From the Alarm Type drop-down list, indicate whether the event will be triggered by the rising threshold, falling threshold, or both the rising and falling thresholds.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  The available options are Rising Threshold, Falling Threshold, and Rising and Falling Threshold.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 7   From the Sample Type drop-down list, choose either Relative or Absolute. Relative restricts the threshold to use the number of occurrences in the user-set sample period. Absolute sets the threshold to use the total number of occurrences, regardless of time period.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 8   Enter the appropriate number of seconds in the Sample Period field.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 9   Enter the appropriate number of occurrences in the Rising Threshold field.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  For a rising type of alarm, the measured value must move from below the falling threshold to above the rising threshold. For example, if a network is running below a rising threshold of 1000 collisions every 15 seconds and a problem causes 1001 collisions in 15 seconds, the excess occurrences trigger an alarm.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 10   Enter the appropriate number of occurrences in the Falling Threshold field. In most cases a falling threshold is set lower than the rising threshold.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  A falling threshold is the counterpart to a rising threshold. When the number of occurrences is above the rising threshold and then drops below a falling threshold, it resets the rising threshold. For example, when the network problem that caused 1001 collisions in 15 seconds subsides and creates only 799 collisions in 15 seconds, occurrences fall below a falling threshold of 800 collisions. This resets the rising threshold so that if network collisions again spike over a 1000 per 15-second period, an event again triggers when the rising threshold is crossed. An event is triggered only the first time a rising threshold is exceeded (otherwise, a single network problem might cause a rising threshold to be exceeded multiple times and cause a flood of events).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 11   Click OK.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  To view all RMON thresholds, check the Show All RMON thresholds checkbox.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 12   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  DLP-G720 Provisioning the Card with Trunk Port Alarm and TCA Thresholds

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  This task provisions the 100G-LC-C, 100G-CK-C, 100G-ME-C, 200G-CK-LC, 100ME-CKC, or 400G-XP-LC cards with trunk port alarm and TCA thresholds.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the 100G-LC-C, 100G-CK-C, 100G-ME-C, 200G-CK-LC, 100ME-CKC, or 400G-XP-LC card where you want to provision the trunk port alarm and TCA threshold settings.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Optics Thresholds tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    You must modify 15 Min and 1 Day independently. To do so, choose the appropriate radio button and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Do not modify the Laser Bias parameters.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 3   If TCA is not selected, click the TCA radio button and then click Refresh. If it is checked, continue with step 4.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 4   Verify if the port TCA thresholds are set. Provision new thresholds as needed by double-clicking the threshold value you want to change, deleting it, entering a new value, and pressing Enter.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 5   Under Types, click the Alarm radio button and click Refresh.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Do not modify the Laser Bias parameters.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 6   Verify if the port Alarm thresholds are set. Provision new thresholds as needed by double-clicking the threshold value you want to change, deleting it, entering a new value, and pressing Enter.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 7   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 8   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    DLP-G721 Provisioning the Client Port Alarm and TCA Thresholds

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    This task provisions the client port alarm and TCA thresholds for the 100G-LC-C, 10x10G-LC, CFP-LC, MR-MXP, 100G-CK-C, 100G-ME-C, , 200G-CK-LC, 100ME-CKC, and 400G-XP-LC cards.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    The client port alarm and TCA thresholds cannot be provisioned on the QSFP+ ports of the MR-MXP cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Required

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the card where you want to change the client port alarm and TCA threshold settings.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Optics Thresholds tabs. The TCA thresholds are shown by default.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 3   Verify if the TCA thresholds for client ports for RX Power High, RX Power Low, TX Power High, and TX Power Low parameters are set based on the client interface at the other end. Provision new thresholds as needed by double-clicking the threshold value you want to change, deleting it, entering a new value, and pressing Enter.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Do not modify the Laser Bias parameters.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      You must modify 15 Min and 1 Day independently. To do so, choose the appropriate radio button and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      The hardware device that plugs into a card faceplate to provide a fiber interface to the card is called a Small Form-factor Pluggable (SFP, QSFP+, XFP, or CXP) or a C Form-factor Pluggable (CFP, CFP2, or CPAK). In CTC, SFPs, QSFPs+, XFPs, CXPs, CFPs, and CPAKs are called pluggable port modules (PPMs). SFPs/QSFPs+/XFPs/CXPs/CFPs/CPAKs are hot-swappable I/O devices that plug into a port to link the port with the fiber-optic network. Multirate PPMs have provisionable port rates and payloads. For more information, see SFP, SFP+, QSFP+, XFP, CXP, CFP, and CPAK Modules.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      For multi-lane pluggables (CXP, CFP, CPAK), the thresholds are set on the first lane and copied on the remaining lanes. You can edit only the first lane.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 5   Repeat step 3 and step 4 to provision each additional client port.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 6   Under Types, click the Alarm radio button and click Refresh.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 7   Verify if the client port Alarm thresholds for RX Power High, RX Power Low, TX Power High, and TX Power Low parameters are set based on the client interface that is provisioned. Provision new thresholds as needed by double-clicking the threshold value you want to change, deleting it, entering a new value, and hitting Enter.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 8   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 9   Repeat step 7 and step 8 to provision each additional client port.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 10   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      DLP-G722 Changing the Card OTN Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      This task changes the OTN settings for the 100G-LC-C, 100G-CK-C, 100G-ME-C, 100ME-CKC, 10x10G-LC, 200G-CK-LC, CFP-LC, or 400G-XP-LC cards.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      The OTN settings cannot be provisioned on the virtual port of the MR-MXP card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the card where you want to change the OTN settings.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 2   Click the Provisioning > OTN tabs, then choose one of the following subtabs: OTN Lines, ITU-T G.709 Thresholds, FEC Thresholds, Trail Trace Identifier, or Proactive Protection Regen.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 3   Modify any of the settings described in the following tables.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        You must modify each of these options independently: Near End and Far End, 15 Min and 1 Day, and SM and PM. To do so, choose the appropriate radio button and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        The following table describes the values on the Provisioning > OTN > OTN Lines tab.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Table 197  Card OTN Line Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Options

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        (Display only) Displays the port number.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        All client and trunk ports

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        ITU-T G.709 OTN

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Sets the OTN lines according to ITU-T G.709.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Enabled by default

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        FEC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Sets the OTN lines to forward error correction (FEC).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        See FEC Modes.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        SF BER

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        (Display only) Displays the signal fail (SF) bit error rate (BER).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 1E-5

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        SD BER

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Sets the signal degrade (SD) bit error rate (BER).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 1E-5

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 1E-6

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 1E-7 (Default)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 1E-8

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 1E-9

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        ProvidesSync

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Sets the ProvidesSync card parameter. If checked, the card is provisioned as a NE timing reference.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • Checked

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • Unchecked

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        SyncMsgIn

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Sets the EnableSync card parameter. Enables synchronization status messages (S1 byte), which allow the node to choose the best timing source.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • Checked

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • Unchecked

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Admin SSM In

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Overrides the synchronization status message (SSM) and the synchronization traceability unknown (STU) value. If the node does not receive an SSM signal, it defaults to STU.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • STU—Sync traceability unknown

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • ST2—Stratum 2

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • ST3—Stratum 3

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • SMC—SONET minimum clock

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • ST4—Stratum 4

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • DUS—Do not use for timing

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • RES—Reserved; quality level set

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        The following table describes the values on the Provisioning > OTN > ITU-T G.709 Thresholds tab.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Table 198  ITU-T G.709 Threshold Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Options

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        (Display only) Displays the port number.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        ES

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Errored seconds (ES)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Numeric. Can be set for Near End or Far End, for 15-minute or one-day intervals, or for SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk). Select an option and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        SES

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Severely errored seconds (SES)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Numeric. Can be set for Near End or Far End, for 15-minute or one-day intervals, or for SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk). Select an option and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        UAS

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Unavailable seconds (UAS)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Numeric. Can be set for Near End or Far End, for 15-minute or one-day intervals, or for SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk). Select an option and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        BBE

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Background block errors (BBE)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Numeric. Can be set for Near End or Far End, for 15-minute or one-day intervals, or for SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk). Select an option and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        FC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Failure counter (FC)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Numeric. Can be set for Near End or Far End, for 15-minute or one-day intervals, or for SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk). Select an option and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        The following table describes the values on the Provisioning > OTN > FEC Thresholds tab.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Table 199  Card FEC Threshold Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Options

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        (Display only) Displays the port number.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Bit Errors Corrected

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Sets the value for bit errors corrected.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Numeric. Can be set for 15-minute or one-day intervals.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Uncorrectable Words

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Sets the value for uncorrectable words.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Numeric. Can be set for 15-minute or one-day intervals.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        The following table describes the values on the Provisioning > OTN > Trail Trace Identifier tab.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Table 200 Card Trail Trace Identifier Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Options

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Displays the port number.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Sets the level.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • Section

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • Path

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Received Trace Mode

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Sets the trace mode.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • Off/None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • Manual

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Disable FDI on TTIM?

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        If a Trace Identifier Mismatch on Section overhead alarm arises because of a J0 overhead string mismatch, no Forward Defect Indication (FDI) signal is sent to the downstream nodes if this box is checked.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        This field is enabled only if the Received Trace Mode is set to Manual.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • Checked (FDI on TTIM is disabled)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • Unchecked (FDI on TTIM is not disabled)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Transmit

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        (Release 10.1 and earlier releases )

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Supported in 400G-XP-LC card

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Displays the current transmit string or sets a new transmit string.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • Hex Mode—Click to change the display to hexadecimal (button changes to ASCII Mode).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • ASCII Mode—Click to change the display to ASCII (button changes to Hex Mode).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          The button title changes based on the current display mode.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Expected

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        (Release 10.1 and earlier releases)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Supported in 400G-XP-LC card

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Displays the current expected string or sets a new expected string.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • Hex Mode—Click to change the display to hexadecimal (button changes to ASCII Mode).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • ASCII Mode—Click to change the display to ASCII (button changes to Hex Mode).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          The button title changes based on the current display mode.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Received

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        (Release 10.1 and earlier releases)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Supported in 400G-XP-LC card

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        (Display only) Displays the current received string.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • Hex Mode—Click to change the display to hexadecimal (button changes to ASCII Mode).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • ASCII Mode—Click to change the display to ASCII (button changes to Hex Mode).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          The button title changes based on the current display mode.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        In Release 10.3 and later releases:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Transmit Area—The Edit Transmit Area allows you to enter a new transmit string. The Current Transmit Area displays the current transmit string.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Expected Area—The Edit Expected Area allows you to enter a new expected string. The Current Expected Area displays the current expected string.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Received Area—The Current Received Area displays the current received string.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        SAPI

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Source Access Point Identifier (SAPI) of the TTI.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        DAPI

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Destination Access Point Identifier (DAPI) of the TTI.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        User Operator Data

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        User operator data of the TTI.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Edit Mode

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Sets the transmit or expected string type to ASCII or Hex.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Fill from Current

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Uses the values of the current or expected transmit string for the SAPI, DAPI, and User Operator Data fields.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Hex Mode

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        When the button label displays “Hex Mode”, the strings in the SAPI, DAPI and User Operator fields are in ASCII format. Click the Hex Mode button to display the string in hexadecimal format. The button name also changes to “ASCII Mode”. Click ASCII Mode to return the strings to ASCII format.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Auto-refresh

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        If checked, automatically refreshes the display every five seconds.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Do not check the auto-refresh checkbox while configuring the TTI strings.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • Checked

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • Unchecked (default)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        The received trace value in the Provisioning -> OTN -> Trail Trace Identifier tab might be empty upon the following conditions:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        1. The user has logged into the node for the first time.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        2. MXP_10x10G_100G operating mode is configured on the 100GS-CK-LC or the 200G-CK-LC card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        3. Trail Trace Identifier is configured.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        4. 100GS-CK-LC or the 200G-CK-LC card is reset.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Click Refresh or Reset to view the received trace value immediately or click Auto-refresh to view the received trace value after five seconds.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Table 201 Support for Proactive Protection Regeneration

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Card

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Operating Mode

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Supported Payloads

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        100G-LC-C and 100G-ME-C

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        TXP-100G or RGN-100G

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        100GE, OTU4

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        100G-CK-C and 100ME-CKC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        TXP-100G or RGN-100G

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • CPAK-­100G-­LR4 with 100GE,OTU4
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • CPAK-­100G-­SR10 with 100GE,OTU4

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        10x10G-­LC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        MXP-10x10G

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        OTU2

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        CFP-LC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        CFP-TXP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        100GE, OTU4

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        The 100GS-CK-LC and 200G-CK-LC cards do not support proactive protection.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        The following table describes the values on the Provisioning > OTN > Proactive Protection Regen tabs.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Table 202  Card Proactive Protection Regen Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Options

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        (Display only) Displays the port number and name (optional).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Trigger Threshold

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Sets the maximum BER threshold to trigger proactive protection.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 1E-3

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 9E-4 to 1E-4

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 9E-5 to 1E-5

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 9E-6 to 1E-6

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 9E-7 to 1E-7

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Trigger Window (ms)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Sets the duration when BER is monitored before triggering the proactive protection.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        The trigger window value must be a multiple of:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 10 ms for trigger thresholds between 1E-3 and 6E-6

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 100 ms for trigger threshold between 5E-6 to 1E-7

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Trigger window must be less than or equal to 500 ms for trigger thresholds between 1E-3 and 6E-6. The trigger window must be less than or equal to 3900 ms for trigger thresholds between 5E-6 to 1E-7.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Time in milliseconds.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Revert Threshold

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Sets the revert threshold value of BER.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        The revert threshold settings must be less than the trigger threshold values.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 1E-4

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 9E-5 to 1E-5

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 9E-6 to 1E-6

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 9E-7 to 1E-7

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 9E-8 to 5E-8

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Revert Window (ms)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Sets the duration when BER is monitored for settings that are less than the revert threshold value before which proactive protection provided to the router is removed.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        The revert window value must be at least 2000 ms and a multiple of:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 10 ms for a revert threshold of 1E-4 to 6E-7

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • 100 ms for a revert threshold of 5E-7 to 5E-8.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        The revert window must be less than or equal to 3900 ms.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Time in milliseconds.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Enable Proactive Protection

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Enables proactive protection.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        The available options for TXP-100G operating mode on the 100G-LC or 100G-CK card are:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • Disabled—Proactive protection is not enabled.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • FRR Proactive Protection—Supported on all the pluggables except on ONS-CC-100G-LR4= and CPAK-100G-LR4 when the client payload is 100GE-LAN.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • Pre-FEC PSM Proactive Protection—This option is supported on the trunk port only when the client has ONS-CC-100G-LR4= and CPAK-100G-LR4. Also, this option is applicable only when the card is configured in TXP-100G and CFP-TXP operating modes using 100GE or OTU4 payload.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        The available options for MXP-10x10G operating mode are:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • Enabled
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • Disabled

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        The available options for 10x10G-LC card are:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • Egress Proactive Protection Enabled
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • Egress Proactive Protection Disabled
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        DLP-G770 Enabling PRBS Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        This task enables PRBS settings for the 100G-LC-C, 100G-CK-C, 100G-ME-C, 100ME-CKC, 100GS-CK-LC, and 200G-CK-LC cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the card where you want to enable the PRBS settings.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 2   Click the Maintenance > PRBS tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 3   Modify any of the settings as described in the following table.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Table 203  Card PRBS Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Options

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          (Display only) Displays the port number.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Trunk ports

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Admin State

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Sets the port service state unless network conditions prevent the change. For more information about administrative states, see the Administrative and Service States document.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • IS (ANSI) or Unlocked (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • IS,AINS (ANSI) or Unlocked,automaticInService (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • OOS,DSBLD (ANSI) or Locked,disabled (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • OOS,MT (ANSI) or Locked,maintenance (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Generator Pattern

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Displays the pattern generated by the line card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          PRBS_31

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Detected Pattern

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Displays the pattern detected by the line card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • PRBS_11
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • PRBS_23
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • PRBS_31

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Only PRBS_31 is supported on the 100GS-CK-LC and 200G-CK-LC cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Pattern Sync Status

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Displays the pattern sync status.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • PATTERN_NONE
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • PATTERN_OK
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          • PATTERN_ERROR
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          NTP-G351 Retrieving MAC Addresses on MR-MXP Cards

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          This procedure enables you to retrieve the MAC address of the host connected to the MR-MXP ports for 10 GE clients using the Link Layer Discovery Protocol (LLDP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          NTP-G235 Provisioning an Operating Mode

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Retrieve or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 1   In the node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the MR-MXP card where you want to retrieve the source MAC addresses.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 2   Click the Maintenance > LLDP tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 3   Click Retrieve.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            The table displays the following fields:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Port-Displays the port number.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Source MAC Address-Displays the MAC address of the node to which the port is connected.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Stop. You have completed this procedure.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            NTP-G338 Provisioning an Operating Mode on the WSE Card

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            This procedure enables you to provision an operating mode on the WSE card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Super user

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the WSE card where you want to provision an operating mode. The card view appears.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Card tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              You cannot edit an existing operating mode on the WSE card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 3   In the Operating Modes tab, click Create.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 4   Choose the configuration from the Card Configuration drop-down list. The card configuration options are TXP-10G and RGN-10G modes.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 5   Select the defined port pair in the Card Configuration Dialog area. The WSE card supports a maximum of five TXP-10G modes, five RGN-10G modes, or a combination of five TXP-10G, and RGN-10G modes.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 6   Click Finish. The selected operating mode is provisioned on the WSE card.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 7   Complete the DLP-G726 Preprovisioning a Multirate PPM task.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 8   Complete the DLP-G278 Provisioning the Optical Line Rate task.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Stop. You have completed this procedure.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              NTP-G339 Modifying the WSE Card Line Settings and PM Parameter Thresholds

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              This procedure changes the line and PM parameter threshold settings of the WSE card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 1   As needed, complete the NTP-G103 Backing Up the Database task, to preserve the existing transmission settings.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 2   Perform any of the following tasks as needed:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Stop. You have completed this procedure.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                DLP-G739 Changing the WSE Card Line Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                This task changes the line settings of the WSE card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the WSE card where you want to change the line settings.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line > Ports tabs.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Tabs and parameter selections vary according to pluggable port modules (PPM) provisioning.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 3   Modify any of the line settings in the Ports tab as described in the following table.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Table 204 WSE Card Line Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Options

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  (Display only) Displays the port number.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  1 through 10

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Port Name

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Assigns a logical name for the specified port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  User-defined. Name can be up to 80 alphanumeric or special characters, or both. Blank by default.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  DLP-G104 Assigning a Name to a Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Admin State

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Sets the port service state unless network conditions prevent the change. For more information about administrative states, see the Administrative and Service States document.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • IS (ANSI) or Unlocked (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • OOS, DSBLD (ANSI) or Locked,disabled (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • OOS, MT (ANSI) or Locked,maintenance (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • IS, AINS (ANSI) or Unlocked,AutomaticInService (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Service State

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  (Display only) Identifies the autonomously generated state that gives the overall condition of the port. Service states appear in the format: Primary State-Primary State Qualifier, Secondary State. For more information about service states, see the Administrative and Service States document.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • IS-NR (ANSI) or Unlocked-enabled (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • OOS-AU, AINS (ANSI) or Unlocked-disabled, automaticInService (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • OOS-MA, DSBLD (ANSI) or Locked-enabled,disabled (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • OOS-MA, MT (ANSI) or Locked-enabled,maintenance (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • OOS-MA, LPBK&MT (ANSI) or Locked-enabled,loopback & maintenance (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  ALS Mode

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Sets the automatic laser shutdown (ALS) function mode.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • Disabled (default)— ALS is off; the laser is not automatically shut down when traffic outage or loss of signal (LOS) occurs.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • Auto Restart—ALS is on; the laser automatically shuts down when traffic outage or LOS occurs. It automatically restarts when the conditions that caused the outage are resolved.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • Manual Restart— ALS is on; the laser automatically shuts down when traffic outage or LOS occurs. However, the laser must be manually restarted when conditions that caused the outage are resolved.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • Manual Restart for Test— Manually restarts the laser for testing.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  AINS Soak

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Sets the automatic in-service (AINS) soak period. Double-click the time and use the up and down arrows to change settings.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • Duration of valid input signal, in hh.mm format, after which the card state changes to in-service (IS) automatically.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • 0 to 48 hours, 15-minute increments.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Reach

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Sets the optical reach distance of the client port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Autoprovision—The system automatically provisions the reach from the pluggable port module (PPM) reach value on the hardware.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Wavelength

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Displays the wavelength of the client port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • First Tunable Wavelength

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • Further wavelengths:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    • – 850 nm through 1610 nm

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  OverClock

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Enables or disables overclock mode.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • OFF

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • ON

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  When an OTU2 payload is provisioned on the WSE card in the TXP-10G or RGN-10G operating mode, the overclock parameter is automatically set to ON.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Fault Signalling

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Shuts down the far-end laser in response to certain defects.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • AIS/Send Local Fault

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • Squelch/Laser-Off

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Mapping Mode

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Sets the mapping mode.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  In a WSE card with a 10-GE payload, when a network fault or failure occurs, and the user sets squelch to the Disable state, the faults propagated downstream are different in GFP and CBR mapping.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  In GFP mapping, the device connected to the client reports a momentary local fault, but in CBR mapping, the local fault is reported for the entire duration of the fault.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • CBR

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • GFP

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Termination Mode

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Sets the termination mode.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Transparent
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Table 205 Reach Distances for WSE Card

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Card

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Payload

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Reach

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  WSE

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  OTU2

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  SR-MM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  P1I1-2D1

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  P1S1-2D2b

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  P1L1-2D2

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  DWDM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  OTU2e

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  TEN_GE_SR

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  TEN_GE_LR

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  TEN_GE_ER

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  TEN_GE_ZR

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  DWDM

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  DLP-G740 Changing the WSE Card Ethernet Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  This task changes the ethernet settings of the WSE card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the WSE card where you want to change the ethernet settings.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line > Ethernet tabs.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Tabs and parameter selections vary according to pluggable port modules (PPM) provisioning.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 3   Modify any of the line settings in the Ethernet tab as described in the table.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Table 206 WSE Card Ethernet Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Options

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    (Display only) Displays the port number n-n and rate.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    --

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Port Name

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    (Display only) Displays the port name.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    --

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Admin State

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Sets the port service state unless network conditions prevent the change. For more information about administrative states, see the Administrative and Service States document.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    • IS (ANSI) or Unlocked (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    • OOS, DSBLD (ANSI) or Locked,disabled (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    • OOS, MT (ANSI) or Locked,maintenance (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    • IS, AINS (ANSI) or Unlocked,AutomaticInService (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Service State

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    (Display only) Identifies the autonomously generated state that gives the overall condition of the port. Service states appear in the format: Primary State-Primary State Qualifier, Secondary State. For more information about service states, see the Administrative and Service States document.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    • IS-NR (ANSI) or Unlocked-enabled (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    • OOS-AU, AINS (ANSI) or Unlocked-disabled, automaticInService (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    • OOS-MA, DSBLD (ANSI) or Locked-enabled,disabled (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    • OOS-MA, MT (ANSI) or Locked-enabled,maintenance (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    • OOS-MA, LPBK&MT (ANSI) or Locked-enabled,loopback & maintenance (ETSI)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    ALS Mode

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Sets the automatic laser shutdown (ALS) function mode.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    • Disabled (default)— ALS is off; the laser is not automatically shut down when traffic outage or loss of signal (LOS) occurs.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    • Manual Restart— ALS is on; the laser automatically shuts down when traffic outage or LOS occurs. However, the laser must be manually restarted when conditions that caused the outage are resolved.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    • Manual Restart for Test— Manually restarts the laser for testing.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    AINS Soak

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Sets the automatic in-service (AINS) soak period. Double-click the time and use the up and down arrows to change settings.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    • Duration of valid input signal, in hh.mm format, after which the card state changes to in-service (IS) automatically.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    • 0 to 48 hours, 15-minute increments.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Reach

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Sets the optical reach distance of the client port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Autoprovision—The system automatically provisions the reach from the pluggable port module (PPM) reach value on the hardware.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Wavelength

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Displays the wavelength of the client port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    • First Tunable Wavelength

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    • Further wavelengths:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      • – 850 nm through 1610 nm

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    MTU

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Sets the maximum size of the Ethernet frames accepted by the port. The port must be in OOS/locked state.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Numeric. Default: 1548

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Range 64 to 9700

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Termination Mode

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    (Display-only) Sets the mode of operation.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Transparent
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    DLP-G744 Changing the WSE Card Security Thresholds

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    This task changes the security threshold settings of the WSE card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the WSE card where you want to change the security threshold settings.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Security Thresholds tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 3   Modify any of the settings as described in the table.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      You must modify each of these options independently: TCA and Alarm, and 15 Min and 1 Day. To do so, choose the appropriate radio button and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Table 207 WSE Card Security Threshold Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Selects the port number.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Sequence Mismatch

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Shows the number of times the Sequence Number (SEQ) for an AES packet has differed at the encryption and decryption ends.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Sequence Mismatch Interval

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Shows the interval between successive sequence mismatches.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Authentication Error

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Shows the number of times there has been a mismatch between the ICV (Integrity Check Value) received with an encrypted packet and the ICV calculated at the decryption end.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Authentication Error Interval

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Shows the interval between successive authentication errors.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Backward Authentication Error

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Shows the number of times an authentication error has been detected at the egress of the destination WSE port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Backward Authentication Error Interval

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Shows the interval between successive backward authentication errors.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      DLP-G745 Changing the WSE Card Line RMON Thresholds

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      This task changes the line RMON threshold settings for WSE cards carrying Ethernet or FC payloads.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the WSE card where you want to change the RMON threshold settings in the card view.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Line Thresholds > RMON Thresholds tabs.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 3   Click Create. The Create Threshold dialog box appears.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 4   From the Port drop-down list, choose the applicable port, either the payload port, for example “1-1 (TEN_GE)” port.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 5   From the Variable drop-down list, choose an Ethernet variable. See Table 11-230 for a list of available Ethernet variables.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Table 208 WSE Card Ethernet Variables

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Variable

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        rxTotalPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Total number of received packets.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        etherStatsPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Total number of frames received on an interface in both Rx and Tx directions.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        etherStatsOctets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Total number of octets of data (including those in bad packets) received on the network (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        etherStatsOversizePkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Total number of packets received that were longer than 1518 octets (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets) and were otherwise well-formed.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        dot3StatsFCSErrors

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Total number of frames received on a particular interface that are an integral number of octets in length but do not pass the FCS check.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        dot3StatsAlignmentErrors

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Total number of frames received on a particular interface that are not an integral number of octets in length and do not pass the FCS check. This counter is only valid for FE modes of operation.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        dot3StatsSymbolErrors

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Contains a count of received frames that have an associated RX_ER assertion during a data reception error event (MII) or data reception error event or carrier extension error (GMII) from the PCS.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        dot3StatsFrameTooLong

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Total number of frames received on a particular interface that exceed the maximum permitted frame size.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        dot3StatsLCVErrors/mediaIndStatsRxLcvErrors

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Number of received line code violations at the PCS layer.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        dot3StatsLayer1Errors

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Number of Layer 1 errors as defined within the following conditions:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • During Packet Reception—Layer 1 errors are only counted one time per packet. The Layer 1 error is indicated as a direct result of a line side protocol violation in which RX_DV is asserted. This is an uncommon event from which may be the reason why the device loses synchronization.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        • During Interpacket Reception—The Layer 1 error is indicated as a direct result of a line side protocol violation in which RX_DV is de-asserted. This is an uncommon event. The Layer 1 error is also asserted on detection of a False Carrier indication and is asserted on detection of Erred byte (interpacket) signal encoding. When the Layer 1 error is asserted during inter-packet reception, it is only statistically asserted in the vector.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        etherStatsJabbers

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Total number of packets received that were longer than 1518 octets (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets), and had either a bad FCS with an integral number of octets (FCS error) or a bad FCS with a non-integral number of octets (alignment error).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        etherStatsUndersizePkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Total number of packets received that were less than 64 octets long (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets) and were otherwise well-formed.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        etherStatsFragments

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Total number of packets received that were less than 64 octets in length (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets) and had either a bad FCS with an integral number of octets (FCS error) or a bad FCS with a non-integral number of octets (alignment error). Note that it is entirely normal for etherStatsFragments to increment. This is because itcounts both runts (which are normal occurrences due to collisions) and noise hits.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        etherStatsPkts64Octets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Total number of packets (including bad packets) received that were 64 octets in length (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        etherStatsPkts65to127Octets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Total number of packets (including bad packets) received that were between 65 and 127 octets in length inclusive (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        etherStatsPkts128to255Octets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Total number of packets (including bad packets) received that were between 128 and 255 octets in length inclusive (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        etherStatsPkts256to511Octets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Total number of packets (including bad packets) received that were between 256 and 511 octets in length inclusive (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        etherStatsPkts512to1023Octets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Total number of packets (including bad packets) received that were between 512 and 1023 octets in length inclusive (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        etherStatsPkts1024to1518Octets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Total number of packets (including bad packets) received that were between 1024 and 1518 octets in length inclusive (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        etherStatsMulticastPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Total number of good packets received that were directed to a multicast address. Note that this number does not include packets directed to the broadcast address.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        etherStatsBroadcastPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Total number of good packets received that were directed to the broadcast address. Note that this number does not include multicast packets.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        etherStatsPkts1519tomaxOctets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Total number of packets (including bad packets) received that were 1591 octets in length (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        ifInUcastPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        (The counter does not increment for traffic with incorrect Ethertype and packet size of more than 64 bytes on the WSE card.)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Total number of packets delivered by this sublayer to a higher sublayer that are not addressed to a multicast or broadcast address.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        ifInMulticastPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        (The counter does not increment for traffic with incorrect Ethertype and packet size of more than 64 bytes on the WSE card.)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Total number of packets delivered by this sublayer to a higher sublayer that are addressed to a multicast address. For a MAC layer protocol, this includes both group and functional addresses.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        ifInBroadcastPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        (The counter does not increment for traffic with incorrect Ethertype and packet size of more than 64 bytes on the WSE card.)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Total number of packets delivered by this sublayer to a higher sublayer that are addressed to a broadcast address.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        ifInErrors

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Total number of received errors.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        IfOutUcastPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Total count of packets transmitted to a unicast group destination address.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        ifOutMulticastPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Total number of packets that higher-level protocols requested to be transmitted, which were addressed to a multicast address at this sublayer. These include packets that were discarded or not sent. For a MAC layer protocol, this includes both group and functional addresses.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        ifOutBroadcastPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Total number of packets that higher-level protocols requested to be transmitted, which were addressed to a broadcast address at this sublayer. These include packets that were discarded or not sent.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        ifOutOctets

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Total number of octets transmitted out of the interface, including framing characters.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        mediaIndStatsTXFramesBadCRC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Total number of transmitted data frames with payload CRC errors when HDLC framing is used.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        mediaIndStatsTXShortPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Number of transmitted frames containing less than the minimum permitted frame size as programmed with the transmit MAC Min Frame Length Configuration Register.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        txTotalPkts

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Total number of transmitted packets.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 6   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 7   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        DLP-G746 Provisioning the WSE Card with Port Alarm and TCA Thresholds

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        This task provisions the WSE card with port alarm and TCA thresholds.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the WSE card where you want to provision the alarm and TCA threshold settings for the port.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 2   Click the Provisioning > Optics Thresholds tabs. The TCA thresholds are shown by default.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Note    You must modify 15 Min and 1 Day independently. Choose the appropriate radio button and click Refresh.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Note    Do not modify the Laser Bias parameters.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 3   If TCA is not selected, select the TCA option and then click Refresh. If it is checked, continue with Step 4.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 4   Verify whether the port TCA thresholds for RX Power High, RX Power Low, TX Power High, and TX Power Low are set.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Provision new thresholds as needed by double-clicking the threshold value you want to change, deleting it, entering a new value, and pressing Enter.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 5   Under Types, click the Alarm radio button and click Refresh.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 6   Verify whether the port alarm thresholds for RX Power High, RX Power Low, TX Power High, and TX Power Low are set.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Provision new thresholds as needed by double-clicking the threshold value you want to change, deleting it, entering a new value, and pressing Enter.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 7   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 8   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          DLP-G747 Change the WSE Card OTN Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          This task changes the OTN settings for the WSE card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          DLP-G46 Log into CTC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Provisioning or higher

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 1   In node view (single-shelf mode) or shelf view (multishelf view), double-click the WSE card where you want to change the OTN settings.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 2   Click the Provisioning > OTN tabs. Choose one of these subtabs: OTN Lines, ITU-T G.709 Thresholds, FEC Thresholds, or Trail Trace Identifier.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 3   Modify any of the settings described in the tables.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Note    You must modify each of these options independently: Near End and Far End, 15 Min and 1 Day, and SM and PM. Choose the appropriate radio button and click Refresh.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            The table describes the values on the Provisioning > OTN > OTN Lines tab.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Table 209 WSE Card OTN Line Settings
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Parameter Description Options

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            (Display only) Displays the port number.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            All client and trunk ports

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            ITU-T G.709

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            OTN

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Sets the OTN lines according to ITU-T G.709.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Enabled by default

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            FEC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Sets the OTN lines to forward error correction (FEC).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Disable

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Standard

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Enhanced

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            SF BER

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            (Display only) Displays the signal fail (SF) bit error rate (BER).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            1E-5

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            SD BER

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Sets the signal degrade (SD) bit error rate (BER).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • 1E-5

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • 1E-6

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • 1E-7 (Default)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • 1E-8

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • 1E-9

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            ProvidesSync

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Sets the ProvidesSync card parameter. If checked, the card is provisioned as a NE timing reference.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Checked

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Unchecked

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            SyncMsgIn

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Sets the EnableSync card parameter. Enables synchronization status messages (S1 byte), which allow the node to choose the best timing source.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Checked

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Unchecked

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Admin SSM In

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Overrides the synchronization status message (SSM) and the synchronization traceability unknown (STU) value. If the node does not receive an SSM signal, it defaults to STU.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • PRS—Primary Reference Source

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • STU—Sync traceability unknown

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • ST2—Stratum 2

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • ST3—Stratum 3

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • SMC—SONET minimum clock

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • ST4—Stratum 4

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • DUS—Do not use for timing

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • RES—Reserved; quality level set

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            The following table describes the values on the Provisioning > OTN > ITU-T G.709 Thresholds tab.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Table 210 WSE ITU-T G.709 Threshold Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Options

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            (Display only) Displays the port number.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            All client and trunk ports

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            ES

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Errored seconds (ES)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Numeric. Can be set for Near End or Far End, for 15-minutes or one-day intervals, or for SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk). Select an option and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            SES

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Severely errored seconds (SES)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Numeric. Can be set for Near End or Far End, for 15-minutes or one-day intervals, or for SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk). Select an option and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            UAS

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Unavailable seconds (UAS)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Numeric. Can be set for Near End or Far End, for 15-minutes or one-day intervals, or for SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk). Select an option and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            BBE

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Background block errors (BBE)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Numeric. Can be set for Near End or Far End, for 15-minutes or one-day intervals, or for SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk). Select an option and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            FC

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Failure counter (FC)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Numeric. Can be set for Near End or Far End, for 15-minutes or one-day intervals, or for SM (OTUk) or PM (ODUk). Select an option and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            The following table describes the values on the Provisioning > OTN > FEC Thresholds tab.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Table 211 WSE Card FEC Threshold Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Options

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            (Display only) Displays the port number.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            All client and trunk ports

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Bit Errors Corrected

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Sets the value for bit errors corrected.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Numeric. Can be set for 15-minutes or one-day intervals. Select an option and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Uncorrectable Words

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Sets the value for uncorrectable words.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Numeric. Can be set for 15-minutes or one-day intervals. Select an option and click Refresh.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            The following table describes the values on the Provisioning > OTN > Trail Trace Identifier tab.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Table 212 WSE Card Trail Trace Identifier Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Parameter

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Description

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Options

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Port

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            (Display only) Displays the port number.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            All client and trunk ports

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Sets the level.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Section

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Path

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Received Trace Mode

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Sets the trace mode.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Off/None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Manual

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Disable FDI on TTIM?

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            If a Trace Identifier Mismatch on Section overhead alarm arises because of a J0 overhead string mismatch, no Forward Defect Indication (FDI) signal is sent to the downstream nodes if this box is checked.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            This field is enabled only if the Received Trace Mode is set to Manual.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Checked (FDI on TTIM is disabled)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Manual

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Unchecked (FDI on TTIM is not disabled)

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Transmit

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Displays the current transmit string or sets a new transmit string.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Hex Mode— Click to change the display to hexadecimal (button changes to ASCII Mode).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • ASCII Mode—Click to change the display to ASCII (button changes to Hex Mode).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              The button title changes based on the current display mode.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Expected

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Displays the current expected string or sets a new expected string.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Hex Mode— Click to change the display to hexadecimal (button changes to ASCII Mode).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • ASCII Mode—Click to change the display to ASCII (button changes to Hex Mode).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              The button title changes based on the current display mode.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Received

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            (Display only) Displays the current received string.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Hex Mode— Click to change the display to hexadecimal (button changes to ASCII Mode).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • ASCII Mode—Click to change the display to ASCII (button changes to Hex Mode).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              The button title changes based on the current display mode.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Auto-refresh

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            If checked, automatically refreshes the display every 5 seconds.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Checked

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            • Unchecked

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            NTP-G340 Provisioning Encryption on the WSE and MR-MXP Cards

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            This procedure enables you to provision encryption on the WSE and MR-MXP cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Security super user

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            The card authentication and payload encryption must be enabled to check Bit Interleaved Parity-8 (BIP-8) functionality on encrypted traffic.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Perform any of the following tasks as needed:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Stop. You have completed this procedure.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            DLP-G759 Configuring GCC2 Settings

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            This task configures a GCC2 channel on OTN enabled trunk ports to establish a connection between two WSE or two MR-MXP cards by configuring the IP address and ports of the source and destination cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Disable Card Authentication for MR-MXP Card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            The card authentication and payload encryption are enabled by default and cannot be disabled for MR-MXP-K9 and MR-MXP-K9= PIDs.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Onsite or Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Security super user

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 1   In node view (single shelf mode), or shelf view (multi-shelf mode), double-click the WSE or MR-XMP card for which you want to configure the GCC settings.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 2   Go to Provisioning > Encryption > GCC2 Settings.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 3   In the Card IP Address field, provide the IP address of the source WSE or MR-MXP card.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 4   Click on the Destination Card IP entry. Specify the IP address of the destination card.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 5   Click on the Destination Port entry. Specify the port number of the destination card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              There can be multiple destination card IPs and destination ports for WSE card and only a single destination card IP and destination port for MR-MXP card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 6   Click Apply.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              To change the MR-MXP card role from master to slave and vice versa:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              1. Remove only the card IP address or only the destination card IP address or both.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              2. Modify or configure the required IP address in the Card IP Address or Destination Card IP field.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 7   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              DLP-G748 Enabling Card Authentication

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              This task initiates the authentication of a destination WSE or MR-MXP card with a source WSE or MR-MXP card. This ensures that the source card communicates only with the destination card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              The card authentication and payload encryption are enabled by default and cannot be disabled for MR-MXP-K9 and MR-MXP-K9= PIDs.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Required

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Onsite or Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Super user

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 1   In node view (single shelf mode), or shelf view (multi-shelf mode), double-click the WSE or MR-MXP card for which you need to enable card authentication.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 2   Go to Provisioning > Encryption > Security.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 3   (Only for WSE card) From the Port list, choose the port on which card authentication is to be enabled.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 4   Check the Card Authentication checkbox.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                The master key for encryption is exchanged between the source and destination WSE or MR-MXP cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 5   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 6   (Only for WSE card) Repeat step 3 to step 5 for every port that carries the encrypted payload, as the card authentication takes place independently on each port of the source WSE card.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 7   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                DLP-G749 Enabling Payload Encryption

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                This task enables encryption of OTN frames emerging from a port of the source WSE or MR-MXP card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                The card authentication and payload encryption are enabled by default and cannot be disabled for MR-MXP-K9 and MR-MXP-K9= PIDs.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Required

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Onsite or Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Security super user

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 1   In node view (single shelf mode), or shelf view (multi-shelf mode), double-click the WSE or MR-MXP card for which you want to enable payload encryption.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 2   Go to Provisioning > Encryption > Security.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 3   Check the Payload Encryption check box to enable encryption of the OTN frames.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  In WSE card, do not enable encryption with far-end client loopback. This affects the traffic. In MR-MXP card, the client loopback is disabled when encryption is enabled.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  When encryption is enabled in the near end and disabled in the far end, the client port of MR-MXP card raises Local Fault (LF) and the client port of WSE card raises SYNCLOSS alarm.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 4   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 5   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  DLP-G Enabling Payload Authentication and Setting Authentication Error Thresholds

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  This task enables payload authentication on the MR-MXP card to validate the integrity of the received payloads. This task also sets the payload authentication error thresholds.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  The payload authentication is enabled by default and can be disabled for MR-MXP-K9 and MR-MXP-K9= PIDs of MR-MXP card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Required

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Onsite or Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Super user

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 1   In node view (single shelf mode), or shelf view (multi-shelf mode), double-click the MR-MXP card for which you want to enable payload authentication.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 2   Go to Provisioning > Encryption > Security tab.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 3   Check the Payload Authentication check box to enable payload authentication and click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 4   Go to Provisioning > Security Thresholds tab and click the Alarm radio button.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 5   Enter the authentication error threshold value in the Payload Authentication Error field.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    The default value is 1. The range is 1 to 500.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    The Payload Authentication Alarm is raised when the payload authentication error PM counter for 10 seconds in the Encryption PM tab exceeds the payload authentication error value set in the Security Thresholds tab. The Payload Authentication Alarm is not raised if payload authentication is enabled only on the near end or far end.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Step 6   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    DLP-G753 Setting AES Secure Packet Configuration

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    This task configures the number of OTN frames per AES secure packet. The AES secure packet for each port can be made up of 4 or 8 OTN frames. For more information, see AES Secure Packet

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    The card authentication and payload encryption are enabled by default and cannot be disabled for MR-MXP-K9 and MR-MXP-K9= PIDs.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Onsite or Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Security super user

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 1   In node view (single shelf mode), or shelf view (multi-shelf mode), double-click the WSE or MR-MXP card for which you want to set the AES secure packet configuration.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 2   Go to Provisioning > Encryption > OTN Overhead for Packet traffic.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 3   Click on the AES Secure Packet entry corresponding to the port where the AES secure packet must be configured. A dropdown list appears.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 4   From the drop-down list, choose either 4 OTN Frame Based or 8 OTN Frame Based.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 5   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Step 6   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      DLP-G754 Specifying ESP Header and Trailer Locations

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      This task specifies the location of the ESP (Encapsulating Security Payload) Header and Trailer in each OTN frame of the AES secure packet.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      The card authentication and payload encryption are enabled by default and cannot be disabled for MR-MXP-K9 and MR-MXP-K9= PIDs.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Onsite or Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Security super user

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                      Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 1   In node view (single shelf mode), or shelf view (multi-shelf mode), double-click the WSE or MR-MXP card for which you want to specify the ESP header and trailer locations.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 2   Go to Provisioning > Encryption > OTN Overhead for Packet traffic.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 3   Click on the ESP Header Location entry corresponding to a port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        The locations available are A, B, C, D, E and F. The default values of ESP Header Location and ESP Trailer Location are location A. The ESP header and trailer require a total of 32 bytes within the OTN overhead.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 4   Choose the ESP header location from the predefined values in the list.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        The ESP Trailer Location is updated to match the location of the ESP header.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 5   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Step 6   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        DLP-G755 Enabling PRBS Generation and Monitoring

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        This task lets you enable PRBS generation at the ingress, and PRBS monitoring at the egress of each port for the source and destination WSE or MR-MXP cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        For MR-MXP card, PRBS Generation and Monitoring is possible only when card authentication and payload encryption are disabled.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        The card authentication and payload encryption are enabled by default and cannot be disabled for MR-MXP-K9 and MR-MXP-K9= PIDs.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Onsite or Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Security super user

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                        Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 1   In node view (single shelf mode), or shelf view (multi-shelf mode), double-click the WSE or MR-MXP card for which you want to enable PRBS generation and PRBS monitoring.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 2   Go to Provisioning > Encryption > OTN Overhead for Packet traffic.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 3   Check the Ingress PRBS Generator check box for a port to enable PRBS generation at the ingress of that port. The ingress of a port is the data path in the encryption block.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 4   Check the Egress PRBS Monitor check box for a port to enable PRBS monitoring at the egress of that port. The egress of a port is the data path in the decryption block.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 5   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Step 6   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          DLP-G751 Resetting the Master Key

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          This task lets you reset the master key for each encrypted stream of the source WSE or MR-MXP card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          For more information, see Key Management.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Onsite or Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Security user or security super user

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                          Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 1   In node view (single shelf mode), or shelf view (multi-shelf mode), double-click the WSE or MR-MXP card for which you want to reset the master key.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 2   Go to Provisioning > Encryption > Key Management.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 3   (For WSE card) Click the Reset Master Key button for a port to reset the master key used for the payload encryption on that port.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            (For MR-MXP card) Click the Reset Master Key button to reset the master key used for the payload encryption on the card.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            By resetting the master key, a key exchange is enforced by overriding the existing master key reset interval, and a new interval is calculated from the time the key is reset.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 4   Check the TCA on Key Reset check box to raise TCA notification indicating MASTERKEY-SUCCESS transient condition of the payload on a port listed in the Port column.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            When this check box is checked on both the near end and far end, the Alarms and History tabs are updated with TCA notifications on both the near end and far end in the specified master key change interval. Two key resets occur in every key reset interval.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 5   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Step 6   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            DLP-G752 Changing the Master Key Reset Interval

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            This task lets you change the master key reset interval between two consecutive resets of the master key that is used for payload encryption.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Onsite or Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Security user or security super user

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                            Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 1   In node view (single shelf mode), or shelf view (multi-shelf mode), double-click the WSE or MR-MXP card for which you want to change the master key reset interval.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 2   Go to Provisioning > Encryption > Key Management.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 3   Click on the Master Key Change Interval entry. For WSE card, two spin boxes appear in place of the entry and for MR-MXP card, four spin boxes appear.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              For WSE card, the box on the left registers the time in hours; the box on the right, the time in minutes. For MR-MXP card, four boxes register the time in days, hours, minutes, and seconds.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              For WSE card, the master key interval can be set in multiples of 15 minutes between 15 minutes to 48 hours. For MR-MXP card, the master key interval can be set between 50 seconds and 48 hours.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 4   Set the desired values in the boxes.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              When the time interval elapses, a new master key is exchanged between the source and destination WSE or MR-MXP cards.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 5   Check the TCA on Key Reset check box to raise TCA notification indicating MASTERKEY-SUCCESS transient condition of the payload on a port listed in the Port column.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              When this check box is checked on both the near end and far end, the Alarms and History tabs are updated with TCA notifications on both the near end and far end in the specified master key change interval. Two key resets occur in every key reset interval.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 6   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Step 7   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              NTP-G342 Provisioning FIPS and CC Mode

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              This procedure lets you enable the FIPS and CC mode on the node.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              As needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Onsite or remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Security super user


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Note


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Provisioning a FIPS and CC mode is not supported in Macintosh computers.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Perform any of the following tasks as needed:

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Stop. You have completed this procedure.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              DLP-G761 Enabling FIPS and CC Mode

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              This task lets you enable the Federal Information Processing Standard (FIPS) mode and Common Criteria (CC) for the node. The CTC can be run in FIPS and CC mode. It supports FIPS 140-2 level 2 standards of encryption and cryptographic services. The CC certification ensures that the node is accessed, managed, monitored and provisioned in a highly secure manner. In the FIPS and CC mode, only the algorithms that are approved by FIPS and CC can be run. When the FIPS and CC mode is selected, the node reboots and performs a self-test at startup.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Note   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Use this procedure with caution. Running FIPS and CC mode in a multi-shelf node with the WSE card in the master shelf, might lead to loss of control with the subtended shelfs if a problem occurs.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Onsite or Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Security super user


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Note


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              When FIPS mode is enabled during CTC startup, CTC cache directory path must not contain any space in the Settings > Cache tab. Otherwise, CTC cannot be launched successfully.


                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                              Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 1   Select the node for which you want to enable FIPS and CC mode.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 2   Secure all the access points:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                1. In the node view, click Provisioning > Security > Access.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                2. Change the Access State of Pseudo IOS Access, Shell Access, EMS Access, TL1 Access , and SNMP Access to Secure state.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                3. Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 3   Click the FIPS and CC tab.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 4   Select the FIPS and CC Mode check box to enable FIPS and CC mode for that node.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Caution   

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                In a situation that warrants a breach into the system, the system can be protected by erasing the private keys. To erase all the private keys in the WSE, MR-MXP, and TNC cards, click Zeroise Key. A warning message is displayed with details about the consequence of zeroizing the keys. This will rewrite all the private keys with zeros. This implementation for the private keys is a requirement as per the FIPS 140-2 compliance.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 5   Click Apply.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Step 6   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                DLP-G760 Configuring Management of FIPS and CC Mode Enabled NE

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Purpose

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                This task configures the requirements to manage the Federal Information Processing Standard (FIPS) and Common Criteria (CC) mode enabled network element.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                This procedure also applies to EMS and Shell Secure mode.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Tools/Equipment

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Prerequisite Procedures

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Required/As Needed

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Required to use the FIPS and CC mode

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Onsite/Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Onsite or Remote

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Security Level

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                None

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                Procedure
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 1   Install JRE version 7.0.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  1. Uninstall previous versions of JREs from the control panel.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  2. Restart the computer.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  3. Download and install the latest JRE version 7.0. for Windows x64.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 2   Go to Java Control Panel and click the Advanced tab. Expand Security > General settings. Perform these actions:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  1. Uncheck the Use SSL 3.0 check box.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  2. Check the Use TLS 1.0 check box.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 3   In the Java Control Panel, click the General tab. Click Settings and perform these actions to clear the JNLP cache:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  1. Clear the Keep temporary files on my computer check box.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  2. Click Delete Files.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  3. Select the files to delete and click OK.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  4. Click OK and exit the Java Control Panel.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 4   Install Java Cryptography Extension (JCE)version 7.0.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  1. Download the JCE.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  2. Extract the contents of the downloaded policy file.
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  3. Copy and overwrite the security policy file to C:\Program Files\Java\jre7\lib\security\.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    <java-home>/lib/security [Unix]

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    <java-home>\lib\security [Win32]

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    where <java-home> is the location where the Jave SE Runtime Environmen (JRE) is installed.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 5   Configure the browser settings:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • Chrome browser settings:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    1. Go to Chrome > Settings.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    2. Click the Change Proxy settings button and click the Encryption tab.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    3. Uncheck the Use SSL 3.0 check box.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    4. Check the Use TLS 1.0 check box and click OK.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  • Firefox browser settings:
                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    1. Go to Mozilla Firefox > Tools > Options.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    2. Click the Advanced tab.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    3. Click the tab.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    4. Uncheck the Use SSL 3.0 check box.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    5. Check the Use TLS 1.0 check box.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    6. Click Security Devices.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    7. Click Enable FIPS.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                    8. Click OK twice.

                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                                  Step 6   Return to your originating procedure (NTP).